You are on page 1of 1100

Engineering

Mechanics
Statics and Dynamics

Irving H. Shames
Professor
Dept. of Civil, Mechanical and Eirvirorrmenrul En,qirierring
The George Washington Uiiiver.yiQ

Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River, New Jersey 07458


Acqui\iiionr Editor: William Stenquiit
Editor in Chic1 Marcia Hoiton
I’mduclion Editor: Ro\e Krrnao
Text I l e s p c r : Christme Wull
Covcr Dc\igsei: Amy Roam
Editorial Ashiavant: Meg Wci.1
Manufacturing Buyer: Lhnna Sullivan

K&Jj 0 1907. 19811. 1Yhh. 1959. 10% hy Prsnlice~Hall,Inc


Simon & SchusterlA Viacom Company
Upprr Saddle River. Ncw Jcrsey (17458

The author and puhlisher ol Ihis hook have u ~ r i ihcir


l k s t eflurl\ in preparing this hook.
These cfforti include Ihe development, rcsearch, anti crrling ofthe theurieq and progrilms
10 deteiminc their sffeclirenen. ‘The mthur arid puhlirher shall not he liable m any cveiit for
incidcniel o r cunrequeiitial d;mngrs wilh. or arising w l OS, lhc furnishing. pcrformiincc. or
usc of their p n i p m s .

All rights lsscrvcd. N o pact ofrhis h w k may be repruduscd o r


rrmsmillcd in m y form or hy m y mrilns. without written peimi\sion
in writing from Ihc puhliahei.

Printetl in the Unilml States of America

IIJ 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 I

I S B N 0-L3-35b924-l

Prcnlice-Hall lntcriiilli~niil(UKI Limited. Lundon


Prcnlicc-Hall of Australia Ply Limmd. SyJocy
Prriilice~HnllCan.tda Inc.. Toconlu
Prcnlicc~HallHispanuamcricima, S . A . . Mexico
Prcnlicc-Hall of India Privillc I.imiled. New D c l h i
Prentics~Hilll01 Japan. Inc.. Tokyo
Simon & Schuhlcr Ask& PIC. Lld., S i n p p o r r
Edilorn Prenlice Hall do Rmsil, I.tda., Rio d,: J;meilo
Contents

Preface ix $2.3 Addition and Subtraction


of Vectors 24
1 Fundamentals of Mechanics 2.4 Resolution of Vectors; Scalar
Review I 3 Components 30
tl.1 Introduction 3 t2.5 Unit Vectors 33
t1.2 Basic Dimensions and Units 2.6 Useful Ways of Representing
of Mechanics, 4 Vectors 35
71.3 Secondary Dimensional Quantities 7 2.7 Scalar or Dot Product of Two
71.4 Law of Dimensional Homogeneity 8 Vectors 41
71.5 Dimensional Relation between 2.8 Cross Product of Two Vectors 47
Force and Mass 9 2.9 Scalar Triple Product 5 1
1.6 Units of Mass 10
2.10 A Note on Vector Notation 54
1.7 Idealizations of Mechanics 12
2.11 Closure 56
11.8 Vector and Scalar Quantities 14
1.9 Equality and Equivalence
of Vectors 17
t1.10 Laws of Mechanics 19 3 Important vector Quantities 61
1.11 Closure 22 3.1 Position Vector 61
3.2 Moment of a Force about a Point 62
3.3 Moment of a Force about an Axis 69
2 Elements of vector Algebra 3.4 The Couple and Couple Moment 77
Review II 23 3.5 The Couple Moment as a
t2.1 Introduction 23 Free Vector 79
72.2 Magnitude and Multiplication 3.6 Addition and Subtraction of
of a Vector by a Scalar 23 Couples 80
IV CONTENTS

3.7 Moment of a Couple About a Line 82 6.6 Looking Ahead-Deflection of


3.8 Closure 89 a Simple, Linearly Elastic Truss 242

4 Equivalent Force systems 93 Part B: Section Forces in Beams 247


4.1 Introduction 93 6.7 Introduction 247
4.2 Translation of a Force to 6.8 Shear Force, Axial Force,
a Parallel Position 94 and Bending Moment 247
4.3 Resultant of a Force System 102 6.9 Differential Relations
4.4 Simplest Resultants of Special for Equilibrium 25Y
Force Systems 106
4.5 Distributed Force Systems 107 Part C: Chains and Cables 266
4.6 Closure 143 6.10 Introduction 266
6.11 Coplanar Cables; Loading is a Function
5 Equations of Equilibrium 151 ofx 266
5.1 lntroduction 15 I 6.12 Coplanar Cables: Loading is the Weight
of the Cable Itself 270
5.2 The Free-body Diagram 152
6.13 Closure 277
5.3 Free Bodies Involving
Interior Sections 154
*5.4 Looking Ahead-Control 7 Friction FOrCeS 281
Volumes 158 7.1 Introduction 281
5.5 General Equations of Equilibrium 162 7.2 Laws of Coulomb Friction 282
5.6 Problems of Equilibrium I 164 *7.3 A Comment Concerning the
5.7 Problems of Equilibrium 11 183 Use of Coulomb’.: Law 284
5.8 Two Point Equivalent Loading 199 7.4 Simple Contact Friction Problems 284
5.9 Problems Arising from Structures 200 7.5 Complex Surface Contact Friction
5.10 Static Indeterminacy 204 Problems 299
5.11 Closure 210 7.6 Belt Friction 301
7.7 The Square Screw Thread 3 17
6 introduction to structural *7.8 Rolling Resistance 319
Mechanics 221 7.9 Closure 323

Part A: Trusses 221 8 Properties of surfaces 331


6.1 The Structural Model 221 8.1 Introduction 331
6.2 The Simple Truss 224 8.2 First Moment of an Area and
6.3 Solution of Simple Trusses 225 the Centroid 331
6.4 Method of Joints 225 8.3 Other Centers 342
6.5 Method of Sections 238 8.4 Theorems of Pappus-Guldinus 347
CONTENTS V

8.5 Second Moments and the Product 10.5 Looking Ahead-Deformable


of Area of a Plane Area 355 Solids 424
8.6 Tranfer Theorems 356
8.7 Computations Involving Second Moments Part B: Method of Total Potential
and Products of Area 357 Energy 432
8.8 Relation Between Second Moments and
10.6 Conservative Systems 432
Products of Area 366
10.7 Condition of Equilibrium
8.9 Polar Moment of Area 369
for a Conservative System 434
8.10 Principal Axes 370
10.8 Stability 441
8.11 Closure 375 10.9 Looking Ahead-More on Total
Potential Energy 443
9 Moments and Products 10.10 Closure 446
oflnertia 379
9.1 Introduction 379 11 Kinematics of a Particle-simple
9.2 Formal Definition of Relative Motion 451
Inertia Quantities 379
9.3 Relation Between Mass-Inertia Terms and 11.1 Introduction 45 1
Area-Inertia Terms 386
9.4 Translation of Coordinate Axes 392 Part A: General Notions 452
“9.5 Transformation Properties 11.2 Differentiation of a Vector with Respect
of the Inertia Terms 395 toTime 452
*9.6 Looking Ahead-Tensors 400
*9.7 The Inertia Ellipsoid and Principal
Part B: Velocity and Acceleration
Moments of Inertia 407
Calculations 454
9.8 Closure 410
11.3 Introductory Remark 454
11.4 Rectangular Components 455
10 *Methods of virtual work and 11.5 Velocity and Acceleration in
stationary Potential Energy 413 Terms of Path Variables 465
10.1 Introduction 413 11.6 Cylindrical Coordinates 480

Part A: Method of Virtual Work 414


Part C: Simple Kinematical Relations
10.2 Principle of Virtual Work and Applications 492
for a Particle 414
11.7 Simple Relative Motion 492
10.3 Principle of Virtual Work
for Rigid Bodies 415 11.8 Motion of a Particle Relative to a Pair of
Translating Axes 494
10.4 Degrees of Freedom and the
Solution of Problems 418 11.9 Closure 504
Vi CONTENTS

12 Particle Dynamics 511 13.3 Conservative Force Field 594


13.4 Conservation of Mechanical
12.1 Introduction 51I Energy 598
Part A: Rectangular Coordinates; 13.5 Alternative Form of Work-Energy
Equation 603
Rectilinear Translation 512
12.2 Newton's Law for Rectangular Part B: Systems of Particles 609
Coordinates 5 12
13.6 Work-Energy Equations 609
12.3 Rectilinear Translation 5 12
13.7 Kinetic Energy Expression Based on
12.4 A Comment 528 Center of Mass 614
13.8 Work-Kinetic Energy Expressions Based
Part B: Cylindrical Coordinates; on Center of Mass 619
Central Force Motion 536
13.9 Closure 631
12.5 Newton's Law for Cylindrical
Coordinates 536
12.6 Central Force Motion- 14 Methods of Momentum for
An Introduction 538 Particles 637
*12.7 Gravitational Central Force
Motion 539 Part A: Linear Momentum 637
"12.8 Applications to Space
14.1 Impulse and Momentum Relations for a
Mechanics 544
Particle 637
Part C: Path Variables 561 14.2 Linear-Momentum Considerations for a
System of Particles 643
12.9 Newton's Law for Path 14.3 Impulsive Forces 648
Variables 561 14.4 Impact 659
Part D: A System of Particles 564 "14.5 Collision of a Particle with a
Massive Rigid Body 665
12.10 The General Motion of a System
of Particles 564 Part B: Moment of Momentum 675
12.11 Closure 571 14.6 Moment-of-Momentum Equation
for a Single Particle 675
13 Energy Methods for Particles 579 14.7 More on Space Mechanics 678
14.8 Moment-of-Momentum Equation
Part A: Analysis for a
for a System of Particles 686
Single Particle 579
*14.9 Looking Ahead-Basic Laws
13.1 Introduction 579 of Continua 694
13.2 Power Considerations 585 14.10 Closure 700
CONTENTS vii

15 Kinematics of Rigid Bodies: *16.9 Balancing 838


Relative Motion 707 16.10 Closure 846
15.1 Introduction 707
15.2 Translation and Rotation of
Rigid Bodies 707
17 Energy and Impulse-Momentum
Methods for Rigid Bodies 853
15.3 Chasles’ Theorem 709
15.4 Derivative of a Vector Fixed 17.1 Introduction 853
in a Moving Reference 71 1
15.5 Applications of the Fixed-Vector
Part A: Energy Methods 853
Concept 723 17.2 Kinetic Energy of a Rigid Body 853
15.6 General Relationship Between 17.3 Work-Energy Relations 860
Time Derivatives of a Vector
for Different References 743 Part B: Impulse-Momentum
15.7 The Relationship Between Methods 878
Velocities of a Particle for
Different References 744 17.4 Angular Momentum of a
15.8 Acceleration of a Particle for Different Rigid Body About Any Point
References 755 in the Body 878
15.9 A New Look at Newton’s Law 773 17.5 Impulse-Momentum Equations 882
15.10 The Coriolis Force 776 17.6 Impulsive Forces and Torques: Eccentric
15.11 Closure 781 Impact 895
17.7 Closure 907

16 Kinetics of Plane Motion of Rigid


Bodies 787 18 *Dynamics of General Rigid-Body
16.1 Introduction 787 Motion 911
16.2 Moment-of-Momentum 18.1 Introduction 91 1
Equations 788 18.2 Euler’s Equations of Motion 914
16.3 Pure Rotation of a Body of Revolution 18.3 Application of Euler’s Equations 916
About its Axis of Revolution 791 18.4 Necessary and Sufficient
16.4 Pure Rotation of a Body with Two Conditions for Equilibrium of a
Orthogonal Planes of Symmetry 797 Rigid Body 930
16.5 Pure Rotation of Slablike Bodies 800 18.5 Three-Dimensional Motion About
16.6 Rolling Slablike Bodies 810 a Fixed Point; Euler Angles 930
16.7 General Plane Motion of a 18.6 Equations of Motion Using Euler
Slablike Body 816 Angles 934
16.8 Pure Rotation of an Arbitrary 18.7 Torque-Free Motion 945
Rigid Body 834 18.8 Closure 958
...
VI11 CON'lt.NlS

I9 Vibrations 961 APPENDIX I


19.1 Introduction 961
Integration Formulas xvii
19.2 Frce Vihratioii 961
19.3 Torsional Vibration 973 APPENDIX II
*19.4 Examples of Other Free-Oscillating Computation of Principal
Motions 9x2 Moments of Inertia xix
*IY.S Energy Methods 984
19.6 Linear Restoring Force and a Force APPENDIX 111
Varying Sinusoidally with Time 900 Additional Data For
19.7 Linear Restoring Force with Viscous the Ellipse xxi
Damping 999
19.8 I.inelrr Rehtoring Force, Viscous APPENDIX IV
Damping, and a Harmonic Proof that Infinitesimal
Disturhance IO07 Rotations Are Vectors xxiii
* 19.9 Oscillatory Systems with Multi-Degrees
of Freedom IO I4
Projects xxv
19.10 Closurc 1022

Index Ixxvii
Preface

With the publication of the fourth edition, this text moves into the
fourth decade of its existence. In the spirit of the times, the first edition
introduced a number of “firsts” in an introductory engineering
mechanics textbook. These “firsts” included
a) the first treatment of space mechanics
b) the first use of the control volume for linear momentum consid-
erations of fluids
c ) the first introduction to the concept of the tensor
Users of the earlier editions will be glad to know that the 4th edi-
tion continues with the same approach to engineering mechanics. The
goal has always been to aim toward working problems as soon as pos-
sible from first principles. Thus, examples are carefully chosen during
the development of a series of related areas to instill continuity in the
evolving theory and then, after these areas have been carefully dis-
cussed with rigor, come the problems. Furthermore at the ends of each
chapter, there are many problems that have not been arranged by text
section. The instructor is encouraged as soon as hekhe is well along in
the chapter to use these problems. The instructors manual will indicate
the nature of each of these problems as well as the degree of difficulty.
The text is not chopped up into many methodologies each with an
abbreviated discussion followed by many examples for using the spe-
cific methodology and finally a set of problems carefully tailored for
the methodology. The nature of the format in this and preceding edi-
tions is more than ever first to discourage excessive mapping of home-
work problems from the examples. And second, it is to lessen the
memorization of specific, specialized methodologies in lieu of absorb-
ing basic principles.

ix
X PREFACE

A new feature in the fourth edition is a series of starred sections


called “Looking Ahead . . . .” These are simplified discussions of top-
ics that appear in later engineering courses and tie in directly or indi-
rectly to the topic under study. For instance, after discussing free
body diagrams, there is a short “Looking Ahead” section in which the
concept and use of the control volume is presented as well as the sys-
tem concepts that appear in tluid mechanics and thermodynamics. In
the chapter on virtual work for particles and rigid bodies, there is a
simplified discussion of the displacement methods and force methods
for deformable bodies that will show up later in solids courses. After
finding the forces for simple trusses, there is a “Looking Ahead” sec-
tion discussing brietly what has to be done to get displacements.
There are quite a few others in the text. It has been found that many
students find these interesting and later when they come across these
topics in other courses or work, they report that the connections so
formed coming out of their sophomore mechanics courses have been
most valuable.
Over 400 new problems have been added to the fourth edition
equally divided between the statics and dynamics books. A complete
word-processed solutions manual accompanies the text. The illustra-
tions needed for problem statement and solution are taken as enlarge-
ments from the text. Generally, each problem is on a separate page.
The instructor will be able conveniently to select problems in order to
post solutions or to form transparencies as desired. Also, there are 30
computer projects in which, for a number of cases, the student pre-
pares hidher own software or engages in design. As an added bonus,
the student will be able to maintain hidher proficiency in program-
ming. Carefully prepared computer programs as well as computer out-
puts will be included in the manual. I normally assign one or two such
projects during a semester over and above the usual course material.
Also included in the manual is a disk that has the aforementioned pro-
grams for each of the computer projects. The computer programs for
these projects generally run about 30 lines of FORTRAN and run on a
personal computer. The programming required involves skills devel-
oped in the freshman course on FORTRAN.
Another important new feature of the fourth edition is an organi-
zation that allows one to go directly to the three dimensional chapter
on dynamics of rigid bodies (Chapter 18) and then to easily return to
plane motion (Chapter 16). Or one can go the opposite way. Footnotes
indicate how this can be done, and complimentary problems are noted
in the Solutions Manual.
PREFACE XI

Another change is Chapter 16 on plane motion. It has been


reworked with the aim of attaining greater rigor and clarity particu-
larly in the solving of problems.
There has also been an increase in the coverage and problems for
hydrostatics as well as examples and problems that will preview prob-
lems coming in the solids course that utilize principles from statics.
It should also be noted that the notation used has been chosen to
correspond to that which will be used in more advanced courses in
order to improve continuity with upper division courses. Thus, for mo-
ments and products of inertia I use I, I,, lxzetc. rather than ly l,, ,P
etc. The same notation is used for second moments and products of
area to emphasize the direct relation between these and the preceding
quantities. Experience indicates that there need be. no difficulty on the
student’s part in distinguishing between these quantities; the context of
the discussion suffices for this purpose. The concept of the tensor is
presented in a way that for years we have found to be readily under-
stood by sophomores even when presented in large classes. This saves
time and makes for continuity in all mechanics courses, particularly in
the solid mechanics course. For bending moment, shear force, and
stress use is made of a common convention for the sign-namely the
convention involving the normal to the area element and the direction
of the quantity involved be it bending moment, shear force or stress
component. All this and indeed other steps taken in the book will make
for smooth transition to upper division course work.
In overall summary, two main goals have been pursued in this
edition. They are
1. To encourage working problems from first principles and thus to
minimize excessive mapping from examples and to discourage rote
learning of specific methodologies for solving various and sundry
kinds of specific problems.
2. To “open-end” the material to later course work in other engineer-
ing sciences with the view toward making smoother transitions and
to provide for greater continuity. Also, the purpose is to engage the
interest and curiosity of students for further study of mechanics.
During the 13 years after the third edition, I have been teaching
sophomore mechanics to very large classes at SUNY, Buffalo, and,
after that, to regular sections of students at The George Washington
University, the latter involving an international student body with very
diverse backgrounds. During this time, I have been working on improv-
ing the clarity and strength of this book under classroom conditions
xii PREFACE

giving it the most severe test as a text. I believe the fourth edition as a
result will be a distinct improvement over the previous editions and
will offer a real choice for schools desiring a more mature treatment of
engineering mechanics.
I believe sophomore mechanics is probably the most important
course taken by engineers in that much of the later curriculum depends
heavily on this course. And for all engineering programs, this is usu-
ally the first real engineering course where students can and must be
creative and inventive in solving problems. Their old habits of map-
ping and rote learning of specific problem methodologies will not suf-
fice and they must learn to see mechanics as an integral science. The
student must “bite the bullet” and work in the way he/she will have to
work later in the curriculum and even later when getting out of school
altogether. No other subject so richly involves mathematics, physics,
computers, and down to earth common sense simultaneously in such
an interesting and challenging way. We should take maximum advan-
tage of the students exposure to this beautiful subject to get h i d h e r on
the right track now so as to be ready for upper division work.
At this stage of my career, I will risk impropriety by presenting
now an extended section of acknowledgments. I want to give thanks to
SUNY at Buffalo where I spent 31 happy years and where I wrote
many of my hooks. And I want to salute the thousands (about 5000) of
fine students who took my courses during this long stretch. I wish to
thank my eminent friend and colleague Professor Shahid Ahmad who
among other things taught the sophomore mechanics sequence with
me and who continues to teach it. He gave me a very thorough review
of the fourth edition with many valuable suggestions. I thank him pro-
fusely. I want particularly to thank Professor Michael Symans, from
Washington State University, Pullman for his superb contributions to
the entire manuscript. I came to The George Washington University at
the invitation of my longtime friend and former Buffalo colleague
Dean Gideon Frieder and the faculty in the Civil, Mechanical and
Environmental Engineering Department. Here, I came back into con-
tact with two well-known scholars that I knew from the early days of
my career, namely Professor Hal Liebowitz (president-elect of the
National Academy of Engineering) and Professor Ali Cambel (author
of recent well-received book on chaos). 1 must give profound thanks to
the chairman of my new department at G.W., Professor Sharam
Sarkani. He has allowed me to play a vital role in the academic pro-
gram of the department. I will be able to continue my writing at full
speed as a result. 1 shall always be grateful to him. Let me not forget
PREFACE
...
XI11

the two dear ladies in the front office of the department. Mrs. Zephra
Coles in her decisive efficient way took care of all my needs even
before I was aware of them. And Ms. Joyce Jeffress was no less help-
ful and always had a humorous comment to make.
I was extremely fortunate in having the following professors as
reviewers.
Professor Shahid Ahmad, SUNY at Buffalo
Professor Ravinder Chona, Texas A&M University
Professor Bruce H. Kamopp. University of Michigan
Professor Richard E Keltie, North Carolina State University
Professor Stephen Malkin, University of Massachusetts
Professor Sudhakar Nair, Illinois Institute of Technology
Professor Jonathan Wickert, Camegie Mellon University
I wish to thank these gentlemen for their valuable assistance and
encouragement.
I have two people left. One is my good friend Professor Bob
Jones from V.P.I. who assisted me in the third edition with several
hundred excellent statics problems and who went over the entire man-
uscript with me with able assistance and advice. I continue to benefit
in the new edition from his input of the third edition. And now, finally,
the most important person of all, my dear wife Sheila. She has put up
all these years with the author of this book, an absent-minded, hope-
less workaholic. Whatever I have accomplished of any value in a long
and ongoing career, I owe to her.

To my Dear, Wondeijiil Wife Sheila


About the Author

Irving Shames presently serves as a Professor in the Department of


Civil, Mechanical, and Environmental Engineering at The George
Washington University. Prior to this appointment Professor Shames
was a Distinguished Teaching Professor and Faculty Professor at The
State University of New York-Buffalo, where he spent 31 years.
Professor Shames has written up to this point in time 10 text-
books. His first book Engineering Mechanics, Statics and Dynamics
was originally published in 1958, and it is going into its fourth edition
in 1996. All of the books written by Professor Shames have been char-
acterized by innovations that have become mainstays of how engineer-
ing principles are taught to students. Engineering Mechanics, Statics
and Dynamics was the first widely used Mechanics book based on
vector principles. It ushered in the almost universal use of vector prin-
ciples in teaching engineering mechanics courses today.
Other textbooks written by Professor Shames include:

Mechanics of Deformable Solids, Prentice-Hall, Inc.


Mechanics of Fluids, McGraw-Hill
* Introduction to Solid Mechanics, Prentice-Hall, Inc.
* Introduction to Statics, Rentice-Hall, Inc.
* Solid Mechanics-A Variational Approach (with C.L. Dym),
McCraw-Hill
Energy and Finite Element Methods in Structural Mechanics, (with

- C.L. Dym), Hemisphere Corp., of Taylor and Francis


Elastic and Inelastic Stress Analysis (with F. Cozzarelli), Prentice-
Hall, Inc.
XVI ABOIJTTHF AI'THOK

In recent ycars, I'rofesor Shalne\ has expanded his teaching


xtivitics and t i a h held two suiiiiner fiicully workshops in mechanics
\ponsored by the State (if Ncw York, and one national workshop spon-
sorcd by the National Science Foundation. The programs involved the
iiitegr:ition both conceptually and pedagogically 0 1 mechanics from
the sophomore year on through gt-aduate school.
Statics
REVIEW I*

Fundamentals
of Mechanics
Introduction
+l.l
Mechanics is the physical science concerned with the dynamical behavior (as
opposed to chemical and thermal behavior) of bodies that are acted on by
mechanical disturbances. Since such behavior is involved in virtually all the
situations that confront an engineer, mechanics lies at the core of much engi-
neering analysis. In fact, no physical science plays a greater role in engineer-
ing than does mechanics, and it is the oldest of all the physical sciences. The
writings of Archimedes covering buoyancy and the lever were recorded
before 200 B.C. Our modem knowledge of gravity and motion was established
by Isaac Newton (1642-1727), whose laws founded Newtonian mechanics,
the subject matter of this text.
In 1905, Einstein placed limitations on Newton's formulations with his
theory of relativity and thus set the stage for the development of relativistic
mechanics. The newer theories, however, give results that depart from those
of Newton's formulations only when the speed of a body approaches the
speed of light ( I 86,000 mileslsec). These speeds are encountered in the large-
scale phenomena of dynamical astronomy. Furthermore for small-scale
phenomena involving subatomic particles, quantum mechanics must be used
rather than Newtonian mechanics. Despite these limitations, it remains never-
theless true that, in the great bulk of engineering problems, Newtonian
mechanics still applies.

*The reader is urged 10 be sure that Section 1.9 is thoroughly understood since this Section
is vital for a goad understanding of statics in panicular and mechanics in general.
Also, the nutation t before the titles of certain sections indicates thal specific queslions
concerning the contents of these sections requiring verbal answers are presented at the end of the
chapler. The instructor may wish to assign these sections as a reading asignment along with the
requirement to answer the aforestated asssiated questions as the author routinely daes himself.

3
4 CHAPTER I FUNDAMENTALS OFMECHANICS

t1.2 Basic Dimensions and Units of


Mechanics
To study mechanics, we must establish abstractions to describe those charac-
teristics of a body that interest us. These abstractions are called dimensions.
The dimensions that we pick, which are independent of all other dimensions,
are termed primary or basic dimensions, and the ones that are then developed
in terms of the basic dimensions we call secondary dimensions. Of the many
possible sets of basic dimensions that we could use, we will confine ourselves
at present to the set that includes the dimensions of length, time, and mass.
Another convenient set will he examined later.

Length-A Concept for Describing Size Quantitatively. In order to deter-


mine the size of an object, we must place a second object of known size next
to it. Thus, in pictures of machinery, a man often appears standing disinter-
estedly beside the apparatus. Without him, it would be difficult to gage the
size of the unfamiliar machine. Although the man has served as some sort of
standard measure, we can, of course, only get an approximate idea of the
machine's size. Men's heights vary, and, what is even worse, the shape of a
man is too complicated to be of much help in acquiring a precise measure-
ment of the machine's size. What we need, obviously, is an object that is
constant in shape and, moreover, simple in concept. Thus, instead of a three-
dimensional object, we choose a one-dimensional object.' Then, we can use
the known mathematical concepts of geometry to extend the measure of size
in one dimension to the three dimensions necessary to characterize a general
body. A straight line scratched on a metal bar that is kept at uniform thermal
and physical conditions (as, e.g., the meter bar kept at Skvres, France) serves
as this simple invariant standard in one dimension. We can now readily cal-
culate and communicate the distance along a cettain direction of an object by
counting the number of standards and fractions thereof that can be marked off
along this direction. We commonly refer to this distance as length, although
the term " length could also apply to the more general concept of size. Other
aspects of size, such as volume and area, can then be formulated in terms of
the standard by the methods of plane, spherical, and solid geometry.
A unit is the name we give an accepted measure of a dimension. Many
systems of units are actually employed around the world, but we shall only
use the two major systems, the American system and the SI system. The basic
unit of length in the American system is the foot, whereas the basic unit of
length in the SI system is the meter.

Time-A Concept for Ordering the Flow of Events. In observing the pic-
ture of the machine with the man standing close by, we can sometimes tell
approximately when the picture was taken by the style of clothes the man is

'We are using the word "dimensional" here in its everyday sense and not as defined above.
SECTION 1.2 BASIC DIM!3”SIONS AND UNITS OF MECHANICS 5

wearing. But how do we determine this? We may say to ourselves: “During


the thirties, people wore the type of straw hat that the fellow in the picture is
wearing.” In other words, the “when” is tied to certain events that are experi-
enced by, or otherwise known to, the observer. For a more accurate descrip-
tion of “when,” we must find an action that appears to he completely
repeatable. Then, we can order the events under study by counting the num-
her of these repeatable actions and fractions thereof that occur while the
events transpire. The rotation of the earth gives rise to an event that serves as
a good measure of time-the day. But we need smaller units in most of our
work in engineering, and thus, generally, we tie events to the second, which is
an interval repeatable 86,400 times a day.

Mass-A Property of Matter. The student ordinarily has no trouble under-


standing the concepts of length and time because helshe is constantly aware
of the size of things through hisher senses of sight and touch, and is always
conscious of time by observing the flow of events in hisher daily life. The
concept of mass, however, is not as easily grasped since it does not impinge
as directly on our daily experience.
Mass is a property of matter that can be determined from two different
actions on bodies. To study the first action, suppose that we consider two
hard bodies of entirely different composition, size, shape, color, and so on. If
we attach the bodies to identical springs, as shown in Fig. 1.1, each spring
will extend some distance as a result of the attraction of gravity for the hod-
Body A Body B
ies. By grinding off some of the material on the body that causes the greater
extension, we can make the deflections that are induced on both springs Figure 1.1. Bodies restrained by identical
equal. Even if we raise the springs to a new height above the earth’s surface, springs.
thus lessening the deformation of the springs, the extensions induced by the
pull of gravity will he the same for both bodies. And since they are, we can
conclude that the bodies have an equivalent innate property. This property of
each body that manifests itself in the amount of gravitational attraction we
call man.
The equivalence of these bodies, after the aforementioned grinding oper-
ation, can be indicated in yet a second action. If we move both bodies an
equal distance downward, by stretching each spring, and then release them at
the same time, they will begin to move in an identical manner (except for
small variations due to differences in wind friction and local deformations of
the bodies). We have imposed, in effect, the same mechanical disturbance on
each body and we have elicited the same dynamical response. Hence, despite
many obvious differences, the two bodies again show an equivalence.

The pcoperry of mpcs, thn, Chomcrcrke8 a body both in the action of


na1 a n r a c k and in tlu response IO a mekhnnicd

To communicate this property quantitatively, we may choose some


convenient body and compare other bodies to it in either of the two above-
6 CHAPTER I FUNDAMENTALS OF MECHANICS

mentioned actions. The two basic units commonly used in much American
engineering practice to measure mass are the pound mass, which is defined in
terms of the attraction of gravity for a standard body at a standard location,
and the slug, which is defined in terms of the dynamical response of a stan-
dard body to a standard mechanical disturbance. A similar duality of mass
units does not exist in the SI system. There only the kilugmm is used as the
basic measure of mass. The kilogram is measured in terms of response of a
body to a mechanical disturbance. Both systems of units will he discussed
further in a subsequent section.

We have now established three basic independent dimensions to


describe certain physical phenomena. It is convenient to identify these dimen-
sions in the following manner:
length [L]
time [tl
mass [MI
These formal expressions of identification for basic dimensions and the more
complicated groupings to he presented in Section 1.3 for secondary dimen-
sions are called “dimensional representations.”
Often, there are occasions when we want to change units during com-
putations. For instance, we may wish to change feet into inches or millime-
ters. In such a case, we must replace the unit in question by a physically
equivalent number of new units. Thus, a foot is replaced by 12 inches or 30.5
millimeters. A listing of common systems of units is given in Table 1.1, and
a table of equivalences hetween these and other units is given on the inside
covers. Such relations between units will he expressed in this way:
1 ft 12 in. = 305 mm
The three horizontal bars are not used to denote algebraic equivalence;
instead, they are used to indicate physical equivalence. Here is another way
of expressing the relations above:

Table 1.1 common systems of units


c!P SI

Mass Gram Mass Kilogram


Length Centimeter Length Meter
Time Second Time Second
FOKC Dyne Force Newton
English American Practice
Mass Pound mass Mass Slug or pound mass
Length Foot Length Foot
Time Second Time Second
Force Poundal Force Puund force
SECTION 1.3 SECONDARY DIMENSIONAL QUANTITIES 7

The unity on the right side of these relations indicates that the numerator and
denominator on the left side are physically equivalent, and thus have a 1:l
relation. This notation will prove convenient when we consider the change of
units for secondary dimensions in the next section.

t1.3 Secondary Dimensional Quantities


When physical characteristics are described in terms of basic dimensions by
the use of suitable definitions (e.g., velocity is defined2 as a distance divided
by a time interval), such quantities are called secondary dimensional quanti-
ties. In Section 1.4, we will see that these quantities may also be established as
a consequence of natural laws. The dimensional representation of secondary
quantities is given in terms of the basic dimensions that enter into the formula-
tion of the concept. For example, the dimensional representation of velocity is
[velocity] = -
[Ll
[/I
That is, the dimensional representation of velocity is the dimension length
divided by the dimension time. The units for a secondary quantity are then
given in terms of the units of the constituent basic dimensions. Thus,
[velocity units] = -[ftl
[secl
A chunge of units from one system into another usually involves a
change in the scale of measure of the secondary quantities involved in the
problem. Thus, one scale unit of velocity in the American system is 1 foot per
second, while in the SI system it is I meter per second. How may these scale
units he correctly related for complicated secondary quantities? That is, for
our simple case, how many meters per second are equivalent to 1 foot per
second? The formal expressions of dimensional representation may he put to
good use for such an evaluation. The procedure is as follows. Express the
dependent quantity dimensionally; substitute existing units for the basic
dimensions; and finally, change these units to the equivalent numbers of units
in the new system. The result gives the number of scale units of the quantity
in the new system of units that is equivalent to 1 scale unit of the quantity in
the old system. Performing these operations for velocity, we would thus have

l(&) I(*) = .305(2)

>A more precise definilion will be given in the chapters on dynamics.


8 CHAPTER I FUNDAMENTALS OF MECHANICS

which means that ,305scale unit of velocity in the SI system is equivalent to


I scale unit in the American system.
Another way of changing units when secondary dimensions are present
is to make use of the formalism illustrated in relations 1.1. To change a unit
in an expression, multiply this unit by a ratio physically equivalent to unity,
as we discussed earlier, so that the old unit is canceled out, leaving the
desired unit with the proper numerical coefficient. In the example of velocity
used above, we may replace ft/sec by mlsec in the following manner:

It should he clear that, when we multiply by such ratios to accomplish a


change of units as shown above, we do not alter the magnitude of the actual
physical quantity represented by the expression. Students are strongly urged
to employ the above technique in their work, for the use of less formal meth-
ods is generally an invitation to error.

t1.4 l a w of Dimensional Homogeneity


Now that we can describe certain aspects of nature in a quantitative manner
through basic and secondary dimensions, we can by careful observation and
experimentation leam to relate certain of the quantities in the form of equa-
tions. In this regard, there is an important law, the law of dimen.siona1 homo-
geneity, which imposes a restriction on the formulation of such equations. This
law states that. because natural phenomena proceed with no regard for man-
made units, basic equations representing physical phenomena must be valid
f o r all systems of units. Thus, the equation for the period of a pendulum,
7
t = 2 x , / ~ / g , must be valid for all systems of units, and is accordingly said to
be dimensionally homogeneous. It then follows that the fundamental equations
of physics are dimensionally homogeneous; and all equations derived analyti-
cally from these fundamental laws must also be dimensionally homogeneous.
What restriction does this condition place on an equation? To answer
this, let us examine the following arbitrary equation:
x=ygd+k

For this equation to be dimensionally homogeneous, the numerical equality


between both sides of the equation must he maintained for all systems of
units. To accomplish this, the change in the scale of measure of each group of
terms must be the same when there is a change of units. That is, if the numer-
ical measure of one group such as ygd is doubled for a new system 0 1 units,
so must that of the quantities x and k. For 1hi.r to occur under all systems
of units, it is necessary that everj grouping in the eyuution have the .same
dimensirmal representation.
In this regard, consider the dimensional representation of the above
equation expressed in the following manner:
SECTION 1.5 DIMENSIONAL. RELATION BETWEEN FORCE AND MASS 9

[XI = b g 4 + [kl
From the previous conclusion for dimensional homogeneity, we require that
[XI = [yg4 = [kl
As a further illustration, consider the dimensional representation of an
equation that is not dimensionally homogeneous:
[LI = [fl’ + [rl
When we change units from the American to the SI system, the units of feet
give way to units of meters, but there is no change in the unit of time, and it
becomes clear that the numerical value of the left side of the equation
changes while that of the right side does not. The equation, then, becomes
invalid in the new system of units and hence is not derived from the basic
laws of physics. Throughout this book, we shall invariably be concerned with
dimensionally homogeneous equations. Therefore, we should dimensionally
analyze our equations to help spot errors.

t1.5 Dimensional Relation Between


Force and Mass
We shall now employ the law of dimensional homogeneity to establish a new
secondary dimension-namely force. A superficial use of Newton’s law will
be employed for this purpose. In a later section, this law will be presented in
greater detail, but it will suffice at this time to state that the acceleration of a
particle3 is inversely proportional to its mass for a given disturbance. Mathe-
matically, this becomes
a = -1
- m
where is the proportionality symbol. Inserting the constant of proportional-
ity, F, we have, on rearranging the equation,
(1.2)

F=ma (1.3)
The mechanical disturbance, represented by F and calledforce, must have the
following dimensional representation, according to the law of dimensional
homogeneity:
[ F ] = [ M I -[Ll
(1.4)
[fIZ
The type of disturbance for which relation 1.2 is valid is usually the action of
one body on another by direct contact. However, other actions, such as mag-
netic, electrostatic, and gravitational actions of one body on another involving
no contact, also create mechanical effects that are valid in Newton’s equation.

‘We shall define panicles in Section 1.7.


10 CHAPTER I FLNDAMENTALS OF MECHANICS

We could have initiated the study of mechanics by consideringfiirce as


a basic dimension, the manifestation of which can he measured by the elon-
gation of a standard spring at a prescribed temperature. Experiment would
then indicate that for a given body the acceleration is directly proportional to
the applied force. Mathematically,
F m a; therefore, F = mu

from which we see that the proportionality constant now represents the prop-
erty of mass. Here, mass is now a secondary quantity whose dimensional rep-
resentation is determined from Newton's law:

As was mentioned earlier, we now have a choice between two systems


of basic dimensions-the MLt or the FLr system of basic dimensions. Physi-
cists prefer the former, whereas engineers usually prefer the latter.

1.6 Units of Mass


As we have already seen, the concept of mass arose from two types of actions
-those of motion and gravitational attraction. In American engineering prac-
tice, units of mass are based on hoth actions, and this sometimes leads to con-
fusion. Let us consider the FLt system of basic dimensions tor the following
discussion. The unit of force may he taken to be the pound-force (Ihf), which
is defined as a force that extends a standard spring a certain distance at
a given temperature. Using Newton's law, we then define the slug as the
amount of mass that a I-pound force will cause to accelerate at the rate of
I foot per second per second.
On the other hand, another unit of mass can he stipulated if we use the
gravitational effect as a criterion. Herc. the pound muxs (Ihm) is defined as
the amount of matter that is drawn by gravity toward the earth by a force of
I pound-force (Ihf) at a specified position on the earth's surface.
We have formulated two units of mass by two different actions, and to
relate these units we must subject them to the sumt. action. Thus, we can take
1 pound mass and see what fraction or multiplc of it will be accelerated
1 ft/sec2 under the action of I pound afforce. This fraction or multiple will then
represent the number of units of pound mass that are equivalent to I slug.
It turns out that this coefficient is go, where g, has the value corresponding to
the acceleration of gravity at a position on the earth's surface where the
pound mass was standardized. To three significant figures, the value of R~ is
32.2. We may then make the statement of equivalence that
I slug = 32.2 pounds mass
SECTION 1.6 UNITS OF MASS 11

To use the pound-mass unit in Newton’s law, it is necessary to divide by


go to form units of mass, that have been derived from Newton’s law. Thus,

where m has the units of pound mass and &go has units of slugs. Having
properly introduced into Newton’s law the pound-mass unit from the view-
point of physical equivalence, let us now consider the dimensional homo-
geneity of the resulting equation. The right side of &. 1.6 must have the
dimensional representation of F and, since the unit here for F is the pound
force, the right side must then have this unit. Examination of the units on the
right side of the equation then indicates that the units of go must be

(1.7)

How does weight tit into this picture? Weight is defined as the force of
gravity on a body. Its value will depend on the position of the body relative to
the earth‘s surface. At a location on the earth’s surface where the pound mass is
standardized, a mass of 1 pound (Ibm) has the weight of 1 pound (Ibf), but with
increasing altitude the weight will become smaller than 1 pound (Ibf). The
mass, however, remains at all times a I-pound mass (Ibm). If the altitude is not
exceedingly large, the measure of weight, in Ibf, will practically equal the mea-
sure of mass, in Ibm. Therefore, it is unfortunately the practice in engineering to
think erroneously of weight at positions other than on the earth‘s surface as the
measure of mass, and consequently to use the symbol W to represent either Ibm
or Ibf. In this age of rockets and missiles, it behooves us to be careful about the
proper usage of units of mass and weight throughout the entire text.
If we know the weight of a body at some point, we can determine its
mass in slugs very easily, provided that we know the acceleration of gravity,
g, at that point. Thus, according to Newton’s law,
W(lbf) = m(s1ugs) x g(ft/sec*)
Therefore,

(1 3 )

Up to this point, we have only considered the American system of


units. In the SI system of units, a kilogram is the amount of mass that will
accelerate 1 m/sec2 under the action of a force of 1 newton. Here we do not
have the problem of 2 units of mass; the kilogram is the basic unit of mass.
However, we do have another kind of problem-that the kilogram is unfortu-
nately also used as a measure of force, as is the newton. One kilogram of
force is the weight of 1 kilogram of mass at the earth‘s surface, where the
acceleration of gravity (Le., the acceleration due to the force of gravity) is
12 CHAPTER I FUNDAMENTALS OF MECHANICS

9.81 m/sec2. A newton, on the other hand, is the force that causes I kilogram
of mass to have an acceleration of 1 m/sec2. Hence, Y.8 1 newtons are equiva-
lent to I kilogram of force. That is,
9.81 newtons 1 kilogram(force) = 2.205 Ibf
Note from the above that the newton is a comparatively small force, equaling
approximately one-fifth of a pound. A kilonewton (1000 newtons), which
will be used often, is about 200 Ib. In this text, we shall nor use the kilogram
as a unit of force. However, you should he aware that many people do."
Note that at the earth's surface the weight W o1a mass M is:
W(newtons) = [M(kilograms)](Y.81)(m/s2) (1.9)
Hence:
W(newtons)
M(kilograms) = _ _ _ _ ~ ~ ~ ~ (1.10)
9.81 (rnls')

Away from the earth's surfxe, use the acceleration of gravity x rather than
9.81 in the above equations.

1.7 Idealizations of Mechanics


As we have pointed out, basic and secondary dimensions may sometimes be
related in equations to represent a physical action that we are interested in.
We want to represent an action using the known laws of physics, and also to
be able to form equations simple enough to he susceptible to mathematical
computational techniques. Invariably in our deliberations, we must replace
the actual physical action and the participating bodies with hypothetical,
highly simplified substitutes. We must he sure, of course, that the results of
our substitutions have some reasonable correlation with reality. All analytical
physical sciences must resort to this technique, and. consequently, their coni-
putations are not cut-and-dried but involve a considerable amount of imagi-
nation, ingenuity, and insight into physical behavior. We shall, at this time,
set forth the most fundamental idealizations of mechanics and a hit of the phi-
losophy involved in scientific analysis.

Continuum. Even the simpliI"ica1ion of matter into molecules, atoms, elec-


trons, and so on, is too complex a picture for many problems of engineering
mechanics. In most problems, we are interested only in the average measur-
able manifestations of these elementary bodies. Pressure, density, and tem-
perature are actually the gross effects of the actions of the many molecules
and atoms, and they can be conveniently assumed to arise from a hypotheti-
cally continuous distribution of matter, which we shall call the continuum,
instead of from a conglomeration of discrete, tiny hodies. Without such an

'This is particularly true in the marketplace where the word "kilos" is often heard
SECTION 1.7 IDEALIZATIONS OF MECHANICS 13

artifice, we would have to consider the action of each of these elementary


bodies-a virtual impossibility for most problems.

Rigid Body. In many cases involving the action on a body by a force, we


simplify the continuum concept even further. The most elemental case is that
of a rigid body, which is a continuum that undergoes theoretically no defor-
mation whatever. Actually, every body must deform to a certain degree under
the actions of forces, hut in many cases the deformation is ton small to affect
Figure 1.2. Rigid-body assumption-use
the desired analysis. It is then preferable to consider the body as rigid, and original geometry.
proceed with simplified computations. For example, assume that we are to
determine the forces transmitted by a beam to the earth as the result of a load
P (Fig. 1.2). If P is small enough, the beam will undergo little deflection, and
we can carry out a straightforward simple analysis using the undefomed
geometry as if the body were indeed rigid. If we were to attempt a more accu-
rate analysis-even though a slight increase in accuracy is not required-we
would then need to know the exact position that the load assumes relative to Figure 1.3. Deformable body.
the beam afrer the beam has ceased to deform, as shown in an exaggerated
manner in Fig. 1.3. To do this accurately is a hopelessly difficult task, espe-
cially when we consider that the support must also “give” in a certain way.
Although the alternative to a rigid-body analysis here leads us to a virtually
impossible calculation, situations do arise in which more realistic models
must be employed to yield the required accuracy. For example, when deter-
mining the internal force distribution in a body, we must often take the defor-
mation into account, however small it might be. Other cases will be presented
later. The guiding principle is to make such simplifications as are consistent
with the required accuracy ojthe results.

Point Force. A finite force exerted on one body by another must cause a
finite amount of local deformation, and always creates a finite area of contact
between the bodies through which the force is transmitted. However, since
we have formulated the concept of the figid body, we should also be able to
imagine a finite force to be transmitted through an infinitesimal area or point.
This simplification of a force distribution is called a point force. In many
cases where the actual area of contact io a problem is very small but is not
known exactly, the use of the concept of the point force results in little sacri-
fice in accuracy. In Figs. 1.2 and 1.3, we actually employed the graphical rep-
resentation of the point force.

Particle. The particle is defined as an object that has no size but that has a
mass. Perhaps this does not sound like a very helpful definition for engineers
to employ, but it is actually one of the most useful in mechanics. For the tra-
jectory of a planet, for example, it is the mass of the planet and not its size
that is significant. Hence, we can consider planets as particles for such com-
putations. On the other hand, take a figure skater spinning on the ice. Her rev-
olutions are controlled beautifully by the orientation of the body. In this
motion, the size and distribution of the body are significant, and since a
14 CHAPTER 1 FUNDAMENTALS OF MECHANICS

particle, by definition. can have no distribution. i t i s patently clear that a par-


ticle cannot represent the skater in this case. If; however, the skater should he
hilled as the “human cannonball on skates” and he shot out of a large air gun.
i t would be possible to consider her as a single particle i n ascertaining her Lra-
jectory, since arm and leg movements that werc significant while she was
spinning on the ice would have l i t t l e effect o n the arc traversed by the main
portion of her body.
You will learn later that the wiitri- ofnirrss 01-muss w i i f r r i s a hypii-
thelical point at which one can concentrate thc mass ot the body for ccrliiin
dynamics calculations. Actually i n the previous cxamplcs of thc planet and
the “human cannonball on skates,” the particle wc reler to i s actually the
mass center whose motion i s sufficient for the desired infiirmation. Thus,
when the motion of the mass center o f a body suffices for thc information
desired, we can replace the body by a particle. n m e l y the mass center.

Many other simplifications pervade mechanics. The perfectly elastic


body, the frictionless fluid, and so on. will become familiar as you study var-
ious phases nf mechanics.

11.8 Vector and Scalar Quantities


We have now proposed sets of basic dimensions and secondary dimensions to
describe certain aspects uf nature. However. more than just the dimensional
identification and the number (if units arc often necdcd to convey adequately
the desired information. For instance, to specify fully the motion o f a car,
which we may represent as ii particle at this tiine. we must answer the lollow-
ing questions:
1. How fast?
2. Which way?
The concept o f velocity entails the information desired in questions I and 2.
The first question, “How fast?”, i s answered hy the speednmeter reading,
which gives the value o f the velncity in miles per hour or kilometers per hour.
The second question, “Which w a y ~ y i,s more complicated. hecause two sepa-
rete factors arc involved. First, we must specify the angular orientation of the
velocity relative to a reference Srame. Second, we [nust speciSy the sense (if
the velocity, which tells us whether we are moving r o w i r d o r uw’ay.from ii
given point. The concepts o f angular orientation of the velocity and sense o f
the velocity are often collectively denoted as the dire&irr of the velocity.
Graphically, we may use a directed linr, .rrgmr’nt (an arrow) to describe the
velocity of the car. The length o f the directed line segment gives information
as to “how fast” and i s the magnitude o f the velocity. The angular orientation
of the directed line segment and the position of’the arrowhead give inturma-
tion as to “which way”-that is, as tii the direction o f the velocity. The
SECTION 1.8 VECTOR AND SCALAR QUANTlTlES 15

directed line segment itself is called the velocity, whereas the length of the
directed line segment-that is, the magnitude-is called the speed.
There are many physical quantities that are represented by a directed
line segment and thus are describable by specifying a magnitude and a direc-
tion. The most common example is force, where the magnitude is a measure
of the intensity of the force and the direction is evident from how the force is
applied. Another example is the displacement vecior between two points on
the path of a particle. The magnitude of the displacement vector corresponds
to the distance moved along a straighr line between two points, and the direc-
tion is defined by the orientation of this line relative to a reference, with the
sense corresponding to which point is being approached. Thus, pae (see Fig.
1.4) is the displacement vector from A to B (while p,, goes from B to A).

Path of
*-- a particle

(. \-

1.4 \
I

Figure 1.4. Displacement vector pAB.

Certain quantities having magnitude and direction combine their effects

e
in a special way. Thus, the combined effect of two forces acting on a particle,
as shown in Fig. 1.5, corresponds to a single force that may be shown by
experiment to be equal to the diagonal of a parallelogram formed by the
graphical representation of the forces. That is, the quantities add according to F, + F2
the parallelogram law. All quantities that have magnitude and direction and
that add according to the parallelogram law are called vector quaniities. Other
quantities that have only magnitude, such as temperature and work, are called
scalar quantities. A vector quantity will be denoted with a boldface italic let- Figure 1.5. Parallelogram law.
ter, which in the case of force becomes F.5
The reader may ask Don’t all quantities having magnitude and direc-
tion combine according to the parallelogram law and, therefore, become

.iYour inslmclm on the blackboard and you in your homework will not be able lo use bld;
face notation lor vcctors. Accordingly, you may choose IOuse a superscript arrow or bar, e.&. F
or F (E or E are other possibilities).
16 CHAPTER I FUNDAMENTALS OF MECHANICS

vector quantities? No, not all of them do. One very important example will he
pointed out after we reconsider Fig. 1.5. In the construction of the parallelo-
gram it matters not which force is laid out first. In other words, “ F , combined
with F,” gives the same result as “F, combined with F,.” In short, the com-
bination is commutative. If a combination is not commutative, it cannot in
general he represented by a parallelogram operation and is thus not a vector.
With this in mind, consider the finite angle of rotation of a body about an
axis. We can associate a magnitude (degrees or radians) and a direction (the
axis and a stipulation of clockwise or counterclockwise) with this quantity.
However, the finite angle of rotation cannot he considered a vector because in
general two finite rotations about different axes cannot he replaced by a single

I 90”

Figure 1.6. Successive rotations are not


commutative.
SECTION I .Y EQUALITY AND EQUIVALENCE OF VECTORS 17

finite rotation consistent with the parallelogram law. The easiest way to show
this is to demonstrate that the combination of such rotations is not commuta-
tive. In Fig. I .6(a) a book is to he given two rotations-a 90" counterclock-
wise rotation about the x axis and a 90" clockwise rotation about the i axis,
both looking in toward the origin. This is carried out in Figs. 1.6(b) and (c).
In Fig. 1.6(c), the sequence of combination is reversed from that in Fig.
1.6(b), and you can see how it alters the final orientation of the hook. Finite
angular rotation, therefore, is not a vector quantity, since the parallelogram
law is not valid for such a ~ o m b i n a t i o n . ~
You may now wonder why we tacked on the parallelogram law for the
definition o f a vector and thereby excluded finite rotations from this category.
The answer to this query is as follows. In the next chapter, we will present
cemin sets of very useful operations termed w c t u r algebra. These operations
are valid in general only if the parallelogram law is satisfied as you will see
when we get to Chapter 2. Therefore, we had to restrict the definition of a
vector in order to he able to use this kind of algebra for these quantities. Also,
it is to he pointed out that later in the text we will present yet a third defini-
tion consistent with our latest definition. This next definition will have certain
advantages as we will see later. +==
/
Before closing the section, we will set forth one more definition. The
/ine (,faction of a vector is a hypothetical infinite straight line collinear with
the vector (see Fig. 1.7). Thus, the velocities of two cars moving on different
lanes of a straight highway have different lines of action. Keep in mind that
the line of action involves no connotation as to sense. Thus, a vector V'
cnllinear with V in Fig. 1.7 and with opposite sense would nevertheless have -m

the same line of action. Figure 1.7. Line of action of B vector.

1.9 Equality and Equivalence of Vectors


We shall avoid many pitfalls in the study of mechanics if we clearly make a
distinction between the equality and the equivalence of vectors.
Twjo L'ecfors are equal if they have the .same dimcmsions, rnugnirudc,,
and direction. In Fig. 1.8, the velocity vectors of three particles have equal
length, are identically inclined toward the reference xyr, and havc the samc
sense. Although they have different lines of actinn, they are nevertheless
equal according to the definition.
Two vectorr are equivalent in a certain c a p a c i y if each prodnces the
vev ,same e f t k t in this capacity. If the criterion in Fig. I .8is change of ele-
vation of the particles or total distance traveled by the particles, all three
vectors give the same result. They are, in addition to being equal, alsu

"However. wriishingly rniull rotations can be considered a i YCE~UIS since thc commutative
Figure 1.8. Equal-velocity vectors.
law applies for the combiniltiun of such rotations. A proof of this assertion is presenlcd in Appcn-
din IV. The tbct that infinitesimal rotations are vectors i n accordance with our definition w i l l be
an irnpoltant consideration when we discuss angular velocity in Chapter 15.
18 CHAPTER I ~ U N U A M L N T A L Sor MECHANICS

equivalent fur thcsc capacities. I f the absolute height u l the parlicles above
the .cy plane i s the quesliiin i n piiint, these vectors w i l l no1 he equivalenl
despite their equality. Thus, i t must be cinphasizcd that cquol 1wtor.s need
t i u f uIwri?,s bP ryuivulent: i f deprid.s cririrelv oii / h e situuriori ut hund. Fur-
thermore, vectors that itre n o t equal may s t i l l hc cquivalcnt i n soine capac-
ity. l'hus, i n the beam i n Fig. 1.9, forces F , and C; are unequal, since their
magnitudes are IO Ih and 20 Ih, respectively. However, it i s clear from ele-
mentary physics cliat their mnments ahiiul the hase 01 the heani are equal,
and su the forces liave the same "turning" action at the fixed end of the
heain. I n that capacity. the forces are equivalenl. If. however, we are inter-
ested i n the dellcction of the free end of the heam resulting from each force,
there i s no longer ;in equivalcncc hclwcen thc force.;, since each w i l l give a
different dcllcctiun.

,,]'

I_
~~~~~

Figure 1.9. F , and I.?equivalent Tor iiioriient


ahw1 A.

To sum up. the ryrcnli~ynf two vecturs i s determined by the vectors


themselves. and thc equivuleurp hctwecn two vccturs i s dctcrniined hy the
task involving the vectors.
In probleins o f mech;mics. we can prufitehly delineate three classes of
situatiuns cunccrning equivalence of veckirs:

1. 5'irirution.s it[ M h i d ~vw/o,-.v miry he p . s i r i o w d unywherr in .spuce wirlwur


1o.u or (.huuKr r,/meuriinp providrd thuc mu,ynilurlr und dir(,<.timu w k e p
intu(.t. Under such circ~iinstaiicesthe vectors are c:nlled free ve('tor.r. For
example. the velocity v c c t i m i n Fig. I.X are lrce vectors a s far as total dis-
Lance traveled i h concerned.
2. .Si/iiution.~in w/iir./~Lvt'lor.v mriy 1)r mmw/ u l o q /li<,ir1iur.so f w t i m wirli-
on/ c'hungr o/ ,nrui,iin,y. Under such circunislainces the vectors are called
truri.smi.s.sible vi't'tutx For cxample. i n towing the object i n Fig. I.IO, we
may apply the lorce anywhere alung t l i t rupc AH or inay piish at point C.
The resulting motion i s lhe same in all cases. s i i lhe Snrce i s a transinissihle
vector for this purpose.
3. Situurions in w/iir.h fhP I ' ~ ~ ' I oi ~n us t br rippli~4NI r1c:finite I1oinl.s. The
point may he represented as the tail or head of the arrow iii thc graphical
representation. For this case. n o other positioii of application leads tu
SECTION 1.10 LAWS OFMECHANICS 19

equivalence. Under such circumstances. the vector is called a bound vec-


tor. For example, if we are interested in the deformation induced by forces
in the body in Fig. 1.10, we must be more selective in our actions than we
were when all we wanted to know was the motion of the body. Clearly,
force F will cause a different deformation when applied at point C than Figure 1.10. F i s transmissible for towing.
it will when applied at point A . The force is thus a bound vector for this
problem.
We shall be concerned throughout this text with considerations of equivalence.

tl.10 laws of Mechanics


The enure structure of mechanics rests on relatively few basic laws. Never-
theless, for the student to comprehend these laws sufticiently to undertake
novel and varied problems, much study will be required.
We shall now discuss briefly the following laws, which are considered
to be the foundation of mechanics:
1. Newton’s first and second laws of motion.
2. Newton’s third law.
3. The gravitational law of attraction.
4. The parallelogram law.

Newton’s First and Second Laws of Motion. These laws were first stated
by Newton as

Every particle continues in a state of rest or uniform motion in a straight


line upless it is compelled to change that state by forces imposed on it.
The c b g c of motion is proportional to the naturn1;ferCe impressed and
is made in a direction of the straight line in which the force is impressed.

Notice that the words “rest,” “uniform motion,” and “change of motion’’
appear in the statements above. For such information to he meaningful, we
must have some frame of reference relative to which these states of motion can
be described. We may then ask: relative to what reference in space does every
particle remain at “rest” or “move uniformly along a straight line’’ in the
absence of any forces? Or, in the case of a force acting on the particle, relative
to what reference in space is the “change in motion proportional to the force”?
Experiment indicates that the “fixed stars act as a reference for which the first
and second laws of Newton are highly accurate. Later, we will see that any
other system that moves uniformly and without rotation relative to the fixed
stars may be used as a reference with equal accuracy. All such references are
called inertial references. The earth’s surface is usually employed as a refer-
ence in engineering work. Because of the rotation of the earth and the varia-
20 CHAPIEK 1 FUNl1AMENTAI.S OF MECHANICS

ticins i n its miition around the sun, i t i s iiot, strictly speaking. iui inertial rcScr-
ence. However, the departure i s xi small Sor m o s t situiitiiins (cxccptions arc
the motion iif guided missile!, and spacccralt) that the trior incurred i s very
slight. We shall, therefore, usually consider the earth's s u r l x c as an inertial
reference, but w i l l keep i n mind the somewhat appr(iximatc iiaturu of this stcp.
As a result n t the preceding discus~ion.we may define equilihriuni as
thuc .slate ($'I hoc/y in which ull its c~instiru~vrt purtid<,s u m ut r('.st or n i o h g
irn~/?wmlyulon(: u straighl line w l u t i v e to 11ii i i i e ~ ~ i ir&wiiw.
il The coiivcrse
nf Newton's first law, then, stipulates Ibr the equilibrium stale that there [must
be nu force (os equivalent action of no force) acting on the body. Many situii-
rions f a l l into this category. The study of bodies in equilibrium i s called S I U I -
i c s . and i t w i l l be an important consideration in this text.
In addition tn the reference limitations explained above. ii serious limitti-
tion was brought to light at tlic turn ill this century. As pointed out carlicr. the
piiineering work 11f Einstein revealed that the laws 01 Newtun become increas-
ingly more approximate a!, the spccd ul' a body incrcii. Ncar the spccd of
light, they are untenable. hi the vast majority of ciigincc ciimpututions. the
speed iif a body i s so small compared to the speed light that these departures
from Newtonian mechanics. called r<dutivi.stic.e[ 1.5, may be entirely disrc-
farded with little sacrifice in accuracy. In ciinhidci-ing the motion of high-
energy elementary particles occurring i n nuclear phenomena, however, we
cannot ignore relativistic effects. Finally, when we get down t o very small dis-
tances. such as those between the protons and neutrons in the iiucleus o f iui
atom. we find that Newtonian mechanics cannot explain many observed phe-
rionieiia. In this case, we must rexiit to quantum mechanics. arid then New-
t u n ' s laws give way to the Schrddingcr e i p l i i i n a s the key equation.

Newton's Third Law. Newton stated in his third law:

To every action rhere is always opposed an equul rcucrion, or the mutual


actiuns of mu bodies upon euch other are ulwuys equal arid directed to
contrary points.

This i s illustrated graphically i n Fig. I. I I , where the action and reaction


between two bodies arise Srom direct contact. Other imporrant actions i n
which Newton's third law holds arc gravitationdl attractions (to be discussed
next) and electrostatic forces between charged pat-ticks. I t should he pointed
out that there are actiiiiis that dii nut fiillow this law. nutably the electrinnag-
netic fiirces between charged moving bodies.'

Law of Gravitational Attraction. It has alrcady been piiintcd out that these
i s an attraction between the earth and the bodies at its surface, such as A and B

'Llectmmagnclic fi,rcrs b ~ t w r c~hnr g c d m w i n g ~ ~ I I I C I C I iiir cqu'ti and ,q'pubiiu hui iiiu


iiut wllincilr and ~ C I I C L arc
~IDI "dircclcd LO contray poiair."
.
SECTION 1.10 LAWS OF MECHANICS 21

in Fig. 1.1 I . This attraction is mutual and Newton’s third law applies. There
is also an attraction between the two bodies A and B themselves, but this
force because of the small size of both bodies is extremely weak. However,
the mechanism for the mutual attraction between the earth and each body is
the same as that for the mutual attraction between the bodies. These forces of
attraction may be given by the law of gravitational attractiun:

Figure 1.11. Newton’s third law

Two anicles will be attracted toward each other along their connecting
line ith a force whose magnitude is directly proponional to the product
of the masses and inversely proportional to the distMce squared between
the pqnicles.
~

Avoiding vector notation for now, we may thus say that

F = G -m1mz (1.1 I)
I2

where G is called the universal gravitational constant. In the actions involv-


ing the earth and the bodies discussed above, we may consider each body as
a particle, with its entire mass concentrated at its center of gravity.* Hence, if
we know the various constants in formula I , I 1, we can compute the weight of
a given mass at different altitudes above the earth.

Parallelogram Law. Stevinius (1 548-1 620) was the first to demonstrate


that forces could be combined by representing them by arrows to some
suitable scale, and then forming a parallelogram in which the diagonal repre-
sents the sum of the two forces. As we pointed out, all vectors must combine
in this manner.

*To be studied in detail in Chapter 4.


22 CHAPTER I FIINDAMENTA1.S OF MECHANICS

1.11 Closure
In this chapter, we havc introduccd the basic dimensions by which we can
describc in a quanlikttivc manner certain aspccw 01 nalurc. These hasic, and
from them secondary, dimensions may be related by dimensionally homoge-
ncous equations which, with suitable idcalirations, can represent certain
actions i n nature. The baric laws of mechanics were thus introduccd. Since
the equations of these laws relate vector quantities, we shall introduce a use-
ful and highly dercriplive set of vector operations in Chapter 2 in order to
learn to handle these laws effectively and to gain more insight into mechanics
in general. These operations are generally c:illcd

Check-Out for Sections with 'i


1.1. What are two kinds of limitations on Newtonian mechanics'?
1.2. What are the two phenomena wherein mass plays a key role?
1.3. If a pound force is defined by the extension of a standard spring,
define the pound mass and the slug.
1.4. Express mass density dimensionally. How many scale units of
mass density (mass per unit volume) in the SI units are equivalent
to I scale unit in the American system using (a) slugs, ft, sec and
(b) Ibm, ft, sec?
1.5. (a) What is a necessary condition for dimensionul lumogeneily in
an equation'?
(b) In the Newtonian viscosity law, the frictional resistance T
(force per unit area) in a fluid is proportional to the distance
rate of change of velocity dV/dy. The proportionality constant
pis called the coefficient of viscosity. What is its dimensional
representation?
1.6. Define a vector and a scalar.
1.7. What is meant by line of action o f a vector?
1.8. What is a di.splucement vector?
1.9. What is an inertial reference?
REVIEW I1*

Vector Algebra
72.1 Introduction
In Chapter I , we saw that a scalar quantity is adequately given by a magnitude,
while a vector quantity requires the additional specification of a direction. The
basic algebraic operations for the handling of scalar quantities are those famil-
iar ones studied in grade school, so familiar that you now wonder even that
you had to be “introduced” to them. For vector quantities, these methods may
be cumbersome since the directional aspects must be taken into account.
Therefore, an algebra has evolved that clearly and concisely allows for certain
vely useful manipulations of vectors. It is not merely for elegance or sophisti-
cation that we employ vector algebra. Indeed, we can achieve greater insight
into the subject matter-particularly into dynamics-by employing the more
powerful and descriptive methods introduced in this chapter.

t2.2 Magnitude and Multiplication


of a Vector by a Scalar
The magnitude of a quantity, in strict mathematical parlance, is always apos-
ifive number of units whose value corresponds to the numerical measure of
the quantity. Thus, the magnitude of a quantity of measure -50 units is +50
units. Note that the magnitude of a quantity is its absolute value. The mathe-
matical symbol for indicating the magnitude of a quantity is a set of vertical
lines enclosing the quantity. That is,
1-50 units1 = absolute value (-50 units) = +50 units

*The reader is urged to pay particular attention to Section 2.4 on Resolution of Vectors
and Section 2.6 on Useful Ways of Representing Vectors.
-tAgain, as in Chapter I,we have used the symbol t for cenain section headings to indicate
that at the end of the chapter there are questions to be answered in writing pertaining to these sec-
tions. The instmcter may wish tu assign the reading of these seclians along with the aforemen-
tioned questions.
23
24 CHAlTEK 2 t L L M t N I ' S 01: VC("I0R ALGCRRA

Similarly. the miignitude of a vector quantity i s a positive riumhcr 01unit5


corresponding to the length of the vector i n those units. Using our vector
symh~ils.we ciin say that
magnitude u i wctor A = A 1 A
Thus, A i s positivc sciiliir qu;inlity. We m;iy iiow di\ciiis the iiiiil1iplic;ition
ii
oi. _.
'I b ~ .t by ii sciiliii~.
0 1

The definitinn (71 the product o i vectoi A h y wiliir iii,written simply iis
m A , i s given i n the following IiiiinncI:

Thc vector -A iiiay he ciiii\idcred a\ 1he p~iiclucto i thc sciiliir - I ;ind


the vector A . 'lhu\. ironi the 5lateiiicnt ahove u e see that -A d i i f w lrom A i n
that i t h a s an opposite w i s e . I'urtlierniore. [ h a c npcriitims havc nothing to

i
do with the line ofactinii < > f abector. .;oA and -A may 1 h : i ~ dilfcrcnt lines 01'
x t i o n . This w i l l he lhc ciise n1tlic couple lo he \tudied i n Ch;ipter 3.

.:2.3 Addition and Subtraction

*&<
C
(ill
n of Vectors
In ;idding a number 01w c t o ~ - \ \re . miiy rcpeiitcdly cmpluy Ihc parallclogram con-
\t~-uction.Wc ciiii dci this graphically hy sciiliiig the Icngllis d t h c iirrou's accord-
ing to the niiigiiiludc~n l the \'ccti)r q i i ~ i i i t i l i ethey
~ rcprcvnt. The magnitude (it.
A tI n-ci lhc final iirrou' ciiii then he iiiterpretcd in teiniir o i i t s length by cinployinf tlic
chosen scale f k t o r . A.; xi ea:iinple, ciinsider thi' coplaniir' \cctors A. R. and C
shown in Fig. 2. I(a). .I'he addition of the \cctors A . H. and C h a hccn iicconi-
C'
.~ ,4-C plishcd i n two ways. 111 t i g . 2.11hl we lirst add 11 and C and thcn iidd the rcsult-
-.
- & ~~~~~~~

H ing vector (showii cla\lied) lo A . This cnmhin;iti(in ciin he represented hy the


fhl i i o t i i t i ~ nA + IH + CI. 111Fig. 2.llc). \\ idd A iind B. and then add the result-
iiig vectoi- (shoum (Iadied) to C. The reprc\eiilatioii 01 this combination is givcii
iis IA + + R) C'. Nolc that thc f i n a ~ectoi-is identical fiIr hotli procedures. Thus.
A + (R + CI = (A + Rl t C (2.1)
~.

,.*
[A -111

_,'
-< '

/--;,
--.-
-11
Whcii the quiiiititics itivol\cd iii xi algchraic opcriition
out rcstriclinii. ilic ~ i ~ ~ c ~ r i i sl i o i i to
s;iiil hc
ciin hc froupcd witli-
n r s i r i o t i i ~ e .Thus. the ;idditinn o i
C t o r s i s hnth coninii~tiitivc.iis caplained enrliei-, uid a\sociati\'c,
'To determine ii siin~iiiatiiiii(11. Ict u s h a y . two vectors uritliout recoursc
IC1
to graphics. we need nnly inlakc ii siinplc \ketch o S the vectors approximatcly
IO sciilc. By tising hiiiiiliw trigonnineti-ic relation\. we can get a dircct cviilu-
Figure 2.1. Addition hy pmillclograiii iau. ation o i t h c result. This i s illiistratcd iii the f i ~ l l ~ i w i nca;iinples.
g

l('q>law.imcmio: " w n c p l m . " t \ ,t ii~biil


SECTION 2.3 A DD ITI O N AN D SUBTRACTION OF VECTORS 25

Example 2.1
Add the forces acting on a particle situated at the origin of a two-dimen-
sional reference frame (Fig. 2.2). Onc force has a magnitude of 10 Ib act-
ing in the positive x direction, whereas the other has a magnitude of 5 Ib
acting at an angle of 135" with a sense directed away from the origin.
y
I
I R

A- li
0 IOlb
Figure 2.2. Find F and a using trigonometry

To get the sum (shown as F ) , we may use the law of cosines' for one of
the triangular poriions of the sketched paiallelogr~m.Thus, using triangle OBA,

+ 5 2 - (2)(10)(5)cos45"]1~2
IF1 = [ I 0 2
= (100 + 25 - 70.7)"2 = \'54.3 = 7.37 Ib

The direction of the vector may he described by giving the angle and the sense.
The angle is determined by employing the law of sines for triangle OBA.?

(5)(0.707)
sin a = = 0.480
7.37
Therefore.
F = 7.31 Ih
a = 28.6"

The sense is shown using the directed line segment


26 ('HAPTFR 2 EIXMENTS 01' Vk.CI'OK AlMitHKA

Example 2.2
A simple slingshot (hec Fig. 2.3) i s about to be "fired." I f the entire rubber
band requires 3 Ib per inch o f elongation, what force does the hand exert
on the hand'! Thc total unstretched length of the rubber band i s 5 in.
The top view 01 the slingshot i s shown in Fig. 2.4. The change in
overall length of the ruhher hand A L from i t s unstretchcd length i s

A L = 2(1.5' +~ 2 ) "- ~5 = I 1.28 in.

The teiisiiin i n the entire extended rubber hand i s then ( II .28)(3)Ib. Con-
sequently, the fiircc F transmitted by rorh / c y of the slingshot i s
Figure 2.3. Simplc dingshut.
F = ( I I .2X)(1) = 33.84 lb
and the value of H
I.5 -y.1
0 = tan-' ~

8
= 10.62° -. .
13"
I n Fig. 2.5, we show a paralleliigram involving the Ibrccs Farid their suni
R where R i s the force that the hand exerts on the hand. We ciin use the law
Figure 2.4. Top \ i e u 01the slingchor.
of cosines on either of the triangles to get K . Thus
842 + 33.84' - (2)(33.84)(33.84)cos cx
Noting that cy = 180" - (?)(10.62") = 158.8" we have
F = 13.X4 Ih
K = [(2)(33.84)'(1 - c o ~ 1 5 X . X ' ) ] ~ ~=~ 66.52

A more direct calculation can be used by considering two right triangles


within the chosen triangle. Then using elementary trigon<iinctry we have
R = (2K33.84) COS (10.62)" = 66.52 Ib Figure 2.5. Parsllclogram 011orcrs

It must be emphatically pointed out that thc additiim (if vectorsA and R
only involves the vectors themselves and iiot thcir lines of actions or thcir posi-
tions along their respective lincs 0faction. That is. we can change their lines 01
action and miive them along their rchpcctive lines of action 50 a s to form two
sides 01a parallelogram. For thc additional vector algebra that we will devclop
in this chapter, we can tnkc siiniliir liheilics with the ~ e c ~ oinvolved.
rs
We inay also add the vectors by moving them successively to parallel
positions so that the head of one v c c t ~ rconnects to the lail of the iiext vector,
and s o (111. The sum o f the \'cctors will then he ii vcctor w l i ~ s etail connects to
the tnil 01 the first vector and whose head connects to the head of the last vec-
tor. This last step will lorin a polygon from the v e c t ~ r s .and wc say that the
vector sum then "closcs the polygon." Thus. adding thc IO-lh vector to the
SECTION 2.3 ADDITION AND SUBTRACTION OF VECTORS 27

5-lb vector in Fig. 2.2, we would form the sides OA and AB of a triangle. The
sum F then closes the triangle and is OB. Also, in Fig. 2.6(a), we have shown
three coplanar vectors F,, F2,and Fi. The vectors are connected in Fig. 2.6(h)
as described. The sum of the vectors then is the dashed vector that closes the
polygon. In Fig. 2.6(c), we have laid off the vectors F,, F2.and Fiin a differ-
ent sequence. Nevertheless, it is seen that the sum is the same vector as in Fig.
2.6(b). Clearly, the order of laying off the vectors is not significant.

Figure 2.7. Subtraction of vectors.

Figure 2.6. Addition by “closing the polygon.”

A simple physical interpretation of the above vector sum can he formed


for vectors each of which represents a movement of a certain distance and
, direction (i.e,, a displacement vector). Then, traveling along the system of
given vectors you start from one point (the tail of the first vector) and end at
another point (the head of the last vector). The vector sum that closes the
polygon is equivalent to the system of given vectors, in that it takes you from

c\P
the same initial to the same final point. (h)
The polygon summation process, like the parallelogram of addition, can
be used as a graphical process, or, still better, can be used to generate analyti- B+A-D-C
cal computations with the aid of trigonometry. The extension of this proce-
dure to any number of vectors is obvious. k
The process of subtraction of vectors is defined in the following man- -D ”xD
ner: to subtract vector B from vector A , we reverse the direction of B (i.e.,
multiply by - 1) and then add this new vector toA (Fig. 2.7).
This process may also be used in the polygon construction. Thus, consider -c
(c)
coplanar vectors A , B, C , and D in Fig. 2.8(a). To form A + B - C - D ,
Figure 2.8. Addition and
we proceed a s shown in Fig. 2.8(b). Again, the order of the process is not sig- subtraction using polygon
nificant, as can be seen in Fig. 2.8(c). construction.
2.1. Add ii 20-N force pointing in the positive r direction to a magnitude of force 8 and the direction of forcc C?(For the Eim-
50-N forcc at an nnple 45" to the .r axis in the first quadrant and plcst rcsulti, usc the force polygon, which for this c a w is ;I right
dirccted away from the origin. triangle. and pcrform analytical computations.1

2.2. Subtract the 20-N force in Prohlem 2.1 from the SO-N force.

2.3. Add thc \,ectors in the .x? plane. Do this first graphically.
using the force polygon. and then do it aialytically.

(7.S j 2 0 Ih
c-) A
w
10 N

Fieure P.2.h

2.7. A light cahlc from a Jccp i\ tied to the peak of an A-fi-amr


Figure P.2.3 m d c x c m it lorcc of450 N along thc cahlc. A I,OOO-kg log i s su\-
pcnded from a .;ecimd cahlc, which i s fastened to the peak. Whal
2.4. A lightweight homemade plane i s bcinf ohserved LIS i t flies i, the t ~ , l a l fri,,n c.,hle\ ,," rhr A-fr;i,,,c'!
at constant altitude hut in a wries of scparatc comtant directions.
At the outset, i t goes rluc east for 5 km, then due north for 7 kin.
thcn southcast fur 4 km. and finally, southwmt for R km. (iraphi-
cally determine the shortest dislancc from thc starting poinl to the
end point of the previous ohscrvationi. See Fig. P.2.4.

Figure P.2.7

2.8. Find thr toLal force and i t \ direction from the cahlr acting
on each of the three pulleys. each of which i s free tu turn. The
IOO-N weigh1 i\ stationary.

Figure P.2.4

2.5. A homing pigcon i s released at point A and is observed. I t


flier I O krn due south, then gocs duc east for IS km. Next i t goes
southcast for I O k m and finally gocs due south 5 km to reach i t s
destination H. Graphically drtrmminc thc \hwtcst distance betweeii
A and B . Ncglcct the earth'\ cuwature.

add up to a forcc C that has n magnitude of 20 N. What is the Figure P.2.8


2.9. If the difference between forces B and A in Fig. P.2.6 is a 2.15. A man pulls with force Won a rope through a simple fric-
force D having a magnitude of 25 N, what i s the magnitude of B tionless pulley to raise a weight W. What total force is exerted on
and the direction o f D ? the pulley?
2.10. What is the sum ofthe forces transmitted by the structural
rods to the pin at A?
.. , I

f400 N

Figure P.2.10
2.11. Suppose in Problem 2.10 we require that the total force
transmitted by the members to pin A be inclined 12" to the hori- Figure P.2.15
zontal. If we do not change the force transmitted by the horizontal 2.16. Add the three vectors using the parallelogram law twice.
member, what must be the new force for the other member whose The 100-N force is in the xz plane, while the other two forces are
direction remains at 40"? What is the total force? parallel to the yz plane and do not intersect. Give the magnitude of
2.12. Using the parallelogram law, find the tensile force in the sum and the angle if forms with f h e x axis.
cable AC, T,,., and the angle a.(We will do this problem differ-
ently in Example S.4.)

n = so*
W = 1,000 N
T~w=hOflN

x
Figure P.2.16
Figure P.2.12
2.13. In the preceding problem, what should the angle 6 be so 2.17. A mass M is supported by cables (I) and (2). The tension
that the sum of the forces from cable DE and cable EA is colinear in cable ( I ) is 200 N, whereas the tension in ( 2 )is such as to main-
with the boom CE? Verify that S = 55". tain the configuration shown. what is the mass of M in kilograms?
(You will leam very shortly that the weight of M must be equal
2.14. Three forces act on the block. The 500-N and the 600-N and opposite to the vector sum of the supporting forces for
forms act, respectively, on the upper and lower faces of the block, equilibrium.)
while the 1,000-N force acts along the edge. Give the magnitude
of the sum nf these forces using the parallelogram law twice.
0

/ 30"
Figure P.2.14 Figure P.2.17
I

29
2.18. Two foothall player, are pushing a hlocking dummy.
Playcr A pushcs with Ill(l-lh forcc whilc player R pushes with
ISO-lh force toward how C of thc dummy. What i s the total furce
cxertcd on the dummy hy the players'!

a
Figure F.2.19

*2.20. Dn prohlcin 2.19 tind then lorm an intciactivc computer


prnpram \o that l l i e wer at ii prumpl i s askcd 10 insert an anglc n
H in radian.: fbr which the program w i l l deliver the onricct values of
F;, F,. :Ind /7
2.21. Twu soccer player5 approach a stntir,nary hall I O ft away
t r i m the gnal. Simitltaner~udy.a player on triini 0 inffensc) kicks
rhc hall with frrcc 100 Ih Snr a split sccnnd while a player on team
rl (defense) kick.: with force 70 Ih durinp the samc timc intcrval.
Does the offense score (asuming lhiit the g d i c i s asleep)'!
Figure P.2.18

2.19. What ire the f o ~ m x s and F; and the angle !3fw any given
mglr a to relieve the force of gravity W from the horiiomal \up-
part of the hlock at A'! Thc rollers on thc side u l the hlock tlo not
70 Ih
crmtrihute to thc vertical support nf the hlock. The wire5 cnnnect
til the gcrrmerric center of the hlock C.The weight W i s 5 0 0 N .
Form three independent equations for any given a involving the
unknowns f ; . f:, and b.
- l[l'-/
Figure P.2.21

Stipulated
directions 2.4 Resolution of Vectors;
Scalar Components
The opposite action (11 addition nf vectors i s c;illed rc~.solrrriori.Thus, liir a
given vector C , we may find 8 pair nf vectors in any two stipulated directions
coplanar with C such that thc t w n \'cctnrs. callcd ~'onii~onrnt.s, sum ti) the
Figure 2.9. Two-dimensional original vector. This i s a tn.o~ifin~i~n.vionir1
resolution invnlving two compo-
rewlution of vcctor C. nent vectors i,oplwzor with the original vector. We shall discuss three-
dimensional resolution involving three noncoplanar component vectors later
in the section. The two-dimensional resolution citn he accomplished by
graphical construction 0 1 the parallelogram. or by using simple helpful
sketches and then emplnying trigonometric relations. An example nf ~ W O -
dimensional rcsiilution is shown in Fig. 2.9. Thc two vectors C , and C ,
formed in this way are the compomnt vectors. Wc olten replace a vector b y
its components siticc the cnniponents are alway:, cquivalcnt i n rigid-body
nicchanics to the original vector. When this i s done. it i s ofteii helplul to indi-
Figure 2.10. Vector C is
replaced hy i t \ components cate that the original vcctor i s no longer operative by drawing it wavy line
and is m) longer opcrativc. through the original veclor as shown i n Fig. 2.10.
SECTION 2.4 RESOLUTION OF VECTORS: SCALAR COMPONENTS 31

Example 2.3
A sailboat cannot go directly into the wind, but must tack from side
to side as shown in Fig. 2. I I wherein a sailboat is going from marker A to
marker I3 5,000 meters apart. What is the additional distance AL beyond
5,OOO m that the sailboat must travel to get from A to B ?
Clearly the displacement vectofl pARis equivalent to the vector sum
of displacement vectors pAc plus pcR in that the same starting points A ,
and the same destination points B,are involved in each case. Thus, vectors
pAc and pcR are two-dimensional components of vector pas Accordingly,
we can show a parallelogram for those vectors for which triangle ABC
forms half of the parallelogram (see Fig. 2.12). We leave it for you to jus-
tify the various angles indicated in the diagram. Now we first use the law
(if sines.
Marker A
~~
AC ~
5,000 Figure 2.11. Sailboat tacking.
sinp sinn

And
BC - s,oon
sin y sinn

Hence the increase in distance AL is L I-ZO.

AL = (2,418.4 + 2,988.4) - 5,000 = 406.8 m

'A di.splac?menf vector. we remind you, connects two points A and B in spacc and i s Figure 2.12. Enlarged parallelogram.
often denoted as p,, The order of the subacnpts gives the sense of the vector-here going
from A to 8.

It is also readily possible to find three components not in the .same plane
as C that add up to C. This is the aforementioned three-dimensional resolution.
Consider the specification of three orthopnal directions' for the resolution of
C positioned in the first quadrant, as is shown in Fig. 2.13. The resolution may
be accomplished in two steps. Resolve C along the z direction, and along the

/ c4

sAlthough the vector can be resolved along three .skew directions (hence nononhogonal), Figure 2.13. Orthogonal or
the orthogonal directions are used most often in engineering practice. rectangular components.
32 CHAPTER 2 E L E M E N K OF V E r I O K Al.(iEHRA

intersection o f Ihc x? planc and the planc formed by C and the :axis. This is ii
twii-ilimcnsi~inal recolulioii with tlie par;illelogr;im hccmiing a rectangle
because o l the niwinalcy of the :axis to IIic .x? plane. This gives nrthogonal
\'cctoi-s C , and C, t l i i i ~replace original toi- C . Next take vector C,, and
r c s o h e it along axes . x ~and ? hy ii hecond t u ~ o ~ d i n i c n i ~ ires(iluti~in
nal involving
a 1-ectangle oncc iigain thus forming 1 ogoiial vectors C , and C , tliat may
replace veckir C,. Clearly (irthogonal 01s C , , C , , illid c,
add up 10 C and
accordingly can replace C undr~- any and all circuni ces. Hence C , . C2. and
C , w e called orfliiip,wil or ~ ~ ~ ~ ( i uwii/iiJiwii/
~i~iikir
The direction of a rector C relative ttr iiii or~li~iyon;il rcference i s given
by the cosines 01 the angles fol-med by the \ecror arid tlic rcspcclive c(iordi-
nille axes. These are called dir~wlioii~r)sine.s and arc dcnoted as

cos ( C . .1) = cos n z i


cos ( C , ?) = cos p
F Ill (2.2)
cos ( C . :) = 1'11s y = ,I

uhcrc (x, p. and yare associ:ited with tlie .c. ?. and :iixcs. rcspectively. Now
le1 us consider the right triangle. whose sides iire C and the comlxmi'iil vector.
C , . \howti sliiided i n Fig. 2. 13. I t tlicii l ~ c c o ~ iclciir.
i e ~ froiii trig~iii~iiiietric
coii-
sidcriilioiis rif the right triangle. thal lor thc fir71 qiiadrant
,C,I = iC1 co\ y = Cl I1 (2.3)
If wc h:id decided 10 resolve C first i n the direction instcad of the :direc-
tion. we would havc pl-duccd ii gc(iiiictry froni which we could ciincludc that
lC,l = ~ C ~ ISiniilwly.
II. u'c ciiii say tliiit lC,l x ~ C l iWc
. ciin thcn exprey\ IC i n
terms 01' it\ orthogon;il components i n the fi,llowing iminner. using the
Pythagorean theorem."

IC1 = [( CIIf + (lCin)2 + (~C!ll)~]l (2.4)

From this equation we cim dchnc tlie I J ~ - I / I O ~ O ~ I Oor


/ suilur
rwlm~iiliir mni~
thc vcctor C having w i ? orientatinn a s
p m 7 ~ ' i i tof
.~

= (C(1. C, = (C(nr. C': = ( C , N (2.51

1, Note tlial (;. (;, and (.:~


may hc ncgative. depending on Lhc sign of the dii-ec-
/ y. l ~ C;. mil C~(ire
fioii cosincs. l-'in:illy. i t i i i i i s t he poinled out tliiil ~ i l l l i o i ~ , C;
cmo<.io/edw i i h wr-lui,i ii,rc,v liiid l r e i r w wr/<,i,z i I i w < ~ t i m vtly? , i t o i . r hec,i
Iiqml .si,tiliir.s(irrd iiiii.sr he 11iimIl~~d ( i s .sm/iir,s. l'lius. an cquatiori such
as IOV = a
cos i s 1101 correct. bcciiusc (lie lest side i s ii veclor and the right
side i s a scalar. This sh(iuld spui- you lo obscrvc care i n your notation
Sotnctimcs only o w of the sciiliir iirthiigiiiiiil coniporients o f a
ngular sciilar coniponciit) i h desired. Then. .just one direc-
tion i s prescribed. as shown i n Fig. 2.14. Thus. h e scalar rectangular coin-
Figure 2.14. Rcctaogular component OF C. ponent C', i s C 8cos6. Note u e have shii\vn a pair of other recliingular
SECTION 2.5 UNIT VECTORS 33

components as dashed vectors in Fig. 2.14. However, it is only the single


component C, that we often use, disregarding other rectangular components.
It is always the case that the triangle formed by the vector and its scalar rec-
tangular component is a right triangle. In establishing C, we therefore speak
of “dropping a perpendicular from C to s ” or of “projecting along s.”
The scalar rectangular component Cycould also be the result of a fwo-
dimensionul orthogonal resolution wherein the other component is in the
plane of C and Cyand is normal to C,. It is important to remember, however,

q
that a component of a nonorthogonal two-dimensional resolution is nof a rec-
tangular component.
As a final consideration, let us examine vectors A and B , which, along
with directions, form a plane as is shown in Fig. 2.15. The sum of the vectors
A and B is found by the parallelogram law to be C. We shall now show that
the projection of‘C along s is the same as the sum of the projections of the
two-dimensional components of A and B , taken along s . That is,
Cy = Ay + E,
On the diagram, then, the following relation must be verified:
c s
ac = ad + ub (a)
But
Figure 2.15. C,= A, + B,.
uc = ab + bc (b)
Also, it is clear that
ad = bc (C)
By substituting from Eqs. (b) and (c) into Eq. (a), we reduce Eq. (a) to an
identity which shows that the projection of the sum of two vectors is the same
as the sum of the projections of the two vectors.

2.5 Unit Vectors


It is sometimes convenient to express a vector C as the product of its magni-
tude and a vector a of unit magnitude and having direction corresponding to
the vector C. The vector a is called a unit vector. The unit vector is also at
times denoted ash. (You will write it as 6.) It has no dimensions. We formu-
late this vector as follows:

a(unit vector in direction C) =


C
~
(2.6)
IC1
Clearly, this development fulfills the requirements that have been set forth for
this vector. We can then express thc vcctor C in the form
C = lCla (2.7)
The unit vector, once established, does not have, per se, an inherent line of
action. This will be determined entirely by its use. In the preceding equation,
34 CHAPTER 2 ELEMENTS OF VECTOR ALGEBRA

the unit vector a might be considered collinear with the vector C. However,
we can represent the vector D , shown in Fig. 2.16 parallel to C, hy using the
unit vector a a s follows:

I ) = lD!a (2.7a)
Figure 2.16. Unit vector a.
It thus acts as a free vector. Occasionally. it is useful to lahel a unit vector
meant to have the line of action of a certain vector with the lowercase letter of
the capital letter associated with that vector. Thus. i n Eqs. 2.7 and 2.7(a) for
this purpose we might have employed in the place ofa the letters c and d (in
your case i. and &, respectively. Next, if a given vector is represented using a
lowercase letter, such as the vector r , then we oflen make use of the circuni-
flex mark to indicate the .ociated unit vector. Thus,

r = lrli (2.7h)
Unit vectors that are of particular use are those dircctcd along the direc-
tions of coordinate axes of a rectangular reference, where i, j . and k (your
instructor will prohahly use the notation ?,,r,
and &) comespond to the x. y. and
i directions, as shown in Fig. 2.17.'
Since the sum of a set of concurrent vectors is equivalent in all situa-
tions to the original vector, wc can always replace the vector C by its rcctun-
gular scalar components in the following manncr:
Figure 2.17. Unil vec~orslor .r?iaxcs
C = C:i + C,/ + C.k (2.8)
In Chapter I , we saw that vectors lhal are q u a l havc the same m a p -
lude and direction. Hence, if A = B , we can say that

A,i + A , j + A;k = 0.i + B,j + Brk (2.9)


Then, since the unit vectors have mutually different dircctions. we conclude
€rom ahove that
A,i = R,i
A , j = B,j
A,k = B:k
It then follows that
A , = R,
A, = B,.
A ; = B:

'Curvilinear caardinalc rystems iiilvc associated sei* (11 u r ~ YCCLOIE


l just 8s do the rectan-
gular coordinatc ayslcrns. As will be seen Iaitcr. however. culain or Ihew unit vectors do not a11
have tined directions in space for a given rclcrcncc as tlu rhc vectois i . j . arid k .
SECTION 2.6 USEFUL WAYS OF REPRESENTING VECTORS 35

Hence, the vector equation, A = B, has resulted in three scalar equations that
in totality are equivalent in every way to the vector statement of equality.
Thus, in Newton's law we would have
F = m (2.1021)
as the vector equation, and
F, = ma,, F, = ma,, F, = maI (2. IOb)
as the corresponding scalar equations.

2.6 Useful Ways of Representing Vectors


Quite often, we show a rectangular parallelepiped with sides oriented parallel
to the coordinate axes and positioned somewhere along the line of action of a
vector (see Fig. 2.18) such that this line of action coincides with an inside
diagonal of the rectangular parallelepiped. The purpose of this rectangular
parallelepiped and diagonal is to allow for the easy determination of the ori-
entation of the line of action and hence the orientation of a vector. AB in the
diagram is such a diagonal used for the determination of the line of action of
vector F . Numbers for this purpose are shown along the sides of the rectan-
gular parallelepiped without units. Any set of numbers can be used as long as
the ratios of these numbers remain the ones required for the proper determi-
nation of the orientation of the vector. That determination proceeds by first
replacing the displacement vector p,,, from comer A to comer B by a set of
three vector displacements going from A to B along the sides of the rectangu-
lar parallelepiped. We thereby can replace the vector p,, by the sum of its
rectangular components. Thus, for the case shown in Fig. 2.18 we can say8
PA,
= l O j - 4i + 6k = i+ lOj
4 + 6k
z
B

I A IO

X /
Figure 2.18. Rectangular parallelepiped used for specifying the direction of a vector.

XImagineyou are "walking" from A to B hut restricting your movements to he along the
coordinate directions. This movement i s equivalent to going directly from A to B in that the Same
endmints result.
36 CHAPTER 2 ELEMENTS OF VECTOR AI.OE~RA

Now using the Pythagorean theorem, divide pAn by i t s magnitude, namely:


+ 6', We thus form the unit vectorbA8. That is.
,42 +

- PA# -
-
-4; + I O j + 6k = -.3244i + .81 I l j + .4867k
bAt{ 7
-

lP,,Hl \42 + IO' + 6'


As a final step we can give vector F as fMows:
F = F(-.3?44i + .81 I1.j + .4867k)
If F = 100 N we then can say:
F = -32.441' + 81.1 1.j + 48.67k N
Note that the rectangular parallelepiped can he anywhere along the line
of action of F including cases where F i s not inside of the parallelepiped or
extends heyond the parallelepiped (see Fig, 2.19). In the two-dimensional
case. a right triangle serves the same purpose as the rectangular paral-
, lelepiped i n three dimensions. This i s shown i n Fig. 2.20 where vector V i s i n
h the x? plane. Here we can say.

v=v
I 9
\.2' + 9 2
i + ,
.;2? + 97
= V(.9762i + .2169j)

Figure 2.19. Other ways to use the reclangular


parallelepiped.
L- -~
Figure 2.20. Right triangle used fur sppecifying
the direction ot it vector m two dirnensionq.

There are times when the rectangular parallelpiped i s not shown explic-
itly. However. thc Icngth o f the sides o f one having the proper diagonal may
hc availahle so that the replacement of the diagonal displacement vector into
rectangular components can he readily achieved. The simplest procedure i s IO
mcntally move from the beginning point o f the diagonal to the final point
always moving along coordinatc directions, or, i n other words, always mov-
ing along the sides 0 1 the hypothetical rectangular parallelepiped. Thus. i n
Fig. 2.21, for the v e c t ~ rF, we can consider A B to he the diagonal and in
p i n g from A to B we could first move i n the minus x direction by an amount
-1. then move i n the plus ?' direction by the amounl 1.5, and finally i n the I
dircclion hy an amount 3 . This would take us from initial point A to final
point IT. The corresponding displacement veclor would then he

p,, = -1; + I.Sj + 3j


The following example w i l l illustrate the use of orthogonal resolution
as well a s the use of rectangular components of vect~rs.
SECTION 2.6 USEFUL WAYS OF REPRESENTING VECTORS 37

Example 2.4
A crane (not shown) is supporting a 2,000-N crate (see Fig. 2.21) through
three cables: AB, CB, and DB. Note that D is at the center of the outer edge
of the crate; C is 1.6 m from the comer of this edge; and B is directly
above the center of the crate. What are the forces Fl, F2, and Fi transmitted
by the cables?
We will soon l e a n formally what our common sense tells us, namely
that the vector sum of force F,, force 5. and force Fi must equal 2,OWk N.
We first express these three forces in terms of rectangular components. Thus,

-li + 1.5j + 3k

= .;(-.2857i
1
+ ,42861 + .8571k) N

= F,(-.1761i - ,44021 + .8805k) N


We now sum the three forces to equal 2,OOOk N.

F,(-.2857i + .4286j + .8571k) + F2(.3162i + .9487k)


+ F3(-.I761i - .4402j + .8805k) = 2,OOOk
We have three scalar equations from the previous equation.

-2857 Fl + ,3162 F2 - ,1761 F3 = 0


,4286 Fl + 0 - ,4402 F3 = 0
,8571 Fl + ,9487 F2 + ,8805 F7 = 2,000
Solving simultaneously, we get the following results:

3m
Figure 2.21. A crate is supported by three forces.
2.22. Resolve thc 100-1h force into a set of components along
the slot shown and in the vertical direction.

F i g i r e P.2.2.5

2.26. Two tughants are maneuvering an w e a n liiw The desired


iota1 inrcc i s 3,000 Ih at an angle r r f I S " a h cliown i n the diagram.
If thc tughaat frrrces have dircctim\ a s shown, what inwt the
forces I.', and F- he''

Figure P.2.22

2.23. A lamer needc to build a fence from the corner of his ham
to the corner of hic chicken house 10 m away in the NE dircction.
However, he wants to enclose ils much of the harnyard as possi-
hie. Thus, he nins thc fcncc cmt, from thc corner of his ham to thc
prnpeny line and then NNE to thc corncr of his chickcn housc.
How long i s the fencc?

* /
2.24. Resolve the force F into a component perpendicular to AR Figure P.2.26
and a component parallel to NC.

2.27. I n the previous pruhlem, if F2 = I.000 Ih and = 40",


what should I.; and n he so that F, + F? yiclds the indicated
vmn-ih ~ C K C C ' !

2.28. A I.000-N force is resolvcd into component.; along AH and


Ac. If the component along AH i s 700 N.determine the angle n
and the value of the component along AC.

Figure P.2.24

2.25. A simple truss (to be studied later in detail) supports two


forces. If the forces in the members are colinear with the mem-
hcrs, what arc the forces in thc mcmbcrs? Him; The lorccs in thc
mcmherq must have a vector w m q u a l and opposite to the vcctoi
sum of E; and F,. The entire Eystem i s coplanar. Figure P.2.28
2.29. Two men are trying to pull a crate which will not move y
until a 150-lb total force is applied in any one direction. Man A
can pull only at 45' to the desired direction of crate motion,
whereas man B can pull only at 60" to the desired motion. What
force must each man exert to start the box moving as shown?

Desired

A
+
motion
C' 1
Figure P.2.31
5001b

2.32. The orthogonal components of a force are:


x comvonent 10 Ib in oositive x direction
y component 20 Ib in positive y direction
z component 30 Ib in negative z direction
(a) What is the magnitude of the force itself?
(b) What are the direction cosines of the force?
2.33. What are the rectangular components of the 100-lb force?
Figure P.2.29 What are the direction cosines for this force?
z
\

2.30. What IS the sum of the three forces? The 2,000-N force IS ,
in the y z plane. , \

/ '45"
I A
4 I '\\ II

Figure P.2.33
2.34. The 1,000-N force is parallel to the displacement vector
<A while the 2,000-N force is parallel to the displacement vector
CB. What is the vector sum of these forces?

Figure P.2.30

2.31. The 500-N force is to be resolved into components along


the AC and AB directions in the xy plane measured by the angles a
and p. If the component along AC is to be 1,000 N and the com- x
ponent along AB is to be 800 N, compute a and p. Figure P.2.34

39
2.35. A S(l-m-long diagrinal inemher Ot i n ii space iiallir I\
inclined a1 a = 70" and 30" t o the I and Y BXCS. respeclixly.
7:

What is y? How long mist rncmhel-c OA. A ( ' . ON. HC, and ('E hi.
to suppafi b: <)i
01;'

I t:

Figure P.2.35 /'


2.36. What is thc orthogonal total f h x cwnponcnt in tlic .I
direction 01 the ioice tiansmittcd to pin A of a roo1 t n h i h i tlic
four rncrnher,'! What is the total cirmpi,nent in the ? dbrcction"

Cahlcc :KC i n

,
1

Figure P.2.37 Figure P.2.43

40
2.44. Express the 100-N force in terms of the unit vectors i, j , 2.45. Express the unit vectors i,j , and k in terms of unit vectors
and k . What is the unit vector in the direction of the 100-N force'! e;. eo, and e7.(These are unit vectors for cvlindricul coordinates.)
The force lies along diagonal AB. Express the 1,000-lb force going through the origin and through
point (2, 4, 4) in terms of thc unit vectors i, j , k and E?, eti, eZwith
0 = 60". (See the footnote o n p. 34.)

Figure P.2.44 Figure P.2.45

2.7 Scalar or Dot Product of


m o Vectors
In elementary physics, work was defined as the product of the force compo-
nent, in the direction of a displacement, times the displacement. In effect, two
vectors, force and displacement, are employed to give a scalar, work. In other
physical problems, vectors are associated in this same manner so as to result
in a scalar quantity. A vector operation that represents such operations con-
cisely is the scalar product (or dot product), which, for the vectorA and B in
Fig. 2.22, is defined as'
<Figure 2.22. a is smallest
angle between A and B .

A . B = IAI IBl cos a (2. I 1 )


where a is the smaller angle between the two vectors. Note that the dot prod-
uct may involve vectors of different dimensional representation, and may be
positive or negative, depending on whether the smaller included angle a is
less than or greater than 90". Note also that A * B is equivalent to first pro-
jecting vector A onto the line of action of vector B (this gives us IAI cos a),
and then multiplying by the magnitude of vector B (or vice versa). The appro-
priate sign must, of course, be assigned positive if the projected component of
vector A and vector B point in the same direction; negative, if nol.
The work concept for a force F acting on a particle moving along a
path described by s can now be given as

W =JF.ds

where ds is a displacement on the path along which the particle is moved


''TOensure that there is 11" c u n l u h n between the dot product of two vectors and the ordi-
nary product or two scalars that you have used up to now, we urge you to read A R = C as "A
dotted intoR l i e l d s C."
42 CHAPTER 2 ELEMENTS OF VECTOR ALGEBRA

As with addition and subtraction of vectors, the dot product operation


involves only the vectors themselves and not their rcspective lines of action.
Accordingly, for a dot product of two vectors. we can move the vectors so a s
Lo intersect at their tails as in Fig. 2.22. Remember in so doing we must not
alter the magnitudcs and directions of the vectors.
Let us next consider the scalar product of mA and n u . If we carry it out
according to our definitions:
( n A ) * ( n B ) = Id/ jrrR1 cos (d. nBJ
(2.131
= (inn) IAI IRI cos (A. R ) = (mnJ (A B)
Hence, the scalar coefficients in the dot product of two vectors multiply in the
ordinary way, while only the vectors themselves undergo the vectorial opera-
tion as we have defined it.
From the definition, clearly thc dot product is commutnrivr. since the
numher /AI lB1 cos ( A , BJ is independent of the order of multiplication of its
terms. Thus,
A - R = R - A (2.14)
Let us now consider A * ( B + C).By definition, we may project the
vector ( B + C ) onto the line of action of A and then, assigning the appropri-
ate sign, multiply the magnitude of A times the projection of B + C . How-
ever, in Section 2.4 we showed that the projection of the sum of two vectors
is the same as the sun1 of thc prtijections of the vectors, which means that
A.(R +C) = A * B+ A .C (2.15)
An operation on a sum of quantities that is the same as the sum of the opera-
tions on the quantities is called a di.rtrihurive n p r n r i o n . Thus, the dot product
is distributive.
The scalar product between unit vectors will now be carried out. The
product i * j is 0, since the angle a in Eq. 2. I I is 90". which makes cos a = 0.
On the other hand. i * i = I . We can thus conclude that the dot product of
equal orthogonal unit vectors for a given reference is unity and that of un-
equal orthogonal unit vectors is zero.
If we express the vectors A and B in Cartesian components whcn taking
the dot product, we get
A * B = (A,i t A ,j + Ark) * (B,i + H,j + B:k)
(2.16)
= A t B z t A y B y t A.B.
. .
Thus, wc see that B scalar producl of two vectors is the sum of the ordinary
products of the respective components."'

"'Thus the ordinary griide school producr of two numhers, i.e. (o)(h), is n special C ~ S C0 1
the dot product n * b where the the vectors have thc w n c d i r e c l i m Thus
<ti hi = (ii)(h)
SECTION 2.1 SCALAR OK DOT PRODUCT OF TWO VECTORS 43
If a vector is multiplied by itself as a dot product, the result is the
square of the magnitude of the vector. That is,
A A = /AI IAl = A’ (2.17)
Conversely. the square of a number may be considered to be the dot product
of two equal vectors having a magnitude equal to the number. Note also that
A A = A: + A;. + A: = A’ (2.18)
We can conclude from Eq. 2.18 that
~~~

A = ./A: + A: + A:
which checks with the Pythagorean theorem.
The dot product may be of immediate use in expressing the scalar rec-
tangular component of a vector along a given direction as discussed in Sec-
tion 2.4. If you refer back to Fig. 2.14, you will recall that the component of
C along the direction s is given as
c, = IC/ cos 6
Now let us consider a unit vector s along the direction of the line s. If we
carry out the dot product of C and s according to our fundamental definition,
the result is
c s = IC1 Is1 cos 6

Similarly, the following useful relations are valid:


C,=C*i, C,=C.j, C.=C.k
Finally, express the unit vector i directed out from the origin (see Fig. k
2.23) in terms of the orthogonal scalar components:
-
3 = (i i ) i + -
(3 j ) j + (i * k)k
/L
0 ,
1-
But
Figure 2.23. Unit vector idirected from 0.
i * i = 131 lil cos (3, n) = /
Similarly, 3 - j = m and 3 k = n. Hence, we can say that
3 = li + mj + nk (2.19)
Thus, the orthogunal scalar components of a unit vectur are the direction
cosines of the direction uf the unit vector. Now, computing the square of the
magnitude of i , we have
li12= 1 = /2 + mz + nz (2.20)
We thus arrive at the familiar geometrical relation that the sum of the squares
of the direction cosines of a vector is unity.
Example 2.5
Cables GA and GB (see Fig. 2.24) are par1 (11 it guy-wire system support-
ing two radio transmission towers. What are the length:, o f GA and GLI and
the angle a hetween them? - -
We may directly set up thc vectorsGA and GB hy inspecting the dia-
gmni. l h u s on moving along the coordinate directions, i t is easy to scc that
ZA = 3Wlj - 400i + 5OOk rn
Gii 3Oij + 100i + S O O ~m
=

Using the Pythagorean theorcm, we can ray Sur the length:, ofGA and&
- :
<A
; = (300’ + 400L + 5002)1/L= 707 in
G H = (300’ + 100’ + 5 0 0 2 ) ” 2 = 592 111
Now we usc the dot product definition to find thc angle.
-
(;A * 6
3= (GA)iGLI)cos (Y

Thcrclbrz.

Hence,

a = 44.18”
A

Figure 2.24. Kvdio transmission tiiwers.


2.46. Given the vectors
2.50. Show that
A = 10i + 20j + 3k
B = -l0j + 1% cos (A, E ) = 11' + mm' + nn'

what is A * B ? What is cos (A, E)? What is the projection of A where I, m, n and 1', m', n' are direction cosines of A and E ,
along E ? respectively, with respect to the given xyz reference.

2.47. Given the vectors


2.51. Explain why the following operations are meaningless:
A = 16i

compute
+ 3j. E = 10k - 6i, C = 4j
(a) (A * E )
(b) (A E )
-+ C
C
(a) C(A * C )
(b) -C + [ E -+ B
(-A)IC
2.52. A block A is constrained to move along a 20' incline in
2.48. Given the vectors the yz plane. How far does the block have to move if the force F
is to do I O ft-lb of work?
A=6i+3j+10k
B=Z-Sj+Sk
C = 5i - 2j + l k z

what vector D gives the following results'? 1 F = 10i + 20i + 15k Ib


D - A = 2 0
D . B = 5
D.i=IO Y

2.49. A sailboat is tacking into a 20-knot wind. The boat has a


velocity component along its axis of 6 kn but because of side slip
X
and water currents, it has a speed a speed of .2 kn at right angles
Figure P.2.52
to its axis. What are the x and y components of the wind velocity
and the boat velocity? What is the angle between the wind d o c -
ity and the sailboat velocity'?
2.53. An electrostatic field E exerts a force on a charged pani-
cle of qE, where q is the charge of the particle. If we have for E :
E = 6i + 3j + 2k dyneslcoulomb
what work is done by the field on a panicle with a unit charge
moving along B straight line from the origin to position x = 20
mm, y = 40 mm, z = -40 mm?

2.54. A force vector of magnitude 100 N has a line of action


with direction cosines 1 = .7, m = .2, n = .59 relative to a ref-
erence xyz. The vector points away from the origin. What is the
component of the force vector along a direction a having direc-
tion cosines 1 = -.3, m = . I , and n = 9 5 for the xyz reference'?
(Hint: Whenever simply a component is asked for, it is virtually
Figure P.2.49 always the rvctrrngulrrr component that is desired.)

4:
2.55. What is the anglc bctwccn the I ,0011-N force and the axis 2.60. What is the rectangular component UC the 500-N forcc
A B ! The force is i n thc diagonal plane GCDE. alirrig the diagonal Iron, R to A'!

Fieure P.2.60
~

/I I\,l,lllllli.

Figure P.2.55 2.61. A radio tiiwci is held by guy wires. It A H were t<>he
moved to inleriect CII whilc rcmaining pardkl ID i t s original
2.56, (iiven a force F = Ioi + sj Ak N. If this force is
+
position, what is the angle brtwccn AH and U T !
have a rectangular component of X N along a line having a unit
vectur i= .hi + .Xk, what shuuld A hc'! What is the angle
hetween F arid i?

2.57. Given a twce Ai + Bj + 2llk N, what must A and H he to


give a rectaiigular ctimpr~nent01 Ill N iii the direction
i , = .?i + .6j + .742k
as wcll as il cornpuncot of 18 N i n the dircctiun
i, = .4i + .Yj + .1732k!

2.58. Find the dot prtiduct ul the vectors represented hy thz


diagonal5 from A to I" arid trmn 1) to G. Whal is thc angle hetween
them?

(?
l(1'
I
,,'
I

,, ------

XI'
c

1)
*--_ Y
Figure P.2.61
2.62. What is the angle bctweeii the 1.000-N force and the posi-
tion vector r'!

Figure P.2.58

2.59. A force F is givcn as


F = 8OOi + hOOj - I ,000k N
x'
What is the recfrmyulur cornporrenr along an axis A ~ Aequally
inclincd tu thc positive x, s, and :axes? Figure P.2.62

46
SECTION 2.8 CROSS PRODUCT OF TWO VECTORS 47

2.8 Cross Product of N o Vectors


There are interactions between vector quantities that result in vector quanti-
ties. One such interaction is the moment of a force, which involves a special
product of the force and a position vector (to he studied in Chapter 3). To set
up a convenient operation for these situations, the vecfor cross product has
been established. For the two vectors (having possibly different dimensions)
shown in Fig. 2.25 as A and B , the operation" is defined as
A X B = C (2.21)
where C has a magnitude that is given as
IC1 = IAI lB1 sin a (2.22)

Figure 2.25. A x B = C.

The angle a is the smaller of the two angles between the vectors, thus making
sin a always positive. The vector C has an orientation normal to the plane of
the vectors A and B . The sense, furthermore, corresponds to the advance of a
right-hand screw rotated about C as an axis while turning from A to B
through a-that is, from the first stated vector to the second stated vector
through the smaller angle between them. In Fig. 2.25, the screw would
advance upward in rotating from A to B, whether the procedure is viewed
from above or below the plane formed by A and B. The reader can easily ver-
ify this. The description of vector C is now complete, since the magnitude
and direction are fully established. The line of action of C is not determined
by the cross product; it depends on the use of the vector C.
Again we remind you that the cross product, like the other vector alge-
braic operations, does not involve lines of action, so in taking a cross product
we can move the vectors so as to come together at their tails as in Fig. 2.25.
As in the previous case, the coefficients of the vectors will multiply as
ordinary scalars. This may he deduced from the nature of the definition.
However, the commutative law breaks down for this product. We can verify,
by carefully considering the definition of the cross product, that
(A X B ) = -(B X A) (2.23)

"Again, we urge you to read A X B = Cas "A crossed into B yields C.'
48 CHAPTER 2 EI.EMENTS OF VECTOR AI.GERRA

P We can readily show that the cross product, like the dot product. is a
distributive operation. To do this, consider in Fig. 2.26 il prism mniipqr with
edges coinciding with the vectors A , H , C, and (A + B ) . We can represent
the area of each face of the prism as a vector whose inngnitude equals the
area o l the face and whose direction is norm;~lto the face with a sense point-
, ing out (by convention) from thc body. It will be left to the student to justil'y
the given formulation for each of the vectors in Fig. 2.27. Since the prism is a
closed surface, the net projected area in any direclion must be zero, and this.
in turn, means that the total arm \sector must he zero. We then gct
it (A + B) X C + $A X B + 4B X A + C X A + C X H = 0
Figure 2.26. Prim using A , B, and C.

Figure 2.27. Area vzctorc tor prism f i c m

Noting that the second and third expressions cancel each olher. we get. 011
rearranging the terms.
C X (A+B)=C X A + C X B (2.24)
We have thus demonstrated the di,stributiw property of the cross product.
Next. consider the cross product of rccliinpular unit vectors. Here, the
product of equal vector5 is zero hecause a and. consequently. sin CY are iero.
The product i X j is unity i n magnitude. and hccnusc (if h e right-hand-screw
rule must he parallel 111 the :axis. If the :a x i s has been erected in a seiise con-

Istt-hand triad

/
Ki@t~handtriad ixj=-k

(ill (hi
Figure 2.28. Diffcrent kinds of rcfcrcnccs.
AA A v A:
B.\ By 4 (2.26)
i j k

(2.27)

For the products along the dashed diagonals, we must remember in this
method tu multiply by -I. We then add all six products as follows:
A , B > k + H,A,j + A,B:i - A ; B , i - B,A,j - A,B,k
= ( A , B - A$, ) i + (A,B, - A,B;)j + (A,B, - A,B,)k
Clearly, this is the same result as in Eq. 2.25. It must be cautioned that this
method of evaluating a determinant is correct only for 3 x 3 determinants. If
the cross product of two vectors involves less than six nonzero components,
such as in the cross product
( 6 i + lOj) X ( 5 j - 3 k )
then it is advisable to multiply the components directly and collect terms, as
in Eq. 2.25.
Example 2.6
A pyramid i s shown i n Fig. 2.30. If the height of the pyramid i s 300 I t .
find the angle brtweeii the outward n(irnia1s ti1 planes A D B and HIlC."
We sliall first find the unit normals to the aforesteted planes. Then.
using lhc dot product between these normals. we can easily find the
desircd angle.
To get thc unit normal n I lo plane A B D , we Sirst coinpulc the area
,
vectorA for this plane. Thus. from simple trigiinomelry and the delinition
o f the cross priiduct.

A,=;A%xA%
/ A 100' H
N11k next that
Figure 2.30. Pyramid.
"G = l00j ft
-
Furthcrmiire. we cai cxprcss A D i n rcctangular components by moving
lrom A tii I)along coordiiiatc directions as f ~ i l l i i w s :

A% = S O j - 5Oi + 300k f t
Hcnce.

A, = i (I 00j ) x (-5Oi + soj + 3nok )


= 15,oooi + 2.S00k ft?
Accordingly

A I - 1 ~ , 0 0 0+i 2,sook ~~~

1 ,
"I =
~~

(a)
IA, 15,0002 + 2.5002
= .c)X64i t . lh44k

A h for unit n(iriiiiil ti2 corresponding Lo plane UIlC, whohe arm vectiir we
denote as A ,. w e havc

A,. = .~ 7x .n7,
Niitc chat

2 -I OOi I t
=

And once again. moving along coordinate directions. we have for B D


-
871 = -SOj -- SOi + 300k ft
SECTION 2.9 SCALAR TRIPLE PRODUCT 51

Example 2.6 (Continued)


Hence,
A, = &(-1OOi) x (-50; - 5 0 j + 300k)
= I5,OOOj + 2,500k ft2
Accordingly,
4 - I5,000j+2,500k
n -----
2 -
lA21 115,0002+ 2,5W2
= .9864j + .1644k
Now, we use the dot product of n, and n2. Thus,
n, n2 = cos /3 (C)
where p is the angle between the normals to the planes. Substituting from
Eqs. (a) and (b) into (c), we get
cos p = ,0270
Therefore,

We see from this example that a plane surface can be represented as a vector,
and if that plane surface i s part of a closed surface, by convention the area
vector is in the direction of the outward normal.

2.9 Scalar miple Product


A very useful quantity is the scalar triple product, which for a set of vectors
A , B , and C is defined as
(A x B) * C (2.28)
This clearly is a scalar quantity.
A simple geometric meaning can be associated with this operation. In
Fig. 2.3 I , we have shown A . E , and C as an arbitrary set of concurrent vec-
tors. We have set up an xyz reference such that the A and B vectors are in the
xy plime. Further, a parallelogram abcd in the xy p k n e is shown in the dia-
gram. We can say that
IA X Bl = IAI lB1 sin a = area of ahcd
, /' _;11111-1
Figure 2.31. A and R in p planc.

Using thi.; gemictrical iiitzrpretati(in (if the \ c a l x triplc pr(iduct. the


reader can e x i l y conclude that

(A x R ) * C = ~ (A X C) B = ~ (C X B) * A (2.29)
Thc computation 01 ihe scalar lriple pmduct i s a very s m i ~ h t h r w i ~ r d
pi-ocess. It will he left iis an cxercise (Prohleni 2.72) for you to demonstrate that
I
,A, As A~
( A X H ) - C = 13~ 19> n~ (2.30)
C.) C> C<

I n liiler chapters. we shall einploy the svalar triple product. although wc chall not
alwayh want 10 associate ihc preceding gcomclric inteq~reltationof this prodticl.
Another opcration involvinz thrcc vectors i s ~ l l cI
defined Ihr vectors A . B. and C a s A x ( B x C).Thc vector triple product
i s a vector quantity and w i l l appear quitc o l t c n i n sttidier oidynamics. It w i l l
be left h r you lo demonstrate that

A X (B X C ) = R(A * C ) - C(A * B ) (2.11)


Notice here that the vector triple product can he carried oi11by uhing only dot
products.
SECTION 2.9 SCALAR TRIPLE PRODUCT 53

Example 2.7
In Example 2.6, what is the area projected by plane ADE onto an infinite
plane that is inclined equally to the x, y , and z axes?
The normal n to the infinite plane must have three equal direction
cosines. Hence, noting Eq. 2.20 for the sum of the squares of a set of direc-
tion cosines, we can say that

Therefore

Hence,

The projected area then is given as

A,, = (; A ~ Ix -
AZ) n
= [ $ ( - 5 O i + 5 0 j + 3 0 0 k ) x ( - I O O i ) ] *. 3- L ( i +j + k )

The preceding result is a scalar triple product that can readily be solved as
follows (disregarding the final sign):
2.10 A Note on Vector Notation
When expressing ryirations. we must at all times clearly denote sciilar and
vectoi- qiiaiititics ;ind hmdlc them ;iccordingIy. When ire simply identify-
ing quantities i n il di.scu.s.sioii or i n a rliugi-(irrm. however, instead of using the
vector reprcscntation. I;. we can .just LISZ I.. On the other hand. / ~w ' i l l be
undcrstiiiid to rcprcscnt i n ;in equatioii the magnitude o l the vector F . Thu,
using f i n thc itnit \'cctor in the direcIion of I>.w e can then say:
F = /'f
= b'lcos (I;. r)i + cos tF. ! ) j + co\ ( F , : ) k ]

A \ another exaniplc. wc might wiiiit to employ the lorcc F, which i s shown in


the coplanar diagr;im o f Fig. 2.32ia) al a k n ~ i w i i i i c l i n a l i ~ nand acting a1 a
point (1. A correct representation o l this Iiirce i n a vector equation would he
I.(-cos ai + sin aj).
As for \ c a l x components 01 a n y vecfor 1:. we shall adopt the following
understanding. The Iiotiltim t';,h i , or t'; labeling s o m e vector component i n a
r/iu,y,-rinrw i l l hc undcrsloiid to rcprcscnt the niu,yi~ii~ide o f that particular c o n -
ponent. Thus, in Fig. 2.32(b) the two ctimponcnLs shown arc cqual in magni-
tude hut opposite i n sense. Ncvcrtheless. thcy xrc both Iahclcd F,. H11wever.
i n an cquetion inviilving these quantities. thc scnsc must propcrly he
accounted for by the appropriatc usc o f signs.
2.63. If A = I O i + hj - 3k and B = 6i,find A x B and B 2.69. If the coordinates of vertex E of the inclined pyramid are
x A . What is the magnitude of the resulting vector'! What are its ( 5 , SO, 80) m, what is the angle between Outward normals to faces
direction cosines relative to the xyz reference in which A and B A L E and BCE!
are expressed?
2.64. What are the cross and dot products for the vectors A and
B given as: E
A = 6 i + 3 j + 4k
B = Ri 3j + 2k? ~

2.65. If vectors A and B in the xy plane have a dot product of SO


units, and if the magnitudes of these vectors are I O units and R
units, respectively. what is A x B !
-
2.66. (a) If A * B = A B'. does B necessarily equal E'?
Explain.
(b) If A X B = A X E , does B necessarily equal B"! Y
Explain.
2.67. What is the cross product of the displacement vector from
A to B times the displacement vector from C to D'!
X

I Figure P.2.69
2.70. In Prvblem 2.69, what is the area of face ADE of the p y m
C
mid? What is the projection of the area of face ADE onto a p l a ~
whose normal is along the direction 6 where:
X'
~ = O . h i- 0.Rj

2.71. (a) Compute the product

/ (A X B) - C

Figure P.2.67 in terms of onhogonal components.


2.68. Making use of the cross product, give the unit vector n (b) Compute (C X A ) B and compare with the result in
normal to thc inclined surface ABC. part (a).
2.72. Compute the determinant
I

Ar Ay A:
B, gv B:
c1 cy c:
where each row represents, respectively, the scalar components of
A , B , and C. Compare the result with the computation of ( A x B )
C by using the dot-product and crowproduct operations.

2.73. In Example 2.5, what is the area vector for GAB assuming
/ a straight line connects points A and E ! Give the results in kilo-
Figure P.2.68 meters squared.
Fixure P.2.71

2.11 Closure

Check-Oulfor Sections with t


2.1 What i s meant by thc n i u p i t ~ o~ fka vector? What sign iiwst i t hauc'?
2.2 Can you multiply a vector C by ii sciilar s ? If so, dcscribc the rcsull.
2.3 What are the Im, o f u m i w s and the law qfsiiirs'?
2.4 What i s nicaiil by the <rs.w(.iariwlaw of addition'?
2.5 Describe two ways to add ;my three vectors graphically.
2.6 How do you subtract vector D Srom vector F'?
2.7 Given a vector D , how would you forni a m i t vector collinear with D'!
2.8 What are the cciiliir equations 01 thc following vector equation'?
Di + E,j - Ihk = 20i + iI S + G)k
2.78. Flight 304 from Dallas is tlying NE to Chicago XJU miles
away. To avoid a niilssive storm Srvnt, the pilot decides instead to
Ily due north to Topcka, Kansas, and then ENE (see Fig. P.2.4 f i x
compass settings) to Chicago. What are the distances that he must
travel from Dallas to Topeka and from Topeka ti) Chicago'!

N
Chicago

Figure P.2.80

2.81. Cuntractori encountered an irnpasiahle swnmp while build-


inp a road from town T to city C SO kin SE. To avoid the swamp,
45" they built the road SSW from T and thcrr ENE to C. How long is
E the road? ( H i m : See the compass-settings diagram, Fig. P.2.4.)
Dallas
Figure P.2.78
2.82. Sum all forces acting on the block. Plane A is parallel to
the .r.v plane. We will later m d y the special properties of two par-
allel forces (called a c o u p k ) that are opposile in direction atid
2.79. What is thc cross product between the 1,000-N force and in magnitude'
the diiplaccrnent vector p,,,"'?

.
//" (3.4, - 2 )
I,11011 N
-y

Figure P.2.79

Figure P.2.82

2.80. Four member, of a space frame are loaded as shown. What


are the orthogunill scalar components of the forces on the ball 2.83. The r and I compunsnti of the force F arc known tu be
joint at O?l h e 1,000-N force goes thmugh points D and E of the 100 Ih and -311 Ib, respectively. What i q thc f k c F and what are
rectangular p;irallelepiped. its direction cosincc"

SI
,
400 Ib 500 Ib with a speed of 100 d s e c . What are the force components on the
electron'? The charge of the electron is l.hOlX x coulombs.

s
n

heirht iof point A'?


Figure P.2.89
2.90. A skeet shooter is aiming his gun at point A . What is the
L. Figure P.2.92
7

.
A(2,15,z)m 2.93. For the line segment A X , determine
cosines m and n.
zx and direction

Figure P.2.90 ?--/

2.91. If F, and the 5 W N force sum vectorially to FT, determine /


F, and F,
Figure P.2.93
2.94. Using the scalar triple product, find the area projected onto
the d a n e N from the surface ABC. Plane N is infinite and is nor-
mal to the vector
r = 50i + 40j + 30k ft

500 N

Figure P.2.91
2.92. The force on a charge moving through a magnetic field B
is given as
F = ~ V X B A Y

where q = inagnitude of the charge, coulombs x


F = force on the hody, newtons Figure P.2.94
V = velocity vector of the pafiicle. meters per second
2.95. A 500-lh crate is held up by three forces. Clearly the three
B = magnetic flux density. webers per meter2
forces should add up to a force of 500 Ib going upward. What
Suppose that an electron moves through a uniform magnetic field should forces F , and F, he for this condition'? All forces are
of IO" Wh/mz in a direction inclined 30' to the field, as shown, coplanar (in the same plane).

59 I
!hl Il a hze-bee gun i s to sliont down thc ballowi, a s s u n -
2.100. What i s thc anglr S hclwccn r and the displaccmcnt
ing i t is morncnlarily slali<mary ill C. what arc thc
"CCtOl p,,,,.!
direction corinrs ol the prupcr lint. r i f sight?

Figure P.2.96 Figire P.2.100

60
Important
Vector
Quantities z

3.1 Position Vector


In this chapter, we shall discuss a number of useful vector quantities. Con-
sider first the path of motion of a particle shown dashed in Fig. 3.1. As indi-
cated in Chapter I, the di,splacemenr vecfor p is a directed line segment
connecting any two points on the path of motion, such as points I and 2 in
Fig. 3.1. The displacement vector thus represents the shortest movement of
the panicle to get from one position on the path of motion to another. The Figure 3.1. Displacement vector p
purpose of the rectangular parallelepiped shown in the diagram is to convey hetween points 1 and 2.
the magnitude and direction of p as explained earlier. We can readily express

)/;
p between points I and 2 in terms of rectangular components by noting
the distance in the coordinate directions needed to go from I to 2. Thus, in
Fig. 3.1, p l r = - 2i + 6 j + 3k m.
The directed line segment r from the origin of a coordinate system to a

y"
point P in space (Fig. 3.2) is called the position vector. The notations R and p
are also used for position vectors. You can conclude from Chapter 2 that the . o j Y
x
magnitude of the position vector is the distance between lhe origin 0 and
x
point P. The scalar components of a position vector are simply the coordi-
Figure 3.2. Position vector.
nates of the point P. To express r in Cartesian components, we then have

r = xi + y j + zk (3.1) __---
We can obviously express a displacement vector p between points 1
and 2 (see Fig. 3.3) in terms of position vectors for points 1 and 2 (Le., r , and
r2)as follows:
__
p = r? - r , = (x2 ~ x,)i + cy2 ~ y,)j + (z, - z,jk (3.2)

Figure 3.3. Relation hetween a


displacement vector and position
Yectors.
61
62 ("AFTER 3 IMI'ORTANT VECTOR QUANTITIES

Example 3.1
T w o bets ul' refercnces. .YK and XYZ. arc shown in Fig. 3.4. The position
vector o l the origin 0 o l r y : rclative to XYZ is given as
R = IOi + 6j + Sk m (a)
The position vector. r'. i f a point P relative til XY7 is
r' = 3i + 2.1 - hk m (h)
What is the position vector r of point 'f relative ti1 .v?i? What arc the coor-
dinates .I,y. and iof I"?
From Fig. 3.4. i l is clear that
r ' = K + r IC1

Therefore.
r = r' -- R = (3i + Zj - 6k) - (IOi + hJ + Sk)
r =-7iL4j- Ilkm I4

We can then conclude that


' X
x = -7m
Figure 3.4. Refercnccs .q; and X ) %
y = -4m (c) scpamtcd hy position vector it.
z = -11 m

t" 3.2 Moment of a Force About a Point


Case A. For Simple Cases. The moment of a force about a point 0 (see
Fig. 3.5). you will recall from physics, is a vector M whose magnitude equals
the product of the force magnitude times the perpendicular distance d from 0 to
the line of action of the force. And the direction of this vector is perpendicular to
the plane of the point and the force, with a sense determined from the familiar
right-hand-screw rule.' The line of action of M is determined by the prohlem at
hand. In Fig. 3.5, the line of action of M i s taken for simplicity through point 0.

Case B. For Complex Cases. Another apprwach is to employ a position


vcctcir r from point 0 to nnypoinf P along the line ol'action of force F as shown
Figure 3.5 Moment 0 1 force F nhoul 0 is F d in Fig. 3.6. The nioment M of F about point 0 will he shown to he given as1

M = r x F (3.3)
SECTION 3.2 MOMENT OF A FORCE ABOUT A POINT 63

For the purpose of forming the cross product, the vectors in Fig. 3.6 can he
moved to the configuration shown in Fig. 3.7. Then the cross product between
r and F obviously has the magnitude
lr X FI = /rl IF\ sin a = IF1 lrl sin p = IF1 r sin fi = Fd
where r sin fi = d, the perpendicular distance from 0 to the line of action of
F , as can readily he seen in Fig. 3.7. Thus, we get the same magnitude of M
as with the elementary definition. Also, note that the direction of M here is
identical to that of the elementary definition. Thus we have the same result as
for the elementary definition in all pertinent respects. We shall use either of
these formulations depending on the situation at hand.
Figure 3.6. Put r from 0 to any point along
the line of action of F .
The first of these formulations will he used generally for cases where
the force and point are in a convenient plane, and where the perpendicular
distance between the point and the line of action of the force is easily mea-
sured. As an example, we have shown in Fig. 3.8 a system of coplanar forces
acting on a beam. The moment of the forces about point A is thenZ
MA = -(5)(1,000).4 - (4)(600)k + (11)R,k ft-lb
= ( I IR, - 7,400)k ft-lb

x
Figure 3.7. Move vector r end F

Figure 3.8. Coplanar forces on a beam


For a coplanar force system such as this, we may simply give the scalar form
of the equation above, as follows:
MA = IIR, - 7,400ft-lh
The second formulation of the moment ahout a point, namely r X F ,
is used for complicated coplanar cases and for three-dimensional cases. We
shall illustrate such a case in Example 3.2 after we discuss the rectangular
components of M.
Consider next a system of n concurrent forces in Fig. 3.9 whose total
moment ahout point 0 (where we have established reference xyz) is desired.
We can say that
M=M, +M,+M,+...+Mn
= r x F , + r x F , + r X F , (3.5)
+ . . . + r x F,
‘Please nole that we still use lhe right-hand-screw rule in determining Ihe signs of the
respective moment% Figure 3.9. Concurrent forces
Now. hecause (if the distrihutive pixipei-ty of the c r w s product. Eq. 3.5 can
he bvrittcn

M = r X (6+ F, + F3 + . . . + I;,,) (3.61


Wc ciin conclude iriiiii the preceding eqiiatioiis that thc s u m of the minimits
ahout it point of a system of concurrent fixcss i s the same iis ihc ~iionicnt
ahout tlic point of the \uni 01 rhc force^. l h i r i-esul~i s kiiinvn iis \'uri,qmm'v
I/i('ofwi~.which y>um a y UCIIreciill Srofii physics.
Ax ii hpccial ca\c of Varigniin's thcorcni, we inay find i t convenient io
deconipose a iorcc F inti1 i h rcclangular ciimpiincnts (Vi;. 1. IO). and tticn t o
iise these coniponents ior taking iiioiiieiits ahwt ;I point. Wc cim Ihrn s;ly that

M = r x F = r x (P;i + /I./ + Fk) (3.7)


SECTION 3.2 MOMENTS OF FORCE ABOUT A POINT 65

Example 3.2
Determine the moment of the 100-lb force F , shown in Fig. 3.11, about
points A and E , respectively.
As a first step, let us express force F vectorially. Note that the force
is collinear with the vector pljEfrom D,, to E, where
pllK= Xi + 4 j - 4k
To get a unit vectorp in the direction of P , , ~ .we proceed as follows:
P,], - Xi + 4 j - 4k
= (b)
lPDE/ is2 + 4 2 + 4 2
~

Figure 3.11. Find moments at A and 8.


= .X16i + .408j - .408k

We can then express the force F in the following manner:


F=I.'pf,,=(100)(.816i+.408j-.40Xk)
=81.6;+40.Xj-40.8k (c)
To get the moment MAabout point A , we choose a position vector
from point A to point D which is on the line of action of force F. Thus, we
have, for cn,
G~~= IOi + 4 j - Xk ft (d)

=I%
and for MA,we than get
MA = r A , , X F = ( 1 0 i + 4 j - 8 k ) X
,
(81.6it40.8j-40.8k)

-
m,
W.6 40.8 - .
= (10)(40.8)k + (Xl.6)(-8)j + (4)(-40.8)i
-(-8)(40.8)i - ( 4 0 . 8 ) ( 1 0 ) j- (4)(81.6)k

Therefore.
MA = 163.21 - 245j + X1.6k ft-lh (e)
As tor the moment about reference point E , we employ the position
vector rBI, from B to position D,again on the line of action of force F.
Thus, we have
rHfj= 4j - Xk ft
Accordingly,
M, = rHIl x F = (4j - Xk) x (81.6i + 40.Xj - 40.8k)
= (4)(81.6)(-k) + (4)(-40.8)(i) + (-X)(XI,6)(j) + (-X)(40.8)(-;) (t)

MB = 163.23 - 653j - 326k fklb


3.1. What is thc position v e c t ~ r from the origin (0, 0, 01 to the 3.7. A particle mmes along ii circular path in the xy plane. What
poinl (3, 4, 5 ) ft'! What are its magnitude and direction cosines? is the position vector r of this p;irticle as ii function of the wordi.
nxte r"
3.2. What is the displacement vector from position 16. 13, 71 ft
to position ( I O , --3, 4) ft'? I

3.3. A surveyor determines that the top 0 1 a radir, transmission


I
tower is at position r, = (1,OOOi + I,OOOj + 1,000k) m relillivc
:(I her position. Similarly. the top of a sccond tower is locatcd hy
5 = (2,000i+ 500j + 700k) m. What is the distance hetwcen
.he two tower tops?

3.4. Reference XJZ is rotated 30" counterclockwise about its ~i


rxis to form reference XYZ. What is the position vector r for refer-
:nce xyz of a point having a position V C C ~ O Ir' h r rcfcrencc X Y 7
:iven as
r' = hi' + 107 + 3k' m? Figure P.3.7.

3sc i , j , and k (no primes) lor unit vectorb auaciatcd with refer- 3.8. A particle moves along a paraholic path i n thc i;plane. If the
:nce 1y7. particle has a1 ow point n pmition vrctiii r = 4 j + Zk, give the
piisition ~ c c t oa1
i ~any point on Ihe path i i i ii fimotion of Ihr :c o w
1.5. Find the momcnt of thc SO-lb forcc ahout the support at A din;ilc.
ind a h w l support A of the simply supported hzam.
v

-
)---
61)'-
100'----t
Fieure P.3.S.
1.6. Find the moment of the two lorces first ahout point A and
hen ahout point R.
(a) Do not u s e r X F fbrmat-only scalar prodncts.
(h) lJsc vector approach.
Figure P.3.8.

I,OOO N 3.9. An nnillery spotter on Hill 350 (350 rn high) eqimiltes the
posirioii o i an cncmy tnnk as 3.000 m NE of him at a n C I c v a t i m
200 m helow hi? position. A 105-nim howmer unil with n range
x of I1.(100 m i s 10,1100 m doc south oltht. spotter. and il 155-mm
h o w i t m unit with a rangu of 1.000 m is 11,001) m SSE o l t h r
spottcr (rce Fig. P.2.41. Both gun units are located at an elevation
-2m---,
OS 150 111. Can eillirr o r hoth gun unit, hit thc tank, o r r m w t an air
mike be callcd in?
Figure P.3.h.
3.10. Find the moment of the forces about points A and B . 3.13. The total equivalent forces from water and gravity are
(a) Use scalar approach. shown on the dam. (We will soon be able to compute such equiv-
(b) Use vector approach. alents.) Compute the mnment of these forces about the toe of the
dam in the right-hand comer.

(Asrume a11 forces

+ L -kI
8’
‘Toe

Figure P.3.13.
3.14. In an underwater “village” for research. an American flag
is in place as shown. It is of plastic material and can rotate so as to
be oriented parallel to the flow of water. A uniform friction force
distribution from the flow is present on both faces of the flag hav-
ing the value of 10 N per square meter. Also the flagpole has a
uniform force from the flow of 20 N per meter of length of the
flagpole. Finally there is an upward buoyant force on the flag of
Figure P.3.10.
30 N and on the flagpole of 8 N. What is the moment vector of
3.11. The crew of a submarine patrol plane, with three-dimen- these forces at the base of the flagpole?
sional radar, sights a surfaced submarine 10,000 yards north and
5,000 yards east while flying at an elevation of 3,000 ft above sea
level. Where should the pilot insmct a second patrol plane flying
at an elevation of 4.000 ft at a position 40,000 yards east of the
first plane to look for confirmation of the sighting?
3.12. A power company lineman can comfortably trim branches
I m from his waist at an angle of 45” above the horizontal. His
waist coincides with the pivot of the work capsule. How high a
branch can he trim if the maximum elevation angle of the arm is
75“ and the maximum extended length is 12 m? Figure P.3.14.
3.15. Three transmission lines are placed unsymmetrically on a
power-line pole. For each pole, the weight of a single line when cov-
ered with ice is 2,ooO N. What is the moment at the base of a pole?

1.5 m
Figure P.3.12. Figure P.3.15.

67
3.22. What i\ the moment of a IO-lh I w c e F directed ;ilonf lhe
3.17. A truck-mounted crane has a 20-m hrxnn inclincd a1 60" to
di:igmaI of a cuhr ahout thc c ~ m c nof the cuhc'! 'The sidc 01 thc
the horizontal. What i \ the moment ahout the honm pi\ot due t o a
w h c i s (i I t .
liftcd wcight of 30 k N ? Do hy vector and hy scilliii~methodi.

Figure P.3.22.
3.23. Three guy wires are used in the suppon syslem lor a trle-
\ i s i o n transmicrion towcr that i\ h0O m tall. Wircb A and R arc
tiphtcnrd t o a tzmion o f hO LN. whereit\ w,irc C has iinly 30 kN 01
Figure P.3.17. t c m i o n What i s thr nomrnt 01 h e wire I w c v a h w l the hax 0
o f lhe tower'i Thc y :,xi\ i': ciillincar with A O .
3.18. A small hlirnp i s lempr,l-arily mrxrred
as shown in the d i i i -
gram wherein / I C and the centerline of AH arc coplanar. A
force F from wind, weight. and buoyancy i s shown ;sling ill Ihc I
centerline of the hlirnp. It

F = 5i + l l j + IXk kN
what are the moment w c t m from F ahwt A . N. and c?

I
hi1 111

Figure P.3.18. F i p r e P.3.23.

68
3.24. Cables CD and AB help support member ED and the
I ,000-lb load at D. At E there is a ball-and-socket joint which also
supports the member. Denoting the forces from the cables as Fer,
and FAB. respectively, compute moments of the three forces about
point E . Plane EGD is perpendicular to the wall. Get results in
terms of Fro and T,r

Figure P.3.24.

3.3 Moment of a Force About an Axis


Case A. For Simple Cases. By means of a simple situation, we shall
set forth a definition of the moment of a force about an axis. Suppose that a
disc I s mounted on a shaft that is free to rotate in a set of bearings, as shown in
Fig. 1.12. A force F, inclined to the plane A of the disc, acts on the disc. We
decompose the force into two coplanar rectangular components, one normal to
plane A of the disc and one tangent to plane A of the disc, that is, into forces FB
and 5, respectively, so as to form a plane shown tinted, normal to plane A.

Figure 3.12. 5 turns disc


We low )m experience that Fs does not cause : disc rota1
know from physics and intuition that the rotational motion of the disc is

69
70 CHAPTER 3 IMPORTANT VEC'TOR Ol~\Wl'l'llliS

delermincd by the product (if F;1 and the perpendicular distance d I m m the
centerline (ifthe shaft to the line of action of F4. You w i l l remember from
physics, this product i s nothing more than tlie mmncnt 01. force F ahout the
axis (if the shaft. We sliall next generalire from this simple case tn the general
case o f taking Ihc moment d'un\. force F ahout ow? axis.
T o compute the moment (or tnrque) of a force F i n a planc perpendicular
to plane A ahout an axis B-B (Fig. 3.13). we pass any plane A perpendicular to
the axis. This plane cuts i3-R a1 (I and thc line of action of forcc Fat some poini
P. 'The fnrce F i s then pro.jectcd to fomi a reclmgular component r;,
along ii
line at P normal 10 plane A and tliiis parallel tu R-B. a s shown in the diagram.
'The intersection of plane A with lhe plane of Snrceh F,$ and F (the latter plane i h
shown shaded and i h a plane throush F and pcrpeiidicular to plane A ) sives ;I
H
' direction C-C along which the other rcclangular component of I.: denoted :is ti.
can he projected." The moment of F about the line 8 - ~ Bi s then defined as the
scalar reprcsentation of the mnment of lj ahout point ( I with a inagnitude equal
to <</--a prcihlcni discussed a1 the heginning OS the previous section (Case A).
Figure 3.13. F(1rmula% the mOll1ellt Thus in accordance wilh the definition, the component kjr which i s parallel to
ahout an axis R -8.
the axis 11-8. contributes 110 moment about the iixis, and wc may say:
Mnment ahout a x i s B-H = l<)ldl = (cos a ) ( d )
with nn appropriate sign. The moment about an a x i s clrarly i s a scalar. evcn
though this niomcnt i s associated with a particulx axis that has ii distinct
direction. 'The situation i s the same as it i s with the scalar components V,, V,.
v, etc.. which arc associated with certain directinns but which are scalar\.
The reader will he quick to noLe that Fig. 3.13 reprchents ii generalization (it
Fig. 3.12 having an axis H-B. a plane A normal to this axis and fillally an
arhitrary force E To explain further. we have redrawn Fig. 3.13 Isec Fig.
3.14Ia)l showing only plane A , axes R-R and C-C, and the force I;. In Fig.
3.14(h), we have also included the moment vector M . This latter diagram then
takes us back Lo Fig. 3.5 where wc first defined the moment vector o f '.I 1.nrce
ahout a point i n a most simple manner. Accordingly, we note, nn the cine
hand. for the moment ahout point (I [scc Fig. 3.14(b)], we can get the vector
M , whereas 011 the other hand i n Fig. 3.I4la) we can get the scalar iiiomciit M
ahout an axis B-8 at point n and perpendicular to planc A . Thus, by taking the
scalar value o f M in Fig. 3.14(b), wc get the moment about the a x i s at puint ( I
normal t o plane A as formulated in the development of Fig. 3. 13.

Figure 3.14. Comparison of Figs. 3.13 and 3.5.


SECTION 3.3 MOMENT OF A FORCE ABOLIT AN AXIS 71

We can thus conclude, on considering Fig. 3.15. that the moment of F


about point C can be considered in two ways as follows:

Figure 3.15. Consideration of the moment


of F about point A .

Before continuing, we wish to point out that 4 in Fig. 3.13 can be


decomposed into pairs of components in plane A . From Varignon's theorem
we can employ these components instead of 6 in computing the moment
about the B--B axis. For each force component, we multiply the force times
the perpendicular distance from a to the line of action of the force component
using the right-hand-screw rule to determine the sense and thus the sign.

Case B. For Complex Cases. When we discussed the moment of a


force about apoint, we presented a formulation useful for simple cases (i.e., a
vector of magnitude Fd) as well as a more powerful formulation that would
be needed fix more complex situations (Le., r x F ) . Thus far, for moments
about an axis, we have presented a formulation Fd that is useful for simple
cases? and now we shall present a formulation that is needed for more com-
plex cases. For this purpose, we have redrawn Fig. 13.13 as Fig. 13.16(d). In
Fig. 13.16(b), we have shown axis B-B of Fig. 13.16(a) as a n n axis and have
set up coordinate axes y and z at any point 0 anywhere on axis B-B. The
coordinate distances x, y . and z for the point P are shown for this reference.
The position vector r to P is also shown. The force component FH of Fig.
3.16(a) now becomes force component F,. And, instead of using we shall FA,
<.
decompose it into components and 4 in plane A as shown in Fig. 3.16(b).
We now compute the moment about the x axis for force F using this
new arrangement which does not require F to be in a plane perpendicular
to plane A . Clearly, F, contributes no moment, as before. The force components
<. and 5 are in plane A that is perpendicular to the axis of interest and so,
as before in the case of 5,we multiply each of these forces by the perpendicu-
lar distance of point a to the respective lines of action of these forces.

'That is. for cases where the force and point in question are in a plane easily seen to he nor^
mal to the ru-is in question. thus allowing for an easy determination of the perpendicular distance
between the point and the line of action of the force.
72 CHAPTER 3 IMPORTANT VECTOR amNri-riEs

For Sorce t;. this pcrpcndicular distance i s clc;irly x. a h can rcadily be


the diagmni, and, lor force E ; , this perpendiculx distance i s :. Using the right-
hand-scrcw rule fiir :isccrt;iining llic sense oleach o i the momenls. wc: can say:
ahout~raxis=
~ii~iiieiit IxF - :.f< j (3.10)
Were we to hikc m o m e n t s OFF ahout the origio 0, wc \vould get (scc Eq. 1.8)

M=M,i+M,j+M:k=rx F
= IyF - :F:)i + iC1.i - xF;),j + (.r/,; - yF\;,)h (3.1 I )

Comparing Eqs. 3.10 arid 3.1 I. wc ciin conclude that tlie iiioiiieiil about the .I
axis i s simply M , . 1he.v coiiilionent o l M about 0.We ciin thus concludi: that the
moment about the .v axis 01the Iilrce F is ihc component i n the .\ direction of the

/'
+~/ , "
moment 0 1 F about a point 0 positioned m ~ w l w r calong
moment ;ihout 1 axis 7 M, = M,,
, the Iaxis, T ~is. I

- i = (r X

We may generali/e tlie preceding discussion iis Iollows. Consider iiii arbitral-y
axis ii-ii to which we have ;is\igned a unit vector 11 (Fig. 3.17). An uhitrary
F) * i (1.12)

force I; i\ a l m shown. 'lo gut the iiioiiicnl M,, of I'orcc F ahout axis 11-PI. \e
Figure 3.17. M,,= ir X F ) * 12. clioosc any point 0 along 11-11. Then draw ii p o s i t h i vector r Iron1 point 0 to
any point dong Ihc line 01; d u n of F . Thih h a been shown i n [he diagraiii.
We can then hay. fironi our prcvious discussion.

M,,= (r X I;) - n
(3.13)
SECTION 3.3 MOMENT OF A FORCE ABOUT AN AXIS 13

(Notice from Eqs. 3.12 and 3.13 that the moment of a force about an axis
involves a scalar triple product.) Equation 3.13 stipulates in words that:

The moment of a force about an axis equak the scalar component in the
direction qf the axis of the m m e n f vector taken about any point along
the axis.

This is lhe more powerful formulation that can he used for complex cases.

Note that the unit vector n c d n have two opposite senses along the axis n,
in contrast to the usual unit vectors i, j, and k associated with the coordinate
axes. A moment M,, about the n axis determined from M * n has a sense con-
sistent with the sense chosen for n. Thdt is, a positive moment M,, has a sense
corresponding to that of n, and a negative moment M,, has a sense opposite to
that o f n . If the opposite sense had been chosen for n, the sign of M n would
be opposite to that found in the first case. However, the same physical moment
is obtained i n both cases.
If we specify the moments of a force about three orthogonal concurrent
axes, we then single out one possible point in space for 0 along the axes.
Point 0,of course. is the origin of the axes. These three moments about
orthogonal axes then become the orthogonal scalar components of the
moment of I; about point 0, and we can say:
M = (moment about the x axis)i +
(moment about they axislj + (3.14)
(moment about the z axis)k = M,i + MJ + M:k
From this relation, we can conclude that:

The three orthogonal components ojthe moment of a force about a point


are the muments of this force about the three o e
the point as a n origin.

You may now ask what the physical differences are in applications of
monients about an axis and moments about a point. The simplest example is
in the dynamics of rigid bodies. If a body is constrained so it can only spin
about its axis, as in Fig. 3.12, the rotary motion will depend on the moment of
the lorces about the axis of rotation. as related by a scalar equation. The less
familiar concept of moment about a point is illustrated in the motion of bod-
ies that have n o constrhints, such as missiles and rockets. In these cases, the
rotationiil motion of the body is related by a vector equation to the moment of
forces acting on the body about a point called the center ofmass. (The center
of mass will he defined completely later.)
14 CHAPTER 3 IMPORTANT VECTOR QUANTITI~S

Example 3.3
Coinpiitc the moment of a force F = 1Oi +
hj N. which gocs through
po5ition cz = 2 i + 6.j in (see Fig. 3.181, about a line going through points
I and 2 having the respective position vectors i!
I
rl = hi + I O j - i k in
r, = -3i - 1 2 j + 6k in
T u compute this moment. we can take the moment o f F about either
point I or point 2, and then rind the component or this vector along the /' -.
..
direction of the displacement vector hetween I and 2 or between 2 and I. r,'

Mathematically, wc have, using a displacement vector from point I tu


point u. namely (c, - r , ) . Figure 3.1X. Find momenl d F ahout line.

M I' = Iir,, - r , ) x FI * fi (3)

where i j i s the unit vector along thc line chosen to have a sense going from
point 2 to point I. The formulation ahove i s the s c d a r triple product exani-
incd in Chapter 2 and we can usc the determinant approach for the calcu-
lation m c e the components 01 the vectors (r,, - rl). F , and i j have been
determined. Thus. we have

iI r(! - rI = ( 2 i + 6 j )- (hi + lOj - i k )


= -4i - 4.j + 3k m
F = IOi +6 j N

= .354i + X66j - .354k

We then have, for M,,:

! -4 -4 3~

i
#
Mp =I 10 h 01 =
3 5 4 ,866 - . 1 d
13.94 N-m ib)

i Because M,, i s pobilive. wc have a clockwisc inoiiieiil about thc line as we


i look from point 2 to point I . I 1 we had chosen p lo have an opposite sense,
: then M,, would have been computed a s -13.94 N-in. Then. we would con-
i cludc that MI, i s a coiintcrclockwix rniimcnt about the line a s one looks
! from point I to point 2. Note that the same physical inoinent i s determined
in both cases.
SECTION 3.3 MOMENT OF FORCE ABOUT AN A X I S 75

Example 3.4
A deep submergence vessel is connected to its mother ship by a cable
(Fig. 3.19). The vessel becomes snagged on some rocks and the mother
ship steams ahead in a forward direction in an attempt to free the sub-
merged vessel. The connecting cable is suspended from a crane directed
up over the wdter 20 m above the center of mass of the mother ship and 15
m out from the longitudinal axis of the mother shim The cable transmits a
I

force of 200 kN. It is inclined 50" from the vertical in a vertical plane
which. in turn, is oriented 20" from the longitudinal axis of the ship. What
is the moment tending to cause the mother ship to roll about its longitudi-
nal axis (].e., the x-axis)?
The position vector from the center of mass C to point A is
r = -1Sj + 20km

0 -15 20
M, = -144 -52.4 -128.6 kN-m
1 0 0
3.25. Disc A has a radius of 600 mm.What i s the moment of the 3.29. A blimp i\ moored to a tmvcr at A . A forcc on A Irmr t h i b
%rces ahout the center of thc disc? What i s the torque of thew blimp i s
brces ahout the axis of the shaft'!
F = Si + 3j + I.Xk k N

I What i s the moment ahaut tixis C ' c m the gmund'! Knowledge 01


~ t othcr ni~nirnt\at the b a s t is nreded to pnqxrly
this m o m c ~ and
dchign the fciundation of the tower.

/2
I I\N

kN
Figure P.3.25.

L2h. A fmce F acts at position ( 3 , 2, 0) ft. It I S in thc ,Q planc


md is inclined at 30" from the I axis with a s c n x directed away
rom the origin. What is the momcnt of this force ahout an axis
ping through thc paints (6, 2. 5 ) ft and (0, -2. - 3) ft?

1.27. A force F = IOi + C r j N goes through the origin of the c,


.uordinate system. What is the nioment 01this fircr F about an
Figure P.3.29.
!xis going through points I ;md 2 with position vcctors?
r , = 6i +
3k m
r2 = 16j - 4 k m 3.30. Compute thc thrurt 01 the applicd tnrcci shown aluog
the axis nf the rhair and the torque of the firrcr? about the a x ~ sof
the shaft.
1.28. Given a forcc F = IOi + 3j N acting at posirion
= S j + I0k ni, what i s the turquc ahout the diagonal showti iii 100 Ih
. ...
.
he diagram? What i?the t n ~ m e n tabout point E!

L)

3m

,...t...-;h,--i 2m 3.31. What


A/

Figure P.3.30.

i s the milximuni load W that the craiic c u i lift witli-


out tipping about A'! Hirrr: when tipping is irnpcnding, what i s Lhc
Figure P.3.28. suppoiring force tit thc wheel at IT!

'6
3.34. The base of a Sire truck extension ladder is rotated 75”
counter-clockwise. The 25-m ladder j s elevated 60‘ from the hor-

L .x
izontal. The ladder weight is 20 kN and is regarded as concen-
trated at a point I O m up from the base (the lower part of the
ladder weighs much more than the upper part). A 9 0 - N fireman
and the 500-N young lady he is rescuing are at the top of the lad-
der. (a) What is the mument at the hase of the ladder tending to tip
over the fire truck’! (b) What is the moment about the horizontal
axis having unit vector 6 shown in the diagram?

Figure P.3.31.
3.32. Find the moment of the I ,000-lh force about an axis going
hetween points D and C.

View A-A
Figure P.3.34.
Figure P.3.32.
3.33. In Problem 3.24, what is the mumenr of the three indicated
forces about axis CD?

3.4 The Couple and Couple Moment


A special arrangement of forces that is of great importance is the cuuple. The
I A\,-F
cuuple is formed by any two equal parallel forces that have opposite senses
(Fig. 3.20). O n a rigid body, a couple has only one effect, a “turning” action.
Individual forces or combinations of forces that do not constitute couples
y
may “push” o r “pull” as well as “turn” a body. The turning action is given
quantitatively by the moment of forces about a point or an axis. We shall,
accordingly, be most concerned with the moment of a couple, or what we 1

shall call the couple moment. Figure 3.20. A couple.

I1
78 CHAI'PdK 3 IMI'OKrANT VECTOR QUANTITIES

e = 1rl-r:) Let us now evaluate the moment of the couple about thc vrigin. Posi-
tion vectors have heen drawn in Fig. 3.21 to points I and 2 anywhere along
-F the respective line OS action of each force. Adding the monient of each force
about 0, we have f i r the couple moment M
M = rl x F + rL x (-F)
(3.15)
= (rl - r.) x F

We can see that (rl - r , ) i s a displacement vector between points 2


and I, and if we call this vector-e, the formulation above hecomes

Figure 3.21. Cornpule ~ i i i m c nof~ couplc M = e X F 13.16)


abuut 0.
Since e i s i n thc planc o f the couple. i t i h clear froin thc dcfinition of a cross
product that M i h in an i r i e n t a t i ~ nnorinal to the plane o S the couple. The
sense in this case may he seen in Fig. 3.22 to he directed downward. in accor-
dance with the right-hand-screw rule. Notc thc use ofthe double arrow to rep-
resent the ciiuple miiment. Note also that the riitatiiin of e to F , a s stipulated
in the cross-product lormulation, i s i n the siiiiie direction as the "turning"
action u t the two force vectors, and from now vn wc shall use the latter crite-
rim for determining the sense of r ~ t a t i o nto he used with the right-hand-
screw rule.

M
Figure 3.22. I he cuuplc moment M

Now that the direction of couplc ~nornentM has hem established for
the couple, wc need only compute the niagnitude for a complete description.
Points I and 2 may be chosen anywhere along the lines o f action of the forces
without changing the resulting moment. since the forces arc transmissible for
taking moments. Therefore, to compute Ihc magnitude 01 the ciiuple moment
vector it will be simplest to choose positions I and 2 s o that e i s p r p e n d i r u -
lar to the lines of action of the forces ( e i s then dcnvted as eL). From the def-
inition of thc cross product, we can then say:

IMI = lell IF! sin '10" = led = IFId (3.17)


where the more familiar notation. (1. has been used in place v1 lell as the per-
pendicular distance hetween the lines of action 01the forces.
SECTION 3.5 THE COUPLE MOMENT AS A FREE VECTOR 19

Note that in the computation of the moment of the couple about origin
0, the final result in no way involved the position of point 0. Thus, we can
assume immediately that the couple has the .same moment about every point
in space. More about this in the next section.

3.5 The Couple Moment as a Free Vector


Had we chosen any other position in space as the origin, and had we com-
puted the moment of the couple about it, we would have formed the same
moment vector. To understand this, note that although the position vectors to
points 1 and 2 will change for a new origin O‘, the difference between these
vectors (which has been termed e ) does not change, as can readily be
observed in Fig. 3.23. Since M = e X F, we can conclude that the couple
hus the sume momenr about every point in space. The particular line of action
of the vector representation of the couple moment that is illustrated in Fig.
3.24 is then of little significance and can be moved anywhere. In short, the
couple moment is n free vecror. That is, we may move this vector anywhere in
space without changing its meaning, provided that we keep the direction and
magnitude intact. Consequently, for the purpose of taking moments, we may
move the couple itself anywhere in its own or a parallel plane, provided that
the direction of turning is not altered-i.e., we cannot “flip” the couple over. In
any of these possible planes, we can also change the magnitude of the forces
of the couple to other equal values, provided that the distance d is simultane-
ously changed so that the product IFld remains the same. Since none of these
steps changes the direction or magnitude of the couple moment, all of them
are permissible.

Figure 3.23. Vector e is the same for both references.


80 CHAPILR 1 IMI'OKTANT VFCTOR OI'ANTITIFS

As we pointcd out ciirlicr. the only effect of a couple on ii rigid hody i s


represented quantitatively by lhc miimcnt of the
i t s turning action. which i s
couple-i.c., thc ciiuplc iniimcni. Since this i s its sole effect. it i s only naturiil
to represent the couple hy specifications of i t s moment; its magnitude. then.
becomes IFId and its direction that of i t s monient. Thi\ i h tlic siliiic a s identi-
lying a person by Iicrlhih joh (i.e., its :I teacher. plumber, etc.). Thus, in Fig.
1.24. the cmiple niiiment C inay he used to seprcmit the indicated couplc.

3.6 Addition and Subtraction of Couples


loo lh-ft
Since couples thcinscl\,cs liavc x r o iiet lorccs. addition per se of coiiplcs
alw;iys yields 7ei-c lorcc. Fur this rciis1111. the ;iddition and suhtsactioii of
ciiuples i s interpreted to iiieaii ;idditiiin and subtsaction 01the t?zotnwii.s of thc
couples. Since ciiuple nioniciits arc lrec vector\. we ciiii tilways arrange to
have a concurrent system 01 vector\. We r h l l iiow tahe the iipportuiiity ki
illustrate inany 01the ciirlies remarks about couples by adding the two couples
\tiown on the face 111 the cuhe iii I"g. 3.25. Noticc that the couple miiment
vectors 01thc couples have heeii drawn. Sincc lliese vectors arc frcc. lhey may
be moved ttr ii convenient position and then added. The total couplc inoiiienl
25 Ib-I1 llirii hcciimcs 103.2 lh-ft iit an anglc 111 16- with the Iiorimiitill. as shown in
Fig. 3.26. The couple that crcatcs [hi\ lusning action i s in ;I plane at right
;inglcs ti) thih oriciitation with ii cli>chwise senw iis (ihscrvcd froin below.

100 lh-It 4 103.? lh-li


Figure 3.25. Add c r ~ i p l e s .

25 Ih-ft
SECTION 3.6 ADDITION AND SUBTRACTION OF COUPLES 81

This addition may be shown to he valid by the following more elemen-


tary procedure. The couples of the cube are moved in their respective planes
to the positions shown in Fig. 3.27, which does not alter the moment o f the
couples, as pointed out in Section 3.5. If the couple on plane B is adjusted to
have a force magnitude of 20 Ib and if the separating distance is decreased to
514 ft, the couple moment is not changed (Fig. 3.28). We thus form a system
o f forces in which two of the forces are equal, opposite, and collinear and,
since these two forces together cannot contribute moment. they m a y he deleted.
leaving a single couple on a plane inclined to the original planes (Fig. 3.29).
The distance between the remaining forces is
Figure 3.27. Movc couplcs.
425 + ft = 5.16ft

and so the magnitude of the couple moment may then be computed to be


103.2 Ib-ft. The orientation of the normal to the plane of the couple is readily
evaluated as 16" with the horizontal, making the tntal couple moment identi-
cal to our preceding result.

Figure 3.28. Change values o l two


furcea.

Figure 3.29. Eliminate collincnr 20-lb


f0VXS.

A common notation for couples in a plane is shown in Fig. 3.30. The


values given will be that o f the couple moments.

Figure 3.30. Repressentiltiun of couple moments in


a plene.
82 C H A P T ~ Ki IMP O RT A N T VECTOR Q U A N T I T I ~ S

Example 3.5
Replace the system of forces and couple shown in Fig. 1.31 by ii single
couple moment. Note that the 1.000-N-in couple m ~ m c i i ti s in thc diago-
nal plane ABCD. As a first step in the prohlem. identify ii second couple
moment i n addition to the couple moment i n the diagonal plane.
Examine the vertical forces. There i s an upward sun) of 1.700 N
clearly not colinear with the downward 1,700-N force. These forces form
the second couple. To gel the couple moment for these forces. we take
m~imcntsol these forces about the origin as follows:

C, = 3k x 80Oj + (3k + 2;) x (700 - 17O(l)j + 2; x 200j


= 600; - 1.600k N-m

As for the I ,000-N-ni couple moment. wc look in it direction along lhe .\


axis toward the origin as shown in Fig. 1.32.
The angle a in Fig. 3.32 i s given as follows:
tan a = 314 a = 36.87''
:_
Hence we have fix the second couplc moment C,.
C , = -1,000 cos 36.87"k + I.000 sin 16.87'j
= -800k + 6OOj N-m

N o w we can add the two couple moments to get C,,,,,.


C,,,, = C, + C2 = (600; - 1,600k) + (-800k + 600j)

CmAL = 6001 - 2,400kN-m Figure 3.32. View along the .I a i \ .

3.7 Moment of a Couple About a line


I n section 3.3. we pointed out that the moment of a force I: about a line A-A
(see Fig. 3.33) is fiiund by first taking the moment of F about or!? point P on A -
A arid then dotting this ifector into a. the unit bector along the l i i Thai
~ is,
M,,,, = (r X F) * a (3.lX)
Figure 3.33. To tind moment of F
ahout A-A. Consider now the moment i i f a couple about a liiic. For this purpose, we show
a couple niomeiit C and line A-A in Fig. 3.13. As belirrc, wc Irrst want the
nioineiit of the couple about any point P along &,l. Hut the inomcnt of C
ahout ever? point in space i s simply C itself. Therelore, tu gel the moment
aboul thc line &A all we nccd to do i s dot C into a . Tho\,

h ~ , ~=, ,C - a (3.10)
Since C i s a free vector, the moments o l C about all lines parallel to A-A m u s t
Figure 3.34. 1 0 find moment of couple have the same value.
about A-A.
SECTION 3.1 MOMENT OF A COUPLE ABOUT A LINE 83

Example 3.6
Consider the steering mechanism for a go-cart in Fig. 3.35. The linkages
are all in a plane oriented at 45" to the horizontal. This plane is perpendic-
ular to the steering column. In a hard turn, the driver exerts oppositely
directed forces of 30 Ib with each hand in order to turn the 12-in. diameter
steering wheel clockwise as the driver looks at the steering wheel. What is
the moment applied to each wheel about an axis normal to the ground?
Assume half the transmitted torque goes to each wheel

Steerine
X

I-+
View looking down
steering column
Figure 3.35. Steering mechanism of a go-cart.

The couple moment applied to the steering wheel is readily determined as

C = (30)(12)(.7071' - .707j) = 254.51 ~ 254.5jin-lb

The torque about the vertical axis for each wheel is now easily evaluated.
Thus

Torque =
2
~ -
I ( 2 5 4 . 5 - 254.53) j = -127.3 in-lb
, .
84 ('HAPIER 3 IMPORTANT VECTOR QUANTITIES

Example 3.7
I n Pis. 3.36, find
(a) the sum 01 the lbrces
(b) the sun1 of thc couplcs
(c) the torquc of the entire system about axis C-C having direction
cosines I = .46 and rn = .61 mil going through point A .

Figure 3.36. Force system in spisr.

= 700i + 267.3; + 534.5j + 8OI.Xk

X F = 967.3i + 534.5j + 801.8kN

(h) c C = 400k + 500 Si-8/'+7k


,5' + 82 + 72
+ 800 4j - 21 +Ik WIT1
4' + 2' + I'
SECTION 3.1 MOMENT OF A COUPLE ABOUT A LINE 85

Example 3.7 (Continued)

ZC = 400k + 212.8i - 340.53 + 297.9k + 594.2j


- 297.1i + 445.7k

z i + 253.1j t 1 , I W
(c) To find M,, we proceed by first finding the unit vector along C-C,
which we denote as P. Thus from geometry

/* + m2 + n2 = I
+
.462 .63* n2 = I
:_ +
n = ,6257
Hence,
c? = .46i + .63j + .6257k
We now get M<.(..

M,, = {(6i - 3i - S j - 16k) x (700i)+ (-3i - S j - 16k)


x (267.3 + 534.51 + 801.8k) + (212.81' - 140.5j + 297.9k)
+ (594.2j - 297.11' + 445.7k) + 400k) (.46i + 6 3 j + .6257k)

Carrying out calculations in the large bracket, we get:

M,, = {(5,60Ok - II,20Oj)+(2,138i-l,872j +534.9k)


+ (212.8i - 340.5j + 297.9k) + (594.2j - 297.1i + 445.7k)
+ 400k) (.46i + .63j + .6257k)

Mc.c= 944 7 - 8,075 + 4,554 = -2,516


+-
i
i

Figure P.3.37. Vigilre l'..UIl


3.41. A couple is shown in the yz plane. What is the moment of 3.44. What is the moment of the forces shown about point A and
this couple about the origin'! About point (6, 3, 4) m'! What is the about a point P having ii position vector
moment of the couple about a line through the origin with direc-
tion cosines I = 0. rn = .8, n = -.6? If this line is shifted to a
r,, = IOi + 7j + ISkm'!
parallel position so that it goes through point (6, 3, 4) m, what is
the moment o f the couple about this line'?

E
I
I 10N

3m

200 N
y+v. Figure P.3.41.
x
Figure P.3.44.

- 3.42. Given the indicated forces, what is the moment of these 3.45. Find the torque about axis A-A developed by the 100-lb
forces about points A and E? force and the 3,000-ft-lb couple moment. The position vector r, is:
r , = l O i + 8 j + 12kft

Figure P.3.42.

3.43. An eight-bladed windmill used for power generation and /


pumping water stops turning because a bearing on the blade shaft
has "frozen up." However, the wind still blows, so each blade is Figure P.3.45.
subjected to a 25-lb force perpendicular to the (flat) blade surface. 3.46. ~i,,d M~~ N~~~that the 400.ft.]b couple is along
The force effectively acts at 2 ft from the centerline of the shaft to the diagonal from point A point 8,
which the blades are attached. The blades are inclined at 60" to the
axis of rotation. What is the total thrust of all the blade forces on
the windmill shaft'? What is the moment on the stalled shaft?
I

u of blade
Figure P.3.43. Figure P.3.46.

87
Figure P.3.49. Figure P.3.53.
3.54. An oil-field pump has two valves, one on top and one on 3.56. Add the couples whose forces act along diagonals of the
the side, that must be closed simultaneously. The valve wheels are sides of the rectangular parallelepiped.
each 21 in. in diameter and are turned with both hands by workers
who can exen hetween 50 Ib and 125 Ib with each hand. I f a weak
worker tums the side wheel and a strong worker turns the tap
wheel, whet ic the total twisting moment (couple mument) on the
pump'?
Sm ,
3.55. What is the mal moment about the origin of the force sys- ,,
tem shown'! SN
10 m
Figure P.3.56.

/
Figure P.3.55.

3.8 closure
In this chapter, we have considered several important vector quantities and
their properties. In particular, for rigid bodies we found we could take certain
liberties with a couple without invalidating the results.
Note in particular that in the chapter on vector algebra, the line of
action was of no significance. However, it should now be abundantly clear
that in taking moments we cannot change the line of action of the force. On/?
the line of action of a couple momerrf can be changed to any parallel position
for rigid bodies. Moreover, i t is important to remember that we can always
move a force along its line of action any time we are computing moments.
We are now ready to pursue in greater detail the impottant subject of
equivalence of force systems for rigid body considerations. We will see that in
equivalence considerations of rigid bodies, we again must he careful about
what to do with lines of action. They will play a vital role in our deliberations.

89
3.57. A n A-framc fbr hoiyting and dragging equipment i? hcld in 3.60. What i s thc moment ahout A of thc 500-N force and the
the position shown by a cahle C. To determine thc cahlc force. the 3.110(1-N-m c i ~ u p l cncting 011 the cantilcvcr hr:rm?
mnment of the applicd force about axib 8-8 must bc known. What
is that momcnt whcn n 1,000-N lbrcr is applied a i shown'!

000 N-ni

Figure P.3.60.

3.61. A furcr F = I h i + l O j - 3k Ih goes through point i t


havinz ii position w u t i i i r,, = I h i - j + 12k ft. What is the
innnienl ahout an :,xis p i n g Ihl-oush prrintc I arid 2 having rcspcc-
t I.nno I\: t i w pixitm, vectors given :s\
Figure P.3.57.
r , = hi + 3j - 2h fi
3.58. A plumber places his hands I8 in. apart on a pipe threader r~ = 3; - 4.j + IZk li'!
md can push (and pull) with 80 Ih of force. What couple moment
joes he exert'.' How much could he exert i f he moved his hand5 t u
he ends s o that his hands are 24 in. apart'! Whet force musi hc
ipply at the ends to achieve the came couple nwnxnt :IF when he
ield his hands 18 in. apart?

0
-I I X"+
Figure P.3.58.
1.59. Find the torque ahnut e linr gving fi-im point I to point 2.

3.63. What i i the tulal c w p l c imoment of thc three couples


shown? What IS the i n ~ ~ n e n~ft thir force systcm ahout point
(3. 4. 1) It'! What i s Ihc rnomcnt nf this f k c system nhout the
/ P = 1.OOOi t 6OOjN
pwition vector r = 3; + 4 j + 2k fl takcn ab an axis'! What i s
Figure P.3.59. thr total fkroc of thi, \\,stun'!
3.?il
I 3.66. Compute the moment of the XX)-lb force about points P,and
p,.

/ XI0 Ib
300 Ih

Figure P.3.63.
Figure P.3.66.
3.64. Find the torque about axis AB.
3.67. A tow tNck is inclined at 45" to the edge A-A of a ravine
with sides sloping at 45" to the vertical. The operator attaches a
cable to a wrecked car in the ravine and starts the winch. The cable
is oriented normal to A-A and develops a force of IS kN. What are
the moments tending to tip over the tow truck about the led1
wheels (rocking backward). (Hint; Use the position vector from C
to B in Fig. P.3.67(c).)Notc that view 0-0 is n m n d l to A-A and
parallel to the incline.

I /
Figure P.3.64.

3.65. A force is developed by a liquid nn a pipe any time the


pipe changes the direction or the speed of flow as a result of an
elbow or a nozzle. Such fbrces can he of considerable magnitude
and must be taken into account in building design. We h a w
shown three such forces. What moment stemming from thece
forces must be counteracted by the support at O?

I
I.',

I
./ Figure P.3.67.
Figure P.3.65.
3.68. A surveyor o n a IIlO-m-high hill dctcrrnines that Ihr cnrnrl~ 3.71. Find the t m p e of lhr f w c c sy.;tcm ahout iixi5,4-/<.
of a huilding at thc hair of the hill is 600 m east :ind 1.500 m
north of her pmition. What is tho posilian of the huildiog c o m r i
relati\-e to another surveyor on top of a 5,~100-m-highmountain
that is 10,000 m wcst and 3,000 ni south of the hill'? What i\ ihc
distance from thc second \ u i n r y w to the huilding c m ~ r ' !

3.69. ComQUIr the rnomcnt of the 1.00ll-lh furcr :ih<,ut support^ IN


ing points A and H . .. ~

1 ,
I,000ih ~i

Figure P.3.71.

Figure P.3.69.
3.70. What is the turning action OS the forcsc shown about the
diagonal A-n?

Figure P.3.72

Figure P.3.70.

92
Equivalent
Force
Systems
4.1 Introduction
In Chapter I , we defined equivalent vectors as those that have the same
capacity in some given situation. We shall now investigate an important class
of situations, namely those in which a rigid-body model can be employed.
Specifically, we will he concerned with equivalence requirements for force
systems acting on a rigid body. Parenthetically, we will begin to see that the
line of action plays a vital role in the mechanics of rigid bodies.
The effect that forces have on a rigid body is only manifested in the
motion (or lack of motion) of the body induced by the forces. Two force sys-
tems, then, are equivalent if they are capable of initiating the same motion of
the rigid body. The conditions required to give two force systems this equal
capacity are:
1. Each force system must exert an equal “ p u s h or “pull” on the body in any
direction. For two systems, this requirement is satisfied if the addition of
the forces in each system results in equal force vectors.
2. Each force system must exert an equal “turning” action about any point in
space. This means that the moment vectors of the force systems for any
chosen point must be equal.
Although these conditions will most likely be intuitively acceptable to the
reader, we shall later prove them to be necessary and, for certain situations,
sufficient fbr equivalence when we study dynamics.
As a beginning here, we shall reiterate several hasic force equivalences
for rigid bodies that will serve as a foundation for more complex cases. You
should subject them to the tests listed above.
1. The sun1 o l a set of concurrent lorces i s a singlc liirce that i s equivalent to
the original system. Convei-sely, a single f171ce i s equivalent to any coin-
plctc set of i t s cc~niponcnts.
2. A Sorce may he moved along its linc oiaction (i.c., forces are transmissi-
hlc vectors).
3. The only elSect tliat ii couplc develops on ii rigid hody i s cmhodied i n the
couplc momen[. Since the ciiople monicni i s a l w a y it lree vector. for our
purposcs at present the couplc may he altcl-cd i n m y way as long as thc
c1)uplc i i i o m e i i l i\ tnot changcd.
Note for ( I ) and ( 2 ) ;ihiive. we ciiiinot change thc linc OS action alone while
maintaining equivalence.
In succccding sectioiis. k e shall present other equivalence relatioils for
rigid bodies and then examine peifectly general h r c e \yslcnis with a view to
rcplacing Lhcm with iiiiii-e convcnicnt and simplcr cquivaleiit force systems.
Thcsc simple i-epl;tccnicnts air oftcn called nmilruiir.r iif the more general
YYStems.

4.2 Translation of a Force


to a Parallel Position
I n Pig. 4.1. let us c o n d c r [he pos<ihility of miiving ii force F (solid arrow)
acting [in a rigid hody to a parallel position at point (I wliilc maint;iining rigid-
hody equivalence. If at posilioii (I we apply equal and iipposite forces, one of
which i s F and the othcr - F, ii syctcm of thiee Iirces i s fortricd that i s clearly
equivalent 111 the original single forcc F. Note tliiit Ihc original liircc F and
thc new Sorcc i n the oppositc sense form a couple (thc pair i s identified hy a
wavy connecting line). As usual. we represent the couple hy its moment C.as
shown i n Fig. 4.2. iiorniiil to the plane A of point a and llic original h c c F .
Thc magnitude of thc couple imonic~itC i s 1I;d. where d i s (he perpendicular
distance hetween point (I and (he original line iiiaction o f the fol-cc. The cou-
plc imonient may hc moved 10 any palallel liositioii. i n c l u d i n ~the orib'
Tin. as

indicated i n Fig. 4.2.


SECTION 4.2 TRANSLATION OF A FORCE TO A PARALLEL POSITION 95
Thus, we see that a force may be moved tu any parallel position, pro-
vided rhat a couple moment of rhe mrrecf orientation and magnitude is
.simnltaneously provided. There are, then, an infinite number of arrangements
possible to get the equivalent effects of a single force on a rigid body.'
We now present a simple method for computing the couple moment
developed on moving a force to a parallel position. Return to Fig. 4. I and
compute the moment M of the original force F about point a. We can express
this as [see Fig. 4.3 (a)]

x 1

(a) (b)
Figure 4.3. Couple moment on moving F is p x F .

M = p X F (4.1)

where p is a position vector from a to any point along the line of action of F .
Now the equivalent force system, shown in Fig. 4.3 (h), must have the same
moment, M, about point a as the original system. Clearly, the moment about
point a in Fig 4.3 (b) is due only to the couple moment C. That is,

M = C (4.2)

Accordingly, we conclude, on comparing the previous two equations, that

C = p X F

Thus, in shifting a force to pass through some new point, we introduce a


couple whose couple moment equals the moment of the force about this
new point.
We illustrate this in the following examples.

' A moment of thought will give credence to the ahove procedure of maintaining rigid hody
equivalence while moving B force to a different line of action. By moving F IO go rhruugh point
a, you are eliminating the moment ahout a that existed before the move. The couple moment
inserted at 1ht: time of the move realores this lost moment.
'Thcrclore.

C = -12k - 1 2 j - 54; -t (ii + 24; + 51k

I
C = -4Xi + 12j + 42k ft-lb
SECTION 4.2 T RA N SL A TIO N O F A FO RC E TO A PARALLEL POSITION 91

Example 4.2
What is the equivalent force system at position A for the 100-N force
shown in Fig. 4.5?

Figure 4.5. Find equivalent force system at A .


The 100-N force can he expressed vectorially as follows:

F = -48.Oi - 68.55' + 54.8k'N


We then have the force given above at A . In addition, we have a c ~ u p l e
moment, C, found using a position vector, r, from A to any point along the
line of action of the 100-N force. Thus, choosing point B for r, we have
C = (I0i - S j + 8 k ) x ( - 4 8 . 0 i - 68.5j + 54.8k)

= (10)(-68 5 ) k + (-48)(8)j + (-8)(54 8 ) i


- (8)(-68.5)i - (54.8)(10)j- (-E)(-48 O)k

Therefole,
C = 109.6i - 9321 - 1,069191-m (h)

- _-I
98 CHAPTER 4 E Q U I VA LE N T FORCE SYSTEMS

The reverse of the proccdurc just presented may be instituted in reduc-


ing a force and a c(iuplc in rhe S N ~ pP l m e to a .sitigle cquivalcnt force. This
is illustrated in Fig. 4.6 (a) where ii couple composed 01 lorces R and -8 a
distance d , apart and :I force A are shown i n planc N . The moment repreuen-
tation of thc couple is shown with force A i n Fig. 4.6 ( h ) .

(1,) Fulrs A and couple moment


Figure 4.6. A coplanar frircr and couple.
Equal and opposite forces A and -A may i i r x t he added ti) the systcm at
a specific position e (see Fig. 4.7). The purpose olthis step is to form another
couple moment with a magnitude lAld2 equal to IHId,and with a directon of
turning opposite to the original couple moment (see Fig. 4.8) and this dictates
the position of P . The couple ninrnents then cancel each other out and we are
left with only a single force A going through point r . Therelbre. we can
alwdys reduce a rwcc and a couple in the s3me plane to a single force which
clearly must have a .spwjfk line ,!f nction f i x the case at hand.
Figure 4.7. Equal and opposite ~orccs
placed at e

I _/ ” ‘

Figure 4.8. Adjiisr d2 so that couple


moments cancel.
We now exemplify the ahovc procedure in the following example
SECTION 4.2 TRANSLATlON OF A FORCE TO A PARALLEL POSITION 99

Example 4.3
In Fig. 4.9(a), we have shown a cantilever beam supporting a single force
and a couple in the xy plane. We wish to reduce this system to a single
force equivalent to the given system for purposes of rigid-body mechanics.
In Fig. 4.9(b), we have shown the couple moment and a point P to
which we shall shift the I ,000-N force. It should be clear on inspection that
the couple moment accompanying this shift will have a sign opposite to the
original couple moment. Our task now is to get the correct distance d so as
to effect a cancellation of the couple moments. Thus we require that
di x (1,000) (.707i ~ ,707j) + SSOk = 0

:. -(707d)k + 550k = 0 tf s J78m


Note we could have reached the above result more simply if we had resolved
the force into rectangular components first. Only the vertical component has
nonzero moment about e and so dispensing with vectors, we can directly say
-707d + 550 = 0 d = ,778 m

, I I
(a) Coplanar loading (h) Move force to point e

i
( c ) Single force at e

Figure 4.9. Reduction of a coplanar force and couple to a single force with a specific line of action.
4.1. Replace the 100-lb force hy an equivalent \ystcm, fmm n
rigid-body point of view, at A . Do the same lor point H . Do thk
problem by the technique 01 adding equal and opposite collinear
forces and also by using (he cross prriduct.

r 100 Ih - 3 111

Figure P.4.4.
~- *

5. A plumber c x c n s a vertical 60-lh fol-cc on il pipe wren< 1


+-- 3(l,+ inclined at 10" to thc hnrimnlal. What f w c r and couple nomcnt
Figure P.4.1. on thr pipe are equivalent tn thc plumber'& action?

4.2. Tri hack an airplane away from the boarding gate. it tractor
pushes with a force of 15 kN on [he nose wheels. What i s rh?
equivalent farce system on the landing-gear pivot point. which i s
2 m above the point where the tractor pushes?

~~~~~~

/
/A3
' PivotPoint

Figure P.4.5.
Figure P.4.2.

1.3. Replace the 1,000-1b force by equivalent systcms at pointr 4.6. A tractor pera at or i s attzmpting to lift a IO-kN bouldcr.
4 and 6. Do so by using the addition of cqud and opposite What arc thc cquiialent lwuc systims :it A a n d at H l r m thr
iollinear force components and hy using the c r o s ~product. hnuldcr'!

+
n - cy,
Figure P.4.3. Figure P.4.6.
4.7. A small hoist has a lifting capacity of 20 kN. What are the 4.10. A carpenter presses down on a brace-and-bit with a 150-N
largest and smallest equivalent force systems at A for the rated force while turning the brace with a 200-N force oriented for
maximum capacity? maximum twist. What is the equivalent force system on the end of
the bit at A?
r
I

Figure P.4.7.
4.8. Replace the forces by a \ingle equivalent force
1001b 1200lb Figure P.4.10.
4.11. A force F = 3 i - 6 j + 4k lb goes through point (6, 3,
2) ft. Replace this force by an equivalent system where the force
goes through point (2, - 5, IO) ft.
412. A force F = 20i - 60j + 30k N goes through a point
20' +20, +20 (10, - 5, 4) m. What is the equivalent system at point A having
position vector rA = 20i + 3j - 15k m?
Figure P.4.8.
4.13. Find the equivalent force system at the base of the
4.9. Replace the forces and torques shown acting on the appara- cantilever pipe system stemming from force F = 1,000 Ib.
tus by a single force. Carefully give the line of action of this force.

Figure P.4.9. Figure P.4.13.

101
4.14. Replace the h.000-N force and the I0,OOtI-N-m ciiupli
moment hy ii single Iorcu. Whcrc docs this force cross tht
x axis'!

4.17. A wpplementary mppoiling guy-wirc systcm for a 00-rn~


Ld1 tower IS lightened. The cables ;ire fiistcncd t o thc gmond at
[101t11\ 120" apart mtl 100 m irom thc t o w u hasc. Whnt i\ the
cquivalent i ~ c hyslent
e acting on thc tower hasc whcrt the tensioii
i s SO kN in cahlc AT, 75 kN i n 81: a n d 25 k N in ('7'1

6,000 N
Figure P.4.14.

4.15. In Prohlrrn 4.13. the pipe weighs 20 Ih/ft. What i\ thc


rquivalcnt force system at A froin the weight of thc pipc'! [Hirir:
Concentrate the weight, of the pipe sections at thc rwpective c c w
ters of grsvity (gcomstric centcis i n thi, ca\c).I
4.16. 'The operator o i a sinall hoam-type crane i s rrying t u drag a
chunk of cnncrete. The hoorn i s IO" ahove the hwimntal and
rotated 30" clackwisc as seen l r o r ahovr. Thc cahlc i s directed a s
shown in thc diagmn arid has 60 kN of tension. What is thc cquiv-
nlent force systcm at thc hoom pivot point! Figure P.4.17

4.3 Resultant of a Force System


As defined at the beginning of the chapter. :I resultrint o f r r . f i ~.s?srrm
r~ is n
simpler equivalent [ w e systcm. I n many compulatims it i s desirable first to
establish a resultant before cntcring into other comptrtations.
For a general arrangcmcnt of forces, no niattcr h o w complex. we can
always move a11 forces and couplc imimcnts. the latter including hoth those
given and those lorined from the movement 01 fwces. to proceed through any
single point. The result i s then a systcm (if concurrenl forccs at the point and
a system (if concurrent couple moments. These systems may then he coin-

I02
SECTTON4.3 RESULTANT OF A FORCE SYSTEM 103

bined into a single force and a single couple moment. Thus, in Fig. 4.10 we
have shown some arbitrary system of forces and couples using full lines. The
resultant force and couple moment combination at the origin of a rectangular
reference is shown as dashed lines.
z

Figure 4.10. Resultant of general force system

Thus, any force system can be replaced at any point by equivalents no


more complex than a single force and a single couple moment. In special
cases, which we shall examine shortly, we may have simpler equivalents such
as a single force or a single couple moment. Finally, for equilibrium of a
body, it is necessary that at any chosen point the simplest resultant system of
force and couple moment acting on the body he zero vectors-a fact that will
he discussed in dynamics2
The methods of finding a resultant of forces involve nothing new. In mov-
ing to any new point, you will recall, there is no change in the force itself other
than a shift of line of action; thus, any component of the resultant force, such as
the x component, can simply be taken as the sum of the respective x components
of all the forces in the system. We may then say tor the resultant force

(4.3)

The couple moment accompanying FR for a chosen point a may then be


given as
C, = [rl X Fl + r2 X F2 + . . . I + [C, +C,+.. . I (4.4)
where the first bracketed quantities result from moving the noncouple forces
to a, and the second are simply the sum of the given couple moments. The
vectors r are from a to arbitrary points along the lines of action of the forces.
In more compact form, the equation above becomes

(4.5)

The following example is an illustration of the procedure

‘When we refer hereafter to a resultant, we yhall mean the simplest resultant


104 CIIAPTER 1 CQUIVALCNI' I:ORCI< S Y S TEM S

r Example 4.4
T w o forces and a couplc arc shown in Fig. 1.I I, the couplc hciiig pmiiioncd
in the I? plnne. We shall find thc resultant (ifthe teiir at thc w-igin 0.

Figure 4.11. Find ircwltiim at 0

A t 0 we will have ii set of two concurrcnt fcirce5. which nlay hc


added to give 1,;:
= (10 + hi; + ( 3 + 3 ) j + ( 6 - 2)k

4 = 16; + 6 j + 4 k N
The resultant couple niornent ill piiint 0 i s the vector ~ U I I I or ihc ciiuplc-
mnmetit vector? devclopcd by mii\'ing the two forces. plu\ Ihc couple
rnornent o f the couplc in thc :
!plane. Thus,

C, = r l X PI + r, x P, - 30; N-in
NOW

r l x Fl = (10; + Sj + 3k) X 1 IOi + 3.j + hkl


= 2I i - 3Oj - 20k N-111
rr X F, = (10; + 3ji X (hi + 3.j - ? k )
= -6; + 2O.j + IZk N-til
Hence,
C, = - 1 5 - l O j - SkN-m

The rehultanl i h shown in Fir_.3.12.


I
SECTION 4.3 RESULTANT OF A FORCE SYSTEM 105
* Example 4.5
What i s the resultant at A of the applied loads acting in Fig. 4.13’! The
forces are directed to intersect the centerline of the shaft along which we

Figure 4.13. Find resultant at A ; F , and F , are concurrent.


have placed the z axis. We first express the loads vectorially. Thus,

= -40.2i + 53.7j - 134.lk Ib

= 94.8i - 176k Ib
F3 = -100jlb
C = -50k ft-lb
We can now readily find the resultant force system at A. Thus,?
F, = (-40.2 + 94.8)i + (53.7 - l0O)j + (-134.1 - 176.0)k

FR = 54.62 - 46.31’ - 3IOklb


C, = (-Ilk) X F; + (-8k) X (Fz + FJ + (-50k)
= -Ilk X (-40.2i + 53.7j - 134.lkJ + (-8k)
X (94% - 17h.Ok - IOOj) - 50k

CR = -u)9i - 316j - 50k ft-lb


‘Remember that for C rcauliing lrvin il muvement of a force, the posirion vector gora
from the point (in this CBSC point A) to the line of action of the force.
106 CHAPTER 4 EQLIJVALENTPVKCE S Y S TE M S

4.4 Simplest Resultants


of Special Force Systems
We shall now consider special but important force systems and will establish
the sirnplrst resultants possible for each case. Examples will serve to illustrate
the method of procedure.

Case A. Coplanar Force Systems. In Fig. 4.14, a system of forces


and couples is shown in plane A. By moving the forces to a common point a
in plane A, we will form additional couples in the plane. The force portion of
the equivalent system at such a point will he given as

x FK = [ T ( < , ) t ] i + [ T ( < , ) v ] j (4.6)


Figure 4.14. Coplanar force system.
The couple moment portion of the equivalent system can be given as
(using the right hand rule h r proper signs):
c, = (Fd, + F*d2 + . . .)k + (C, + C, +.. . )k (4.7)
where d,, d,, etc., are perpendicular distances from point a to the lines of
action of the noncouple forces, and C,, C,, etc.. are the values of the given
couple moments. The resultant at o is shown in Fig. 4.15.
If FR# 0, (i.e.. if Fr t 0 andor b; f 0 ) we can move the force
P I'
from a to yet a new parallel position so as to introduce a second couple
moment to cancel C, nf Fig. 4.15 in the manner described earlier in Section
4.2. Since the x and y directions used are arhitrary, except for the condition
that they be in thc plane of the forces, we can make the following conclusion.
~ t h e . f i i r ccornpnents
(~ in any direction in rht. plane add to uther rhun zero,
x we may replace the entire coplunar .system by ( I singlr,forcr x'ifh a specific
(?r
Figure 4.15. Resultant at point u. line flcti,lrl.
What happens if cP
F, = 0 and F, = O ? Without a force at point
P
a, we can no longer eliminate a couple in plane A . Thus, our second conclu-
sion is that if Ft arid 7, are v r o , the resiiltont m u f he u couple
P I'
mament ur be z r o .
In thc coplanar case, therefore, the simplest equivalent force system
must be a single force along i) specific line of action, a single couple moment,
or a null vector. The following example is used to illustrate the method of
determining such a resultant directly without the intermediate steps followed
in this discussion.
SECTION 4.4 SIMPLEST RESULTANTS O F SPECIAL FORCE SYSTEMS 107

Example 4.6
Consider a coplanar force system shown in Fig. 4.16. The simplest resul-
tant is to be fnund. Since F c and F~ are not zero, we know that we
I' P
can replace the system by a single force, which is

We now need to find the line of action in the plane that will make this sin-
gle force equivalent to the given system. To be equivalent for rigid-body
mechanics, this force without a couple moment must have the same tum-
Figure 4.16. Find simplest resultant
ing actinn about any point or axis in space as that of the given system.
Now the simplest resultant force must intercept the x axis at some point X4 L
We can determine X by equating the moment of the resultant force without
a couple moment about the origin with that of the original system of forces
and couples. Using the vector Ti as a position vector from the origin to the
line of action of FR (see Fig. 4.17), we accordingly have

xi X (6i + 13j) (Si + 2 j )


=
x (6i + 3 j ) + (Si + 3 j ) x (IOj) - 30k fb)

Carrying out the cross products,


Figure 4.17. Simplest resultant.
24k ~ 12k + S0k - 30k = I 3 2 (C)

Hence.

By specifying the x intercept, X, we fully determine the line of action of the


simplest resultant force. We could have also used the intercept with t h e y
axis, y, for this purpose. In that case, the position vector from the origin
out to the line of action is y j , and we have, on equating moments about 0
of the resultant without a couple moment with that of the original system:

j$ X (6i + 13j) = (Si + 2 j ) X (6i + 3 j ) + (Si + 3 j ) X (IOj) - 30k

Y=

'If the resultant force is parallel to the x axis, the intercept will be at infinity.
108 CHAPTER 4 EQUIVALENT FORCE SYSTEMS

Example 4.7
Compute the .simplest resultant for the loads shown acting on the heam i n
Fig. 4. IX(a). Givc thc intercept with the x axis.

/+ifJ-
...

75 N
IL)

Figure 4.18. Find siinplcst resultant.

I t i s immediately apparent on inspection of the diagram that

F , = loOi - 75j N (a)

Let x he the intercept with the x axis of the line o f action of I$ when this
line o f action corresponds to zero couple moment C, [see Fig. 4. IS(b)l. I n
Fig. 4.18(c). we have decomposed F, along this line of action into rcctati-
gular components so as to permit simple calculations of moments about
the origin 0 (here we mean moments about the z axis). Accordingly,
equating moments about the z axis of F, without a couple moment, with
that 0 1 the original system o f loads, we get,
-(75)(i;) = 50 - (2.5)(75) - (.4)(100)

X = 2.37 m I
Thus, the simplest resultant i s a force lOOi - 7 5 j N intercepting the bearrl
axis at a position I = 2.37 ni.

As pointed out earlier, i n the instance wherein F, = 0. we then possi-


hly have as the simplest resultant a couple moment normal to the plane o f the
coplanar force system. There i s also the possibility that there i s zero couple
moment, i n which cahe the lorces o l the coplanar force system i~ornplulrly
cancel each other’s effects on a rigid body. To find the couple moment for the
case where FK = 0, we simply take inutnents o f the coplanar force system
ahout m y p i n t i n space. This moment, if i t i s not equal to zero, i s clearly the
couple-moment vector sought.
SECTION 4.4 SIMPLEST RESULTANTS OF SPECIAL FORCE SYSTEMS 109

Example 4.8
What is the simplest resultant for the forces shown acting on beam AB in
Fig. 4 . 1 9 '

Jt.6 m 6 1.2 "1 -


Figure 4.19. Cuplanar loading un a simply aupported beam

Our first step will he to compute the resultant force by adding up the
force vectors. Thus
F, = 1,500j - 666.2 - (I,SXS.X)(.S)j
+ (1,585.8)(.866)i- 7 0 7 . l i 7 0 7 . l j
~

Collecting terms, we have


F, = (-666.2 + 1,373.3 - 707.l)i + (IS00 - 792.9 - 701.1)j = 0
The simplest resultant clearly must he either a couple moment or be a null
vector. For this information, we shall take moments about point A.
C, = ( [ . 3 - (.2)(.707)]i - (.2)(.707)jJ x (-666.2)
+ (.3)(1,5OO)k - (.6)(1,SX5.8)(.5)k

+ (li + .2j) x (-707.li - 7 0 7 . l j )

C, = -94.20k + 4SQk - 47S.7k


- 707.lk + 141.4k = '-685.6ki-J-m
We have a couple moment in the minus z direction having any arbitrary
line of action as the simplest resultant.

It is important thet the nature of the equivalence just instituted be


clearly understood. Thus, for finding the supporting force system, we can use
the undeformed geometry and hence the single force replacement. However,
for finding the deflection of the heam, it should be obvious that the replace-
ment is invalid. Note, finally, that there is only one point on the beam that
will allow for a single force to he equivalent to the original system for pur-
poses of rigid-body considerations.
110 CHAPTt3 4 EQUIVALENI FOK('E SYSTEMS

Case B. Parallel Force Systems in Space. Nuw. consider the sys-


t e m 01I I p a ~ t l l e forces
l i n Fig. 4.20. wherc the :direction has been selected
parallel to the forces. We also include m couples whose planes are parallel to
the :dircction bec;ruse such couples can be considered to he composed of
equal and opposite forces parallel t o the :direction. We can i n o x the forces
s o that they all pass through the origin uf the .q:axes; the force portion of the
equivalent hysteni i s then

Figure 4.20. Parallel system rrf force\.


F,? = E'<,)k 1
l h c couple inomenl ponion of the equivalent system i s found by applying Eq.
(4.8)

4.5 to this case:

wlicrc F represents tlic noncouple Ibrces. Cairyiiig out the crocs product, we get

Froin this. we sec that the couple mi)nicnt must always be parallel tu the .I?
plane (i.e., perpendicular to the directioii of the forces). We then have at the
origin il single force and a single couple moment at right angles to each uther
[see Fig. 4.2I'a)l. llFM# 0, wc can move Ft again to anothcr line of action
in a plane A perpendicular t o C# /see Fig. 4.21(h)Jand. choosing the proper
value of d , ensure that /$I = lC,l with ii sense opposite to CMSsuch that we
eliminate the couple ~noinent.We thuh eiitl up wirh a single force having a
particular line 01 action specified hy the intercept T,? of the line of action of
the f'urcc with the .ky planc. I f the suninration of forces should happen tu he
Lero. the equivalent system tnust thzn he a couple moment or a inull vector.
Thus, ltw sirnplrst rrrulrunl syrfewi o ( o parrillt.1 fiJWC sy,sfvrri i.5 either
~ ( I .sp(witic line o f w t i o n , u .siiiRle wupl<,niommt, or (1 null i'ri'tor.
u , f . r wifh
The following cxample will illustrate how we can directly dctcrmine lhe sin-
plest resulrant.

Figure 4.21. Simplcst rcsultnnt f o r


parallel furce system.
SECTION 4.4 SIMPLEST RESULTANTS OF SPECIAL FORCE SYSTEMS 111

Example 4.9
Find the simplest resultant of the parallel force system in Fig. 4.22(a)
i

I’

X’
(b)
Figure 4.22. Find simplest resultant.

The sum of the forces is 30 Ib in the negative z direction. Hence, a


position can he found in which a single force is equivalent to the original
system. Assume that this resultant force without a couple moment pro-
ceeds through the point X, 7 [Fig. 4.22(b)]. We can equate the moment of
this resultant force about the x and y axes with the corresponding moments
of the original system and thus form the scalar equations that yield the
proper value of Y and 7. Equating moments about the x axis, we get
(30)(2) - (20)(2) - (4O)(lO) = -3Oj;
Therefore,
7= 12.7

Equating moments about they axis, we have


-(30)(2) + (20)(4) + (40)(4) = 30T
Therefore.

You can also show, as an exercise, that the same result can he reached for
x, j by equating moments of the resultant force without a couple moment
~

about the origin with that of the original system about the origin.
i 12 CHAPTER 1 FQIIIVA1,CNl I,OR('I-: SYSTEMS

Example 4.10
Consider the parallel Iorcc system i n f:ig. 4.23(a). What i s tlic 4inplcxt
resultant?
Here we have a c:ise whcrc Ihc sum (ifthe forces is x i - c mil \(I 411 N
FR = 0. Therefore, 1hc simplest resultant inusl be a couple i n o n i c n ~or he a
null vector. To gel Lhih ciiuplc iiiiinienf, Cr we c m lake inioiiieti1s 0 1 the
fkrces about rmy poi111 in space. Thii tnonient bectiir then c q i d s tlic (3.2)m (2.4Jm
desircd couplc niwneiit C,?. One proccdurc i s ti) use llic origin nl'thc refer- , /'( 4 . 2 ) m
rncc as the point ahout whicli 10 lakc iniiiiients. Then we ciin \ay (ha1
CK = (4i + 2 j ) x (-.iOk) + ( 3 ; + 2.1') ,ill
X (4llk) + C?i + 4.1') X (-1Ok)
= -2Oi + 20j N-iii (a!
The rectangular conipincnls (if C, along the .v and y iixes are the iniiimcnl~
of the brcc system ahout these axes. Thus.
(C,), = -20 N-iri
(C,), = ?ON-Ill (h!
We can get the riiciments o f t h e foi-ce\ about [lie x aiid y a x e \ directly I " C,<= X l i 4 2Ilj \ ~ w
and thus generate [he ciimpoiieiits or [lie dcsircd ciiuple iiioiiienl <it. 117,

Accordingly, using rhc clt'meiitary definilion 01 l l i e iiioiiiciil 01 :I force I;igure 4,23, P;,I-allcl f,lrce sr,tr,ll,
about a line as presented earlier. we have
(e,)\ = -(10)(4j + (40K2) - ( 3 0 ! ( 2 )= -20 N-ni
(C,)? = (10)(2) - (40)(1) + (10)(4) = 2 0 N-iri
Thus, the moment of lhe force syslcin abmit the origin, ; ~ n dhcncc ahout
any point. i s 1lien [he desired couple niii~ncnt(Fig. 4.23Ih))

C, = -2Qi + 20jN-m
. . .. . . , ., ,.,... ..

N(iw rhal v e l i i i \ ~ cciriisidered the coiiccpl (if the siinplcsl rcsultant for
coplanaI and parallel hi-ce systems. wc wish to pi1 hach to tlic ,qewrdf;ww sys-
tems for a irioiiieiil. We Iciirned eai-lier ltial ~ ' caii c nlw;iys replace such ii systenr
iii r i g i d - h d y inechanich hy a single fhrcc F<and a single couple moinent C , iil
any chosen point. IC this ;ilw;iys tlie very simplest systeiii 1o1-rigid-body iiiech;rii-
ics? No. i t i s iiiit. '1.0 \how this. deciini~nisctlie couple iniinicnt C,, iiito t w o rec-
tangular c(iiiipoiicn1s (; arid peq~cndicularto the forcc and collinear with [he
liirce. respectively. We ciiii iiow concciu;ibly 1111)vethe force 10 ii specilic p a i d
kl piisiti(iii iuid ciin cliiiiiniile C,. thc c ~ i ~ i i p o n ciilciiuple
nl iiioiiiciil iioriiial 10 the
force. Hiiwever. there i s i i d i i n g that u'e can d(1 ahout thc C;, conipiinent of cou-

,cy1* %
'
Figure 4.24. Enamplci of thc v - c a l l c d
wrench. This is ,he \jmplcst leprearnt;ltj~,ll
ple inoiiient collincx (or parallrl) to the force. The rc;ixin Ibr this i s that any
inoveiiieiil OS thc forcc 10 a pafiillcl 1nisitioii i,/wiys introduces a couplc iiioiiienl
/~',rp~~it[l;(,i,fli~r
to thc liirce. Thus the ciinipiineiit
rialing C, we end up with the force c3
canniil he affected. By eliiiii-
;iid C, collinear with F,. This systcni i s tlii'
siniplcst iii tlie g e i i c r i case aiid il i\ c;illcd a w r ~ m d 7iscc Fig. 4.24). H(iwcver.
%'e shall nlit generally use the \ ~ r e n c tcoiicept
i in this text and will work instead
01 a general force \ystern. with llic rcsultiint hrcc F,<;uid tlie couplc iniimeiit C, iil m y chosen point.
4.20. Find the resultant of thc fvrce systcm at point A . The 100-
N. 200-N, and 900-N Iruds are at the centers r i f the pipe sections.

?'
I

500 Ih

YO0 N
c-d
i
j
400 N

Figure P.4.18. sin N


Figure P.4.20.
4.19. Compute the iesultnnt force bystem at A stemming from
the indicnted 50-lb force. What is the twist developed about the 4.21. A 20-kN car and an XO-kN truck are stoppcd (in a bridge.
axis of the shaft at A'! The 50-lh force is normal to the wrench. What is the resultant force system of these vehicles at the cenler
of the bridge'? At the center of the left end of the bridge? The dis-
tanceq given to truck and car are to respective centers of gravity
where we can concentrate the weights.

Ac-
/I
k l X +

Figure P.4.19. Figure P.4.21.


4.22. Two heavy machinery criltes (A weighs 20 kN and B 4.25. Find thr simplcw resuliilnt of the lul-ces shown acting o n
weighs 3 1 kN) are placed on a truck. Whilt is the resultant force the beam. Give thc intel-ccpt with the axis of the beam.
syblem at Ihc center of the rear axle'! The ~ e n t c r sof gravity 01 the
crates. where we can conccntriite the weights, are at the geometric I.5I)O It,
centers.

500 Ib

Figure P.4.25.
4.26. Find the . s i m p l ~ wredfarit of thc forces \hewn acting on
the pulley. Givr the intwcrpt with thc .t axib.

Figure P.4.22.

4.23. Replace the system of forces hy a iesultilnt at A


Figure P.4.26.
4.27. A inail raises a 50-lb bucket of water to the top of a brick-
layer's scaffold. Also. a Jeep winch i s used 10 m i x a 2In-lh load
of bricks. What i c the ,sinrple.sr resultant fi~rcciyrtem on the scaf-
fold'? Givr the iintercept. Consider the pulleys to bc frictionless
so that the 50-1b force and the 200-lb force are trtinimitted respec-
tivcly to the man and tu the Jeep.

Figure P.4.23.

4.24. Evaluate Farces F ; . F2, and F;, so that thr resultant of the
forces and torque acting on the plate is /ern in both force and cou-
ple moment. (Hint; If the resultant is zero for one point. w i l l it not Figure P.4.27.
be zero for any point? Explain why.)
4.2% Find the resullanl x 1 A .

I S O Ih I.ooo s
Figure P.4.24. Figure P.4.28.

I14
4.29. Compute the simplest resultant for the loads acting o n the 4.32. A parallel system of forces is such that: a 20-N force acts
beam. Give the intercept with the axis of the beam. at position x = 10 m, y = 3 m: a 30-N force acts at position x =
5 m, y = -3m; a SO-N force acts at position x = -2 m, y = 5 m.
v
(a) If all forces point in the negative z direction, give the
simplest resultant force and its line of action.
(b) If the 50-N force points in the plus idirection and the
others in the negative idirection. what is the simplest
resultant?

25'* S' 2 0 ' 4


Figure P.4.29.
4.33. What is the .simplrst resultant of the three forces and
couple shown acting on the shaft and disc'! The disc radius is 5 ft.
4.30. Find the .simpIm resultant for the fiirces. Give the location
of this resultant clearly.
/
SO0 Ib It

Figure P.4.33.

Figure P.4.30.

4.31. ~~~l~~~ the system of forces acting on the rivets of the 4.34. What is the simplest resultant for the system of forces?
plate by the simplest resultant. Give the intercept of this resultant Each square is 10 mm o n edge.
with the x axis.
y
I

It

I l + I I .-I--
.---

U
Figure P.4.31. Figure P.4.34.
1.35. What i s the simplc>t rculvant? Where docs i t s line 11f 1+-22'-I
icriori crash lhc .t ani\'!

Figure P.4.3X.
Figure P.4.35,

1.36. What i s thc simplest r e d t a n t 01 the loadings shown? Be


rure 1c, give its line d a u t i o n .
1110 N uesullilllt

Figure P . 4 3
Figure P.4.36.

1.37. T w o hoists arc operaled UII the w n c ovcrhzad track. Hoist


4 has a 1.000bkN I<iilil.arid hoisl N has a 4,000-kN load. Whal is
ihe r e d m l Cwcr syslcm at the left cnd 0 of the track'! Where
due\ the ,simpip.rr reiiiltiint f w c e act'.'

Figure P.4.37.

4.38. A I<,-hoy trailer weighs l h . 0 0 0 Ih atid i\ Ihded with :I


I5.000-1h hulldozcr A arid il I2.0011-1b front-rnd l o ~ d e M.
r What is
the siinplcst rcsultanl 1orce and where does i t act'! The weiphts ot
the michincs and trililer act at lhcir rchpeilivc centcis of gve\ity 20 k N
(C.G.I. Figure P.4.40

II 6
SECTION 4.5 DISTRIBUTED FORCE SYSTEMS I 17

4.5 Distributed Force Systems


Our discussions up to now have been restricted to discrete vectors-in partic-
ular, to point forces. Vectors as well as scalars, may also be continuously dis-
tributed throughout a finite volume. Such distributions are called vecror and
,sr.ulur,field,s,respectively. A simple example of a scalar field is the tempera-
ture distribution, expressed as T(x,y , ,II), where the variable t indicates that
the field may be changing with time. Thus, if a position x,,,yo. zl) and a time
fl) are specified, we can determine the temperature at this position and time
provided that we know the temperature distribution function (i.e., how T
depends on the independent variables x, y , z, and t). A vector field is some-
times expressed in the form F(x, y. z, t). A common example of a vector field
is the gravitational force field of the earth-a field that i s known to vary with
elevation above sea level, among other factors. Note, however, that the grav-
itational field is virtually constant with time.
In place of the vector field, it is more convenient at times to employ
three scalar fields that represent the orthogonal scalar components of a vector
field at all points. Thus, for a force field we can say:
fcxce component in .r direction = g(x, J’, i,
I)
force component in y direction = h(x, y, z,t)
force component in z direction = /(x. .y. i,f)

where g, h. and 1 represent functions of the coordinates and time. If we sub-


stitute coordinates of a special position and the time into these functions, we
get the force components F,. <., and F for that position and time. The force
field and its component scalar fields are then related in this way:
F(x, y . i, f) = n(x. y, ,It)i + h(x, y. z, t)j + l(x, y. t)k
i,

More often, the notation for the equation above is written


F(x. y. z, t ) = FJx. Y , z, i)i + F,.(x. y, z, t)j + F(x, y, z, t)k (4.1 1 )
Vector fields are not restricted to forces but include other quantities such as
velocity fields and heat-flow fields.
Force distributions, such as gravitational force, that exert influence
directly on the elements of mass distributed throughout the body are termed
body fiirce distributions and are usually given per unit of mass that they
directly influence. Thus, if B(r, y, z, t) is such a body force distribution, the
force on an element dm would be B(x. y . 7,t)dm.
Force distributions over a surface are called surfhceforce distributionsh
T(x. y , z, t) and are given per unit area of the surface directly influenced. A
simple example is the force distribution on the surface of a body submerged
in a fluid. In the case of a static fluid or of a frictionless fluid, the force from
the fluid on an area element is always normal to the area element and directed

“Surface forces are often called suriuce rrucrions in solid mechanica.


1 18 CHAPTER 4 EQIIIVALtNl FOR(.'I! SYSTEMS

i n toward thc hiidy. The force per unit area stemming Sriim such fluid action
i s c a l l e d p r ~ s s u r rand i s denoted a s p Pressure i s a scalar quantity. The direc-
tion of thc force resulting lroni a pressure on a surface is given by the uricn-
tatimi of the surfiicc. [You w i l l recall f r m Chapter 2 that an arm clement can
be considered as a vector which i s normal to thc arc3 clement and directed
outward from the enclosed body (Fig. 4.25).1 The infinitesimal force on the
area clement i s then h' 'Ivell 21s
Figure 4.25. Area vector
df = -1' &
A more specialiml. but nevertheleqs common, force distribution i s that
of a continuous load on a beam. This i s oftcn a parallel loading distribution
that i s synimctrical about the center planc .x?. of a beam, as illustrated i n Fig.
4.26. Various heights of hricks stacked on ii beam would he an example of
this kind of Iwading. We can replace such a Ii~adinghy an equivalent coplanar
distributioii that acts a l the cciilcr plane. The loading i s given per unit length
and i s denoted as M', the iiireiisif?. 01 loiidblg. Thc lorce on an element dx of
the heam, then. i s IV d r .

We have thus presenlcd force systeriis distributed throughout volumes


(biidy lorcesj, over surfaces (surlace forces or trxtionsj. and over lines. The
conclusions about resultants that were reached carlicr for general. parallcl,
and coplanar point force systems are also valid for these distrihuted force sys-
tenis. These concIusii~iisare true hecause each distributed force system can he
considered as an infinite nurnher US infinitesimal point lurces of the type used
heretofore. We shall illustrate the handling of force distributions i n the fol-
lowing cxmiples.

Case A. Parallel Body Force System-Center of Gravity.


Consider a rigid body (Fig. 4.27) whose density (masslunit volume) i s given
as p(x, y, zj. I t i s acted 011 by gravity, which. for a small body, may be con-
sidered to result i n a distributcd parallel lorce field.
Since we have here ii parallel system O S lorces i n space with the same
Figure 4.27. G r w i t y hody sense. we know that a single lorcc without a couple moment along a certain
force distrihution. line of action w i l l he equivalent to thc distribution. Thc gravity body furce
SECTION 4.5 DISTRIBUTED FORCE SYSTEMS 119

B(x, v , 2 ) given per unit mass is -gk. The infinitesimal force on a differential
mass element dm, then, is -g(p dv)k, where d v i s the volume of the element?
We find the resultant force on the system by replacing the summation in Eq.
4.8 with an integration, Thus,

FR = -J,g(pdv)k = -gk[ V pdv = -gMk

where, with g as a constant, the second integral becomes simply the entire
mass of the body M.
Next, we must find the line of action of this single equivalent force
without a couple moment. Let us denote the intercept of this line of action
with the xy plane as X, j ; (see Fig. 4.27). The resultant at this position must
have the same moments as the distribution about the x and y axes:

- FRY- --- gJ" YPdlI FRx = -gJV x p dc',

Hence, we have

x p dv y p dt.
x=-
~

y=-
M M
Thus, we have fully established the simplest resultant. Now, the body is reori-
ented in space, keeping with it the line of action of the resultant as shown in
Fig. 4.28. A new computation of the line of action of the simplest resultant
for the second orientation yields a line that intersects the original line at a
point C. It can be shown that lines of action for simplest resultants for all
other orientations of the body must intersect at the same point C . We call this
point the center ( f g r u v i t y . Effectively, we can say for rigid-body considera-
tions that all the weight of the body can be assumed to be concentrated at the
center of gravity.

I Line of action
om firpt onentation

X Line of action from


second orientation
Figure 4.28. Location of center of gravity

'Note that gp is the weight per unit volume. which is often given as y. the so-called specific
weight.
Find Ihc cciitcr 01 gravity of the tii;ingiilar block having a uniloriii dcnxily
p shown i n Fig. 4.20.
The totiil weight ~ S l t i chody i s easily c v i i l i ~ i i t c diis

= :'p(d,<.'2) (21)

To find 7.we w i l l equiitc the in11111c1iIo i I,;? ahoui the .I i i h i s with ihiit I
of the weight distrihution O S Ihc hlock. kicilit:~ic lhc lalter. we shall
'1'11
choo\c within the hlock h!/iuilc.~brrol elements whosc weights are ciisily
coinputed. A h Ihc inoriiciit 01 the weight o S ciicli clciiicnl ahout the I
axis i s 111 he likewise easily coniptiteil. Inlinilcsimal slices < i t thickncss (I?
paiallcl to the .r; plant! l u l f i l l (1111 requiicliiciils nicely. The weight 0 1 w c h
a slice i \ simply !:h cly),i,y. whci~c: i s Ihc height 01tlie \lice (scc Fig. 4.2'1).
because all points (11tht slice i i i c iit tlie siiiiic criiirdin;itc disliiiicc v irom
the .r axis. clc;irly the ~ i i i m c i ioft tlie weight 01 the \lice i s easily coiiiputed
a s -?(:/J i1yjp.q. By letting i' 11111 Sroiii l l 10 ( I during iiii i i i t c g ~ i t i ~wi c. ciiii
~ i c c o u ~lor
i t iill the \lice\ iii the hody. T l i i i s . \vc have

-,I<.:
I = /i:!(:/J </l'Jp,V !I11

The tcrni :ciin he cxpl-essed with the ;11d 171 similar lrimglrs in Ici-iii\ ol
lhc inlcgralion v;il-iahli. J

.- ~~
1'
<' (i

:= (;;J (CJ

We then have for tk.lh!. on r c p l x i i i g I.,,,using F:q. (a).


SECTION 1.5 DISTRIBUTED FORCE SYSTEMS 121

Example 4.12
Find the center of gravity for the body of revolution shown in Fig. 4.31.
The radial distance of the surface from they axis is given as

r = & y 2 ft (a:

y constant density p , is IO ft long, and has a cylindrical hole at


The k ~ d has
the right end of length 2 ft and diameter I ft.

‘/?
I- 7 ’ 4

IO’ -I
Figure 4.31. Body of revolution. Find center ofgravity.

We need only compute 7, since i t is clear that 2 = X = 0, owing to


symmetry. We first compute the weight of the body. Using slices of thick-
ness dy, as shown in the diagram, we sum the weight of all slices in the
body assuming it is whole by letting y run from 0 to I O in an integration.
We then subtract the weight of a 2-ft cylindcr of diameter I ft to take into
account the cylindrical cavity inside the body. Thus, we have, noting that
the area of a circle is nrz or nD2/4

Using Eq. (a) to replace 12 in terms of y , we get


122 CHARKR 4 EQlIIVALk~NTFORCE SYSTEMS

Example 4.12 (Continued)


To get y , we equate the moment of W about the x axis with that of the weight
distribution. For the latter, wc sum the momcnts ahout thc .v axis of the
weight of a11 slices, assuming first n c inside cavity. Then. we subtract fm111
this the moment about the .r axis of the weight of il cylinder corresponding to
the cavity in the body. Because p is constant, the center of gravity of this lat-
ter cylinder is at its geometric center s o that the monient arni froin thc ~Y axis
for the weight of the cylinder is clearly 9 ft. Thus. we have

Suppose as will be the case in Pmblern 4.43 that y (= pg), which


is the .specific fi,eiRht (weight per unit volume). varies with y. That is,
y = y ( y ) . Then for this problem, note that

also

Note here we cannot take the short cuts used in the original problem wherc
y was a constant,
SECTION 4.5 DISTRIBUTED FORCE SYSTEMS 123
Example 4.13
A plate is shown in Fig. 4.32 lying flat on the ground. The plate is 60 mm
thick and has a uniform density. The curved edge is that of a parabola with
zero slope at the origin. Find the coordinates of the center of gravity.
The equation of a parabola oriented like that of the curved edge of
the plate is
y = CX* (a) I

We can determine C by noting that y = 2 m when x = 3 m. Hence, Figure 4.32. Find center nf gravity
of plate.
2 = C * 9 (b)
Therefore,
c=2
9
The desired curve then is
y = ~
2 $
‘ 9-
Therefore,
= -1-
42
y”2 (C)

We shall consider horizontal strips of the plate of width d y


(see Fig. 4.33). Using the specific weight, which is weight per volume
and is equal to pg. we have for the total weight W of the plate:

where f is the thickness. We replace x using Eq. (c) to get


Figure 4.33. Use of horizontal strips.

Integrating, we get
2
W = r y + (1y 3 / * ) ( z ) ( = ry&(2)3” = 4ry N (d)
L’ 2 311
We next take moments about the x axis in order to get 7.Thus,
124 C'HAPTER 4 COLIIVAI.ENT FOKCL SYSTEMS

Example 4.13 (Continued)


Using 4ry i o r W from Eq. (d). we get, for v:
.y=$m I fl

Tii get i. we take miiments ahout the !axis, s t i l l utili7iiig the hori-
zontal strips of Fig. 4.33. The center of gravity of a strip is at its center
since y i s constant and s o the miiinent aim 1111- ii strip ahout tlic y a x i s i c .xi?.

W.? = 1;; ( r .r (l!)?, (F)


Continuing with the calculations. we liavc

On replacing W according to Eq. Id), we get fir.i:

.r=#m (,hl

Next, we proceed to get .X using vertical strips as shown i n Fig. 4.34.


Equaling moments of the weights of lhcsc vertical strips ahiiut the y axih
with that of the tntal weight W at its ccnlcr of gravity .I. wc gel oil rioting
that ( 2 - J) i s the length 0 1 Ihe strip

Figure 4.34. Use of vertical strips.

Using W = 4y1, we can now solvc for .r. l h u s , we again gel


7 = <I ni

Finally. i t i h clear that the ? ciiordinate i s zero for rehence .I;Y ill thc
centcr plane of the plate.
~ _-. - " ,, .
..I~___._

111the prcviiios problems, we used sliccs of the body having a thicknesses


rl? or d z . If the spccilic weight were ii fiinction of position. y(.i.
no1 readily uhe such slices, since wc cannot ziisily cxpirss the weight 01' such
iliccs iii a simple iniiniicr. The reason fix this i\ that in the .r and r directions the
dimensions 01 the elemen1 are finite. and s o y would vary in thcse din-ections
thimughout thc clement. If, however. we c h i m e an elenicnt that i s infinitesimal
t . s , as an inrinitesimal rectangular parallelepiped having vi11-
i n rill r l I r ~ i ~ l i i ~ t such
unie dx cl! 11:. then y ciin he aswmed to he constant throughout the clcincnt. The
wcight of the elcmcnt i s then easily seen to he y(d.r d? d:.), whcre the coordinates
of ycorrespond Lo the position o i the elenienl. We now illuslriite a simple case.
SECTION 4.5 DISTRIBUTED FORCE S YS TEMS 125

Example 4.14
Consider a block (see Fig. 4.35) wherein the specific weight y at comer A
is 200 Ihf/ft’. The specific weight in the block does not change in the x
direction. However, it decreases linearly by 50 IhWft’ in 10 ft in the y
direction, and increases linearly by 50 Ihf/ft’ in 8 ft in the z direction, as
has been shown in the diagram. What are the coordinates 2,g of the center
of gravity for this block’?

Figure 4.35. Block with varying y

We must first express y at any position P(x, y , z ) . Using simple pro-


portions, we can say

v
y = 2 0 0 - ~ ( 5 0 ) + q8S ‘O ) (a)
IO
= 200 - 5 y + 6.252 Ibf/ft’
We shall first compute the weight of the block (Le., the resultant
force of gravity), We do not use an infinitesimal slice o r rectangular rod of
the block, as we have done heretofore. With the specific weight varying
with both y and z , it would not he an easy matter to compute the weight
and moment of a slice or a rod. Instead, we shall use an infinitesimal rec-
tangular parallelepiped having volume dx dy dz, located at a position hav-
ing coordinates x, y , and z as has been shown in Fig, 4.36(a). Because of
the yanishingly small size of this element, the specific weight y can he
considered constant inside the element, and so the weight dW of the ele-
ment can he given asx

dW = y(dx dy dz) = (200 - 5y + 6.252) dr dy dz

“We are dcleting higher order quantities.


126 CIIAPTER 4 ~ I J I J I V A L E N IFORCE SYSTEMS

Example 4.14 (Continued)


T u include thc weight o l u l l such elenicnls in the block. we first let .v “run”
from 0 lo 4 ft while holding J and z fixed. Thr rectangular parallclcpiped
OS Fig. 4.3hla) then heconics a rectangular rod ac shown in Fig. 4.36(hl.
Having ruii its course. x i s no longer a variable i n this summation priicess.
Next. let y ”run” from 0 to IO while holding Iconstant. The rectangular
rod of Fig. 4.36(h) then bcciinies an infinitesimal slice. a s shown i n Fig.
4.361~).The variable y has thus run its course and ir. no longer a variablc.
This lcaves only the variable ;, and now we let r “run” froni 0 to X.
Clcady, we cover the entire hkick hy this process.
We can do this inathcmatically by a process called inid~ipleinrrfim-
tion. We pcrt~irmthree iiitcgrations, paralleling tlic thrcc steps oullined i n
the previous paragraph. Thus. we can lormulate W a s ffoll~iws:

We first consider integr;ition with reqpecl ti1 x holding ? and I constant.


That i c

J(:(200 - SJ + 6.25;)dr
As iii the firsl step set lorth in the previous paragraph, to go from a rectan-
gular pnrallelepiped to a rectangular rod, wc integrate with respect (o .i
from ,x = 0 tu .t. = 4 n,hile holding? and :constant. ‘Thus,
I
j(,(200 - 5y + 6.25:)rh = (2l~lIx
- S?X + 6.25:.*)1;
= xoo - 20y + 25;
With .v no longer a variable (since i t has run its course), the equation for W
becomes

Now, we hold 3 constant and integrate with respect t o y from 0 to IO. (This
takes us from a rectangular rod to ii slice.) Thuh,
(C)

Figure 4.36. (a) Infinitesimal element at


l b ) I runs from 0 IO 4. while i
P ( . y y, :);
and v are fixed, to form rcctangular rod:
( c ) ? runs from 0 to I O , while holding:
N o w ? has I-UII i t s cw~rse.and wc have fixed. 11, frrrm slice.

X
w=J 11
(7,000 + 250:) if:
SECTION 4.5 DISTRIBUTED FORCE SYSTEMS 127

Example 4.14 (Continued)


By integrating with respect to z. we sum up all the slices, and we have cov-
ered the entire block. Thus,

To get j , we equate the moment ahout the x axis of the resultant


force without a couple moment with the moment of the distribution. Thus,
using multiple integration as described above:

-(64,0OO)p = -I I /
R
n n
10 4

n'
v(200 - 5 y + 6.252) dx dy dz
Therefore, integrating with respect to x, then y. and then z as before,
we have
64,OOO.v = lRji"(200yx- Sy'x + 6.25yzx)/,,4 dydz
n o
= /,"I:" (800y - 20)'' + 25.~2)dy dz

= - 6,667 + 1,250z)dz
~ox(40,000

and
= [3 3 , 3 3 3 ~+ 1250 5* I = 307,000

y = 4.79 a

Because y dots not depend on x, we can directly conclude by


mpection that X = 2 ft.

Next, in the case of a body made up of simple shapes (subbodies) such


as cones, spheres. cylinders, and cubes, we can find the center of gravity of
the body by using the centers of gravity of the known subbody shapes. Thus,
we can say on taking moments about they axis that
y",a[(z)= X.w;(3' (4.12)

where W is the weight of the ith subbody and where [z), is the x coordinate to
the center of gravity of the ith subbody. Bodies made up of simple subbodies
are called composite bodies.
<- L2is
SECTION 4.5 DISTRIBUTED FORCE SYSTEMS I29

Case B. Parallel Force Distribution over a Plane Surface-


Center of Pressure. Let us now consider a normal pressure distribution
over a {dune surface A in the ,ty plane in Fig. 4.38. The vertical ordinate is
taken as a pressure ordinate, s o that over the area A we have a pressure distri-
bution p ( x , y ) represented by the pressure surface. Since in this case lhere is a
parallel force system with one sense of direction, we know that the simplest
resultant is ii single force, which is given as

Figure 4.38. Prcsure distribution

The position x , y can hc computed by equating the moments about they and x
axes of the resultant force without a couple moment with the corresponding
momcnts of thc distribution. Solving f<)rZ and 7,

x =
I p r [/A

J
~~ ~~

/I d.4

,:= iv dA
11 </A

Since wc know that 11 is a function of .r and y over the surface, we can carry
out the preceding integrations either analytically or numerically. The point
thus determined is called the center ofpressure.
(In later chapters. we shall consider distributed frictional forces over
plane and curved surfaces. In these cases, the simplest rcsultant i s not neccs-
sarily a single forcc as it was in the special case above.)
130 CHAPTkR 4 EQUIVALENT FORCE SYSTEMS

Example 4.16
A plate ABCD on which both distributed and point force systems act is
shown i n Fig. 4.39. The pressure distribution is given as
/ I = -4? + 100 psf (21)
Find the simplest resultant lor the system.
To get the resultant for-ce, we consider a strip dy along the plate as shown
in Fig. 4.39. The reason fix using buch a strip is that the prcssure 17 is uniform
along this stnp, as ciln he seen lroni the diagram. Hence, the force from the
pressure on the strip is simply / I dA = p[dy)lS). Thus. we can ~ i l ythat
fifl = -jSp(s,(m., - son
11

;t- -*!
Figure 4.39. Find simplest m u l l a n t .
FK = ( 2 0 ” - 500y)’ - 500 = -2,167 lb
3 ~rl

To get the position ~F,J of the resultant force FKwithout a couple moment.
wc cquate moments of FK about the I and y axes with that of the original
system. Thus. starting with the x axis, we have using strip d? as before:
-2,1677 = - j i ) ’ p ( s d y ) - (500)(2)

= -j$-4U.’ + 100)dU.- 1.000


- i.ooo = -4.125
Therefore,
7 = 1.904 ft
Now, considering they axis, we still use the strips dv because / I is uniform
along such strips. Howcvcr. the force <If=11 dA = p(S)[<fy) may he conyid-
ered acting at the center of the strip, and accordingly has a moment arm
about the ? axis equal to SI2 for each slrip. Hence, we can say that
2.167.r = I’2- pis(/y) +
I1
500
(sno)12)- :---
12
- q - 4 , ’ + IOO)dJ+ 1.000-41.7 = 5.125
2

- ~___._....I_... ~ --_ll-...--.......l.- ~

In a statlonay liquid. the pressure at the surface of the liquid is transmitted


uniformly Ihmughout the liquid. In addition, there is superposed a lineal-ly increas-
ing pressure with depth resulting from gravity acting on thc liquid. Thus. i l we
havc [I,,,,~, at the surface (often called the free surface). the prewtre in the liquid is
P = P,,,z,, + P
where y i s the specific weight of thc liquid and I’ is the depth helow the sur-
h c c . Thus, for a given liquid the presburc is unilorm at any constant distance
below the frcc surface. With this in mind. examine the following example.
SECTION 4.5 DISTRIBUTED FORCE SYSTEMS 13 1

Example 4.17
In Fig. 4.40 find the force on the door AB from water whose specific
weight is 9,806 N/mZand on whose free surface there is atmospheric pres-
sure equal to 101,325 Nlmz (= 101,325 Pa).q Also find the center of pres-
sure.
The pressure on the door AB is then
11 = P ~ + ~(y)(r)
, ~ = P , , , ~+ (y)(.s)(sin 45")
where s is the distance from 0 along the inclined wall OR. The resultant
force is then , Door A B

Figure 4.40. Door AB is exposed on


one side to water and on the other
side t o air.
= 1sy[101,325 + (9,806)(.707)~](2)ds
101,325s + (9,806)(.707)%

To get the center of pressure equate moments about 0 with that of the
resultant. Thus using the notation S to locate the center of pressure we have

1.199 x 10hs = 5
9

5
+
s [ ~ = , ~(y)(s)(sin45")](2)ds

= [lO,,32S$ + (9,806)(.707)%
I: (2)

:. 3 P 7.061 m

Clearly the total force on the door from inside and outside would
include the contribution of the atmospheric pressure on the outside. We can
e a d y determine this force by deleting p<,<,,,in the preceding calculations.'U

'The unit of pressure in the SI system is the pascal, where I pascal = 1 Pa = I Nlm'.
"We have touched here on the subject of hydrostnrics. For a treatment of this suhjcct
that may he similar to what you will study in your upcoming course in fluid mechanics, see
Shames, I.H.. Mechunics off nu id.^, 3rd Edition, 1992. McCraw-Hill, Inc.,Chapter 3

We finish this series of examples with a multiple integration problem.


*Example 4.18
What i s thc simplest rehulkint and the ccnier iif pressure l11r the prccsurc I'
distribution shown i n Fig. 4.41'?
Notice that thc pressure varics linearly i n the x and y directions. Thc
, !
211 N i m ~
pressure at any poinl x,y i n the distrihution can he givcn :I\ follows with
the aid of similar triangles:

/
= 2: + 6.1Pa
1,'igurc 4.41. N i r n u n i l u r m I~ICSSLIIC
diwihiitioii.
We cannot employ a convenient strip here along which the pressure i s u n -
form, an i n Example 4.16. For this reasnn we consider rectangular :ire3 elc-
ment d-r h. tn work with (scc Fig. 4.41). For such i1 siiiiill area. w ciiii
assume the pressure a s constant s o that p d x i/y i\ Ihc lirrce 1111 lhc cIcnicn1.
To find the resultant lnrce, we mint inlcgnlte over thc IO x 5 r e ~ t i l n g l e .
This integration involvcs twn vnri;ihle\ a n d i s again ii case o l m ~ , t t i p itif<,-
/~~
Rmtion. Thus, we can say that

wherein we first integrate with respect lo .x while holding v constant and


then inlcgrate with respcct t o s ( i n this way we cover the cntil-e 10 x 5 I-cc-
tangular arca). Thus. we have

Ill
= - j,, (II)\.+ 7 5 )(/y

FR = - 1,250 N
To find ~V for FH without il couple mon1cnt. we equate moments 01 F;?
about the x axis with that of the distrihittioti. Thus.

~I .,^.___.. __" ", ~ . . .. ., ,. " , , . ". . ... .. ~~


SECTION 4.5 DISTRIBUTED FORCE SYSTEMS 133

Example 4.18 (Continued)


Therefore,
v=
- -I 1 i n I 5( 2 ~ + 6 x ) ~ d x d y
1,250 n n
~ -I J
- '0 ( 2 v 2 r6 x+ 2~ ~ )dyl
5

1,250 o 0

= - 1In
1,250
(1oy2 + 7 5 y ) d y
10

10

p= 5.67 m

A5 for 3, we proceed a3 follow9


X(1,250) = 5, I,px d x dy
in 5

Therefore,
~

I=- ' SIn J5(2y


1,250 o o
+ 6 x ) x d x dy
- l,&oJ:0(2~$
_ +y)l 5

= ---I
I ' 0 (25y + 250)dy
1,250 n

x =,3
The center of pressure is thus at (3.00, 5.67) m.

Case C. Coplanar Parallel Force Distribution. As we pointed


out earlier, this type of loading may be considered for beams loaded symmet-
rically over the longitudinal midplane of the beam. The loading is represented
by an intensity function w(x) as shown in Fig. 4.26. This coplanar parallel
force distribution can he replaced by a single force given as
FR = -J w ( x ) d x j
We find the position of FRwithout a couple moment by equating moments of
FR and the distribution w about a convenient point of the beam, usually one of
the ends. Solving for .F, we get
134 CHAPTER 4 EQUIVALI:NT I'ORCE SYSTEMS

Example 4.19
A simply supported heam i s shown in Fig. 4.42 supporting a 1,000-lh
point h r c e , a S O 0 Ib-ft couple. and a coplanar. parabolic. distrihutcd load
w Ih/St. Find thc simplest i-esulliint of this force systcm.
To exprcss the intensity of loading lor the coordinate system shown
in the diagram. we hegin with thc gcneral iormulation
Lt,? = at + h
Note from the diagram that when A = 25 we have w = 0, and when Fig''re 4.42. Find qimQlest
reSU'tan'.

x = 6s. wc h w c IV = 50. Suh.jccting Eq. ( a ) to these conditions, wc can


determine fi and ti. Thus.

0 = 4251 + i, ih)
2.500 = iil6S) + h (e)
Subtracting. we can gel ( i as follows:
-2.500 = -4Iki

Therefore,
(i = 62.5
From Eq. (h). we gcl
h = -(25)(62.i) = -1,562.5
Thus, wc have
I+= h2.5.1 - 1,562.5 (d)
Summing forces. wc get i c r b;.
hi
F+( = -1,000 - J25 .,'62.5~t - 1,502.5 N I X (el

To integratc this. we may change rari;ihlcs as follows:

11 = 62.S.t - 1.562.5 i0
Thercfim.
N;LI = h 2 . i d t ~

Substituting into the intcgral i n Eq. ( e ) , wc have"


SECTION 4 5 DISTRIBUTED FORCE SYSTEMS 135

ExamPle 4.19 (Continued)

We now computer for the resultant without a couple as follows:


-~
- 2,3337 = -(10)(1,000) - 1 x>/62.5x
65

25
- 1,562.5 dx - 500 (g)

We can evaluate the integral most readily by consulting the mathematical


formulas in Appendix 1. We find the following formula (No 6):

In our case b = 62.5 and a = -1,562.5, so the indefinite integral for our
case is

Putting in limits, we have

..
= 65,333 - 0 = 65.333
Going back to Eq. (g), we can now solve easily for X, Thus,
x
~

= -_ 1_ [-(10)(1.000) - 65,300 - 5001


2,330

Z = 32.5 ft

Before closing, it will he pointed out that, for a loading function w(x).
the resultant [,'w dx, equals the area under the loading cuwe. This fact is
particularly useful for the case of a triangular loading function such as is
shown in Fig. 4.43. Hence, we can say on inspection that the resultant force
has the value 5 I FR = (;i(5i(1.000)

Fn = ~(5)(1,000)= 2,500 N
Furthermore, you can readily show that the simplest resultant has a line
of action that is (2/3) x (length of loading) from the toe of the loading.''
Thus, 4 without a couple moment is at a position (2/3)(5) to the right of a
(see Fig. 4.43). You are urged to use this information when needed. Figure 4.43. Triangular loading resultant.

"In Chapter 8, you will learn that the simplest resultant force for a distribution w(x) goes
through the cvnrrnld of the area under w(x). The centroid will be carefully defined at that lime.
Figure P.4.15.

Figure P.J.4.3. Figure P.4.46.


4.47. Show that thc volume and center 01 gravity of the conical 4.50. In Problem 4.49 find the distance from the ground to the
frustum are, respectively. center of gravity if the total weight is 2.37 x I O x kN.

r; + qr2 + r i ) *4.51. A plate of thickness 30 mm has a specific weight ythat


varies lincarly in the x direction from 26 k N / d at A to 36 kN/m3
and at R,and varies in they direction a i the square 01) from 26 kN/m’
at A to 40 kN/m‘ at C. Where is the cenler of gravity of the plate?

A sm n
crowyection I - h l Figure P.4.51.
Figure P.4.47.
4.52. You are looking down on n plate with a hole in it as shown.
Thc thickness has a constant value equal t o t and the specific weight
4.48. Find the center of gravity of the piate bounded hy a y is constant. Find the coordinates F, 7 o1Ihe e w e r qf,vuviq.
straight line and a parahola.

A
Figure P.4.52.
Figure P.4.48.
4.53. Find the center of gravity of the plate having uniform
4.49. A massive radio-wave antenna for detcction of signals thickness and uniform specific weight. You are looking down
from outer space is a body of revdutinn with a parabolic face (see onto the top of thc plate.
the diagram). These antennas may be carved from rock in a valley
?’
I

away from other disturbing signals. What would the antenna


weigh if invde Srom concrete (23.6 kN/m’) for locatiun in a
remrxe desert area’!

Figure P.4.49. Figure P.4.53.

137
4.54. Thc tup view of a platc is shown. Find center 01 grevit! V.57. Suppose in Pmhlem 4.12 that
cnordinatcs r, v.
.f = ( . O I ~ k + 2 1 + . k ) k ot./lhni
Find Ihe .sinrplr.sr resultant for p = 450 Ihmlfl'. Find the plopel-
Y i s conslant line of action.
?
and thickness I
.2 m -1 .I r
nd i s constant 4.58. After il fast stop and swerve 10 Ihc left. the load of sand
(specific wcight = I S kNhn') in a dump truck i s i n the positirm
shown. What i s thc simplest resultan1 force on thc truck ti-om
thc sand and where does i t act'! If the truck was full (with a I c v d
tup) hcforc thc stop, how inuch sand spillcd'.' U w the results of
Problem 4.46.

.2 "I
Figure P.4.54.

4.55. The thin circular rod has a weight of MI N/m. What i s the >
coodinarc of i t s C C ~ ~ CofI gravity?The rud fumis me-half of a circle

Figure P.4.58.
In Problems 4.5Y rhmufiir 4.62 U.IP rhc k n o w , posiliom o/ <cnfe~.s
of ,q'at,iry of ,simple .)hiipc,.s.

4.59. A n I-heain cantilwered out from a wall weighs 30 Ihlft


and support\ a 300-1h hoist. Steel (4x7 Ihift') cover plates I i n
thick are welded on thc hcam near the wall to increme the carry-
Y
ing capacity o f the heam. What i s the moment at the wall duc t o
Figure P.4.55. the weight ofthe reinforced b c m and the hoisted load of4.000 Ih
at thz outermost position of the hoist? Whilt is thc .sinzplv.st resul-
4.56. Find J for the uentcr of gravity of the horizontal plate with tant force and its location'?
a hole in i t .

Im

5m

Figure P.4.56.
I Figure P.4.59.

138
4.60. The bulk materials trailer weighs 10,ooO Ib and is filled 4.62. Find the center of gravity of the body shown. It has a con-
with cement ( y = 94 Ib/ft’) in the front compartment (sections 1 stant specific weight throughout. Cone and cylinder are on block
and Z), and half-filled with water ( y = 62.5 Ib/ft3) in the rear surfaces.
compartment (sections 3 and 4). What is the simplest resultant Cimeh=.Ilm
force, and where does it act? What is the resultant when the water
is drained? Use the center of gravity and volume results from
Problem 4.47 (conical frustum).

Figure P.4.62.
4.63. Find the .simplest resultant of a normal pressure distri-
bution over the rectangular area with aides a and b. Give the coor-
dinates of the center of pressure.

P
1’ 2 Trai1erC.G. 3 4
Figure P.4.60.

4.61. Find the coordinates (x, y), vf the center of gravity of the Figure P.4.63.
loaded conveyor system. The centers of gravity of the crates C
4.64. Find the simplest resultant acting on the vertical wall
and D are at their geometric centers. WE is the weight of the frame
ABCD. Give the coordinates of the center of pressure. The pres-
whose C.G. is at its geometric center.
sure varies such that p = E/Cv + I ) + F psi, withy in feet, from
IO psi to 50 psi, as indicated in the diagram. E and F are constants.

We= 1001b
Wc=80lb
WD = 300 Ib
WE= 1,000lb
2 WBELT = 5 Ib/ft I-
Figure P.4.61. Figure P.4.64.

139
4.65. One lloor of a warehouse i s divided into lour area?. Area I 4.68. (a) Find the torque about axis i\H from thc wrcocl~.
i s s t a c k 4 high with TV scts such that thc distrihutcd load i s (h) Find the torque ahout axih An
lroni lhc distrihutcd
p = 120 Ihlft2.A r m 2 has refrigerators with 11 = 65 Ibift'. Area 3 loads. ( H i m ; I.ooh dowm lirwn a h w e to hclp vicw
has stcreos stacked s o that 11 = XO Ih/ft2. Area 4 has wa.;hing prohlcm.)
machines with 11 = SO Ihlft'. What i q thc simplest resultant force
and where does i t act'!

1- 100'
t

Figure P.4.65.
4.66. Consider a prcssurc distrihution 1, fbrminp a hemispherical
surpace over a domain 01 radius 5 in. IS the inaximuni pressure i s Ill m
5 Pa, what i s the s i m p k s l resultant from this prcs\urc distrihution'!

I' Figure P.4.68.

4.69. For the system 01 lorccs shown. determine the turquc


ahout the a x i s going trorn A t o B. N o i r : 'The 100-N force and thc
triangular load distribution are i n the y: planc and the 100-N-m
couple i s mi the tup facc d thc rcuiimpular hux.

v
s(m)
Figure P.4.66.

-
4.67. A reclangular lank contains watcr. If the tank i s rotated
clockwise IO" ahout an axis normal t o the page. what toque i s
required to maintain the configuration? Width o f tank i s I 11.

1-
x it
___

2-1,+- 2-1,
t
Figure P.4.67. Figure Y.4.6Y.
4.70. A manornerrr is a simple pressure measuring device. One 4.12. (a) Calculate the force on the door from all fluids inside
such manometer called B U rube is shown in the diagram. The tank and outside. The specific gravity of the oil is 0.8. This
contains water including the tube to level M where mercury i s pre- means that the oil has a specific weight y which is 0.8
sent. M and N are at the same Icvel. What is the gage pressure times lhat of water (y,,, = 62.4 Ihlft'). Note that a
(ie., the pressure a b w z atmosphere) at point LI in the tank for the uniform pressure on the surface of a liquid extends
following data: undiminished throughout the depth of the liquid.
(b) Determine the distance from the surface of the oil to
d , = .2 111 d, = . 6 m yH:o = 9,806 N/m3 the .rimpIrst rrsultant force on the door from all fluids.
y,, = (13.7)(yHP) Nim'

[ H i n t : M and N are at the same level and are joined by the


same fluid, namely mercury. Hence, the pressures there are
equal.]
t, ft

2qS 10 i t

ft

Figure P.4.72.

Mercury
Figure P.4.70.

4.71. Imagine a liquid which when stationary stratifies in such a 4,73, Ar what height
will the water the door to
way that the specific weight is proportional to the square root of The door is wide, Neglect friction and the weight
the pressure. At the free surface, the specific weight is known and o f the door.
has the value & What is the pressure as a function of depth frvm
the free surface? What is the resultant force un one face AH of
a rectangular plate submerged in the liquid! The width of the plate
is b.

piitm

X
36 kN

Figure P.4.71. Figure P.4.73.

141
4.74. Find the krcc on the door front the inside and uulsiile 4.77. A hlock I ft thick i h suhniergcd i n water. Computr thr
prebsureh. Give the poritiuri of the re%dlml lurce ahvvc the siinplest resultant force and the center of prehsure uti [he huttom
base of the door. The specific grevity .S of the oil i s 0.7, i.c., .;urt~icc.Take y = 62.4 Ih/tt'.
x>,,= K.7)Yk, 0.

/p\ ,,Top i\ ripen

Figure P.4.74.

4.75. Find the total f k x o n door Ail fri,m fluid\. The spccific
gravity S o l a fluid i h y; .,",J x , ~~.
Take$>,, = 1l.h. Find the pinition Figure P.4.77.
of this force from thc hottuirlof the dour.
*4.78. Wha1 i s thc r ~ s ~ l t m
force
l from wiler and where does i l
act on thc 40-m-high circular concrctc d a m hetwero two wall, of
a rocky gorge? (Water wcishs Y.XO6 N l m ' . )

I?tl

H
40
t-
111

J it Tup "icw
Figure P.4.75 Figure P.4.78.

4.79. The weight of the wire AHC'L) per unit length. w, incrcascs
4.76. What i \ the simplest r5sd13111 flircc t r i m the water and linearly lr<m4 orlft at ,t ti) 2 0 o,lft nl 11. Where is thc center 01
where due\ i t acl un the h O - m - h ~ ~X00-m-laog
h rtraight canhiill gravity <,1thc wire?
dam'! (Water weigh, O.XO6 N/m'.1

Figure P.4.76. Figure I'.4.79


4.80. Find the center of gravity of the wire. The weight per unit 4.82. At what distance ifrom point A can the system of thin
length increases as the square of the length of wire from a value of rods be suspended so that it will just balance? Use the formula
3 ozlft ai A until it reaches the value of 8 ozlft at C. It then developed in the previous problem for the radial distance to the
decreaaes I orJft for every 10 ft of length. 360r. 9
center of gravity of a thin circular rod, namely -
E9 s'n-i
Y

I,
W.
= .IR m
= 500 Nim

Figure P.4.80.
4.81. What is the center of gravity coordinate y, for a thin circu-
lar rod shown in the diagram? It has a weight of w Nlm. The rod is 1 4; = 70'
placed symmetrically about they axis. The angle Q is in degrees. Figure P.4.82.

Y
Figure P.4.81.

4.6 Closure
We now have the tools that enable us to replace, for purposes of rigid body
mechanics, any system of forces by a resultant consisting of a force and a
couple moment. These tools will prove very .helpful in our computations.
More important at this time, however, is the fact that in considering condi-
tions of equilibrium for rigid bodies we need only concern ourselves with this
resultant to reach conclusions valid for any force system, no matter bow com-
plex. From this viewpoint, we shall develop the fundamental equations of std-
tics in Chapter 5 and then employ them to solve a large variety of problems.

143
4.88 A Seep weigh5 I I kN and has hoth a front winch and a r e a y = Ill* (x' + 3x) ;:
powcr takeoff. The tension in the winch cable is 5 kN. The puwer
Parabola
take-off develops 300 N-tn of torque T ahout an axis parallel to
the x axis. If the driver wcighs XU0 N, wh;it is the resultant force
sy\tem at the indicated center of gravity of the Jeep where we can
consider the weight of thc Jcep to he concentrated?

c1 1 Scencenter

x I-

-
-1.Sm-
3m
ii +1.2m
1 4.91.
Figure P.4.')0.
Find the torque about axis OH from the system of forces.

Figure P.4.XX. 7

4.89. What is thc .simpk~tr e d t a n t for the forces and couple F =200i+300kN
actin3 011 the bean'!

311 Ih
4
Figure P.4.91.

92. A rectangular plate chown as ARC can rotate about hinge


E . What length 1 should RC be so there is zero tarquc about H
100 Ih from the water, air. and weight o l thc platc'! Take this weight as
Figure P.4.89. 1,000 Nlm o l Icngth. Thc width i ? I m. x,,~= 9,806 Nlm'.

4.90. A parabolic body of revolution has cut out of it a second


parabolic body uf revolution starting at A and forming a sharp
edge at H with x r o dopz at A .
(a) What is I' as a function ol .r for the cut-out body of
revolution?
(h) Set up an integral for computing W (weight) and then
thc center of gravity coordinate i.
Notr; y vxic:; with x. Do not solvc the integral. Figure P.4.92.

I45
4.93. An open rectangular bank u t water 1 5 partially filled with
water. The dimensions iirc \hewn.
t i l ) r k t e r n t i n e thc hrcc on ihc h m w n 01 thc t a d l r o n ~
the water.
(hl Detemmine the force on the donr <hmvn at thc Cidc 01
the tank. Indicate the pwition of this firrcc 1r<m l l i c
bottom of the tank.
Note that the atmospheric pressure develops equal and opposite
forces on both sides of the door and hence yizlds n o inut f<,rcc.

,
,i
Figure P.4.93.

4.94. Sandhags are piled on a bean. Each hag i h I 11 witlc and


weighs 100 Ih. What i s the simplcst resultant force imd where doe&
it act’?What linear mathematical function ofthe di\crihuted Ioiiil ciin
he used to represent the sandhap <rvecthe left 1 ft 01the tieiiiii’l

Figure P.4.94.
4.95. A cantilcvcr b u m i s subjected t o a linearly w q i n p I h d
over p d n 01 i t s length. What i s the .sit!rpl<ml rcwlt:int f~rrce.and
where does it act’! What i c the moment :It thc suppomd cnd?

146
4.98. Find the resultant force system at A for the forces on the 4.100. The L-shaped concrete past supports an elevated railroad.
~~

bent cantilever beam. BC is parallel to z axis The concrete weighs 150 Ib/ft3. What is the simplest resultant
Force from the weight and the load and where does it act? Load
acts at center of top surface.

40,000 Ib

15'

1
Figure P.4.100.
Figure P.4.98.

4.101. Explain why the system shown can he considered a sys-


4.99. (a) Find equations describing both parabolas. tem of parallel forces. Find the simplesr resultant for this system.
(h) Using rjerfical strips (and a composite body approach), The grid is of squares,
find weight of plate in terms of yt.
(c) Using vaticill strips, find X of C.G.

( I O , - 3) ft X

Figure P.4.99. Figure P.4.101.

I47
l.102. A plate 01 thickness f has as the uppcr edge a parabolic
:uwc with infinite slope at the origin. Find the x, y coordinates 01
hc criitei ut gravity fnr this plate.

Figure P.4.1U4.
*4.105. A block has 8 rectangular portion removed (darkened
region). If ths spccific weight is given a h

2'
tind x for the CCIIISI of gravity
Figure P.4.102.

1.103. A rectangular tank conmitih a liquid. At the tup U Ithe


iquid there i s a pressure ol ,1380 Nlmm' absolute. What i s the
/7
A-
.iinplesl resultatit lbicr in the inside surface of the dour AH!
Nhwe is thc ceiitcr ot pressuse relative to the bottom of the door'!
rake y = 8,190 Nlm' for the liquid. I?m

y
Air

f
5m / I2 n,

Figure P.4.105.
Liquid 4.106. Compute the sirnl,ics1 resultant fix the loads shown act^
irig un the simply supported beam. t i i v r the line of action

bigure P.4.103.

l.104. The sprcilic weight ot thr material i n a right circular


m e varies directly :IS the s q u a r ~Crt the distance? from the hase.
f 1;, = S O Ih/ft3 is the cpecific weight at the base. and i f y' = 70
hlft' is the specific wcight at the tip, when, i \ the center u l g r a v -
ly ,!I the cone'! (Szz hint in Pmhlrm 4.45.)

48
4.107. Fmd the center ot gravity ot the plate. *4.109. The pressure pO at the corner 0 of the plate is SO Pa and
increases linearly in they direction by 5 P d m . In the x direction, it
increases parabolically starting with zero slope s o that in 20 m the
pressure has gone from S O Pa to 500 Pa. What is the simplest
resultant for this distribution'! Give the coordinates of the center
of pressure.

--v

Figure P.4.107. ~/c-'"m+

Figure P.4.109.

4.110. A sluice-gate door in a dam is 3 m wide and 3 m high.


The water level i n the dam is 4 m above the top of the door. The
4.108. Find the center of gravity of the W s s . All members have gate is opened the level f a l l s 4.,, What is the
the same weight per unit length. resultant force on the closed door at hoth water levcls? Where du
the forces act (i.e., where i s the "center of pressure" i n each case)?
Water weighs 4,806 Nlm'.

Figure P.4.108. Figure P.4.110.

149

__ ~ ~ ~~
~-
4.111. A cylindrical tank of watcr is rotated at cmbtilnt angular 4.112. Firid lhc 'i arid Y coordinates UT the center of gravity 0 1
speed Wuntil the water ceases t o c h m g c shapc. The result is a Srw the hodich \hewn. Thehe c i i n s i q of:
surface which, from lluid inrchaiiicr cansidcrations, is that of a ( a ) A plate AH('whose thicknsss I = SO niin.
paraboluid. If the prcswl-e varics direclly as the depth hclow Ihc (hj A rod I> 01d ~ i m z t e r.? m :md leneth 3 m.
I r e sutfke. w h a t i \ the w s d ~ m force
t on a qu:idmnt ~ r fthe hasr (i.) A hlock F whocc thickness (not \huwn) is 3 in.
01the cylirrder? Take y = 62.4 Ihlft'. [ H i m : Use circular strip in 'Ihc density of thc three bodich i \ the SJIIIC.
quadrant having area l l 4 ~ 2 n - d r ) . ~

Figure P.4.111. Figure P.4.112.

I SO
Equations
of EquiIibrium
5.1 Introduction
You will recall from Section 1.10 that apurficle in equilibrium is one that is
stationary or that moves uniformly relative to an inertial reference. A body is
in equilibrium if all the particles that may be considered to comprise the body
are in equilibiium. It follows, then, that a rigid body in equilibrium cannot be
rotating relative to an inertial reference. In this chapter, we shall consider
bodies in equilibrium for which the rigid-body model is valid. For these bod-
ies, there are certain simple equations that relate all the surface and body
forces, or their equivalents, that act on the body. With these equations, we can
sometimes ascertain the value of a certain number of unknown forces. For
5
instance, in the beam shown in Fig. 5.1, we know the loads F; and and also W
the weight W of the beam, and we want to determine the forces transmitted to Figure 5.1. Loaded beam.
the earth so that we can design a foundation to support the structure properly.
Knowing that the beam is in equilibrium and that the small deflection of the
beam will not appreciably affect the forces transmitted to the earth, we can
write rigid-body equations of equilibrium involving the unknown and known
forces acting on the beam and thus arrive at the desired information.
Note in the beam problem above that a number of steps are implied.
First, there is the singling out of the beam itself for discussion. Then, we
express certain equations of equilibrium for the beam, which we take as a
rigid body. Finally, there is the evaluation of the unknowns and interpretation
of the results. In this chapter, we will carefully examine each of these steps.
Of critical importance is the need to be able to isolate a body or part of
a body for analysis. Such a body is called afree body. We will first carefully
investigate the development of free-body diagrams. We urge you to pay
special heed to this topic, since if is the must important step in the solving of
mechunics problems. An incorrect free-body diagram means that all ensuing

151
+
w I 5.2 The Free-Body Diagram
I<
SECTION 5.2 THE FRELBODY DIAC;KAM 153

I M Rollcra
(ill

(CI

Figure 5.6. Standard connections

In general, to ascertain the nature (11 the fnrcc system that a body M is
capable of transmitting to a second body N through some connector or sup-
port, we may proceed in the following manner. Mentally move the bodies rel-
ativc to each other in each of three orthogonal directions. In those directions
where relative motion is impedcd or prevented by the connector or support,
there can be a Sorce component at this connector or support in a free-body
diagram ofeither body M or N. Next, mentally rotate bodies M and N relative
to each other about thc orthogonal axes. In each direction about which rela-
tive rotation is impeded or prevented by the connector or support, there can
bc a couple-moment component at this connector or suppon in a free-body
diagram of body M or N. Now as a result of equilibrium considerations of
body M or A',certain force and couple-moment components that are capable
of being generated at a support or connector will he zero for the particular
loadings at hand. Indeed. one can often readily recognize this by inspection.
For instance, consider the pin-connected beam loaded in a coplanar manner
shown partially in Fig. 5.7. I f we mentally move the beam relative to the
gnmnd in the I,y. and 7 directions, we get resistmce from the pin for each Figure 5.7. Pin connectim
direction, and so the ground at A can transmit force components A,, A,, and
154 CHAPTER 5 IiQlJATIONS OF EQLIILIRRIIJM

A ~ Howe\~cr.
. hecause the loading is coplanar iii the .i\' plane, the force coni-
poncnr A _ niuit bc Lero and can he deleted. Next. inlentally rotale the be;m
rclati\'c to the ground at A about the three orthogonal axes. Because of the
smooth pin conlicetion. thcrc i s t i i ) resistance ahout the : axis and MI
M; = 0.But there i s resistancc ahout t h c ~ and? r axcs. Howevcr, the coplanar
loading iii the .r?. plane cannot e x t i t iiiorncnts ahout the ~r arid s axes. and s o
the couple inioiiients M , and M, arc 721-0. All told. then. we jus1 have Icirce
cc)mp~~nenls A , and A , a1 the pin connection, a\ hiis heeri shown earlicr in
Fig. S.h(bJ.whcrciii w e rclicd on physical reasoning for this result.

5.3 Free Bodies Involving


Interior Sections
l,tt us consider;^ rigid body i n equilihriuiii as shown i n Fig. 5.8. Clearly, every
portinti ( i t t h i s hocly inul iilso he in equilihriuin. If we consider the hody as
two pirts A and 8.w e can present cithei- part i n a lice-body diagram. To do
this, we niust includc 011 the poition chosen to he the free hody the Ibrces f i m t
t x i s c at the coniinon section (Fig. 5.Y). The suilacc between
flip o t / i ( , t - / ~ u rthat
B \
both seetioils may he any curved or plane surface, and ovcr i t there will hz a
~ dislrihution. I n the general c a e . wc know that such ;I distrih-
c ~ n t i n u o uforce
utioii can he replaced by a single force and ii single couple nioinent (at any
Figure 5.8. Rigid hod) i n cquilihrium chosen point) and this has been done in the tiec-hody diagram or parts A aiid
B in Fig. 5.4. Nolice that Newton's third law has heen ohserved.

Figure 5.9. krcc hodics ot parts .1 and H


As a special case. consider a beam with one end cmbeddcd i n a iiiassivc
wall (canlilcver beam) aiid loaded within the .x:v plane (Fig. 5. IO). A free hndy
Figure 5.10. Cantilc\w beam. 01 the p o r t i m (if Ihc heam cxteiiding from Ihe w a l l i s shown i n Fig. 5. I I
Recause 01 the geometi-ic symmetry OS the hcam ahout the .(I plane and the
Iact that thc loads arc i n this pliine. thc cxposcd forces i n the cut section can
he considered coplanar. Hence, these exposed I i r c e q ciin he replaced by a
single lorce and ii single couplc inonienl i n the centcr plane. and il is the usuiil
practice to dccomposc the I'orcc into components F, and PI. Allhough a line 111
actiori for the liirce can hc found that would enahlc us to climinate the couple
ninlnent. i t i s dcsirahle in slructural problems to work with an equivalent i y s -
IV tcni that has the lorcc p i n g through the center 01 the heam cross section.
Figure 5.1 1. Free-hdy diogr;im arid thus to liave a couple moment. 111 the iicxt section. we will see how F a n d
01cmtilever heam. C. can he ;iscertiiincd.
SECTION 5.3 FREE BODIES INVOLVING INTERIOR SECTIONS 155

Example 5.1
As a further illustration of a free-body diagram, we shall now consider the
frameZ shown in Fig. 5.12, which consists of members connected by fric-
tionless pins. The force systems acting on the assembly and its parts will
he taken as coplanar. We shall now sketch free-body diagrams of the
assembly and its parts.

Free-body diagmm of the entire assembly. The magnitude and direction of


the force at A from the wall onto the assembly is not known. However, we
know that this force is in the plane of the system. Therefore, two components Figure 5.12. A frame.
are shown at this point (Fig. 5.13). Since the direction of the force C i s known,
there are then three unknown scalar quantities, A,, A,, and C , for the free body.
A

Free-body diagram of the component parts. When two members are


pinned together, such as members DE and AB or DE and BC, we usually
consider the pin to be part of one of the bodies. However, when more than
two members are connected at a pin, such as members AB, BC, and BF at
B, we often isolate the pin and consider that all members act on the pin
rather than directly on each other, as illustrated in Fig. 5.14. Notice four
sets of forces that form pairs of reactions have been enclosed with dashed 1,OOU Ih
lines. The fifth set is the 1,000-lb force on the pin and on the member BE
Figure 5.13. Free-body diagram
of frame.
I

Figure 5.14. Free-body diagrams of parts.

frame i s it system of connected straight or benr, long. slender members where some
of the connecting pins are not at the ends of the members as is the case for structures that we
will study kter called I T U I S ~ S .
Example 5.1 (Continued)
Do niil he cwncerned about the pi-nper ,SPII,SP [if an unknown force
ciimlmient that yrw draw 1111 the free-body diagram, for y o u m a y choose
cithei- a pnsiti\'e or n c g a t i x scnse for tlicsc components. When the \piilues
01 these qi~antities:ire ascertained by methods iil stiltics, the proper sense
(breach coinponcot can then he estahlishcd: hut. liavins chosen a seiisc for
a mniponcnt, you must he sure that the rrw(.tion to this ciimponent has the
oppasir<, s e i i s c ~ ~ ~ - eyiru
l s e aril1 \ irilate Newtiin's third law.

Free-body d i q r n m ofportion of the assemhly to the right o f M - M . I n


making a free body 01 the portion to the right [if section M-M (see
Fig. 5 . ISa). we must rememhcr to piit i n the weight of the portions n l the
inernhers remaining &v the cut liiis hccn made. At the two cut5 made hy
h--M we must replacc coplanar fiirce distrihutions hy resulkints. as i n the
case nf the previously coiisidercd cnntilcvcr heaiii. This is accomplished
by inserting two h r c c co~iipiincnlsnsu;illy normal and tangential to the
cross section and a couple mnnient a h \vas done for the cantilever bcam.
Note i n Pig. 5. I X b ) tliat there arc w v c n unhnown scalar quantities lor this
free-body diagram. They iirc C',, CL. t;.F,. t;?. and Fd. Apparently. the
numher 01 unknowns varieq widely lor the various free bodies that may
he drawn O r thc system. For this reawn. you nitist choose the free-body
diagram that is suitahle 101- your ncedr wilh snmz discretion in ordcr ti)
eflectively solvc l i r the desii-ed unknowiis.
SECTION 5.3 FREE BODIES INVOLVING INTERIOR SECTIONS 157

Example 5.2
Draw a free-body diagram of the beam AB and the frictionless pulley in Fig.
5.16 (a). The weight of the pulley is W, and the weight of the beam is K8.

Figure 5.16. (a) Beam AB: (b) Free-body diagram of AB;


(c) Free-body diagram of Pulley D

The free-body diagram of beam AB is shown in Fig. 5.16(b). The


weight of the beam has been shown at its center of gravity. Components U,
and U,, are forces from the pulley D acting on the beam through the pin
at B. The free-body diagram of the pulley is shown in Fig. 5.16(c).
Some students may he tempted to put the weight of the pulley at U in
the free-body diagram of beam A B . The argument given is that this weight
“goes through B.” To put the pulley weight at U on free body AB is strictly
speaking an error! The fact is that the weight of the pulley is a body force
acting throughout the pulley and does not act on the beam UD. It so hap-
pens that the simplest resultant of this body force distribution on D goes
through a position corresponding to pin B. This does not alter the fact that
this weight acts on the pulley and nor on the beam. The beam can only feel
forces U, and U, transmitted from the pulley to the beam through pin U .
These forces are related to the pulley weight as well as the tension in the
cord around the pulley through equations of equilibrium for the free body
Example 5.3
We finish this series of free-hody diagrams with a three~diineiisional
case. In Fig. 5.17(a) we sliou' a structure having h;ill-joint connections at
A and n, a fixed-end support at U and. finally. at i" the column R resting
directly on the foundation. Draw the frcc-body diagratn fcir the slruclure.
We show the frcc hody diagr;nn O r this case i n Fig. S.I7(h).

"5.4 looking Ahead-Control Volumes


I n rigid-body irw<./iuiri(,swc use Ihc free hody whcrein wc isolate a hody or a
portion ( f a hody and wc identify all the external f i m e 7 acting on the body so
that we can employ Newtiin's l a b .
In ./7uid mw/wiiii.s. we may either make :I free body of some chosen
chunk ot lluid (here i t i s called a system). but more likely i t w i l l be more prot-
itable to identify some volume i n space involving fluid flow through the vol-
unic. Such a v(iIu~iici s celled ii ( * i t i f r . d inlinfne. Here, as in the case of a free
body, wc must specify crll the cxrrrnol fi)rms such as triictions o n the hound-
ing suifaccs of the conrrol v ~ l u m eand. i n addition, hody forces on the mater-
ial inside the c o n t r ~ lvoluiiic. Thih identification and force specification i s
needcd to ensure, i n appropriate equations, that Newton's law and other laws
iire satisfied for the fluid and other bodies inside the control voluiiic at any
Lime f.
Thos. you must dcveliip sensitivity at this early stage o f your studies in
depicting cxternal fotres fiir a frcc hody. The ~ a m ecarc w i l l he needed in
your upcoming courses i n lluid nicchanics.
5.1. Draw the free-body diagram of the gas-grill lid when it is 5.3. Draw a free-body diagram of the A-frame
lifted at the handle to a 45" open position.

Figure P.5.1.

5.2. A large antenna is supported by three guy wires and rests on B


large spherical ball joint. Draw the free-body diagram ofthe antenna. Figure P.5.3.

5.4. Draw complete free-body diagrams for the member AB and


for cylinder D. Neglect friction at the contact surfaces of the
cylinder. The weights of the cylinder and the member are denoted
as y , and W,,, respectively.

Figure P.5.2. Figure P.5.4.


5.11. Draw lire-body diagrams of each pan of the me-branch
trimmer.

Branch 2 3
Figure P.5.11.
Figure P.5.14.
5.12. Draw free-body diagrams for the two booms and the body
E of the power shovel. Consider the wcight of each part to act at a
central location. (Regard the .;havcl and payload as concentrated 5,15, Draw a free-body diagra,n of members CG, AG, and the
forces, W, and W,,., respectively.) disc B. Include as the only weight that of disc B . Label all forces.
(Hitit: Consider the pin at G as a scparate free body.)

P
Figure P.5.12.
Figure P.5.15.
5.13. Draw the free-body diagram for the hulldozer, B , hydraulic
ram, R,and tractor, T. Cunsidcr the weight of cach part,R, X, and T.
5.16. Draw the free-body diagram of the horizontally bent can
tilevered beam. Use only X:I components of a11 vectors drawn.

..

Figure P.5.13.

5.14. Draw a free-body diagram of the whule apparatus and of


each of its parts: AB. AC, BC, and I). Include thc weights of all
bodies. Label forces. Figure P.5.16.

16
5.5 General Equations of Equilibrium
For every free-hody diagram. we can replace the system of forces and couples
acting on the hody by a single lorce and ii single couple moment at a point ( 1 .
The forcc will have the same magnitude and direction, n o matter where point
a is chohen 10 n i o ~ the
e entire system by methods discussed earlier. However.
the couple-moment vector will depend on the point chosen. We will pmve in
dynamics that:

The necessary cimditiuns,fnr a rigid body IO be in equilibrium are rhat the


resultant force F, and the resultant couple moment C, .for any point a be
7ero vectors.

That is,

FR = 0
c, = 0

W e shall prove i n dynamics, furthermore, that the conditions above are .s@
c.iriit tn maintain an inifiully .rfationury body in a state nfequilibriutn. These
arc the fundamental equations of statics. You will rememher from Section 4.3
rhat the resultant FR is the sum nf the forces moved to the cotnmon point, and
that the couple moment C, is equal 10 the sum of the moments of all the orig-
inal forces and couples taken about this point. Hence, the cquations ahove can
hc written

(5.221)

(S.2h)

where Ihe p,'s are displacement vectors from the conirniin point (1 to any
p i n 1 on the lines of action of the respective forces. Frnm this form of the
equations oS statics. we can conclude that for equilibrium tn exist, the w m r
.rum of tlw ~;Jw..s m u s I be zero and the moinewt of rhr .y>'.s/rrn,!f,fi)rw.s mnd
miiiplm about miy point in .ypace musf be zero.
Now that we have summed forces and have taken moments ahout a
point ti. we will demonstrate that we cannot find another independent equa-
tion hy taking moments ahout a diffrrent point ti. For the hody in Fig. 5.18.
wc have initially the fdlowing equations of equilibrium using point (I:

x F~ + p, x F , + 11, x F, + pd x F~ = n (5.41
SECTION 5.5 GENERAL EQUATIONS OF EQUILIBRIUM 163

Figure 5.18. Consider moments about point h

The new point h is separated from a by the position vector d. The position
vector (shown dashed) from h to the line of action of the force F, can be
given in terms of d and the displacement vector p, as follows. Similarly for
(pJh,which is not shown, and others.

~ (d + P,)
( P , )=
(p2Ih= (d + P& etc.
The moment equation for point b can then he given as
(P, + dl x 4 + (P, + 4 X F2 + (P, + 4 X F3 + (p4 + 4 X F4 = 0
Using the distributive rule for cross products, we can restate this equation as

( P , X F, + X F2 + P, X F3 + p4 X F4)
+d X (F, + F2 + F? + F4) = 0 (5.5)

Since the expression in the second set of parentheses is zero, in accor-


dance with Eq. 5.3, the remaining portion degenerates to Eq. 5.4, and thus we
have not introduced a new equation. Therefore, there are only two indepen-
dent vector equations of equilibrium for any single free body.
We shall now show that instead of using Eqs. 5.3 and 5.4 as the equa-
tions of equilibrium, we can instead use Eqs. 5.4 and 5.5. That is, instead of
summing forces and then taking moments ahout a point for equilibrium, we
can instead take moments about rwo points. Thus, if Eq. 5.4 is satisfied for
point a, then for point b we end up in Eq. 5.5 with

dX(F,+F,+F,+F,)=O (5.6)
If point b can be any point in space making d arbitrary, then the above equa-
tion indicates that the vector sum of forces is zero. If a point b happens to be
chosen making Eq. (5.6) identically 0 = 0. (and hence useless), choose
another point b. We then have equilibrium since F, = 0 and C, = 0.
Using the vector Eqs. 5.2, we can now express the scalar equations of
equilibrium. Since, as you will recall, the rectangular components of the
moment of a force about a point are the moments of the force about the onhog-
onal axes at the point, we may state these equations in the following manner:
164 CHAPTER 5 EQUATIONS OF t?QUIL.IRRIlJM

From this set o f equations, i t i s clear that !io more than si.^ unknown scular-
qiiun1ifir.s i l l / / ! e,qmrru/ m s c ~ r hen s o l d hy lnellior/.s of .stuli~~s,fi~i'
u .sin,s/e
. f W C h<J</Y.'
We can easily express on? nrrrnhu oT scalar equations of equilibrium
for a free hody by selecting references that have different axis directions,
along which we can sum forces and ahout which we can take moments. How-
ever, i n choosing s i x indepewlmr equations, we w i l l find that the remaining
equations w i l l he dependcnt (111 these six. Thac is, these equations w i l l he
sums, differences, ctc., of the independent set and so w i l l he o f no use i n solv-
i n g lor desircd unknowns othet- than for purposcs (it' checking calculations.

5.6 Problems of Equilibrium I


We shall now examine prohlems o f equilihrium i n which the rigid-body
assumption i s valid. 'lo solve such prohlems, wc musl find the value o f cer-
lain unknown fhrces and couple niomcnts. We first draw a rree-body diagram
o f the entire system or portions thcreof to clearly rxpose pertinent unknowns
for analysis. We then write the equilibrium equations i n terms of the
unknowns along with Lhe known forces and geometry. As we have seen. for
any free hody there i s a limited number of independent scalar equations o f
equilibrium. Thus. at times we must employ several free-body diagrams for
portions of the system to produce cnough independem equaiinns to solve all
the unknowns.
For any lrcc hody, wc may proceed hy expressing two hasic vector
equations of statics. After carrying out such vector operations as cross prod-
ucts and additions i n Ihe equations, we form scalar equations. These scalar
equations are then solvcd simultaneously (logcther with scalar equations from
other free-body diagrams that may hc needed) to find the unknown forces and
SECTION 5.6 PROBLEMS OF EQUILIBRIUM I 165

couple moments. We can also express the scalar equations immediately by


using the alternative scalar equilibrium relations that we formulated in previ-
ous sections. In the first case, we start with more compact vector equations
and a m v e a1 the expanded scalar equations by the formal procedures of vec-
tor algebra. In the latter case, we evaluate the expanded scalar equations by
carrying out arithmetic operations on the free-body diagram as we write the
equations. Which procedure is more desirable? It all depends on the problem
and the investigator’s skill in vector manipulation. It is true that many statics
problems submit easily to a direct scalar approach, hut the more challenging
problems of statics and dynamics definitely favor an initial vector approach. In
this text, we shall employ the particular procedure that the occasion warrants.
In statics problems, we must assign a sense to each component of an
unknown force or couple moment in order to write the equations. If, on solv-
ing the equations. we obtain a negative sign .for a component, then we have
guessed the wrong .sen.sefor that componenr. Nothing need he redone should
this occur. Continue with the remainder of the problem, retaining the minus
sign (or signs). At the end of the problem, report the correct sense of your
force components and couple-moment components.
We shall now solve and discuss a number of problems of equilibrium,
These problems are divided into four classes of force systems:
1. Concurrent.
2. Coplanar.
3. Parallel.
4. General.
The type of simplest resultant for each special system of forces is most
useful in determining the number of scalar equations available in a given
problem. The procedure is to classify the force system, note what simplest
resultant force system is associated with the classification. and then consider
the number of scalar equations necessary and sufficient to guarantee this
resultant to he zero. The following cases exemplify this procedure.

I
[Case A. Concurrent System of Forces. In this case, since the
simplest resultant is a single force at the point of concurrency, the only
requirement for equilibrium is that this force he zero. We can ensure this con-
dition if the orthogonal components of this force are separately equal to zero.
Thus, we have three equations of equilibrium of the form

As was pointed out in the general vector discussion, there are other
ways of ensuring a zero resultant. Suppose that the moments of the concur-
rent force system are zero about three nonparallel axes: a,b, and y. That is,
C(M,)! = 0, c c M p ) i = 0, c ( M y ) i= 0 (5.9)
i
166 CHAFTER s ~ Q I I A T I O N SOF EQIJILIBRIUM

Any m e of the follnwing three conditions must then hc true:

1. The rcsultant forcc F; i s ~ c r o .


2. F; cuts all three axcs (see, Fig. 5.19).
3. FA cuts two axes and i s parallel 10 the third (see Fig. 5.201

Figure 5.19. F , cuts t h m axes.

Figure 5.20. F,<cuts t w axes and i s parallel 10 third.

We can guarantee condition I and thus equilibrium i f we select axes a, 0, and


y so that no straight line can intersect a l l three axes or can cut two axes and
he parallel to the third. Then wc can use Fqs. 5 9 as the equations o f equilih-
rium under the aforcstdted conditions rather than using Eqs. 5.8. What hap-
pens i f an axis used violates these conditions? The resulting equation will
either he an identily 0 = 0 or will be dependent on a previous independent
equation of equilibrium for onc of the axcs. No harm i s done. Onc should usc
nther axes until three independent cquationq are found.
Similarly, m e can sum forcer i n one direction and take moments ahoul
two axes. Setting these equal lo zero can yicld three independent equations nf
equilibrium. If not. use other axes.
The essential conclusion 10 he drawn i s that there nrc three independent
srnlnr f,quntions of equilibrium / i w a coiicizrrmt ,fi,n.c .system. For such
systems i t i s most likely that you will always w n i forces rather than take
moments. However. for olher fnrce systems that we shall undertake, there
w i l l be ample opportunity to profitably cmploy alternate fnrms o f equations
other than those that we shall at first prescribe. The imporvdnt thing to
remember i s that, just as i n (he concurrent force systems, only a definite num-
ber of equations for a given free hody will he independent. Simply writing
more equations beyond this number w i l l only lead to identities and equations
that w i l l he of no use for wlving for Ihe desired unknowns.
SECTION 5.6 PROBLEMS OF E Q U I L IBRIUM I 167

Example 5.4
What are the tensions in cables AC and AB in Fig. 5.21? The system is in
equilibrium. The following data apply:
W = 1,000 N j3 = 50" a = 37"

Figure 5.21. Derrick holding a beam.

Immediately i t should be clear from observation of the diagram that


TAD = 1,000 N (tension) i T,,= 1,000N

A suitable free body that exposes the desired unknowns is the ring A,
which may be considered as a panicle for this computation because of its
comparatively small size (Fig. 5.22). Physical intuition indicates that the
cables are in tension and hence pulling away from A as we have indicated
in the diagram although, as mentioned previously, it is nor necessary to
recognize at the outset the correct sense of an unknown force. The force Figure 5.22. Free-body
diagram of pin A .
system acting on the particle must be a concurrent system. Here it is also
coplanar as well, and therefore we may solve for only two unknowns.
Hence, we can proceed to the scalar equations of equilibrium. Thus,

CFv=O 1,000 ~ TAc cos 37" - TARcos 50' = 0


:. .7986TA, + .6428TA, = 1,000 (a)

Solving for c, and c, from Eqs. (a) and (h), we get


9"4

l& = 602.6N &l = 767.1 N

Since the signs for TAc and ce


are positive, we have chosen the correct
senses fix the forces in the free-body diagram.
168 CHAPTER S EQUAIIONS OF F<OUII.IIJKIIIM

p Example 5.4 (Continued)


Anotlicr way (if ai-riving at the ~ ~ ~ u t i o
i stto
l , collsider tile,fivce /J,J/y-
gon that wils discussed i n Section 2.3. Bccause the forces arc i n equilihrium.
the polygon niiisl close; that is. lhc haid of the final lorcc niiist coincide with
thc tail of the inilial Force. In this cast. we have il triillifde. ils ~ h o w ' I 1ill
I Fig. 5.23 ;ipproximately 10 scale. We can nnw use the l i i w 6f sines
I.ONIN

T,,,= 602.6 N

The force polygon m:iy lhu.; be used lo good ad\wita$c whcn threc
concurrcnt coplanar forces arc i n cquilihrium.
As a final allernative. ICI 11s now initiate thc ci)rnputation lor the
unknown tensions from the hasic i'C('fOl' equ;ltionc (11' Stiltics. pirxt. U c
must expresh all forccs i n \'ectur notation.
?<.= TI, (-sin 1 7 ' i - c o h 17" j j

C,, = T,,+ (\in SO" i - cos So" . j )

We get the lollowing equation when the \'eclor s u m of the lorccs i s sct
equal lo zero:

%(. (-.6OlXi - .7YXbj) + r;, (.766Oi - ,612X.j) + I,OOOj = 0


Choosing point A. tlie point OF concun-ency, we clearly scc thiit the \uni of
moments 01 thc fiirces about this point i s zero. s o the \econd hasic equa-
tion of equilibrium i s intrinsically satisfied. Wc now regroup tlic terms o i
the preceding cquiition i n tlie following niiinncr:
(-.601X?;,. + .76hO3,,)i + (-.7'>863, - .h4?X7;,j + l.OO0j.j = 0

To satisfy this equation. each of tlie quantities i n parentheses must he wr(i.


This gives the ccalar equations t i i ) and (h) sliilctl e:irliei-. fi.oiii which the
scalar quantities !;,j iintl Cc.cim he sol\cd.

Thc three dtcrniitive inelhods of solutivn iue apparently 01equal uyc-


lulness in this simple pri)hlcin. Howcvcl-. the lcircc p ~ i l y g o ni h only (if practi-
c ~ i p l ~ u iforces,
cal use for tlirce c01icur1~111 ar where thc trigi)nomctric properties
01;I triangle can he directly uscd. The olhcr method\ can be readily cxtended
to inure complex concurreiit pi~ohlcms.
SECTION 5.6 PROBLEMS OF EQUILIBRIUM I 169

Find the forces in cables D B and CB in Fig. 5.24. The 500-N force is
parallel to the y axis. Consider B to be a hall joint located in the xz plane.
Rod A B is a compression member, with a hall joint at A .
In Fig. 5.25 we have indicated the forces acting on joint B. Clearly
we have a three-dimensional concurrent force system with three un-
knowns. We cim readily determine the unknown forces here hy simply set- Y
ting the sum of the forces equal to zero. However, since we only want the
forces in the two cables, we shall proceed by setting the moment of the
A
forces about point A of rod A B equal to zero, thereby not including
the forcc in member AB.
Denoting the force in BC as c.
and the force in BD as we G,
proceed inow to establish the rectangular components of these forces.

-1%
-,
1152
==)
+ 9 j + 5k
+ 92 + S’
= Tc(-.824i + .495j + ,275.k) N
-15 + S j + 13k = T,(-733i + 244j + 63%) N
\ 152 + 5’ + I?’ Figure 5.24. Rod A B and cables
CB and LIB support a 500-lb force.
The poyition vector that we shall use for the moment about point A
i b % H . which is

‘aH = 1Si + 5j - 5k rn

We now set the moments ahout point A equal to zero.

E M A= O

(1% + S j - Sk) X [T,.(-.624i + ,495j + ,275k) +

7;,(-.733i + 244j + .63Sk) - SOOJ] = 0

We simplify the calculations further by noting that cable BD has a direc-


tion inclined to the plene A C B in which the other three forces lie. This can
only mean that the force 7, must have a zero value. Hence, deleting this
force in the above equation and carrying out the cross products, it is easy
to get the remaining nonzero force. We thus have

q=649N &=ON
Figure 5.25. Free-body diagram of joint E .
170 CHAPTEK 5 F,QLIAlIONS OF EQUILlt(KII!M

Example 5.5 (Continued)


Finally. as indicated at the outset. we could proceed hy summing
Sorces in the coordinate directions. The resulting scalar equations for all
three unknown forces are

-0.8247; - 0.7337;, + 0.90ST4 = 0


0.495T. + 0.2447;, + 0 . 3 0 2 ~ ;= 500
(3.2757;. + 0.6157;, - 0.3027; = 0
We may now solve the sitnultaneuus equations using C'rrinwr'r d r . Thus
we calculate first the determinant of the coelficicnts of the unknown\. Thus

To calculate
I
-0.824 -0.733
0.495
0.275
0.244
0.905
0.302
0.635 -0.302

T . we pruceed as follows:
I = 0.272

0 -0.733 O.YO5
1500 0.244 0.302

Note that the first column of the deterniinant consists of thc right side
terms of the set of simultaneous equations i n placc 01 the coellicients of
the desired unknown. We can solve for the other unknowns similarly. We
then would have the comprcssive h r c e in member AB which i b 541 N .

I Case B. Coplanar Forces System. 1 we h;lve shown that the sini-


p l e g resultant for a coplanar force system (see F i g 4.14) is a single force or
a single couple monicnt nomial to the plane. Thus. to ensure that the resultant
furcc is 7.ero. we require lor a coplanar system in which all forces are in the
~ v xplane:
c
(b-<J , = 0 . ( F ; J, = 0 (5.10)

To ensure that the resultant couplc moment is zero. we require for mninenls
abuut any axis parallel to the z axis:

We conclude that there are three scalar equations olequilibriuni for a copla-
nar lurce system. Other combinations, such as two moment equations for twu
axes parallel to the .: axiz and a single force summation. il properly chosen,
may bc employed to give the three independent scalar equations of equilih-
rium, as was discussed in case A .
SECTION 5.6 PROBLEMS OF EQUILIBRIUM I 171

Example 5.6

Figure 5.26. A car i s being towed up an incline at a constant speed.

A car shown in Fig. 5.26 is being towed at a steady speed up an incline


having an angle of 159 The car weighs 3,600 Ib. The center of gravity is
located as is shown in the diagram. Calculate the supporting force on each
wheel and force 7:

\ 3,6W Ib
N,
Figure 5.27. Free-body diagram of the car

A free-body diagram of the car is shown in Fig. 5.27. The forces N,


and Nz are the total forces, respectively, for the rear wheels and the front
wheels. Note, because the wheels are rotating at cnnstant speed, there are
no friction forces present. We have thus formed on this free body a coplanar
force system involving three unknowns and hence the unknowns are
solvable by rigid-body statics. Using axes tangent and normal to the incline
we have
172 CHAPTER 5 EQUATIONS OF liQllll.lRRIUM

Example 5.6 (Continued)

C F ,= o T - WsinO = o
.: T = i3,hOO)(siii 15") = 931.7 Ih
i
T = 931.7 1h 1

+io11 7)(1 5 ) l = 1.785 Ih

From Eq.( I ) . we can now per N , . Thu,

N, = 3,477 - N2 = 3.477 - 1,785 = 1,692 Ib

Clcarly each rear whccl has acting on it 21 normal fbrcr OF N,l2 = 846. I Ib
and each front wheel has ii normal force o l N , l 2 = XY2.5 Ih.

Rear wheel support force = 846.1 Ib


..
Front wheel support force = 892.5 lb

We may now check this soIuliu~iby using a rcdundant equation uf


equilibrium. Thus

We have here il roundoff error, which wc can scccpt fix thz accuracy ol
the calculations Laken in this pnrblcm.
SECTION 5.6 PROBLEMS OF EQUILIBRIUM I 113

Example 5.7
A frame is shown in Fig. 5.28 in which the frictionless pulley at D has a
mass of 200 kg. Neglecting the weights of the bars, find the force trans-
mitted from one bar to the other at joint C.

Figure 5.28. Loaded frame


To expose force components C, and Cy, we form the free body of bar
BD. This is shown as F.B.D. I in Fig. 5.29. It is clear that for this free body
we have six unknowns and only three independent equations of equilib-
. ~ free-body diagram of the bent b a AC is then drawn (F.B.D. I1
r i ~ mThe
in Fig. 5.29). Here, we have three more equations hut we bring in three

FBD 1 F B D I1

- 1.962 N

5.000 N
F.B.D. 111
Figure 5.29. Free-body diagrams of frame parts

41t should be noted that it is possible to have situations wherein there we more
uriknowns than independent equations of equilibrium for a givm free body, but wherein
some of the unknowns--perhaps the dcsircd onea--can be still determined by the equations
available. However, not all the unknowns “ I the free body can be solved. Accordingly, be
alert for such situations, so as to ,minimize the work involved. In this case. we must consider
other free-body diagrams.
I14 ("AFTER 5 FQLIATIONS OF FQIIII.IHKIUM

Example 5.7 (Continued)


more unknowns. Finally, the tree-body diagram 0 1 the pulley (F.B.D. 111 in
Fig. 5.29) gives threc more equations with no additional unknowns. We
now have nine equalions available and nine unknowns and can proceed
with confidence. Since only two ot. the unknowns are desired, we shall
take select scalar equations from each of the free-hody diagrams to arrive
at the components C , and <.! most quickly

From F.H.D. 111:

Therefore.

Therefore.

-I ,962 - s.000 + 0,= 0


Therefore.
11, = 6.962 N
From F.B.D. I:

Therefore,

Fmnz F.B.D. 11:

-(1.3)(14) - (7')(3.l) - C,(4) + C s ( 2 . S )= 0


Thereiore,
C, = 24.300 N
We can give the Sorce at C (transmittcd from bar AC lo bar B D ) as

C =24,W + 11.313jN
5.17. In a tug of war, when team B pulls with a 400-lb force, 5.20. Find the tensions in the three cables connected to B. The
huw much force must team C exert for a draw? With what force entire system of cables is coplanar. The roller at E is free to turn
does team A pull'? without resistance.

Ropes tied to a ring

- B
Y B

C
Figure P.5.17. Figure P.5.20.
5.18. Find the tensile force in cables AB and CB. The remaining 5.21. A 700-N circus performer causes a .15-m sag in the
cables ride over frictionless pulleys E and F. middle of a 12-m tightrope with a 5,000-Ninitial tension. What
additional tension is induced in the cable? What is the cable ten-
sion when the performer is 1 m from the end and the sag is .I2 m?

Figure P.5.21.
-1 5.22. A 27-lb mirror is held up by a wire fastened to two hooks
Figure P.5.18. on the mirror frame. (a) What is the force on the wall hook and the
5.19. Find the force transmitted by wire BC. The pulley E can be tension in the wire? (b) If the wire will break at a tension of 32 Ib,
assumed to be frictionless in this problem. must the wall hook be moved (i.e., the wire lengthened or sholt-
ened and the 4-in. rise distance changed)? If so, to what point?

Wall hook

Figure P.5.19. Figure P.5.22.

17.
c(M,), = 0. Axe\ d and e arc in,>[ ~ ~ i l i t i l l ctol the A; plane.
/'

Moreover, the axe, are oricntcd so that the linc 01 action 0 1 the
re\ultanl force cannot inter\rct hoth axcs.

5.24. Cylinders A and H weigh 500 N ciich mil c)llndc~. ( ' '%
weighs 1,000 N. C m ~ ~ p ~alli l contact
e force&.

/i

Figure P.5.25. Figure P.J.2X.


5.29. Find the supporting force systems far the beams shown.
Note that there is a pin connection at C. Neglect the weights of . ... .. ...
the beams.

v
1.000 N

I00 N/m Figure P.5.31.

n--I 5.32. What are thc supporting forces for the frame'! Neglect all
wights except the IO-kN weight. Disregard friction.

klTlTL 8m
Figure P.5.29.

5.30. Find the supporting force systems at A and B. The length


of C R is 8 m.

R
Figure P.5.32.

5.33. Find the supporting forces at E and K Pulleys A and B


offer n o rotational resistance from friction at the beerings.
A

Figure P.5.30.

5.31. What are the supporting forces at A and D fbr the frame
shown? What are the forces in members AB, BE. and BC? Figure P.5.33.

177
Figure P.5.34.

35. An e l a l i c cord AH i \ .just tau1 beliore 1,000 force i \


iplied. I f il takes 5.0 N / m m of elongalion of the card, what is the
r l i i i ) i i 7'in the curd after the I ,000-N force i s applied'! Set up the
Iuation for 7'hut do ~101solve.

Figure P.S.35.

36. A thin hoop o1 radius I 1x1 and weight 500 N rests on an


:line. What friction force/ at A i s needed for this configun~atiun'?
hat i s the tension iii wire CB?

Kigure P.5.36. k ipure P.5.39.

8
5.40. What is the supporting force system at A for the cantilever 5.43. Find the supporting force aystem at A
beam? Neglect the weight of the beam.

' -kid
I- A
Figure P.S.40. Figure P.S.43.

5.41. In Problem 5.40, find the force system transmitted through


the crms section at B. 5.44. A light bent rod AD is pinned to a straight light rod CB at
C. The bent rad supports a uniform load. A spring is stretched to
connect the two rods. The spring has a spring constant of IO4 N/m,
and its unstretched length is .8 m. Find the supporting forces at
5,42. A beam AB is pinned at to a simply suppone,jA and B. The force in the spring is I O 4 times the elongation
beam RC. For the luads given, find the supporting force systcm at in meters.
A . Determine force components that are normal and tangential to
the cross-section of beam AB. Neglect the weights of the beams.

- 2m

Figure P.S.42. Figure P.S.44.

175
5.45. Light rods A I ) and HC are pinncd together at C and sup- s A and (T. AB weighs 100
5.47. Sulve fbr the supponing f r ~ e at
w i t a ?OWN and a IOO-N Indd. What arc the supporting forces a1 Ih, and RC weighs 150 Ih.
I and H?

300 N

Figure P.5.45.

Figure P.5.47.

i.46. A light rod CI) is held in a horiiontal position hy a strung


,lastic hand AH (shock cord), which acts like a spring in that it 5.48. What torque 7 i s ncsded to maintain the configura-
akrs IO3 N per meter felong gat ion vfthe band. The upper part of tion shown for the cumprcssor if p , = 5 psig'! The system lies
he band i s connected to a small wheel free to roll on a horizontal horizontally.
llrfdce. What is the angle a needed tu suppoit a 200-N l w d
.s shown?

Figure P.5.46. Figure P.5.48.

80
5.49. Wurk Problem 5.48 for the system oriented vertically with 5.52. Find the supporting forces at A and G. The weight of W is
BC weighing 3 Ib and CD weighing 5 Ib. 500 N and the weight of C is 200 N. Neglect d l other weights.
The cord connecting C and D is vertical.

5.50. Neglecting friction, find the angle p of line AB for equilib-


a, W,, and W,.
rium in t e n n s of ai,

Figure P.5.52.

Figure P.5.50.

5.53. What torque T is needed for equilibrium if cylinder R


weighs 500 N and CD weighs 30U N?

5.51. If the rod CD weighs 20 Ib, what torque T i s needed to


maintain equilibrium? The system is in a vertical plane. Cylinder
A weighs 10 Ib and cylinder B weighs 5 Ib. Disregard friction. At
D there is a slot.

30"

Figure P.5.51. Figure P.5.53.


5.54. A har A l l i s pinned tn twn identical planewy g a r s ellch of A
jiameler 311 in. Gear 1: is pinned t n har AI3 and meshes with the
wo planctary pears. which i n turn mesh with statimary gear I). II
1 tirrquc 7 ' 0 1 100 N ~ im s applicd 10 bar AH, ~ 1 c't~
~ c m1i l ltorquc
s ncedcd t o he applied t u thc upper planctary g c x 10 iniiintain

II.5 111

I
.

Figure P.5.54.

3.121 m
i.56. A Bucyrus+Eris tianhi1 crilnr i s holding il chimnc) having
I weight 0120 kN. The chirnnq is held by il cahle that g w \ w e r
L pulley at A , thcn gee. i w c i a cccntid pullry at I). and thcn to a
uinch ill K . The position of baom AI! (on to,,) is inaintaincil hy
WII heparate cahles, one from A t o /I. and the other from R to p~kI-
ey C. Find the tensions in cohle5 AH and RC. Nuts that HC is oii-
,ntcd 30" from [he vertical f o r the setup show!. Consider only ttir /

veight of the load and neglect frictim. Figure P.5.57.

82
SECTION 5.7 PROBLEMS OF EQUILIBRIUM 11 183

5.7 Problems of Equilibrium II

lease c. I
Parallel Forces in Space. In the case of parallel forces
in space (see Fig. 4.20), we already h o w that the simplest resultant can be
either a single force or a couple moment. If the forces are in the z direction,
then

=0 (5.12)

ensures that the resultant force is zero. Also,

guarantees that the resultant couple moment is zero, where the .r and v axes
may be chosen in any plane perpendicular to the direction of the
Thus, three independent scalar equations are available fur equilibrium of par-
allel forces in space.
A summary of the special cases discussed thus far is given below.
For even simpler systems such as the concurrent-coplanar and the parallel-
coplanar systems, clearly, there is one less equation of equilibrium.

Number oJ Equations
System Simplest Resultant for Equilibrium

Concurrent Single force 3


(three-dimensional)
Coplanar Single fkce or
single couple moment 3
Parallel Single force or
(three-dimensional) single couple moment 3

'For parallel forces in the I direction, a simplest resultant consisring ot a couple moment
only murl have this couple moment parallel to the xy plane (see diagram). Recall from Chapter 3
that the orthogonal q z components of C, equals the torque of the system about these axes.
Hence. by setting x ( M r ) ,= C(Mv), = ( I , weareensuring thatC, = 0.
184 CHAPTER 5 I~QUATIONS< ) F F.QlllLlUKlllM

Example 5.8
Dcteriniiie ttic ~ W C C S required to suppoi-t (hi' unifi)rm heirin in Fig. 5.30
showii Iwded with ii couple. a point force. iiiid ii downw;ird par;ihi)lic (lis-
trihutim of lo:ld hnring 7er-0 slope :it the origin. Thc weiftit o1 thr, hzam i s
I O 0 Ib.

&~ ~~~

20' ~ --

lO(1 Ihiul.1

Figure 5.30. Find \ u p p < r l i n gforce\

Since ii couple ciin hn rotated w i l l i w t afleclins Ihc cquilihriurli of


the hody. we ciiii orieiil lhc couple s o llliil the lorccs arc vertic:il. AccoId-
ingly. wc have here ii hcam loaded hy ii system 01 parallel coplanar loads.
Clearly. Ihc siippoi-lin$ forces imusi hc wrtical, i i h shown ill F:ig. 5.31.
wlicre %'e havc ii frcc-hirdy di;igl-aiii of ttic hciuii. Siiicc tlicrc ;ire imly IH(I
unknown quantities. UT ciin handle the prohlcm hy \Liiticid considcralion
01this free body.

KI H,
Figure 5.31. f+cc,-hodj di:igr:wi

The cquatinn Ibr thc loading curve must he I V = m' +


h. whcrc o
and I, are ttr IRdctcriniiicd l i r ~ nthe
i Ir,;iding ilat,~and tlic c h k c iilrrfereilce.
With an .qrcfcreiicc ;it thc lelt end. tis shown, M'U then havc the conditions:

1. W h c n x = (1. bt' = 0.
2. When v = 20, 11' = 400.

To satisfy these cmiditimih, h niust he /ern ;ind (I niusl hc uiiity: the Itxiding
liinctiim i\ lhus given a\

II' = ~ x ' lhifi


SECTION 5.1 PROBLEMS OF EQUILIBRIUM I1 185

Example 5.8 (Continued)


In this problem, we shall agein work directly with the scalar equti-
tions. By summing moments about the left and right ends of the beam, we
can then solve for the unknowns directly:

-500 - (10)(100) - (15)(500) - I, 2u


xy dx + 20R2 = 0

Replacing y by xz, then integrating and canceling terms, we get

-9,000 -
4'!:'I+ 20R, = 0

By inserting limits and solving, we get one of the unknowns:

R, = 2,450lb

Next,

-20Ri - 500 + (10)(100) + ( 5 ) ( 5 0 0 )+ 1,:(20 - x)ydx = 0

Replacing y by x2, integrating and then solving for R , , we have

R , = 817lb

As a check on these computations, we can sum forces in the vertical


direction. The result must he zero (or as close to zero as the accuracy of
our calculations permits):

R, + K2 - 100 - 500 ~ IU
20
x 2 d,x = 0

Therefore,
2,667 - 2,661 = 0
Always take the opportunity to check a solution in this manner (i.e., by
using a redundant equilibrium equation). In later problems, we shall rely
heavily on calculated reactions (supporting forces); thus, we must make
sure they are correct.
186 C H A PT ER 5 E Q UA TI O N S OF FQIIII.IBRIIIM

Example 5.9
I n Fig, 5.32. find the suppnrting I i r c e s at A. D. and I ) . Note thc pin ~(111-

ncction at C. Also inole that at I<we h a w n weldcd connection


Y

Figure 5.32. h l c m h c n . A ( ' and ( ' I ) arc pinncd 31 ('.

The free-hody diagram for thc entire system is shown i n Fig. 5.33.
We have a coplanai s y s k m (ifforces fkr this free body and s o w e hmc
only three independent equations of equilibrium. Howcvcr we have Iiei~r
four unknowns. One of the unknowns, namcly A , , can he s e r i i hy iti-
spection to he /,cro lea\'ing now a coplanar parallel system with three
unknowns but with o n l y two equations ofeqiiilihriuin.
\'

Figure 5.33. Rcc-hudy d i a g a n i I.(F.R.I). I)

We shell next consider the frcc hody 01 mernhcr [ I ) . This is shown


in Fig. 5.34 where we have simplified the distributed loading i n order to
better facilitate the ensuing computakiiins. Clearly. i i i t i s t he x r o . Thus. 7'
for F.B.D. I I in Fig. 5.34. we will then haue only two unknmwis lor which <',
we havc two equations of equilibrium. By raking moments ahout point C' Figure 5,34,R-ec-hody diagl~am
in Fig. 5.34, we can directly dererniine [Ir. (F.H.D. 11)
SECTION 5.7 PROBLEMS OF E Q UILIBRIUM II 187

Example 5.9 (Continued)

~
C M c = 0:
~~~

(D,)(IS) - ( 2 c u ) ( l s ) ( y ) - (:)(1s)(300)[(~)(15)] =0

We may now go hack to Fig. 5.33 to solve for the remaining two
unknowns. Thus, simplifying the loading between C and D as we have
done i n Fig. 5.34. we have

A> + E )
I
+ 3,000 - (200)(34) - 1(300)(1S) =0
c
M, = 0 :
~-
-A,(13) + (3,000)(21) ~ (200)(34)(2; - 13)

- ~2( 3 0 0 ) ( 1 5 ) [ h + ( ~ ) ( I S )=
] 0

From Eq. (h), we get

And from Eq. (a), we have


,*
4.- 6,069N
Note that A, was negative indicating that we had inserted the wrong
sense for this force in F.B.D. 1. We did not make any changes in the ensu-
ing calculations while going to Eq. (a) (valid for F.B.D. 1) to calculate B,
(i,e., we used the result from Eq. (c) with the negative sign of A, intact).
Also, if you were tempted in F.B.D. 1 to include the force C, at pin
C in this diagram you were flirting with the prime error in the statics of
rigid bodies-namely, including a force which is infernal to the particular
free body drawn.

general case is a force and a couple moment. Six equations of equilibrium


can be given for each free-body diagram. We now examine two examples
for this case.
Example 5.10
A derrick i s shown in Fig. 5.35 supporting a 1,000-1b load. The verticil1
heam has a ball-and-socket coniiection inti, the ground at r l and i s held hy
guy wircs ( I C ' and tic Neglect the weight of the mcinhers and guy wires.
and find the tensiirns in the guy wires u r ' , hr. and ('e.

Figure 5.35. Loaded rlrrriok.

If we select as ti free hody both membcrs and the interconnecting


guy wire w , we shall cxpose two of the desired unknowns (Fig. 5.36).
Note that this i s a general three-dimensional h r c e system with iinly five
unknowns." Allhough all these unknowns can be solved by statical consid-
erations of this free hody, you will notice that, if we take monicnts ahout
point d , we w i l l involve in a vector equation only thc desired unknowns
Th,.and T,, . Accordingly. all unknown for-ces need riot he computed kir
this free-body di;ipr;im. You should always look for such short cuts in sit-
uations such as this.
To determine the unknown tension ?;.<,, we musl employ another Figure 5.3h. F'er-budY diagram I.
free-body diagram. Either the vertical cor horimntal member will expose
this unknown i n it manner susecptihle ti) solulion. The latter has been
selected and i s shown in Fig. 5.37. Note that we have here a coplanar force
system with ttircc unknowns. Again. you ciln Fee that, by taking moments
about p i n t , / . wc will involve only the desired unknown.
4 P

6; I,OOO Ih
'% \ h i ~ o l dhc clciii on 8sipection ,,I big. 5.35 Ihiit. duc 11) symnclry. forma in the ~ W O
supp<,niog ~ i i h l ~nwst b he eqiiill. Usmg i l i i s intoimiitmr1 i\ l i i n t i i r n ~ ~ i nt ol using cine of thc
Figure 5.31. Free-body diagram 2.
cquiitiow d c q o i l i h r i i ~ i n Hiwcrcr.
. ror praclice we w i l l not uhc this inforination and we w i l l
b u l \ c lor h o l h 0 1 ihcxl cnhlcs and d e m ~ ~ n w alhcir t c cqu"liiy. Also, iiutc that there i s it sixth
cquiiliori d c q u i l i h r i i i r t i llijll i, iklcniicnlly \ulialicd. To hcc this. look a1 rnooients of the forcer
about a x ~ qmi i n E g . 5.36 Why i s Ihc l ~ t i t iiioiiiciit l dcnticidly quill i m zero ahuut this axi,,
lhuc denyiiip \ I \ im q u i l t i o n io hclp ~ I V C for unLnrwns'! I \ the derrick complcicly coii-
ctraiocd" F.xplisin
SECTION 5.7 PROBLEMS OF EQUILIBRIUM II 189

Example 5.10 (Continued)


The vector T,, may then be given as

Similarly, we have for Tbc,

Using the free-body diagram in Fig. 5.36, we now set the sum of
moments about point d equal to zero. Thus, employing the relations above,
we get

'' ( S i
13k x __
m - l O j - 13k) + 13k x - (Tbc
-Si
x'333
- l O j - 13k)
+ l O j x (-1,000k) = 0 (c)
When we make the substitution of variable tl = and
f2 = Tb< /m3,
the preceding equation becomes
[130(tl t t2) - lO,OOO]i t [104(tl - t 2 ] j = 0 (d)
The scalar equations,
130(tl + fz) - 10,000 = 0
104(tl - t2) = 0
can now be readily solved to give f l = f2 = 38.5. Hence, we get
cc = 38.5 ~ 6 %= 702 Ib and qc = 38.5 (333 = 702 lb.'

Turning finally to free-body diagram 2 in Fig. 5.37, we see that, in


summing moments about f,the horizontal component of the tension q,has
a zero-moment arm. Thus,
(10)(0.707)T,, ~ (IO)(l,OOO) = 0

Hence,

'By taking moments in Fig. 5.36 about the line connecting points a and d (see Fig.
5.35). we could get Tbcdirectly using the scalar triple product. We suggest that you try this.
190 CH.\PIt% 5 EQlli\llONS OF CQLIII.IHKIIIM

Example 5.11
A blimp i s \ h o w in Fig. 5.38 fixed at Ihc mooring lower n by a
ball-ioint coiiiieclion. and held by ciihles A B and A<'. The lhlimp has a
ma!.\of l,SOO hg. Thc s i m p l c b l resultirnt forcc P from air prcssure (includ-
ing the effect\ 01 wind) is
F = I7.500i + I .OOOlj + I ,500k N
at ii position hhown in the diagram. Compute the tensior in the cables a s
well as the I0rcc tran\initled L o the ball ,j(iint at the top 111 the towx i i t D.
Also, what Sorce syslcni is transinittcd to the ground at G through the
mooring tower? l h e towcr weighs 5.000 N.

Figure 5.38. Telhrl-cd hliiiip.


We shall first consider ;I frec-body diagram of the hlinrp. as shown
i n Fig. 5.34. We have five unknown 1orcez hcrc. and we can d v e all 01
tlieiii by using equation!. ~Sequilihriulnfor this free As it Sirst step,
we express the cahlc tensions vectorially. That is.

We now gii hack to the basic vector cquation ~ I e q u i l i h r i u n i 'l'hur


.
Figure 5.39. Fize-body diagram OF
hlimp.
SECTION 5.7 PROBLEMS OF EQUILIBRIUM I1 191

I Example 5.11 (Continued)


The scalar equations are

DL + 2,785
Dy +
I
- .933%,. - .894T,, = 0
1,000 +
.447%, = 0
(a)
(b)
D. + 1.500 - .359%, = 0 (C)
Next take moments about point D

1 3 j x (9.81j(I,SOO)(-i)+ I h j x (17,500i + I,OOOj + 1,500k)


+ 2 9 j x TA,(-.933i - .359k) + 291 x TA,(-.894i + ,4471) = 0
Carrying out the various cross products, we end up nnly with k and i com-
ponents, thus generating two scalar equations.' They are

-10.41T,,. + 24,000 = 0 (d)

25.9%, + 27.I%,. - 88,700 = 0 (e)

We now have five independent equations for five unknowns. We can thus
solve these equations simultaneously. From Eq.(d), we have

T,, = 2,305 N

From Eq. (e), we have

TAB= 1,012

From Eq. (cj, we have

Dz = -673 N

From Eq. (b), we have

D, = -1,452 N

T h e lhird equation is 0 = 0.That is, there are no moments ahout they axis. because
all forces pass through the Y axis.
Hcncc.

Frim tliih. we gcl

Mb= 0
M , = 17.470 N-III
M = -37,xoo N-Ill

We ciiii conclude tliiit. iil the ceiiler ol thc hilhc. the Siircc systcm from the
ground is
!
I' = 5.2701' ~ l,4S2j - h72k N
C = 17.47Uj - 37.XOOk N-iii

i
Thc Ibrcc system acting on the gr<~undiit the ccntcr 0 1 tlic hasc i\ tlrc re-
i action t o Llie sy\te~iiahiibc. Thus.
6

<,,>
,,,, = -.5,27Oi + 1.452j + 612kN
C,cc,t,,, = -17,470j + 37,800k N-m
5.58. The triplc pulley sheave and the double pulley sheave
I
weigh I S Ib and 10 Ih, respeclively. What rope fbrce is necehsary
to lift a 350-1b engine'! What is the force o n the ceiling hook!

Counter
welght I

Figure P.5.60.

5.61. A Jcep winch is used to raise itself by a force of 2 kN.


What are the reactions at thz Jeep tires with and without the winch
load'? The drivcr weighs 800 N. and the Jeep weighs I I kN. The
cenler of gravity of the Jeep is shown.

Figure P.5.58.

5.59. A multipurpose pry bar can be used tn pull nails in the


three positions. If a fbrce of 400 Ib is required to remove a nail
t ~ . ~ m + ) I-
1.3m
3.1 m
-
and a carpenter can exen SO Ib, which position(s) must he use'? Figure P.5.61.

5.62. A diflerrnriul p d l q is shown. Compute F in terms of W ,


r, . and rz.

~ I .25"

c F

Figure P.5.59.

5.60. At what position must the operator of the cuunterwcight


crane locate the SO-kN counterweight whcn he lifts a IO-kN h a d
of steel? Figure P.5.62.
19
5.63. What is the longest portion of pipe weighing 400 Ib/ft that 5.66. An 1-hcam canrilevcred out Srom a u d l wcighs 30 lhift and
can he lifted without tipping the 12,000-lh tractor'! Take the center supprim a 700-lh hoist. Steel (4x7 Ihilt'l TIIVCI plates I iii. thick
rravity. of the tractor at the L'eonietiic centcr.
of - arc uvlded on thc heam iirx the wiill lo incieiice the mmient-
Carl-yinp capacity of the heam. What arc the reiictioiis at the u.all
when a 400I-lh In;id is hoisted at thc out~rmostpmition of the
hoist'.'

I,>,\,
>P>p

It- 8'-+
I

+ -5'-l
Figure P.S.63.
9
Figure 1'5.66.
Y/
<y- ~

5.64. The L-shilped concrete post supports an clevated railroad. 5,67, the fc,rcc fill- ci iltlvcI.he; ,,,,
The concrete weighs 1501 Ih/W What are the reactions at thr hese shr,wn (.,
of the post'!

40.000 Ih

r 5.68. Find the \upporting force sysrcm lor ttir cmtilewr heams

i -8
Figure P.5.64.
cmncctcd to har A H hy pins.

5.65. Two hoists arc operated on the same overhead track. Hoist Figure P.S.6X.
A has a 3,000-lh load, and hoist R has ii 4.000-lh load. What are
rc.cti~,ns the ends c,c Lhr trach when the hoi,ts arc i n [he 5.69. The tciilcr weighs SO kN and is loadcd w i t h crate\ wigti-
position shown? i n s ')O kN and 4 1 k N . What
iiic thc rriictions at thr ,car wheel ;ind
rm the tractor at ,I..'

I 194
Figure P.5.65.
I'igure P.S.69.
5.70. What load W will a pull P of IO0 Ib lift in the pulley sys- 5.73. A 20-kN block is being raised at constant speed. If there is
tem? Sheaves A, H, and C weigh 20 Ih, 15 Ih, and 30 Ib, respec- no friction in the three pulleys, what are forces F,, 4 , and F7
tively. Assume first that the three sheaves are frictionless and find needed for the job! The block i s not rotating in any way. The line
W, Then, calculate W that can he raised at constdnt speed for the of action of the weight vector passes through point C as shown.
case where the resisting torque in each of sheaves A and H is .01
times the total force at the bearing of each of sheaves A and H .

Figure P.5.73.

Figure P.5.70.
5.74. A 10-ton sounding rocket (used for exploring outer space)
5.71. A piece of pop art is being developed. The weight of the has a center of gravity shown as C.G.,. It is mounted on a
body enclosed by the full lines is 2 k N . What is the smallest dis- launcher whose weight is SO tons with a center of gravity at C.G.,.
tance d that the artist can use for cutting a .5-m-diameter hnle and The launcher has three identical legs separated 120" from each
still avoid tipping'? The body is uniform in thickness. other. Leg At4 is in the same plane as the rocket and suppolting
arms CDE. What are the supporting forces from the ground? What
4 m *-2 m-1 I torque is transmitted from the horizontal arm C D to the ramp ED
I by the rack and pinion at hinge D to counteract the weight of
- = t i m
the rocket'?

='I
Figure P.5.71.

5.72. What is the largest weight W that the crane cdn lift without
tipping? What are the supporting forces when the crane lifts this
load? What is the force and couple-moment system transmitted
through section C of the beam? Compute the force and couple-
moment system transmitted through section D . The crane weighs
1 0 tons, having a center of gravity as shown in the diagram.

50'

e
~

20
'c
I
Figure P.5.72. Figure P.5.74.
195
5.75. A door i s hinged at A and N and contains watcr whosc spe-
cific weight y is 62.5 Ihift'. A firrce 1.' nornral to the dnor keeps
the door closed. What are the forccs on the hinges A and II and thr
force F to ctrunteract the water? As noted in Chapter 4, thc prei-
sure in thc water above atmosphere i s givcn as yd. where rl is the
pcrpendicular distance from the k e surface of the wjatcr.

A
7 111
1

t '

Figure P.5.77.

5.78. Find the supporting force and couple-moment system for


the cnntile\icr hcam. What i s the force and couple-moment system
Figure P.S.75. Irammitted through a cross section of the heam at R'!

5.76. A row of hooks of length 750 niin and weighing 200 N sits
.m a three-legged tahle as shown. 'The legs are equidistant from
:ach other with one leg N coinciding with the y axis. l'he crthcr
:wo legs lie along a line parallel to the ,t axis. If thc tahle weighs I
100 N,will i t tip'! If not, what hie the fhrces on the legs'?

500 Ih
Figure P.S.78.

5.79. A structure i s supported hy a ball-and-socket joint at A , a


pin connection at N offering no resistance in the direction A B , and
a himplr roller support at C. What are the supporting forces fcrr the
lnads shown'!

Figure P.S.76.
i.77. A small helicopter i s in a hovering m a n c u v c ~ ~The
. lhcli-
opter rntor hladcs givc a lifting force I ; hut therc result\ from the
ir forces on the hlades B lorquc c', . The rex rotor prevents thc
ielicupter from rotating ahout the i axis hut drvclaps n torquc C , .
:ompute the force F; and couple C, i n terns of the weight @
+
2(H) kN
iow arc F, and (I, related'! Figure P.5.79.

96
5.80. Compute the value of F to maintain the 200-lb weight 5.83. Determine the vertical force F that must be applied to the
shown. Assume that the bearings are frictionless, and determine windlass to maintain the 100-lb weight. Also, determine the sup-
the forces from the bearings on the shaft at A and B. porting forces from the bearings onto the shaft. The handle DE on
which the force is applied is in the indicated XI plane.

Figure P.5.80. Figure P.5.83.


5.81. A bar with two right-angle bends supports a force F given as
F = 10i + 3j + IOOkN
If the bar has a weight of I O N/m, what is the supporting force
system at A'? 5.84. A transport plane has a gross weight of 70.000 Ib with a
center of gravity as shown. Wheels A and B are locked by the
braking system while an engine is being tested under load prior to
take off. A thrust T of 3,000 Ib is developed by this engine. What
are the supporting forces?

Figure P.5.81.

5.82. What is the resultant of the force system transmitted across


the section at A? The couple is parallel to plane M.
V

-1 I.zm+
Figure P.5.82. Figure P.5.84.
5.85. Two cahles GH and K N support a rod A R which connCCtC
to a ball-and-socket joint wpporl at A and q q m r l s ii 500-kg hady
C at R . Whal are the tensioni in the cahle and the supporting
forces at A’!

Figure P.S.87.

5.88. What force P is needed tu huld thr door i n a hwimntal


pohilion? ‘lhc door weighs SO Ih. Dcterminc the SuppOl-li~lf
\ A and 8.At A there i s a pin and at /I therc i\ il hall-and-
l o ~ w c :it
mckrt ,joint.

Figure P.5.85.

5.86. What changc in elentirm fkr thc 100-lh weight will a coii-
ple of 300 Ih-ft support if wc neglect li.ictian in the hearings :it A

I and R? A l w , determine the suppolling fbrce cwnponcnts at the


bearings for this crrnfiguration.
Figure P.S.88.
*S.RY. A onilbnn has of length / a n d weight 1V i s connecled to
the ground hy a ball-and-wckct iomt, and r a t s on a wnicylindcr
i r o n which i t 15 not allowed to slip down hy n wall at U . If we
crinsidcr the wall and cylindcr 10 he frictiotilcah. dctcmiine the
supporting I r c z c at A for the follou,ing data:

I = I m
< = 30 111
,’ _I .?O 111

h = ..101n
W = 100N

I 5.87.
Figure P.5.86.

Dctcrmine thc frircc P requircd to ep the 150-N or of


an airplane open SO” while in Ilight. Thc Sorce P IS excrfed ill il
dircctinn normal to the fiiselagc. There is a i i ~ prersure
t increase
o n thc ootcide s u r f x x of .02 N/,nmz. A l w . determine the support-
ing forces at thc hinge&.Consider thal the top hinge supports any
vertical force on the door. Figure P.5.89.

198
SECTION 5.8 TWO POINT EQUIVALENT LOADINGS 199

5.8 Two Point Equivalent Loadings


We shall now consider a simple case of equilibrium that occurs often and
from which simple useful conclusions may readily be drawn.
Consider a rigid body on which the equivalent systems of two separate
forces are respectively applied at two points a and b as shown in Fig. 5.41. If
the body is in equilibrium, the first basic equation of statics, 5.l(a), stipulates
that F, = -F2;that is, the forces must be equal and opposite. The second fun-
damental equation of statics, 5.l(b), requires that C = 0, indicating that the
forces be collinear so as not to form a nonzero couple. With points a and b
given as points of application for the two forces in Fig. 5.41, clearly the com-
mon line of action for the forces must coincide with the line segment ab. Such 4 +
bodies, where there are only two points of loading, are sometimes called Figure 5.42. Compression
“two-force” members. Such members occur often in structural mechanics and tension members
problems. Furthermore, there is considerable saving of time and labor if the
student recognizes them at the outset of any problem.

a b )

Figure 5.41. Two-force member.

We often have to deal with pin-connected structural members with


loads applied at the pins. If we neglect friction at the pins and also the weight
of the members, we can conclude that the equivalent of only two forces act on Figure 5.43. Line of action
each member. These forces, then, must be equal and opposite and must have of F collinear with ab.
lines of action that are collinear, with the line joining the points of application
of the forces. If the member is straight (see Fig. 5.42). the common line of
action of the two forces coincides with the centerline of the member. The top
member in Fig. 5.42 is a compression member, the one below a tensile mem-
ber. Note that the bent member in Fig. 5.43, if weightless, is also a two point
loaded member. The line of action of the forces must coincide with the line
ab connecting the two points of loading. However, the beam in Fig. 5.44 is
not a two point loaded member since at the left end there will be a couple
moment, And, clearly, such a loading must entail two points of loading to
accommodate the two equal and opposite forces comprising the couple. There
are then in effect three points of loading for this member. Accordingly, use
caution here when dealing with a cantilever beam.
Before considering an example, it should be emphasized that the forces Figure 5.44. Cantilever beam is not an
4 and 5 in Fig. 5.41 may be the resultants of systems of concurrent forces at example of a two point loaded member.
a and b, respectively. Since concurrent forces are always equivalent to their
resultant at the point of concurrency, the member in Fig. 5.41 is still a two-
force member with the resulting restrictions on the resultants & and F2.
A device lor crushing rock\ ic chown i n Fig. 5.45. A pistiin I ) having iiii
%in. diameter is aclivated hy il pressure 11 of 5 0 p i g ( ~ ~ i i u n dper
h sqliale
inch above that or the atmosphere). Rod?, A B , 11C'. ;1nd Ill) can he consid-
ered wcightlcss for this prohlcni. What is the horimnkil force tranhrnitled
at A tn the trapped rock shown i n the diagram'?
We have he]-e thrcc two-force menibcrh coining kigethci- iit 11.
Accordingly. if we i d a t e pin I1 a s a rrec body. we will h;ir.c Ilircc forces
acting o n thc pin. These forces must he collinciir with the cenlerliiieh 01 the
respectivc mcnihers. a s explained earlier (Fig. 5.42).
Thc force I.;>is easily computed by considcring the iictioii 1 i i Ihc
piston. Thus. we get
Figure 5.45. Rock crusher.

/;] = 150)nx' = 2,51(1 Ih


4

The lorcc transmitted to the rock i n the horimiitiil dircction ic flieii 4.850
1 cos I S " = 4.690 Ih. I;,
i
:. Horizontal force transiniltcd to thc rock = 4,690 Ib Figure 5.36.trce-hmly dia;rarn o i pin H.

5.9 Problems Arising From Structures


SECTION 5.9 PROBLEMS ARISING FROM STRUCTURES 201

Example 5.13
Rod C shown in Fig. 5.47 is welded to a rigid drum A , which is rotating
about its axis at a steady angular speed w o f 500 RPM. This rod has a mass
per unit length w , which varies linearly from the base to the tip starting
with the value of 20 kg/m at the base to 28 kglm at the tip. If normal .strexs
is defined as the normal force at a section divided by the area of the sec-
tion (similar to pressure except that the force can be pulling away from the
section rather than always pushing against the section), what is the normal
stress at any cross section of the cylinder at a distance r from the centerline
B-B of the drum due only to the motion?

,Rod C

Figure 5.47. Rods attached tu il rotating rigid drum

First we expose a section of the rod at a distance r from B-B in a


,frre-bod? diagram as shown in Fig. 5.48 in which we denote the normal
stress acting on this section as rrr.The force from this section must restrain
the centrifugal force stemming from the angular motion of the portion of
the rod beyond position r. For this purpose, we consider an infinitesimal
slice of the rod (see Fig. 5.48). We shall use the variable q to denote the
distance to the slice from the centerline B-B. Furthermore, the thickness of
the slice shall he d q . We shall use rl to position slices bctween end posi-
tion r of the free-body diagram and the tip of the rod. We are using this
approech for bookkeeping purposes. Now you will recall from freshman
physics that the centrifugal force on this slice is given by
202 CHAPTEK 5 EQUATIONS OF EQlJlLIBRlUM

Example 5.13 (Continued)

F.B.D ,XCentritugal turcr

B R

Figure 5.48. Free hody exposes T,, at section r. Note that q is a dummy wriahle.

Consequently, the total centrifugal force for the material beyond position r
in the free body of Fig. 5.48 will he found by integration to be

7
f,,,, = WJJ dq 0
' (b)

Next, note that the term w varies linearly with JJ as follows:

w = 20 + '1.2 8 kg/m

Clearly from this equation we see that when q = .2, we get a' = 20
kglm and when JJ = .7, we get M' = 28 kg/m. Also, the variation is
linear. Now, going back to Eq. (b), we have

Integrating f,,,,, = 2.742 x IO'

= 2.742 x 10'[4.116 + 1.829 - 8.40r2 ~ 5.333~~1

We can give the desired stress T , by~ dividing by the cross-sectional area
nD2/4 = 7.854 x 10-'mZ. We thus have the desired normal stress distri-
bution for sections of the rod as follows:
SECTION 5.9 PROBLEMS ARISING FROM STRUCTURES 203

Example 5.14
Consider a thin-walled tank containing air at a pressure of 100 psi above
that of the atmosphere [see Fig. 5.49(a)]. The outside diameter D of the
tank is 2 ft and the wall thickness t is 114 in. We consider as a free body
from the tank wall a vanishingly small element such as ABCE in the dia-
gram having the shape of a rectangular parallelepiped. What are the stresses
on the cut surfaces of the element? Neglect the weight of the cylinder.

(4 (b) (C)

Figure 5.49. Thin-walled tank with inside gauge pressure p .

We can examine face BC by considering a free body of part of the


tank, as shown in Fig. 5.49(h) exposing BC. (Note that we have not
included the pressure on the inside wall). Because there is a net force from
the air pressure only in the aria1 direction of the cylinder, we can expect
normal stress r,, (like pressure except that it is tensile rather than com-
pressive) over the cut section of the cylinder, as has heen indicated in the
diagram. Furthermore, because the wall of the tank is thin compared to the
diameter, we can assume that the stress r,,, is uniform across the thickness.
Finally, for reasons of uxiul symmet? of geometry and loading, we can
expect this stress to he uniform around the entire cross section. Now we
may sily from considerations of equilibrium in the axial direction that

L J

p-( D - 2 t ) 2 (IOO)(24 - $1'


.: 7 =- = 2.325 psi
nl D2 - ( D - 2 t ) 2 = -24* - 23.52 (a)
Hence, on face BC we have a uniform stress of 2,325 psi. Clearly, this
must also be true for face AE. This is called an uxiul stress.
To expose face EC next, we consider a half-cylinder of unit length
such as is shown in Fig. 5.49(c). Because it is j a r from the ends and
because the wall is thin, we can assume as an approximation that the stress
rn2 shown is uniform over the cut section." A pressure p is shown acting

"Nenr the ends of the tank lhe stress distribution varies in value because of 1he pror-
imily ofthe comp/icoredyrornrrry atid the contributions toward equilibrium afthe end plates.
204 ('HAPTEII s EQUATIONS or EQUILIBKIIJM

Example 5.14 (Continued)


:4normal to the insidc wall surface. (The stress r,,, computed earlier i s licit
; shown, to avoid cluttering the diagram.) Now we consider an end view of
! this body i n Fig. 5.50 lor cquilihriuin i n the vertical directiiin. Wc havc

lrp(;
2[(r,,?) ( / ) ( I ) ] -- - /)c/Q(l)sinQ = o (b)

:. r,,2 = 21I [,,('2' -- I ) ] ( - cos Q ) ~ n


I1
3
y
t

Figure 5.50. I k r bridy of pari of


I
!
r,,2 = ,J( 2I
- 1) = 4,700 psi cylinder.

i We puinl out now that the force in a piirlicular direclion friini a uni- 5,,
: lorm Dressitre on a curved surfice equals lhc Drcssurc times the .uroiected
. r
area of this surface i n the directkin (if thc dcsircd force. (You w i l l leiirii
this i n your studies (if hydrostatics.) Thus for the case at hand tlie projected
area i s that of a rectangle I x (11 - 21). s o that the second expresion of r
Eq. (h) becomes p ( D - 2).You inay rcadily verify that this give\ thc "\

sanie result as ahovc. TI,


The stress r,,, i s
called the hoop .srrc.ss; i t i s about twice the u~rirrl
,sfre.s,sr,, . Wc show element A M % with the stresscs present in Fig. 5.51 Figure 5.51. Free body u l ~ n
clcrncnt of the cylinder.

......., _"l_l_..
, .," ,__x_I .. . ,. ~ .... , ;_______..
. ,.

5.10 Static indeterminacy


Examine the simple beam i n Fig. 5.52, with known external loads and weight.
I S thc defiirniation of the heam i s small, and the final positions o f the external
loads alter deformation differ only slighlly Srom their initial positions, we can
unic the bcem to be rigid and. using the wideformed gcomctry, we can
solve the \upporting forces A, I<<, and B,. This is piissihle since we have three
equationa (if equilibrium available. Suppose, now, that an additional support
i s made availahle to the beam, as indicated in Fig. 5.53. Thc beam can still be
coiisidered a rigid body, since the applicd I m d w i l l shift even less hecause 0 1
I{, de1orm;ition. Thcrclore, the resultant force coming from the ground to coun-
tciilct the applied loads and wcight of the beam niust he the sume as before. In
Figure 5.52. Skitically drtel-minatc problem tile first case, i n which two supports wei-e given, howcvcr, a unique set 01val-
ues for the Siirces A . B l , and By gsve us the required rcsullant. In other words,
we wcrc able to solve for these liirccs hy stdtics alone, without further cun-
SECTION 5.10 STATIC INDETERMINACY 205

siderations. In the second case, rigid-body statics will give the required same
resultant supporting force system, but now there are an infinite number of
possible combinations of values of the supporting forces that will give us the
resultant system demanded by equilibrium of rigid bodies. To decide on the
proper combination of supporting forces requires additional computation.
Although the deformation properties of the beam were unimportant up to this
point, they now become the all-important criterion in apportioning the sup-
porting forces. These problems are termed statically indeterminute, in con-
trast to h e statically determinate type, in which statics and the rigid-body
assumption suffice. For a given system of loads and masses, two models-the
Figure 5.53. Statically indeterminate
rigid-body model and models taught in other courses involving elastic behav- problem.
ior-are accordingly both employed to achieve a desired end. In summary:

indeterminate problem, we must satisfy both the equaiions of


fur rigidbodies and the equations that stemfrum deformation
tions. In statically determinare problems, we need only satisfy
ons of equilibrium.

In the discussion thus far, we used a beam as the rigid body and dis-
cussed the statical determinacy of the supporting system. Clearly, the same
conclusions apply to any structure that, without the aid of the external con-
straints, can be taken as a rigid body. If, for such a structure as a free body,
there are as many unknown supporting force and couple-moment components
as there are equations of equilibrium, and if these equations can be solved for
these unknowns, we say that the structure is externally statically determinate.
On the other hand, should we desire to know the forces transmitted
between internal members of this kind of structure (i.e., one that does not
depend on the external constraints for rigidity), we then examine free bodies
of these members. When all the unknown force and couple-moment compo-
nents can be found by the equations of equilibrium for these free bodies, we
then say that the structure is internally statically determinute.
There aTe structures that depend on the external constraints for rigidity
(see the mucture shown in Fig. 5.54). Mathematically speaking, we can say
for such structures that the supporting force system always depends on both
the internal forces and the external loads. (This is in contrast to the previous
case, where the supporting forces could, for the externally statically determi-
nate case, be related directly with the external loads without consideration of
the internal forces.) In this case, we do not distinguish between internal and
external statical determinacy, since the evaluation of supporting forces will Figure 5.54. Nonrigid structure
involve free bodies of some or all of the internal members of the structure;
hence, some or all of the internal forces and moments will be involved. For
such cases, we simply state that the structure is statically determinate if, for
all the unknown force and couple-moment components, we have enough
equations of equilibrium that can be solved for these unknowns.
5.90. Draw tree-hudy diagram\ liir the hoe. aims, and tractor 01
the bdckhuc. Conhidcr thr weight of cach part to act at a central
location. Thc backhoe IS inot digging at thc insmil shown. Neglect
the weights of the hydraulic systcms CE, A H , and F l i ,

Figure P.5.90.

5.Yl. A parking-lot gate ami weighs 150 N. Becauw 01 thc


.itper, thc weight can he regarded a\ conccntl-a~cdat a puint I .?5
11 from the pivot point. What iorce must he exrrtcd hy the sole-
loid to l i l t the galc? What mlcnoitl force i\ necehsary it a 300-N
:r,unlerwcight i s plised .25 111 t o the left o l t h e pivot point?

i.92. Find thz force dclivcrcd ill c' i n a lhiiiimnval direction


v crush the rock. Presrurc p = 100 p i g arid p , = hO psig
pressures nieebured a h w r atmmpheric prehwrci. The diameter\
)Ithe pistons are h iii. each. Nrglcot thc wciplit d thr rock Figure P.5.94
5.95. Find the values of F and C so that members A B and CD 5.98. (a) Find the supporting forces at B. Neglect the weights of
fail simultaneously. The maximum load for A B is 15 kN and for the members.
CII is 22 kN.Neglect the weight of the members. (b) What is the force in the member CB?

1 1
100 mm
Figure P.5.95.
5.96. The landing carriage uf a transport plane supports a sta-
tionary total vertical load of 200 k N There are two wheels on Figure P.5.98.
each side of shock strut AB. Find the force in member EC, and the
forces transmitted to the fuselage at A, if the brakes are locked and
5.99. Find the suppotting forces at B and C. Disc A weighs
the engines are tested resulting in a thrust of 5 kN, 40% of which
is resisted by this landing gear. 200 N. Neglect the weights of the members as well as friction.

5.97. Find the magnitudcs (if the supporting forces fur the frame
show You may only use fuv free-body diagrams for this prob- Figure P.5.99.
lem. k t forth a complete system of equations for solving the
desired unknowns hut do not carry out the algebra for actually
solving these equations for the desired unknowns. 5.100. Find the supporting force system at C. Neglect friction.

Figure P.5.97. Figure P.5.100.

207
c

U
Figure P.5.102 Figure I'.5.I04.
5.105. A trdp door i s kept open hy a rod CD, whose weight we 5.107. Find the supporting forces at A and C. You must show
shall neglect. The door has hinges a1 A and R and has B weight OS and use only m e free-body diagram.
200 Ib. A wind hlowing against the outside surface of the door
creates a prersure increase o f 2 Iblft'. Find the force in the rod,
assuming that it cannot slip from the position shown. Also deter-
mine the forces transmitted to the hinges. Only hinge B can resist
motion along direction A R .

2m k+

Figure P.5.107.

5.108. A coupling between two shafts transmits an axid load ot


5,000 N. Four bolts ha\ing a diameter each of 13 m m , cmnects
the two units. Befbrc loading of the shafts, thesc bolts have anly
negligible tensile forces. Assuming that each bolt carries the same
Inad, what i s the average normal stress in each bolt stemming
from the 5.(100 N lotid?

Figure P.5.105.

5.106. Find the Ibrce BO. A l l conncctims are ball-and-socket


,ioints. Neglect the wcights of a l l the members. Member AB has
CF"
50Nm

two XI' bends. Member RI) i s in the yz. plane.


Figure P.5.108.

5.109. A circular shaft i s suspended from above. The specific


weight OS the shaft material i s 1.22 x I O * Nlm'. What i s the ten-
sile stress r.. o n cross sections of the shaft a i a function of r?

Figure P.5.109.

5.110. Do the previous pmblrm k r the czce whex the specific


weight y varies with the syuure of z starting with the value of
6.50 x IO" Nlm' at the top and reaching a value of 7.50 x
Figure P.S.106. IO4 Nlm' at the bottom.

209
Figure 1'.5.1 11.

5.11 Closure
5.113. Determine the tensions in 811 the cables. Block A has a 5.116. Find the forces on the block of ice from the hook.; at
mass of 600 kg. Note that GH is in the yz plane. A and F .

Figure P.5.113.

5.114. Determine the force components at G. E weighs 300 Ih. A


+I 5' *I
Figure P.5.116.

5.117. Members AB and BC weighing, respectively, 50 N and


200 N are connected to each other by a pin. BC cunnecls to a disc
K on which a turque T, = 200 N-m is applied. What turque T is
needed on A B tu keep the system in equilibrium at the configura-
Figure P.5.114. tion shown'?

5.115. A scenic excursion train with cog wheels for steep


inclines weighs 30 tons when fully loaded. If the cog wheels have
a mean radius to the contact points of the teeth of 2 ft, what torque
must he applied to the driver wheels A if wheels B run free? What
force do wheels B lransmit to the ground?

I I /-

Figure P.5.115. Figure P.5.117.

21
5.1 I X .A transport j e t planr has ii weight without frirl uf220 kN.
If om wing is I<,aded with SO k N r i f f k l , what are the force? in
eich 01 the three landing gear?

4
H--'
111 4 111

Figure P.5.118.

5.119. A rod AB i s connected by a hall-and-wcket joiiit to a


frictionlesc sleeve at A , arid by a ball-and-sochet .joint t o ii fixcd
position at 8.What are the supporting fbrccs at B and at A i l we
ncglect the weight of AB? The 100LIh load i\ connected 10 the
C C I I ~ C I0 1 A l l .

8'

Figure P.5.119. Figure P.5.122.

212
5.123. Light rods RC and AC are pinned togetherat C and sup- 5.125. A bent rod AUCB supports two weights-one at the cen-
port a BOO-N load and a 500-N-m couple moment. What arc the ter of AU and one at the centcr of UC. There are ball-and-socket
supporting forces at A and B ? joint supports at A and R . With one scalar equation using the triple
scalar product, determine the tension in cable Uc'.

2m

10,

Figure P.5.123.
I x
Figure P.5.125.

5.124. A rod AB is held by a hall-and-socket joint at A and sup-


ports a 100-kg mass C at 8.This rod is in the z? plane and is 5.126. Find the tension in cable FH. The disc C weighs 500 Ih.
inclined to the? axis by an angle of 159 The rod is 16 m long and Use only one free body.
F is at its midpoint. Find the forces in cables DF and ER. Crosa-
hatching indicates part of the V E plane. H

Figure P.5.124. Figure P.5.126.

213
Figure I'S.131
5.132. A uniform block weighing 500 Ih is constrained by three 5.135. A mechanism consists OS two weights W each OS weight
wires. What are the tensions in these wires? 50 N,tour light linkagi: rods each of length (iequal 10 200 mm,
and a spring K whose spring constant i s X Nlmm. The spring i c
unextended when H = 450 I f held vertically, what is the angle B
A n fix equilihrium'! Neglect friction. The force from the spring equals
K times the compression of the sprins.

Figure P.5.132.

5.133. Find the suppvrting forces for thz frame shown


Figure P.S.135.

,,- ~ k 2,000 Nini 5.136. Find the compressive force in pawl AB. What is the resul-
tant supporting force system at E!

2-
Figure P.5.133.

5.134. Four cables supporl a black of weight 5,000 N. The edges


of the block are parallel to the coordinate axes. Point B i s at
(7, 7, -15). What are the forces in the cables and the direction
cosines for cable CI)? , ~, ,, .,:__
fi:
Figure P.5.136.
5.137. A IO-kN load is lifted in the front loader bucket. Whal
are the furces at the connections tu the bucket and to ann AEI
Hydraulic ram DF i s prrpcndicular to arm AE, and AC is h o r i m n ~
tal. Points A and I. ;ire iit the same height above the friiund.

IS'",

Figure P.5.134. Figure P.5.137.


n

L - 1

Figure P.5.142.
5.144. What force F do the pliers develop on the pipe section Ll?
Ncglect friction.
Wind load
normal to arc

10 m m

A ti
Figure P.5.146.

5.147. An arch is formed by uniform plates A and R. Plate A


weighs 5 kN and plate R weighs 2 kN. What are the supporting
forces at C, 1). and E'!

20 kN
'13ON I
Figure P.5.144.

5.145. What are the supporting forces for the frame'? Neglrct a11
weights except the IO-kN weight.

Figure P.5.147.
5.148. Find the iupponing forces at the ball-and-socket connec-
tions A , 0, and C. Mcmbers A 8 and DB are pinned together
through member EC at R.

I.000 Ib
Parallel
n
Figure P.5.145.

5.146. A 20-m circular arch must withstand a wind load given


lor O < B < 7 ~ 1 2as

f = 5,000( I - n)
e Nlm
where B is measured in radians. Note that for 8 > 7~12,there i?
n o loading. What are the supporting forces? (Hint: What is the x
point lor which taking moments is simplest'!) Figure P.5.148.

217
5153. A bar can rotate parallel to plane A about an axis of rota- .4? m ... 30 m
tion normal to the plane at 0. A weight W is held by a cord that is
attached to the bar over a small pulley that can rotate freely as the
bar rotiltes. Find the value of C for equilibrium if h = 300 mm,
W = 30 N, @ = 3(Y, I = 700 mm, and d = 500 mm.

x x
5.157. Find the supporting forces at A , A, and C. Neglect the
weight ofthe rod. Use only one free-body diagram.
IW Ib
Figure P.5.153,

5.154. Find the supporting forces at A and B in the frame.


Neglect weights of member?.

I I O Ih/ft

40'

Figure P.5.154.
c 30"

5.155. A holt cutter has a force of 130 N applied at each handle. Figure P.5.157.
What is the force on the bolt from the cutter edge?
5.158. The 5,000 Ib viin A of an airline food catering truck rises
straight up until its floor is level with the airplane tloor. A hydraulic
ram pulls on the right bottom support of the lift mechanism at which
we have rollers to prevent friction. The two members of the lift
mechanism are pinned at their center. The center of gravity of the
van is its geometric center. What is the ram force for this position?

,Bolt
I- 1 2 ' 4 No friction

130 N
Figure P.5.155.

5.156. A steam locomotive is developing a pressure of .20 Nlmm'


gage. If the train is stationary, what is the total traction force from
the two wheels shown? Neglect the weight of the various connect-
ing rods. Neglect friction in piston system and connecting rod pins. Figure P.5.158.

219
E

I'

!!
Figure P.S.159.
S.IU1. For lhc structure \houii. dclemiine i h c i m c e i n the
;:ihlc Et'.

Figurc P.S.lh0. Figure P.S.162

220
Introduction
to Structural
Mechanics
Part A Trusses
6.1 The Structural Model
A trus,? is a system of members that are fastened together at their ends to sup-
port stationary and moving loads.' Everyday examples of trusses are shown in
Figs. 6. I and 6.2. Each member of a truss is usually of uniform cross-section
along its length; however. the various members typically have different cross-
sectional areas because they must transmit different forces. Our purpose in
Part A of this chapter is to set forth methods for determining forces in members
of an elementary class of trusses.
As a first step, we shall divide trusses into two main categories accord-
ing to geometry. A truss consisting of a coplanar system of members is called
a plane Irus.7. Examples of plane trusses are the sides of a bridge (see Fig.
6.1) and a roof truss (see Fig. 6.2). A three-dimensional system of members,
on the other hand, is called a p a c e truss. A common example of a space truss
is the tower from an electric power transmission system (see Fig. 6.3). Both
plane trusses and space trusses consist of members having cross-sections
resembling the letters H, I, and L. Such members are commonly used in many
structural applications. These members are fastened together to form a truss
by being welded, riveted, or bolted to intermediate structural elements called
Russet plates such as has been shown in Fig. 6.4(a) for the case of a plane
truss. The analysis of forces and moments in such connections is clearly quite
complicated. Fortunately, there is a way of simplifying these connections

' A i i u s , ~is different than a,frame (see the footnote on p. 157) in that the members of a truss
are always connected together at the ends of the members. as will soon become evident, whereas
a frame has some rnemhers with connections not at the ends of the member.

22 I
222 CHAPTER 6 INI'ROI~IICTIONTO STRUCTURAL MECHANICS

Figure 6.1. Foot hridgc near author's former home. Sidcs oi sirucfurc are plane irusscs

Figure 6.2. Roof trusses that are plane trusses


SECTION 6.1 THE STRUCTURAL MODE 223

Figure 6.3. Space tmsscs supporting transmission lines


sending power into the northeast grid of the United
States.

such as to incur very little loss in accuracy in determining forces in the mem-
hers. Specifically, if the centerlines of the members are (nncurrenf at the
connections, such as is shown in Fig. 6.4(a) for the coplanar case, then we
can replace the complex connection at the points of concurrency by a simple
pin connection in the coplanar truss and a simple ball-and-socket connection
for the space truss. Such a replacement is called an iderzliiution of the system.
This is illustrated for a plane truss in Fig. 6.4, where the actual connector or
joint is shown in (a) and the idealization as a pinned joint is shown in (b).
In order to maximize the load-carrying capacity of a truss, the external
loads must he applied at the joints. The prime reason for this rule is the fact
that the members of a truss are long and slender, thus rendering compression
members less able to c a y loads transverse to their centerlines away from the
ends? If the weights of the members are neglected, as is sometimes the case,
it should be apparent that each member is a t ~ ' ~ ~ f i )member,
rce and accord-
ingly is either a tensile member or a cornpression member. If the weight is
not negligible, the common practice as an approximation is to apply half the
weight of a member to each of its two joints. Thus, the idealization of a mem-
ber as a two-force member is still valid.
'You will understand these limitations innre clearly when you study huckling in your
strength 0 1 materials course.
rriiioviil 01 ;my of i t s menrherc dcstioyc i t s rigidity. Ii rcmo\:ing :I mrniher
does not dcstioy rigidity, the \ti-ucture I \ said IO be (iv?r~ri,qid.Wc shiill he
SIXTION 6.4 METHOD OF JOINTS 225

forces acting on it from the members can always he found. (One such joint is
the last joint formed.) Each unknown force from a member onto this joint
must Iiavc a direction collinear with that member, and hence has a known
direction. There are, then, only three unknown scalars, and since we have a
concurrent forcc system they can he determined by statics alone. We then
find another joint with only three unknowns and so carry on the computations
until the forces in the entire structure have been evaluated. For the simple
plane truss, it similitr procedure can be followed. The free body of at least one
joint has only two unknown forces. We have a concurrent, coplanar force sys-
tem, and we accordingly can solve the corresponding two equilibrium equa-
tions in two unknowns at that joint. Wc then proceed to the other joints,
thereby evaluating all member forces by the use of statics alone.

6.3 Solution of Simple Trusses


Generally, the first step in a truss analysis is to compute the supporting forces
c

*,
I)
in the ovurall truss. This calculation of the external forces or reactions that
must exist to keep the truss in equilibrium is independent of whether the truss,
internally, is statically detcrminate or statically indeterminate. Simply regard
the truss as a rigid body to which forces are applied, some known (given
applied forces) and some unknown (rcactions),' and solve for the reactions as
10 m
we did in Chapter 5. We have shown a simple plane truss in Fig. 6.7(a) and
have shown the features of the truss in Fig. 6.7(b) thal are essential for the cal-
culations of the reactions. Note that members such as CA, DB, and DE need
not he shown in the free body since they provide irirmnirrl forces for the body.
Once the free-body diagram has heen carefully drawn, use three equa-
tions of equilibrium to determine the reactions of a plane tmss (six equations
for a space truss). It is highly advisable to then check your results by using
another (dependent) equation of equilibrium. You will be using the computed
reactions for many subsequent calculations involving forces in internal mem-
hers. Accordingly, with much work at stake. it is important to start off with a
correct set of reactions.
t
R,

We shall present two methods for determining the forces in the mem- Z.(xx) N
hers of the truss. One is called the rnezhod oj'joinrs and the other is called the (b)
merhod of serliorrs. As will be seen in the following sections, the prime dii- Figure 6.7. Free-hody analysis of truss.
ference between these method:, lies in the choice of the free bodies to he used.

6.4 Method of Joints


In the method of joints, the free-body diagrams to he used. once the reactions
are determined, are the pins or hall joints and the forces applied to them hy
the attached members and external loads. Note that we havc already alluded

'Suppming Ibrrch are o r h c j l l c d rwcliom i n S I ~ U F I U T . ~mcchanics


~
226 CHAPTER 6 INTRODUCTION TO STRUCrtJKAI. M[.C'HANICS

to this method in Section 6.2. Consider first Ihc trian$ular plane truss shown
i n Fig. h.X(a). Niitice we havc already determined the I'L'ilctions.
' '

1.000 N I .lIOO N

51111 N ilil N 5110 N


(Bl lhl IC1

Figure 6.8. Mcthod ol.juint\ joint B.

Next, consider the free hody of pin B [Fig. h.X(b)l. The unknown forces
from the members arc shown cnlliiiear with the centerlines o f Ihese member5
since they are two-liirce nienihers. We can s o l v e fiir these foi-ccs by setting
the sum of forces equal to zern i n the hnrizont;il and vertical directinns. to g c ~

Because both forces arc p m h i r q against pin B. the corresponding members arc
compressive rathcr than tension rnenihers. We can mnst readily see this fact hy
considering Fig. 6.X(c), where members AH and C" have been cut ;it vwinus
places. Notice that AH i s also pushing againsl pin A as dncs ('8against pin <'.
Thus, nnce having decided that the incmhers arc. compressive meinhers 21s ii
result of considerations itf a pin at one end o f the member. we can conclude
that the member i s pushing with equal force against the pin at the other end.
To make for specd and accuracy in we go Sviiiii nnr .joint to ;mother. wc rec-
ornmend that, once the nature of the Inading i n a mcmher has heen established
hy considerations at a pin. we mark down this viilue using a T for t e n s i ~ nor ii
C for compression after i t on the trusb diagram. as shown i n Fig. h.Y(a). Note
also that apprnpriate arrows arc drawn in the memhcrs. Thcsc imows rcprescnr
577 N forces developcd by the tnrmher,~,,n die phia. Hence. for minprevsior! the
arrnws point lowcirri the pins, ;uid for r c v s i o r i they point c i w < y lrom the pins.
Acciirdingly. if we now comidcr the Iree hody of pin A a s shiiwii in Fig.
h.S)(h). we know the direction and valuc nf the Ihrcc 011 A lrnm nicmher AB.
500 N If a negative valuc i s found fiir a I i r c e at ii pin. the seiise CIS the force
has heen taken incorrectly iit the outset. With thi\ in mind. wc deciclc whether
the memher ~issociatedwith Ihc fnrce is a teii\ion or comprehsiiin inemher
(b) and we label the mcrnher accordingly, a b s h w m in Fig. h.Y(a) for use later i n
examining the pin at the other end 01the incinher as a ltee hody.
Figure 6.9. Procedure for method of joints
(a) Notation for mcmhers AB and CH: We now consider the solutiiin nf ii plane ti-ucs prnhlem hy the method
(b) free-body diagram of A. ofjnints i n prcater detail.
SFCTION 6.4 METHOD OF JOINTS 227

Example 6.1
A simple plane truss is shown in Fig. 6. IO. Two I ,000-lh loads are shown D
acting on pins C and E. We are to determine the force transmitted by each
member. Neglect the weight of the members.
In this simple loading, we see by inspection that there are 1,000-lb
vertical forces at each support. We shall begin, then, hy studying pin A , for
which there are only two unknowns.

Pin A. The forces on pin A are the known 1,000-lb supporting force and 1.000lh 1,000Ih
two unknown forces from the members AB and AC. The orientation of Figure 6.10. Plane truss
these forces is known from the geometry of the truss, but the magnitude
and sense must be determined. To help in interpreting the results, put the
forces in the same position as the corresponding members in the truss dia-
gram as is shown in Fig. 6.1 l . That is, avoid the force diagram in Fig.
6.12, which is equivalent to the one in Fig. 6.11 but which may lead to
errors in interpretation. There are two unknowns for the concurrent coplanar
force system in Fig. 6.1 I and thus, if we use the scalar equations of equi-
librium, we may evaluate sR
and FAc:
A FA(.
=0
~

F~~ - n 707~,,= 0 I 1,000 Ih

F, = 0 Figure 6.11. Pin


~- ~~

~ ~= n
-0 7 0 7 +~ 1,000

Therefore,

FAB = 1,414B , FAc 0 1,mm

Since both results are positive, we have chosen the proper senses for the 1,000 Ib
FAX
forces. We can then conclude on examining Fig. 6.1 I that AB is a com-
pression member, whereas AC is a tension member:? In Fig. 6.13, we have Figure 6.12. Pin A--avoid this diagram.
labeled the members accordingly.
If we next examine pin C , clearly since there are three unknowns
involved for this pin, we cannot solve for the forces by equilibrium equa-
tions at this time. However, pin B can be handled, and once Gcis known,
the forces on pin C can be determined.

Pin E. Since AB is a compression member (see Fig. 6.13) we know that it


exerts a Sorce of 1,414 Ib directed against pin B as has been shown in Fig. A F
6.14. As for members BC and E D , we assign senses as shown. 1,000 Ih T
I
I,(XX)lh 1,000lh 1.000lh I.OMlIh
sHad we used Fig. 6.12 as a lree hody. the State of loading in the memkrs (i.e.. tension
or compression) would not he clear..Therefore. we strongly rccommend putting forces reprc~ Figure 6.13. Notation for members A 8
senting memkrs in positions coinciding with the members. and AC.
228 CHAPTER 6 INTRODIICTION TO S I K t ~ ( ' T 1 I R A I . MM'HANII'S

Example 6.1 (Continued)

Figure 6.14. Pin li,

Summing forces on pin A (Fig. 6.14). wc get

(1.414)(0.707)+ Fk( = 0

FBc = -1,000 Ib

Hcrc we have ohtained Lwo negativc qumtitic\. indicating t l i i i t wc i


!
have made incorrect clioiceb 0 1 sense. Kccping t h i h i n mind, we can con-
clude that memhes R D i s a compression membcr, when-ens mcnihcr IK' i\
a tension mcmher. Noticc that wc havc shown thebe liirccs propci-1) iii
Fig. 6. I S .
We can proceed i n this nianner i r o m .joint to ,joint. A I thc last .joint
a11 the forces w i l l havc hecn computed without using il iis ii frcc hody.
Thus, i t i s available to he used iis ii check on the solution. 'lhnt is. thc win
of the known forces for thc last joint in the iand directions should hc
zero or closc to zero, dcpcnding (in the accuracy of yiiur ciilciilation\. We
urge you to take advantage of this check. The final wlutiim i h ~ I i o In ~ n
Fig. 6.15. Notice that membcr CI) has zero load. This docs not i n e m that
we can get rid of this nieniher. Othes luxlings expccted for thc t r i i s y hill
result in nonzero forcc lor C.'D. Furtherninre. without C I ) thc truss will not
he rigid.

Figure 6.15. Solution lor tius?. I


SECTION 6.4 METHOD OF JOINTS 229

Example 6.2
A bridge truss is shown in Fig. 6.16 supporting at its pins half of a roadbed
weighing 1,000 Ib per foot. A truck is shown on the bridge having esti-
mated loads on pins E , G, and I of the truss equaling, respectively, 1 ton,
1.5 tons, and 2.5 tons. The members weigh 45 Ib/ft. Include the weight of
the members by putting half the weight of a member at each of its two sup-
porting pins. Find the supporting forces.
A F H J

L.
Figure 6.16. A bridge truss supporting a roadbed and a truck

We first determine the forces on the pins from the weight of the
members denoting them as (W,)j.Thus we have

s Weights of members
I ~ a d 1:

(W,)*= (W,), = 2[?(20)(45)]


I = 900 Ih
I 20 (45) = 1,536.5 Ib
( y ) R= (T), = 2[;(20)(45)] + -2(.707) ~

(W,),. = (W,),= (W,)(=;3[;(20)(45)]+ I 20


2[1(m)(45)] = 2,623 Ib

(W,)” = (W,))=
H (W,)E = 3[;(20)(45)] = 1,350 Ib

Next we get to the roadbed

Loads 2: Weights from the roadbed


1
(Wz),,
= (W2), = 2(500)(20)= 5,000 Ib
(W2)<:= ( W 2 ) E= (Wz)G = (500)(20)= 10,000 Ib

Finally, we list the loads from the truck.

Loads 3: Weightsfrom the truck


(W?), = 2,000 Ih
(W,),; = 3,000 Ib
(WJ, = 5,000 Ib
230 CHAPTliR 6 INTROL~lJ('Tl0NTO S'IKII('TC'RAL MIX'IIANICS

ExamtAe 6.2 (Continued)


I
We are now rcady to determine [he supporling fiwcec for the ti-ins. Taking
the entire truss a s a frce hody we firs1 take niulncnts ahout joint I ( w e
Fig. 6.17).
!

1S.lUl0 Ih
SECTION 6.4 METHOD OF JOINTS 231
Example 6.3
Ascertain the forces transmitted by each member of the three-dimensional
truss [Fig. 6.18(a)].
We can rcddily find the supporting forces for this simple structure
by considering the whole structure as a free body and by making use of
the symmetry of the loading and geometry. The results are shown in
Fig. 6.18(b).

Figure 6.18. (a) Space tmss and (b) free-body diagram

Joint F. It is clear, on an inspection of the forces in the x direction acting


on joint F, that :FpE = 0 , since all other forces are in a plane at right
angles to it. These other forces are shown in Fig. 6.19. Summing forces in
they and z directions, we get F

I,&JOlb
Figure 6.19. Free-body diagram of joint F.
Therefore,
FBD = 2,240lb compression
I
cz F =0:
10
-FAF + 1,000 - 2,240- =0
4500
Therefore,
CF = I.000 - 1,000 = 0
232 CHAPTER h INTRODUCTION TO STRUCTURAL. MI~CIIANK'S

Example 6.3 (Continued)

Joint B. Going to .join1 B, w e see ]Fig. 6.1X(h)l that FnR = 0 and

tiE= 0 , Since thcre are 110 olhcr liirce components on pin B i n the

directions of these members. Finally. FBc = 2.000 Ih tension

Joint A . Let uh ncxt consider,joini A (Fig. (i.20). Wc cim express I11l-c~ ct(.
and 5,:vectorially. Thuc.

Joint I). We now consider.ioint D (Fig. 6.21). Forces 4.,)and F:,,i ~ r e


expressed 21s lollows: Figure 6.21. I'rec-hmly diasmrii of jainl IJ.

.. . ~ . ..,. . "I __-


SECTION 6.4 METHOD OF JOINTS 233
I Example 6.3 (Continued)

Hence, summing forces, we get


-2,000j - 1,000k - F,,,i + 2,240(.894j + .447k)
+ F,,(-.40Xi - .816j - .408k) = 0 (d)
Thus,
-2,000 + 2.000 - .81bF,, = 0 (e)
l& + .408F,, = 0 (0
-1,000 + 1,000 - ,4085, = 0 (8)

We see here that FED = 0 and F,, = 0 ,

Joint E. The only nonzerc) forces on joint E are the supporting forces and
F;.&, as shown in Fig. 6.22(a). We solve I& = Z&Wlbcompression .

Joint C. As a check on our problem, we can examine joint C. The only


nonzero forces are shown on the joint [Fig. 6.22(b)]. The reader may read-
ily verify that the solution checks.

E X

1,000 Ib

1,000 Ib
(a) (b)
Figure 6.22. (a) Free-body diagram ofjoint E and (b) joint C.
234 ('HAPTER 6 INTKOIXJ(:TION TO STKIICIIIRAI.MECHANICS

Belore proceeding with the problems. i t will he well to comment on


the loading 01 plane roo1 trusscs. IJsually there will be a series of \cp;ir;itetl
parallel t t u h z e h supporting the loading from the r o d such a s i h S ~ O W I I i n
Fig. 6.23, wlicre a wind pressurc is shown on a roof as 11. Niiw the Oisiilr tru\h
can he considered to support the loading over a region extending h;lllway tc
each neighboring trus? (shown as distanced). Furthermore. pins A and B sup-
pori thc force exerted on area Ilmk while pins B and C suppol-t the forces
excrtcd on area /IT/,. When dcaling with the entire inside truss a s a free hody,
you can use thc resultant force from pressure ovcr krwn. Howcvcr. when
dcaling with thc pins as ii free hody you must use the forces coming on tu
each pin as described ahove and no1 the totnl resultanl, which was iiscd tor
lhc free hody of the entire internal truss. Clearly. thc outhide trusses support
halt the Iimds descrihed ahove.

Figure 6.23. R o d trussc? supporting 21 wind load

Finally, we wish Lo remind you that a curved meinhcr i n a truss. such as


appears in Prohleins 6.5 and 6.8. is a two-forcc incinher with forces coming
only lrom the pinz. Rccdll that. for such nienihrrz, the force transmitted to the
pins niiist he collinear with the line connecting the pins. such as is shown i n
Fig. 6.14.
6.1. Slate which of the trusses shown are simple trusses and
which are not.

(a) Pratt INSS +4m+ ~-


Figure P.6.3.
6.4. A rooftop pond is filled with cooling water from an air con-
ditioner and is supported by a series of parallel plane trusses.
What are the forces in each member of an inside truss'! The roof
trusses are spaced a1 10 ft apart Water weights 62.4 IMA.',
(b) Fink ~NSS

i:
f
10'
i
(c) Special-purpose t r u s ~
Figure P.6.1

6.2. Find the forces transmitted by each member of the truss


Figure P.6.4.

6.5. Find the forces transmitted by the straight members of the


truss. DC is circular

5,000 Ib
Figure P.6.2.

6.3. The simple country-road bridge has floor beams to carry


vehicle loads tn the tmss joints. Find the forces in all members for
a truck-loaded weight of 160 kN. Floor beams I are supported by
pins A and B, while floor beams 2 are supported by pins B and C. Figure P.6.5.
* B

23

I
6.6. Roof tiusscs such 215 the o n r shown arc spaced 6 rn apart in
il long, ncctangular huilding. During thc wintcr. MIOW loads of LIP
to I kN/rn2 (or I kPa) ac~uniulateon the central portion o l the
nnrf. Find the force in each memher for il t r u \ no1 at the cnda of
the huilding.

Figure P.h.h.
6.9.

A
p
Find the lol-crs in thc mcmhrrs of the truss.

.
8

45"
IO", (' 10m
I,OOO N

IO 111

Figure P.6.Y.

6.7. 'Ihc bridge supportr a rtradway Imd of I.000 Ihilt lor each
0 1 the twu trusses. Each mcinhcr weighs 30 Ihilt. Crmpute the
fiirces i n the rnernhers, accounting approxim;itcly for the weight
6.10. In Example 6.1. incluilc the weights ut the memhcrs
[if t h e rnrrnhcrs.
;tppruxim:itcly. The mmmhrrs each weigh 100 Ih/ft.

I' H

6.11. Dctcriiiiiic the lorurs in thc mrmhel-s. T h r pulley5 ill c'and


I'cach weigh 300 N. Ncplecl all iithct vicighth. Bc surc yuu have
il check OI your iiiluIiuii.

Figure P.6.7. 1.000 N

6.8. Find

a
the force, i n the straight incmhcrs u l Ihc tiuhh

IO'
/I 1 0 ,

5 0 0 Ih
1)

500 Ih
Figure P.h.8
IO'
+T

Figure P.h.11
6.12 Roadway and vehicle loads are transmitted to the highway
bridge ~ N S S as the idealized forces shown. Each load is 100 kN.
What are the forces in the members?

-1 6 panela at 6 m 2 Figure P.6.14.


Figure P.6.12. 6.15. Find the forces i n the members of the truss. The 1.000-lb
Force is parallel to they axis, and the 500-lb force is parallel to the
:axis.

6.13. A hoist weighing 5 kN lifts railroad cars for truck repair.


The hoist has a 150-kN capacity and hangs from a truss with an L-
shaped member to clear boxcars. What are the forces in the
straight members for full capacity of the hoist’?

Figure P.6.15.

6.16. Find the forces in the members and the supporting forces
for the space truss ABCD. Note that BDC is in the XI plane.

Figure P.6.13.

6.14. A 5-kN traveling hoist has a 50-kN capacity and is s u s ~


pended from a beam weighing I kN/m, which, in turn, is fastened
to the roof truss at I and G as shown. In addition, wind pressures
of up to 2 kN/m2 (or 2 kPA) act on the side of the roof. The result-
ing force is transmitted to pins A and J . If the trusses are spaced S
m apart, what are the forces in each member of the truss when the
hoist is io the middle of the Span? Figure P.6.16.

231
rJ-

6.5 Method of Sections

23R
SECTION 6.5 METHOD OF SECTIONS 239
well inside a truss and avoid the laborious process of proceeding joint by joint
until reaching a joint on which the desired unknown force acts.
Generally a free body is created by passing a section (or cut) through
the truss such as section A-A or section B-B in Fig 6.25(a). Note that the sec-
tion can he straight or curved. The corresponding right hand free-body dia-
grams [see Fig. 6.25(b) for cut A-A and Fig. 6.25(c) for cut B-B] involve

B
A

(c)
Figure 6.25. Section cuts.

coplanar force systems. We have, accordingly, three equations of equilih-


rium available for each free body. One can also choose to use left-hand free-
body diagrams for these cuts. Note that in contrast to the method of joints,
one or more equilibrium equations can most profitably he moment equations.
The choice of the section (or sections) to find the desired unknowns inside a
truss involves ingenuity on the part of the engineer. Helshe will want the
fewest and simplest sections to find desired forces for one or more members
inside the truss. The method of sections is used for efficiently finding limited
information. The method of joints for such problems is by contrast one of
"brute force."
We now illustrate the method of sections in the following examples.
SECTION 6.5 METHOD OF SECTIONS 241

Exa iple 6.5


A pla tru% is shown in Fig. 6.21 for which only the force in member AB
is des rd. The supporting forces have been determined and are shown in
the di :ram.
1,000 N

I 7x9 N
1.077 N
Figure 6.21. Plane truss.

I Fig. 6.28(a) we have shown a cut J-J of the truss exposing force
5w ( lis is the same force diagram as that which results from the free-body
diagr; I of pin A,) We have here three unknown forces for which only two
equat ns of equilibrium are available. We must use an additional free body.
hus, in Fig. 6.28(b) we have shown a second cut K-K. Note that by
takin; moments about joint B, we can solve for <,c directly. With this
infori ition we can then return to the first cut to get the desired unknown
CH. i cordingly, we have, for free body 11:

C M B=0:
-(10)(500) + (30)(789) - (FAc)(sin 30")(30) = 0
(Note ve have transmitted FAc to joint H in evaluating its moment contr-
butio ) Solving for FAc we get
FAc = 1,245 N

.
a) Free body I from cut J-J (a) Free body I1 lrom C u t K-K

Figure 6.28. Free bodies needed for the computation of fiirce FAD.

~~~
242 ('HAPTLIK 6 INTKOIIIICTION 7'0 STKllCTliKAL. ME('IIANI('S

Example 6.5 (Continued)


Summing forces for free body 1. we have"

F,,,,cos 30" ~ FA<.cos 30" ~ 1.000 sin 30" = 0

Thcrcfbre,
Pi,,, = I .X22N

Therefore.

FAB = -66IN

We see that member A B i s a Leiision nieinber rathcr than ii compressim


member a i wiis our initial guess i n drawing thc free-hody diagrams.

I n retrospect. you w i l l note that. i n the method of joints, errurs made


early w i l l (if neccssity propagate through the calculations. There is, on the
other hand, much less likelihood of this occurring in the method of. sections.
However. for simple trusses with many members, we may profitahly use the
method of joints i n conjunction with a computer for which the brute-force
approach of the method o f joints i s ideally suited. I1 i s to be pointed out that
there i s computer soltw;rre availahle which makes this kind of computation
routine and quick.

*6.6 Looking Ahead-Deflection


of a Simple, Linearly Elastic Truss
I n the solids or structures courses you will soon hc laking. you w i l l he given
inhtruction for dctcnnining the nioxnient o f the pins of a linearly elastic, s i n -
ple truss steiriniing from the cxtcrnal loads. It i s true that you can now deter-
mine the forces in il simple truss and from this you can determine the change
i n length of each memher. However, using t h i s data as well a s the accompany-
ing changes o f orienllition (if the meinhen, you w i l l find i t next to impossible
to get the movements o f the pins for all hut the most trivial trusses.
!
SECTION 6.6 LOOKING AHEAD-DERECTION OF A SIMPLE, LINEARLY ELASTIC TRUSS 243
~

You will learn later of a neat method of doing this. In this method, each
movable (unconstrained) pin is imagined to be given first a hypothetical
movemeit’ 6, in one of two orthogonal directions, say the x direction here,
while no movement is allowed for that pin in the y direction. All other pins
are held fixed for the preceding action. We now evaluate via geometry the
changes in length stemming from 6, of all members affected by this hypo-
thetical < isplacement. Also, the energy of deformation8 for these members is
computei. The aforementioned displacement is shown in Fig. 6.29 for 6,. In Figure 6.29. A simple truss has its free pin
addition to the energy of deformation nf the affected members, we compute H given a hypothetical dnplacement 6,
the worb done by external forces that undergo movement from 6,, keeping while keeping all other displacement
components fixed. Note that only members
the forcqs constant during this movement. Here the work is F(cos a)6,.This CH, EH, and H E are involved. Work done is
procedure is canied out for each such x and y displacement for all of the mov- F(cos a)&,.
able pin?. We then add up all the energy terms and all the work terms, multi-
plying tke latter by - I . We then have a function of all of the n 6’scomprising
the x a n i y components of all movable pins. This function, which is com-
monly dmoted as n, is then extremized with respect to the n 6’s. We then
form n s multaneous equations from

(%)i = O
i = l,2, ... n

truss, th- members were deformable and we mentioned that we needed the
energy c f deformation for the use of the total potential energy principle.

’This is called a virruol displucemenl and will be discussed further in Chapter 10 when we
discuss the: method of virtual work.
xYoi will learn to calculate the energy of deformation in your solid mechanics or your
structures EOUTSB. The formula is where S is the axial change in length of the member, A
2L
is the cross-sectional area. E is the modulus of elasticity. and L is the length of the member.
6.25. Find the Iorucs in members C'D. DG, and llC i n the plane
11U\\.

I .oi)o ih
Figure P.6.22.

6.27. 'The roof is subjected t o :I wind hading of 20 Iblft'. Find


the 1orurs iii rncinhers LK and K.101 an interior tius5 if thc irusse\
arc spaccd 10 11 apdl~l.

Figure P.6.23.

'44
6.31. A pair of trusses supports a roadway weighing 500 Ib/ft.
By method of sections, find the forces in DF and DE. The road-
way is supported at pins A , D, F, and H on the two trusses.

15’ I” F 15’

M m

IIj0-k; Guideway 1 “5-kN hoist


t 45-kN lOdd
Figure P.6.31.
supported at
J and G only

Figure P.6.28.

6.29. In Example 6.2, determine the forces in members FG and


CE.
I
6.32. Find the force in members H E , FH, FE, and E‘C of the

I
6.30. (a Find the forces in members DG and DF by the method
of .secrio 2. Stare whether the members are tension or compression
members
members AC, AB, CB, and CD by the
diagram in an appropriate manner and
truss.

are in tension or compression.

I 80 kN
I SOkN I SO kN

SK

,
I Figure P.6.30. Figure P.6.32.

245
6.33. Find the force in member JF in the truss. 6.35. A railmad engine i \ stairing to cros\ the deck-type truh,

+ + Ion1
hridge chawn. If ths wcighc of the engine i s idealiied by Ihr hul-
\ mrmbcrs AH. HL. Cti. CL, /.ti.
SO-kip loads," find che l i ~ e in
/)ti.K.I. and I N
?,500 N

SOK XIK X!K 50K

2,500 N

2,500 N

2.500 N

I Figure P.6.33

''A kip ib a kilopound, 01 1.000 Ib.

246
I SECTION 6.8 SHEAR FORCE, AXIAL FORCE, AND BENDING MOMENT 241

Part IB: Section Forces in Beams'"


6.7 /Introduction

6.8 Shear Force, Axial Force,


and Bending Moment
, . I I .

M' fl

1UJ

Figure 6.30. Kesoltant ;it ii scctiiiii

additional slicilr c i m p i m c n t V~ !ree Fig. 6.3 I). oiie additional hending-


momeiit cnmponenl M > , and ii couple inomcnl along the axis of tlic beam M\.
which we shall call the twt.\f;ti,q tnom(w.
Notice i n Fig. 6.3!)(c)that a sectind ll-cc-hody diagram h a s hcen drawn
which exposcs [lie "othei- side" o f thc cross-section at position x. The shear
Force. axial f w c c . and bending momrnl Cor [his section h w e heen prinicd i n
ilic d i a p n i . We know f r o m Ncwtiin's third law that they should he equal and
opposite 10 the ciirresponding unprimcd qunnlities i n part ( b ) of the diag'ani.
We can thus choose for our conipuralions cither ii left-liand or n right-hand
free-body diagram. But this poses somewhat of ii prohlem for 11s whcn u e
m m c ki reporting the s i g i \ o f Ihe transmitted forccs and couple morncnts :I( ii
section. We catin01 use the direction of a lorcc or couple inotnenl a1 thc scc-
Lion Clearly. this would hc inadcquiite since the s e n x o l Ihc force or couplc
t i i ~ m e n tiit :I wctioii would depend on whether a left-hand or a right-hand
lrce-body diagram wiis used. 'Tu associate an unambiguous sign lor shcar
lorcc, axial force. and bending tmoriicnt i i t a secfion. we ;tdiipt the following
invention:
1 SECTION 6.8 SHEAR FORCE, AXIAL FORCE. AND BENDING MOMENT 249

i
A forc componenffor a section is positive
sectio and theforce component both
in the egative dbctions of any orie

The sam is true for the bending moment.


T s, consider Fig. 6.30. For the left-hand free-body diagram, the area
vector f r section x points in the positive x direction. Note also that H, y,,and
the vect 'a1 representation of M2also point in positive directions of the xyz axes.
Hence, a cording to our convention we have drawn a positive shear force, a pos-
itive axi I force, and a positive bending moment at the section at x. For the right-
hand fre -body diagram, the cross-sectional area vector points in the negative x
~

i
direction And, since H', V!', and Mlpoint in negative directions of the x, y , and z
axes, th 'e components are again positive for the section at x according to our
conventi m. Clearly, by employing this convention, we can easily and effectively
specify e force system at a section without the danger of ambiguity.
i P

1 Figure 6.31. Section resultant for three-dimensional loading

iI
A pointed out earlier, we can solve for Vy,H, and Mz at section x using
rigid-bo y mechanics for either a left-hand or a right-hand free-body diagram
provide that we know a11 the external forces. The quantities y,, H , and M2
will dep nd on x, and for this reason, it is the practice to sketch shear-force and
bending moment diagrams to convey this information for the entire heam.
e now illustrate the computation of V and M.

"S me authors employ the reverse convention for shear force from the one that we have
proposed. O u r convention is consistent with the usual convention used in the theory of elarticity
f k thc si n of stress at a point. and it is fnr this rcilson that we have employed this mnvznlian
rather tha the other one.
250 CHAPTER 6 INTRODUCTION TO STRIICTIIRAI. MECHANIC’S

Example 6.6
We shall express the shear-fiirce and hending-m(irnent equations fnr thc
simply supported heam shown in Fig. h.RZ(a). whose weight we shall
neglect. The support forces ohtained frcini equilihrium are S O 0 N each.
To get the shear force at a section x, we isnlate either thc left or ]right
side of the beam at x and employ the equations of. equilibrium 011 thc
resulting free hody. If.r lies between A and C [if the heam. the only noniii-
ternal force present for a left-hand free hody i s the left supporting fwcc
[see Fig. 6.32(h)l. Notice that we have used directions for Vand M (rherc
i s no need for suhscripts in the simple pniblem) correspiinding to the po.s-
itiw states frrirn the point o f view [if our convention. Clearly, the (i/,qehroi(.
sign we get for these quantities from equilihrium calculations will then
correspond t o the umvmrion sign. If li i s between C and H for such a free
body. two external forces appear lsee Fig. h.32(cJl. Therefore. i l thc shcar
force i s to be cnprcssed as a function of .r. clearly separate equation5 C O Y -
ering the two ranges. 0 < .r < 112 and 112 < x < /, are necessary. Summing
forces we then get

o<li__<112:
500 + V = 0: therefore. V = ~ ~ 5 0N 0
112 < x < I:
~~~~ ~

S O 0 - 1.000 + V = 0; therefore. V = 5Oll N (h)

Notice from the above results that therc i s a sudden chaiigc o f the shear
force from -S(X) N to +XK) N as we pas? the position of the concentrated
I ,000-N load. Clearly then, the value l i t shear niiist perforce he in~lr/r,rni-
nrrtr at the position of this concentrated load. I t i s f(ir this very reason that.
in the ranges o l applicability of Eqs. (a) and (hl. we have excluded the
positions o f the three concentrated loads ol the problem. Note further that
ilthere wcrc only a diatrihuted load starting at point C. therc would not he
discontinuity in shear and so we would not have to delete the position of
point C i n the rangc applicahility of the shear equatinns.
Now let us turn ti1 the bending-moment equ;lti~ins. Again, UK inust
consider two discrete regions. Taking moments ahout position 1. we gct

-S00x + M = 0; therefore, M = 5011s N-in IC1


1
t
//2<r 5 i : ~
-soox + i . n 0 0 ( ~- $1 + M = (I:

therefore. M = S O O ( / - x) N-in (11)

, ._--I_ . .. ... . , . _”__ ..


i SECTION 6.8 SHEAR FORCE, AXIAL FORCE, AND BENDING MOMENT 25 1

4
Exa pie 6.6 (Continued)

In the present problem there are no point couples


(d), we include the entire beam in the combined

500 N V

y
1.000N

V
500 N
(c)
Figure 6.32. Simply supported beam.

It/is generally the practice to express the shear and bending-moment

I
equatio s successively under common ranges of applicability. In such cimm-
stances we shall adopt the practice of excluding from any range of applica-
bility a y points of discontinuity for eirher the shear or the bending-moment
equatiobs.
252 CIIAI"I1IK h lNTR0I)L'ClION TO STRUCTURAL MK'HANICS

r Example 6.7
r
j Dctei-mine llic hhcar-force and hending-moment equations for the simply
! supported bean shown i n Fig. 6.33. Neglect the weight of tlie hcam.
W e inus1 first find [he supporting Iorccs for the hcani. Hence. we
: liave tising the right-hand irulc

K,(2?) - soo - (50)(X)(X) - (I.ooo)(x, =0

a Ttrcreliirc.
i R, = 532 Ih
;
In Fig. 6.34(a) we have shown a l r a - b o d y diagram exposing sec-
ii tions between the left suppnrt and the uniform Inad. Summing forces and
taking moments ahout a point i n the seclinn. where we have drawn V aid
i M a s positive according IO o u r wiivcntioii. we gct
4:
(l<r~<_

I
868 + V = 0: thcreliire, V = -868 Ih
8
-86Xi +M = 0: therefore. M = X68.x ft-lh
The iicxt i i i t e i - v i
i h hctweeii ttir heginning o l Ihc uniform lond and the
poinl fiirce. 'Thus, ohwrving I'ig. h.?4(h):
4~5 .l.~<&

liir V,
808 - 5O(x - 4 ) + V = 0
:. V = 50.x - 1.068 Ih
and fix M

:. M = -25r' + I.llh8.~- 400 fl-lh


I We now ciinsider the interval hctwccn the poinl force and the end trf the
utiilorin l o x i Thus. ohserving Fig. 6.34(c):
?-Ll--S 12:
lor v. Figure 6.34.Free-hody diagrams irir
I various r a n p a
868 - so(^, - 4 ) - m o + v =o
:. 1' = S t r ~.68 Ih
SECTION 6.8 SHEAK FORCE, AXIAL FORCE, AND BENDING MOMENT 253

ple 6.7 (Continued)


, and forM,
I
~
-868x ~~ *
+ 5 0 ( x - 4)2 + I,WO(x - 8 ) + M = 0
:. M = -25x2 1 6 8 1 + 7,600 ft-lb

i,..
The xt interval is between the end of uniform loading and the point cou-
ple. e can now replace the uniform loading by its resultant of 400 Ib, as
show in Fig. 6.34(d). Thus,
18:

868 - 400 - 1,000 + V = 0


I
.: 1' = 532 Ih
i
~ andforM,
~

I
-868x + 1,4OO(x - 8) + M =0

i8
~

.: M = -5321 111,200 ft-lb


The I st interval goes from the point couple to the right supp&rt. It is to be
point d out that the point couple does mi contribute directly to the shear
force and we could have used the above formulation for V for interval I8 <
x< . However, the couple does contribute directly to the bending moment,
thus uiring the additional interval. Accordingly, using Fig. 6.34(e), we get
< x < 22: (el
Figure 6.34. (conrinurdJ Free-body
i V = 532 Ih (as in previous interval) diagrams for various ranges.
~

Whepas for M we have


I -868x + 1,4OO(x - 8) - 500 I M = 0
.: M + 11,700 ft-lh
~

= -532x
j

a downward force P, as shown in Fig. 6.35(a), in-

it a positive bending moment P t [see


P induces on sections 5 to the right
6.36(b)]. Finally, as can be seen

to the right of it (it does not


254 CHAPTER h INTRODUCTION 1
'0 STRUCTURAL MECHANICS
require from equilibrium a shear force), whereas a counterclockwise couple
moment C [Fig. 6.37(h)l requires ;I negalive bending moment 4' on sec-
tions to the right of it. 111 the following example. we shall show how by this
reasoning we may more directly formulate the shear-force and hending-
moment equations.

I I

Figure 6.36. Rending mornen1 mduced h) P

Figure 6.37. Bending moinent induced hy C.


SECTION h.8 SHEAR FORCE, AXIAL FORCE, AND BENDING MOMENT 255

Exi lDle 6.8


Eva te the shear-force and bending-moment equations for the beam i

shoy in Fig. 6.38.


4 free-body diagram of the beam is shown in Fig. 6.39. We can im-
x
med ely compute the supporting forces as follows, remembering to use
the I ht-hand rule.
CLL
M -0. ” J?L
Figure 6.38. Simply supported beam.
-R,(26) + (500)(21) - 800 + (500)(5)= 0
The ore,
R, = 4691b

E M , = 0:

Q(26) - (500)(21) - 800 - (500)(5)= 0


The ore,
R, = 531 Ib
We 111 now directly give the shear force Vand bending moment M while
vie\ g Fig. 6.39. Thus,
n<x<5:
V = -469 Ib
M = 469xft-lb
5 < x < 13:
V = -469 + 500 = 31 Ib
M = 469s - 500(s - 5 ) = -31x + 2,500 ft-lb
13 < x 5 16:
__ ~~ 9- i
-

V = 31 Ib (same as previous interval) f,

M = 469x - 500(x - 5 ) + 800 = -31x + 3,300 ft-lb


16 5 x < 26:
V = -469 + 500 + 50(x - 16) = -769 + 50x Ib

M = 469s - 500(x -- 5 ) + 800 -


50(.x
-
- 16)? Figure 6.39. Free-body diagram of beam
2
= -25~’ + 769x - 3,100 ft-lb
We all present effective methods of sketching the shear-force and bend-
ing- m e n t diagrams in Section 6.9.
-
256 CHAPTEK 6 INTKiXW(710N TO SIRLICTUKAI. R.IECHj\KICS

Bcliire we proceed further. i f must he carefully pointed uut that the


replacement (if a distributcd load by ilsingle rcsultiiiit lorcc is iinly mcaniiigful
fix the pili-ticular lrec hody on which the i i r c e distrihurion acts. Thus, to coni-
pute the rcacticiiis Sur the entire heaiii taken as n tree hody (Fig. 6.40). we can

replace the wcight di\tribution ivO hy the torill weight at position 1.12 (Fig.
6.41). FoI llic hendiiig iiioiiieiit iit ~ x ,the restillant of the loading lur thc Sree
beam. ~ x

Figure P.6.40.
6.41. Formulate ths shear-force and bending-moment equalions
for the simply supported beam.

300 N

:! Figure P.6.37.

6.38. F rmulatz Ihe shear-force and bending-moment equationr


for the c' ntilever beam. Do not include the weight of the beam.

Figure P.6.41.
6.42. Compute shear force and bending moments for the bent
-X beam as functions o f s along the centerline of the beam.
IO lhlfl

Figure P.6.38.

and bending-moment equations

Figure P.6.42.
6.43. A simply suppmted beam is loaded in two planes. Thi:
means there will be shear-force components V, and Vz and bend
ing-moment components M: and My.Compute these as function
of x . The beam is 40 ft in length.

I
6.40.

I(1)
or the beam shown, what is the shear force and bending~
moment at the following positions?

( ) 5 ft from the left end

I2 ft from the left end


Figure P.6.43.
&) 5 ft from Ihc right end
2:
1
I
6.44. What are tlic shear force, hcnding moment. and axial force 6.47. A hoist can move along a bcnm whilc supporting a l0,OOIl-
for tlic three-dimensional cantilever hram! Give your results sep- Ih l o x . It the hoist st:~rts31 lhe left and moves liom 4 = 3 to I=
arately for the three porlians A H , H C . and Cl). Neglrct the weight I?.dctcl-mine Ihe shear f k e and hmding momcnt at A in terms
of thc memhcr. Usc ,s as the dictairce along the ccnterline from I ) . 01i. At what priiition i do we get thc ineninurn shear fbrcc ill A
and thc mnxiiniiin hending mornenl a1 ,I,
What
! ills their v;ilues'!
I,noo N

x
Y'
, "

10.000 Ih
Figurc P.6.44
F i p r e P.6.47.

6.48. A pipe weighs I O lhift and has a n imide diameter of 2 i n


6.45. Oil flow\ from a tank through il pipc AB. Thc oil weighs Ifil i s full of wiitcr and the p r e w r c irf the water i y that r i f the
40 Ibift' and. in flowing, dzvelops a drag on the pipe r r f I Ihift. atmrnphei~ciit the ciitratlct. A. coniporc thc \hear force, i i x i i i l force.
The pipe has an inside diainctci 013 in. and a length of211 ft. f k w ant1 hending mimien1 01the pipe from A to 11. l l s e coordinate i
condition?,arc assumed ID he the same along the entire length of mcaured f m m A olonp the centcrline 01 the pipe.
the pipe. What arc the shear force, bending nrmmt, :md axial
force along the pipe? The pipe weighs IO lhirl.
I

~1
i,' .

Figure P.h.45.

6.46. Determine the shear iixcc, bending moment, and zixiiil Figure P.6.48.
force a s lunctions u i H for thc circular heam.
6.49. After finding the supporting iorces, detzrmine fur Pnrhli-m
6.37 the \hsar-l<rcc and hending-moment equations without thc
fiirthei iiid of free-hwiy diagrams.

ll& 6.50. Deterrninc the <hcac-torcr and hendingmoment equittiona


trri Frohlcm 6.7U without the ;lid of frcc~hodydi.',Pl<U"\.
.'

A 1 4 5 " ~
6.51. I n Priihlrin 6..39. alter delermlning the supporting forces.
tletcimine thr shcar-fbrce and hending-motncnt equation? without
Figure P.h.46. thr aid of li-er-hody di,:'Ail:l",b.

258
i
6.52. In Problem 6.40, after finding the supporting forces, write 6.54. Formulate the shear-force and bending-moment equations
the shear force and bending moment as a function of x for the for the simply supported beam. [Suggestion: For the domain 5 <
beam wit out the aid of free-body diagrams. x < IS, it i s simplest to replace the indicated downward triangu-
lar load, going from 400 Nlm to zero, by a uniform 4Ml-NIm uni-
6.53. Gi e the shear-force and bending-moment equations for form downward load from x = 5 to x = IS plus a triangular
the cantil ver beam. Except for determining the supporting forces, upward load going from zero to 400 Nlrn in the interval.]
i
do not us free-body diagrams.
i

1,000 N 4Ml Nlrn

x
I

I Figure P.6.53.
-
-l5m------t
20m
Figure P.6.54.

6.9 11 for
Differential Relations
Equilibrium

1
In Secti n 6.8, we considered free bodies of finite size comprising variable
portion of a beam in order to ascertain the resultant force system at sections
along t beam. We shall now proceed in a different manner by examining an
infinite 'mal slice of the beam. Equations of equilibrium for this slice will Figure 6.43. Element Ax of beam.
then yi Id diferenrial equations rather than algebraic equations for the vari-
ables V n d M .
C nsider a slice AX of the beam shown in Fig. 6.43. We adopt the con-
ventionl that intensity of loading w in the positive coordinate direction is
of the beam has been included

diagram of the element in Fig. 6.44. Note we have


and bending-moment convention as presented z
' ' V+AV
forces: Figure 6.44. Free-body diagrdm of element.

L
,
i
F, = 0:

-V + ( V + A V ) + WAX = 0

iL
Taking moments about corner a of the element, we get

M, = 0:
260 CHAPTER 0 INTRODUCTION TO S T R U C T I K A I , MECIIANICS

where p i s some lraction which. when multiplied hy Ax, gives the proper
moment arm OS the force I$’ Ax ahout corner (1. Thcsc equations can he written
i n the following niaiinei- after w e cancel tcrins and divide through hy Ar:
i\v --
Ax -I”

AM = -I/
AI
+ ivPAi
I n the liniit a s h r i (1. we get the following differential equations:

dV
- (6.321)
dx = -w

We may next integrate Eqs. 6.3(a) and 6.3(b) from position I along the
beam to position 2. Thus, UT ha\c

(6.4)
and

= - p h
(M)?-(M),
I

Thercforc,

( M ) , = ( M ) , - JIVdx
(6.5)
Equation (6.41 incans that the ctmige i n the shear lorce hetwccn two points
on a hcam ecluiils m i n u (lie area under the loading curve hetwccn these
pointq provided that there i s no point force present i n thc interval.? Note that.
if w ( . x ) i s positive i n an inlei-val. the area under this curve i b positive i n this
interval: i l w ( l i i is nepative i n a n interval. Ihc iirea under this curve i s negative
in this interval. Siinilarly, FA]. 6.5 indicates that thc change i n hending
moment hctweeri Iwo points on a beam equals minus the area (if the shear-
force diagram hetwccn these points pro\’ided that there arc n o point couplc
moments applied in the inter\al. If Vi.r) i s positivc i n an interval. [hc area
undcr this curvc i s positive i n tliib interval: i l V ( x ) i s negative i n an interval,
the area under thc curve i s ncpativc lor this intcrval. In cketching the diagram.
we shall make use oSEq. 6.4 and 6.5 a s well as thc diffei-entii equations 6.3.

“lbu dilirrenfial c q i i ~ l i o i ib.~i,:i)I C o ~ l ymeenmgful with i t conimuous Ionding p r e m ~ i .


while t$ h X h j i \ w>ly \ h I iri the Aihirnce 01 p o i n t ‘m~tplcriiorncnt\.
j SECTION 6.9 DIFFERENTIAI. RELATIONS FOR EQUILIBRIUM 261

I
i.
Exa pie 6.9
and bending-moment distributions for the simply
in Fig. 6.45 and label the key points.

Figure 6.45. Simply supported beam.


~

IThe supporting forces R, and R, are found by rules of statics. Thus,

(-R,(20) + (500)(14) + (50)(10)(10/2) - 100 = 0


I

R, = 470 Ib
0:
=
~

R2(20) - (500)(6) - (50)(10)(15) - 100 = 0


Therd fore.
R, = 5 3 0 l b
530 Ih
sketching the diagrams, we shall employ Eqs. 6.3, 6.4, and 6.5-

of the shear-force and bending-moment equations, evaluating ia)

on the shear diagram that the 470-lb supporting force


x

-470
(b)
2.820
2.025
2,7u(1
- M 1.925

A r 11 I B
V, and we have a 30-Ib shear force at point D. Again, since w = 0 in iC)
262 rttAPTCR 6 INTRODUCTION TO STRIJCTUKAL blFCIIANICS

Example 6.9 (Continued)


load at D, there i s ino sudden change iii shear as we crash this point. Ncnt.
the change in shear hetween 1) and I1 i s i i i i i i i i s the area (11 the loading
curvef4 i n this interval i n ;scordance with Eq. 6.4. But this ;rea i s
(-SO)( IO) = -500. Hcnce, from Eq. 6.4 the value (IS vj
(.iu\t Io (he left lit.
the support) i s yj - (-500) = 530 Ih. Also, since N i s incpti

stant hetween I1 and B. the slope of the shear curve should he positive and
constant, i n accorkincc with Eq. h.Xa1. Hence. we can draw it straight line
between V,, = 30 Ih and V, = 530 Ih. As we now cross the ]right support
force. we see that it induces a negative h e a r <if 530 Ih on scclioiis 10 thc
right of thc support, and s o at I3 the shear c u r w conics hack t i l zero.
We now proceed with the bending-moment curve. With iio point coil-
ple moment presenr at A. the value o f M,* must he zcrii. The changc in
moment between A and C i s then minus the area underneath the shear curve
in this interval. We can then say from Eq. 6.5 that M,. = M , - (-470)i6)
= 0 + 2,820 = 2,820 It-lh, and we denote this in the nioineiil diagram. Fur-
thermore the value of V i s a negative constiin1 in the interval and. accord-
ingly [see P:q. 6.3(h)J, the slope (ifthc moment curvc i s positive and
constant. We can then draw a straight line hctweeri MAand M,.. Hetwecn C
and 11 the area for the shear diagram i s 120 Ih-St, and s o we can say thal M,,
= M,. - (120) = 2.820 - 120 = 2,700 St-lh. Again. with Vconslant and
positive in the iiitcrvd, the slope of the moment curve must he negativc and
constant in the i n t e r d and has heen so drawn. Hetweeii I ) anti F the iirea
under the shear curve i s readily sccn to he ( 3 0 ) ( 5 )+ + ( 5 ) ( 2 5 0 )= 775 ll-lh.
Hence, the bending moment goes from 2,700 St-lb at 11 to 1,925 St-lh at F.
Now the shear cuwe i s positive and irrrrv,.sing i n value ;IF we go from D to
F. This means that the slope of the bending-moment curve i s ncgatike atid
hecoming steeper a s we go from D to I:.As wc go by F wc eiicounter lllc
100-ft-lh point couple moment and we can say that this point couple moment
induces a positive 100-St-lh mnmcnt on sections to the right (if point F.
Accordingly, there is a sudden increase i n bending ni(iment o l 100 It-lh at F,
as has heen shown i n the diagram. The area ofthe shear diagram hetwcen
F and L( is readily seen from Fig. 6.46(h) to he (2XO)(S) +
;(5)(2SO) =
2,025 ft-lh. We see thcn that the bending miiment gocs to zero ill H. Since
the shear Iorce i s positive and inr.reu.sing hetween F and H. wc conclude
that the slope o f the hcnding-inomcnt curve i s negativc and hecoining
,stef’pcras we approach R. We have thus drawn the shcar-force and bend-
ing-moment diagram and have labeled all key points.
Note that to he correct, both the shear-force and hending-nioment
curves must go to zero at the end of the beam to the right iif the right sop-
port. This serves a s a check o n the correctnes iir the calculations.

laNotc tlmt the pnim couplr mnment llas a r.cru nrf frorce and b n nerd no1 he ill concern
in the inlcrvill from D lo B a s far as shear i s conccrned. Howcwr. i f will hc ii p m i l ulicic
auddrn chengr occurs in the hending-momcnr diagram
- . ~ . - .
I

I
SECTION 6.9 DIFFERENTIAL RELATIONS FOR EQUILIBRILM 263

In xample 6.9, we can get equations and diagrams of shear force and
bending moment independently of each other. With simple loadings such as
point fo ces, point couples, and uniform distributions, this can readily be
done. In eed, this covers many problems that occur in practice. Usually, all
that is n eded are the labeled diagrams of the kind that we set forth in the pre-
vious pr blem. In problems with more complex loadings, we usually set forth

1
the equ ions in the customary manner and then sketch the curves using the
equatio s to give key values of V and M (the areas for the various curves are
no long r the simple familiar ones, thus precluding advantageous use of Eqs.
6.4 and 3;the key points are then connected by curves sketched by making
use o f t e slope relations as in Example 6.9.
It ill be helpful to remember that if a curve has inareusing magnitude
(absolut value), the subsequent curve must have a steepening slope over the
hand, if a curve has decreasing magnitude
curve must have aflatrening slope over the

Figure 6.48. At V = 0, possible


maximum for M.

and bending-moment curves where there is zero value of


be possible maximum values of shear force and bending
10 Ihlit
IO K

n ++I++
I ,lli)i~
Ih
Figure P.6.55.
Figure P.6.58.

Si10 N-111 Xi1 N l m


c
+I+++
-+

Figure P.h.57. Figure P.6.60

!64
6.61. ! tch the shear-force and bending-moment diagrams for 6.64. A cantilever beam supports a parabolic and a triangular
the sin ,idally loaded beam. What is the maximum bending load. What are the shear-force and bending-moment equations'!
mamen Sketch the shear-force and bending-moment diagrams. See the
suggestion in Problem 6.54 regarding the triangular load.
w = sin i i x / L Ib/ft
/

-X

Figure P.6.61.

Figure P.6.64.

6.62. imulate the shear-frxce and bending-moment equations


for the tm. Sketch the shear and moment diagrams.

6.65. Determine the shear-force and bending-moment equations


for the beam. Then sketch the diagrams using the aforementioned
equations if necessary to ascertain key points in the diagrams,
such as the position between the supports where V = 0. What is
the bending moment there?

1,000 Ih
60,000 Ib-ft
I 00 I b/ft

6.63. 'imply supported I-beam is shown. A hole must be cut


througt e web to allow passage of a pipe that mns horizontally Figure P.6.65.
at right gles to the heam.

Where, within the marked 24-ft section, would the hole


lrilrl af t the moment-carrying capacity of the beam?

In the same marked section, where should the hole go


to least e c t the shear-carrying capacity of the beam'?

21'- 24'-4

4' r
4,000 Ih

\
l7'-p5'1
8,000 Ih 5.000 Ib
3'

111 1 1 1 1 Ul 11 1 80 Ib/fl

t
Figure P.6.63.

265
266 CHAI'TCK 6 INTRODIICTION TO SI'KIJ('TIJRA1. MFCllANlCS

Part C: Chains and Cables


6.10 Introduction
We often cncountcr I-elatively llzxihlc cables or chains that are used to s u p
port Iuads. I n suspension hridgcs, lur cxample, we h i d a coplanar arrange-
ment i n which a cable wpports a large load. The weight of ttic cable itself in
m c h cascs may oliun be considcrcd negligible. 111 traiisniissiixi lincs, oil ttrc
ollicr hand, the principal Iircc i s the weight o l the cahle itscI1. In Part C. wc
shall c\'iiluate the sh;ipc 01 and the tension in the cahles f o r both these cascs.
T u Ihcilitalc computations. thc model OS Llic structural system will he
assunicd 1 0 bc perfectly flexible and inextensihlc. The llexihility assumption
ineiins that at the center of any cross section 01the cahle only a tensile force
i s lransmittcd and there can hc no bending municnt there. The Surcc transmit-
lcd Iliriiugh tlie cablc inusl. under these conditiiins. he tangent to the cable at
all posilions along thc cahle. The inextcnsibility assumption means that the
length of thc cable i h consveiit.

6.11 Coplanar Cables: Loading is a


Function of x

;I/-\
r- ~
~_r/ / We shell iiiiw consider lhc case of a cahle suspended helwecn two irigid S U ~ -
porls A and 1) under thc action o f a loading function W)I( given per unit
length a s measured in the hnri:ontnl direction. This Ii,ading w i l l bc consid-
crcd to he copliinar with the cahle and directed vertically. as shown in Fig.
6.49. Consider an clcnient o f t h e cahlc of length A.7 a s a (tee hody (Fig. 6.50).
I,
~- ~~

~~ ~~~~ ~ Y ~~~~ ~

Figure 6.49. Copl;inar cahlr; i v = I*'(,)

Summing liirces in the .r and directions, respectivcly. we get


- 7 . ~ 1 s 6' + ('I'+ A T ) cor($ + A@ = 0 (6.6a)
-Tsin H + (T + A / ' ) sin (6' + AH) - w , ~A.l; = 0 (h.6b)
i SECllON 6.11 COPLANAR CABLES; LOADING IS A FUNCTION OF X 261

where $
taking t
I

is the average loading over the interval Ax. Dividing by Ax and


limit as A x + 0, we have
i
~

~ lim
Ax-0
[( T + AT)cos(BA+x AO) - TcosO
~~

i
lim [ ( T + AT) sin(O + AO) - T sin B
i 41-0 Ax
iI
The terd w is now the loading at position x . The left sides of the equations
accordance with elementary calculus, and so we can

(6.7a)

(6.7b)

From Ed. 6.7(a), we conclude that

Tcos O = constant = H (6.8)

where c/early the constant H represents the horizontal component of the ten-
sile forcb anywhere along the cable. Integrating Eq. 6.7(b), we get

i TsinO = / w ( x ) d x + ~ ; (6.9)
~

where
d is a constant of integration. Solving for Tin Eq. 6.8 and substituting
into Eq. 6.9, we get
~

t
Noting hat sin Olcos O = tan 8 = dyldx, we have, on canying out a second
integrat on:

t
Equatioh 6. 10 is the deflection curve for the cable in terms of H , w(x). and the
constan s of integration. The constants of integration must he determined by
the bou dary conditions at the supports A and B .
+ i

Exa ple 6.10 (Continued)


SECTION 6.1 I COPLANAR CABLES; LOADING IS A FUNCTION OF X

the largest 0 occurs at x = 112 (i.e., at the supports).


we have, for
269

Cons+pently, we get for T,,:

T,,, = --
H
cos[ tan-I ( ~ 1 1H2 ) ]

Fromltrigonometric consideration of the denominator,


I

Substituting for H using Eq. (c), we then get, on rearranging the terms,

I
]Finally, to determine the lrngth ofrhe cuble for the given conditions,
we m st perform the following integration:
P

F
Now he slope, dy/& equals wxlH [see Eq.
H Lse Eq. (c)] becomes 8hxll.z Therefore,
(01, which on substituting for

This
inay be integrated using a formula to be found in Appendix I to give

I
Subs ituting limits, we have
r

1
Rea anging so that the result is given as a function of the sag ratio hll and
the s an 1, we get finally
!
,
i
SECTION 6.12 COPLANAR CABLES: LOADING IS THE WEIGHT OF THE CABLE ITSELF 271
I
Dividinglthrough by As and taking the limit as As + zero, we get equations
analogo+ to Eqs. 6.7.

Integratilg, we have
I
TcosO = H (6.I I a)
i ~ Tsine=J’w(s)ds+~; (6.1 1b)

Eliminating Tfrom Eqs. 6.1 I , we get, as in the previous development:


9
dx
= w(s)d.s + C,

equation is a function of s. Thus, we cannot directly inte-


Accordingly, note that
~
dy = (d.? - dx2)1’2
Hence, flom this equation,

(6.13)

Substituting for dyldx in Eq. 6.12 using the preceding result, we get

Solving lor &/&, we have

Separatihg variables and integrating, we get


I

i
I
~ (6.14)

i
~

t step, if possible determine the constant C , by applying a slope-


in Eq. 6.14, solve for s as a func-
272 CHAFTER 6 INTRODUCTION IO STRUCTURAL M1:CHANICS

Example 6.11
Consider a uniform cablc having a span / ;uid ii sag /I a\ s h i n \ n i n Fig.
6.52. The weight per u i i i l length I I ' the
~ cahle is a constant. Ikteriiiiiic ihc
shape of the cahle when i t i( loaded only by its own weight.

For simplicity. we have placed a relerencc at the ccntcr of the span


where the slope or (he ciiblc i h Lei-o. Acciirdingly. considw Eq. 6. I2 for
rhia case:

When s = 0 we I-equirc Ihal &Idr = 0.whcrcupiin i s /.cro. NOM- c o w


sider Eq. 6.14:

Integrating the right side 01 the equation using integralion forniul;i IO lrom
Appendix 1, wc gct
SECTION 6.12 COPLANAR CABLES; LOADING IS THE WEIGHT OF THE CABLE lTSELF 213
Example 6.11 (Continued)
The constant C, must also he zero, since x = 0 at s = 0. Solving for s
from Eq. (cj, we get

s
H .
= - sinh -
xw
w H

Substituting for s in Eq. (a) using the preceding result, we have

dv
rr;r . w
= sinh - x
H

Integrating, we get

Since y = 0 at x = 0, the constant C, becomes -Hlw. We then have the


deflection curve:

This curve is called a catenmy curve.''


To determine H , we set y = h when x = 112. Thus,

This equation can be solved by trial and error by the student or by a com-
puter. We may then proceed to determine the maximum force in the cable
as well as the length of the cable in the manner followed in Example 6. 10.

'"rhe Latin for chain i s curenu


Example 6.12
A watcr ckicr i s shown i n Fig. 6.53 dmpling Iron1 a kite that is towed hy a
powerhoal at a speed i r I 30 inph. 'The hoat devzlops a thi-ust (11 200 Ih. Thz
drag o n the hoar from the water i s estiinated a s 100 lti. At Ihc sopport A.
the ropc has a tangent ol 30". I1 the man weighs I50 Ib. find the height and
the lift of thc kite as well as the maximum tension i n the rope. The kite
weighs 25 Ih. Thc u i i i l i r n i rupc i!. SO I t long ; ~ ~ weighs
id 3 Ih/It. Neglect -
aerodynamic eflccts on the rope.
We stail with Eu. 6.12. which heciimcs f i r this ca.e:

lJsing a reference at A as shown i n the diagram, we know that dy1d.t = tall


30- = 377 when i = 0. Thus, we get for C , .
= 577

Equation 6.14 i b c o n d e r e d next. We have

+
Integrating by making a change i n variable to replacc [(w/H).s ,5771 and
using the inlegration f(irmula 10 i n Appendix I. we get

Solving kir s, we have

Substituting Sor s in Eq. (a) using Erl. ( 2 ) . we get

lnlegraling again, we have

We must now zvaluatc thc unknown constants C,, <'~+. and H using
thc boundary conditions and data of thc priihlem. First.iince H is the hor-
izontal comp~inentof fbrce transmittcd hy the rope. we k n o w that H i s the
thrust of Lhe hoat minus the drag of Ihe watcr. 'Thus.
H = 100lh
Also, x = 0 when s = 0 . s o that from Eq. (,e).we get C2 a s iollows:

sinh(- A
5
100
(' ) = ,577
SECTION 6.12 COPLANAR CABLES, LOADING IS THE WEIGHT OF THE CABLE ITSELF 275

Example 6.12 (Continued)


Therefore.
- loo
_
" C
2
= sinh-' ,577 = ,549

Hence,
C, = -109.8
Finally, note that x = 0 when y = 0. From Eq. (e), we can then get con-
stant C, in the following manner:
C, = -Tcosh[s(-109.8)]
100
100
= -200 cosh ,548 = -23 1
We may now evaluate the position x', y' of point B of the kite. To
get x', we insert for s in Eq. (b) the value of S O ft. Thus,

Now from Eq. (e) we can get y' and consequently the desired height.

y' = K c o s h [ ( 4 0 . 9
.s + 109.8)-]-100
5 231

,,.
..-X' = 28.6 fc (0
The maximum tension in the rope occurs at point B, where 0 is
greatest. To get Omdx, we go back to Eq. (a). Thus,

Therefore,
= 39.6"
Hence, from Eq. 6.1 I(a) we have for :,"I

To get the lifting force of the kite, we draw a free-body diagram of


point B of the kite as shown in Fig. 6.54. Note that F, and F,c are, respec-
tively, the aerodynamic lift and drag forces on the kite. The lift force F y of Figure 6.54. Free-hody diagram
the kite then becomes of kite support.

F, = 175 + Tmaxsin 39.6" = ' (i)


6.66. Find the length of a cahlc wctched hetween twu suppolts 6.70. The lefl side of a cahle i s mourned at an elcvatim 7 111
at thr sainc elevation with \pen / = 200 ft and s q I t = 50 fi, if it hclow the right side. The \ag. msaiorcd from the left iuppon, i s 7
i s huh.jccted to a vertical h a d u t 4 lblft uniformly dist~ibutedin thc m. Find the niaximum tension if the cahlr has il un(fiwn2 loading i n
h o r i i ~ n t direction.
~l (Assume that the weight of the cable is cithcr the vertical direction of 1500 Nlm. [ B c , y f i c v f i o , z ; Place rcfcrence at
nrgligihle o r includcd in the 4~lhIftdistrihutiwi.) Find the maxi- position of zero slope and dctcrmiiie the location 01 this point
m u m tcnsioii. fram the houndary conditions.]
6.67. A cahlc xqports an X000-kg uniform har. What is the equa-
tion d w r i h i n g the shape of the cahle and what is the inaxiinurn
tension i n the c;ihle'l

-
i

?Ktn +-I
1

Figure P.6.70.

Figure P.6.67. 6.71. A blimp is dragging a chain of leiiglh 400 f t and weight 10
IMft. A thrust of 300 Ib is developed hy the hlimp a b i t moves
6.6X. A cable supports a uniform londing U I100 Iblft. If the low-
against an air resistniicc of 2~10Ih. HOWmuch chair, i\ 011 the
est point of the cablc occur&20 ft S r m ? point A as shown, what is
ground and how high i ? the hlimp? l h e vertical lift of !tie blimp
thc n i i i h i i n ~ i nt e i i h i i m i n the cahle and its length? Usc A as the ori-
on the cable is takzn as 1,000 Ib.
gin of rrtcrrncc.
X(]'.__~
-L
.
R i

Figure P.6.68.
Firurr P.6.71.
6.69. A unifixm cahlc ih \ h o w whose weight we shall ncglrct.
If a hading givcn ac 5r N l m is imposed wi thc cahle, what i s the 6.72. A Iargc halloon has a hrioymt fixci. of 100 Ib. 11 i s held hy
dctlcctim curve of the cable i t thew i s a zero slope of thc curve at
a l50-ft cahle whose weight is .5 Ih/ft. What i \ !he hcight /z of the
point A'! What is the maximum tunsian?
balloan above the ground w h m a steady wind cuuscs i t 111 assun~s
v thc position shuw,n? What i s the maximum tension i n thc cahlc'l

Figure P.6.69. Figure P.6.72.


6.13. What is the detlection curve for the uniform cable shown 6.16. A flexible, inextensible cable is haded by concentrated
weighing 30 N/m? Find the maximum tension. Compute the forces. If we neglect the weight of the cable, what are the support-
height h of the support B . ing forces at A and B? What are the tensions in the chord AC and
the angle d![Hint: Proceed by using finite free bodies and work-
ing from first principles.]

Figure P.6.76.
Figure P.6.73. 6.11. A system of two inextensible, flexible cables is shown
supporting a 2,000-lb platform in a horimntal position. What are
6.14. A search boat is dragging the lake floor for stolen mer- the inclinations of the cable segments AB, B C , and DE to accom-
chandise using a 100-m chain weighing 100 N/m. The tension of plish this and what lengths should they be'! Neglect the weight of
the chain at support point B is 5,000 N and the chain makes an the segments and note the hint in Problzm 6.76.
angle of SV there. What is the height of point B above the lake
bed'? Also, what length of chain is dragging along on the bottom'!
Do not consider buoyant effects.

- Figure P.6.14.

6.15. A cable weighing 3 Ib/ft is stretched between two points


on the same level. If the length of the cable is 450 ft and the ten-
Figure P.6.71.

sion at the points of support is 1,500 Ib, find the sag and the dis-
tance between the points of support. Put reference at left support.

6.13 closure
Essentially what w e have done in this chapter is to apply previously devel-
oped material t o situations of singular importance in engineering. Further
information (in structures can be found in hooks on strength of materials and
structural mechanics. We turn again to new material in Chapter I , where w e
will discuss the Coulomb laws of friction.
8LZ I
6.82. Express the shear-force and bending-moment equations 6.85. Sketch the shear-force and bending-moment diagrams
with the aid of free-body diagrams. Then express Vand M without labeling key point.5.
the diagrams.

Y Y

x x

m m
Figure P.6.82. Figure P.6.85.

6.83. Express the sheat-force and bending-moment equations 6.86. Find the shape of a cable stretched between two points on
without the aid of free-body diagrams. the same level, I units apan with sag h , and subjected to a vertical
loading of

n.x
w ( x ) = 5cos r- N/m
l
distributed in the horizontal direction. The coordinate x is mea-
500 N/m sured from the zero slope position of the cable.

6.87. (a) By inspection, which members in the truss shown have


a zero force for the given loads?
Figure P.6.83.
(b) For the Fink ~ N S S in Fig. P.6.I.with vertical loads on
the bottom pins, which members will carry a zero force?

6.84. Give the shear-force and bending-moment equations for


the beam, and sketch shea-force and bending-moment diagrams.
At what position between supports is the bending moment equal
ti) Lero?

I .ooo Ib

50 Ib
-t
10'
+
6,000 N
Figure P.6.84. Figure P.6.87.

279
30'

A
4,000 N
Figure P.h.88.

Figure P.6.91.
Friction
Forces
7.1 Introduction
Friction is the force distribution at the surface of contact between two bodies
that prevents or impedes sliding motion of one body relative to the other. This
force distribution is tangent to the contact surface and has, for the body under
consideration, a direction at every point in the contact surface that is in oppo-
sition to the possible or existing slipping motion of the body at that point.
Frictional effects are associated with energy dissipation and are there-
fore sometimes considered undesirable. At other times, however, this means
of changing mechanical energy to heat is a beneficial one, as for example in
brakes, where the kinetic energy of a vehicle is dissipated into heat. In statics
applications, frictional forces are often necessary to maintain equilibrium.
Coulomb .friction is that friction which occurs between bodies having
dry contact surfaces, and is not to he confused with the action of one body on
another separated by a film of fluid such as oil. These latter problems are
termed lubrication proh1em.s and are studied in the tluid mechanics courses.
Coulomb, or dry, friction is a complicated phenomenon, and actually not
much is known about its true nature.’ The major cause of dry friction is
believed to be the microscopic roughness of the surfaces of contact. Inter-
locking microscopic protuberances oppose the relative motion between the
surfaces. When sliding is present between the surfaces, some of these protu-
berances either are sheared off or are melted by high local temperatures. This
is the reason for the high rate of “wear” for dry-body contact and indicates
why it is desirable to separate the surfaces by a film of fluid.

‘Fur a imme complcle discussion ol friction. rce F. P. Bowdm and D. Tabor, The Friction
und Luhrkution oj‘Solk/.~.Oxfwd Unircraiiy Press, New York. 1950.

28 I
We have previously employed the ternis “smooth’ and “rough” sur-
faces of contact. A “smooth” surface can only suppnlt a normal force. On the
other hand. ii “rough” surface in addition can support a force tangent to the
contact suiface (i,e,, a frictiiin iorcc). In this chapter. we shall consider certain
situatinns wherehy the friction Snrce can be direclly related to the normal
force at a surface of contact. Olhcr than including this incw relationship, we
use only thc usual static equilibrium equatiwis.

7.2 Laws of Coulomb Friction


(‘omlition of imprndine Everybody has gnne thniugh the experience nf sliding lurniture along a floor.
We exert a continuously increasing force which i s ciiinpletely resisted hy fric-
tion until the nhject heginc to nii)ve-usuall) with ii lurch. .The lurch occurs
hecausc once the oh.ject hegins to move. there i s ii decrease i n firictional force
from the maximum force attained under static condili(ins. An idealized plot nf
thi? force as a function of tiinc i s shown in Fig. 7. I where the force P applied
to the furniture, idealizcd as ii hloch in Fig. 1.2. i s shown 10 drnp from the
highcst or limiting valiie 10 a Iowcr value which i s constiint with lime. This
latter constant value i s independent iif the velocity o f the nhject. The condi-
Figure 7.1. Idealized plot of applied forcc P. tion corresponding to the maximum value i s termed thc conditiiin nf irnpfvid-
irrg rnoriiiii or itnpmdinI: slippqqe.
By carrying out experiments on hlocks tending to i n w e without rota-
tion or actually moving without ~ri~tatioii on flat surfaces, Couliimh in 1781
presented certain concIusions which ;ire applicable at the c(inditiini of
impmding .slippafie os once clippuge I i a . ~hegirn. These h a w since hecomc

L.r
known as Coulomh’s laws of friction For hliick psnhleinr. hc reported that:

1. The total fnrce nf f r i c l i m that can he develiiped i s independent of the


magnitude (if the area nf c ~ n t a c t .
2. For low relative velocities between sliding objects. the lrictional force i s
practically independent n i veliicily. However. the sliding lrictiiinal force i s
lcss than the frictional fnrce corres~oiidingt n inipending slippage.
Fig,ure 7,2, 3. The lotal frictional force that can he developed i s prnportional to the tior-
inal force transmitled iicrnss the surfice of cnnlacl.

Conclusions I and 2 iiiay cnime as a surprise IO inost of you and be coii-


lrary to your “iiitiiition.” Nebel-theless. they arc iiccuraft’ enough statements
for many engineering applicalions. More precise studies 01 friction, as wds
pointed out earlicr, are complicated and involved. We can rxprcss conclusion
3 mathematically a h :
1 - N
Therefore.

f = }‘A’ (7.
I)
where ji i s called the (.mf/i,.irniq:fi-icriori.
SECTION 1.2 LAWS OF COULOMB FRICTION 283

Equation 7.1 is valid only a t conditions uf impending slippage or while


the body is slipping. Since the limiting static friction force exceeds the
dynamic friction force, we differentiate between coefficients of friction for
those conditions. Thus, we have coefficients of static friction and coefficients
of dynamic friction, pTand p,,, respectively. The accompanying table is a
small list of static coefficients that are commonly used. The corresponding
coefficients of friction for dynamic conditions are about 25% less.

Static Coefficients of FrlctionZ


Steel on cast iron .40
Coppe,.ron steel 36
Hard steel on hard steel .42
Mild steel on mild steel .57
Rope on wood .70
Wood on wood .20-.75

Let us consider carefully the simple block problem used to develop the
laws 0 1 Coulomb. Note that we have:

1. A plane surface of contact.


2. An impending or actual motion which is in the same direction for all area
elements of the contact surface. Thus, there is no impending or actual rota-
tion between the bodies in contact.
3. The further implication that the properties of the respective bodies are uni-
form at the contact surface. Thus, the coefficient of friction p is constant
for all area elements of the contact surface.

What do we do if any of these conditions is violated? We can always choose


an infinitesimal part of the area of contact between the bodies. Such an infin-
itesimal area can he considered plane even though the general surface of con-
tact of which it is an infinitesimal part is not. Furthermore, the relative motion
at this infinitesimal contact surface may he considered as along a straight line
even though the finite surface of which it is a part may not have such a sim-
ple straight motion. Finally, for the infinitesimal area of contact, we may con-
sider the materials to he uniform even though the properties of the material
vary over the finite area of contact. In short, when conditions 1 through 3 do
not prevail, we can still use Coulomb’s law in the small (i.e., at infinitesimal
contact areas) and then integrate the results. We shall call such problems
complrx surface contact problems and we shall examine a series of such
problems in Section 1.4.

ZF. P.Bowden and D. Tabor. The Friction and Lubrication ojSolidr, Oxford University
Press. New York, 1950.
"7.3 A Comment Concerning
the use of Coulomb's Law
Ac a simple illu\lralion <if why curvature (11 the surtacc of contilcl is sccond
order and hence negligihlc. consider yourself at a location on the earth where
i t i s perfectly round as ii planet. As you look around you over a small area
compared to ii significant portion o f thc earth':, surSacc. there i s no evidence to
your ohservatiini ur in what yiio normally do that indicares the presence of cur-
vature of the earlh. In Lhc same way, an infinitesimal arca ciin he considered
Slat c v c ~ii f i h part OS II finite curved :,urhcc when considering Couloinh's law.
Furthcrinore. a s~ntion;iry. iiiinrolatinp ohserver in inertial space look-
ing at ii similar sniiill iirzii on the earth's surfice a1 Ihc equator sccs the ~ e l o c -
ity of the area essentially as given by R o where R i s thc radius o f t h e Earth
;ind w i:, its angular velocity. All parts o f this small arca w i l l have this same
velocity up ti) only s c c o n d - d e r varialio~ias seen hy this observcr. And, so
friim this viewpoint. all points within the area are esscntially translating with
the af~,rcmentioned speed. 'lo explain lurther. we w i l l now say that lhis small
area has a maximum dimension given by thc Icngth r. The rolutioilul specd of
;my point seen by an inertial and herice inonriitating observer at the area and
tran4atinp witli the area must he no greater than v u . Clearly then, this rota-
tional spccd i s iie,qli~yih/ysmoll when compared with Rw. Hence, an infinites-
imal arca at a finite dislancc from the axis (iI~r(it~tio11 01ii rotating surface can
he considcrcd as having primarily a translational velocity and so permits the
use of Ciiulnmh's law ''in the small."

7.4 Simple Contact Friction Problems


We iiow examine simple ciintacl problems where Ciiuliimh's laws apply to
the coiitiict surtice ci.s CL ~ ; h o l rwithout requiring integration pri~cedures.We
shall thus consider uniforni blocklike hodics akin to those used by Coulomb.
Also. we shall considcr hodies which however complex havc very smrrll coli-
L&t .
' . surf'accs. such a:, i n Fig. 7.3(al. Clearly. the whole c ~ n t a e tsurface can
then he coiisidcred an inlinitesinial plane area and for rzasons set forth ear-
lier, we shall directly use Coulomh's laws whcn approprialc as has been
rhown i n Fig. 7.3(h).
Beiorc proceeding to the examples. we have one additional point to
make. For ii l'inite simplc surface of contact. such as the block shown i n Fig.
7 . 2 . we iiiust note that wc do nut generally know the line [if action fur the
simplest rehultant supporting force N, since wc do not generally know the
iiorniiil force dislrihution hetween the two hodics. Hencc, we cannot take
moments for such free-body diagrams without intriiducing additional unknown
distanccs i n the equatiiili. Conccquently. for such prohlems we liniit ourselves
to suiiirniiig iorces only. This i h tior true. however, when w e havc a poiiu
SECTION 1.4 SIMPLE CONTACT FRICTION PROBLEMS 285

contact such as in Fig. 7.3(a). The line of action of the supporting force must
be at the point of contact, and we can thus take moments without introducing
additional unknown distances.

Figure 7.3.(a) Small contact surface;


(b) Coulomb's laws applied.

Two common classes of statics problems involve dry friction. In one


class, we know that motion is impending, or has been established and is uni-
form, and we desire information about certain forces that are present. We can
then express friction forces at surfaces of contact where there is impending
L.
or actual slippage as pN according to Coulomb's law and, using for other
friction forces, proceed by methods of statics. However, the proper direction
must be given to all friction forces. That is, they must oppose possible,
impmding, or actual relative motion ut the contact surfaces. In the second
class of problems. external loads on a body are given, and we desire to deter-
mine whether the friction forces present are sufficient to maintain equi-
librium. One way to attack this latter type of problem is to assume that
impending motion exists in the various possible directions, and to solve for
the external forces required for such conditions. By comparing the actual
external forces present with those required for the various impending
motions, we can then deduce whether the body can he restrained by frictional
forces from sliding.
The following examples are used to illustrate the two classes of
problems.
286 CII,APTCR7 ~ R I C T I O NFORCLS

Example 7.1
A n automnhile i s shown i n Fig. 7.4(;1) o n ii roadway inclined at an anplc H
wilh thc hprizontal. I1 the coefficients of. static and dynamic friction
'
~

between the (ires and the road are taken RS (1.6 and 0 . 5 . rcspectibely. what
; i s the ni;lxinnum inclination H,><;,%that the car can climb at uiiiS<)rm speed'!
! I t has rear-wheel drive and has a total Iuadcd weight 013.600 Ih. The cell-
tcr (11gravity ior this loaded conditinn ha\ been shown in thc diagram
I.ct us assume that the drive wheels do not "spin"; thit
1 rclative v c l i i ~ i t yhetween the tire sui-fke and the niad sur1.a
: c1111t~1ct. Thai, clearly, the maximum friction liirce pixsihlc i s times the
inorinill forcc at lhis contact surldcc, iis ha\ hccn indicated i n Fig. 7.4(hj.'
We cain considcr this to be a u ~ p / ( i n ( i iproblem
- with thrcc unknnwns.
1 N,. N2. and Hc,l,th. A c c d i n g l y . sincc the fricticin force i s reslricted to a
point. three equation\ [if equilihriutn arc avnilablc. IJsing llie rcicrcnce .rv
shown in the diagi-an. we have:
F; = 0 :
~~ ~ ~

.6N, - 3,600 sin B,,,,, = 0 (a)


CF; = f):
N, + N, ~ 3.600 cos H,,,,,, = 0 (hi
CM:, 0:
ION, ~ + (3.600sinH,,,;,,)(I)
(3,h(10cosH,,,,,)(~) = 0 (Ci

'l'n solve Sor H,,,:,,. wc eliminate N , Srnm Eqs. (a) and (bl, gctting a s B rcsult
the equatiiin
N, = 3.600 cos e,,,,, ~ 0,000 sin (d)
Now. elimin;iting N, froin Eq. ( c j using Eq. (dl, wc get
I X . 0 0 0 cos B,,,,, - 56.400 sin 0,,,:, = 0
~

'There fire,
tan Hrl,2,x= ,320 (C)

Hence.
!
B,,,, = 17.1" (1)

! If the drive wheel5 wcre caused to spin. we would have to use p,, in place
i
0 f p 5for this pnihlein. We would then arrive
iit ii smaller H,,,,,,. which S i x
this problem would bc 14.7".
i
-
i ihcir
'You will nolicc lllnl lhcrc I \ IIO iriclicin Imcc o n th? Iront wheel\. 'This IS SI) hecauw
m q u c ciirrririg iron1 rhr autorrwh~ie'sIMmmission onlcl lhrse uhcei,. whilc it1 the
I \ IIW
siiiiic liinc llic whceh .IK 1oiii1~ngill c o i i h t i i n i speeil. Note we are ncplroing "nilling" ve\is.
~iinccilsmriiiig lmni the i l c l o ~ ~ ~ m0 i1oihc
n ro.d \urTacc and lhc mc. i j s~iiiillIorcc 10 he c o w
iidered an Sciiion 1 . 8 . a \i;wved hcciion
SECTION 7.4 SIMP1.E CONTACT FRICTION PROBLEMS 287

Example 7.2
Using the data of Example 7. I , compute the torque needed by the drive
wheels to move the car at a uniform speed up an incline where f3= 15".
Also, assume that the brakes have " locked while the car is in a parked
position on the incline. What force is then needed to tow the car either up
the incline or down the incline with the brakes in this condition? The
diameter of the tire is 25 in.
A free-body diagram for the first part of the problem is shown in Fig.
7.5(a). Note that the friction f0rce.f will now he determined by Newton's
law and not by Coulomb's law, since we do not have impending slippage
between the wheel and the road for this case. Accordingly, we have, f0r.f:

cF =n:
______ 1

.f - 3,600 sin 15' = 0

Therefore,

,f= 932 Ib

The torque needed is then computed using the rear wheels as a free body
[see Fig. 7.5(a)]. Taking moments about A, we have

torque = ( f ) ( r )= (932)(*$) = 971 ft-DJ

For the second part of the problem, we have shown the required free
body in Fig. 7.5(b). Note that we have used Coulomb's law for the friction
forces with the dynamic friction coefficient p,, on all wheels. We now
write the equations of equilibrium for this free body.

TuD- S ( N , + N z )- 3,600sin 15' =0 (a)

(N, + N 2 )- 3.6Oocos 15" = 0 (b)

Solving for N, + N2 from Eq. (b), and substituting into Eq. (a), we can now
solve for Tup.Hence,

Ttzp= (.5)(3,600)( 966) + 932 = (c)


,-
'

I,,,,.,
SECTION 7.4 SIMPLE CONTACT FRICTION PROBLEMS 289

Example 7.3
In Fig. 7.6 a strongbox of mass 75 kg rests on a floor. The static coeffi-
cient of friction for the contact surface is 20. What is the largest force P
and what is the highest position h for applying this force that will not
allow the strongbox to eithcr slip on thc floor or to tip ?
The free-body diagram for the strongbox is shown in Fig. 7.7. The
condition of impending motion has been recognized by the use of -1 .h m 4
Coulomb’s law. Furthermore, by concentrating the supporting and friction
forces at the left corner, we are stipulating impending tipping for the proh- Figure 7.6. Strongbox
being pushed.
lem. Thesc two impendin&conditions impose the largest possible values of
P and h that we are seekine.-
The pertinent forces constitute a coplanar system of forces at
the midplane of the strongbox. We procecd with the scalar equations of
equilibrium: I

N = 75g = 7 3 6 N

P = .2N = 147.1.5N Figure 7.7. Impending tipping and


dlpplng

~ ( 7 5 g ) ( . 3 ) +(147.1S)h = 0

Therefore, we get for the largest P and the largest h the following
results:

P,,,sx = 147.15 N h,,, = 1.50 m

Thus, the height of the applied load must he less than or equal to I .SO m in
order to avoid tipping.

The three examples presented illustrated the,first type of friction proh-


lem wherein we know the nature of the motion or impending motion present
in the system and we determine certilin roorces or positions of certain forces.
In the last example of this series, we illustrate the .second type of friction
problem set forth carlier-namely the problem of deciding whether bodies
will move or not move under prcscrihed external forces.
290 CHA1"Ik;K 1 FRICTlClN bOK('ES

Example 7.4
1 Thc ciicfficienl of static friclicin kir all contiic1 surfaces i n Fig. 7.X i s .2.
I
Does thc 50-lb force move the block A iip. hold i t in equilihrium. or i s il
too small to prcvmt A from coming down and H fr(nn moving w t ' ! The
1 50-lb fiircc i s exerted at the niidpl;inc iif the hlircks s o llial w e cain consider
this ii coplanar pmblcm.
4

.i
I 200 Ib

We ciin cmipute ii liirce P i n placc 111. the 50-lh fhrcc I(I cause i n -
i block H to the left, and ii forcc P fb1- impcnding m i l i o n
pending m o t i i i ~01
of hlock R to the right. I n this way, we can judge hy comp;irism the action
that tht: SO-Ih tiirce w i l l C:IUSZ.
The f r o - b o d y &igrains for impending nr(ilion o l h l o c k H to the l e f t
have hccn shown i n Fig. 7.9, which conlains the unknown fwcc I' iiieii-
tioned abiivc. We necd not be ciincerned ahoul the correct Iocatioii (11the
centers of gfii\'ity n1 thr hloch\, since wc shall only add forces i n the
analysis. ( W c do not know the line of action o f thc inorniiil liirccs iit
lhc cwitact surlxec and thcrefore in not takr moments.) Summing forces
on block A . wc gel

iV2cos I S " j - N , s i n IS''i-~ . 2 N , j - X ( ) j


+ N,i - .2NZco\ 15"i '. .2N, sin IS':j = 0

The scalar c q i i i i t i i i i i ~arc:

N , .?59N, .1932N,
- - =0
.OhhN, - .?N,- 200 - .051XN, = 0

Solving cimultiineously. wc get

N, = 243 Ih. N, = 1OY.R Ih


SECTION 7.4 SIMPLE CONTACT FRICTION PROBLEMS 291

Example 7.4 (Continued)


For the fre.e-body diagram of B. we have, on summing forces,

-N2 cos 157 + Nz sin 15"i - Pi + .2N3i + N , j


- 1 0 0 j + . 2 N 2 c o s 1S"i+.2N2sin ISy=O
This yields the following scalar equations:
-P + 62.9 + .2N3 + 46.9 = 0
-235 + N , - 100 + 12.6 = 0
Solving simultaneously, we have
P = 174 Ib

Clearly, the stipulated force of 50 Ih is insufficient to induce a motion of


block B to the left, so further computation is necessary.
Next, we reverse the direction of force P and compute what its value
must be to move the block B to the right. The frictional forces in Fig. 7.9 are
all reversed, and the vector equation of equilibrium for block A becomes

N2 cos 15y - Nz sin 1S"i + .2N,j - 2OOj


+ N,i + .2N2 cos 1% + .2N2 sin l5y = 0
The scalar equations are:
N , - .259N2 + .1932N2 = 0
.966N2 + .2N, - 200 + .0518N2 = 0

Solving simultaneously, we get


N2 = 194.1 Ib, N , = 12.80 Ib

For free body B we have, on summing forces,

-N2 cos l 5 . j + N2 sin 15Oi + Pi - .2N3i + N 3 j


- lOOj - .2Nz cos 157 - .2N2 sin 157 = 0

The following are the scalar equations:


P - .2N3 + 50.3 - 37.5 = 0
-100 + N3 - 187.5 - 10.05 = 0
Solving, we get P = 46.7 Ib. Thus, we would have to pull to the right to get
block B to move in this direction. We can now conclude from this study
that the blocks are in equilibrium.
7.1. A hlock has a force F applied to it. If this force has a timc
variatioii as shown in the diagram, draw a simple sketch showing
the friction force variation with time. Take p3 = .1 and p,, = .2 for
the problem.

Figure P.7.4.
7 . 5 Explain how a violin how. when drawn oyer a string, main-
tains the vibration oi the string. Put thi.: in leimi 0 1 friction forccs
and the difference i n static and dynamic cocfficients of frictirin.

7.6. Whit is thc valuz of thc force F. inclined at 30" to thc hnri-
~ o i i t a l ,nccded to get thc hlock juct ctartetl up the incline? What is
the forcc F needed t u keep it .just moving up at s constant speed'!
I
The coefficients of ctntic and dynamic friction arc .3 ;md .?lF,
respectively.

W = 100 Ih

Figure P.7.1.

7.2. Show hy increasing the inclination @ o nan inclined surface


unlil there is impending slippage o f supported hodics. we rrach
the anfile ofrepose 9, so that tan $$= p>

Figure P.7.6.
1.3. Tu what minimum angle must the drivcr elevate thc dump 7.7. Bodies A and L( weigh 500 N and 300 N, respeclivcly. The
bed of the truck to cause the wooden cratc of weight W to slide plalfol-m nn which they are placed is raised from thc horizontnl
out? For wood on steel, p, = .6 and p,, = .4. poaition t o an anplc H. What i'i the ~ , i u i n i r o nanplc that can he
reached before the bodies slip down the incline'? Takc p> for body
N and the plane as .2 and fl?for hod! A and the plane as .i.

Figure P.7.3.

7.4. A platform is suspendcd by two ropes which are attached 1~


docks lhat can slide horizontally. At what value of W does the
hitform begin to descend'? Will W stan tipping'? Figure P.7.7.

!92
7.8. What is the minimum value of p,vthat will allow the rod AB 7.11. A 30-ton tank is moving up a 30" incline. If ps= .6 for the
to remain in place? The rod has a length of 3.3 m and it has a contact surface between tread and ground, what muximum torque
weight of 200 N. can be developed at the rear drive sprocket with no slipping?
What maximum towing force F can the tank develop? Take the
mean diameter of the rear sprocket as 2 ft.
Data
W=200N
L = 3.3 m

A
Figure P.7.11.
Figure P.7.8.
7.12. A SCi-lb crate A rests on a I,OM)-lb crate B. The centers of
7.9. Find the minimum force P to get block A moving gravity of the crates are at the geometric centers. The coefficients of
static friction between contact sufaces are shown in the diagram.
The force Tis increased from zero. What is the fin1 action to occur?

Dofa
W, = 200 Ih
W, = 90 Ih
F'= 3

Figure P.7.9.
7.10. What minimum force F is needed to staR body A moving
to the right if px= .2S for all surfaces? The following weights are
given:
W, = 125 N W, = SO N W,, = 100 N
The length oSAB is 2.5 m.

Figure P.7.12.
7.13. What force F is needed to get the 300-kg block moving to
the right? The coefficient of static friction for all surfaces is .3.

p, = .3
Figure P.7.10. Figure P.7.13.

29:
Y

Figure P.7.19.
7.20. The cylinder shown weighs 200 N and is at rest. What is
the friction force at A ? If there is impending slippage, what is the
static coefficient of friction? The supporting plane is inclined at
60" to the horizontal.

Figure P.7.22.

Figure P.7.20.

1.23. An insect nies to climb out of a hemispherical bowl of


radius 600 mm. If the coefficient of static friction between insect
and bowl is .4, how high up does the insect go? If the bowl is spun
ahout a vertical axis, the bug gets pushed out in a radial direction by
7.21. Armature B is stationary while rotorA rotates with angular
the force m m 2 , as you learned in physics. At what speed o will the
speed 0. In armature B there is a braking system. If M~ = .4, what
bug just be able to get out of the bowl?
is the braking torque on A for a force F of 300 N? Note that the
rod on which F 1s applied is pinned at C to the armature B
Neglect friction between B and the brake pads C and H.

Figure P.7.23.

1.24. A block A of mass 500 kg rests on a stationary support B


where the static coefficient of friction ps = .4. On the right side,
support C is on rollers. The dynamic coefficient of friction .udof
Figure P.7.21. the support C with body A is .2. If C is moved at constant speed to
the left, how far does it move before body A begins to move?

7.22. A 200-lb load is placed on the luggage rack of the 4,500-lh


station wagon. Will the station wagon climb the hill more easily
or with greater difficulty with the luggage than without'? Explain.
The static coefficient of friction is .55. Figure P.7.24.

295
Figure V.7.27. Figure P.7.32.

296
7.33. The block of weight W is tu he moved up an inclined 7.36. What is the minimum static coefficient of friction required
plane. A rod of length c with negligible weight is attached to the to maintain the bracket and its 500-lh load in a SVdtic position?
block and the force F is applied to the tup of this rod. If the coef- (Assume point contacts at the horizontal centerlines of the arms.)
ficient of static friction is determine in terms o f u , d, and p,rthe The center of gravity is I in. from the shaft centerline. Hint: Note
mnximum length c for which the block will begin to slide rather that there is clearance between the veitical shaft and the horizon-
than tip. tal arms.

Figure P.7.33.

7.34. Determine the range of values of W, for which the block Figure P.7.36.
will either slide up the plane or slide down the plane. At what
value of W, is the friction force zero? W2 = 100 Ih.

W- = 100 Ih
7.31. If the static coefficient of friction in Problem 7.36 is .2, at
what minimum distance from the centerline of the vertical shaft
can we support the 500-lh load without slipping?

Figure P.7.34.
7.38. A rod is held hy a cord at one end. If the force F = 200 N,
and if the rod weighs 450 N, what is the mruimum angle a that the
rod can he placed for between the rod and the floor equal to .4?
$, J !

7.35. A 200-kN tractor is to push a 60-kN cuncrete beam up a The rod is I m in length.
15' incline at a construction site. If pc,= .5 between beam and din
and if pris .6 between tractor tread and din, can the tractor do the
job? If so, what torque must be developed on the tractor drive
sprocket which is .8 m in diameter'? What force P is then devel-
oped to push the beam'?

Figure P.7.3S. Figure P.7.38.

297
7.39, Suppose tliat a i l ice liftcr IS uscd to support a hard block nf 7.41. A hcam supports loud C' wcighiiip 5 0 0 N. At suppoflh .4
matcrial hy friction only. What i s the ,ni,iimunr coefficient of static and H. the static coefficient of frictioil i\ .2. At thc Contact surlac~!
friction, u,, to accomplish this for any weigh1 W a n d frri the g e m - helween load C and the bcam. the dynamic coefficient 0 1 friction
etry shown i n the di;ig!ram'! i s . l S . It force I: m o v e > C'steadily tu rhc Icit. how far doe\ it IIIII\IC
b e f k thc bcam hegins tu move'! The beam w e i g h 200 N.
10" t ,~
Neglect tlic hcighi iol the hriuii in p u r ciilculiltioiii.

A i

~ 111

Figure P.7.41.

7.42. DO Problsni 7.41 fur thc cilx whcrc [lie height 1 i, takcn
imv account. 'lakc I = 120 i n i n

7.43. A roil is supported h i IWO u,hrrls spinning in oppoiitc


directions. Ifthe wheels were horirmtal, the rod wimld he placed
centrally over thc wheel, for equilihriuni. However, the wheels
have an inclination ol20" a s shown, and lhr rnd m u h t he placed at
LI pusition off center for equilibrium. If thc cocflicienl of fricliuii
is L I , , = .8, how many lcct oll w i t c r iiiuhi the rud he placed?

Figure P.7.39. I O 0 Ih
7.40. A rectangular case is loaded with uniform vertical thin
rods such that when i t i s full, as shown in (a), the case has a total
weight of 1,000 Ih. The case weighr 100 Ib whcn ciripty and hits a
cocfficient of static friction of .3 with tlic tlwx as shown in thc
diagram. A forcc 7'of 200 Ih i s nnintained un the ci\se. It the r d s

I are unloaded a\ shown in ( h ) , what i s thc limiting value o f x for


equilibrium to he inaintiiined'!

P.7.44.
Figure P.7.43

How much forcc /: !nust hc applied ti) the wedge I n


hepin to iilisc the cratc? Neglcct changes in gcrmetry. What force
must the hiopprr hlock provide to prevent the crate frnm inwing t o
the Icft'! The slatic coefficient o i friction hetwccn all wtiaccs i s 3

c-..-
(,'d
(a) (h)
Figure P.7.40. Figure P.7.44.
7.45. What is the ninrimum height x of a step bo that the force P 1.41. If we neglect friction at rhc mllen, and the coefficient of
will roll the 50-lb cylinder over the step with no slipping at a? static friction is .2 for all surfaces, ascendin whether the 5.000-lb
Take p,, = 3. weight will go up, go down, or stay stationary.

Figure P.7.45.
7.46. The rod AI1 ic pulled at A and it moves to the left. If the
coefficient of dynamic friction for the rod ar A and B is .4, what must
the minimum value of W, be to prevent the block from tipping
when a = ZO"? With this value of W,, determine the minimum
coefficient of static friction between the block and the supporting

-
plane needed to just prevent the block from sliding. W , is 100 N.

4,000 Ib

0 nim

A
60mm 1- 1-
Figure P.1.46. Figure P.7.47.

7.5 Complex Surface Contact


Friction Problems
In the examples undertaken heretofore, the nature of the relative impending
or actual motion between the plane surfaces of contact was quite simple-that
of motion without rotation. We shall now examine more general types of con-
tacts between bodies. In Example 7.5. we have a plane contact surface hut
with varying direction of impending or slipping motion for the area elements
as a result of rotation. In such problems we shall have to apply Coulomb's
laws locally to infinitesimal areas of contact and to integrate the results, for
reasons explained in Section 7.2. To do this, we must ascertain the distribu-
tion of the tiormal force at the contact surfdce, an undertaking that is usually
difficult and well beyond the cdpahilities of rigid-body statics, as explained in
Chapter 5. However, we can at times approximately compute frictional
effects by ertimating the manner of distribution of the normal force at the sur-
face of contact. We now illustrate this.
300 CHAPTFK 7 FKlCrlON FOKC'FS

Example 7.5
Compute the frictional resistancc to rotation of a rotating solid cylinder
with an attached pad A pressing against a flat dry surface with a h r c e P
(see Fig. 7.10). The pad A and the stationary tlnt dry surface constitute a \
dry rlirust hrurinR. A P
The direction of the frictional forces distributed over the contact sur-
face is no longer simple. We therefore takc an infinitesimal area for e x a n -
illation. This area is shown i n Fig. 7.10, where the clement has been
formed from polar-coordinate differentials so as lo he related simply to the
boundaries. The arca CIAis equal to r d0 dr. We shall ussuirw that the nor-
mal force P is uniformly distributed over the entire area of contact. The
normal force on the area element is then

The friction force associated with this lcirce during moliori is


Figure 7.10. Dry thrust bearing.

The direction oE df must opposc the relative motion between the surfaces.
The relative ni(iti~inis rotation 01 concentric circles ahout the ccnterline,
so the direction of a force dfl (Fig. 7. I I) must lie tangent to a circle of
radius r. At 180" from thc position of thc area element for df;, we may
carry out a similar calculation fhr ii force (If,, which for the same rmust be
equal and opposite to df;,thua forming a couple. Since thc cntire area may
he decomposed in this way, wc can conclude that there are only couples in
the plane of contact. If we take moments of all infinitesimal forces ahout
the center, we get the magnitude of the total frictional couple moment. The
direction of the couple moment is along the shaft axis. First, consider area
elements on the ring (if radius r:

Figure 7.11. Friction forces f < r mcouplcs.


SECTION^.^ BELTFRICTION 301

Example 7.5 (Continued)

i Taking pd as constant and holding r constant, we have on integration with


respect to 8:

dM = p d -
nDZ/4
2m2dr

We thus account for all area elements on the ring of radius r. To account
for all the rings of the contact surface, we next integrate with respect to r
from zero to 012. Clearly, this gives us the total resisting torque M. Thus,

What we have performed in the last three steps is multiple integration,


which we introduced in Chapter 4 when dealing with rectangular
coordinates.

7.6 Belt Friction


A flexible belt is shown in Fig. 7.12 wrapped around a portion of a drum,
with the amount of wrap indicated by angle p. The angle p i s called the angle
of wrap. Assume that the drum is stationary and tensions T , and T, are such
that motion is impending between the belt and the drum. We shall take the
impending motion of the belt to be clockwise relative to the drum, and there-
fore the tension T , exceeds tension T2.

ds

I
Figure 7.12. Belt wrapped around drum.
302 CHAFTER 7 FRICTION bowi~s
Consider an infinitesimal segment 01' the bell as a lrce hody. This seg-
ment subtends an angle d 8 a1 thc drum cenier as shown in Fig. 7.13. Sum-
ming force components i n the radial and transverse directions and equating
them to zcrn as per ryrrilihriurn, we get the following x a l w equations:

Figure 7.13. h e - h o d y diagram of regiirnr (if


helt; impending blippage.

Therefore,
dN
dT cos 7
- = fll ON

Therefore.

-2T sin dt) rl t)


-~
2 -
- dT sin -$ f dN = 0

The sine of a very small angle approximately equals thc angle ilself i n radi-
ans. Furthermore, to the same degree of accuracy, the cosine of a sinal1 angle
apprwches unity. (That these relations are true inay bc seen by cxpanding the
sine and cosine i n a powcr series and then retaining only the firs1 tcrms.) Thc
preceding equilibrium equations then become
(IN
dT = 0 % (7.2a)

-7a8 - dT d8 + dN =0 (7.2b)
2
SECTION 7.6 BELT FRICTION 303

In the last equation, we have an expression involving the product of two


infinitesimals. This quantity may he considered negligible compared to the
other terms of the equation involving only one differential. Thus, we have for
this equation:
Td0=dN (7.3)
From Eqs. 1.2a and 7.3, we may form an equation involving T and 0. Thus,
by eliminating dN from the equations, we have
dT = &T d 0
Hence,

Integrating both sides around the portion of the belt in contact with the drum,

we get

01

We therefore have established a relation between the tensions on each


part of the belt at a condition of impending motion between the belt and the
drum. The same relation can he reached for a rotating drum with impending
slippage between the belt and the drum i f w e neglect centrifugal eflects on the
belt. Furthennore, by using the dynamic coefficient of friction in the formula
above, we have the case of the belt slipping at constant speed over either a
rotating or stationary drum (again neglecting centrifugal effects on the belt).
Thus, for all such cases, we have

(7.5)

where the proper coefficient of friction must he used to suit the problem, and Tj

the angle ,8 must he expressed in radians. Note that the ratio of tensions
w
depends only on the angle of wrap 0 and the coefficient of friction p. Thus, if
the drum A is forced to the right, as shown in Fig. 7.14, the tensions will
increase, hut if ,8 is not affected by the action, the ratio of T,IT, for impending
or actual constant speed slippage is not affected by this action. However, the -c
torque developed by the belt on the drum as a result of friction is affected by 2’

the force F. The torque is easily determined by using the drum and the portion l?igure 7.14. F Q ~ FCaffects
~ T, and T~ but
of the belt in contact with the drum as a free body, as is shown in Fig. 7.14. not T,IT,.
304 C HA PTER 7 wt(-rro[V FORCES

Thus.
SECTION 7.6 BELT FRICTION 305

Example 7.6
A drum (see Fig. 7.15) requires a torque of 200 N-m to get it to start rotat-
ing. If the static coefficient of friction usbetween the belt and the drum is
.35, what is the minimum axial force F on the drum required to create
enough tension in the belt to start the rotation of the drum?

Torque required = 200 N-m


Radius = 250 mm

72
Figure 7.15. Drum is driven by a belt.

The angle of wrap /3 clearly is n radians. To get the minimum force


F, we use the condition of impending slippage between belt and drum so
that we can say
T - $5,
L = 3 00
~

(a)
T2

For the condition of starting rotation we have

Mu = torque required = 200 N-m


~~

:. (T, - T2)(.25) = 200 (b)

It is now a simple matter to solve the previous two equations simultane-


ously to get
T , = 1,200 N T2 = 400 N
Finally we can determine the minimum value of F for this problem by
summing forces in the x direction as follows:

Fnli,l= 1,200 + 400 = 1,600 N


i

J
SECTlON 7.6 BELT FRICTION 307

Example 7.7 (Continued)


For the idler pulley (no resisting or applied torques), we have

T3 = T2 (C)

From Eqs. (c) and (d), we conclude that


T2 = T3 = 250 Ib (e)
From Eq. (b) we now get for the maximum tension T , :

TI = T,+37I = (f)

We must next check the driving pulley to ensure that there is no slip-
page occumng. For the condition of impending slippage, we have, using
as T2 the value of 250 Ib and solving for T ,
TI -
- T *e4 X = (250)(3.51) = 878 Ib
Clearly, since the T , needed is only 621 Ib (see Eq.(f)), we do not have slip-
page at the dnving pulley, and we conclude that the maximum tension is
indeed 621 Ib.
Driving pulley
Belt on conveyor frame

Torque

SO0 Ib

j = .OS N

I
/

Idler pulley
Figure 7.17. Various free-body diagrams of parts of conveyor.
308 ( ' I I A P I I I K 1 I ~ K I ( T I O Nl:OU('l?i

3' Example 7.8


An electi-ic motor (not \hewn) i n Fig. 7.18 drives at constant speed the
1 pulley B. which c~innecl\to pulley A by ii belt. Pulley 4 is uit~ncctcdto il
1
I
compressor (not shown! which rcquircs 700 N-m torque 10 drive i t ill ~1111-
staiit speed 01,~. I f ,u, Ibr the belt and either piillcy is .A, what nnininium
value o f t h e indicated force F is required to have ino dipping anywhcrc?

if^-_^-_____ ,,,, I
Figure 7.18. Deli- driver comprrssuu'.

As ii f'ir\t stcp. we determine the m g l e s of wrap p for the respeclive


pulleys. For thi, pui-p(ix, wc first compute a (Fig. 7.19). Note that thc
radii 0 , l l and OljE. k i n g perpendicular 10 lhc same line DE..iire thei-cforc
pariillel to each r1ther. Drawing E<'par;lllel to 0,Ow we t l i m forin ix i n the
shaded triiinglc. Hence. wc can say:

$
Fi'iQure7.19. Find an$lcs of wrap

1
1
Note i n Fig. 7.1') Ihiil is pcrpendicular to <:E and [hat (I.,(; is perpen-
dicular 10 Ill;, Thcrclore. the included angle between OA6' aiid O~,Gmost
cqual the included angle hctwccn C1:' and Ill.'. Thih an&!le i s n. Clearly. the
i
;mgk hctwccn O,j.l ;ind O,,ti is also this angle ix. We cim inow express t h r
angles (if w r q fur holh pulleys a s follows:

p, = 1x0" + 2(5.74) = 191.5'


p, = 180" 3 1 . 7 4 ) = 168.5"
.. ., . ,l_" . . "".,, . .. . .. . .. .
SECTION 7.6 BELT FRICTION 309

Example 7.8 (Continued)


Now consider pulley A as a free body in Fig. 7.20. Note that the minimum
force F corresponds to the condition of impending slippage. Accordingly,
for this condition at A, we have

Figure 7.20. Free-body diagram of A.

Also, summing moments about the center of the pulley, we have

[(TI), - (T2),I(.50) - 700 = 0

Solving Eqs. (a) and (b) simultaneously, we get


= 1,898 N; ( T J A = 498 N
From equilibrium, we can compute force FA as follows:
(1,898 + 498) cos 5.74" ~ FA = 0

Now go to pulley B to see what minimum force FR is needed so that


the belt does not slip on it during operations. Consider in Fig. 7.21 the free-
body diagram of pulley E . For impending slipping on pulley E , we have

Figure 7.21. Free-body diagram of B


31 0 CHAlTEK 7 FRIrTION FOKCES

Example 7.8 (continued)


The torque for pulley B needed I o dcvelop 700 N-m on pulley A is next
computed. Thus,"

Therefore,
M, = 320 N-in

Summing moments in Fig. 7.21 ahout the ccnler of. B. we then have on
using the above resull

- [(TI),, . - lT2),](.30) + 420 = 0

Therefore,
(TI),$ ~ Cr,), = 1,400 (e)

Solving Eqs. (d) and (c) simultaneously, we gct

(TI),, = 2,112.5 N: (T2),j = 625 N

Hence, the minimum F,, needed for pulley B is

r;, = (2.025 + 625) cos 5.74" =

Notc that the ratios til' the tcnsions for irnpendiny .sli/qiiiKe f o r the two
cylinders art'

1)riven cylindcr.4 ti^


T
= 3.81 FA = 2,384 N

T
Driving cylinder B & = 1.24 fi; = 2,637 N
5
If we use impending slippage for driven cylinder A , we will have slipping
for driving cylinder B, which we cannot tolerate. Thub, if we use the larger
force of 2,617 N. we will hc well under the impending slippage condition
of the driven cylinder A . Clearly. the optimum result to uvoid slip[i~geand
to minimize the belt tension ior greater life of the belt is to have a force
somewhere above 2.617 N . Here is a place for good engineering judgement
and experience.

"Note [hill the ratio oi tranimitlcd torques MJM, between directly connected pulleys
and gears will cquiil r J r , or l ) J l l ,01 the pullcyr o r gear*. Can you vcriiy lhis yourself'
7.48. Compute the frictional resisting torque for the concentric 7.51. Compute the frictional torque needed to rotate the trun-
dry thrwt bearing. The coefficient of friction is taken aspc cated cone relative to the fixed member. The cone has a 20-mm-
diameter base and a 60" cone angle and is cut off 3 mm from the
cone tip. The dynamic coefficient of friction is .2.

7.49. The support end of a dry thrust bearing is shown. Four


pads form the contact surface. If a shaft creates a 100-N thrust
uniformly distributed over the pads, what is the resisting torque
for a dynamic coefficient of friction of , 1 '?

7.52. A 1,000-Nblock is being lowered down an inclined sur-


face. The block is pinned to the incline al C, and at E a cord is
played out so as to cause the body to rotate at uniform speed about
C. Taking pd to be .3 and assuming the contact pressure is uni-
form along the base of the block, compute T for the configuration
shown in the diagram.

7.50. In Example 7.5, the normal force distribution at the con-


tact surface is not uniform but, as a result of wear, is inversely
proportiunal to the radius r. What, then, is the resisting torque M?
7.57. The seaman pulls with 100-N force and wants to stop the
motorboat from moving away from the dock under power. How
few wraps n OS the rope must he make around the post if the
motorboat develops 3,500 N of thrust and the static coefficient o f
friction between the rope and thc post is . 2 ?

Figure P.7.60.
Figure P.7.57.
7.61. A mountain climber of weight W h a y s freely suspended
7.58. A length of belt rests on a flat surfact and runs over a by one rope that is fatened at one end to his waist, wrapped one-
quarter of the drum. A load Wrests on the horizontal portion of half turn about a rock with I(, = .2, and held at the othcr end in
the belt, which in turn is supported by a table. If the static coeffi- his hand. What minimum force in terms of W must he pull with to
cient of friction for all surfaces is 3, compute the maximum maintain his position'! What minimum force must he pull the rope
wcight W that can be moved by rotating the drum. into himself with to gain altitude?

Figure P.7.58.
7.59. The rope holding the 50-lb weight E passes over the drum
and i s attached ~t A. The weight of C is 60 Ib. What is the mini^
mum static coefficient of friction between the rope and the dNm
to maintain equilibrium of the drum'?

Figure P.7.61.
7.62. Pulley B is turned by a diesel engine and drives pulley A
connected to a generator. If the torque that A must transmit to the

I I generator is 500 N-m, what is the minimum static coefficient of


friction between the belt and pulleys for thz case where the force
F is 2,(100 N ?

Figure P.7.59.
7.60. What is the maximum weight that can be supported by the
system in the position shown? Pulley B connor turn. Bar AC is
fined to cylindcr A , which weighs 500 N. The coefficient of static
friction for all contact surfaces is 3. 2m
-l-
Figure P.7.62.

313
7.63. A hand hrake ik \ h o w Iip<, = .4, what i s the rcristing 1.66. ( a ) What force P i s necded t o drvelop a resisting torque 01
li~l-i]oewhen thc rhait is rotating'! What are the supporting fbrce.; hS N-m on the rrrtating drum'! 'The dynamic coellicient
mi the rod AB. of friction / I < ,i s 0.4.
(h) With thc same force P from part (a), %,hat must the
value o f p,, he i n wdcr 11, increilw the resisting t i r q u r
hy IO N-m'.'

Figure P.7.63.

7.64. A conyeyor i s shown with two driving pulleys A and B .


Drivel- 4 has no angle o f W d p of 330". wherca5 B has a wrap of
1x0". If the dynamic cuefficient nf friction between the hell and
the hed o l the wn\,ryr,l- is .I. atid the m a l weight to he Iran\-
ported is 1(1,000 N. what is the .s,nnlirrf sfatic coefficient of fric- Figure P.7.66.
tion between the belt and the driving pulleys'! One-fifth of the
Iuad can he assumed to he hetween thc twn pulleys at dl times. 1.67. What is the maximum value r f a x i a l l o a d P 10 maintain a
and the tension in the slack side (underneath) i s 2,000 N. Therc i s rritational speed 0 = 5 r;id/s of the dry thrust hearing'! The sum
a free-wheelin$ pulley at the left end uf the conveyor. You will of the hell forces is 200 N . The cwifact surtaor helween the hclt
have t o SOIYC a n cquation hy (rial and ciror. and drum and hetween the dry thrust hcaring and base havc the
mmc H , and p,, of .4 ;and 3. r c y v x t i v c l y .

Figure P.7.64.

7.65. A freely turning idlcr pulley i s used 10 increase the angle


of wrap for the pullcys shown. If the tension in the slack side
a h w e is 200 Ih, find the nrmi~numtorque that a n be transmitted
hy the pulleys for a static coefficient uf friction of .3

Idler pulley

Figure P.7.65.

314
7.68. Rod AR weighing 200 N is supported by a cable wrapped
around a semicylinder having a coefficient of friction pTequal to
250 mm
.2. A weight C having a mass of IO kg can slide on rod AB. What
is the maximum range x from the centerline that the center of C
can be placed without causing slippage?

/ 1.2m

7.71. From first principles, show that the normal force per unit
A B length, w, acting on a drum from a belt is given as
w, = 2r
Use the indicated diagram as an aid. [ H i n o Start with Eq. 7.2(a)
and use Eq. 7.4 for any point a.]

"
7.69. The cable mechanism shown is similar to that used to move
the station indicator on a radio. If the indicator jams, what force is
developed at the indicator base to free the jam when the required
torque applied to the turning nob is IO b i n ? Also. what are the J
forces in the various regions of the cable? The static coefficient of T2
friction is .IS.
--," I P
I
T,
Idler Figure P.7.71.
Pulley 7.72. what minimum force F is needed so that dmm A can transmit
a clockwise torque of 500 N-m without slipping? The coefficient of
friction, pa,between A and the belt is .4. What minimwn caefftcient
of static friction is needed between drum R and belt for no slipping?
Figure P.7.69.
~

F
7.70. What are the minimum possible supporting force c o m p -
nene needed for pulley B as a result of the action of the belt? The
static coefficient of friction between the belt and pulley B is .3 and
between the belt and pulley A is .4. The torque that the belt delivers +lm+
to A is 200 N-m. Figure P.7.72.

315
induced hy hod) (. weighing S O 0 N ?The weight (11 A i \ 100 N .
The m t i c c w l l i c ! r n t ,if friction hetween the hclth arid A i s .J. and
between A iuid the w;illi i s . I .Neglect li-ictiun at pulley (;.

IO0 1111

Figure P.7.1

7.14. A V-hell i \ \huwn. ShnN that

Figure P.7.16.
7.77. .A pullcy A i\dri\cn hy an outadc ;ipenl at a spccd w o i 100
I-pm. A bclt weighing 30 Nlm i s driven hy thc pulley. IlT2 = 21x1
N. what i s the ,,ro.rirmm pmhihle tciisiiin 7, computed without con-
sidering ccntrilirp;il r f f e a c ? Cornputt: T,accounting lin- ccntrifugal
ellcuts, and g i w the perccntqc cmor incurred hy tnot including CCII-
trilupal cffccts. 'The \tittic cncfficient ot triution hetween tho helt
Figure P.7.74.
iind thc pullq i\ 3. Suc Prohlerri 7.76 hcfirre doing this pmhlem.

Figure P.7.17.
SECTION 7.7 THE SQUARE SCREW THREAD 3 11

7.7 The Square Screw Thread


We shall now consider the action of a nut on a screw that has square threads
(Fig. 7.22). Let us take r as the mean radius from the centerline of the screw
to the thread. The pitch, p. is the distance along the screw between adjacent
threads, and the lead, L, i s the distance that a nut will advance in the direction
of the axis of the screw in one revolution. For screw threads that are single-
threaded, L equals p . For an n-threaded screw, the lead L is np.
Forces are transmitted from screw to nut over several revolutions of
thread, and hence we have a distribution of normal and friction forces. How-
ever, because of the narrow width of the thread, we may consider the distrib-
Figure 7.22. Square screw thread
ution to be confined at a distance r from the centerline, thus forming a
“loading” strip winding around the centerline of the screw. Figure 7.22 illus-
trates infinitesimal normal and frictional forces on an infinitesimal pan of the
strip. The local slope tan a as one looks in radially is determined by consid-
ering the definition of L, the lead. Thus,

slope = t a n a = -L =-np
2nr 2nr

All elements of the proposed distribution have the same inclination


(direction cosine) relative to the z direction. In the summation of forces in this
direction, therefore, we can consider the distribution to be replaced by a single
normal force N a n d a single friction force f at the inclinations shown in Fig.
7.23 at a position anywhere along the thread. And, since the elements of the
distribution have the same moment ann about the centerline in addition to the
common inclination, we may use the concentrated forces mentioned above in
taking moments about the centerline. There is thus a “limited equivalence”
between N and f and the force distribution from the nut onto the screw. The
other forces on the screw will be considered as an axial load P and a torque M7
collinear with P (Fig. 7.23). For equilibrium at a condition of impending
morion to raise the screw, we then have the following scalar equations:’ Figure 1.23. Free-body diagram.

-P + Ncos a - ptNsin a = 0

+,,N cos a r - N sin a r + M, = 0

’The equalions also apply to .steady rotation of the n u t on the scccw, in which case one uses
the dynamic coefficient of friction fld in the equations.
3I8 CHAPTER 7 FRIC TIO N FORCES

These cquatioris ]nay he used to eliminate the Scirce N and so get a relation
between P and M. that will hc o S practical significance. This may readily hc
done by solving S& N i n ( a ) and substituting into ih). Thc result is

A n important question arises when we employ the scrcw and nut in the
form of a jack as shown in Fig. 7.24. Once having raised a Imad P by apply-
ing the torque M. to the jackscrew, does the dcvice maintain the load at the
raised position when the applied torque i s rcleased. (11 docs the screw unwind

, ’ ,’ _,,\,
,/ ,, ,

Figure 7.24. Jackscl-rw.

under the action of the load and thus lower the load? I n other words, i s this a
selflorking device’! To examine this. we go hack to the equalions of equilih-
rium. Setting hf. = 0 and changing thc direction o f the friction Sorces, we
have the condilion for impending “unwinding” 01 the screw. Eliminating N
l‘rom the equations. we get

/‘!-(-/I< cos01 + sina)


= 0
c11sa-+rS sina

This requires that


-pr cos a + \in a = 0
Thereforc,
p . = tan a (7.9)
We can conclude thal. if the coefficient of friction prequals or excccds tan a.
we w i l l have a self.-locking condition. If M, i s less than tan 01, the screw %,ill
unwind and will not support ii load P without the proper external torque.
SECTION 7.8 R O I . I . I N CRESISTANCE
; 319

Example 7.9
A jackscrew with a double thread of mean diameter 2 in. is shown in Fig.
7.24. The pitch is .2 in. If a force F of 40 I b i s applied to the device, what
load W can be raised'? With this load on the device, what will happen if the
applied force F is released! Take / I , = .3 for the surfaces of contact.
The applied torque M, is clearly:

M... = 12 (40) = 26.7 Ib-ft (4


The angle a for this screw is given as

Therefore,
a = 3.64'
Using Eq. 7.8 we can solve lor P . Thus,

p =
M. (cos a - @,$ sin a )
r ( p , cosa + sin a )
-
(26.7)[.998 ~ (.3)(.0635
_ _ _ -~
~

_
,&[(.3)(.998)+ ,06351

The load W is 864 Ih. The device is self-locking since @,s exceeds tan
a = ,0636.

p, > tan (r ,,:. 8e ng,

To lower the load requires a reverse torque. We may readily com-


pute this torque by using Eq. 7.8 with the friction forces reversed. Thus,

864(&)[-(.3)(.998) + ,06351
( MZ)down = ~- - 16.71 Ih-tt (d)
,998 + (.3)(.0635)

"7.8 Rolling Resistance


Let us now consider the situation where a hard roller moYes without slipping
along a horizontal surface while supporting a load W at the center. Since we
know from experience that a horizontal force P is required to maintain uni-
form motion, some sort of resistance must he present. We can understand this
resistance if we examine the deformation shown in an exaggerated manner in
Fig. 7.75. If foi-cc P i s ahng the cciiterline a h shown, Ihc cquivalenl liirce sys-
vi lo;rd />,I U t l C C i
tein c w i i i n g 01110 tlie roller from the regioti o f cnntiicI niiist he ihat O S a force
~

I' ~ l w c c wquiwtl tor


c,~nit,,,ll >pccct N whosc line O S iiclion i i l s o gocc through t h center ~ OS the rnller since, you
w i l l recall S i r i n i Chapter 5. three notipal-allel forces niiist he c o n ~ i ~ r r cfor ~it
equilibrium, 111ordcr to develop ii r c s i ~ t u i c e10 ~ i i ~ t i oclearly
n. N i i i u s i he ori-
ented iit iin anglc 4 with the vertical direction. i i s i s shown in Fig. 7.25. The
sciiliir equ;iti,iiis O S q u i l i l i i . i u i i t hccome

W = N cos 6: P = A' cin 4


Therefore.
Figure 7.25. Rolling ie*i\liincc modcl.
; = lilt1 @ (7.10,

Since ilic iireii 01coti1iic1 i s sni:ill, we ticite tliiit q5 i s ii s m a l l angle and that tali
@ = \in $. The h i l i @ i\ sccn to he u i i ~Srnni I:ip. 7.25. Thcrcriirc, we inay sa)
Illill

Solving fort', we gel


,
I -
- w<r
( 7 .I I h)

The dist;incc ( I i n tliex cqu;itirins i h ciillcd the c , w / f ; ( . i oj'tdIii8,y


~~ rrsisru,i(.e.
Couloinh suggesled that l i i r wiriorhle Ioadc 1V. the riitin PIW is c o n s t m i
for given m;ikrials and ii gibe11 geometry ( r = cm\tant). Liioking at Eq.
7.I la, w e scc tliiit (I must then he ii c ~ n c t i i i i tlcii~given geomc~ryiind inateri-
iilc. Ciiuloinh added that, Sor given materials and iwrinhic I-adius, the riitin
PIU'varics in\'ei-sely iis r ; that is, a s the radiuh OS the cyliridcr i s increased. the
reci~tancclo uniform iriutioii lor ii given load W decre;ises. Thus. considering
Ikl. 7. I l a iigain. we may cnnclude that. for given nialcriiils, (I i s a l s o c ~ n ~ t m t
for iill s i x s o i rollers atid loads. Ilowevcr. other invcsligiitors have contested
huth ~ t a t e ~ i i c n t s1xirticul;irly
, the laltei- one. ;ind ihcrc i s :I nccd for further
invcstig;ition i n l l i i s iireii. I.aching hetter datii. we prcwnt the following list of
rolling ~ ~ c l l i c i c iStir i t ~your iise. hot we tiiust ciiution th;il you ehould iint
expect great ;iccur;icq froiii t h i s general procediir:~.
~ . . ~.
~ .. .. .. ~ ~

Coefficients of Rolling Resistance


-. ~ ~ ~ . .. ~ ~~ ~. ~~~~ ~

ti (in.)
S t c d on hieel ,007 .!II 5
Sicel ,111 wood .Oh .IO~

Pwum;itic tires , , I / viiuiith raid ~!I? - SI1


Pncuni;ilic liw 011 mod ro:td .!I4 - .Oh
H;iidrnrd \tee1 on h:il-deneJ \ t c d .0!,02 .0005
SECTION 7.8 ROLLING RESISTANCE 321

Example 7.10
What is the rolling resistance of a railroad freight car weighing 100 tons?
The wheels have a diameter of 30 in. The coefficient of rolling resistance
between wheel and track is ,001 in. Compare the resistance to that of a
truck and trailer having the same total weight and with tires having a
diameter of 4 ft. The coefficient of rolling resistance a between the truck
tires and road is ,025 in.
We can use Eq. 7. I 1 b directly for the desired results. Thus. for the
railroad freight car, we haveK

For the truck, we get

We see a decided differences between the two vehicles, with clear advan-
tage toward the railroad freight car.

T h e number of wheels n plays no role here since we divide the load by n to get the
load per wheel and then niultiply hy n to get Lhc m a l resirtanfe.
7.78. A simple C-clamp i s used t o hold two pieces of metal
together. The clamp has a single square thread with a pitch 01
12 in. and a mean diameter of .75 in. The static coefficient of fric-
tion i s 30.Find the torque required i f a 1,000-lh compressive h a d
i s required on the blocks. If the thread I S a double thread. what i s
the required torquc?
c

Figure P.7.78.
1.79. The mast of n railhoat i s held hy wires called shroud,, iis
rhown in the diagram. Racing sailors are carelul t o get the pmpcr
ension in the shrouds hy adjusting the lurnhucklc at the hattom or
:he shrouds. When wc do this we say wc are .'tuning" thc hoat. II
i tension of I S 0 N exists in the chroud. what torque I S needed l o
itart tightening further by turning the tumhuckle? 'lhc pitch of the
;ingle threaded screw i s 1.5 mni and the mean diameler i s X . 0 mni.
The static coefficient of friction i s .2.

Figure P.7.79.
1.80. Forccs F of SO Ih are applied to the jackscrew shown. The
4
hread diametcr is 2 in. and the pitch i\ in. The %,tic coefficimt
if friction Tor the thread IS .OS. The wripht I?J and colliir arc nm
ierniitted to rotate and so the collar must rotatc on the shaft o1 the
crew. Ifthe static cocfficient of friction hctween the colliir and
haft is .I.determine the wcight W that can he liftcd hy this system.

122 Figure P.7.82.


7.83. Consider a single-threaded screw where the pitchp = 4.5 7.86. In Problem 735, suppose there is only rear-wheel drive
mm and the mean radius is 20 mm. For a coefficient of friction p,\ available. What is the minimum static coefficient of friction
= .3, what torque is needed on the nut for it to turn under a load of needed between tires and ground for the vehicle to move?
1.(XI0 N ? Compute this for a square thread and then do it for a tri-
angular thread where the angle p is 30". See Problem 7.82 before 7.87. A roller thrust bearing is shown supporting a force P of 2.5
doing this problem. kN. What torque Tis need to turn the shaft A at constant speed if
the only resistance is that from the hall hearings? The coefficient
7.84. If the coefficient of rolling resistance of a cylinder on a flat of rolling resistance for the balls and the bearing surfaces is
surface is .05 in., at what inclination of the surface will the cylin- ,01270 mm. The mean radius from the centerline of the shaft to
der of radius r = I ft roll with uniform velocity?
the balls is 30 mm.
7.85. A 65-kN vehicle designed for polar expeditions is on a
very slippery ice surface fur which the static coefficient of friction
between tires and ice is ,005. Also, the coefficient of rolling resis-
tance is known to be .8 mm. Will the vehicle be able to move?
The vehicle has four-wheel drive.

~ 1 . 2 m 4 - 1.3 m-.,
Figure P.7.85. Figure P.7.87.

7.9 Closure
In this chapter, we have examined the results of two independent experi-
ments: that of impending or actual sliding of one body over another and that
of a cylinder or sphere rolling at constant speed over a flat surface. Without
any theoretical basis, the results of such experiments must be used in situa-
tions that closely parallel the experiments themselves.
In the case of a rolling cylinder, both rolling resistance and sliding
resistance are present. However. for a cylinder accelerating with any appre-
ciable magnitude, only sliding friction need be accounted for. With no accel-
eration on a horizontal surface, only rolling resistance need be considered.
Most situations fall into these categories. For very small accelerations, both
effects are present and must be taken into account. We can then expect only a
crude result for such computations.
Before going further. we must carefully define certain properties of
plane surfaces in order to facilitate later computations in mechanics where
such properties are most useful. These plane surface properties and other
related topics will be studied in Chapter 8.

323
7.88. If thc static coefficient of friction for all surV~cesis 3 5 , find 7.91. A lriction drive is shown with A the drivcr dicc and R the
the force F needed to start the 2 0 - N weight moving to the right. dri\eti disc. If fiwce F pressing R onto A is I S 0 N. what i ? the
ninrimu~rrtorque M , that can he developed'? For this torque. whal
is the lurquc M , needed for thc drive disc A ? The static coefficient
o f friction bctwccn A and H is .7. What mitical force must COLI G
i
,30" wilhsrand f o r thc action dcscrihed ahrivr!

Figure P.7.XX.

7.89. A loaded crate is shown. Thc crate weighs 500 Ih wilh il


ccnier of gravity at its geometric center. Thc contact w h c z
between crate and floor has a static coefficient of friction of .2. II
H = 90", show that the crate will slide hefore m c can increasc I
enough fcw tipping to occur. If a stop is to bc inserted in rhc floor Figure P.7.91.
at A to prevent slipping so that the cmte could he tipped. whal
minimum horizontal force will he exerted on thc stop?

7.92. Detmninc thc weight of hlock A for impending motion to


the right. Thc static coefficient of friction hctwern the vahle and
thc wrlaccs which it conlacts is 0.2. Thc m l i c crrcfficienl 0 1 fric-
tion helwrrn hkrch A a i d the burface upon which it rei15 is (1.4.
Tht. two prist\ are circular with ii diameter of0.25 in.

A
Figure P.7.89.

Figure P.7.92.

7.90. In Problem 7.K9, compute a value o f H and I whzre dip-


ping and tipping will occur siinultancously. If the actual angle H i \
smaller than this value of 8, is there any further nerd of the slop at 7.93. lh Pnrhlem 7.92 till- impending slippage of hody A to
4 to prevent slipping'? the kil.

324
7.94. A tug is pushing a barge into a berth. After the barge turns 7.96. The drum is driven by a motor with a maximum torque
clockwise and touches the sides of the pilings, what thrust must capability of 500 Ib-ft. The static coefficient of friction between
the tug develop to move it at uniform speed of 2 knots fanher into the drum and the braking strap (belt) is .4. How much force P
the berth? The dynamic Coefficient of friction between the barge must an operator exert to stop the drum if it rotates ( I ) clockwise
and the sides of the berth is .4. The drag from the water is 3,000 N and (2) counterclockwise? What are the belt forces in each case'?
along the centerline of the barge.

Side P

Figure P.7.96.

Figure P.7.94.

7.97. The four drive pulleys shown are used to transmit a torque
from pulley A to pulley D on an electric typewriter. If the static
7.95. The static and dynamic coefficients of friction for the coefficient of friction between the belts and the pulleys is .3, what
upper surface of A of the are ps = .4, pd = .3, is the torque available at pulley D if 10 b i n . of torque is input to
and for the lower surface of contact B are p,, = .I and pd = .OS. the shaft of pulley A? What are the belt forces?
What is the minimum force P needed to just get the cylinder
moving'!

R
-
Figure P.7.93. Figure P.7.97.

325
7.98. A scissors jack i s shown lifting the cnd of a car s o that K = 7.100. A hot rcctanpolar mctal i n g u IS to he flatlcncd hy passing
6.67 kN. What torque T i s needed krr thic operation? Notc that A through cylindrical roller\. I I tlic ingm i \ 10 he drawn into the
i s merely a bearing and at B we linvc a nut. 'I'he \crcu is sin& r d e n hy friction once il toiiches the ~DIICIS,what i\ the minhrrum
threaded with a pitch of 3 mm and a mean diamcter o f 20 mnl. thickness I ofthe ingnl that can he auhiwed hy thi5 pmccss on one
The static coefficient of frictinn hetween the screw and nut at 13 is p i s 9 'I'hc static cocfficicnl of friction for tlic contact between
.3. Neglect the weight ofthe members and evaluiltc Tfor B = 45" inpwt and cylindcr i'l .3. The cylindel~, rotate a i showu with ang'u-
and for 0 = 60". lal- rpced w.

1"

Pigwe P.7.100,

7.101. A ccmc clutch i~bhown. Assuming that uniform pressure\


surlacei, compute thc m ~ x i , m mtorque
exist hetwcen thc w r i t a c t
that can hc tran\mittcd. Thc \tiitiu c d f i c i e n t of I i ~ i c t i u ni s .30 and
the activating force F i c 100 Ih. IMim Acsurne that the niming
Figure P.7.98.
cone transmits i l h 100-1h axial f w c c trr the statinmry c m e hy pres-
sure primarily. That i\. wc will neglect the friction-torcr compo^
nent un thr cone wriace normal ti, thc lrmsverse direction.l

1.99. A hlack C weighing 1 0 k N i q being moved on rollerr A t


ind B each weighing I kN. What force P i s nceded to m;iintain
steady motion? Take the coefficient o f rolling rcsiitancr hetween
.he mllers and the ground to he .h mm and hetween hlock L' ;MI
hc rollers to be .4 mm.
"I

Figure P.7.99.
+- l[y-

Figure P.7.101.
F ~~ 100 Ih t
126
7.102. In Fig. P.7.18, delete the external forces and couple at
point G, and replace with a force of 6,000 N at point G at an angle
a with the horizontal going from left to right. For the condition of
impending slippage in the downward direction. what should the
angle a be?

Figure P.7.104.

7.105. Shaft CD rotates at constant angular speed in a set of dry


jouinal bearings (as a result of poor maintenance). Approximately
what torque is needed to maintain the angular motion for the fol-
lowing data'?
M A = 50 kg M B = 80 kg Shaft CD = 40 kg ud = .2
See Problem 1.104before doing this problem.

60 mm A R
Figure P.7.102.

7.103. In Problem 1.39, what is the minimum angle between the


supporting links CD and ED to support any weight W if the static Figure P.7.105.
coefficient of friction is p~ = .4?
7.106. Two identical light rods are pinned together at B. End C
of rod BC is pinned while end A of rod AB rests on a rough floor
7.104. A shaft AB rotates at constant angular speed in a pair of
having a coefficient of friction with the rod of pd = .5. The
dry journal bearings. The total weight of the shaft and the cylinder
spring requires a force of 5 Nlmm of stretch. A load is applied
it is supporting is W. A torque T i s needed to maintain the steady
slowly at B and then maintained constant at F = 300 N. What is
angular motion. There is a small clearance between the shaft and
the angle 0 when the system ceases to move'? The spring is un-
the journal, resulting in a point confacf between these bodies at
stretched when 0 = 45". (HincYou will have to solve an equation
some position E as shown. Form a two-dimensional force system
by trial and error.]
acting on the shaft by moving W, the total friction force, the total
normal force on the shaft surface. and the torque to a plane normal
F
to the centerline of the shaft and at a location at the centei of the
system. View this system along the centerline.

(a) From considerations of equilibrium, what and where


is the resultant force vector from the friction force and
the normal force onto the shaft?
(b) If the angle @ in the diagram is very small and if the
coefficient of dynamic friction is p<!,explain how we
can give the following approximate equation

T = Wp<,r

where I is the radius of the shaft. Figure P.7.106.

327
I70 iiim
Figure P.7.107.

L . . . l
Figare 1'.7.109.

I A I
7.112. In Prohlem 7.27, what maximum value should W, be ir
order to S t a n moving the system to the left? All other data art
unchanged.

7.113. A block rests on a surface for which there is a coefticienl


of friction p , = .2. Over what range of angle p will there be nc
movement of the block for the 150-N force? (You will have to
solve an equation by trial and error.)

Figure P.7.110.

7.111. A triangular pile of width I ft is being driven into the


ground slowly by a force P of 50,000 Ib. There is pressure an the
lateral surfaces of the pile. This pressure varies linearly from 0 ai F L , =2
A to /io at B, as has been shown in the diagram. If the coefficient Figure P.7.113.
of dynamic friction between the pile and the soil is 0.6, what is the
ma.ximum prcssure ,I(,'!

7.114. What is the largest load that can be suspended without


moving blocks A and E'?The static coefficient of friction for all
plane surfaces of cuntact is 3. Block A weighs 500 N and block B
weighs 700 N. Neglect friction in the pulley system.

Width of
pile = I ft

Figure P.7.111. Figure P.7.114.

329
7.115. What is the minimum force F to hold the cylinders. each
weighing 100 Ih'! Takc IC, = .2 liir all surf.ict.s of contac~.

= I 10 Nlmm'
Figure P.7.116.

7.117. Find the cord tension ifhlock I attains mnximuni friction


Figure P.7.115.

1.116. A compressor is shown. If the prcsaurc in the cylinder is


1.40 N1mm2 above atmosphere (gage), what mininzum torque 7 i h
iccdcd to initiate mution in rhc systcm? Neglect the weight o f t h c
:rank and connecting rod as far as thcir ctintrihution triward imov-
ng the system. Consider fi-ictioii only hetwecn thc piston and L.-l
:ylinder walls where the coefficient 01 Irictiun = .IS. Figure P.7.117

330
Properties
of Surfaces
8.1 Introduction
If we are buying a tract of land, we certainly want to consider the size and, with
equal interest, the shape and orientation of the earth’s surface, and possibly its
agricultural, geological, or aesthetic potentials. The size of a surface (Le., the
area) is a familiar concept and has been used in the previous section. Certain
aspects of the shape and orientation of a surface will he examined in this c h a p
ter. There are a number of formulations that convey meaning about the shape
and disposition of a surface relative to some reference. To he sure, these for-
mulations are not used by real estate people, hut in engineering work, where a
variety of quantitative descriptions are necessary, these formulations will prove
most useful. In general, we shall restrict our attention to coplanar surfaces.

8.2 First Moment of an Area


and the Centroid
A coplanar surface of area A and a reference xy in the plane of the surface are
shown in Fig. 8.1. We define thefirst moment of area A about the x axis as

Mx = jAY& (8.1)

and the first moment about the v axis as

These two quantities convey a certain knowledge of the shape, size, and
orientation of the area, which we can use in many analyses of mechanics.

331
332 CHAPTHK 8 PKOPEKTII<SOF SIJKPACES

You will no doubt notice the similarity of the preceding integrals 10


\ those which would occur f(ir computing moments about the x and? axes from
a parallel force distribution oriented normal to the area A in Fig. 8.1. The
moment of such a force distribution has been shown for the purposes of rigid-
hody calculations to be equivalent to that of a single resultant force located at
a particular point 1.7 . Similarly. we can concentrate lhe entire area A at a
posilion x , , y,, called the w i i / i - o i d ' where, for computations of lint moments.
this new amngement is equi\dent In the original distribution (Fig. 8.2). The
coordinatcs x . and are usually called the wntruidul ~nordiririrr.~. To coni-
I - :
pute these coordinatcs. we simply eqiiatc miimenls 111 the distributed arcii
Figure 8.1. Plane area. with that of thc conccntratcd area ahout both axes:

Figure 8.2. Centmdal 'oord!n.iie\

'The location of the centriiid of an area can readily bc shown to be indeppn-


&iit ( i t the r&wiiw employed. That is. the centroid is a proprro, only
U X ~ S
of the owii ilsclS. We have wked the render to prove this in Problem 8.1
If the axe5 ,ry havc their origin at the centroid, thcn thcsc axes are called
nd clearly the first nioineiits about (hcsc axes must be zero.
Finally. we point out that all axes going through the centroid of an arc3
arc called renrroiilirl ii.ies for that area. Clearly. the .fir.v n i o i ~ i ~ not s/ r m ureu
uhoiit nti.y < ! / i / . v wntroidul ii.ir.s iniisf hr :era. This inust he true since the per-
pendicular dislmce frnm the cenlroid lo the centroidal axis must he zero.
SECTION 8.2 FIRST MOMENT OF AN AREA AND THE CENTROID 333

Example 8.1
A plane surface is shown in Fig. 8.3 hounded by the x axis, the curve y’=
25x, and a line parallel to they axis. What are the first moments of the area
about the x and y axes and what are the centroidal coordinates?
We shall first compute M, and My for this area. Using vertical infini-
tesimal area elements of width dx and height y . we have noting that
t ”’ 250’

y = 5x,’

pdL 10’
To compute M ,we use horizontal area elements of width dy and length
Figure 8.3. Find centroid,
(IO-x) as shown in the diagram. Thus

v could alsc we used vertical strips for computing M, as follows u: R


centroids of the vertical strips:

M, = I -(ydx)=I
lo
0 2
Y
0
725x
d.x
10
= (l’2.5)($)~ = 625 ft3
n

To compute the position of the centroid (x,., y,), we will need the
area A of the surface. Thus, using vertical strips:

= 105.4 ft2
334 CHAPTER 8 PROPERTIES OF SURFACES

f Example 8.1 (Continued)


The centroidal coordinates are, accordingly,

To get the moment of the area about an axis y’. which is 15 It Io thc
lelt of t h e y axis. simply proceed as follows:
= 105.4 6.00 + 15 = 2.213 ft’
. ~... i
Consider now a planc arca with an arI.\ ,!/.sytritiicJrry such a s is \howl1 ill
Fig. X.4, where the J axis is collinear with the axis 01symmetry. I n coinput-
ing x,. for this area. we havc

In evaluating the inkgrid ahove. we i i i n considcr iircii element\ in syn~metric


pairs such as shown in Fig. 8.4. where we have hhown ii pair of area elcnicnls
which are iiiii-ror images OS cach other ahout the axis 0 1 iymmetry. Clearly,
the first moment of such a pair about the axis of symmetry is ~ e r oAnd. . since
the entire area can he considered as composed of such pairs. we can conclude
that ,r? = 0. Thus, the cenlriiid of a11 area with onc axis of symmetry must
therefore lie somewhcrc along thih axis of cyminetry. The axis of symmetry
then is a centroidal axis. which is another indication that the first ninmcnl of
area must he 7.ero about such an axis. With two orthogonal axcs of s y n ~ m e t ~ - y ,
the centroid inust lie at the inlersccti(in O S these axes. T h w . lor such areas 21s
circles and rectangles. the centroid is easily determined by inspcction.
In many problem>, the arca (11 interest ciin he imcidered formed hy [he
addition o r subtracti(in iif ciinple familiar arciis whiihe centroids arc known by
5ymmctry inspection as well as by otlier firmiliar areas. cuch iis triangles and sectors of
circles whosc centroids and areas are givcn i n handhoohh. Wc call areas rnade
Figure 8.4. Arca with one axis of symmelry up of such simple areas u i r n / m ~ I / earcas. ( A listing of familiar areas is given
fiir your convcnicncc on the inside bach covcr of this text.) For such p r i b
Icms. we can say that

where .< and \;, (with proper signs) are the cenlroickil co(irdinatcs to simple
area Ai,and where A is the totid area.
SECTION 8.2 FIRST MOMENT OF AN AREA AND THE CENTROID 335
Example 8.2
Find the centroid of the shaded section shown in Fig. 8.5

t
60 rnm

1- 200 mm d- X

Figure 8.5. Composite area.

We may consider four separate areas. These are the triangle ( l ) , the
circle (2) and the rectangle (3) all cut from an original rectangular 200 x
140 mm2 area which we denote as area (4). In composite-area problems,
we urge you to set up a format of the kind we shall now illustrate. Using
the positions of the centroid of a right triangle as given in the inside covers
of this text, we have:

~~~ ~

A , = -f(30)(80) = -1,200 10 -12,000 113.3 -136,000


A, = - 7 ~ 5 0 ~ = -7,850 100 -785,000 70 -549,780
A, = -(40)(60) = -2,400 180 -432,000 110 -264,000
A, = (20Ol(140) = 28,ooo 100 2,800,000 70 1,960,000
A = 16,550 mm2 c AjXj = EAjY, =
1.571 x 106mm3 1.011 x 106mm3
-
Therefore.
336 CHAPTER K PKOFERTIFS OF SUKI'ACES

We now illustrate ho\+ wc can use the composilc-;i~-c:a approach lor


finding the ceiitniid ol iin m i l c(imp~iscd<iff m i l i a r parts iis just described.
I n clo.;ing. wc would likc to piiint out that the centroid ciincept can he
of use in finding Llic simples1 resultant ol a dislrihulcd loading. Thus. con-
sider thc di\ti-ihuted kiiiding ii.f.rI shmvn in Fig. X.6.The rcsultant fiirce <, 01'
t t i i i loading. also shown i n the diagi-ani. i\ given iis
8.1. Show that the centroid of area A is the same point for axes
XJ and x'y'. Thus, thc pasition of rhc ccntroid of an area is a pmp-
crty only of the area.

v'

-1,-

I
~

Figure P.8.4.
t
8.5. What are the centroidal cormiinates for the shadzd arza?
The curved boundary is that of a parabola. [Hint: 'The general
Figure P.8.1. equation for parabola? of the shape shown is J = cr.r2 + b.1

8.2. Show that thc centroid of the right triangle is x, = 2a/3. v

T
\ = MD.

J I..
v
Parabola
20 ni

Figure P.8.2.

8.3. Find t h r ccntroid of thc area under the half-sine wave. Whal
is the first moment of this area about axis A 4 1

l5m -__(

ki.
?
Figure P.8.5.
Y = sin .r 7
8.6. Show that the centroid of the area under a semicircle is ab

L, A
shown in the diagram.

Figure P.8.3.

8.4. What are the first moments of the area about the x and y
ares? The curved houndary is that of a parabola. [Him: The gen- n
eral equation for parabolas of the shape shown is y 2 = ai + h.1 Figure P.8.6.

33:
I*-- / +-I
Figure P.8.7.

Figure P.8.10.

8.11. Show that thc ccntrrrid of thc trianglc is at x, = ( o +


b]/3. v, = hl?. [Hint: B i n ~ ~thc
h triaoglc inlo two right trianglcr
i w which the uetitmids arc known fioiri Problcni 8.2.1

4'
t
h
I
I ~~ ~~

t-1
20'
--I li -~ +I
1- "

Figure ILX.8.
Figure P.8.11.

8.12. What are the cetitroidal cnordinates for the shaded area'?
The outer hoondziry is that ,if it circle having ii radius of I 111.

ti

-I 4 kigure P.8.12.
Figure P.X.V.

338
8.13. What are the coordinates of the centroid of the shaded area?
The parabola is given as y2 = 2x withy and x in millimeters.

y = 7mm
x

Figure P.8.15.
In rhr remaining problems of this secrion, U J Y cenmidal
p0SirilJn.Cof'rimple ur?u.s us jilund in rhe inside co~erx.
8.16. Find the centroid of the end shield of a bulldozer blade.

x = 10 mm
Figure P.8.13.

8.14. Find the centroid of the shaded area. The equation of the
curve is y = 5xz with x and y in millimeters. What is the first
moment of the area about line AB?
1 - 4 4
Figure P.8.16.
8.17. In Example 2.6, determine ic for the centroid of the ui-
y
angular faces of the pyramid plus the base area ABCE. The height
I
I I
of the pyramid is 300 ft.
8.18. A parallelogram and an ellipse have been cut from a rec-
tangular plate, What are the centroidal coordinates of what is left
of the plate? What i h M,,for this area? Use formulas given on the

c
80 mm inside ofthe hack covers.
Y'
\

AIY, 7)

+ 1mmm +
Figure P.8.14.

8.15. Find the centroid of the shaded area. What is the first c
moment of this area about line A-A. The upper boundary is a
parabola y2 = 501 with x and y in millimeters. Figure P.8.18.

339
8.19. A mrdiu,i axis has the mnic aira o n one side of the axis as
it does on the other side. Find the distance hetween the horizontal
(median l i n e and a parallel centmidal axis.
t
/(----A
I---. 100 irim
Figure P.8.19.
60'

*I
50 mm

-
f
I:I+- 5' .*I
Figure P.X.22.
1,
8.23. Find thc centroid of the end of rhc buckct of B sinall frrrnt
X.20. Find thc ccntroid of the truss gnwt.1 platc. end lvilder.

Find the centroid of thc indicatcd area. Figure P.8.23.


v 8.24. Whew is the czntroid of the airplane's vertical stabilizer
I (whole area)'!

r
( - ' 0 2 4. l
Figure P.X.21.

8.22. Find the crntruidal cuordin;acs ftrr the shaded area shown 1- J 111 -1 t I 111
I

tiiw rhc results in meters. [Hinr: Sec Fig. P.8.f.l Vigure P.8.24.

I 340
8.25. What is the first moment ofthe shaded area about the diag- 8.27. A wide-flange I beam (identified as 14WF202 I beam) is
onal A-A? [Hinr: Consider symmetry.] shown with two reinforcing plates on top. At what height above
the bottom i s the centroid of the beam located'?

.r

Figure P.8.25.

1
Figure P.8.27.

8.26. A built-up beam is shown with four 120-mm by 120-mm


by 20-mm angles. Find the vertical distance above the base for the
centroid of the cross-section.

8.28. Compute the position of the centroid of the shaded u t a .


[ H i m See Fig. P.8.6.1

0 In,"
21 mm
5 1- 1-35 mm+

f 13 mm

4T- 41 mm A+-
35 mm
Figure P.8.28.

34 I
Figure P.8.30.

ICL,--rl

Figure P.8.2Y.

8.3 Other Centers


We employ the concepts of n i ~ i n c n t sand ccntroids in mechanics for three-
dimensional bodies as wcll as for plaiie areas. Thus, w e intriiduce now the
I first tnoment 01a volunie. V. 01a hiidy (see Fig. X.X) ahout a point 0 where

(8.6)

Figure 8.8. Center of voIume. C.V.. of a v?. = jjjrdr.


hody. i

Thcrrlore.

r' = v! Jjjri / r ' (8.7)


1

We see that the center of volume is the poinl wherc we could hypothetically
concentrate thc entire volu~neof il body for purposcs of computing the firhi
moment of the volume lit. the hody about some point 0. The components of
Eq. 8.7 pibe the ( ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ , , i d d i ~ofi ~volttine
i i i ( . ( ,.x,
.~ , );, and z c . Thus, we have

342
SECTION 8.3 OTHER CENTERS 343

The integral x do. it should be noted, gives the first moment of volume
about the yz plane, etc.
If we replace dv by dm = p du in Eq. 8.6, where p is the mass densiv,
we get thefirst moment o f m a n about 0.That is,

moment vector of mass = 111r


V
p dz: (8.9)

The cenfer of mass rc is then given as

(8.10)

where M is the total mass of the body. The center of mass is the point in space
where hypothetically we could concentrate the entire mass for purposes of
computing the first moment of mass about a point 0. Using the components
of Eq. 8.10, we can say that

lls XP dv YP dL'
, 2, =
ISf =pdv
"= IljpdZJ ' yc = JjJpdv
IIJ p
dv
In our work in dynamics, we shall consider the center of mass of a
system of n particles (see Fig. 8.9). We will then say:

Therefore, $/.Me V

mi';
- i=l (8.1 I)
M
x e m,
where M is the total mass of the system. Clearly, if the particles are of infini- Figure 8,9. System of panic,es showing
tesimal mass and constitute a continuous body, we get hack Eq. 8.10. center of mass, C.M.
Finally, if we replace dv by ydu, where y ( = pg) is the specific weight,
we arrive at the concept of center of gravity discussed in Chapter 4. We have
used the center of gravity of a body in many calculations thus far as a point to
concentrate the entire weight of a body.
You should have no trouble in concluding from Eq. 8.10 that if p is
constant throughout a body, the center of mass coincides with the center of
volume. Furthermore, if y ( = pg) is constant throughout a body, the center of
gravity of the body corresponds to the center of volume of the body. If,
finally, p and g are each constant for a body, all three points coincide for the
body.
We now illustrate the computation of the center of volume. Computa-
tion for the center of mass follows similar lines, and we have already com-
puted centers of gravity in Chapter 4.
c
SECTION 8.3 OTHER CENTERS 345

Example 8.4
What is the coordinate s? for the center of volume of the body of revolu-
tion shown in Fig. 8.1 I'! Note that a cone has been cut away from the left
8
!
end whilc. at the right end, we have a hemispherical region.

-1 4 mm-11 mm

Figure 8.11. Compovte valume

We have a composite body consisting of three simple domains-a


cone (body I ) , a cylinder (body 21, and a hemisphere (body 3). Using
furinulas from the inside covers, we have:

Tliereforc,

We have presented 8 number of three-dimensional problems for detcr-


mining the center of volume, ccnter of mass, and the center of gravity of com-
posite bodies. We will leave it to the student to work hidher way through
these problems, working from first principles, without the need of examples.
However, we ask that you follow the following format, which clearly is an
extension 01' what we havc been doing up to this point.
346 CHAPlEK X PROP1IRTIES I F SURFACES

(p; I,

...

I n closing. wc wish to point o u t further that curved surfaces and lines


have centroids. Since we shall have occasion in the next section to consider
the ccntrnid of a line, wc simply point nut inow (see Fig. 8.12) that
Figure 8.12. Czntniid frir ciirwd line.

(8.12a)

(X.12hi

wlicre 1. i s the length nf the line. Note that the centroid C will not gcnerally
lie along the line.
Consider next a curve tnadc u p nf simple curves each of whose cem
troids i s known. Such i s the case shnwn i n Fig. 8.13. inade up nf straight
lines. .The linc segment I.,.has for instance centroid C, with coordinates il,7,.
iis has heen shown i n the diagram. We can then suy for the enlire curve that

Figure 8.13. Ccntroid for coinporite line. (8.13)


SECTION 8.4 THEOREMS OF PAPPUS-GULDINUS 341

"8.4 Theorems of Pappus-Guldinus


The theorems of Pappus-Guldinus were first set forth by Pappus about 300
A . D . and then restated by the Swiss mathematician Paul Guldinus about 1640.
These theorems are concerned with the relation of a surface of revolution to
its generating curve, and the relation of a volume of revolution 10 its general-
ing area.
The first of the theorems may be stated as follows:

Y Generating curve

Figure 8.14. Coplanar generating curve.

To prove this theorem, consider first an element d/ of the generating curve


shown in Fig. 8.14. For a single revolution of the generating curve about the
x axis, the line segment d/ traces an area

dA = 2Ry dl
For the entire curve this area becomes the surface of revolution given as

A = 2 n I y d l = 2ny,L (8.14)

where L is the length of the curve and y, is the centroidal coordinate of the
curve. But 2 % is~the~ circumferential length of the circle formed by having the
centroid of the curve rotate about the .r axis. The first theorem is thus proved.
348 CHAPTEI< K PROPERTIES OF St!KFA(TS

An(ithcr way 01intcrpreting Eq. X.14 i h to note that the area ofthe hody
<)Irevolution i s e q u l to 211 times thc .fii:st monwir 0 1 the generating curve
about the axis of rc\'oIulioii. If the genernting c u I \ ~ ci h coinposcd of himplc
curves. I-,. whose ccntroidh iirc known. such a s the cncc shiiwn i n Fig. 8.13.
thcn we can exprcs, A iic l i i l l o w s :

whcl-c 7,i s the centniidsl c~iordinateto the ith line segment L,.
Thc second theoreni may he stated a s liillciws:

Consider a plane su$ace and an axis of revolution coplonar with the sur-
,face bat oriented such that the axis cui1 intersect the surface only as u tan-
gent at the boundary or havv no intersection ai all. The volume of the
body ufrevolution developed by rotating the plane surface about the axis
uf revolution equals the product O f the area of the suface times tbe cir-
cumference of the circle fiirmed by the centroid qf the suface in the
process of generating the body uf revolution.
SECTlON 8.4 THEOREMS OF PAPPUS-GULDINUS 349

Thus, the volume V equals the area of the generating surface A times the cir-
cumferential length of the circle of radius yc. The second theorem is thus also
proved.2
Another way to interpret Eq. 8.16 is to note that Vequals 2a times the
first moment of the generating area A about the axis of revolution. If this area
A is made up of simple areas At, we can say that

(8.17)

where y,, IS the centroidal coordinate to the ith area A , .


We now illustrate the use of the theorems of Pappus and Guldinus. As
we proceed, it will be helpful to remember the theorems by noting that you
multiply a length (or area) of the generator by the distance moved by the cen-
troid of the generator.

'11 is ta be pointed out that the cenVoid of a volume of revolution will not be coincident
with the centroid of a longitudinal cross-section taken along the axis of the volume. Example: a
cone and its triimgular. longitudinal cross-section.

Example 8.5
Determine the surface area and volume of the bulk materials trailer shown
in Fig. 8.16.

Figure 8.16. Bulk materials trailer.


We shall first determine the surface area by considering the first
moment about the centerline A-A (see Fig. 8.17) of the generating curve of

lte"'7- e20'-

A A
Figure 8.17. Generating curve for surface of revolution
350 CHAPTEK 8 I'KOPFRTIES 0 1 ' SIJKI:A('FS

Example 8.5 (Continued)


the surface of rwiilutimi. This curvc is a h c t (11' 5 straight line5 e d i of
whose centroids is misily k n o w n by inspection. Accordingly we niay use
Eq. 8.15. For clarity, we use a column forinat for the data as follows:

L, ( f l ) v, ( f l ) L, T, If13

I. 1 I .s 4.5
2. \,,X' + I2 = I(.Oh 3.S 28.21
3. 20 i 80
3. 8.06 3.5 X2l
5. 3 1.5 1.5
L,V, = 115.43

Thcrcfore.
A = (2rO(135.33) = 914ft'
To get the voliinic. we next show i n Fig. 8. I X the generating arcii lor
Ihe hody of rcvolutioii. Notice il has been dcconiposed into simple com-
positc areas. We shall ciiiploy Eq, 8.17 arid hencc wc shall iieed the Sirst
nionient ofarca iibiiut the iixis A-A of the composite arcas. Again. we shall
employ a columii formal for the data.

A ,A

I. 24 I .s 16
2. $(8)(1) = 3 3+ ;= 3.33 13.73
3. 80 2 I60
4. 1 1.137 13.33
5. 24 I .S 16
1A,T, = 2513.7
Therefore.
V = 2 i i x A , T , = ( 2 1 ~ ) ( 2 5 8 . 7=) 1,625ft3

The theorems or Pappus and Guldinus h a w enahled us to computc the sur-


face area and the volume of the bulk inaterials trailer quickly and easily.
8.31. If r2 = ax in the body af revolution shown. compute the
centroidal distance x, of the body.

Figure P.8.34.
8.35. Find the center of mass for the paraboloid of revolution
Figure P.8.31. having a uniform density p.
i
8.32. Using venical elements of volume as shown, compute the
centroidal coordinates x, , yCof the body. Then, using horizontal
elements, compute ?<.
i

Figure P.8.35.
8.36. A small bomb has exploded at position 0.Four pieces of the
bomb move off at high speed. At f = 3 EZC, the following data apply:
Figure P.8.32. m (kgi r (m)
8.33. Compute the center of volume of a right circular cylinder I. .2 Zi + 3j + 4k
of height h and radius at the base r. 2. .I 4i + 4j 6k ~

3. .IS -.li + 2j - 3k
4 ?? 2 - 3i + 2k

Whdt is the position of the center of mass?

Figure P.8.33.
8.34. Determine the position of the center of mass of the solid
hemisphere having a uniform mass density p and with a radius a. Figure P.8.36. 75

I
4
8.43. Find the center of gravity of the bent plate. The rectangular 8.46. Two thin plates are welded tugether. One has a circle of
cutout occurs at thc geometric center of the surface in the-ic plane. radius 2llO mm cut out ns shown. If each plate weighs 450 Nlm',
what is the position 01 thc center of mass?
I IJ
.3 m

Figure P.8.46.
8.47. Where is the center of mass of the bcnt wire if it weighs
Figure Y.8.43. Ill Nlm'!

8.44. A hen1 aluminum rod weighing 30 N l m is fitted intu a i

plastic cylindrr weighing 200 N, as shown. What are the centers I


of volumc, mass. and gravity?

Figure P.8.47.
8.48. Find the centci of mass of the bent wire shown in the z?
Figure P.8.44.
plane. The wirc weighs IS Nlm.
8.45. An illuniinum cylinder fit5 snugly into a brass block. The
brass weighs 43.2 kN1nv' and the illuniiiium wzighh XI kN1m'. Find
the center af volume, the center of mass, and the center of gravity.
400 mm
y

T6OU m m

l? \
Figure P.8.48.
900 mm

8.49. In Prohlcm 8.41, involving a wooden cone-cylinder with i


cylindrical hole, find the center of mass for the case where tht
-I"/ 500 m m -AJ cylinder has a density of4h.C Ibmlft' and the cone has a density oi
Figure P.8.45. 30.0 Ibmlft'.

35:
8.50. The volume uf an ellipsoidal body ofrevolution is known
from calculus to be inab2.If the area of an ellipse is linbI4, find
the centroid of the itred for a semiellipse.

l-~ ~u
in m m
I 2 0 mrn 2nn m m
Figure P.8.50.
Figure P.8.54.
1.51. Find the centroidal coordinate y , of the shaded area shown,
8.55. Find the volumc and r u f i x c nrca n1 the Apollo rpaceship
ising the theorems of Pappus and Guldinus.
used Sor lunar cxploralion.
Y

Figure P.8.51.
1.52. The cutting tool of a lathe is programmed to cut along the
lashed line as shown. What are the volume and the area of the
rody of revolution fnrmed on the lathe'?

Figure P.8.55.
8.56. Find the cenler of volume 5 for thc machine elerncnt shown.

b f ? L20" 4 3 ' J + 8 " 4


Figure P.8.52.
i.53. Find the surSace area and volume of the right conical

I
IO

I
Figure P.8.53.
54. Find the surface area and volume of the Earth entry cap-
1.- -11)- j y
ile for an unmanned Mars sampling mission. Approximate the
xmded nose with a pvinted nosc as shown with the dashed lines.
54 Figure P.8.56.
SECTION 8.5 SECOND MOMENTS AND THE PRODUCT OF AREA OF A PLANE AREA 355

8.5 Second Moments and the Product


of Area3of a Plane Area
We shall now consider other properties of a plane area relative to a given ref-
erence. The second mnrnenfs of the area A about the x and y axes (Fig. 8.19),
denoted as I,, and lyv,respectively, are defined as

I,, =j y? dA
A
(8.18~1)

Ivy= j,,x z dA (8.18b)

I I y-
Figure 8.19. Plane surface

The second moment of area cannot be negative, in contrast to the first


moment. Furthermore, because the square of the distance from the axis is used,
elements of area that are farthest from the axis contribute most to the second
moment of area.
In an analogy to the centroid, the entire area may be concentrated at a
single point (kx, kJ to give the same second moment of area for a given refer-
ence. Thus,

The distances k,, and kv are called the radii ofgyration. This point will have a
position ihui depend.y nui only on the shape (fl the area but also on the posi-
tion o f t h e reference. This situation is unlike the centroid, whose location is
independent of the reference position.
The product .f area relates an area directly to a set of axes and is
defined as
I,, = 1, x y d A (8.20)

‘We often usc the expressions moment and product of inenin for second moment and prod-
uct of area. respectively. However. we shall also use the former expressions in Chapter 9 in con-
necticin with mass distributions.
356 CHAPTER x PROPERTIES OF S ~ J R F A C E S

? This quantity may hc negative.


I I the area under consideration has an axis of symmetry, the product of
area for this axis and any axis orthogonal to this axis must he zero. You can
readily reach this conclusion hy considering the area in Fig. 8.20, which is
dA symmetrical ahout the axis A-A. Notice that the centroid is somewhere along
this axis. (Why ?) The axis of symmetry has hccn indicated as the y axis. and
an arbitrary x axis coplanar with thc area has hecn shown. Also indicated arc
two elemental areas that are positioned as mirror images ahout the J axis. The
contnhution to the product of area of each elcmciit is .KJ CIA. hut with opposite
signs, and so the net i-esull i h x r o . Since the ciitire iireii can he considered to
he composed OS such pairs;. it hecomes evident that the product of area for
such cases is zero. This should no/ he taken to nican that a nonsymmetric area
T cannot have a zero product of area ahout a set of axes. We \hall discuss this
last condition in more deud later.
Area synlnlrlric axis,

8.6 Transfer Theorems


We shall now set foith a theiircm that will he 01gre;u use in computing scc-
ond moments and products of are8 for areas that can he decomposed into sim-
ple parts (composite areas). With this theorem, wc can find second moments
or products of area ahout any axih in terms of second moments or products of
area ahout a pnmllel set of axes going through the cmtroid of the area in
question.
An .r axis is shown in Fig. 8.21 pal-allel to and at B distance d from an
axis x’ going through the centroid of the area. The latter axis you will recall is
a centi-ooidal axis. Thc second momcnt of area about rlic I axis is

where the distance y has been replaced hy (J’ + d ) . Carrying out the squaring
operation and integrating, le;ids to the rcsiilt
=
:
I
y” </A + 2dj,, y’dA + Ad’
The first term on the right-hand side is by definition I r , < , . The second term
,cl involves the first moment of area ahout the .I’axis. But the .x’ axis here is a
centroidal axis, and so the second term is zero. We can inow slate the transfcr
thcorem (frequcntly called the parallel-axis theorem):

Figure 8.21. x and x’ are parallzl axes.


u y axis
-
- ‘about a par die^ + Ad2 (8.21)
a i s at eenmoid

where d is the perpendicular distancc hctween Ihc axis for which I is being
ciimputed and the parallel ccntroidal axis.
SECTION 8.7 COMPUTATION INVOLVING SECOND MOMENTS AND PRODUCTS OF AREA 351

In strength of materials, a course generally following statics, second


moments of area about noncentroidal axes are commonly used. The areas
involved are complicated and not subject to simple integration. Accordingly,
in structural handbooks, the areas and second moments about various cen-
troidal axes are listed for many of the practical configurations with the under-
standing that designers will use the parallel-axis theorem for axes not at the
centroid.
Let us now examine the oroduct of area in order to establish a Darallel- Y Y’

axis theorem for this quantity. Accordingly, two references are shown in Fig.
8.22, one (x’, y’) at the centroid and the other (x, y ) positioned arbitrarily but
parallel relative to x’y’. Note that c and d are the x and y courdinates, respec-
tively, of the centroid of A as measured from reference xy. These coordinates
accordingly must have the proper signs, dependent on what quadrant the cen-
troid ofA is in relative toxy. The product of area about the noncentmidal axes
xy can then be given as
Figure 8.22. c and d measured from xy.
In = I, xy dA = 5, (x’ + c)(y’ + d ) dA

Carrying out the multiplication, we get

Clearly, the first term on the right side by definition is Ix.,.. whereas the next
two terms are zero since x’ and y ’ are centroidal axes. Thus, we arrive at a
parallel-axis theorem for products of area of the form:

It is important to remember that D and d a r e measured from the xy axes


to the centroid and must have the appropriate sign. This will be carefully
pointed out again in the examples of Section 8.7.

8.7 Computations Involving Second


Moments and Products of Area
We shall examine examples for the computation of second moments and
products of an area.
3.58 (‘HAPTER X PROPERTIES O b S I J K b N ‘ t S

Example 8.6
A rectangle is shown in Fig. 8.23. Compute the second moments and prod.
ucts o l area about the centroidal x’y’axci iis well as ahout thc .q axcs.

iii

i~.
x
L
Figure 8.23. Rectangle: hasc h. height h.

l y , vI,r,,s,. For computing It ,,,, we can use a strip of width d?‘ at a dis-
tance s ’ from the x’ axis. The area r l A then hecomes h &‘. Hence, we have

This is a common result and should well he remembered since it occurs so


often. Verhally. fnr such an axis, the second moment 01 area is equal tn %.
the hase h times the height h cubed. The second moment of area for the J’’
axis can immediately he written as

(h)

where the hase and height have simply heen interchanged.


As a result of the previous statement? on symmctry. we iinmediatcly
note that

6.I>\, I,, Emplnylng the tran\ler thcoreni\, we get

I LI = hbh’ +bhe2
I VY = &hb3 + bM2
In computing the product of area. we must he careful to cmploy the proper
signs for the transfer distances. In checking the derivation of the transfer
theorem, we see that these distances are measured from the noncentroidal
axes to the centroid C. Therefore, in this prohlem the transfer distances are
( + e )and (H). Hence, thc computation of It, becomes
:”.,>

I+ = 0 + (hh)(+r)(-d) = (0
and is thus a negative quantity.
SECTION 8.7 COMPUTATTON INVOLVING SECOND MOMENTS AND PRODUCT OF AREA 359

Example 8.7
What are 6, I,. and IX,for the area under the parabolic curve shown in Y
Fig. 8.24?
To find I, we may use horizontal strips of width dy as shown in
Fig. 8.25. We can then say for IXx:
10
I, = y2[dy(10- XI]
But
x = qmiy2
Therefore, 10 Figure 8.24. Plane area.
I, = yz(IO - &6y1'2)dy
0

As for I",. we use vertical infinitesimal strips as shown in Fig. 8.26.


We can, accordingly, say:

Figure 8.25. Horizontal strip.

Finally, for LYwe use an infinitesimal area element dn dy shown in


Fig. 8.27. We must now perform multiple integration4 Thus, we have
I0 v=r1/10
s =I0jVX0 *ydyh

Notice by holding x constant and letting y first run from y = 0 to the curve
y = 3/10 we cover the vertical strip of thickness dn at position x such as is k - 1 0 m m 4
shown in Fig. 8.26. Then by letting x run from zero to IO, we cover the entire Figure 8.26. Vertical strip.
area. Accordingly, we first integrate with respect toy holding x constant. Thus,
Y

/A+
y=M,
Next, integrating with respect to x, we have

b l O m m 4 x

"This multiple integration involves boundaries requiring some variable limits, in con- Figure 8.27. Element for multiple
trast to previous multiple integrations. integration
360 CHAPTER 8 PKOPERTIES OF SURFACES

Example 8.8 ..-.,. :'- "..".


>..

Compute the second niomcnt (if arcil (if a circiiliii- iireii ah(ii11ii di;iiiictcr
(Fig. 8.28).
i

Figure 8.28. Circular area with p d a r ciiwdinarc.;.

Using polar coordinates, we hiivc' lor i l l ;

Completing the integration. uc h a w


SECTION 8.7 COMPUTATION INVOLVING SECOND MOMENTS AND PRODUCT OF AREA 361

Example 8.9
Find the centroid of the area of the unequal-leg Z section shown in Fig.
8.29. Next, determine the second moment of area about the centroidal axes
parallel to the sides of the Z section. Finally, determine the product of area
for the aforementioned centroidal axes.

Figure 8.29. Unequal-leg Z section.

We shall subdivide the Z section into three rectangular areas, as


shown in Fig. 8.30. Also, we shall insert a convenient reference xy,as shown
in the diagram. To find the centroid, we proceed in the following manner:
A, (in.?) ?, (in.) V,. (in.) A,rj(in.') A;?; (in.')

1. (2)(1) = 2 I 7.50 2 15
2. (8)(1) = 8 2.50 4 20 32
3. (4)(1) =A S .so 20 -2
EA, = I4 A,,?, = 42 A,Y, = 49

Figure 8.30. Composite area.


362 CHAPTER x PRO PERTIE S OF SURFACES

Example 8.9 (Continued)


Therefore,

We h w e shown the centroidal axes .xc);. in Fig. 8.31. We now find


using the parallel-axis theorem and the lormulas &hh’ and
and ly,vt,
lxcxc
&hb3 for the second moments of area about centroidal axes of symmetry
of a rectangle.

+[(&1(4)(13)+ (4)(3*)] = 4

0
. = [(&)(1)(23 + ( 2 ) ( 2 2 ) ]+ [(/2)(8)(13) + (8)(fP]
I?<>?
0 0 Figure 8.31. Centroidal axe, XJ

+[(&)(I)(49 + (4)(22)] = 32.


i <
a
Finally, we consider the product of area Cc?<,.Here we must be cau-
tious in using the parallel-axis theorem. Remember that xcy, are centroidal
axes for the entire ales of the Z section. In using the parallel-axis theorem
for a subarea, we must note that x<y<are not centroidal axes for the sub-
area. The centroidal axes to he used in this problem for subareas are the
axes of symmetry of each subarea. In short, xV ,, are simply axes ahout
which we are computing the product of area of each subarea. Therefore, in
the parallel-axis theorem, the transfer distances c and d are measured.from
the x,y, uxer to the rentroid in each subarea, as noted in the development
of the parallel-axis theorem. The proper sign must be assigned each time
to the transfer distances with this in mind. We have for lrcJt:
8.57. Find lxx,/vY. and I=\, for the triangle shown. Give the 8.61. Find I,\ for the shaded area. You must first determine the
results in feet. constant c.

Y
I Y

Figure P.8.57.
8.58. What are the second moments and products of area of the
ellipse for reference xy'? [Hint: Can you work with one quadrant
and then multiply by 4 for the second moments?]
Y

Figure P.8.61,

8.62. Find I v y for the area between the curves

y = 2 sin x ft
Figure P.8.58.
y = sin 2x ft
8.59. Find I,, and I,, for tbe quarter circle of radius 5 m
fromx = O t o x = nft.
Y

8.63. Find I", for the areas enclosed between curves y = cos x
and y = sin x and the lines x = 0 and x = nI2.

8.64. Show that I_ = bh3/12, 5, = b3k/12, and I,, = b2h2/24


x for the right triangle.
5m

:i\
Figure P.8.59.
Y
8.60. Find lix,I">, and I., for the shaded area. I
Y

1 I+-+-
X

Figure P.8.60. Figure P.8.64.

363
8.74. In Problem 8.73, show that I,,,, = bh3t36, Iv+ = 8.77. Find In,.,! lxsc,and I, for the stmctural "hat" section
C~ c
(bhI36Kb2 - ab + a'). and lxcjc = (h2bI72)(2a - b ) for the tri- Disregard all rounded edges.
~. IHint: Use the results of Problems 8.1 I and 8.73 and the
anele.
parallel-axis theorem.]

8.75. Find I-. Ivy. and I,, of the extruded section. Disregard all
rounded edges. Do this problem using 4 areas. Check using 2
areas.

Y Figure P.8.77.
I
8.78. Find In. Ivy. and <,"of the hexagon.

Figure P.8.75. k R d /
Figure P.8.78.

8.79. A beam cross-section is made up of an I-shaped section


8,76, Find the second moment of area of the rectangle (with a with an additional thick plate welded on. Find the second
Of area for the 'CY,. Of the cross-
hole) about the base of the rectangle. Also, determine the product
of area about the base and left side. section. What is Give the results in millimeters.

+9" i

i_2:l(t:i ? b6" - t i
Figure P.S.76. Figure P.8.79.

365
I I

I
Figure P.X.XI.

8.8 Relation Between Second Moments


and Products of Area
We sh:ill iiow show that wc can iisccrliiin second miiments and producl 0 1
area relatiw to a rolalcd rclcrcncc .A'!' i f w e know these quilnlities for refer-
encc r y that has tlic .surne o r i ~ i ~Such
i. ii reference x'y' tmated an anglc a
froni x? (countcrclockwise :is positive) i s shown i n Fig. X.32. Wc shall
assume that the second miimcnts wid product of area for the unprimed refer-
ence are kiiowii.
Hefiire proceeding, wc mu\t know Lhr relation hetween the coordinalcs o1
thc area clcmcnts (/A 101- the Iwo references. Froiii Fig. X.32. yi)u inlay show that
~ i '= i cosa + y sin n IX.23a)
s' = -isin a + ? c o s n lX.23h)
With relation 8.23h. wc can cxprcss I t , $i n, the follo\ving manncr:

= j , ~ t - . ~ s i n a + y c ~ ~ s ~ ~ i (X.24)
= j,,,ty'~c/~ ~[/~

('arrying ouI thc scj~iiire.we h a b e


Figure 8.32. Rimlion of axe\
/s,t, = sin? c x j ~ tA
<!? ~ ?hili n c o s a j . x v < / ~+ c o s i a j y?'/il
n 1 A

Thrrefiire.

I>,>,
= sin' a+ cos2 n ~ 21$)sin cxcos a (8.25)

366
SECTION 8.8 RELATION BETWEEN SECOND MOMENTS AND PRODUCTS OF AREA 367
A more common form of the desired relation can he formed by using the fol-
lowing trigonometric identities:
cos2 a = $(I + cos 2a) (a)
sin2 a = $ ( I - c o s 2 a ) (b)
2 sin a cos a = sin 2a (C)
We then have6

To determine I;,., we need only replace the a in the preceding result by (a +


ED).Thus,

Note that cos (2a + z) = - cos 2a and sin (2a + n) = -sin 2a. Hence,
the equation above becomes

- I
-€ am 2a + 1, (8.27~

Next, the product of area /+.can be computed in a similar manner:


/xc. = j,x’y(d~ = I A ( x c o s a + y s i n a ) ( - x s i n a + y c o s a ) ~

This becomes
1
X Y
I I = sin a cos a (5, - /J + (cos’ a - sinZ a)/xY
Utilizing the previously defined trigonometric identities, we get

= + I,coSzq i (828)

Thus, we see that, if we know the quantities 1,. I,, and I,, for some reference
xy at point 0, the second moments and products of area for every set of axes
at point 0 can be computed. And if, in addition, we employ the transfer theo-
rems, we can compute second moments and products of area for any refer-
ence in the plane of the area.

“!3quations 8.26. 8.27, and 8.28 are called rrnnsfomarion equations. They will appear in
the next chapter and in your upcoming solid mechanics course for variables other than second
moments and products of area. In the remaining portions of this chapter, you will see that a num-
ber of imponant properties of second moments and products of area are deducible direcrly from
these transformation equations. This primarily accounts for the importance of the transformation
equations. Chapter 9 will give you additional insight into this topic.
S EC T ION 8.9 POLAR MOMENT OF AREA 369

8.9 Polar Moment of Area


In the previous section, we saw that the second moments and product of area
Sor an orthogonal reference determined all such quantities for any orthogonal
reference having the same origin. We shall now show that the sum of the
pairs of second moments of area is a constant for all such references at a
point. Thus, in Fig. 8.35 we have a reference xy associated with point a.
Summing I,, and Ivywe have

Figure 8.35. J = I,, + I.>.

Since r 2 is independent of the orientation of the coordinate system, the sum


IA, + I _ is independent of the orientation of the reference. Therefore, the
sum of second moments of area ahout orthogonal axes is a function only of
the position of the origin u for the axes. This sum is termed the polur moment
of area, J.x We can lhen consider J to be a scalar field. Mathematically, this
statement is expressed as

J = J(x: y ' ) (8.29)

where x' and y ' are the coordinates as measured from some convcnicnt
reference x'y'for the point of interest.
That the quantity ( I r r + IJ does not change on rotation of axes can
also be deduced by summing transformation equations 8.26 and 8.27 as we
suggest you do. This group of terms is accordingly termed an invuriunt. Par-
enthetically, we can similarly show that (/&v - I;,) is also invariant under a
rotation of axes.

XQuite oftcn I,, i s used for the polar moment of are&.


370 CHA1”I‘ER X PROPERTIES OF SURFACES

8.10 Principal Axes


Still othcr conclusions may he drawn about second iiiotiients and products of
a r m associated with ii point i n an area. In Fig. 8.36 ail area i s showti with a
reference xy having its urigin at point o . We shall assume that I,.<. I $ , , and I,,
are known for this reference. and shall ask at what angle CY we shall find an
axis having the inuirnuni second mu~iientof :ireti. Since the sum of thc sec-
ond moments of area i s constant Iur any reference with origin at (1. the nrirti-
rnurn second niniiicnt of area must then correspond 10 iui iixis at rifihf anglcs
Figure 8.36. Principal axes to the axis having the maximimi second tiinmetit. Sincc second nimnen~sof
area have heen expressed i n Kqs. 8.26 and 8.21 a s lunctiotis 0 1 lhc variable a
at a point. these extremcs may readily he determined by setting the partial
derivative nf I \ , & , with rcspcct to uequ;il to (erii. Thus.

II we denote the value nf a that satisfies the equation above iis iU, we h a w

Hence,

This formulation gives us the angle ri. which corresponds tO an extreme value
of I > , , , (i.e.. ti) a maximum or minimum valuc). Actually, there are two possi-
ble valucs u f 2 N which are nradians apart that w i l l satisfy the equation above.
Thus,

or
2ix = p +i[

This means that we have two values o f ri, given a s

Thus. there are two axes orthogonal to each other having extreme values for
the second monienl of area at (1. On tie of thehe axes i s the n i a x i i n ~ msecond
moment of area and. a s pointed out carlicr. thc minimum second moment nf
area must appear on the other axis. These axes are called the p r i i i ~ ~ i LpLlI P S .
SECTION 8.1o PRINCIPAL AXES 31 1

Let us now substitute the angle ti into Eq. 8.28 for Q,,:

I,'v
I..=-
xi.
~

2
'~sin 2 8 + /_, cos 2 8 (8.31)

If we now form a right triangle with legs 2'- and (Ivy - 6)and angle 22
such that Eq. (8.30) is satisfied we can readily express the sine and cosine
expressions needed in the preceding equation. Thus

By substituting these results into Eq. 8.31, we get

Hence,
(,y, = 0
Thus, we see that the product of urea corresponding to the principul
u e s is zero. If we set I,.,. equal to zero in Eq. 8.28, you can demonstrate the
converse of the preceding statement by solving for a and comparing the
result with Eq. 8.30. That is, if the product of area is zero for a set of axes at
a point, these axes must be the principal axes at that point. Consequently, if
one axis of a set of axes at a point is symmetrical for the area, the axes are
principal axes at that point.
The concept of principal axes will appear again in the following chap-
ter in connection with the inertia tensor. Thus, the concept is not an isolated
occurrence hut is characteristic of a whole family of quantities. We shall,
then, have further occasion to examine some of the topics introduced in this
chapter from a more general viewpoint.
372 VHAPTER x S U RF A C E S
PKOPEKTIES 01.

Example 8.11
Find the principal second moments of area at the centroid of the Z section
of Example X.9.
We have from this example the following results that will be of use
LO Ub:

/ccrc = 113.2

I Y( V(
= 32.67 in.4
I /'?< = -42.0 in.4
Hence, we have

2 h = 46.21 O, 226.2"
For2ir = 46.21":

I , = 113.2+32.67 + 113.2-32.67cos~46,21~~-~-42~~,n46,21~
2 2
= 72.9 + 27.9 + 30.3 = 131.1 in.4
For 2 0 = 226.2":
.
~~,..',~..
l2 = 72.9 - 27.9 - 30.3 = &.&%%$

As a check on our work, we note that the sum of the second moments
of area are invariant at a point for a rotation of axes. This means that

I r , I( + IVt
V/ = 1, + '2

113.2+32.7= 131.1+14.75
Therefore,
145.9 = 145.9
We thus have a check on our work.

Before closing, we wish to point out that there is a graphical construction


called Mohr's circle relating second moments and products of area for all
possible axes at a point. However, in this text we shall use the analytical rela-
tions thus far presented rather than Mohr's circle. You will see Mohr circle
construction in your strength of materials course where its use in cnnjunction
with the important topics of plane stress and plane strain is very h e l p f ~ l . ~

"See I . H . Shames, Iniroducnon 10 Solid Mechontr..>.Second Edition. Prmrice-Hall. loc..


Englrwuod Clills. N.J.. 1989.
8.82. It is known that area A is IO ft2 and has the following Y

Lx
moments and products of area for the centroidal axes shown:
I= = 40 ft4, I , = 20 ft‘, 5, = 4ft4
Find the moments and products of area for the x’y’ reference at
point a.
Figure P.8.85.
v’
X’

8.86. Use the calculus to show that the polar moment of area of
a circular area of radius I is nr41? at the center.
Y

6 - x
Figure P.8.82.
Figure P.8.86.
8.83. The cross-section of a beam is shown. Compute I,;.. ly.,.,
and c,,in the simplest way without using formulas for second 8.87. Find the direction of the principal axes for the angle sec-
moments and products of area for a triangle. tion at point A.
Y’ Y

. ,
Figure P.8.83. Figure P.8.87.

8.84. Find I,=,I,\, and I,, for the rectangle. Also, compute the 8.88. What are the principal second moments of area at the ori-
polar moment of area at points a and b. gin for the area of Example 8.7?
8.89. Find the principal second moments of area at the centroid
I
for the area shown.

42 ” k

Figure P.8.84.
8.85. Express the polar moment of area of the square as a func-
tion of x , y, the coordinates of points about which the pola 1- IT^ t
moment is taken. Figure P.8.89.
4
7
1,1111

t
"I- r
-
Figure P.8.91.
L, 3' I
8.YZ. Show that thc axe5 for which the product of area i s il ~ i i i i x -
imuiii are rotated from n by an angle a so that

Figure P.8.92.
8.93. What is thc value of the mgle 01 lor thc principal axss at A.

I'

" -2.-
kigure P.8.93
SECTION 8.1 I CLOSURE 375

8.11 closure
In this chapter, we discussed primarily the first and second moments of plane
areas as well as the product of plane areas. These formulations give certain
kinds of evaluations of the distribution of area relative to a plane reference xy.
You will most certainly make much use of these quantities in your later
courses in strength of materials.
In this chapter, we have touched on subject matter that you will en-
counter in the next chapter and also, most assuredly, in later courses. Specifi-
cally, in Chapter 9 you will he introduced to the so-called second-order
inertia tensor having nine terms which change (or transform) in a certain par-
ticular way when we rotate coordinate axes at a point. These particular trans-
formation equations define the inertia tensor. Any other set of nine symmetric
terms that transform via the same form of equations, are symmetric second-
order tensors. You will also learn that the second moments and products of
area form a two-dimensional simplification of the inertia tensor. The trans-
formation equations 8.26 through 8.28 are thus special cases of the three-
dimensional defining equations of the inertia tensor. Take note that certain
vital results emerged from these simplified two-dimensional transformation
equations. They included

1. Invariant property at a point for the sum (In + ZJ on rotation of axes.


2. Principal axes and principal moments of area at a point.
3. A graphical construction called Mohr’s circle that depicts the transforma-
tion equations. This topic has been omitted in this chapter hut will be
described in your solids course where yon will study the two-dimensional
simplifications of the stress and strain tensors. At that time one can make
much use of the Mohr’s circle construction and it is a simple matter then
to describe Mohr’s circle for second moments and products of area.

We will emphasize in the next chapter that there are many symmetric sets
of nine terms that transform exactly like the terms of the inertia tensor and
we classify all of them as second-order tensors. Identifying these sets as
second-order tensors immediately yields vital properties common to all of
them such as those presented above for the two-dimensional moments and
products of area.
There will be more to be said on tensors in a “looking ahead” section of
the next chapter which we invite you to examine.
r -
I
8.102. A half body of revnlution is shown with the x: plane as a 8.105. Using the theorems of Pappus and Guldinus, find the cen-
plane of symmetry. Determine the centroidal coordinates. The troid of the area of a qualter-circle.
radius at any section x varies as the square o f x .
J

Figure P.8.11)5.
Figure P.8.102.
8.103. (a) Find Irk, I,,. and 18>fur the .r? axes at position A . 8.106. A tank has a semisphericdl dome at the left end. Using
the theorems af Pappus and Guldinus, compute the surface and
(b) Find the principal recond moment5 of area at point A.
volume of the tank. Give the results i n meters.

Figure P.B.106.

8.107. Find I and I,,,, for the set of axes at point A fur the

X.104. Whet are the directions of the principal axes at point A'?
Figure P.8.103.
t
12m
VX
v'

8m

A
10m-!-ll (11
~i;
S' Figure P.8.1117.

8.108. Find the centroid of the aren, and then find the second
moments of thc area about centroidal axes parallel to the sidcs of
Figure P.8.104, the area.

311
8.112. A wide-flanged I heam i\ s h ~ ~ w Far d " the upper flangr.
what i \ the first imonienl 0 1 t h ~\haded area as a function o h meii-
\tired froiii .v = 0 at the right rrid t o where s apprrlaches the weh'!
Next pet hl, fur the entirc a m i ahove the position shown a\ i n
t h r wch. Let Y go from (.in the lop of thc wch.

Figure IL8.108.
1.109. Find the principal semiid moments of area at a point
= 321 in?.
where I&> = I I X . 4 in?, and 1 , ) = 1.028 i d .

lc-- 1715-
Figure P.8.112.

I,
+ 2 0 I,, ~~
+

Figure P.X.110.
1.111. ( a ) What are the centmidal coordmatrs o f t h e shaded area'!
(b) What ai(: M&,,and M , , for axes x'v' at A'? 1Il;nr: Ucr
ormulas fur the sector o f a circle given on the imide hack cover.I

, - 8,"

Figure P.8.113.

Figure P.8.111.

78
and Products
of Inertia'
9.1 Introduction
In this chapter, we shall consider certain measures of mass distribution rela-
tive to a reference. These quantities are vital for the study of the dynamics of
rigid bodies. Because these quantities are so closely related to second
moments and products of area, we shall consider them at this early stage
rather than wait for dynamics. We shall also discuss the fact that these mea-
sures of mass distribution-the second moments of inertia of mass and the
products of inertia of mass-are components of what we call a second-order
tensor. Recognizing this fact early will make more simple and understandable
your future studies of stress and strain, since these quantities also happen to
be components of second-order tensors.

9.2 Formal Definition of Inertia


Quantities
We shall now formally define a set of quantities that give information about
the distribution 0 1 mass of a body relative to a Cartesian reference. For this
purpose, a body of mass M and a reference xyz are presented in Fig. 9.1. This
reference and the body may have any motion whatever relative to each other.
The ensuing discussion then holds for the instantaneous orientation shown
at time t. We shall consider that the body is composed of a continuum of par-
ticles, each of which has a mass given by p do. We now present the following Figure 9.1. Body and reference at time f.
definitions:

#This chilpter may he covered at a later stage when studying dynamics. In that case, it
should be covered directly after Chapter 15.

379
380 CHAPTER 9 MOMENTS AND PRODUCTS OF INERTIA

(9.1~1)

(9. I b)

(9.1C)

The terms lxr,I+ and in the set above are called the muss momerifs ujiner-
tiu of the hody'ahout the x,y. and 7. axes. respectively.' Note that in e x h such
case we are integrating the mass elements p d7: times the peipmdicular dis-
tance squared from the mass elements tn the coordinate axis about which we
are computing the moment of inertia. Thus, if we look along thex axis toward
the origin in Fig. 9.1, we would have the Yiew shown in Fig. 9.2. The quan-
tity y * + z 2 used in Eq. 9.la for /,ct is clearly d i the perpendicular distance
squared from dti to the x axis (now seen as a dot). Each of the terms with
mixed indices is called the mass product of inertio ahout the pair of axes
given by the indices. Clearly. from the definition of the product of inertia, we
could reverse indices and thcrehy form three additional products of inertia f i r
a reference. The additional three quantities formed in this way. however, are
equal to the corrcsponding quantities of the original set. That is,

Figure 9.2. View of hody along x axis.

We now have nine inertia terms at a point for a given reference at this point.
Thc values of the set of six independent quantities will, for a given body.

"Nc use the same clntilticm as wa? used for second inoinents and product\ 01 a n n , which arc
dsu suinetinies called inornents and pruducts of inertia. 778s i i standard practice in mechanics. Thm
nccd he no cunfusion i n using thew qaaniitic\ i f we keep the cmlext ofdiscucsinnh clearly in mind.
SECTION 9.2 FORMAL DEFINITION OF INERTIA QUANTITIES 38 1

depend on the posifion and inclination of the reference relative to the body.
You should also understand that the reference may be established anywhere
in space and need nor be situated in the rigid body of interest. Thus there will
be nine inertia terms for reference xyz at point 0 outside the body (Fig. 9.3)
computed using Eqs. 9.1, where the domain of integration is the volume V of
the body. As will be explained later, the nine moments and products of iner-
tia are components of the inertia tensor.
z

Figure 9.3. Origin of xyz outside body.

It will he convenient, when referring to the nine moments and products


of inertia for reference xyz at a point, to list them in a matrix array, as follows:

Notice that the first subscript gives the row and the second subscript gives the
column in the array. Furthermore, the left-to-right downward diagonal in the
array is composed of mass moment of inertia terms while the products of
inertia, oriented at mirror-image positions about this diagonal, are equal. For
this reason we say that the array is symmetric.
We shall now show that the sum of the mass moments of inertia for a
set of orthogonal axes is independent of the orientation of the axes and
depends only on the position of the origin. Examine the sum of such a set of
terms:

Combining the integrals and rearranging, we get

I _ + I v y + Iz, = IJ/2(x2 + y * + z Z ) p d u = IS/2lr(’pdu (9.2)


V V

But the magnitude of the position vector from the origin to a particle is inde-
pendent of the inclination of the reference at the origin. Thus, the sum of the
moments of inertia at a point in space for a given body clearly is an invariant
with respect to rotation of axes.
382 C"A1"I'b:K V MOMliNTS ANI) PRODLICTS OF INKRTI.4

Clcal-ly. 011 inspecli(in nf thc equations 0. I. i t i s clear that the iiioniciits


(11 inertia must always be positive, while the products o f inertia may he posi-
tiYe or negativc. 01intercst i s the case where one 01 the coordinate planes i s
ii plww nf.s\mmrrr\ h r the miss distrihution of the body. Such a plene i s thc

,! \ plane shown i n Fig. 9.4 cutting a hody into two parts, which. by definition
I
" of symmctry. are niirror iniagcs o f each other. For the computation of I > : ,
each half w i l l give ii crintrihuti(in ofthe same magnitude hut ol'oppositc sign.
We can most readily hcc that this i s so by loohing along the y axis tiiwai-d thr
origin. The plane of symmetry then appears as a line coinciding with thc z
1% i i x i c (ECC Fig. 9.5). We can cnnsidcr the body to he composed of pairs of inass
, elements diii which are mirror imagcs of each other with respect to pnsition
Figure 9.4. ?: i\ plane 0 1 cymmrlry. and shape ahout the planc of symmetry. The product (if inertia Sor such ii
pair i s then

I: dm ~ Y: dwt = 0

Thus. we can cnncludc that

I<. =
-- I-
J .x;
"FbI
({in -

<I,/ 111.1 I,,


1:
i---i
lkh
(1111

tl<li,,li,,
= 0

This c(inclusion i s a l s o (rue for I \ $ . We can say that I\>,= 1,: = 0. But on
consulting Fig. Y.4. you shmild be ahle to readily decide that the terni I.\ w i l l
h a w a positivc value. Note that those products of inertia having .r as ;in index
are /era and tlial the .v coordinate axis is normal to the plane of symmctry.
Figure 9.5. V i r % along v axic. Thus, we can conclude that if i w , ~ ~ ~ ~ . s .Nf pi li ur w ~ nof,swnmc,rry f i i r ihr ~no.s.s
di,strihu~iono f u l x d y , tlte p,-o'dum o r i n e r l i a hoi'ing (1,s r m index the cooro'i-
note thar i,s normal to the plaw o / . s w m e l r ! . w,ill he ZPIO.
Considcr next it body ofri~r.olutio~~. Take the z axis to coincide with the
axis of symmetry. It i s easy Io conclude for the origin 0 of xy? anywhere
iil(ing the a x i s of symmetry that

I I:
= I ,: = I > > = 0
I x 5 = I\, = co11stallt

for all possihlc .xy axes iormed hy rotating ahout the z axis at 0. Can you jus-
tify these conclusions?
Finally. we define m d i i o f , s y u i i o n i n a manner analognus to that used
for second moments o f iircii i n Chaptei- 8 . Thus:

where k 5 , k v . arid k . i r e lhe radii (11 gyration and M i s thc total Iiiass.
SECTION 9.2 FORMAL DEFINITION OF INERTIA QUANTITIES 383

Example 9.1
Find the nine components of the inertia tensor of a rectangular body of
uniform density p about point 0 for a reference xyz coincident with the
edges of the block as shown in Fig. 9.6.
We first compute I., Using volume elements dii = dx dy dz, we get
i
on using simple multiple integration:

= ( a 9 + a'bc
- )= p PV ( b 2 + a * ) Figure 9.6. Find /,! at 0
3

where V i s the volume of the body. Note that thex axi5 about which we are
computing the moment of inertia I,x IS normal to the plane having sides of
length a and h, Le., along the z and y axes. Similarly:

-(c2 + a 2 )
I _ = -PV
.. 3
I.,,= --(b
PV 2 +e2)
.~ 3

We next compute lxv

Note for f x v , we use the lengths of the sides along the x and y axes

We accordingly have, for the inertia tensor:


384 C",\PTIR U M O M E N I S A N D I'R0r)UCI'S OF INtRTlh

8 Example 9.2
I
Computc the components of thc inerlia icnsor iit the ccnicr or il s111id
sphere 0 1 uniform dcnsity p iis shown in Fig. 9.7.
SECTION 9.2 FORMAL. DEFINITION OF INERTIA QUANnTIES 385

Example 9.2 (Continued)


With the aid of integrdtion formulas from Appendix I, we have

=
Iv,, PI,n I,,
2n
r* cos? $[- 4cos @(sin2e + 2)]/: dqdr

Integrating next with respect to 4, we get

Finally, we get

R' 4 R' 4
I,, = p - - r r + p - - n
5 3 5 3
8
: . I = -prrR'
x' 15

But

M = p'nR3
3

Hence,

I_ = $ MR2
Because of the point symmetry about point 0, we can also say that

I _ = liZI
= $MR2

Because the coordinate planes are all planes of symmetry for the mass dis-
tribution, the products of inertia are zero. Thus, the inertia tensor can be
given as
386 CHAPTER Y MOMENTS AND PRODIJCTS OF INERTIA

9.3 Relation Between Mass-Inertia


Terms and Area-Inertia Terms
We now relate the second inomrnt and product of area studied in Chapter 8
with the inertia tensor. To do this, consider a plate of constant thickncss I and
uniform density p (Fig. 9.9) A rcferencc is selected so that the ~x? plane is in
the midplane of this plate. The components of the inertia tensor are rewritten
for convenience as

Figure 9.9. Platc <fthickness I

Now consider that the thickncss I is sninll comparcd to the lateral dimension\
of the plate. This means that I is restricted to ii range of values having a small
magnitude. As a resull, we can make two simplifications i n the equations
above. First. we shall set i equal to zero whenever it appears on the right side
of the equations abuve. Second. we shall express d i ’ a s

r/z, = I dA
SECTION 9.3 RELATION BETWEEN MASINERTIA TERMS AND AREA-INERTIA TERMS 387

where dA is an area element on the surface of the plate, as shown in Fig. 9.10
Equations 9.3 then become

Figure 9.10. Use volume elements r dA

Notice, now, that the integrals on the right sides of the equations above are
moments and products of area as presented in Chapter 8.Denoting mass-moment
and product of inertia terms with a subscript M and second moment and product
of area terms with a subscript A , we can then say for the nonzem expressions:

Thus, r a ct pt throughout, we can


compute the inertia tensor components for reference xvz (see Fig. 9.9) by
using the second moments and product of area of the surface of the plate rel-
ative to axes xy.
I t is important to point out that pr is the mass per unit area of the plate.
Imagine next that f goes to zero and simultaneously p goes to infinity at fates
such that the product pt becomes unity in the limit. One might think of the
resulting body to be a plane area. By this approach, we have thus formed a
plane area from a plate and in this way we can think of a plane area as a spe-
cial mass. This explains why we use the same notation for mass moments and
products of inertia as we use for second moments and products of area. How-
ever the units clearly will be different.We now examine a plate problem.
388 CHAPTER 9 MOMENTS AN D PRODUCTS O F INERTIA

Example 9.3
Determine the ine
-
tive to the indicated axes xyz. The weight of the plate is ,002 N/mm.I For
the top edge, y = 2 ~ ' xwith x and y in millimeters.
It is clear that for pt we have, remembering that this product repre-
sents mass per unit area:

002
pt = - - 000204 kglmm'
9.81 - '

We now examine the second moments and product of area for the surface
of the plate about axes xy. Thus?
1ilil y=z\*.~ Figure 9.11. Plate of thickness I.
=I, v=" v2 dydx
1"" yi
2.-*
IO0 *
=I, 0
dx =
u
7x3'zdx
.

= 1.067 x IO' mm4

-~
= I,,
Ino
x 2 y l ~ ' ~dx
' =
n
IW
x2(2\x)dx

i
= 5.71 x IO6 mm4
I?

xy d y dx !

= = 6.67 x los mm4

'Note we have multiple integration wherc one of [he boundaries is variable. The proce
dure tofollow should he evident from the cxample.
SECTION 9.3 RELATION BETWEEN MASS-INERTIA TERMS AND AREA-INERTIA TERMS 389

Example 9.3 (Continued)


i
Using Eq. (a), we can then say for the nonzero inertia tensor components:

Y = (.000204)(1.067X IO') = 21.


= (. .71 x 106) = I16
(I& = (. .67 x 10')

Note that the nonzero inertia tensor components for a reference xyz on a
plate (see Fig. 9.9) are proportional through pt to the corresponding area-
inertia terms for the plate surface. This means that all the formulations of
Chapter 8 apply to the aforementioned nonzero inertia tensor components.
Thus, on rotating the axes about the z axis we may u s e the transformation
equations of Chapter 8. Consequently, the concept of principal axes in the
midplane of the plate at a point applies. For such axes, the product of inertia
is zero. One such axis then gives the maximum moment of inertia for all axes
in the midplane at the point, the other the minimum moment of inertia. We
have presented such problems at the end of this section.
What about principal axes for the inertia tensor at a point in a general
three-dimensional body? Those students who have time to study Section 9.7
will leam that there are three principalaxes at a point in the general case. These
axes are mutually orthogonal and the products of inertia are all zero for such a
set of axes at a point? Furthermore, one of the axes will have a maximum
moment of inertia, another axis will have a minimum moment of inertia, while
the third axis will have an intermediate value. The sum of these three inertia
terms must have a value that is common for all sets of axes at the point.
If, perchance, a set of axes xyz at a point is such that xy and xz form two
planes of symmefv for the mass distribution of the body, then, as we learned
earlier, since the z axis and they axis are normal to the planes of symmetry,
Ix," = I,, = I,, = 0. Thus, all products of inertia are zero. This would also be
true for any two sets of axes of xyz forming two planes of symmetry. Clearly,
axes forming two planes of symmetry must be principal axes. This informa-
tion will suffice in most instances when we have to identify principal axes.
On the other hand, consider the case where there is only one plane of symme-
try for the mass distribution of a body at some point A. Let the xy plane at A
form this plane of symmetry. Then, clearly, the products of inertia between
the z axis that is normal to the plane of symmetry xy and any axis in the xy
plane at A must be zero, as pointed out earlier. Obviously, the z axis must be
a principal axis. The other two principal axes must be in the plane of symme-
try, but generally cannot be located by inspection.
5The third principal axis for a plate at a point in the midplane is the z axis normal to the
plate. Note that (/zz)M must always equal + (IJW Why?
9.1. A uniform hum<igcneous 4cnder rod r i f mass M is shown
Compute I , > and

Figure P.9.1.
Figure P.9.5.
9.2. Find I _ and I , , for the thin rod of Prohleni Y. I for the case
wherc the mass per unit length at the left end is 5 Ihm/ft and
increases linearly so that at the right cnd it is 8 Ihmirt. Thc rod i s 9.6. Compute the moment of inertia, I,, for the half-cylinder
2 0 f t in length. 5hown. The hody is homogeneous and has a mass hi.

9.3. Compute I,>for h e thin homogcneous hrxrp of mass M.

B
Figure P.9.6.
Figure P.9.0.

9.4. compute I r < , I.,, I:?, and I , , for the ~lomoyrneous 9.7. Find 1 . ~and l l vlor the homueencous right circular cylinder
lar parallelepiped. of maw M.

r
i

Figure P.Y.7.

Figure P.9.4.
9.8. For the cylindzr in Prohlem Y.7, the density increases lin-
3 . 5 A wire having the shape of a parabola is shown. The curve carly in the 2 direction from a value o f . 100 gramsimm' at the left
s in the yz plane. If the mass of the wire is .3 N/m,~whatare I,,, end to a value of ,180 pramsimm' at the right end. Take I = 30
ind lrz'?[Hinr: Replace dr along ihe wire by l ( d y 1 & ) 2 + I dz. 1 mm and I = IS0 mm. Find and I.. .
9.9. Show that I, for the homogeneous right circular cone is
+ MR~.
Y
I

Figure P.9.9.
Figure P.9.13.
9.10. In Problem 9.9, the density increases as the square of z in
the z direction from a value of ,200 gramslmm’ at the left end to a 9.14. Find the second moment of area about the x axis for the
value of ,400 grams/mm3 at the right end. If r = 20 mm and the front surface of a very thin plate. If the weight of the plate is
cone is 100 mm in length, find lz,. .02 N/mm2, find the mass moments of inertia about the x and y
axes. What is the mass product of inertia I=??
9.11. A body of revolution is shown. The radial distance r of the
boundary from the x axis is given as r = Z.?. m. What is I, for a x
uniform density of 1,600kg/m3?

y
I

x
Figure P.9.14.
*9.15. A uniform tetrahedron is shown having sides of length a,
Figure P.9.11. b, and c, respectively, and a mass M. Show that lyz = &Mac.
(Suggestion: Let z mn from zero to surface ABC. Let x run from
9.12. A thick hemispherical shell is shown with an inside radius zero to line AB. Finally, Let y run from zero to B. Note that the
of 40 mm and an outside radius of 60 mm. If the density p i s 7,000 equation of a plane surface is z = a* + py + 1: where a,p, and y
kglm,’ what is are constants. The mass of the tetrahedron is pabc16. It will he
simplest in expanding ( I - xlb - y/c12 to proceed in the form [(I
- ylc) - (x/b)I2, keeping (1 - ylc) intact. In the last integration
replace y by [ - c(1 ylc) + cl, etc.)
~

Figure P.9.12.
9.13. Find the mass moment of inertia I, for a very thin plate
forming a quarter-sector of a circle. The plate weighs .4N. What
is the second moment of area about the x axis? What is the prod-
uct of inertia? Axes are in the midplane of the plate. Figure P.9.15.

391
9.18. Can you identify hy inspection any o i i h r principii1 iixe\ 01
inertia iit A'! At R' Explain The dcnsitj oithu matcriiil i\ onii<>l-ni. Figure P.9.19.

392
SECTION 9.4 TRANSLATION OF COORDINATE AXES 393

Note that the quantities bearing the subscript c are constant for the integration
and can be extracted from under the integral sign. Thus,

where p dz: has been replaced in some terms by dm, and the integration
JIS p
V
in the first integral has been evaluated as M, the total mass of the body. The
origin of the primed reference being at the center of mass requires of the
first moments of mass that I j j x ’ d m = I I J y ’ d m = / / j z ’ d m = 0. The
middle two terms accordingly drop out of the expression above, and we rec-
ognize the last expression to be Jz,;,. Thus, the desired relation i s

‘. = I,.
I.. .,., + M(x: + y): (9.7)

By observing the body in Fig. 9.12 along the z and z’ axes (Le., from directly
above), we get a view as is shown in Fig 9.13. From this diagram, we can see
that y: + x,Z = d.’ where d is the perpendicular distance between the z‘ axis
through the center of mass and the z axis about which we are taking moments Y’
of inertia. We may then give the result above as

Izz = iMd2

Figure 9.13. View along L direction


Let us generalize from the previous statement. (from above).

The momea of inenia of a body any a i s the


inenia of the body about a parallel a i s that goes tkough the center of
mass, plus the total mass times the perpendicular db
a e s squared.

We leave it to you to show that for products o f inertia a similar relation


can he reached. For I t +for example, we have

Here, we must take care to put in the proper signs of xc and y, as measured
.from the xyz reference. Equations 9.8 and 9.9 comprise the well-known par-
allel-uxir lhc~oremsanalogous to those formed in Chapter 8 for areas. You can
use them lo advantage for bodies composed of simple familiar shapes, as we
now illustrate.
394 CHAPTER 0 MOMENTS AND PROOLJCTS OF INERTIA

Example 9.4
Find I,, and I,, for the body shown in Fig. 9.14. Take pas constant for the
body. Use the formulations for moments and products of inertia at the cen-
ter of mass as given on the inside front cover page.
We shall consider first a solid rectangular prism having the outer
dinlensions given in Fig. 9.14, and we shall then subtract the contribution IS’
of the cylinder and the rectangular block that have been cut away. Thus,
we have, for the ovcriill rectangular block which we consider as body I,

Figure 9.14. Find lu and ilv.


From this, we shall take away the contribution of the cylinder, which we
denote as body 2. Using the formulas from the inside front cover page,
(Ixr)2 = M(3rZ + h z ) + Md’
= &[pn(1)2(1S)][3(l’) + IS2] + [ p ~ ( l ) ~ ( l S j ] [ 6+’ 7.5’1 (b)
= 5,243~

Also, we shall take away the contribution of the rectangular cutout (bod)
3):
3 & M ( u 2 + h 2 ) + Md2
( l x x )=
= &[P(8)(6)(4)](4* + 6 2 ) + [P(8)(6)(4)](2’ + 3’) (c)
= 3,328~

The quantity lrAfor the body with the rectangular and cylindrical cavities
is then
l a x= (231,200 - 5,243 3,328)~ ~

I,, = 2 (d)
We follow the same procedure to obtain lxy.Thus, for the block as a
whole, we have
(IkV),= (I,,,, + Mx,yc
At the center of mass of the block, both the (x’), and ( y ’ ) ] axes are normal
to planes (if symmetry. Accordingly. (I,,),. = 0. Hence,
C~), = 0 + [P(20)(8)(1S)1(-4~(-IO)
= 96,nnop (e)
For the cylinder, we note that both the ( x ‘ ) and
~ (.y’),- axes at the center of
mass are normal to planes of symmetry. Hence, we can say that
= 0 + 1p(~)(I2)(15)1(-8)(~6)
(I,>),
= 2,262~ (f)
SECTION 9.5 TRANSFORMATION PROPERTIES OF THE INERTIA TERMS 395

Example 9.4 (Continued)


Finally, for the small cutout rectangular parallelepiped, we note that the
( x ' ) ~and cy'), axes at the center of mass are perpendicular to planes of
symmetry Hence, we have
(I& = 0 + [~(8)(6)(4)1(-2)(-16)
= 6,144~ (g)
The quantity /Iy for the body with the rectangular and cylindrical cavities
is then

I If p is given in units of lbdft,) the inertia terms have units of Ibm-ft.z

"9.5 Transformation Properties of the


Inertia Terms
Let us assume that the six independent inertia terms are known at the origin of
a given reference. What is the mass moment of inertia for an axis going
through the origin of the reference and having the direction cosines 1, m, and n
relative to the axes of this reference? The axis about which we are interested
in obtaining the mass moment of inertia is designated as kk in Fig. 9.15.

x
Figure 9.15. Find lhh

From previous conclusions, we can say that

(9.10)
396 CHAPTER 9 MOMENTS AND PRODUCTS OF INERTIA

where @ is the angle between kk and r . W e shall now put sin2 @ i n t o a more
uscful form by considering the right triangle Sormed by the position vector r
and the axis kk. This triangle is shown enlarged in Fig. 9.16. The side a of the
triangle has a magnitude that can be given hy the dol pniduct of r and the unit
vector E, along kk. Thus.

0 = r - Ek = (.xi + ~f + zkj (/i + mj + nk) (9. I 1)

Figure 9.16. Right triangle Sormcd by rand kk

Hence
11 = /.r + niy + IIZ

Using the Pythagorean theorem, we can now givc side b as


h? = lr12 - 02 = (.r2 + y2 + .?1
- + m2j2 +
(/Y ii2? + ?hry + 2lrzxz + 2mnyz)
Thc lerm sin2 $may next be givcn iis

Substituting hack into Eq. 9.10. wc get, on canceling kernis.

-(Pr’ + m’j’ +iiZ;’ + 2 / n ~ r ?+ 2/nrz + ~ m n y z j l p d i ,


Since I’ + in2 + ti2 = I , we can multiply the tirst bracketed exprcssion in
thc integral by this sum:
SECTION 9.5 TRANSFORMATION PROPERTIES OF THE INERTIA TERMS 397

Carrying out the multiplication and collecting terms, we get the relation

Refemng back to the definitions presented by Eqs. 9.1, we reach the desired
transformation equation:

We next put this in a more useful form of the kind you will see in later
courses in mechanics. Note first that 1 is the direction cosine between the
k axis and the x axis. It is common practice to identify this cosine as ab
instead of 1. Note that the subscripts identify the axes involved. Similarly, m
= ub and n = akz.We can now express Eq.9.13 in a form similar to a matrix
array as follows on noting that Izy = 6,
etc.

This format is easily written by first writing the matrix m a y of I‘s on the
right side and then inserting the a’s remembering to insert minus signs for
off-diagonal terms.
Let us next compute the product of inertia for a pair of mutually per- k
pendicular axes, Ok and Oq, as shown in Fig. 9.17. The direction cosines of
Ok we shall take as I, m, and n, whereas the direction cosines of Oq we shall
take as ,‘l m’, and n’. Since the axes are at right angles to each other, we know
that
Ek.€
Y
=o
Therefore, Y

II’ + mm’ + nn’ = 0 (9.15) x


Noting that the coordinates of the mass element p dv along the axes Ok and
Oq are r * ek and r * eq,respectively, we have, for Ikq:
4

Using xyz components of r and the unit vectors, we have

= jjj[(i+ yj + ~ k * )(1i + n ~ +‘ A)]


V
398 CHAPTER 9 MOMENTS .
\iWPKODIK'TS OF I N L K I I A

Hcnce.

+xdin' t .x:lii' + y n l ' + yrmn' + wi/' + -\.nni')p (11'

Collecting k i l n s and bringiiig ~ I i ciiirrctii)n cosines outside the inlegratiolis.


wc gel

Noting lhc definitions i n Eil. 9 I . we ciiii statc Ihc desired Lransforinalion:

li,, = ~ iiitlir/~r ~ ,illr/ ~ + (/n1' +


In/')/,,
+ (Id + d ! I ,+ ~ (111li' + Ii?d!/), (9.19)

We can now rewrilc the p r e \ i w s cquarion in ii more u\cIuI mil simple torin
using U ' Y iis direction cosine\. Thus. noting !hat I' = (I,,).ctc.. we proceed as
in Eq. [I. 14 to uhtain
SECTION 9.5 TRANSFORMATION PROPER'IlES OF THE INERTIA TERMS 399

EXaI'rIple 9.5
Find Iz,7, and I,,,, for the solid cylinder shown in Fig. 9.18. The reference
x'y'z' is found by rotating ahout they axis an amount 30", as shown in the
diagram. The mass of the cylinder is 100 kg. z
It is simplest to first get the inertia tensor components for reference
xyz. Thus, using formulas from the inside front cover page we have
2
Ja = -IM r 2 = L(lOO)(!$) = 21.13 kg-mz
2 2

= 85.56 kg-m2
-Ew30"

Noting that the xyz coordinate planes are planes of symmetry, we can con-
clude that
l x z = IY l = I YZ =o x' b l . 3 m ~ +
Next, evaluate the direction cosines of the z' and the x' axes relative Figure 9.18. Find lz.,,and ldz,
to nyz. Thus,
For z' axis:
a:,= = 60" = ,500
COS
a
Z'Y
= cos 90" = 0
ai.? = cos 30" = ,866
For .c' axis:
aXlr = COS 30" = ,866
a*Y = cos90° = 0
= cos 120" = -SO0
a~c,z

First, we employ Eq. 9.14 to get J,,,,.


= (85.56)(.500)z + (21.13)(.866)'

= '37.h

Finally, we employ Eq. 9.20 to get I,;,.


-Ix,,, = (85.56)(.500)(.866) + (21.13)(.866)(-,500)
Therefore,
400 CHAPTER 9 MOMWTS AND PROIlI!('TS OF INEXI'IA
SECTION 9.6 LOOKING AHEAD: TENSORS 401

You will leam that because of the common transformation law identifying
certain quantities as tensors, there will be extremely important common chardc-
teristics for these quantities which set them a p a t from other quantities. Thus, in
order to leam these common characteristics in an efficient way and to understand
them better, we become involved with tensors as an entity in the engineering sci-
ences, physics. and applied mathematics. You will soon he confronted with the
stress and strain tensors in your courses in strength of materials.
To explore this point further, we have shown an infinitesimal rectangu-
lar parallelepiped extracted from a solid under load. On three orthogonal
faces we have shown nine force intensities (Le., forces per unit area). Those
with repeated indices are called normal stwsses while those with different
pairs of indices are called shear stresses. You will leam, that knowing nine
such stresses, you can readily find three stresses, one normal and two onhog-
onal shear stresses, on any interface at any orientation inside the rectangular
parallelepiped. To find such stresses on an interface knowing the stresses
shown in Fig. 9.19, we have the .same fran.~jbnnationeyuutions given by Eqs.
9.21 and 9.22. Thus stress is a second-ordijr tensor.

-.x

/
r1.r

Figure 9.19. Nine stresses o n three orthogonal interfxes at a point.

A two-ilimensionalsimplification of r!, involving the quantities T ~ T,,~., ,


and T~~ (= T,J as the only nonzero stresses is called plune .stress. This occurs
in a thin plate loaded in the plane of symmetry as shown in Fig. 9.20. Plane
stress is the direct analog of second moments and products ofurea, which is
a two-dimensional simplification of the inertia tensor. Clearly, plane stress
and second inoments and products of area have the same transformation
equations, which arc Eqs. 8.26 through 8.28 with 5,. 5,. T~;.replacing
~~

I<,,I+ -IrY, - - I r ,respectively.


,
In solid mechanics, you will also learn that there are nine terms sjj that Figure 9.20. The case of plane stress.
describe deformation at a point. Thus consider the undeformed an infinitesimal
402 CHAPTER Y MOMENTS AND PRODUC'IS OF INERTIA

rectangular parellelepipcd iii Fig. %2l. Whcn there is it dcforniation there are
namml .struiri.s q,, t~.along thr direction 01 the darkened edges which give
the change7 of length per unit original length o i these edpcs. Furthennore, when
there is a dcfi~rmation.therc arc six slwrrr . s ~ , r r b r , s e t $ = E , , , E,: = e, tyz-
I . ~

t:, that give the ch;inge i n angle i n radialis i r m that of the right angles 1)f the
three darkened edges. Knowing these quantities. we can find any othcr strains in
thc rectangular parallelepiped. Thesc other strains ciin be found by using trans-
li)rmation Eqs. 9.2 I atid 9.22 arid so v t n i i r i is illso a .sec~~rzd-orrkr teiisor.
The two-diniensional simplification 0 1 t involving thc quantities, e l , ,
di. arid ( = e \ , ) a s the only iii)iizero strains is calledplaiie slrrriir and rcp-
resents the strains i n a prismatic body constraincd at the ends with loading
Figure Y.21. An iniinilesimal rectangular
parnllclrpiped with three cdgrh highlighted noriixil to the ccntcrhne in which the lodding docs not vary with :(see Fig.
4.22). Also, thc prismatic body must not be suhjcct ti) bending. Plane strain is
an analogous mathematically t o plane stress and sccond moments and prod-
ucts of area. 411 three are two-dimensional simplifications of second-ordcr
sylrlnielric tcnsors and have the .\(1111? t r ~ ~ ~ i . ~ : ~ ~r ry ~u r~i rt ir~a~~n21s
i. ~~well
: r ~ as
other matheniatical properties. Finally. in elcctroniagnetic theory and nuclear
physics. you will be inti-oduced ti) the quadruple tensor.'
In thr ,fi,llowing prohlenis. use rhe lbrmulus ,fin’ momen1.s unci
produluctr of inertia ut rhr mo.s,s cenler 10 be ,found in the inside
front cover pugr.

9.20. What are the moments and products o f inertia for the XJZ
and x’y’i’ axes for the cylinder?

x
Figure P.9.22.

Figure P.Y.20.
9.23. A thin plate weighing 100 N has the following mass
9.21. For the uniform block, compute the inertia tensor at the moments of inertia at mass center 0:
center of mass, at point u, and at point h far axes parallel to the x y i
reference. Take the mass of the body as M kg. I,, = I5 kg-m2
I\?= 13 kg-m*
i
I,,, = -10 kg-m2

What are the moments of inertia lx,r,,I v,?, and I,,i, at point
P having the position vector:

r = .5i + .2j + .hk m

Also determine I,,:, at P.

Y’

X
?
I 1
Figure P.9.21.

9.22. Determine l t r + l v , + 1:: a i a function of x, y, and 7 for


all Doints in mace far the uniform rectangular parallelepiped. Note
that I?: has its origin at the center of mass and is parallel to the
sides. Figure P.Y.23.

40
9.24. A crate with its contents weighs 20 k N and has its center 9.26. A block having a uniform d e n i i y of 5 frmlsicm' ha\ a
of ,,\a'.i Ilt hole of diamctcr 41) ntm cut out. Whilt arc the principal m c m e ~ ~ t s
r, = 1 . 3 + ?j + .Xk in US iiicitia a1 p<lintA ill the ccntroid of thr right lace of the block?

40 m
-e+--

100 ,"", --t

Figure P.Y.26.

/ J 11, 8 9.27. Find niilxiiiiuni and minimum miiniciits 01 inertia at point


A. The hlnck wrighc 20 N and thc ccmr weighs 14 N.
Kigure P.Y.24.
15
9.25 A cylindrical crate and its cmtents wzigh 500 N. 'The cell-
ter V I IIUS i s at
I
rc = .hi + .7j + 2k m

It i\ kiiown that at A
Figure P.Y.27.
(I,,),, = X S hg-ni'
( I , ,),,, = -22 kg-m'
9.28. Solid sphcl-cs C arid I ) each weighing 25 N and having
radius 01 S O inm are attilched to a thin solid rod wcighing X1 N.
Find I s , and I , \ 211 I<. Also. solid sphcrcs E and G each weighing 20 N and having radii
of 30 rmn are attached to a thin rod weighing 20 N. The rods iiic
attachctl to he unhugunal to each other. What air thc principal
nwmeiits of inertia at point A ?

Figure P.9.25. Figure P.Y.28.


9.29. A cylinder is shown having a conical cavity oriented along
the axis A-A and a cylindrical cavity onented normal to A-A. If
the density of the material is 7,200 kg/m3, what is lap?

A- -A

Figure P.9.29.

9.30. A flywheel is made of steel having a specific weight of


490 Ih/ft.3 What is the moment of inertia about its geometric axis?
What is the radius of gyration?

Figure P.9.32.
9.33. A disc A is mounted on a shaft such that its normal is ori-
ented IO' from the centerline of the shaft. The disc has a diameter
of 2 ft, is 1 in. in thickness, and weighs 100 Ib. Compute the
moment of inertia of the disc about the centerline of the Shaft.

Figure P.9.33.
Figure P.9.30.
9.34. A gear B having a mass of 25 kg rotates abuut axis C-C. If
9.31. Compute Ivy and for the right i ular cylinder, I the rod A has a mass distribution of 7.5 kgim, cumpute the
has a mass of 50 kg. and the square rod, which has a mass moment of inertia ofA and B about the axis C-C.
kg, when the two are joined together so that the rod is radial I C
cylinder. The x axis lies along the bottom of the square rod.

t mss-9ection
5 mm X 25mm

I
Figure P.9.31.

9.32. Compute the moments and products of inertia for the *y C


axes. The specific weight is 490 Ib/ft' throughout. Figure P.9.34.

405
Y.35. A hlock wcighing 100 N ih h w r i . Cimipolt. the tmimieiit 9.38. A bent rod weighs . I Nlmm. What i s I,,,, lor
, A inertia ahoiit thc diagimiil 11-I).
c,, = .iOi + .4Sj + .X4lk?

Figure P.9.35.

1.36. A solid qphere A of diameter I ft and weight 1110 Ih i i C O ~ I - Figure P.9.38.


iccted to the shaft B-B hy a \ d i d rod weighing 2 Ihllt and having
I iliamclei~0 1 I in. Computc I.... for the rod and hall. 9.39. Evaluate the n u t r i x of direction cmine?, for the primcd
axcs rclativc to the unprimcd axrs

.L?'
v 20"
/
B
A
-

l.37. In Prohlem 9 13. Figure


'iin platc:
the fdlowiny r r w l t s lor Ihr
P.9.36.
wc found $4YY .~~

I , l = I , , = .IOl')grams-m~ I' j(P


I , , = ,1164') gram<-rn' .1
Figure P.Y.39.
'ind a11 cmponcnts lor I h r incrtia tensor for relerence x'J':'.
LXCS ~s'y'l i e in Ihr midplane ot the plate.
9.40. The hlock i s uniform 111density and weighs ION. Find I,,:,

4
.-
Figure P.9.37. Figure P.Y.40.
*9.41. A thin rod of length 300 mm and weight 12 N is oriented V.42. Show that the transformation equation for the inertia ten-
relative 10 x'v'z' such that SOTcomponents at a point when there is a rotatiun of axes &e.,
Eqs. 9.14 and 9.20) can be given as follows:
c,! = .4i' + .3j' + .X66k'

where k can be x', y', or z' and y can be x'. y', or 7'. and where i
and j go from .r to y to z. The equation above is a compact defini-
tion of s ~ n n d - o r d e rt m m r s . Remember that in the inertia tensor
you must have a minus sign in front of each product of inertia
term (i.e., -Irv, -Iv2, etc.). [Hint: Let i = 5 ; then sum overj; then
let i = y and sum again o w j ; etc.]

/ 1 *9.43. In Problem 9.42, express the transformation equation to


x' get I+:, in terms of the inertia tensor components for reference xyz
Figure P.Y.41. having the same origin as x's'z'.

k
"9.7 The Inertia Ellipsoid and Principal
Moments of Inertia
Equation 9.14 gives the moment of inertia of a body about an axis k in terms
of the direction cosines of that axis measured from an orthogonal reference Y
with an origin 0 on the axis, and in terms of six independent inertia quantities
for this reference. We wish to explore the nature of the variation of Ikk at a
point 0 in space as the direction of k is changed. (The k axis and the body are
shown in Fig. 9.23, which we shall call the physical diagram.) To do this, we Figure 9.23. Physical diagram.
will employ a geometric representation of moment of inertia at a point that is
developed in the following manner. Along the axis k , we lay off as a distance
the quantity OA given by the relation

where d is an abitraly constant that has a dimension of length that will render 6'
OA dimensionless, as the reader can verify. The term d<ilM is the radius
of gyration and was presented earlier. To avoid confusion, this operation is
shown in another diagram, called the inertia diagram (Fig. 9.24), where the
new 5, rl. and <axes are parallel to the x, y , and z axes of the physical dia- f

gram. Considering all possible directions of k, we observe that some surface


will be formed about the point O', and this surface is related to the shape of
the body through Eq. 9.14. We can express the equation of this surfdce quite Figure 9.24. Inertia diagram.

407
N o w replace ttic d i r c c l i o i i cosine\ i n 141. 9.13. using the relations above:
S EC TION ‘3.7 TH E INERTIA ELLIPSOID AN D PRINCIPAL MOMENTS O F INERTIA 409
therefore imagine that the XK reference (and hence the {qcreference) can be
chosen tu have directions that coincide with the aforementioned symmetric
axes, 0‘1, 0 ’ 2 , and 0 ’ 3 . If we call such references x’y’z’ and respec- t’q’c,
tively, we know from analytic geometry that Eq. 9.27 becomes

where <’,q’, and c are coordinates of thc ellipsoidal wrtace relative to the
new reference, and fx,,z., I,.,,, and IZ.?,
are mass moments of inertia of the body
about the new axes. We can now draw several important conclusions from
this geometrical construction and the accompanying equations. One of the
symmetrical axes of the ellipsoid above is the longest distance from the origin
to the surface of the ellipsoid, and another axis is the smallest distance from
the origin to the ellipsoidal surface. Examining the definition in Eq. 9.24, we
must conclude that the minimum moment of inertia for the point 0 must cor-
respond to the axis having the maximum length, and the maximum moment
of inertia must correspond to the axis having the minimum length. The third
axis has an intermediate value that makes the sum of the moment of inertia
terms equal to the sum of the moment of inertia terms for all orthogonal axes
at point 0,in accordance with Eq. 9.2. In addition, Eq. 9.28 leads us to con-
clude that Ix,?, = fV,:, = /,., = 0 . That is, the products of inertia of the mass
about these axes must be zero. Clearly, these axes are the principal uxrs of
inertia at the point 0.
Sincc the preceding operations could be carried o u t at any point in spdce
for the body, we cm conclude that:

AI each point there is a set of principal axes having the extreme values of
moments of inertia for that point a n d having zero products of inertia.’ The
orientation of these axes will vary continuously j%m point to poinr
throughout space for the given body.

All symmetric second-order tensor quantities have the properties dis-


cussed above for the inertia tensor. By transforming from the original refer-
cnce to the principal reference, we change the inertia tensor representation
from

In mathemalical parlance, we have “diagonalized” the tensor by the preced-


ing operations.

of inertia is set forth in Appendix !I.


“A gcncriil prucedure fur coinpuling principal ~~loments
dl 0 CHAPTER 9 MOMENTS ANLJ PKODtICTS OF INFRTIA

9.8 closure
I n this chapter. we first introduccd the ninc cnnipiincnts comprising the incr-
lia tensnr. Ncxt. we ciiniidered thc ciise o f llic very thin flat plale i n which llie
.qaxes form the 1nidp1;iiie of the plale. We Ioond that the m a s s n i m i e n t s and
prodocts of inertia terms (I,),,, and Ibi- tlie plate are pmpnr-
tional, rcspcctively. t o ( I , < ) , . ( I > , I,.,. and (/,,I,,. tlie iecond nioinents and prod-
uct [ifarea 111 the plate surface. As a result. we could set forth the concept of
principal axes for the incrtiii tensor a s an extcnsion of thc work i n Chapter X.
Thus, wc pointed nut that for thesc axes tlic prnducts o f inertia w i l l he zerii.
Furtherinnre. one principal a s k corresponds lo the iiiaximuni moment 01
inertia at the point while another of the pi-incipal axes corrcspoiids to the inin-
imum moment of incrtia at the point. We pointed out that for hodies with two
nrthogm;il planes of symmetry. llie principal axes al any point o n the line (if
intcrsectioii of the planes of symmetry inust hc alnng this line nf inter~ectiiiii
and nnrinal lo this liiic in the p1;ines of symmetry.
Those readers who studied the starred sections from Section 9.5 onward
w i l l have Ioond proofs 111 the extensinns set lorth earlier ahiiut principal axes
frnm Chaptcr 8. E w n niore imporlant i s the disclnsure that the incrtia tensor
components change their \'slues when the axes are rotated at a point i n
exactly the same way a s inany cithcr physical qiiaiititirs having ninc cornpo-
nents. Such quantities ;ire called second-order teninrs. Because OS the c ~ r -
ninn transformation equation for such quantities, thcy h;we many imporlant
identical properties. such a s principal axcs. In your cnurse i n strength O S
inalerials you shnold learn that stress and strain arc second-order tensors iind
hence h a w principal axes.'" Additionally. y < u w i l l find that a two-dimen-
s i n i i a l stress distributim called I h n e sIres.s i s d a t e d to the stress tensor
csactly a s thc moments and products iif area are related to the incilia tensnr.
The sanie situation exists with strain. Consequcntly. there are similar innthe-
inaticiil formulatiiins for plane stress and the corrcsponding
(plane itrain). Thus. hy tahing the extra time to coiisider llie mathcniatical
considerations n l Sections 0 3 thi-ough 9.7. yciu w i l l find unity hetween Chnp-
ler 9 and some vcry important aspects of strength 01. materials to he studied
later i n your program.
I n Chapter I O , we shall introducr another apprnxh tn studying eqiiilih-
riiini heyoiid what we liavc used thus far. This ;ipprn;ich i s valuahlc lor cer-
tain importanl classes 01 sltdtics priihlenir and ;it the same time fni-ins the
grnundworh for ii nuinher of advanced lechnique? that many students will
study later i n theii- programs.
9.44. Find for the body of revolution having uniform density 9.47. In Problem 9.46, what are the principal axes and the prin-
of .2 kg/mm?. The radial distance Out from the Iaxis to the sur- cipal moments of inertia for the inertia tensor at O!
face is given as

where z is in millimeters. [Hint:Make use of the formula for the 9.48. What are the principal mass moments of inertia at point O?
moment of inertia about the axis of a disc, M?.] Block A weighs 15 N. Rod B weighs 6 N and solid sphere C
weighs I O N. The density in each body is uniform. The diameter
of the sphere is 50 mm.
7

Figure P.9.48.
Figure P.9.44.

9.45. In Problem 9.44, determine 1,: without using the disc for-
mula but using multiple integration instead. 9.49. The block has a density of 15 k&.? Find the moment 01
inertia about anis AB.

9.46. What are the inertia tensor components for the thin plate
about axes xyz? The plate weighs 2 N.

E
E
100 mm
50 mm 5
-X
/O
I
/
Figure P.9.46. Figure P.9.49.

41
9.50. A crate and its contents weigh.: IO kN. The center o f mass 9.52. Find ivr The diameler of A is 0.3 m. R is thc centel
and ivr.
0 1 thc crate and its contents is at of the right Cam of the block. Take p = p,, kglm.’
r, = .40i + .3Oj + .6Ok m

If at A we knuw that

lv,, = 800 kg-m’


1,. = 500 kg-m?

find /?, and 1,: at 8.

Figure P.9.52.

9.53. A body is composed of two adjoining hlocks. Both blocks


4
have a uniform mass density p equal tn I O kg/m.’

la) Find the mass moments of inertia, I < %and lzz


x (b) Find the product of inertia iL3.
Figure Y.9.50. IC) Is thc product of inertia 1,: = 0 (yes or no)’? Why’!
1.51. A semicylinder weighs SO N. What are the principal
noments of inertia at o? What is the prnduct of inertia I,,,::? What
onclusirm can you draw about the direction of principal axes at O ?

-’ I

,/x’ /+300mm -I.- 206 m;n


f
Figure P.9.51. Figure P.9.53.

12
"Methods of Virtual Work
and Stationary
Potential Energy
10.1 Introduction
In the study of statics thus far, we have followed the procedure of isolating a
body to expose certain unknown forces and then formulating either scalar or
vector equations of equilibrium that include all the forces acting on the body.
At this time, alternative methods of expressing conditions of equilibrium,
called the method of virtual work and, derived from it, the method of sfation-
ary pofential energy, will be presented. These methods will yield equilibrium
equations equivalent to those of preceding sections. Furthermore, these new
equations include only certain forces on a body, and accordingly in some
problems will provide a more simple means of solving for desired unknowns.
Actually, we are making a very modest beginning into a vast field of
endeavor called variational mechanics or energy methods with important
applications to both rigid-body and deformable-body solid mechanics.
Indeed, more advanced studies in these fields will surely center around these /?
methods. I
A central concept for energy methods is the work of a force. A differ-
entia1 amount of work d d k due to a force F acting on a particle equals the
component of this force in the direction of movement of the particle times the
differential displacement of the particle:
dWk = F - d r (10.1)
And the work Wi
on a panicle by force F when the particle moves along Figure 10.1. Path ofparticle on
some path (see Fig. 10.1) from point 1 to point 2 is then which F does work.

'i"lIk = 1;, F * dr ( I 0.2)

'For a treatment of energy methods for deformable solids. see 1. H. Shames and C. Dym.
Energy and Finite E l m e m Method?in Structural Mechanim Taylor and Francis Publishers. 1955.

4
Note that the value and direction o f F can vary along tlie path. This fact iiiusl
he taken into account during the intcgratiiin. We shall have inure to say ahoul
the concept of work i n liitcr sections.’

Part A: Method of Virtual Work


10.2 Principle of Virtual Work
for a Particle
For our intrixluction to the principle of virtual work, we will first consider a par-
ticle actcd on hy cxternal loads K,.K,,..., K,,, whose rcsiiltant f i x e pushcs the
particlc ;igainsi ii rigid constraining surface S in space (Fig. ((1.2).This sur(ace S
is assuincd Iu he frictionless and will thus exert a constraining forceNon the par-
, Lick which i s iioriniil to .F. The forccs K, arc called r,ctiwfi,n~e5 in cciniicctioii
1’

with the method 01‘ virtual wnrk. while N retiiiiih llie identilication 01 a rnnvrruin-
Figure 10.2. Paltick (VI ii hictionles\ surface
irrfi .fiirw a\ iised prcviiiusly. Employing the resultiint actiw forcc K,. we ciin
give the neceswy and sufticicnt’ conditions lor cquilihriuin ioi- tlie particle :is
K, + A’ = 0 (10.3)
We shall iiiiw prove that we caii expre\\ [he iiccescary and sufficient
ciinditions 01 equilibrium i n yet another way. Let us iiniiginc that we givc the
particle an infinilesimiil tiypothctical arhitrary displaceincnt that i s consistent
n i t h the coiihtraints (i.c., along the surlace). while keeping the forces K, and
and w i l l he
“Vonstant. Such a displacement i s termed ii i.irtunl ‘i;,~,,l‘,~,~,n,~,,~t,
denoted by &, i n conlmst to a rciil infiniicsiinal displaceincnt. dr, which
might iictudly iiccur during a lime intcrviil ilr. We can Illen take the dot priid-
uct oi the vector Sr with the Ibrce wxtors i n thc equation above:
K, * Sr + N * Sr = 0 (10.4)
Sincc N is normal 10 thc surface and Sr is tangential to the surface. the corie-
spunding scalar product must he 7.ero. leaving
K, * Sr = 0 (I0.5)
The uxpres\ion K,<.Sr i s called (tic virniol i n d 01 the \y\tcrn (if tbrces and i s
denoted as 8Tt’v,,~,.Thu\. thc \:iriuiil wnrk by the active forces oil a plirticlc
SECTION 10.3 PRINCIPLE OF VIRTUAL WORK FOR RIGID BODIES 415

with frictionless constraints is necessarily zero for a particle in equilibrium


for any virtual displacement consistent with the frictionless constraints.
We shall now show that this statement is also sufficient to ensure equi-
librium for the case of a particle initially at rest (relative to an inertial refer-
ence) at the time of application of the active loads. To demonstrate this,
assume that Eq. 10.5 holds but that the particle is nor in equilibrium, If the
particle is not in equilibrium, it must move in a direction that corresponds to
the direction of the resultant of all forces acting on the particle. Consider that
d r represents the initial displacement during the time interval dt. The work
done by the forces must exceed zero for this movement. Since the normal
force N cannot do work for this displacement,
K,.dr>O (10.6)

However, we can choose a virtual displacement 6r to be used in Eq. 10.5 that


i s exactly equal to the proposed dr stated above, and so we see that, by admit-
ting nonequilibrium, we amve at a result (10.6) that is in contradiction to the
starting known condition (Eq. 10.5). We can then conclude that the conjec-
ture that the particle is not in equilibrium is false. Thus, Eq. 10.3 is not only a
necessary condition of equilibrium, but, for an initially stationary particle, is
in itself sufficient for equilibrium. Thus, Eq. 10.5 is completely equivalent to
the equation of equilibrium, 10.3.
We can now state the principle of virtual work for a panicle.

The case of a particle that is not constrained is a special case of the situation
discussed above. Here N = 0, so that Eq. 10.5 is applicable for all infinitesi-
mal displacements as a criterion for equilibrium.

10.3 Principle of Virtual Work for


Rigid Bodies
We now examine a rigid body in equilibrium acted on by active forces K , and
constrained without the aid of friction (Fig. 10.3). The constraining forces Ni ~i~~~ 10.3, ~ i ~body, d forces
arise from direct contact with other immovable bodies (in which case the con- and ideal constraining forces.

4This test breaks down for il panirk thar is moving. Consider a panicle constrained 10
move in a circular path in a horirontal plane, as shown in the diagram. The particle is moving
with constant speed. '%her no active furces. and we consider the constraints as frictionless.
The work for a virtual dis rnent cumistent with the constraints at any time I gives us a m o
result. Nevenheless, the p i s not tn equilibrium, since clearly there is at time I an accelera~
tion toward the center of curvature. Thus. we had to restrict the sufficiency condition lo panicles
that are initially stationilry.
straining forces iirr oricnted inormil to Ihc c o n t ~ i csur1iucl
l 01- irom conkict wilh
iniinovahlc bodies thniugh pin and ball-joint ciinnections. We shall considel-
the body to he made up o f elementar) particles for the purposes o i discusion
Now consider ii particle of inass m,. Actibc loads. cxterniil coiislraining
iorccs. ;ind forces iron1 other piiiticlcs i i u y possibly he acling on the pal-tick
The forces from uther particles :ire internal forces S,which maintain h c rigid-
ity ofthc body. Using tlic rcsultiinls ot'lhcsc !<ari(ius forces on thc particle. wc
m i y slate iron1 Nen'tiin's liiw that ttic neceswy arid sufficient5 condition 1111-
equilihi-ium of the ith parriclc i s
I K , ) , 4. I N , ) , + ( S i < ) ,= 0 (lO.7)

Nov.,. u'e give the pal-tick ii virtual displ;iccnient fir, that i s consistent
with the exlcrior coiislriiitit~and with (he condition that thc body i s rigid.
Taking lie dot priiiluct 01 the vectors in the cquatiiin ahovc wilh 6ri. we gcl

(K,);Sr, t (N,);Sr; +(SI,), -6r, = I ) 1IO.Xl

Cleai-ly,(IV,), * 6r, tiiust he zero. lheciiiise Sr, i s normal ior N j ior constraint
stemming from direct contact with itnniovahlc bodies or hecausc Sr, = 0 for
conslraint stcmniing from pin and Ixill-j~iiiitcoiiiieciioiis with irnmovirtilc
bodies. l.et us then sun1 the resulting cquarions of rhc iol-m 10.8 for all tlic
particles that are considel-cd to mahc up the body. Wc Ixive. for 8 1 panicla.

1x1 us now consider i n niorr detail the internal forces i n order to sho\v
that the second qunnlity on the left-h;ind side of the eqoalioli aho\e i s LCIO.
The force on m, from pxticle iii, w i l l be equal ;ind iippositc IO ~ h cforce (in
liarticle i i i from parliclc iii,.according to Ncwton's third liiw. The interniil
I
iorces on Lhesc particles :Ire sliiium as S and S,,i n Fig. 111.4. The first s u b
script identifies the particle on which ii force acts. while the second subscript
idcntifies the particle exerting this fiircr. Wc ciiii tlirii say that
s = -s ( I O . IO)

Any virtual motion wc give t u :my pair of particles m u s t niiiiiitnin a colistiuit


dihliince between the particle\. Thih r e q i i i ~ ~ n i c sitetiis
nl ironi Ihc rigid-hody
condition and will he truc if:

I. Both parliclcc are given the siiiiie di\placcment SH.


2. The particles ill-e rulatcd 6@relative to eiicli other.''
We liow consider the general ciise where both motions Lire prcscnt: that i\.
hoth I N , untl I W , arc given ii \irliial displaceincnt SH,a n d lurthel-nirirc, HI, i s

' 7 h c d l i c i e n q I~C~IIICIIICIII iagiiiii ; ~ t > p li~o \an irr~i~atty


hla~ionaryp~ritclc.
"Thc viirlual ~ t i ~ ~ d ~ (Sr, ~ c,)Ic e;wh ~ ~ P:IIIICIC\r m i Ihcn
~ n 01c ~ill?~ iwt) ~ hu Ihc ICIUIL ,,i 11,c
< u l x r p w i i , m 01 6R iimt bo?.
SECTION 10.3 PRINCIPLE OF VIRTUAL WORK FOR RIGID BODIES 417

rotated through some angle 64 about inj (Fig. 10.4). The work done during
the rotation must he zero, since Sj, is at right angles to the motion of the mass
m.. Also, the work done on each particle during the equal displacement of
I
both masses must he equal in value and opposite in sign since the forces
move through equal displacements and are themselves equal and opposite.
The mutual effect of all particles of the body is of the type described. Thus,
we can conclude that the internal work done for a rigid body during a virtual
displacement is zero. Hence, a nrcessais condition for- equilibrium is
;,nd SI, =

Y-
-s,,

$8

Figure 10.4. Two panicles of a body


undergoing displacement 8R and rotation S+.
2 (K,),
,=I
* 6r, = 6~,~;,,= o (10.11)

Thus, the virtuol w r k done by nctiveforcrs on a rigii body having friction-


less constraints daring virtual iii.spluccments consistent with rhr consfrainfs
is zero ifthe body is in equilibrium.
We can readily prove that Eq. 10.I I is a silfficienr condition for equi-
librium of an initially stationary body by reasoning i n the same manner that
we did in the case of the single particle. We shall state,first that E4. 10.11
is validfor a body. If the body is not in equilibrium, it must begin to move.
Let us say that each particle ini moves a distance dr, consistent with the con-
straints under the action of the forces. The work done on particle mi is
-
(K,II dr, + i N J j * rfri+ (S,); - drj z 0 (10.12)
But (A',), * drj is necessarily zero because of the nature of the constraints.
When we sum the terms in the equation above for all particles, c(SH)j dr, -
must also be zero because of the condition of rigidity of the body as previ-
ously explained. Theresore, we may state that the supposition of no cquilib-
rium leads to the following inequality:

i ( K , ) ; 'dr, > 0 (10.13)


,=I

But we can conceive a virtual displacement 6r, equal to dr,for each particle to
he used in E q . IO. I I , thus bringing us to a contradiction between this equation
and Eq. 10.13. Since we have taken Eq. 10.11 to apply, we conclude that the
supposition of nonequilihrium which led to Eq. 10.13 must be invalid, and so
the body must he in equilibrium. This logic proves the sufficiency condition
for the principle ol virtual work in the case of a rigid body with ideal con-
straints that is initially stationary at the time of application of the active forces.
Consider now severiil movable rigid hodies that are interconnected
by smooth pins and hall joints or that are in direct frictionless contact with each
other (Fig. 10.5). Some of these bodies are also ideally constrained by irnmow
able rigid bodies in the manner described above. Again, we may examine the
system of particles mi making up the various rigid bodies. The only new kind of
force to he considered is a force at the connecting point between bodies. The
force on one such particle on body A will he equal and opposite to the force on
the corresponding particle in body B at the contact point; and so on. Since such
418 CHAPTER 10 METHOIIS OF VIRTUAL WOKK AND STATIONARY POI'ENTIAI. ENERG\

Figure 10.5. System 0 1 ideally co~islrilinetlrigid hodie\ acted on hy forces K ,

pairs ut' contiguous particles have the same virtual displacement, clearly the vir-
tual work al all connecting points hetween hodies i s zero for any virtual dis-
placement [if the system cnnsisteiit with the cwistrainls. Hence, using thc same
rmsoning ils heforc. we can xiy,(hr- (1 !em o / iniliall? s m r i o n r i n : rigid bodies.
r i ~ .rriffi&nf i.onrliriorr offtquilihiiuin is thor the virtrrul work o/
the n r ~ ~ r . s s(2nd
tlw uctivr f i i r w s be :era f i w t i l l po,vsihle i,irtud displuwmntrs (.onsi.slrirr M , i r h
rlir con.s!ri~int,s.We may then use the fiillowirig equation instead [if equilihriuin:

(K,), Sr, . = 6'71 '\,T, = 1) (II). 14)

where ( K N ) ;arc the iicti\,c forces [in the system of rigid bodies and Sr, are the
movements of the point of application n1 these forces during a virtual dis-
placement of the system consistent with the constraints.

10.4 Degrees of Freedom


and the Solution of Problems
We have developed equations sufficient lor equilihriuni 01 initially stationary
systems i i l hiidies by using the concept of \'irtual work for \'irtual displace-
ments consistent with the constraints. These equations do lint involve rclac-
tions or connecting hrces. arid when these forces are lint of interest, the
method i s quite useful. Thus, we may snlve for as inany unknown a<.tiw
forces as there arc indqwmkwr cquations stemming from \,irtuaI displace-
nients. Thcn our prime interest is to know hnw many independent equations
can he written lor a system stemming from virtual displacements.
For this purpose. we definc iIw ruitiihcr ofilq,ur.s ,!/rrr(4,,in o / o
d '! i.s required 10 full!
tein l i s tlw itumh(~ro / g~~nenrli:rdc o ~ ~ r d i t t i i r ~n ~k .i ~
.sprcIfi rhr, wnfijiurotion r$tlre .sy.rtmt. Thus. tni- the pcnduluin i n Fig. 10.6.
which i s restricted to i n w e in ii plane. one iriilqienrlenr cnrirdinatc 0 locates
I the pendulum. Hence, this system has hut w e degree of lreedom. We m a y
Figure 10.6. Plene pciiduluin. ask: Can't we specify i and y nfthe hob. and thus aren't there two degrces or
' G m c m l r i ~ dcoonlirratrm are a y \et of indqi"mi<,rii v r i r i d h ~ihal can i u l y q i z c i i y the
coniigsralicr " f a aysiein. Gcnrrnlizcd cmrdioatc* cm iriclutk a n y 01 lhc usual c o o r d i n u x such
:is C a r l w i x C O i ) l t l i n ~ t e b or cylindricvl coordin;~le~. huI iiecd no^. We shall only cunuder l h o w
CIISEL wlierc lhc iiiiiiil coi,rdmalec SZPC its ~ h r ~ e n c i m i r s dc o o r ~ l i ~ i i i i c s .
SECTION 104 DECR!z.ES OF FREEDOM AND THE SOLUTION 01. PROBLEMS 419

freedom? The answer is no, because when we specify x or y, the other coor-
dinate is determined since the pendulum support, being inextensihle, must
sweep out a known circle as shown in the diagram. In Fig. 10.7, the piston
and crank arrangement, the four-bar linkage,8 and the balance require only
one coordinate and thus have hut one degree of freedom. On the other hand,
the double pendulum has two degrees of freedom and a particle in space has
three degrees of freedom. The number of degrees of freedom may usually be
readily determined by inspection.
Since each degree of freedom represents an independent coordinate. we
can, for an n-degree-of-freedom system, institute n unique virtual displace-
ments by varying each coordinate separately. This procedure will then given
independent equations of equilibrium from which n unknowns related to the
active forces can he determined. We shall examine several prohlcms to illus-
trate the method of virtual work and its advantages.
Before considering the examples, we wish to point out that a torque M
undergoing a virtual displacement 6@in radians does an amount of virtual
work 6wk equal to
6<M/,= M 64- (10.15)

The proof of this is asked for in Problem 10.30

L Pislun and
crank
arrangement
Four-har
linkage

MULTI DECREE-OF-FREEDOM SYSTEMS


Balance

Figure 10.7. Various systems illustrating degrees of freedom.


*The fourth har ih the hare.
420 CHAPTER 10 METHODS OF VIRTUAL WORK AND STATIONARY POTENTIAL FNEKGY

Example 10.1
A device for compressing metal scrap (a compaclor) is shown in Fig. 10.8.
A horizontal force P is exerted on joint R . The piston at C then comprcsses
the scrap material. For a given force P and a given angle 8, what is the h r c e
F developed on the scrap by the piston C?Neglect the friction hetween the
piston and the cylinder wall, and consider the pin joints to he ideal.
We see by inspection that one coordinate 8 describes the configura-
tion of the system. The device therefore has one degree of freedom. We
shall neglect the weight of the members, and so only two active forces are
present, P and F. By assuming a virtual displaccment 60, we will involve
in the principle of virtual work only those quantities that arc of interest to
us, P. F, and 8.' Let u s then compute the virtual work of the activc forces.

Force P. The virtual displacement 68 is such that force P has a motion in


the horizontal direction of ( 1 68 cos 8) as can readily he deduced from Fig.
10.9 by elementary trigonometric considerations. There is yct another way
of deducing this horizontal motion, which, sometimes, is more desirable.
Using an x)i coordinate system at A as shown in Figs. 10.8 and 10.9, wc
can say Cor the position of joint B:
)in = 1sin0 (a)

I
,
!

Figure 10.8. Cantpilcting devicc.


"It we had used a free~hodyapproach.wc would h a w had to bring in force component\
at A and at C , and we would have had lo dirmemher thc iysten,. To appreciate the mclhod nf
v i m a l work even for this simple prohlcm. we urge you t o nt least set up the prohlcm hy the Figure 10.Y. Virtual m(ivement ni
use ot free-body diagrams. leg AB.
SECTION 111.4 DEGREE OF FREEDOM AND THE SOLUTION OF PROBLEMS 42 1

Example 10.1 (Continued)


Now take the differential of both sides of the equation to get
dya = 1 cos 0 d8 (b)
A differential of a quantity A , namely dA, is very similar to a variation of
the quantity, 6A.The former might actually take place in a process; the lat-
ter takes place in the mind of the engineer. Nevertheless, the relation
between differential quantities should be the same as the relation between
varied quantities. Accordingly, from Eq. (b), we can say:
Sy, = 1 cos 8 68 (C)
Note that the same horizontal movement of B for Seis thus computed as at
the outset using trigonometry.
For the variation GOchosen, the force P acts in the opposite direction
of Sy,, and so the virtual work done by force P i s negative. Thus, we have
G('7dvin)p = -PI COS 8 60 (d)

Force F. We can use the differential approach to get the virtual displace.
ment of piston C. That is,
xc = 1 c o s 8 + i c o s e = 2 1 ~ 0 s ~
dx, = -21 sin 0 d 0

Therefore,
SX, = -21 sin 8 60 (e)

Since the force F is in the same direction as SX,, we should have a positive
result for the work done by force F. Accordingly, we have
6(wvifi)F = F(21 sin 0 )68 (f)

We may now employ the principle of virtual work, which is sufficient here
for ensuring equilibrium. Thus, we can say that
-PI cos 0 60 + F(21 sin 8 )60 = 0 (g)

Canceling 1 60 and solving for F, we get

For any given values of P and 8, we now know the amount of compressive
force that the compactor can develop.
422 CMhPTER I l l MLIIHODS OF VIRTUAL W O R K ANI) STATIONARY POTENTIAL ENERGY

r Example 10.2
I
A hydraulic-lift plallurin for loading trucks is shown i n Fig. 10. IO(n). Only
one side ofthc system is shown: Ihc other side is identical. If thc diameter of
the piston in the hydraulic rani is 3 in., what pressurcp is nceded to support
ii load W OS S.000 Ib when 8 = 60"? The lollowing additional data apply:

I = 24 in.
(1 = 60 in.
<' = 10 in.

Pin A is at Lhc center OS the rod.


W c have hcre n system with om d e p e of fi-redum characterized hy
the angle 8. The iictive forces that do work during a virtual displacement
60 are the weight W a n d thc l i m e from the hydraulic rani. Accordingly.
the virtual rnovenicnts of both the platform E and ,joint A of the hydraulic
ram mu?t he found. Using referencr ~x,:
xp, = ? I sin 8
Therefore.
a?,: = 2 l c o s 0 SB (ill

For thc ram forcc, we want tlic nioverncnt of pin A i n the direction ofthe
axis 01 the pump. namely SI] where is shown i n Fig. IO. IO(a). Ohserving
Fig. 10. IO(h) we cm say Sor r):
~ A("+ CH?
= ( I sin 8 - PI' + ((1 - I c o u 8 1 ~ !h)

Hence. we ha\e
2 q 67 = 2iIsin 8 - eI(lcos6')SO + 2id - /cos@)(/sin0 ) S 8 (c)
Solving for 6q. we get

67 = I(/sin 8 - c ) cos 8 + ( d - I coc 0) sin 8168


'I
= -I( I s i n H c o s B . - t . c t ) s B + d s i n B - I s i n B c o s 8 ) S 0 (d)
r)
I
= -(dsin8-ecos8)68
17
The principle CISvirtual woi-k is now applied to ensure equilihriurn.
Thus, considering one side of the system and using half the Inad, we have
SECTION 10.4 DEGREES OF FREEDOM AND THE SOLUTION OF PROBLEMS 423

i
Example 10.2 (Continued)
Hence,

-(2,500)(21~0~~6O)+p(41r)
160= 0 (e)

Figure 10.10, Pneumatic loading platform


The value of q at the configuration of interest may be determined from Eq.
(b). Thus,
qZ = [(24)(.866) - 1012 + [60 - (24)(.5)]*
Therefore,
q = 49.2 in.

Now canceling 60 and substituting known data into Eq. (e), we may then
determine p for equilibrium:
-(2,500)(2)(24)(.5) + p(4~){$[(60)(.866) - (lO)(.S)]} =0

Therefore.
In a few of the homework prohlcnih. y o n I i i i w t(i iiw siniplc kinein:rrics
(1ia cylinder rnlling without slipping (see Fig. 10. I I j . Y o u will r c c d li~liii
physics thai ihc cylinder i s iiciually rntitliiig ahout ilic piiitil o1 c ~ i i t i i c r-I. I i
Ihc cylinder rotate\ an angle SH then N' = -,'
68. We sli:ill con>idcr h i m -
niatics of rigid hoclics i n detail li11cr i n IIK ICXI.

/
Figure 10.12. Virtual displacemcnt WCIOIK
SECTION 10.s LOOKING AHEAD: DEFORMABLE SOLIDS 425

We may also introduce the concept of the varied,function such that


given a function G(.x,y. 7) we may form
G = G(x +& y + 6,
z+6i,) (IO. 17)

where SX, s\, and 6z are components of Sr"'. We now define the variation of
G , denoted as SG, as
6G=G-G (IO. 18)

In a deformable body we can give the movement of each point in the


body when deformation occurs by using the displacement ,field u(x, y, z).
Specifically, when coordinates of a specific point in the underformed geome-
try are suhstitutcd into the particular vector function u(x,y. 7) depicting a spe-
cific deformation, we get the displacement of that point resulting from this
deformation.
We now extend the concept of a virtual displacement of a point to that
of a virtual displacement field, which is a single-valued, continuous vector
field representing a h.!qxitherirml dpfimmble body movement consistent n,ith
the constraints pre.wnt. We shall restrict ourselves here to virtual displace-
ment fields, which result only in infinitesimal deformation." We have shown
the gross exaggeration of a virtual displacement field in Fig. 10.13. wherein
you will notice that tlie constraints have not been u,iolated. It should now be
clear that we: can conveniently set fonh a virtual displacement field by
employing the so-called variational operator 6. Thus Su may be considered as
a virtual displacement field from a given configuration to a vaned configura-
tion; the constrainls present being taken into account by imposing proper con-
ditions on the variation.
The virtual work concept can now he extended to the case of a
deformable body. We compute the work of the external forces during a vir-
tual displacement of the body with the proviso that these external forces he
maintained constant. With a total body force distribution B(x,y,z ) and a total
traction force distribution T(x,?,z), we can then give the virtual work,
denoted as 6M1,,,, as follows:

S Wv,r, = 111B * 6u d~ + #T 6u dA (10.19) Figure 10.13. Virtudl displacement field


cotisistent with constraints.
V c

For rigid bodies, the virtual ~ ' o r khad to he zero for equilibrium. For
d&irmuhlr bodies tliis is no longer lrue. Instead, for equilibrium the external
virtual work SW,,, given above must he equal to infernal virtual work, which

"The changes in thc coordinates x, y, and: are nut linked tu lime through thr basic laws of
physics a$ would be the case i f we wcrc considering G 10 represent some physical quantity in
*omc real proccss.
1 8 0 n enerd not s o rrslrict onehell. That is. we ~ i l nwork wiih virtwd displacement fields for
/inire deformation and fonnulatc a principle o f v i i l u a l work. Thia would lilkc us beyond the scopc
oithis hook. however.
426 CHAPTER IO METHODS OF VIRTUAI. WORK AND STATIONARY POTENTIAL. ENERGY

must he zero for rigid bodies but which is nut necessrily zero for deformable
solids. In your solid mechanics course you will learn that the internal work for
a deformable body is given by T,,)d€,,d i : wherc the indices i and.j
I .I

range over 1,y, and i forming terms i n the integrand such as rtL6ttt, rAV6t,%.
etc., (nine expressions). The satisfaction of the resulting formulation is a ncc-
essary and sufficient condition for equilibrium and can he used in place of the
familiar equations of equilibrium." Why would one want to do this'! Actu-
ally, as we pointed in the Looking Ahead section in the chapter on structural
mechanics, we can readily solvc certain types of problems using virtual work.
and the theorems derived from virtual work, whereas the approach for these
problems using the equilibrium equations i s extremely cumbersome. One
important case is the solution of indeterminate truss problems. You will come
to these problems later in your studies of structures and in your studies ol
machine design.
Virtual work and two other theorems derivable from it are ciilled
enerEy di,vp/acemenf merhod.? because of the use of the virtual displace-
ment." There is an equally useful set of three formulations analogous to the
three energy displacement methods and they are called rrwrgvforcv methods.
wherein we hypothetically vary the forces instead of hypothetically varying
the deformation.
Before moving [in, the author would like to share a philosiiphical thought
with you. In science we often physically disturb cettain surroundings in the lab-
oratory and carefully observe resulting behavior to learn to understand natural
phenomena. We perhaps unwittingly mimic this approach here in the study of
mechanics. That is. we have instituted mathematical "disturbances" and eval-
uated the results in order to Understand certain vital analytically userul conse-
quences. Thus, we instituted the mathematical "disturbance" of the virtual
displacement field to amve at extremely useful conclusions which form thc
basis of a considerable amount of structural mechanics. Also, we pointed out
that we can institute varied force fields as our mathematicdl disturhanccs.
Again, vital and useful conclusions follow.

"The second energy displacemcm method i s called the rncrhod of iorulporrniial cnryqy. It
wab this principal that was prcsenlcd in the "Looking A h e a d Section 6.2 fur determining the pin
deflections uf simple t ~ u s c s The
. \pccial ca<e 01 this principle lur c o 1 1 s c ~ v ~ 1iorcc
1 ~ c fields iict~
ing on pwiicle.s and rifiiil hodics IS divrlopcd in Pan R o l this chapter. 'The third energy dis
placement mclhotl deiivahle lrum the secontl i s the h n i Cbsngbono I%eorrm.
For a Ihoruugh dewlopinen1 0 1 rhesc six principles with many applications and which i s
w i t h h reach of atudrnts who have ahsorhcd thc key C O I ~ I Cof
~ ~the stdies portion u l this lex<. see
Shames, I.H., Inrmducrion V J Soiid Mechanic.>.seconded., Prentice-Hall. Inc.. Cnglrwootl Clitti.
N.J., Chapters 1 X and 19. A good grasp of ibex six principles is vital l i i iiiuic advanced work in
solid and structuiill mcchimics. not 111 speak of machine design.
10.1, How many degrees of freedom do the following systems 10.3. What is the longest portion of pipe weighing 4M)Ib/ft that
possess'! What coordinates can be used to locate the system? can be lifted without tipping the 12,000-lb tractor?
(a) A rigid body not constrained in space.

T
(b) A rigid body constrained to move along a plane sutiace.
(c) The board AB in the diagram (a).
(d) The spherical bodies shown in diagram (b) may slide
along shaft C-C, which in turn rotates about axis E-E. Shaft C-C
may also slide along E-E. The spindle E-E is on a rotating plat-
form. Give the number of degrees of freedom and coordinates for
a sphere, shaft C-C, and spindle E-E.
A B
i-
Figure P.10.3.
10.4. If W, = 100 N and W, = 150 N, find the angle 0 for
equilibrium.

E
* I Figure P.10.4.
I + 10.5. The triple pulley sheave and the double pulley sheave
C weigh 150 N and 100 N, respectively. What rope force is neces-
sary to lift a 3,500-N engine'?

B
(b)
Figure P.10.1.

10.2. A parking-lot gate arm weighs 150 N. Because of the


taper, the weight can be regarded as concentrated at a point 1.25
m from the pivot point. What is the solenoid force to lift the gate?
What is the solenoid force if a 300-N counterweight is placed .25
m to left of the pivot point?
r__--

I . I 5 m'

Figure P.10.2. Figure P.10.5.

42;
10.6. What weight W call hc lifted with Ihc A-frame hoist in the 10.9. Whal is the tencion in the cahles ofa IO-ft-wide 12-ft-l<mg
position shiiwn i f thc cable tension is 7'' h000-1h drawhridge whrn the hndge is first raised? When thc
hridge is at 35"''

3m
-,

Figure P.I0.6.

10.7. A small hoist has a lifting capacity of 20 kN. What is thc


innximuin possihle cahlc tension load'! Figure P.10.9.
10.10. Assuming frictionless cmtacts, determine the magnitude
if Plor cquilihrium.

.h 111

Figure P.I0.10.
Figure P.10.7.
10.11. A ruck cruhher i'. \how" i n aclivn. If,>, = 50 psiig and p,
= 100 psig. what is the forcr on the rock at the configuraiion
\hewn! Thc dinmeter uf the pihlons is 4 in.

10.8. I f W = 1.000 N and P = 300 N, find the anglc H For


equilibrium.

W
Figure P.10.8. Figure P.lO.ll.
10.12. A 20-lb-ft torque is applied to a scissor jack. If friction is 10.15. A hydraulically actuated gate in a 2-m-square water-car-
disregarded throughout, what weight can be maintained in equilib- rying tunnel under a dam is held in place with a vertical beam AC.
rium? Take the pitch of the screw threads to be .3 in. in opposite What is the force in the hydraulic ram if the specific weight of
senses. All links are of equal length, I ft. water is 9818 N/m3?

Figure P.10.15.

10.16. Find the angle p for equilibrium in terms of the parameters


Figure P.10.12. given in the diagram. Neglect friction and the weight of the beam.
10.13. The 5,000-lb van of an airline food catering truck rises
straight up until its floor is level with the airplane floor. What is
the ram force in that position'?

Figure P.10.16.

10.17. Do Problem 5.54 by the method of virtual work


Figure P.10.13.
10.18. Do Problem 5.55 by the method of virtual work.
10.14. What are the cable tensions when the arms of the power
shovel are in the position shown? Arm AC weighs I3 kN, arm DF
weights 1 1 kN, and the shovel plus the payload weigh 9 kN. 10.19. What is the relation among P, Q, and 0 for equilibrium'?

A
1p

,/ I '
C.G.
' H
2.12m
Figure P.10.14. Figure P.10.19.

425
--+-
k i c k hcrc

Figure P.lO.23

Figure P.IO.ZI.

Fizure P.10.25
10.26. If A weighs SO0 N, and if B weighs 100 N, determine the
weight of C for equilibrium.

10.29. Rod ABC is connected through a pin and slot to a sleeve


which slides on a vertical rod. Before the weight W of 100 N is
. K of the
applied at C, the rod is inclined at an angle of 4 5 ~ If
Figure P.10.26. spring i s 8,000 N/m, what is the angle 0 for equilibrium? The
length of AB is 300 mm and the length of BC is 200 mm when
0 = 45'. Neglect friction and all weights other than W. (Note:
The force from the spring is K times its contraction.)

10.27. An embossing device imprint,s an image at D on metal


stock. If a force F of 200 N is exerted by the operator, what is the
force at D on the stuck? The lengths of AB and BC are each 150 mm.

10.30. Show that the virtual work of a couple moment M for a


rotation &$ is given as
sw = M . 6 6
Figure P.10.27. [Hint DeL-umpoSK M into components normal to and collinear
with &$.I
Sd, M

10.28. A support system holds a 500-N load. Without the load,


0 = 45* and the spring is not compressed. If K for the spring is
10,000 N/m, how far down d will the 500-N load depress the
upper platform if the load is applied slowly and carefully'? Neglect
all other weights. DB = BE = AB :CB = 400 mm. (Note;
The force from the spring is K times its contraction.) Figure P.10.30.

43 1
432 CHAPTER I O METHODS OF VIRTUAL WORK A N D SThTIONAIIY P0TI:NIIAI. E N I t K i Y

Part B: Method of Total Potential Energy


10.6 Conservative Systems
We shall restrict oiirscI\~csin this v c t i o n to cL'rtiiin types ol active tirrces. Thih
restriction will pcrmit LIS to arrivi: at s o m e additional very uscful relations.
Conzider first i i hody x t c d on only hy gswity lorce W a s an active
W Ibrcc iiiid moving iiloiig a fi-icrionlcss p i t h lrom position I to posilioii 2. iih
Y, - shown in Fig. 10.14. The work ~ l o n chy grabity. '71.', ~,i s then

$F.ilr =o (10.23i

How i s the piilcnlial enel-g) l'uiiction V rclnted to F?'10 iimwci- this


query. consider tliat iui w h i t r q iiiljnittlsinial path segment rlr tliirts from
point I . We can then f i v e Eg. 10.12 iis
1.' * ilr = -(I\) (10.?41
SECTION 10.6 CONSERVATIVE SYSTEMS 433

F =- - av (10.26)
I &

Or, in other words,

=-[ja a . a
; i +. z ~ + z k
!
(10.27)
-grad V = -VV
=
The operator we have introduced is called the gradient operator and is given
as follows for rectangular coordinates:
grad =V=-ta . + a J. + -ak (10.28)
A & &
~

We can now say, as an alternative definition, that a conservative force


field must be ( I function of position and expressible as the gradient of a scalar
,field function. The inverse to this statement is also valid. That is, ifa force
,field is a function of position and the gradient of a scalarfield, it must then be
a ~f~il,rservatiw~lrcrfield. Such are the following two force fields.
Constant Force Field. If the force field is constant at all positions, it can
always he expressed as the gradient of a scalar function of the form V = -(M
+ by + C Z ) . where a, b, and c are constants. The constant force field, then, is
F = ai + bj + ck.
In limited changes of position near the Earth's surface (a common situation),
we can consider the gravitational force on a particle of mass, m, as a constant force
field given by .-mgk. Thus, the cunstants for the general force field given above are
a = b = 0 and c = -mg. Clearly, V s P.E. = mgz for this case.
Force Proportional to Linear Displacements. Consider a body limited by
constraints to move along a straight line. Along this line a force is developed
directly proportional to the displacement of the body from some point on the
line. If this line is the x axis, we give this force as
F = -Kxi (10.29)
where x is the displacement from the point. The constant K is a positive num-
ber, so that, with the minus sign in this equation, a positive displacement x
from the origin means that the force is negative and is then directed hack to the
origin. A displacement in the negative direction from the origin (negative x)
means that the force is positive and is directed again toward the origin. Thus,
the force given above is a restoring force about the origin. An example of this
force is that sesulting from the extension of a linear spring (Fig. 10.15). The
force that the spring exerts will be directly proportional to the amount of elon-
gation or compression in the x direction beyond the unextended configuration.
This movement is measured from the origin of the x axis. The constant K i n
this situation is called the spring constant. The change in potential energy due
to the displacements from the origin to some position x, therefore, is
434 CHAPTER IO METHOIX 01: VIRTUAL WORK AND STATIONARY POTENTIAL ENERGY

since -V ~ = -K.ri
(K;2)

Thc chungr in potential energy has been defined as the nr,yufive of (he
wurk done by a conservative force as we go from one position to another.
Clearly, the potential energy change i s then directly eyuul to the work done by
the t-~actiorrIO the conservalive force during this displaccment. I n thr case of
the spring, the reaction force would he the furce,fr(im the surroundings acting
on thc spring at point A (Fig. 10.15). During extension or compression o f the
spring from the undefotmed position, this force (from the surroundings) clearly
inus1 do a positive amuunt o f work. This work must, as noted above, equal the

~ / ~ / ~ / ~
H
1 ~~~~
potential energy change. We now note that we ciin consider t h i s work (or in
other words the change in potential energy) to be a rneasurc of the energy
,
K / ~ / ~ / ~ / ~ / ~ / ~ srored
/ ~ / ~in/the
~ /spring.
~ / ~That / ~when allowed to return to its original position, [he
/ ~ is,
spring will do t h i s aniuunt o f positive work on the surruundings at A , provided
that the relum motiun i s slow enough tu prevent oscillations, etc.
Figure 10.15. Linear spring
10.7 Condition of Equilibrium
for a Conservative System
L e t 11s now consider a system of rigid bodies that i s ideally constrained and acted
on by conservative active fixes. For a virtual displacement from a configuration
of equilibrium, the virtual work done by the active forces, which are maintained
constant during the virtual displacement, must bc zero. We shall now show thac
the condition of equilibrium can be stated in ye1 another way for this system.
Specifically, suppose that we have 11 conservative lbrces acting on the
system of bodies. The incremenl of work for a real infinitesimal movement of
the system can be given iis follows:

where V without subscripts refers to tofu1 potential energy. B y treating 6r


I'
likc dr,, in the equations abovc, we can express the virtual work 8711vrr,
as
SECT10N 10.7 CONDITION OF EQLLIBRRIM FOR A CONSERVATIVE SYSTEM 435

But we know that for equilibrium = 0, and so we can similarly say


for equilibrium: a i
a"= 0 (10.31)
,,
Mathematically, this means that the potential energy has a stationary or an
extremum value at a configuration of equilibrium, or, putting it another way,
the variation (fV is zero at a configuration of equilibrium.15 Thus, we have
another criterion which we may use to solve problems ofequilibrium for con-
servative force systems with ideal constraints.
For solving problems, determine the potential energy using a set of inde-
pendent coordinates. Then, take the variation, 6, of the potential energy. For
example, suppose that V is a function of independent variables 4,. q2'...,q,,
thereby having n degrees of freedom. The variation of Vthen becomes
av
6 V = -&q, av
+ -6q, av
+ ... + -6q, (10.32)
aY1 ay, ay,
For equilibrium, we set this variation equal to zero according to Eq. 10.31.
For the right side of the equation above to be zero, the coefficient of each 6qc
must be zero, since the &. are independent of each other. Thus,

We now have n independent equations, which we can now solve for n 1 IPJ (bJ (CJ
unknowns. This method of approach is illustrated in the following examples.
Figure 10.16. Stationary or extremum
15Tofunher understand this, consider Vas a iuncrion of only one variable,x. A s r a f i ~ w ~ y points'
value (or, as we may say, an extremum) might be B local minimum (ain Fig. 10.16). a local m a -
imum ( b in the figure), or an inflection point (c in the figure). Note far these points that for a dii-
ferential movement. hr. there is zero first-order change in V ( i . L 6v = 0).
436 CHAPTER I O METHODS OF VIRTUAL WORK AND STATIONARY POTENTIAL ENERGY

Example 10.3
A block weighing W Ib is placed slowly on a spring having a spring con-
stant of K IMft (see Fig. 10.17). Calculate how much the spring is com-
pressed at the equilibrium configuration.

Figure 10.17. M a w placed on B


linear spring.

This is a simple problem and could be solved by using the definition of


the spring constant, but we shall take advantage of the simplicity to illustrate
the preceding comments. Note that only conservative forces act on the block,
namely the weight and the spring force. Using the unextended top position of
the spring as the datum for gravitational potential energy and measuring x
from this position we have, tor the potential energy uf the system:

V = -Wx + ;Kx2
Consequently, for equilibrium, we have since there is only one degree of
freedom

LV = - w + Kx
dx
=0

Solving for x, we have


SECTION 10.7 CONDITION OF EQUILIBRIUM FOR A CONSERVATIVE SYSTEM 431

Example 10.4
A mechanism shown in Fig. 10.18 consists of two weights W, four pinned
linkage rods of length a, and a spring K connecting the linkage rods and
which rides along a stationary vertical rod. The spring is unextended when 0
= 45". If friction and the weights of the linkage rods are negligible, what are
the equilibrium configurations for the system of linkage rods and weights?
Only conservative forces can perform work on the system, and so we
may use the stationary potential-energy criterion for equilibrium. We shall
compute the potential energy as a function of 0 (clearly, there is but one
degree of freedom) using the configuration 8 = 45' as the source of datum
levels for the various energies. Observing Fig. 10.19, we can say that
V = -2Wd + f K(2d)' (4
As for the distance d, we can say (see Fig. 10.19) Figure 10.18. A mechanism.
d=a~os45~-acos0 (b)
Hence, we have, for Eq. (a),
V = -2Wa(cos45" - cos0) + f K4a2(cos45" - c 0 s 0 ) ~
For equilibrium, we require that
__
dV 0 = -2Wasin0 + 4KaZ(cos4So- cosO)(sin0) (C)
d0
We can then say

[
sin0 -W-2Ka
(
cos0--
Ail =O i
-
t
We have here two possibilities for satisfying the equation. First, sin 0 = 0
is a solution. so we may say that 0 - 0 (this may not be mechanically pos-
. .'
T
sible) is a configuration of equdlbnum. Clearly, another solution can be
reached by setting the bracketed lerms equal to zero:
Figure 10.19. Movement of mechanism as
determined by 0.
(
-W - 2Ka cos0 - - = 0
h1
Therefore,

The solutions for 0 then are

We have here two possible equilibrium configurations.


10.31. A SO-kg block is placed carefully on a spring. Thc spfing 10.33. Find the equilibrium configurations for the syslern. The
is nonlinear. The force ta deflect the spring a distance 2 rnm is bars are indentical and each hac n weight W , a length of 3 m, and
proportional to the squarz of x. Also, we know that 5 N deflects a mass o f 2 5 kg. The Fpring is unstrerched when the bars arc hori-
the spring I mm. By the method of stationary potential energy. mntal and has a Tpnng const:mt of 1.500 Nlm.
what will he the comprcssion of the spring? Check the result using
a simple calculation hased on the hehavior of the spring.

Figure P.10.33.

1
< Nonlinear spring
<
<
4
7
10.34. The springs of the mechanism are unstretched when 6 =
e,,.Show that 0 = 1 S . Y W when the weight W is added. Take W =
S O 0 N, o = .3 m, K , = I Nlmm. K2 = 2 Nlmrn, and e,, = 45~.
c

Figure P.10.31. Ncglect the weight of the memherc.

10.32. der of radius 2 ft has wrappr iround it il light.


"extensible cord which is tied to a iocj-ib block n on a 70'
nclined surface. The cylinder A is connected to a ror.cionrrl rpring.
rhis spring requires a torque of IS100 ft-lblrad of rntntion and it is
inear and, of c o m e , restoring. If B is connected to A when the tor-
;ional spring is unatrained. and if R is allowed to move h w l y
h w n the incline, what distanced do you allow il to move to reach
m equilibrium configuration? Use the method of stationan.
I , .noten-
ial energy and then check the result by more elementary reasmine.

Figure P.10.34.

10.35. At what elevatiim h must body A he for equilibrium'!


Neglect friction. [ H i n t What is the differential relation hetwren 6
Inextensible cord and 1 defining the positions VI thc blocks alrrng the surface? Inte-
grate to get the relation ihelf.1

\ ,100 Ih

Figure P.10.32. Figure P.10.35.


10.36. Show that the position of equilibrium is 8 = 77.3- for 10.39. Work Problem 10.28 using the method of total potential
the 20-kg rod AB. Neglect friction. energy.

10.40. Work Problem 10.29 using the method of total potential


energy.

Figure P.10.36.
10.41. Do Problem 10.25 by the method of total potential
energy. [Hint: Consider a length of cord on a circular surface. Use
the top p m of the surface as a datum.]

10.37. A beam BC of length 15 ft and weight 500 Ib is placed


against a spring (which has a spring constant of 10 Ihlin.) and 10.42. If member AB is 10 ft long and member BC is 13 ft long,
smooth walls and allowed to come to rest. If the end of the spring show that the angle R corresponding to equilibrium is 3 4 . 5 ~if the
is 5 ft away from the vertical wall when it is not compressed, spring constant K is 10 Iblin. Neglect the weight of the members
show by energy methods that the amount that the spring will be and friction everywhere. Take R = 3 0 ~for the configuration
compressed is ,889 ft. where the spring is unstretched.

IS'
K=10 Iblinch

Figure P.10.42.
Figure P.10.37.

10.43. A combination of spring and torsion-bar suspension is


shown. The spring has a spring constant of 150 Nlmm. The tor-
sion bar is shown on end at A and has a torsional resistance to
10.38. Light rods AB and BC support a 500-N load. End A of rod
rotation of rod AB of 5,000 N - d i a d . If the vertical load is zero,
AB is pinned, whereas end C is on a roller. A spring having a
the vertical spring is of length 450 mm. and rod AB is horizontal.
spring constant of 1,000 Nlm is connected to A and C . The spring
What is the angle a when the suspension supports a weight of 5
is unstretched when R = 4 5 ~ Show
. that the force in the spring is
kN? Rod AB is 400 mm in length.
1,066 N when the 500-N load is being supported.
End view of
R
torsion bar

Figure P.10.38. Figure P.10.43.

439
10.44. Light rods AB and CB are pinned together at B and pasr 10.47. In Problcm 111.46. the hand i\ l i n t strctched and then tied
through frictionless hearings IJ and E. These bearings arc con- while strstched lu supports A and H w that there i s an initial tell-
nected to the ground by ball-and-socket connections and are free sion in the hand 0 1 I N. What i':then the deflection (, caused hy
to rotate about these joints. Sprinzs, each having a s p k f constant the Ill-N load'?
K = 800 N/m, restrain the rods as shown. The springs are
unstretched when 8 = 4 5 ~ Show. that the deflection of B i s 440
m when a 500-N load i s attached slowly to pin 8.The rod.. are
each I m in length. and each unstretched spring i s ,250 m in
length. Neglect the weight of the rods. Rods are weldcd to small
plates at A and C
10.48. A ruhher hand of length .7 m i i stretched t o connect t o
points A and 13. A tcnsim force , > I 30 N i s thereby de~~elopeilin
the hand. A 211-N \r,eight i s then attached t o the hand at C. Find
thc distance (I that point C iiioves downward if the 20-N weight i\
cnnstraincd t o move vertically downward along a frictionless rod.
[Hbir: I i y o u considcr pan rfthc hand, the "cprinp conwnt" for i t
will he greater than that nf the whole hmd.]

Figure P.10.44.

10.45. Do Problem 10.2h by the method of tntal potential


mergy. [Hint; Use E as a datum and get lengths EJ. K P , and PN
in terms of length H E , including unknown constants.] Figure P.10.48.

10.46. An elastic band is originally 1 m long. Applying a ten-


sion force of 30 N, the hand will stretch .8 ni in length. What
10.49. 'The spring connecling hodies A and H has a spring cnn-
jeflection a does a 10-N load induce on the band when the load i s
t m t K oi. 3 Nlmm. The unstrctched length o f the spring i\ 450
%ppliedslowly at the center of the baud? Consider the l o r e vs.
m m . IIhody A weighs 60 N and hody B weighs 90 N, what is the
dongation of the band to be linear like a spring. [Hint: If you con-
metched length of the spring for cquilihrium'! [Hinr: I/ w i l l hc il
sider half of the band, you double the "spring constant."l
Fhction of two varinhles.1
1-m1
- i

Figure P.10.46. Figure P.10.4Y


SECTION 10.8 STABILITY 441

10.8 Stability
Consider a cylinder resting on various surfaces (Fig. 10.20). If we neglect
friction, the only active force is that of gravity. Thus, we have here conserva-
tive systems for which Eq. 10.31 is valid. The only virtual displacement for
which contact with the surfaces is maintained is along the path. In each case,
dyidx is zero. Thus, for an infinitesimal virtual displacement, the first-order
change in elevation is zero. Hence, the change in potential energy is zero for
the first-order considerations. The bodies, therefore, are in equilibrium,
according to the previous section. However, distinct physical differences
exist between the states of equilibrium of the four cases.
Case A. The equilibrium here is said to he stable in that an actual displace-
ment from this configuration is such that the forces tend to return the body to
its equilibrium configuration. Notice that the potential energy is at a minimum
for this condition.
Case B. The equilibrium here is said to he unstable in that an actual dis-
placement from the configuration is such that the forces aid in increasing the
departure from the equilibrium configuration. The potential energy is at a
maximum for this condition.
Case C. The equilibrium here is said to be neutral. Any displacement
means that another equilibrium configuration is established. The potential
energy is B constant for all possible positions of the body.
Case D. This equilibrium state is considered unstable since any displace-
ment to the left of the equilibrium configuration will result in an increasing
departure from this position.
How can we tell whether a system is stable or unstable at its equilibrium
configuration other than by physical inspection, as was done above? Consider
again a simple situation where the potential energy is a function of only one
space coordinatex. That is, V = Vix). We can expand the potential energy in
the form of a Maclaurin series about the position of equilibrium." Thus,

( I 0.34)

x x

Figure 10.20. Different equilibrium configurations.

IhNote that in a Maclaurin series the coefficients of the independent variable x a ~ evalualed
e
at x = 0,which for us is the equilibrium position. We denote this position with the subscript eq.
442 CHAPTER I O METHODS OF VIRTUAL W O RK AND STATIONARY POTENTIAL ENERGY

We know from Eq. 10.33 applied to one variable that at the equilibrium con-
figuration ( d V / d ~ )=~ 0. Hence, we can restate the equation above:

For small enough x. say xo. the sign of AV will be determined by the
sign of the first term in the series, (l/2!)(d2V/dr2Je4
x2," For this reason this
term is called the dominant term in the series. Hence, the sign of (d2V/dxZ)eq
is vital in determining the sign of AV for small enough x. If (d2V/dx2),q IS
positive, then AV is positive for any value of x smaller than .q,. This means
that Vis a local minimum at the equilibrium configuration as can be deduced
from Fig. 10.2021, and we have stable equilibrium.'8 If (d2V/dx2)eqis nega-
tive, then V is a local maximum at the equilibrium configuration and from
Fig. 10.20 we have tinsfable equilibrium. Finally, if (d2V/dx2)eqis zero, we
must investigate the next higher-order derivative in the expansion, and s o
forth.
For cases where the potential energy is known in terms of several vari-
ables, the determination of the kind of equilibrium for the system is corre-
spondingly more complex. For example, if the function V is known in terms
of x and v. we have from the calculus of several variables the following.
For minimum potential energy and therefore for stability:
av dv (10.36a)

(lO.36b)

(10.36~)

For maximum potential energy and therefore for instahility:

(10.37a)

The criteria become increasingly more complex for three or more indepen-
dent variables.
"As x gets smaller than unity, xz will become increasingly larger than 2' and powcrs of I
higher than 3. Hence. depending on the values uf derivatires of Vat equilibrium, them will h e a
value of *--say x,,-For which the first tern in the series will he larger than the sum of a l l <,lhci
terms for ValUeE of r < I,,.
"That is. if the body is displaced a distance x < x,? the hody will return to equilibrium on
TdCVSC.
SECTION 10.9 LOOKING AHEAD: MORE ON TOTAL POTENTIAL ENERGY 443

Example 10.5
A thick plate whose bottom edge is that of a circular arc of radius R is
shown in Fig. 10.21. The center of gravity of the plate is a distance h above
the ground when the plate is in the vertical position as shown in the dia-
gram. What relation must be satisfied by h and R for stable equilibrium?
The plate has one degree of freedom under the action of gravity and
we can use the angle O(Fig. 10.22) as the independent coordinate. We can
express the potential energy V of the system relative to the ground as a
function of 8 in the following manner (see Fig. 10.23):
V = W[R - ( R - h ) COS s] (a)
where W is the weight of the plate. Clearly, 8 = 0 is a position of equilib-
rium since

Now consider d2Vld8’ at = 0. We have

($$) e o = W(R-h)

Clearly, when R > h, (dZVld8Z), = is positive, and so this is the desired


requirement for stable equilibrium. Thus for stable equilibrium, R > h.

R-(R-h) COS 0
Figure 10.21. Plate with circular Figure 10.22. One degree of Figure 10.23. Position of C.G,
bottom edge. freedom.

10.9 Looking Ahead: More on Total


Potential Energy
When we have conservative forces acting on pruticles and rigid bodies, we
found earlier that for establishing necessary and sufficient conditions of equi-
librium we could extremize the potential energy Vassociated with the forces.
That is, we could set
6V = 0
to satisfy equilibrium. Recall that this result was derived from the method of
virtual work. We have a similar formulation for the case of an elastic (not neces-
sarily linearly elastic) body wbeEby we can guarantee equilibrium. This more-
444 CHAPTER I O METHODS OF VIRTUAL WORK AND STATIONARY POTEiYTI,\L liNFR(;Y

general principle is derivable from the more-gencral virtual work principle


mentioned earlier i n section lO.5. Hcre. we 11iu\t extrenii7.e an exprcssinn inore
complicated (as you might expect) than V . This expi-ession is denotcd as nwith
no relation to the number 3.1416.. . . The expression n is what we CJII a.fim.-
tiond, whercin for the substitution of each functim such as v(~r),into the func-
tional a nunihcr is established. A simple example of ii functional I is as follows:

where F is a function o f r (the so-called independent \iiriahIe), y, and clyldr.


Subtilutinn of. a function y(.C into F fiillnwed hy iiii integration hetween the
fixed limils. yields for this funclion y(.i) :I number h r 1. Fonctionals per\,adr
the field of mechanicc and most other analytic Ciclds o l knowledge. A vital
) w i l l cxtremix I . This function then
step is to find the function ~ ( n that
becomes knnwn aq the urrrrriral/un,.fion.'The ciiIcuIus Ir,r doing this is called
the w l d u s 0 1 variations. Thc particular functional for the method of tntill
potential cncrgy is h'riven as
n = -111B * u 0'1. - 8 7 u d.4 + L'
Ii .\

The function to he adjusted to cxtremize ii is u(.x,J, z) taking the placc of ~ ( ~ 1 )


in the preceding functional. and iinw the independcnt \,;iriablcs are .x. y. and 2
in place of just .r in thc preceding functional. The expression 11 is the energy
of defnrmation that you will study l a t a in your solids ciii~rseand presented
cai-lier in Section 10.5 a- 111
1'
Ti,&,,
t
</I,. The principle of total potential
I
energy for the case of elastic hodies is written i n the following deceivingly
simple looking lormulation:
6n = 0
What is most intriguing about this imoccnt looking equation is that it is oftcn
considercd to he thc most powerful equation in solid mechanics!
We have touched on a h r i d area of sludy. namely vari;itinnal methods.
park of which you will encounter in many o f y 0 u r htudies. For cxamplc. j u t
the method (it' total potential energy has thc following ma,jnr uses:
1. It plays a n important role i n opfiinixiti,Jii iIimii:i,.
2. It can he used profitably to dcrive the p r q w r q u a t i o m and thc houndor?
cnnditiuiis for many areas of vital importance such a h plate theory, elastic
stability theory, dynamics of plates and beams. torsion theory, etc,
3. From it we can develop a numher of vital approximation methods. The
most prominent of these methods is the methiid of.finirrd r m m t s .
Clearly this iy an impressive
'vYou can aiudy 111 wme drlail rhr c o n t e i i l i 01 rhc lwi I.imking Ahead scc~ionsof l h i \
chaps, i n I . R . Shamea. lnlrwluclio,~10 .Solid M<dwnU.r. 2nd ed.. 1%9. Prcnlice~Hnll.Inc..
Englewood Cliffs. N.J. Thih i i i a t ~ r i i iihoukl
l he wiihiii thc wach of hrig,hi *ccimd-semester sopho~
imorcs and cerlninly of juniors. Thc author ha\ raught (hi\ maiciiiil hi iriany year, 1 0 seconil-
sentester sophomores OUI of the aiwemesrioned hook. See Chiqxcia 18 iind 1'1.
10.50, A rod AB is connected to the ground by a frictionless Y
ball-and-sockrt connection at A . The rod is free to rest on the I
inside edge of a horizontal plate as shown in the diagram. The
square abcd has its center directly over A. The curve eJg is a semi-
circle. Without resorting to mathematical calculations, identify
positions on this inside edge where equilibrium is possible fur the
rod AB. Describe the nature of the equilibrium and supply sup-
porting arguments. Assume the edge of plate is frictionless.
Figure P.10.54.
10.55. A system of springs and rigid bodies AB and BC is acted
on by a weight W through a pin connection at A. If K is 50 N/mm,
what is the range of the value of W so that the system has an
unstable equilibrium configuration when the rods AB and BC are
collinear'? Neglect the weight of the rods.

P,"
Figure P.10.50. connecuon
10.51. In Problem 10.50, show mathematically that position h is
a position of unstable equilibrium for the rod.
10.52. Rod AB is supported hy a frictionless ball-and-socket
joint at A and leans against the inside edge of a horizontal plate.
What is the nature of the equilibrium position a for the rod?
Assume that the edge of the plate is frictionless.
i

Figure P.10.55.
10.56. A weight W is welded to a light rod AB. At B there is a
torsional spring for which it takes 500 ft-lh to rotate 1 rad. The
torsional spring is linear and restoring and is, for rotation, the ana-
log of the ordinary linear spring for extension or coneaction. If
the torsional spring is unstrained when the rod is vertical, what is
the largest value of W for which we have stable equilibrium in the
vertical direction?

Figure P.10.52.
10.53. Consider that the potential energy of a system is given by
the formulation: V = 8x3 + 6x2 - 7x. What are the equilibrium
positions? Indicate whether these positions are stable or not.
10.54. A section of a cylinder is free to roll on a horizontal sur-
face. If yof the triangular portion of the cylinder is 180 Ib/ft3 and
that of the semicircular portion of the cylinder is 100 IMft', is the
configuration shown in the diagram in stable equilibrium? Figure P.10.56.
44
I
10.57. A light rod A B is pinned to a hlock of weight W at A .
Also at A are two identical springs K. Show that, for W less than
2K1, we have stable equilibrium in the vertical position and, for W
> 2K1, we have unstable equilibrium. The value W = 2KI is Called
il cririrul load for reasons that are explained i n Problem 10.5X.

Figure P.10.58.
10.59. Cylinders A and B have semicircular cross-sections.
Cylinder A supports a rectangular solid shown as C. If p, =
1,600 kg/mz and p< = 800 kg/m’, ascertain whether the arrange-
ment shown is in stable equilibrium. [ H i m Make use of point 0
10.58. I n Problem 10.57, apply a small transverse force F to in computing V.1
body A as shown. Compute the horizontal deflection 6of paint A
for a position of equilibrium by using ordinary statics as developed I
6m
i n earlier chapters. Now show that when W = 2K1 @e.,the critical -
weight), the deflection 6mathemdtically blows up to infinity. This t
shows that, even if W < 2KI and we have stable equilibrium with
I.’ = 0, we get increasingly very large dcflections as the weight W
approaches its critical value and a side load F , however small, is
introduced. The study of stability of equilibrium configuration
therefore is an important area of study in mechanics. Most of you
will encounter this topic in your strength of materials course.

10.10 Closure
In this chapter, wc have taken an approach that differs radically from the
approach used earlier in the text. In earlier chapters, we isolated a hody for
the purpose of writing equilibrium equations using all the forces acting on the
body. This is the approach we often call vectorial mechanics. In this chapter,
we have mathematically compared the equilibrium configuration with admis-
sible neighboring configurations. We concluded that the equilibrium configu-
ration was one from which there is zero virtual work under a virtual
displacement. Or, equivalently for conservative active forces, the equilibrium
configuration was the configuration having stationary (actually minimum)
potential energy when compared to admissible configurations in the neigh-
borhood. We call such an approach variational mechanics. The variational
mechanics point of view is no doubt strange to you at this stage of study and
far more subtle and mathematical than the vectorial mechanics approach.
Shifts like the one from the more physically acceptahle vectoriul
mechanics to the more abstract variational mechanics take place in other
engineering sciences. Variational methods and techniques are used in the
study of plates and shells, elasticity, quantum mechanics, orbital mechanics,
statistical thermodynamics, and electromagnetic theory. The variational
methods and viewpoints thus are important and evcn v i t d in more advanced
studies in thc engineering sciences, physics, and applied mathematics.

446
10.60. At what position must the operator of the counterweight 10.63. The spring is unstretched when 0 = 3LT. At any position
crane locate the 50-kN counterweight when he lifts the IO-kN of the pendulum, the spring remains horizontal. If the spring con-
load of steel? stant is 50 Iblin., at what position will the system be in equilibrium?
20 m

Figure P.10.63.
10.64. If the springs are unstretched when 0 = 0,. find the
angle 0 when the weight W is placed on the system. Use the
method of stationary potential energy.

Figure P.10.60.

10.61. What is the relation between P and Q for equilibrium?

Figure P.10.61.

10.62. A 50 Ih-ft torque is applied to a press. The pitch of the


screw is .5 in. If there is no friction on the screw, and if the base
Figure P.10.64.
of the screw can rotate frictionlessly in a base plate A, what is the
force P imposed by the base plate on body B? 10.65. A mass M of 20 kg slides with no friction along a vertica
rod. Two internal springs K, of spring constant 2 Nlmm and ai
external spring K2 of spring constant 3 Nlmm restrain the weigh
-ft W. If all springs are unstrained at 6' = 3LT, show that the equilib
rium configuration corresponds to 0 = 27.8'.

Figure P.10.62. Figure P.10.65.


10.66. When rod AH i h in thc vaticill position, the spring
attached to the wheel by a flexible cord is unstretched. Determinc
all the possible angles L? for equilibrium. Show which are stable
and which are not stable. The spring has a spring constant 01 8
Ib/in.

Figure P.10.67.
IO.6X. A rectangular xdid body (11 height h rests on ii cylinder
with a semicircular scctiun Set u p criteria for \lahlc and unstable
Figure P.10.66.
riluilihrium iii trrnis n i ii and X 1 1 1hc
~ pasilion shoun

10.67. Two identical rods are pinned together :it H and arc
pinned at A and C . At H there i s a torsinnal spring requiring SO0
N-mlrad of rotation. What is the maximuin weight W thal ciich Ii,d
can have for a c11w uf stable equilibrium when thc ~riids arc
collinear? Figure P.10.68.

448
Dynamics
Kinematics
of a Particle-
Simple Relative Motion
11.1 Introduction
Kinemutics is that phase of mechanics concerned with the study of the motion
of particles and rigid bodies without consideration of what has caused the
motion. We can consider kinematics as the geometry of motion. Once kine-
matics is mastered, we can smoothly proceed to the relations between the
factors causing the motion and the motion itself. The latter area of study is
called dynamics. Dynamics can be conveniently separated into the following
divisions, mnst of which we shall study in this text:
1. Dynamics of a single particle. (You will remember from our chapters
on statics that a particle is an idealization having no volume but having
mass.)
2. Dynamics of a system of particles. This follows division 1 logically and
forms the hasis for the motion of continuous media such as fluid flow and
rigid-body motion.
3. Dynamics of a rigid body. A large portion of this text is concerned with
this important part of mechanics.
4. Dynamics of a system of rigid bodies.
5. Dynamics of a continuous deformable medium.
Clearly, from our opening statements, the particle plays a vital role in
the study of dynamics. What is the connection between the particle, which is a
completely hypothetical concept, and the finite bodies encountered in physical
problems? Briefly the relation is this: In many problems, the size and shape of
a body are not relevant in the discussion of certain aspects of its motion; only
the mass of the object is significant for such computations. For example, in
towing a truck up a hill, as shown in Fig. 11.1, we would only be concerned

45 I
452 ('HAPTRK I I K1NEM:YI'ICS OF A PARTICLE-SIMPLE REl.AT1VE MOTION

W i+
Figure 11.1. 'liwck uimsidcrrd :is u pxiiclc.

with the mass of the truck and 1101 with i t s shape or size (if we neglect force!,
from the wind, etc.. and the riitatiiinal cffects (if the wheels). The truck can
just a, well he considered ii p;uticle i n computing the necessary towing force.
We car present this relationship more precisely i n the following ntaii-
ner. As will he learned in tlie next chapter (Section 12.10). the equation iii
inotioii o f the center of nias\ of any hody can he foriiied by:
1. C(mccntriiting thc cntirc mass ill thc miss cciitcr of thc h d y .
2. Applying the total rc\LiIIant lorce acting [in thc hiidy t o this hypothetical
particle.

When the iniition of the mass ccntcr charactcrizcs a l l w e nced to know ahout
the motiiin (if tlie hody. we employ the particle concept (i.e,, we find the
motion of the m i s s center). Thus. if all points of a hody have the same vcluc-
ily at airy tinie I ([hi\ i s callcd rrun.rl~iror~ i n o l i o i i ) . we necd iinly know the
miition o i t l i e mass center to liilly ch;ir;~cterize the motion (This was the case
fix thc truck. where the rotational inertia of the wheels was neglected.) If.
additiiinally, the sizc i i f a hiidy i \ \mall compared to itr trajectory (as i n plari-
e l x y niiitiiin. for example). the motion of the center o f n i x \ i s all that might
he needed. and so again we can use the particle conccpt ior such hodics.

Part A: General Notions


11.2 Differentiation of a Vector with
Respect to lime
In the study of statics. we dealt with vector quantities. We found i t con\cnient
to incorporale the directional naturc of thcsc quantities i n ii certain n~itatiiin
and set of opevatiiiii\. We called the tolalily iiithese \ery useful foi-intilalions
"\ector algehra." We s h a l l again enparid our thinking iron1 scalars to vec-
tors-hi\ tinic for the operations of differenti;ition and intcgration with
rcspcct t o any scalar variable I (such as timr).
SECTION I I .2 DIFFERENrIATION OF A VECTOR WITH RESPECT TO TIME 453

For scalars, we are concerned only with the variation in magnitude of


some quantity that is changing with time. The scalar definition of the time
derivative, then, is given as

(11.1)

This operation leads to another function of time, which can once more be dif-
ferentiated in this manner. The process can he repeated again and again, for
suitable functions, to give higher derivatives.
In the case of a vector, the variation in time may he a change in magni-
tude, a change in direction, or both. The formal definition of the derivative of
a vector F with respect to time has the same form as Eq. I I . I :

(11.2)

If F has no change in direction during the time interval, this operation differs
little from the scalar case. However, when F changes in direction, we find for
the derivative of F a new vector, having a magnitude as well as a direction,
that is different from F itself. This directional consideration can be somewhat
troublesome.
Let us consider the rate of change of the position vector for a reference
xyz of a particle with respect to time; this rate is defined as the vrlucily vector,
V , of the particle relative to q z . Following the definition given by Eq. 11.2,
we have

The position vectors given in brackets are shown in Fig. 11.2. The subtrxtion

I .. Path of

Figure 11.2. Particle at times f and f + Al

between the two vectors gives rise to the displacement vector Ar, which is
shown as a chord connecting two points As apart along the trajectory of the
particle. Hence, we can say (using the chain rule) that
wherc M'C have multiplied and di\'idrd hy As i n thc liist cxpression As A/
goes to Lerci. the direction ol Ar approaches tangency t o the trajectory at posi-
tion r ( / )and apprixiches A,\ i n magnitude. Consequently. i n the limit. ArlAs
hecoines a unit w c t w e,. tangent to the traieclor>. Tliat i \

( I 1.3)

We c i ~ then
i sii~

Therefore. drlih leads to a vector having n magnitudc equal to the speed 01


the pailicle and a dii-ection ~aiigentto the trajectory. Kccp i i i mind that there
can he any ansle hetueen the p(isition Vector and the velocity vector. Stu-
dents seem to \'ant t o limit this anglc to 90c',which actually restricts you to ii
cit-culiir p a t h The acceleration ~ e c t o (il
r a Ixirtick ciin then be given as

The dillcrcntiation and integration of vector( r, V . and a will concern LI'I


thniuphout tlic text.

Part 6: Velocity and Acceleration


Calculations

11.3 Introductory Remark


As you know lroni statics. w c ciin expres? ii vector i n many ways. For ill-
stance, we can use rectangular compiinents. or. as we udl hhortly explain, we
can use cylindrical components. In evaluating dcriviitivcs of vectors with
respect 10 time. we mu51 pi-oceed i n accordance with the nianner in which the
vector has heen expre\rcd. I n Part B of this chapter. wc will therefore exaiii-
ine certain diffcrcntiation processes tliiit iirc used extensively i n mcchanics.
Other diftkrenti;ition proccsses will he exaniined l a t ~ at
r appropriate tiiiies.
We have already carried out a derivative operation in Section 11.2
directly on the vector r . You will scc in Section 11.5 that llic approach u x d
gives tlic dcrivative iii terms 01' potti vorilrblr~c.This approach will he one o S
several that we shall iiow examine with some care.
SECTION 11.4 RECTANGULAR COMPONENTS 455

11.4 Rectangular Components


Consider first the case where the position vector r of a moving particle is
expressed for a given reference in terms of rectangular components in the fol-
lowing manner:
r ( t ) = x(r)i + y ( r ) j + z(t)k ( I 1.6)

where x ( f ) ,y ( t ) , and z(t) are scalar functions of time. The unit vectors i, j , and
k are fixed in magnitude and direction at all times, and so we can obtain drldt
in the following straightforward manner:

dr = V ( t ) = -dx(t)
t ' + -
dy(t)j + wdt k = i ( t ) i + y(t)j + i(r)k ( I 1.7)
dt dt

A second differentiation with respect to time leads to the acceleration vector:

=a = i ( t ) i + j i ( t ) j + Z(t)k (11.8)
df2
By such a procedure, we have formulated velocity and acceleration vectors in
terms of components parallel to the coordinate axes.
Up to this point, we have formulated the rectangular velocity compo-
nents and the rectangular acceleration components, respectively, by differen-
tiating the position vector once and twice with respect to time. Quite often,
we know the acceleration vector of a particle as a function of time in the form
a(t) = X ( t ) i + s ( t ) j + Z(r)k ( I 1.9)

and wish to have tor this particle the velocity vector or the position vector or
any of their components at any time. We then integrate the time functionx(t),
y ( t ) , and i ( r ) , remembering to include a constant of integration for each inte-
gration. For example, considerx(t). Integrating once, we obtain the velocity
component V,(r) as follows:

Vx(t) = 1 f ( t ) dr + C, (11.10)

where C, is the constant of integration. Knowing \ at some time to, we can


determine C, by substituting to and (V,),, into the equation above and deter-
mining C , . Similarly, for x(r) we obtain from the above:

x(t) = j[jf(r)dt]dt+C,t+C? (11.11)

where C, is the second constant of integration. Knowing x at some time f , we


can determine C , from Eq. 1 1.1 I . The same procedure involving additional
constants applies-to the other acceleration components.
We now illustrate the procedures described above in the following
series of examples.
456 ('tIA1Tl:tt II K

Example 11.1
Pins A and H must aluayh remain in the vrrtical sIo1 01yrAc C'. which
tno\'e\ ttr tlic right at a c ~ t i s t i i n tspccd o f 6 I t l s e c i n Fig. I I ..?. titrthcrmorc.
the pins cannot leave the elliptic slot. (a) What is the speed at which the
pins apprmach each whet- wlieti the yoke s l o t is at ~r = 5 ft? ( h ) What i s the
rate olch;nrge of \peed k i w m l ciicli nlhcr when the yoke \lot i\ at .i~ = 5 ft'!
Thc cqu:ltioti of Ihc clliptic path iii which the pins iniiict ii~ovci \ seen
by inspection to he

.\z + >r-
- _ I
~~~~

(:I) Figure 11.3. Pin \ l i d o in \IDI ; ~ n d)rihc.


IO' 6'

j clciirly. iIcoordinates (.1.y ) are to represent tlic cii(irdinatcs of pin R. tiicy


t m u ~he t time functions iiich Ih:it for any tinie i llie v;iliies .r!i) and ? ( I ) sill-
! isfy Eq. (a). Also..i(/) andy(i) tiiust hc such that piti II t i i m e s at all times
i n the elliptic path. We cati s i t i d y thesc rcquircnictits hy first dilrcrcnlial-
t iiif Eq. (a) with respect to tiiiic. Cancelins (lie factor 2. we ohtain

N o w ~ ~ (Y(II..~(I),
0. andy(i) ~ i i i i ssati\fy
~ Ikl. ( h ) fur iill viilucs o f i 1 0 cnsurc
that H rciniiiiis iii the elliptic path
We can now proceed to calve par1 ( a ) of this pi-ohleln. We !wow that
i pili H must have a velocity .i = h fllscc hcciiiisc (IItlic yokc. Furthcrniiirc.
j when ~c = 5 It. we know from E[]. (a) that

:. v = 5.20 ft
N o w going tu Eq. (b). we can solve f o r i at the iii\tiiiil 01 intcrcit.

!
Thus. pin H tiioves downward with ii spccd of ?.OX ftlccc. Clcarly. pili A
; n i u s t move u p w i r d with the s m i c speed nf 2.08 f t l x c . Thc pins apprmacli
each olhcr at the itistatit o f intcrcsl at ii speed 014.10 I'tlscc.
SECTION 11.4 RECTANGULAR COMPONENTS 457

Example 11.1 (Continued)


To get the acceleration? of pin H , we first differentiate Eq. (b) with respect
to time.

The accelerations.? and? must satisfy the equation above. Since the yoke
moves at constant speed, we can say immediately that x = 0. And using for
x, y , k, and j known quantities for the configuration of interest, we can
solvc for? from Eq. (d). Thus,
o+65 + 5 . 2 0 +~ 2.0X2 = 0
~~

102 62
Therefore

ji = -3.32 ft/sec*

Pin B must be accelerating downward at a rate of3.32 ft/sec2 while pin A


accelerates upward at the same rate. The pins accelerate toward each other,
then, at a rate of 6.64 ftt/secz at the configuration of interest.

In the motion of particles near the earth’s surface, such as the motion of
shells or ballistic missiles, we can often simplify the problem by neglecting
air resistance and taking the accelcration of gravity g as constant (32.2 ftlsec?
or 9.XI mlsec’). For such a case (see Fig. I1.4), we know immediately that
y(r) = -g andi(r) = i ( t ) = 0 . On integrating these accelerations, we can often
determine for the particle useful information as to velocities or positions at
certain times of interest in the pmhlem. We illustrate this procedure in the
following examples.

L X

Figure 11.4. Simple ballistic motion of a shell


458 ('IIAPTER I I K I N I M A l I C S OF A PARTICLE- Slh.1I't.ti KEIATIVI'. !KITION

Example 11.2
Ballistics Problem 1. A shcll i s fired from a hill 500 I t ahove n plain.
Ttic angle (1 of firing (see Fig. I I . S I i s 15' ahovc thc horimntal. and the
muizle velocity v)i s 3.000 ftisec. At what horizontal distance. d, w i l l lhc
shcll hit the plain if wc ncglcct frictioti of the air'?What i s the nhaximun~
hcighl of the shell ahovc LIE plain? l:iti;illy, determine the trajectory of thc
v
shell 1i.e.. find =.f(.xll.

We know imnicdiately ttiat

We need not hothcr with ?(f). since the motion i s coplanar with i(11 = := 0
at all times. We iicxt separate the velocity variahles froni the timc viiri-
ahles hy bringing rlf to Ihe right sidc.: 0 1 the previous cqoations. Thus

dVv = -32.2dr
"V, = Odt
Inlegrating the ahove equations. we get
V > [ J )= -32.21 +
V)(I) = <.,
We shall lake f = 0 211 the iiistaiit the camion is fired. At this instant. WL'
k n o w L; and V, ;rnd can dctcrmine C , atid C,. Thus.
V$Ol = 3,000sin 15" = ( - 3 2 . ? ) ( 0 ) + C',
SECTION 11.4 RECTANGULAR COMPONENTS 459

Example 11.2 (Continued)


Therefore,

C, = Vv(0) = 776ft/sec

Also

V\(0) = 3,000cos1S" = C,

Therefore,

C2 = b'a(Oj = 2,900 ft/sec

We can give the velocity components of the shell now as follows:

dv
V,(t) = d t = -32.2r + 776 ft/sec
dx
V,(rj = = 2,900 ft/sec
dt
~

Thus, the horizontal velocity is constant. Separating the position and time
variables and then integrating, we get the J and y coordinates of the shell.

y ( t ) = -32.2
2
t2
~ + 776t + C, (e)
*(I) = 2,900t + C, (f)

When f = 0, y = x = 0. Thus, from Eqs. (e) and (f), we clearly see that C, =
C, = 0. The coordinates of the shell are then

y ( f ) = -16.1t2 + 776f
x ( f ) = 2,900t

To determine di.stancp d, first find the time f for the impact of the shell
on the plain. That is, set y = -500 in Eq. (g) and solve for the time t. Thus,

-500 = - l h . l t 2 + 776f
460 CHAPTER I I KINEMATICS OF A ['AKrlC'l E C I h I I ' I E K t l U I V F hlOTlON

Example 11.2 (Continued)


Therefore,

Using the quadratic forintila, we get for I :

f = 48.8 vi.

Substituting this value of I i n l c Fq. lhl. we gc'l

d = (2,9OO)t48 8 ) ~ 141,500 ft

To get the moximirm hpiRhz x,,,,,,. firs1 iind Itre tirile I ;\.hi.ii \; = 0.Thus
from Eq. (c) we get
1) - 12 2: I 776
Therefore,
I = 24.1 St'C

Now suhstirute t .:21.1 sei' iiilo F.q. ( € 1 . 'ihih gtt <:, I , \ !, , ,.

:. y- = 9,350 ft

'Thercfnre.

y = -1.917 X 10"x2 +,268~

Clearly, the tra.jectoi-y is that of a puwholn.


SECTION 11.4 RECTANGULAR COMPONENTS 461

Example 11.3
Ballistics Problem 2. A gun emplacement is shown on a cliff in Fig. 11.6.
The muzzle velocity of the gun i s 1,000 d s e c . At what angle a must the
gun point in order to hit target A shown in the diagram'? Neglect friction.

Figure 11.6. Find a to hit A .

Newton's law for the shell is given as follows for a reference n)'
having its origin at the gun.
j f t ) = -9.81
i(t) = 0
Integrating, we get
s(/) = Vv(tl = -9.81r + C, (a)
X(t) = V\(t) = C, (bl
When f = 0, we have j = 1,000 sin a and j; = 1,000 cos a. Applying these
conditions to Eqs. (a) and (b), we solve for C, and C,. Thus,
1,000 sin a = 0 + C,
Therefore,
C, = 1,000 sin a
Also,
1,000 cos a = c2
Therefore.
c, = 1,000 cos a
Hence, we have
$ ( t ) = -9.81t +
1,000sina
i ( t ) = 1,000cosa

Integrating again, we get


~(f)=-9.811+1.000sinaf+C,
f2

x(t) = 1,ooocosa/+C,
Example 11.3 (Continued)

Using the quadratic lormula. wc linii the liillowing anglcs:

ccI = 8.17"
"2 = 81.44"

Therc tire thus two possible firing angles thal w i l l pennil the rtiell 10
hit the target, as shown i n Fig. I I .7.

I
SECTION 11.4 RECTANGULAR COMPONENTS 463

Example 11.4
The engine room of a freighter is on fire. A fire-fighting tughoat has drawn
alongside and is directing a stream of water to enter the stack of the
freighter as shown in Fig. II.8. If the initial speed of the jet of water is 70
ft/sec, is there a value of a of the issuing jet of water that will do the job?
If so, what should a be'?

Figure 11.8. Fire-fighting tughuat directing a jet of water into the stack
of a freighter.
Consider a particle within the stream of water. Neglecting friction.
Newton's law for the particle is given as follows:
y = -32.2 ftlsec' Y = 0 ft/sec?

Integrating twice, and using initial conditions at A , we get


$ = -32.2f + 70 sin a ft/sec (a) i = 70 cosa ft/sec (c)
y = -16.1t2 + 7 0 s i n a t ft (h) I= 7 0 c o s a t ft (d)
Solve for f from Eq. (d) and substitute into Eq. (b) to get
y = -16.1[-L] 2 + 7 0 ~ i n a [ - ~ ]

70 cos a 70 cos a
Replace cos2 a by I/( I + tan? a) and (sin a/cos a) by tan a in the previous
equation and then substitute the coordinates of point B at the stack where the
water is supposed to reach. That is, set x = 40 ft and y = 30 ft. We then get
30 = -(3.29 x 10-')(402)(1 + tan2 cy) + 40 t a n a
:_ tan2 a - 7.61 t a n a + 6.71 = 0
Using the quadratic formula we get
464 C'HAPTRII I I KIK\FMA'I'I('S OF A l ' ~ ~ l ~ ~ l l ~ l , ~ - ~ S
KI11.:\lIVE
l ~ l l ~ l . l V~l .l I l O N

Example 11.4(Continued)
We thus havc IMW aiiglcs h r a, ciicli i i l w t i i c t i will the,rl-clically ciiusc the
streiilii 10 go ttr piiiiit I1 o i the .;tack. Thew iingles :ire
(1, = 4?.?0' a, = x 1.37"
i Docs 1 1 1 ~ .11011c. or hotti angles ;ihovc yield i i s ~ r c i i i ii)t
i wiiter that will
c(ii1iedown iil R YO iis t o enter the stxk'! We i'iiii detzriiiinc t h i s hy liiiding
' thc iiiiixiiiiuiii viilue oI J aiid locating [tie p(isilioii t Iiir chi, iiiiixiriiuiii
: valuc. To do this, we bel? = 0 and x i l v e for f using each IY. ' I l i i i s u'c have

i
:. I = { 2.14')
I.?? I
) scc

i A Acwh (11 the t w o possihlc Ird.jectories i\ shown i n 1:ig. I LO. ClcarIy the
i

1
1
shallow trajcclory will hi?the side of tlie slack nnd i s uiiacceplahlr. while
?hc high trajcct(iry will deposit water iiisidc the stack and i s thus tlic
desired ti-ajcckiry. Thus.

a = 81 37"
SECTION 11.5 VELOCITY AND ACCELERATION IN TERMS OF PATH VARIABLES 465

We do not always know the variation of the position vector with time in
the form of Ey. I I .6. Furthermore, it may he that the components of velocity
and acceleration that we desire are not those parallel to a fixed Cartesian ref-
erence. The evaluation of V a n d a for certain other circumstances will be con-
sidered in the following sections.

11.5 Velocity and Acceleration


in Terms of Path Variables
We have formulated velocity and acceleration for the case where the rectangu-
lar coordinates of a panicle are known as functions of time. We now explore
another approach in which the formulations are carried out in terms of the path
variables of the particle, that is, in terms of geometrical parameters of the path
and the speed and the rate of change of speed of the particle along the path.
These results are particularly useful when a particle moves along a path that
we know apriori (such as the case of a roller coaster).
As a matter of fact, in Section 1 1.2 (F4. I I .4) we expressed the veloc-
ity vector in terms of path variables in the following form:
ds
V = - E (11.12)
dt
where drldt represen& the speed along the path and E, = dr1d.s (see Eq. 11.3)
is the unit vector tangent to the path (and hence collinear with the velocity
vector). The acceleration becomes

(11.13)

Replace dq/dr in this expression by (dc,lds)(drldt), the validity of which is


assured by the chain rule of differentiation We then have

(11.14)

Before proceeding further, let us consider the unit vector E , at two posi-
tions that are A,s apart along the path of the particle as shown in Fig. 11.10. If.
A.7 is small enough. the unit i:ector$ e,(.s) and +[.s + A.s) can be considered to
intersect and thus to form a plane. If As + 0, these unit vectors then form a
limitirrg plane. which we shall call the osculating plune.' The plane will have
an orientation that depends on the position s on the path of the particle. The
osculating planc at r(t) is illustrated in Fig. 11.10. Having defined the oscu-
s
& m ,*E,(\)

r ( f+ Ai) €,(S + A,7)


kiting plane, let us confinur discusxion of Eq. 11.14. Figure 11.10. Osculaling plane arr(f).

IFrum Ihe definition. it should be apparent that the usculating plane at position .Y along a
C U W ~ isact~illlyiorixe,il Lo Lhc curve at posirion J. Since usculalc means lo kiss. the plane
"kisac.,"thc curie. its it were. at .$.
Since we h a w not fiirniiilly carried out thc differentiation or a \'cctor
with respect 10 a spatial coiirdinatc. we shall carry out the derivative dc,lil.v
riecdcd i n Eq. 11.14 from thc basic definition. Thus.

l h e vccmrs ~ p and ) E,(S + A.vj are shown i n Fig. I I. I I(3) along the path and
arc d s i i shown (cnliirgcd) with AE, as a \cctor triangle in Fig. 1 1 . 1 I(h). Ac
piiintcd out earlier, lirr small enough A.s the lincs OS action of thc unit vector5
eJ.sj and E,(.$ + As) w i l l intersect tn form a plane as shown i n Fig. 1 1 . 1 I(a1.
Now i n this plane. draw nonilill line:, to thc aSiircmentioned vcctnrs at the
respcctiivc positions s and ,s + A.s. These lines will intcrscct at some point 0. a s
shriwn in the diagram. Next. concidcr what happens to the plane and to point 0
as A s --f 0.Clearly. the limiting planc is our osculating plane at .s [see Fig.
I I , I I IC)].
Furthermore. the limiting position airived at for point 0 is fir tlrr
o.sdatiiig plonc and i s callcd the c'en/er o { m , ~ ~ i t for ~ path at s . The dis-
i r ~the
taiicc hctwccn 0 and .s i\ denotcd iis R and i s called Ihc riu1iu.s o i ' i ' ~ w w t i m .
Finaly, the vector Ac, (see Fig. I I. I I ih)). in the limit a s As + 0, ends up i n the
osculating plane norind to the path at c and directed toward thc center of cu--
viiturc. 'The unit vect~rciillincarujitli the linritirlg vcctor for AE, i\ dcniitcd as e,,
and i s called the p r i i i c i p ~ tnorniul
l wi'ior.

/C/

Figure 11.1 I . Devcli~pmentillthe osculating plane and the center of cunalurc.

With the limilitig diwctioii o f Ae? cstablihed. we next evaluate the


iis an approximate value that hecomes corrcct as Av --f 11.
imi,ytz;fudo o f AE,
Ohserving the vector triangle i n Fig. I I.II(h). we can uxiirdingly say:

jAe,I = IE,~AO A* tIl.lh)


SECTION I 1.5 VEI.OCITY AND ACCELERATION I N TERMS OF PATH VARIABLES 461

Next, we note in Fig. 1 I.I I (a) that the lines from point 0 to the points s and
s + A,Talong the trajectory form the same angle A@ as is between the vectors
E,(s) and E,(S + A,?) in the vector triangle, and so we can say:
A+ = A.s = A'!
~

(11.17)
Os R
Hence, we have for Eq. I I . 16:
As (11.18)
IAEI =

We thus have the magnitude of AE, established in an approximate man-


ner. Using E,,, the principal normal at 5 , to approximate the direction of AE,
we can write
A.7
AE, = en
R
~

If we use this result in the limiting process of Eq. 1 I . 15 (where it becomes


exact), the evaluation of dr,ld.s becomes

When we substitute Eq. I 1 . I9 into Eq. I I . 14, the acceleration vector becomes

d2s (ds/dt)*
dt2 e+-
a=- (II.20)
R 'fl

We thus have two components of acceleration: une cwmimnenr in u dirrctimrr


tangent to the path und one component in the osculating plane uf right anglc,s
to the puth und poinfinji toward the center ifcun,uture. These components
are of great importance in certain problems.
For the special case of a plane curve, we learned in analytic geometry
that the radius of curvalurt. R is given by the relation

Furthermore, in the case of a plane curve, the osculating plane at every point
clearly must correspond to the plane of the curve, and the computation of unit
vectors E,, and is quite simple, as will be illustrated in Example 11.5.
How do we get the principal normal vector en,the radius of curvature R,
and the direction of the osculating plane for a three-dimensional curve'? One
procedure is to evaluate E , as a function of s and then differentiate this vector
with respect to s . Accordingly, from Eq. 1 I . 19 we can then determine E, as well
as R. We establish the direction of the osculating plane by taking the cross
product E, x E,, tn get a unit vector normal to the osculating plane. This vector
is called the binormul vector. This is illustrated in starred problem I 1.7.
Example 11.6 ..
A particle i s tnovirig iii ilic ~ A pl;ine
Y almg ii parabolic path giveii a.;
Y = 1.22: .I (see Fig. I 1 . 1 3 J with~riiiicl?in inclcrs. AI position A . the par-
ticle ha\ a spccd (11 3 misec d h a \ ii rate 01 change of speed n l 3 miscc'
iiloiig ilic path What i s Ihc ii ior o f llic p r l i d c i i thih
~ position'?
SECTION 11.5 VELOCITY AND ACCELERATION IN TERMS OP PATH VARIABLES 469

Example 11.6 (Continued)


where

At the position of interest (x = I .5 m ) we have

Therefore,
u = 26.5"
Hence,
.st = .X95 + ,4461 (C)

As for e,,, we see from the diagram that


en = S i n a i - c o s a j

Therefore,
en = ,4461' - ,895j (d)
Next, employing Eq. I 1.21, we can find R. We shall need the following
results for this step:
dY = . 6 1 0 ~ - ' / ~
(e)
C ~.~* Y- -,305x-i/2
(f)
dr? -
Substituting Eqs. (e) and (f) into Eq. 11.21, we have for R:

[i + (.6inx-l/2)zr
R= 305*-1/2 (SI

At the position of interest, x = 1.5, we get


R = 8.40 m (h)
We can now give the desired acceleration vector. Thus, from Eq.
I 1.20, we have
9
a = 3(.895i + ,446j) + ,,(.4461' - ,895.j) 0)

:. +
a = 3.16i ,3791
470 CHAPTER I I KINEMATICS OF A I'ARTICl.r.-SIMPI I:. RFl./\TlVE hlOTIOK

*Example 11.7
A particle i s made t o m o w ; h n g a spirzil palh, iis i s shown in Fig. I I .13.

Figure 11.14.
% Thc equations rcprcscnting thc p ~ arc h given parametricall? iii terins o i
/ Ihe uriahle r iii thc Solliiwing iiiannc.l-:
j .xi, = A 'in r l r
y,, = A U I \ qr ( A . q. <' arc h n i ~ \ v ncwistant,) iill
1 - =cT
',,
where the cuhcci-ipt 11 is t i 1 rcniind the rcader that these reliifioti'r rcfcr t o ii
' fixed path. When thc p a r l i c k i s iit the .rp pliiiie ( 7 = I)). i l ha\ ii spccd c ) l
V,, I'tJhec and ii riitc: ol'changc o i \peed of N fticec.'. What i s the ~ICCCICRI-
1 tioii of the partick iii this position?
To answer this. \be must asccrtiiiii E , . E ,,. and K . To pct E , M'C w r i ~ c :
I

Solving lor t h c ilillcrcntials dr


into Eq. (d). wc gct:
,'. (lp
I'
, ;itid (/: I r w n Eq. ( a ) and iuhstiluting
i
SECTION 11.5 VELOCITY AND ACCELERATION IN TERMS OF PATH VARIABLES 41 I

Example 11.7 (Continued)


in which we replaced (cosz q7+ sin2 qzJ by unity. Returning to Eq. (cJ. wc
can thus say:

E =
I [Aq(cosqzi - Sinqz j J + Ck]
( A 2 q 2 + C 2Jll2 (gJ

To get E" and R we employ Eq. I 1.19, but in the following manner:

in which we have replaced dsldz using Eq. (f). We can now employ Eq.
(g) to find de,/dz:

When we substitute this relation for d q l d z i n Eq. (h), the principal normal
vector becomes:

If we take the magnitude of each side, we can solve for R:

We now have e, and E, at any point of the curve in terms of the


parameter z. As the particle goes through the *y plane, this means that the
z coordinate of the position of the particle is zero and zp of the path corre-
sponding to the position of the particle is zero. When we note the last of
Eqs. (a), it is clear, that zmust be zero for this position. Thus en and E, for
the point of interest are:
I
E, = ( A q i + CkJ
(A2q2 + C2)'/*

where we have used Eq. (k) to replace R in Eq. (m). We can now express
the acceleration vector using Eq. 11.20. Thus:

The direction of the osculating plane can be found by taking the


cross product of E , and E,,.
Figure P.lI.2.

472
What is the acceleration of the particle at f = 3 sec? What distance Figure P.11.K.
has been traveled by the particle during this time? [Hint: Let
dr = <d.r2 + d?' + d:' and divide and multiply by dr in second
half of problem. Look up integratiun f h n
pendix I.]
I vn'
!~ ~
+ f'df
~~
in Ap- 11.9. The face of a cathode ray tube is shown. An electron is
made to move in the horizontal (x) direction due to electric fields
in the cathode tube with the following motion:

x = A sin Of mm
11.7. In Example I I . I , what is the acceleration vector for pin B
if the yoke C is accelerating at the rate of I O ft/sec2 at the instant
of. inlerest? Also, the electron is made to move in the vertical direction with
the following motion:

y = Asin (cot + a ) m m
?

Show that for a = 1112, the trajectory on the scrcen is that of a cir-
cle of radius A mm. If a = 11, show that the trajectory is that of a
straight line inclined at -45" to the xy axes. Finally, give the for-
IO ftlsec' mulations for the directions of velocity and acceleration of the
X electron in the .xy plane.
6 fUsec

Figure P.11.7.

11.8. Particles A and B are confined to always be in a cir-


x
c u l a r groove of radius 5 ft. At the Fame time, these parti-
cles m u s t also be in a slot that has the shape of a parabola.
The slot is shown dashed at time I = 0 . If the slot moves to
the right at a constant speed of 1 ftlsec, what are the speed
and rate of change of speed of particles toward each other
at f = I sec? Figure P.11.9.

413
I .-- I
-I

Figure P.11.IZ.
Figure P.II.10.

-.
,

Figure P.11.13.

11.14. A churgcd panicle i\ \hot a1 tirric f = 0 at an angle of45"


w i t h ii q ~ " e d10 ftlsec. It an r l r c l i i c iirld i s such L l i i l t [lie body har
an ~ ~ c c u l c l i i t i i-i rX W j f ~ I w c ' , what i \ the cquation for the trajec-
tory'! What IS thi. value < > i d f w impact'.'

Figure P.ll.11.

ti

I'igure P.11.14.

474
11.15. A projectile is fired at a speed of 1,000 mlsec at an
angle E of 40" measured from an inclined surface, which is at an
angle $ of 20" from the horizontal. If we neglect friction, at
what distance along the incline does the projectile hit the
incline?

Figure P.11.15.

(b)
11.16. Grain is being hlown into an open train container at a Figure P.11.17.
speed ! Iof,20
) fthec. What should the minimum and maximum
elevations d be to ensure that a11 the grain gets into the train? 11.18. In the previous problem, the vane has a velocity given
Neglect friction and winds. relative to the ground reference X Y as

\ ..: .. .. .:.
V = -St' + 27.8 mls
What is the distance 6 between the vane and the position of
.., .i impact of the water that left the vane at time I = 0. Use the trajec-
tory of the preceding problem, which relates x and s for a refer-
cnce xy attached to the vane and moving to the left at I = (1 at a
speed of 100 kmlhr = 27.X mls. The trajectory of the water after
leaving the vane at I = 0 is
6- IS'
y = -.00721x2 + , 3 6 4 m~
with x in meters.
i 11.19. A fighter-bomber is moving at a constant speed of 500
l ( 1 ' 4 mi* when it fires its cannon at a target at 8.The cannon hila a
m u d e velocity of 1,000 mls (relative to the gun barel).
Figure P.11.16.
(a) Determine the distanced. Use reference shown.
(b) What is the horizontal distance hetween the plane and
11.17. A racket-powered test sled slides over rails. This test position B at the time of impact'!
sled is used for experimentation on the ability of man to
undergo large persistent accelerations. To brake the sled Muzzle velocity = 1.000mls
from high speeds, small scoops are lowered to deflect water
from a stationary tank of watec placed near the end of the ., Plane velocity = SO0 mls

run. If the sled is moving at a speed of 100 kmlhr at the ,


..
instant of interest, compute h and d of the detlected stream ,
of water as seen from the sled. Assume no loss in speed of
the water relative to the scoop. Consider the sled as an iner-
tial reference at the instant of interest and attach xy reference
to the sled. Figure P.11.19.

475
..
,.* . ..
.

Figure 1'.11.20.
y 11.28. In the preceding prohlem, a second smaller destroyer is
firing at the target as shown in the diagram. The data of the pre-
ceding problem applies with the following additional data. Due
to strong wind and current, the destroyer has a drift velocity
of 6 km/hr in a northeast dircctiun in addition to its full speed o l
75 kmihr. Form two simultaneous transcendcntal equations for
a and p and verify that a = 2 1.39" and that p = 10.727".

N
I 1 )
S

. 12,000 111

(in Same
horizontal
plane as

Figure P.11.26.

11.27. A destroyer is making B run at full speed of 75 kndhr.


When abreast of a missile site target, it fires two shells. The target
is 12,000 m fioin the destroyer. If the muzzle velocity is 400
misec. what is the angle of firing a with the horizontal that the
Figure P.11.28.
computer must set the guns? Also, what anglc pmust the turret be
rotated relative to the line of sight at the instant of firing? [ H i m
To hit target, what must V, of the shell be? Result: a = 23.7" and
p = 3.260.1 *11.29. A Jeep with an archer is moving at a speed of 30 mi/hr.
At 100-yd distance and moving at right angles to the Jeep is a deer
running at a speed of 15 mihr. If the initial speed of the arrow shot
y
hv the archer to bae- the deer is 200 ftisec. what inclinatiiin a must
I the shot have with the horizontal and what angle p must thc vertical
projection of the shot ontn the ground have relative to the line A n ?

AI

nonzontai piane
as guns )
I I
@ r l S milhi
n
Figure P.11.27. Figure P.11.29.

477
I'ipurc P.11.36.

,,
I
I
!

Cockpit
Figure P.11.34.
11.43. A passenger plane is moving at a constant speed of 200
kmihr in a holding pattern at a conslant elevation. At the instant of
interest, the angle p between the velocity vector and the x axis is 30".
The vector is known through o n - b o d gyroscopic instrumentation
to be changing at the rate p of -5"Isec. What is the radius of cur-

vature of the path at this instant?

1 '\\,,
..J .',,(' X
?'

A
Figure P.11.40.

11.41. A panicle moves with a constant speed of 3 mlsec along


the path. What is the acceleration a at position x = I .5 m'?Give the
rectangular components of a.

x
y Figure P.11.43.

kx
ex
Y = 3x2
11.44. At what position along the ellipse shown does the normal
vector have a set of direction cosines (.707, .707, OY! Recall that the
equation for an ellipse in the position shown is *2iu2 + v2/h2= 1.

Figure P.11.41.

h=5'

11.42.
hasA ,a what
at speed
A iparticlc
softhe10magnitude
ft/sec
movesandalong
of
a rate change of
thea acceleration'?
sinusoidal
of path. If the
speed
What is 5particle
of theft/sec2
mag- a = IO'
nitude and direction of the acceleration of the particle at E , if it
has a speed of 20 ft/sec and a rate of change of speed of 3 ftlsec'
at this paint?

Figure P.11.44.
y

I 11.45. A panicle moves along a path given as

I 1 5' i~~

I I The projection of the particle along the x axis varies as d.2t2 ft


x
x=5 x-IO (where t is in seconds) starting at the origin at t = 0. What are the
4 2 0 ' 4 acceleration components normal and tangential to the path at f = 2
Figure P.11.42. sec? What is the radius of curvature at this point?

479
4x0
SECTION 1 I.6 CYLINDRICAL COORDINATES 48 1

Figure 11.15. Cylindrical coordinates.


Unit vectors are associated with these coordinates and are given as:
e7, which is parallel to the i axis and, for practical purposes, i s the same as k .
This is considered to be the aria1 direction.
e?, which i s normal to the z axis, pointing out from the axis, and is identified
as the radial direction from z .
eP which is normal to the plane formed by e?and eiand has a sense in accor-
dance with the right-hand-screw rule for the permutation z, 7,8. We call
this the transver.se direction.
Nutc thut ei rind eo will change direction as the particle mows relntive
to the xyz reference. Thus, these unit vectors are generally Junctions of lime,
whereas e7 is a constant vector.
Using previously developed concepts, we can express the velocity and
acceleration of the particle relative to the xyz reference in t e r m uf cunrpo-
nentr ulwuys in the transverse, radial, and axial directions und can use cylin-
drical coordinates exclusively in the process. This information is most useful,
for instance, in turbomachine studies (i.e., for centrifugal pumps, compres-
sors, jet engines, etc.), where, if we take the z axis as the axis of rotation, the
axial components of fluid acceleration are used for thrust computation while
the transverse components are important for torque considerations. It is these
components that are meaningful for such computations and not components
parallel to some x y z reference.
The position vector r of the particle determines the direction of the unit
vectors ei and ee at any time f and can be expressed as
r = ?ei + ze. ( I 1.23)

To get the desired velocity, we differentiate r with respect to time:


4x2 I'IiAl'ItX I I KINI(MATICS OF h I ~ \ K I I ( ' L t ; ~ S I M ~ l . IKELATIVE
I MOIION

Our t a h k here i s to evaluate ET On consulting Fig. 11.16. we see clearly that


changes iii direction 01 e, occiir only wtieii the ctrordinatc (if thc particlc
changcs. Hence. rememhering ltial the m:ignirude of e, i s aluays c~inskinl,n e
hiivc Ibr E7 using the chain rule:
der <kr[It)
6
8
'
ill
-
~

'10 (If
= dc,
ilH
e ( I 1.24)

c,(H AH)
i~

I i

Tu cvaluatc [ I t r IdH. we have shown i n Fig. I l.l6(a) the ve:ctor e7 for a g i w n


?and :.:it position\ correspoiiding to H nnd ( O + AOL In Fig. I l.l6(h), iurther-
more. w e have loriiied an enlarged vector triangle from these vectors md. in
this way. we have shown the tor Ac, (i.c.. Ihc change i n E , durinf a chanfc
i n the coordinate 8). From the vector triangle. we see thal

!A€, = le, ~ A e= A 0 ( 1 1.25)

Furthcrinorc. as A 0 ~i 0 wc see. on consulting Fig. I I. 16. that tlic dircwlion


ill Ae, appn,achc\ Ih:it 01the unit veclor and \o wc can approximate Ac, as

Ae, = IAe, 'e,# = A 0 e,, ( I I .xi

where we habe u w d tiq. I I .25 i n the last step. Going hack ti) liq I 1.24. we
titilix the preceding result to write
SECTION 1I.h CYLINDRICAL COORDINATES 483

In the limit, as A 8 + 0, all the previously made approximations become exact


statements and we accordingly have
ds .
2 = BE, (11.28)
dr
The velocity of particle P is, then,

(11 29)

To get the acceleration relative to q z in terms of cylindrical coordinates


and radial, transverse, and axial components, we simply take the time deriva-
tive of the velocity vector above:

a = dV = ?ei + ?67 + + roes + r f j ~+, ?si (I 1.30)


dr
~

We must next evaluate Like si, the vector E, can vary only when a
change in the coordinate 0 causes a change in direction of this vector, as has
been shown in Fig. I l.l7(a). The vectors E&@) and ~ ~+ (A@ 0 have been
shown in an enlarged vector triangle in Fig. I1.17(b) and here we have shown
A€@ the change of the vector E , as a result of the change in coordinate 8. We
can then say, using the chain rule,

(11.31)

(a) (b)
Figure 11.17. Change of unit vector
484 CHAPTER I I hE
KINEMATICS O F 4 PARTICLE - SIMPLE K E L A I I V t(~i'im

As A 0 + 0, the dirrctiiin of A E hecomes


~ that of -ti and the nugnitude of
A E on~ consulting tlie vectoi- triangle, clearly approacheh 1 t 8 , / A 0= A 0 Thus,
the vector A t , become\ appriiximalely -A0 E ~ I. n the limit, wc' then get fiir
Eq. 11.31:

= -&, (11.321

lising b:qs. I I .2X ;ind I I .32. we find thal Eq. I I .30 now hecmnes

u = ?E, + i&, + i.&, + r&" - r@'Er + :E


Collecting coinponciits. wc write

a = ( i -rg")et + (TO + 2PB)c, + re, (11.33)

Thus;. we have accompli.;hed the desired tahh. A similar procedure can


he followed to reach corresponding forinulaliiins kir spherical coordinates.
By now you should hc nhlc to produce the preceding equations readily from
the foregoing habit principle\.
I:or mntion i n R c.i,v.lr in the .r? plane. notc 1ha1? = := 0 , and 7 = r. We
yet the folloning simplifications:

Furthermore. the unit vector E~ is rangent 10 llic palh. and t l i e unit vector E , i\
normal ti1 the path and points away from thc ccnler. Thcrcforc. when we c ~ r r i -
pare Eq. I I .34h with tliiise cteiiiiriing lr(riri considerations irf path variable,
(Section 11,s). c l e x l y for c i r c u l x motioii i n the .xy coordinate plane iif u
right-hand triad:

E , ~- E, (for counterclockwise motion


ii\ sccii from +:)'
E ~ ,= -E. (for clochu,i\e miticin ( I 1.351

Thus. Eqh. I1.34h and I I . X I are equally risclul for quickly expressing the
acceleration 0 1 ii particle moving in a circular path. YIIUprohahly remember
these formulas from carlicr physics courses and may umii 1 0 use them i n t l ~ c
rnsuing work iif thir chapter.
SECTION 11.6 CYLINDRICAL COORDINATES 485

Example 11.8
A towing tank is a device used for evaluating the drag and stability of ship
hulls. Scaled models are moved by a rig along the water at carefully controlled
speeds and attitudes while measurements are being made. Usually, the water is
contained in a long narrow tank with the rig moving overhead along the length
of the tank. However, another useful setup consists of a rotating radial a m (see
Fig. I I . IS), which gives the model a transverse motion. A radial motion along
the arm is mother degree of freedom possible for the model in this system.

Figure 11.18. Circular towing tank


Consider the case where a model is being moved out radially so that
in one revolution of the main beam it has gone, at constant speed relative
to the main beam, from position ?= 3.3 m to i =4 m. The angular speed of
the beam is 3 rpm. What is the acceleration of the hull model relative to
the water when i =4 m ?
In order to find the radial speed of the model, note that one revolu-
tion of the arm corresponds to a time tevaluated as:
r = 1 = 20 sec ~

60

Hence, we can say for P:


r = -~4 - 3.3 -
~

- ,035d s e c
T
We can now readily describe the motion of the system at the instant
of interest with cylindrical coordinates as follows:
r=4m, 0 = 3(2”)
60 = ,314 rad/sec
i; = ,035 d s e c ,
i = 0, L=O
Using Eq. 11.33, we may now evaluate the acceleration vector,
a := [0 ( 4 ) ( . 3 1 4 ) 2 ] ~+~[0 + ( ~ ) ( . 0 3 5 ) ( . 3 1 4 )+] ~[0]5
~ ~
= -.394e, + , 0 2 2 ~ m/sec2
~
Finally,
1
01= ,395 mlsecz

Note that we could have used notation r instead of i here. (Why?)


Example 11.9 ~-c*

A firetruck hac ii lclcsc<iping hiwin holding a firefi$itcr :is shown in Fi?.


1 1 . 19. At linic I . lhc boom i s cutciiding at the ratc 010 niis ;~ndincrcnsing
i t s riitl: 01 cxLcnsioii at .3 ni/s2. i\ls<i at time I . I = 10 n i and [j = 30'. II ii
velocity component o f the firefighter in the vertical d i r c c i i m i s 1 0 he
: 3.3 mlscc at this instant. what \hould/j h c ? Also. if iit this instant the wr-
tical ~~cccIc~..~tion 01 ilic firelighter i s t o he I .7 Inis?. wliiii hhould fl he'!
N o t thal thc nioiiiiii o f thc firefighter i s that u1,joint A .

We first inwrt skilionwy rcScrence.~y: at the h a w ( i l t l i c hiuim u i i h tlic


hoom in thc ~y plane iis shown in Fig. I1.20. C'lcarly. tlic hoiini i s rotating
!
SECTION 1 I.6 CYLINDRICAL COORDINATES 487

Example 11.9 (Continued)


about the I axis and so this axis is the axial direction for the system. Further-
more, the bourn being normal to the z axis must then be in the radial direc-
tion. It should be obvious that there is no motion of the firefighter in the axial
direction. We now give the velocity vector as follows, noting that 0 = p here.

v = ?e, + F O E . + Z E ;
= (.6)e, + ( l O ) ( b ) ~ ,+ O E m/s
~

-
We require that V j = 3.3 d s . We thus have for this purpose

3 . 3 = ( . 6 ) ( ~ ; j)+(IO)(B)(EB.j)=.6sinP+IObcosp

where we have used the fact that the dot product between two unit vectors
is simply the cosine of the angle between the unit vectors. Noting that at
the instant of interest p= 30". we can readily solve forb. We get

Now we write the equation for the acceleration.

a = (P -r@2)Er + ( r e + 2rLB)e, + OE*


= (.3 - (lO)(.346)*)er (lop+ + (2)(.6)(.346))ee
= -.900er + ( l o p + , 4 1 6 ) ~m/s2
~

We require that a j = I .I d s z . Hence

1.7 = -.900(~, j ) + (lop + .416)(c0 * j )


= -.900sin30"+(IO~+.416)cos30"

We then have the following desired information:

Again, as in the preceding example, we could have used r instead of i.


Vigore P.Il.52.

Figure P.11.51.

I
p = 1.3- I() I X I
N v

1 1
4 C 4 0 m m = radius

N
I Figure P.11.56.

11.57. A plane is shown in a dive-homhing mission. It has at the


Fizure P.11.54.
instant of interest a speed of 4x5 km/hr and is increasing its speed
downward at a rate of 81 kmhrlsec. The propeller is rotating at 150
rpm and has a diameter o f 4 m. What is the velocity of the tip of the
propeller shown at A and its acceleration at the instant of interest?
11.55. A paiticle moves with a constant speed of 5 ft/sec along a Use cylindrical velocity components.
straiphl line having direction cosines I = .5, rn = .3. What are the
cylindrical coordinates when lrl = 20 ft? What are the axial and
transverse velocities of the panicle at this position'!

A
Z

X
Figure P.11.57.
Figure P.11.55.
11.58. The motinn of a panicle relative to a reference xyz is
given as follows:
i = .2 sinh f m 13 = .5 sin lif rad z = 6tZ m
with f in seconds. What are the magnitudes of the velocity and
11.56. A wheel i s rotating at time f with an angular speed o o f 5 acceleration vectoT6 at time = set. Note that = 3.h269
radlsec. At this instant, the wheel also has a rate uf change of and cash = 3,7622,
angular speed of 2 radlsec'. A body H is moving along a spoke at
this instant with a speed of 3 mlsec relative to the spoke and is
increasing in its speed at the rate of 1.6 dsec'. These data me
11.59. Given the following cylindrical coordinates for the
motion of a panicle:
given when the spoke, on which B is moving, is vertical and when
H is .h m from the ccnter of the wheel, as shown in the diagram. i = 20 m 0 = 2nr rad z = 51 m
What ;we the velocity and acceleration of B at this instant relative with f in seconds. Sketch the path. What is (his curve? Determine
to the fixed reference XK? the velocity and acceleration vectors.

489
Figure P.11.68.

11.69. Undcrwater cable is being laid from an ocean-going ship.


The cable is unwound from a large spool A at the rear o l the ship.
The cable must be laid so that is no1 drugged {in the ocean bottom If
the ship is moving at a speed of 3 knots, what is thc necessary angu-
lar speed wof the spool A when the cable is coming off at a radius of
Figure P.11.65. 3.2 m? What is the average rate of change of w for the spool
required for proper operation? The cable has a diameter of I S 0 mol.
11.66. A simple garden sprinkler is shown. Water enters at the
base and leaves at the end at a speed of 3 mlsec as seen from the
rotor of the sprinkler. Furthermore, it leilves upward relative to the
rotor at an angle of 60" as shown in the diagram. The rotor has an
angular speed w of 2 radlsec. As seen from the ground. what are
the axial, transverse. and radial velocity and acceleration compo-
nents of the water just as it leaves the rotor?
Figure P.ll.69.

11.70. A variable diameter drum is rotated by a motor at a con-


stant speed w of I O 'pm.A rupe of diarnzter d of .5 in. wraps
around this drum and pulls up a weight W . It is desired that the
velocity ofthe weight's upvard movement he given as
12
x = . 4 + - 8,000 ftisec

where for r = 0 the rope is just about to start wrapping around the
drum at Z = 0. What should the radius i of the drum he as a func-
Figure P.11.66. tion o f Z to accomplish this'! What are the velocity components Y
and i of the weight W when f = I O 0 sec?
11.67. The acceleration of gravity on the surface of Mars is ,385
X
times the acceleration of giaviry on earth. The radius R of Mars is
ahout ,532 times that ofthe earth. What is the time of flight of one
cycle for a satellite in a circular parking orbit 803 miles from the
surface of Mar?'? [Nore: GM = sK2.1 Z

11.68. A threaded rod rotates with angular position I3 = ,3151'


rad. On the rod is a nut which rotates relative to the rod at the rate
w = .4f radisec. When I = 0, the nut is at a distance 2 ft from A .
What is the velocity and acceleration of the nut at I = 10 sec'! The
thread has a pitch of .2 in (see foatnole 4). Give results in radial
and transverse directiuns. Figure P.11.70.

49 1
492 CHAPTER I I KINFMATI('S ( I P A P.4RlICI I S l h l P I t: REI A l ' l V t ! hI(1TIOK

Part C: Simple Kinematical Relations and


Applications
11.7 Simple Relative Motion
Up to ~ncnv,u c h a w comidercd only a hiiiplc rclerence ill our kinemalical coli-
sideralioiis. Thcrc ai-c rime.; when IUO or morc references may he protitahiy
einploycd in describing llic inmior of a particle. Wc shall considcr in (hi\ scc-
tion a ver)' siinple case lliiil w i l l fulfill our needs iii tlic early portiiin of the l e x f .
As a first step consider twn rcierence, . r m~d XYZ (Fig. I I .2 I)moving
in such a way l h a i Ihc direction OS the a x e OS ty: d w a y s rctain the same
orientation relative IO XYZ such iis has heen suggeslrd hq the dashed refer-
ences giving Eiicccssive posilion\ d v v : . Such ii Iiiotioii o l . r y relative io XYZ
i s called rmndnrio,i.

Y
Figure 11.21. Axcc ~ i y are
r translating rel;iti\c io XY/.

Suppow iiow lliilt we have ii vccliir A l t j wliicli varies with time. Now i n
ihe gciirral case. the time wriatioii o S A will depcnd mi from which rcScrcnce
we iire observing the time nriatinii. Fur this reason. UT otten include \uhscripr\
10 identify Ihc refcrence r e l a l i v r 10 which (he time viiriiilioii i\ Liken. l l u s , w e
z ldA/i/f)xy, iis time derivatives o f R iis seen lroni the .SK and
have ( d A l d l ) , ~and
XYZ axes. respectively. Hou' iire these dcrivatiws related for axes ~rv: and XYZ
that are lranslating rclativc to eiicli ollicr'! For this purpose. consider (dA/dljx,L
We w i l l decompose A into components parallel to the . x y axes and s o us h a c

whei-e A , , . 4 , , and /I. arc thc scalar mmponcnts of A a l m g the .ry; axes.
Because x?:. trandatcs rclative to XYZ ( w e Fig. I I.?II, the unit vectors o l . i - r .
SECTION 11.7 SIMPLE RELATIVE MOTION 493

which we have denoted as i , j , and k, are constant vectors as seen from XYZ.
That is, whereas these vectors may change their lines of action, they do nor
change magnitude and direction as seen from XYZ and are thus constant vec-
tors as seen from XYZ. We then have, for the equation above:

But A,. A,y, and A. are scalurs and a time derivative of a scalar, as you may
remember from the calculus, is not dependent on a reference of observation.5
We could readily replace (dALdt),, by (dA;dt)xyz, etc., with no change in
meaning--or we could leave off the subscripts entirely for these terms. Thus,
we can say now:

Now consider (dAldt)xsz.Again, decomposing A into components along the


q z axes and noting that i ,j , and k are constant vectors as seen from xyz, we
can conclude that

( I 1.39)

where as discussed earlier we have dropped the xyz subscripts. Observing


Eqs. 11.38 and 11.39, we conclude that

( I I .40)

That is, the rime derivative o f a vector is the same f o r all reference axes that
are rransluting relative to each uther.
Note in the discussion that the fact that the unit vectors of q z were con-
stunt relative to XYZ resulted in the simple relation 11.41. If xyz were rotuting
relative to XYZ, the unit vectors of xyz would not be constant as seen from
X Y Z and a more complex relationship would exist between (dAldt),, and
(ddldr)~~,,z.
We shall develop this relationship later in the text.

‘Clearly. the time variation of the temperalure T(x,y,z),a scalar, at any position in the class^
room does not depend on the motion of an observer in the classroom who might he interested in
the temperature at B particular position at a particular time.
11.8 Motion of a Particle Relative
t o a Pair of Translating Axes
A pair of references .LK and XY7. are shown now i n Fig. 11.22 moving in
translation rclati\z t o eiicli tither. The wlo<.ii? i ' w i o I 01' any particle P
depends 011 thc referencc fr,irii wliicli the ~ntrliiiinic ohserved. More precisely,
wc say that the velocity ol' particle l'relativc 10 refcrcnce X U is the time rate
oichange OS the piisition veclor r Siir this rcfxeiicc. where this rate of change
i\ Yiewed froti? the XYZ refercncc. Thih can h e slated mithematically as

Similarly. ior ~ l i c\:elocity ofpurliclc Pa' x c n froni rclcrcnce xy. we have

wherc u'e iiow iise pmitiim wctnr p firr refcrence .ryz and view the change
from the .rxz. rclcrence (scc Fig. I I .22). Ry thc same tohcn. (dRidr),, i s the
velocity of h e iirigiii O i tlic .n.; rekrcnce as scen froni XYZ. Since all points
of rhc .y; refcrcnce h a w the same velocity rcliirive 10 X Y Z at any time I for
this c i i i e (translation of .XK], u'e can say that (dRldr),y,,is the velociry or ref-

Y
Figure 11.22. Axe.. . \ K we transl:ning r c l a t i i r 11) XY'Z

From Fig. I 1.22 we can relate position vectors p and r hy thc equation
r = K + p (11.44)
N o w tahc the lime rille 11Sclimgc 01thew Yeclor\ :I\ iccn from XYZ. We get

The tcrin on the Ich side of this equiition is VxyL,iis indicated earlier, and we
shall use rlie IIoLiitiiiiiR Sor (dRldt),lr We ciiii replace the last tern by the
SECTION 11.8 MOTION OF A PARTICLE RELATIVE TO A PAIR OF TRANSLATING AXES 495

derivative (dp/di)xycin accordance with Eq. I I .41 since the axes are in trans-
lation relative to each other. But (dpldt),,? is simply yvz,
the velocity of P rel-
ative IO .xyz. Thus, we have

,v En V,‘ ( I 1.46)

By the same reasoning, we can show that the acceleration of particle P


is related to references X Y Z and xv? as followsh:

( I I .47)

Equations I I .46 and 11.47 convey the physically simple picture that the
motion of a particle relative to XYZ is the sum of the motion of the particle
relative to xyz plus the motion of g z relative to XYZ.
It must be kept clearly in mind that the equations which we have developed
apply only to references which have a translatory motion relative to each other. In
Chapter 15 we shall consider references which have arbitrary motion relative to
each other. (Since a reference is a rigid system, we shall need to examine at that
time the kinematics of rigid bodies in order to develop these general considera-
tions of relative motion.) The equations presented here will then be special cases.
How can we make use of multiple references’? In many problems the
motion of a particle is known relative to a given rigid body, and the motion of
this body is known relative to the ground or other convenient reference. We
can fix a reference n)’z to the body, and if the body is in translation relative to
the ground, we can then employ the given relations presented in this section
to express the motion of the particle relative to the ground.
If, in ensuing chapters, we talk about the “motion of particles relative to
a point,” such as, for example, the center of mass of the system, then it will be
understood that this motion is relative to a hypothetical rqfrrence moving
with the center of mass in a translatory manner or, in other words, relative to
a nonrotating observer moving with the center of mass.’
We illustrate these remarks in the following examples.

“s you 110 douht will anticipate. the acceleration of a panicle as seen from reference XLZ i s

Similarly. we h i v c fororl,;.

’Using a p i n t to convey information ahout relative motion o r a panicle only allows you to
convcy information as to how far or how near the panicle is Io the paint and also as to the rpccd
and rate of change of speed of the panicle toward or away from the point. The imponant infor-
mation regarding direction i s entirely left out, requiring a reference frame in order to give this
kind of information.
.I___ ... .. ..___ ... , -.
. . ., , . . - .I . ~ . .
SECTION I 1.8 MOTION OF A PARTICLE RELATIVE TO A PAIR O F TRANSLATING AXES 491

Example 11.10 (Continued)


1 Thus, denoting the total force from the airplane as FpIanc.
and remembering
4
that the gate valve weighs Ib, we have
I
= I (- 44j 89.5k3
F*l',"e~ zI k ~

(e)

wherc - i k is the fbrce of gravity. Solving for Fpl:~~,c


we get
= -.684j - .890k Ib
FDlanc (f)

Example 11.11
The freighter in Fig. 11.24 is moving at a steady speed V, of 15 k d h r rel-
ative to the water. The freighter is 200 m long at the waterline with point
A at midship. A stalking submerged submarine fires a torpedo when the
submarine and freighter are at the positions shown in the diagram. The tor-
pedo maintains a steady speed V, of 40 kmlhr relative to the water. Will
the torpedo hit thc freighter?

V , = 15 km/hr
V2 = 40 km/hr
Freighter length = 200 m

Figure 11.24. A torpedo is fircd toward n freighter. Does it hit or miss'!


A key feature in solving this problem (and othcrs like it) is that we
can readily tell whether there is a hit or a miss and, if there is il hit. exactly
where this takes place. This is done by simply observing the torpedo from a
vantage point of the freighter. The torpedo vclocity relutivr I O the.freighter
(Le., !.he motion seen by an on-board observer) will point directly to the
position of potential contact with the freighter or will indicate a miss.
398 CllAPTER I I K I N l i M A ~ I K ' SOF A PARTICLE-SIM1'I.I KI:I.ATIVE MOTION

Example 11.11 (Continued)


We accordingly make thc following referencc lincs:

Fix xyz to the freighter


Fix XYZ to the water

This is shown i n Fig. I 1.25. The velocity o f - ~ yand.


. hence the freighter,
relative to XYZ(i.c.,H) is (-15 cos 3O'i + I ? sin XYj) hmlhr. 'The vclocity
of the torpedo relative tu XYZ is 40j kmlhr. We can t l u s;ly
v,,, = v,, + R

Figure 11.25. Veliicity v c c t r m arid relerencc? lor the cnpgcrncnt

Hence.
3Oj = Vt~yy -- I S coc 30"; + I S sin 3O"j
:. V , ! : = IL.YY; + 1 2 . S j kmlhi- (a)

To just miss the freightcr, thc vclocity veclor of thc torpedo relative to the
freighter, Vlyz,must havc ii coursc such that this vcctoI forms an angle o(,
with the horizontal axis given a\ (see Fig. 11.261

pa = n + 60" = tall I
1 0 0 ~+~6(,"
6,000
= h(J.')5" (h)

Now go hack to Eq. ( a ) to ohtain thc actual angle. p,,,., (sce Fig. I I .25).
f o r the actual relative velocity w c t o r VI:.

Figure 11.26. Relative vclocily wxtw


Thus we may all relax: the torpedo.just niisses the freightcr m c e p,.,,~..,
> o,,, V , . fm.juri I n k + the frcightcl-.
11.71. Two wheels rotate about s t a t i o n q axes each at the same 11.73. A sled. used by researchers ti1 test man's ahility to per-
angular velocity, 8= 5 mdJsec. A particle A moves along the spoke of form during large accelerations over extended periods o f time, is
the larger wheel at the speed V, of 5 fdsec relative to the spoke and at powered by a small rocket engine in the rear and slides on lubn-
the instant shown is decelerating at the rate of 3 fdse? relative to the cated tracks. If the sled is accelerating at 68, what force does the
spoke. What are the velncity and acceleration of particle A as seen by man need to exert on a 3-ounce body to give it an acceleration rel-
an observer on the hub of the smaller wheel? What are the velocity ative to the sled of
and acceleration of paticle A as seen hy an observer on the huh of the
smaller wheel if the axis of the larger wheel moves at the instant of
30i + 2Oj ft/secZ
interest to the left with a speed of 10 ftJsec while decelerating at the
rate of 2 ftJsecz'?Both wheels maintain equal angular speeds.

Figure P.11.73.

11.74. On the sled of Problem I I .73 is a device (see the diagram)


on which mass M rotates about a horiLontal axis at an angular speed
w of5.000 rpm. If the inclination Oof the arm BM is maintained at
Figure P.11.71.
30" with the vertical plane C-C, what is the total force on the mass
11.72. Four particles of equal mass undergo coplanar motion in Mat the instant it i s in its uppermost position? The sled is undergo-
the ,xy plane with the following velocities: ing an acceleration of 58. Take M as having a mass of .I5 kg.

v,= 2 d s e c
v, = 3 d s e c
V, = 2 d s e c
V, = 5 d s e c
A
We showed in Section 8.3 that the velocity af the center of mass
can be found as follows:

c
Figure P.11.74.
where is the velocity of the center of mass. What are the veloc- 11.75. A vehicle, wherein a mass M of I Ihm rotates with an
ities of the particles relative to the center of mass? angular speed w equal to 5 radlsec, moves with a speed V given as
V = 5 sin CLI ftlsec relative to the ground with f i n seconds. When
f = I sec, the rod AM is in the position shown. At this instant, what
is the dynamic force exerted by the mass M along the axis of rod
AM if R = 3 radlsec?

Figure P.11.75.

499
11.79. A rackrl ninve? at a ?peed of 700 mlsec and accalciatus
at :i rate of 5~ relatiw to the g w n d refercncc XYZ. The products
of combustion at A leave thc sockct at B spccd of 1.700 mlsec rel-
iiti\,c t o thc rocket and are acczlcrating at the ratc of30 rnlscc' re+
ativc 10 thc rricket. What arc' thc spccd and acceleration of a n
cleincnt o f thc c ~ m b u ~ t i npruducri,
n a i heen from the ground? Thc
iriichel mow, along ii straight-line path w,hosc dircctirin cosines
fcir thc XYZ reference iirr I = .h and ,n = .6.

x
.
i .I

Figure P.11.79.

X------
Figure P.Il.78. Figure P.1 I.80.
11.81. A train is moving at a speed of 10 km/hr. What speed connected to a massless rod. At the instant shown, o = 2 radlsec
should car A have to just barely miss the front of the train? How and 0 = 3 radIsec> both relative to the balloon. What force does
long does it take to reach this position? Use a multireference the rod exert on the device at this instant? Give the result in vector
approach only. and scalar form. The rod is in a horizontal position (see elevation
view) at the instant shown and has a length of .5 m.

Plan view

Elevation view
Figure P.11.83,

11.84. A submarine is moving at a constant horizontal speed of


I5 knots below the surface of the ocean. At the same time, the sub
Figure P.11.81. is descending downward by discharging air with an acceleration
11.82. A Tomahawk missile is being tested for its effect on a of ,023g.s while remaining horizontal. In the submarine, a flyball
naval vessel. A destroyer is towing an old expendable naval governor operates with weights having a mass of 500 g each. The
frigate at a speed of 15 knots. The missile is shown at time f mov- governor is rotating with speed w of 5 radlsec. If at time f, 0 = 30",
ing along a straight line at a constant speed of 500 miihr, the guid- 8 = .2 radlsec, and d = I rad/sec2, what is the force developed on
ance system having been shut off to avoid an accident involving the support of the governor system as a result solely of the motion
the towing destroyer. Does the missile hit the target and if so of the weights at this instant'! [Hint: What is the acceleration of
where does the impact occur? The missile moves at a constant ele- the center of r n a ~of
. ~the spheres relative to inertial space'?]
Yation of I O ft above the surface ofthe water.

15 hots

I * W l f

5W mi/hr

!lA
z
Figure P.ll.82.

11.83. On a windy day. a hot air balloon is moving in a transla-


tory manner relative to the ground with the following acceleration:
a = 2i - 5 j + 3k m/s2

Simultaneously. a man in the balloon basket is swinging a small


device frw measuring the dew point. The device of mass 5 kg is Figure P.11.84.

501
~ Y
11.90. Mass M of 3 k g rotates about point 0 in an accelerating The helicopter blade i s rotating relative to the helicopter in the fol-
rocket in the xy plane. At the instant shown, what i s the force from lowing manner at the instant of interest:
the rod onto the mass? Include the effects of gravity if fi = 7.00
o,= 1OOrpm 0,= 10.3 rpmlsec
mls' at the elevation of the rocket.
The blade i s I O m long. What i s the velocity and the acceleration

n
t m1s2
nf the tip B relative to the ground reference X T L ? Give your
results in meters and seconds. The blade i s Darallel to the X axis at
the instant of interest.

Om
45"
X -x R
o = 5 rad/s2
L, = 2 radlsz
- V+ a

z
Figure P.1 1.92.

Z 11.93. A destroyer in rough seas has thc following translational


acceleration as s e w froin inertial relerencc X Y Z when it is firing
its main battery in the Y Z plane:
Figure P.11.90. a = Sj + 2k mls'
11.91. A light plane i s approaching a runway in a crnss-wind. What must m, and OJ, of the gun harrcl he relative to the ship at
This cross-wind has a uniform <peed y, of 33 milhr. The plane has this instant S I , that tip A of the barrel has zero acceleration relative
a velocity component V, parallel to the ground of 70 milhr relative to XYZ?
to the wind at an angle p of 30'. The rate of descent i s such that the
plane will touch down somewhere along A- A. Will this touchdown
occur on the runway or off the runway for thc data given'?

-
-
-
-
A

-
-
-
- Figure P.11.93.

Figure P.11.91. 11.94. A small clewtor E i n an nccan-going vessel has thc fol-
lowing mntion relative tn the ship:
11.92. A helicopter i s shown moving relative to the ground with
a ,.,,,, = .2gR m/s2
the following motion:

V = 13Oi + 70j + 20k kmlhr 'The ship has thc following motion relative to nearby land:
a = IOi + 16j + 7k kmlhrls a, ,,,,, = .2i + 3j + .6k mls'

503
11.96. A particlc at position (3, 4, 6) ft at time I(,= 1 sec i s given 11.99. A light linc attachcd to a streamlined weight A i s "shut"
a constant acceleration having the value 6i + 3 j ftisec'. If the by a line rifle from a small boat C to a large boat D in heavy seas.
+ +
velocity at the time I,) i s I6i 20j 5k ftlsec, what i s the velocity The weight must travel a distance of 20 yd horizontally and reach
of the panicle 2.0 sec later'! Alsti give the position of the panicle. the larger boat's deck, which i s 20 ft higher than the deck of hoat
C. If the angle a o f firing i s 40", what minimum velocity V,, i s
11.97. A pin i s confined to slide in a circular slot uf radius 6 m. needed! At the instant of tiring, buat C i s dipping down into the
The pin must also slide in a straight slot that moves to the right at waler at a speed of 5 ftlsec. Assume that the larger boat remains
B cmstant speed, V , of 3 mlsec while maintaining a constant angle essentially fined at constant level.
of 30' with the horizontal. What are the velocity and acceleration
of the pin A at the instant shown? &--'I 2 0 yd

y
I

Figure P.11.99.

I1.1W. A projectile is fired at an angle of 60" as shown. At


what elemtion ? does i t strike the hill whose equation has been
estimated as y = IO-'.$ m ? Neglect air friction and take the muz-
le velocity as 1,llOO mlscc.

Figure P.11.97. I.

11.98. A freighter i s i n w i n g in a river at a speed of 5 knots rela-


tive to the water. A small boat A i s moving relative to the water at a
speed of 1 knots in a direction as shown in the diagram. The river i s
moving at a unifbrm sped of .h knots relative ti) the ground. Will
the hoat hit the freighter and, i f so, where will the impact occur?

-
- Figure P.11.100.

11.101. A proposed space laboratory, in order to simulate gravity,


+ 5 hots

-
iotiltes rclative to an inertial reference XTL at a rate wI. For occu-
+ pant A in the living quarters ti) be comfortable. what should the

- 3.ooo'
approximate value of w , be'! Clearly, at the center, there i s close to
,em gravity for zero-g experiments. A conveyor connects the living

-
4

+
.6 knots
~ , ,: " , ,..?
quarters with thc zero-g laboratory. At the instiant of interest, a
package D hei a ?peed of 5 m l s and a iilte of change of speed of 3
m/s2 rchtivc to the Space station, both toward the laboratory. What
arc the axial. transverse, and rddial velocity and acceleration com-
ponents at the instant of interest relative to the inertial reference?
Figure P.11.98. What are the rectangular cumponents of the acceleration vector?

505
/-------i------.
k
I tl Id i>i,ii

Figure P. I 1.104.

Figure P.II.IUh.
ll.lU7. Pilots of tighter planes war special suits designed til 11.110. A mechanical ''aim" for handling radioactive matcriiils
prevent blackouts during a severe maneuver. These suits tend to i s shown. The distance Fcan he varied by telescoping action of the
keep the blood from draining out of the head when the head i s arm. The ann can he rotated about the vertical axis A- A. Finally,
accelerated in a dil-ectiuo from shoulders to head. With this suit, B the arm can he raised or lowered by a worm gear drive (not
flier can take 5 ~ ' so f acceleration in the aforementioned direction. shown). What i s the velocity and acceleration of the object C if
If a tlicr is diving at a speed of 1,001) kmlhr, what i s the minimum the end of the arm mvves U U radially
~ at a rate of 1 ftJsec while the
radius of curvature that he can manage at pullout without suffcr- arm turns at a speed w of 2 r a d s e c ? Finally, the arm i s raised at a
illg had physiological effects'? rate of 2 ftJsec. The distance T at the instant of interest i s 5 ft.
+
What i s the acceleration in the direction E = .Xi ff!
11.108. A particle mwes with constant speed uf 1.5 mlyec along
a path given as x = j2 In y m. Give the acceleration vector of the
~
L
particle in terms o f rectangular components when the partick i s at I
A
position y = 3 m. Do the problem by using path coordinate tech-
niques and then by Cartesian-component techniques. How many
x ' s of acceleration i s the particle subject to'!
ll.109. A submarine i s moving in a translatory manner with
the following velocity and acceleration relative to an inertial refer-
cnce:

V = hi + 7.5j + 2k knots a = .2i ~ .24j + .X?k knotils


A device inside the submarine consists of an arm and a mdSb at die
end of the arm, At the instant of interest, the arm i s rotating in a
vertical plane with the following angular speed and angular accel- x
/ "
eration: Figure P.ll.llO.
w = It) r a d s dJ = 3 rad/s* 11.111. A top-section view of a water sprinkler i s yhown. Water
cnteis at thc center Srom helaw and then goes thrvugh four pas-
The ann i s vertical at this instant. Thc mass at the end of the m d
~agewayiin an impeller. The impeller is rotating at constant speed
may he ctrnsidered t o he a particle having a mass of 5 kg. What
w of 8 rpm. As xzii from the impeller. the water ICBVCS at a speed
are the velocity and acceleration vectors for the motion of the par-
o f I O ft/sec at an angle uf 3U" relative to r. What is the velucity
ticle at this instant relative to the inertial reference? Use units of
and acceleration as seen from the ground of the water as i t leaves
meters and seconds. What must he the force vector from the arm
the impeller and becomes free of the impeller? Give results in the
onto the particle at this instant?
radial, axial, and transverse directions. Use one reference only.

Y
I

Figure P.11.109. Figure P . l l . l l l .

507
11.112. A luggdgc dispcnscr at ;maiiyort rcxmblch a pyramid with
iix flat scgrncnts as sidcs as \liowri in the diagram The S Y ~ ~ ~ IOLLLI~SITI
with ail angular spced w u l 2 rpm. Luggagc is dropped from above
ind slidzb duwii lhc lilccs t u bz pickcd up by I w c I e r s at the ~ J W
A piecc (if luggage IS shmw on a f x r . It ha\ j u c t heeri
Jropped at the position indicaled. If has at thir instant ieru vcloc-
ity as \een from the rotating face but has at this instmt and there-
iftci an acceleration crf .2g along the f i c c . What i s the tovill
iccrlcriltiun, as seen from the ground, of the l u ~ ~ n ea> t .i t r c a c l i c ~
he hasr ill H'I Use one reference only.

Figure P.11.113.

11.1 14. A jet uf wiltet Ihiu 3 s p e d ai the n o u l e of 20 mi\. At


what position dues i t lhit thc parabolic hill? What i s i t & speed at
lliilt puiril'! Dc IOI include I l i c t i w i .

Sidc view
Figure P.11.112.

11.11 A landing craft i s in the pn,ce\r 01 landing o n M:


i.herr the accclcratmn of gravity i s . 3 X S times that 01 the c a
I'he craft has thc followmg :iccelerntiiin relative 10 the landing
i u r f k x at the instant 01interest:

a = .2gi i .4gj ~ 2xk rni\cc'


where fi 1s the :icceleretirm 01gravity o n thc with. At this ~iisliliit.
XI astnrnaut is raising a harid c i m c w weighing 3 N on the earth. I1
he i \ giving the ciliiirril an upward :I Icrution 0 1 3 mdscc' rela-
t igtimnilut cxcrt (in [he
live tu the landinp craft, whiit forcc i i i u ~the
:aniera at the instant of intercct'.'

iO8
11.119. A tube, must of whose centerline is that of an ellipse
given as

?I ?2
-+--I
1.8’ .122

Figure P.11.116. has a cross-sectional diameter D = 100 mm. The tube has the fol-
lowing rotational motion at the instant of interest:
*11.117. A particle has a variable velocity V(t) along a helix
wrapped around a cylinder of radius e. The helix makes a constant w = . I 5 radis W = ,036 radls’
angle a with plane A perpendicular to the z axis. Express the
acceleration a of the particle using cylindrical coordinates. Next,
Water is flowing through thc tube at the following rate at the
express 6, using cylindrical unit vectors and note that the sum of
instant of interest:
the transverse and axial components of a (lust computed) can be
given simply as VE,. Next, express the acceleration of the particle Q = . I 8 Lis Q = ,025 L/s’
using path coordinates. Finally, noting that E , , = --E-, show that
the radius of curvature is given as R = ?-- The tube is in the vertical plane at the instant of interest. What is
cos2 a
the acceleriltion of the water particles at the centerline of the tube
at point C using cylindrical coordinates and cylindrical compo-
nents’! Assume over the cross-section of the tube that the water
d o c i t y and acceleration are uniform.

’I’

Figure P.11.119.

Figure P.11.117. 11.120. A World War I fighter plane is in level tlight moving at
a speed of60 k d h r . At time lo it has an acceleration given as:
11.118. An eagle is diving at a constant $peed of 40 ftlsec to
catch a IO-ft snake that is moving at a constant speed of 15 fl/sec. a = .2gi ~ 3gj +2 k m/s2
What should ff be so that the eagle hits the small head of the
snake‘? The eagle and the snake are moving in a vertical plane. Also at this time, the co-pilot is raising a camera upward with an
acceleration of 0. IRrelative to the plane. If the camera has il m a s
of .01 kg, what forcc must thc co-piloi exert on the camera to give
it the desired motion at time t,,? Note that the plane never rotates
during this action. Take g = Y.81 d s ’ .

X’
Figure P.ll.118. Figure P.II.120.

509
Particle
Dynamics

12.1 Introduction
In Chapter 1 I , we examined the geometry of motion-the kinematics of
motion. In particular, we considered various kinds of coordinate systems: rec-
tangular coordinates, cylindrical coordinates, and path coordinates. In this
chapter, we shall consider Newton’s law for the three coordinate systems
mentioned above, as applied to the motion of a particle.
Before embarking on this study, we shall review notions concerning
units of mass presented earlier in Chapter 1. Recall that a pound mass (Ibm)
is the amount of matter attracted by gravity at a specified location on the
earth’s surface by a force of I pound (Ibf). A slug, on the other hand, is the
amount of matter that will accelerate relative to an inertial reference at the
rate of I ft/secz when acted on by a force of 1 Ibf. Note that the slug is
defined via Newton’s law, and therefore the slug is the proper unit to be used
in Newton’s law. The relation between the pound mass (Ibm) and the slug is
M (Ibm)
M (slugs) = (12.1)
32.2
Note also that the weight of a body in pounds force near the earth’s surface
will numerically equal the mass of the body in pounds mass. It is vital in
using Newton’s law that the mass of the body in pounds mass be properly
converted into slugs via Eq. 12. I
In SI units, recall that a kilogram is the mass that accelerates relative to
an inertial reference at the rate of I meter/sec2 when acted on by a force of I
newton (which is about one-fifth of a pound). If the weight W of a body is
given in terms of newtons, we must divide by 9.81 to get the mass in kilo-
grams needed for Newton’s law. That is,
M ( k g ) = W (N) (12.2)
9.81
~

We are now ready to consider Newton’s law in rectangular coordinates.


511
Part A: Rectangular Coordinates:
Rectilinear Translation
12.2 Newton's l a w for Rectangular
Coordinates
\ ciin expic\\ Ncuton
In iect,ingul,ii c i i ~ i i c I i n ~ i l cwc \ I,\\\ d\ tollow\

If the notion i s hnown rclalivc IC) mi incrtiill rclercncc. we can easily


~ I v for
c the rcckingulai- ciiiiiprincnts oc (lie r c s t t l ~ i i nforce
~ on the palticlc.
The eqoatii)ns IO he s o l v e d arc j u s 1 algebraic cqiiations. The iiii.er.re o f this
problem. wherein the forces iirc known ovcr ii l i m e inlcrviil and thc motion i s
desired during this iiitcr\~~iI, i s no1 s o himplc. For the in\,crsc case. wc tnu\t
get inwilved generally with intcgrxtiiin procedures.
I n the next section. w e s l i i i l l considcr siiuatioiis in which the resultiiiit
lorce on a piisiiclc hiis thc \amc dirccliiin and line 0 1 d o n tit all times. Thc
resulting niotiiiii i s then confined to ii sll-ai:hc line and i s usually called r w l i ~
llmYrr fr',~l.~l~~fio~~.

12.3 Rectilinear Translation


For reclilinciir tran&lalion. wc ma) considcr llic line of action 01the tnotion to
be collinew with one a x i s 01a rectilinear coordiiiale \yhlein. Newton'\ law i \
then one of the cquatiiins (11 the set 12.3. Wc shall use the .r axi.; to coincide
with the line 01 iiclion (11the nici1ioii. The reculinnt lorce I- (we shall not
bother with the .t siihxript hcrc) can hc a conslaiit. a functioii of time, ii func-
tion 01 speed, ii luticlion o f piisitioii. or any comhinalion of these. At thic
time, u'c shall enamine some 0 1 these c a e s . leiiving others to Chapter 19.
where. with the aid of the \tudcnts' knowlcdgc (if differential equations,' wc
s h a l l he iniorc prcparcd l o crinsidcr Ihcni.

Case 1. Force Is a I'unction ofl'imc or a Constant. A piirticlc of mass t,z


acted oii by ii limc-\arying force F ( r ) i s shown i n Fig. 12.1. The plane on
which the hod? iiio\cc\ i\ lrictiiinlcss. Tlic Ihrcc 01 gravity i s equal and opposite
SECTION 12.1 RECTILINEAR TRANSLATION 5 13

Figure 12.1. Rectilinear translation.


to the normal force from the plane so that F(t) is the resultant force acting on
the mass. Newton’s law can then be given as follows:

Therefore,
d2.x
- F(t)
~~

(12.4)
dr2 m
Knowing the acceleration in the x direction, we can readily solve for F(f).
The inverse problem, where we know F ( t ) and wish to determine the
motion, requires integration. For this operation, the function F(t) must be
piecewise continuous? To integrate, we rewrite Eq. 12.4 as follows:

Now integrating both sides we get

where C, is a constant of integration. Integrating once again after bringing dt


from the left side of the equation to the right side, we get

(12.6)

We have thus found the velocity of the particle and its position as func-
tions of time to within two arbitrary constants. These constants can be readily
determined by having the solutions yield a certain velocity and position at
given times. Usually, these conditions are specified at time t = 0 and are
then termed initial conditions. That is, when t = 0,
V = V, and .x = xo (12.7)

These equations can be satisfied by substituting the initial conditions into


Eqs. 12.5 and 12.6 and solving for the constants C, and C,.
Although the preceding discussion centered about a force that is a func-
tion of time, the procedures apply directly to a force that i s a constant. The
following examples illustrate the procedures set forth.

>That is, the function haa only a finite number d finice discontinuities.
5 14 CHAPTER 12 PARTICLE DYNAMICS

Example 12.1
A 100-lb body is initially stationary on a 45" incline as shown in Fig.
12.2(a). The coefficient of dynamic friction pd between the block and
incline is .5. What distance along the incline must the weight slide before
it reaches a speed of 40 fthec?
A free-body diagram is shown in Fig. 12.2(b). Since the acceleration
is zero in the direction normal to the incline, we have from equilibrium
that

= 5N~= 70.7 Ib
100~0~4 (a) Figure 12.2. Body slides on an incline.

Now applying Newton's law in a direction along the incline, we have

Therefore,

2 = 11.38

Rewriting Eq. (b) we have

d ( 2 ) = I1.38dt

Integrating, we get

2
- = I1.38f + C, (C)

s = 11.38-
t2
2
+ C,t + C, (4
When f = 0, s = d d d t = 0, and thus C, = C, = 0. When d d d i = 40
ft/sec, we have for t from Eq. (c) the result

40 = I1.38t

Therefore,

f = 3.51 sec

Substituting this value off in Eq. (d), we can get the distance traveled to
reach the speed of 40 ftlsec as follows:
SECTION 12.3 RECTILINEAR TRANSLATION 5 15

rn Example 12.2
A charged particle is shown in Fig. 12.3 at time f = 0 between large par- "
allel condenser plates separated by a distance d in a vacuum. A time-vary-
ing voltage V (notation not to he confused with velocity) given as
V = 6 sin ut (a)
is applied to the plates. What is the motion of the particle if it has a charge
q coulombs and if we do not consider gravity'?
As we learned in physics, the electric field E becomes for this case

The force on the particle is qE and the resulting motion is that of rectilin-
ear translation. Using Newton's law we accordingly have
y-
Figure 12.3. Charged particle
dZx 6sinot between condenser plates.
z = q m d (C)

Rewriting Eq. (c). we have


dx 6 sin wt
d( x) = 4 7- df

Integrating, we get

d x - -- 6q c o s w t + c ,
-
dt wmd

Applying the initial conditions x = b and dx/dt = 0 when f = 0, we see


that C, = hq/mwd and C, = b. Thus, we get

The motion of the charged particle will he that of sinusoidal oscillation in


which the center of the oscillation drifts from left to right.

Case 2. Force Is a Function of Speed. We next consider the case where


the resultant force on the particle depends only on the value of the speed of
the particle. An example of such a force is the aerodynamic drag force on an
airplane or missile.
We can express Newton's law in the following form:
dV
~- ~ F(V) (12.8)
dr m
516 CHAPTEK I? PAKTICLL DYNAMICS
where F ( V ) is a piecewise continuous function reprcsenting the force in the
positive x direction. If we rearrange the equation in the following manner
(this is called separnrion of vuriuhlrs):

we can integrate to obtain

(12.9)

The result will give I as a function of V. However, we will generally prefer to


solve for V in terms o f f . The result will then have the form

v = H(t, c,)
where H is a function of t and the constant of integration C,. A second inte-
gration may now he performed by first replacing V by dxldt and bringing dt
over to the right side of the equation. We then get on integration

x = j H ( r , C, rir + c2 ( 12. I O )

The constants of integration are determined from the initial conditions of the
problcm.

Example 12.3
rn

A high-speed land racer (Fig. 12.4) is moving at a speed of 100 mlsec. The
1
resistance to motion of the vehicle is primarily due to aerodynamic drag.
which for this specd can he approximated as .2V2 N with V in mlsec. If the
vehicle has a mass of 4,000 kg, what distance will it coast before its speed
is reduced to 70 mlsec?
We have. using Newton's law for this case.
SECTION 12.3 RECTILINEAR TRANSLATION 5 17
Example 12.3 (Continued)
Integrating, we have

- _I -
- -5 x lo-% + c, (c)
V
Taking f = 0 when V = 100, we get C, = -1/100. Replacing V b y dx/dt,
we have next
df 5 x IO-% +-I
V - & = 100 (4
Separating variables once again, we get

dt - dx
-
5 x 10-5t + (1/100)

To integrate, we perform a change of variable. Thus

lJ = 5 x IO-% + (1/100)
:. dlJ = 5 x Io-sdf

We then have as a replacement for our equation

3 = 5 x 10-3 dx
II
Now integrating and replacing lJ, we get

(
In 5 x 1 0-5 f + l m )' = 5 x lo-%+ c,
When t = 0, we take x = 0 and so C, = In (l/lOO), We then have on
combining the logarithmic terms:

ln(5 x + I ) = 5 x 10-5.r (e)

Substitute V = 70 in Eq. (d); solve for f. We get t = 85.7 sec.


Finally, find x for this time from Eq. (e). Thus,

In[(5 x 10-3)(85.7) + I] = 5 x l 0 - h

Therefore,

The distance traveled is then 7.13 km.


518 CHAPTER I 2 I'AKI'ICLb; IUYNAMICS

Example 12.4
A conveyor i s inclined 20" from the horizontal ah shown in Fig. 12.5. As a
i-esult o l spillagr ciluil (in l l i z belt. Ihcrc i s a viscous friction Scirce hctwzen
body 11 and the helt. This foi-ce equals I). I Ihf per unit relative velocity
between body L, and thc hell. Thc helt moves at il conhtant speed VNup the
conveyor while inilially hrdy I ) hac a speed (V,,),, = 2 Il/scc relative 10
the ground i n :I direction doum the conveyor. What \peed V;, should the
belt have in order for hody 1) l o be ahlc to cvciitually approach a Lero
velocity rclatiw t o tlic ground? For hell speed VI,. and Sor the giuen initial
speed o l body 0, namely IV,,),, = Z ftlsec, detcmiinc the time when body
1) attains a !,peed of I ftlsec relative to the ground. l h c mass of ll i s 5 I b m

I.'iFure 12.5. A I h d y \lides ilvwn a convcyoi~hell WCI


with oil.

We hegin hy assigning axes for the prohlem a s I i l l i i u , s (see Fig. 12.6):

Y
Figure 12.6. Friction force f 15 0.1 limes the relati\c vclority
hrtwzcn hody D and the hrlr.

From kinematics we can say


SECTION 12.3 RECTILINEAR TRANSLATION 5 19

Example 12.4 (Continued)


For the friction forcefwe have
f = -(.MVD)qz = -(.lW, + VB)xni
We may now use Newton's law for body D in the x direction. Since
all velocities from here on will be relative to the ground, we can dispense
with the reference subscripts. Thus

When body D attains a theoretical permanent zero velocity relative to the


ground, V, and dV, are equal to zero. This gives us (noting that V, now
becomes V i ) dr

Now determine the time for body D to attain a velocity of 1 ft/sec


relative to the ground for a belt speed of 17.10 ft/sec. For this we go back
to Eq. (a).

dVD - (-.l)(V, + 17.10) + 5sin20' = -.lVD


dt

:. In V, = - -r3.22 + C,
5
When
f = 0, V, = 2 ftlsec, .: Ct = l n 2

Hence, on combining log terms3

In [$1 = -.644r

Set V, = 1 ftlsec. Solve for f .


f = --] '
,644
n(S00) =

'Note from this equation that V , = 2e4.M4' and that VD = -1.288e4.w' and so we
see that as t approaches infinity both of these quantities approach zero. Thus, theoretically
body D could appmach a permanent zero velacity relative to the gmnnd.
Case 3. Force Is a Function of Position. As the final case of this series.
we now consider the rectilinear motion of a body under the action of a force
that i s exprcssihlc cis ii function of pocilion. Pcrhaps the simplest example of
such a case i s Ihc frictionless miss-spi-ing system shown in Fig. 12.7. The
body i s shown at a position where the spring i s unstrained. The horizontal
force froni the spring at d l positions of the body clcarly w i l l be a function of
position .c,

Figure 12.7. Mn\s-spring systcm.

Nrwfi,,!',T In),. for position-dependent forces can hc giber] as

We caiiiiol scpur;ilc the variables for this form o l thc cquiltion as in previous
c:iscs since there are three variables (V. f. and.r). However, by using the chain
rulc of differentiation. w e can change thc left side of the equation 10 a inore
desirable tnrrn in the Ibllowinp manncr:

We ciin now scparate the variable? in Eq. 12.1 I as follows:

r17VdV = F ( s ) r l . r

Intcgrating. we pet

(12. I ? )

Solving 1,r Vand using rl.rldt i n i t s pliicc, we get


SECTION 12.3 RECTILINEAK TRANSLATION 521

Separating variables and integrating again, we get

For a given F(x), V and x can accordingly be evaluated as functions of time


from Eqs. 12.12 and 12.13. The constants of integration C, and C, are deter-
mined from the initial conditions.
A very common force that occurs in many problems is the lineur re-
storing,forct!. Such a force occurs when a body W is constrained by a lin-
ear spring (see Fig. 12.7). The force from such a spring will be
proportional to x measured from a position of W corresponding to the
undefiirmed configuration of the system. Consequently, the force will have
a magnitude of IKxI, where K, called the .spring consfunf, is the force
needed on the spring per unit elongation or compression of the spring. Fur-
thermore, when x bas a positive value, the spring force points in the nega-
tive direction, and when x is negative, the spring force points in the
positive direction. That is, it always points toward the position x = 0 for
which the spring is undeformed. The spring force is for this reason called a
restoring force and must be expressed as -Kx to give the proper direction
for all values of x .
For a nonlinear spring, K will not be constant but will be a function of
the elongation or shortening of the spring. The spring force is then given as

SpmE (12.14)

In the following example and in the homework problems, we examine


certain limited aspects of spring-mass systems to illustrate the formulations
of case 3 and to familiarize us with springs in dynamic systems. A more
complete study of spring-mass systems will be made in Chapter 19. The
motion of such systems, we shall later learn, centers about some stationary
point. That is, the motion is vibratury in nature. We shall study vibrations in
Chapter 19, wherein time-dependent and velocity-dependent forces are pre-
sent simultaneously with the linear restoring force. We are deferring this
topic so as to make maximal use of your course in differential equations that
you are most likely studying concurrently with dynamics. It i s important to
understand, however, that even though we defer vibration studies until later,
such studies are not something apart from the general particle dynamics
undertaken in this chapter.
522 CHAPTER 1 2 PARTICLE DYNAMICS

Example 12.5
A cart A (see Fig. 12.8) having a mass of 200 kg is held on an incline so as
to just touch an undeformed spring whose spring constant K is SO N/mm.
If body A is released very slowly, what distance down the incline must A
move to reach an equilibrium configuration'? If body A is released sud-
denly, what is its speed when it reaches the aforementioned equilibrium
configuration for a slow release'!

1 u -1

Figure 12.8. Cart-\pring \y\tem

As a first step, we have shown a free body of the vehicle in


Fig. 12.9. To do the first part of the problem, all we need do is utilize the

(200)'(Y xI
Figure 12.9. Free-hody diagram of cart

definition of the spring constant. Thus, if. 6represents the compression of


the spring, we can say:
SECTlON 12.3 RECnLlNEAK TRANSLATION 523

Example 12.5 (Continued)


Therefore,

Thus, the spring will be compressed ,01962 m by the cart if it is allowed to


move down the incline very slowly.
For the case of the quick release, we use Newton’s law. Thus, using
x in meters so that K is (SO)( 1,000) N/m:
200x = (200)(9.81)sin 30” - (5O)(l,OOOJ(x)

Therefore,

f = 4.905 - 250x

Rewritingi, we have

dV
V;i
;= 4.905 - 250x

Separating variables and integrating,

-v_2 - 4.9051 ~ 1 2 5 ~ ’+ C,
2

To determine the constant of integration C , , we set x = 0 when V = 0.


Clearly, C; = 0. As a final step, we set x = ,01962 m and solve for V.

V = {2[(4.905)( ,01962) - (125)( .01962)’]\” ’

The following example illustrates an interesting device used by the U S .


Navy to test small devices for high, prolonged acceleration. Hopefully, the
length of the problem will not intimidate you. Use is made of the gas laws
presented in your elementary chemistry courses.
524 CHAPTER 1 2 PARTICLE DYNAMICS

Example 12.6
An air gun is used to test the ability of small devices to withstand high prrr
longed accelerations. A “floating piston” A (Fig. 12.10).on which the device
to he tested is mounted, is held at position C while region I> is tilled with
highly compressed air. Region E is initially at atmospheric pressure hut is
entirely sealed from the outside. When “fired,” a quick-release mechanism
releases the piston and it accelerates rapidly toward the other end of the gun, Val

where the trapped air in E “cushions” the motion so that the piston will begin
eventually to return. However, as it starts back. the high pressure developed
in E is released through valve F and the piston only returns a short distance.
Suppose that the piston and its test specimen have a combined mass
of 2 Ihm and the pressure initially in the chamber D is 1,000 psig (above
atmosphere). Compute the speed of the piston at the halfway point of the Figure 12.10. Air gun.
air gun if we make the simple assumption that the air in D expands accord-
ing t o p = constant and the air in E is compressed also according to p t > =
~ o n s t a n t .Note
~ that I ’ is the specific volume (Le., the volume per unit
mass). Take / ‘ o f this fluid at D to he initially ,207 ftg/lbm and oin E to he
initially 13.10 ft’llbm. Neglect the inertia of the air.
The force on the piston results from the pressures on each face, and
we can show that this force is a function o f x (see Fig. 12.10 for refercnce
axes). Thus, examining the pressure plj first for region D , we have, from
initial conditions,
) c [ci,cno
(pf,~’fj= , + 14.7)(144)](.~07)
=m oo (a)
Furrherrnore, the mass of air D given as MI, is determined from initial data as

where (V,,), is the volume of the air in D initially. Noting that p7) = const.
and then using the right side of Eq. (a) for pf,tiL, as well as the first part of
Eq. (h) for cD, we can determine pf, al any position x of the piston:

‘YOU should r ~ dliom l your earlier work 10 physics and chemistry thilr “U we using 11em
the isothermal form of the quiltion of state for a perfect gas. Two factors of caution should be
pointed out ~ ~ I a t i vtoethe use of chis expression. First. at the high pressures involved in p‘uf ofthe
expansion, the pedcct gas m o d i is only an approximation for the gas. and so the yuarion ol state
of a perfect gas that gives uspri = Consrant is only apprurimale. Fnnhemorr. the assumption 01
isotherm4 expansion gives only an approximatim of the actual process. Perhaps il better approx-
imation is to ilssumr an adiaharic expansion (i.e. no heat wmler). This is dune in Prohlem 12.130,
SECTION 12.3 RECTILINEAR TRANSLATTON 525

Example 12.6 (Continued)


We can similarly get p, as a function of x for region E . Thus,
( p E u E ) o= (14.7)(144)(13.10) = 27,700
and

Hence, at position x of the piston


27,700 - 27,700 - 27,700
PE=--- vE V E / M , - (rr/4)(Iz)(50 - x)/2.88

Therefore,
101,600
PE = 5O-x
Now we can write Newton’s law for this case. Noting that V without
subscripts is velocity and not volume,

M V -dV zl2
--
50 - x (4
where M is the mass of piston and load. Separating variables and integrat-
ing, we get
M V Z = $[293,00OInx+ 101,6001n(50-x)]+C,
-
2 (e)

To get the constant C,, set V = 0 when x = 2 ft. Hence,


C, = - $ (293,000 In 2 + 101,600In 48)
Therefore,
C, = 468,000
Substituting C, in Eq. (e), we get

V = (6) { ~ [ 2 9 3 , 0 0 0 l n x + 1 0 1 , 6 0 0 l n ( 5 0 ~ x ) ] - 4 6 8 , 0 0 0
In

We may rewrite this as follows noting that M = 2 Ibdg:


V = 566[23 In x + 7.98 ln(50 - x) - 46.81”’
At x = 25 ft, we then have for V the desired result:
V = 566(231n 25 + 7.98 In 25 - 46.8)”’
526 CHAPTER I ? PARTICLE DYNAMICS

*Example 12.7
A light stiff riid i s pinned at it and i s constrailled by two linear springs.
K, = 1.000 Nitn and K? - = 1.2(X) Nim. The spring are urirtretched when the
rod i s horimntal. At the right end o f the rod. ii mass M = 5 kg i s attached. If
Ihc rod i s rotated 12" doc.kwi.sc front a horizontal ciintiguration and thcn
released, what i s the spccd of the mass when the rod returns to a position cor-
i r n ~ with miss M attached'!
responding to the .s/& ~ ~ q ~ r i l i h r iposilion

Fieure
weightless

A free-hody diagram 01 the systcin for pi.si/iw H i s shown


i n Fig. 12.12(;1) end a free-hody diagram o f the pailicle M i s shown i n

F . mI F.B.U. I I
(a, (hl

Figure 12.12. Frcc-body iliagrams of thc system and the pnniclr il,r positive c)

Fig. I2.12(b). The spring forces F; aiid F, 011 tlic rod arc givrn as follows
for small positive ro1iitions H :
4 = l 3000N
( . 3 ) ( H ) ( K ,=
F2 = - ( . I ) ( B ) ( K ? )= - 1 2 0 O N (ai
where 8 is in radians. I n the first free hody. we w i l l think 01 the rod as a
illassless perfectly irigid Icvcr iih sludied i n high school or perhaps even
SECTION 12.3 RECTILINEAR TRANSLATION 521

Example 12.7 (Continued)


earlier. Then we can say for the forces on the secund of our free bodies
stemming from the springs5
F; (fromF;) = -4
= -300ON
1
(fromFz) = ? ( F , ) = 4 O N
F;
We can now give Newton's Law for M as follows using y for the
vertical coordinate of the particle:
5 y = -5g-300e-40e
... j i = - g - 3 4 50 e (b)

Next, from kinematics, we can say for small rotation

Now going back to Eq.(b) we replace y by

in order to be able to separate variables. Also replace O by yl.3. We then


may say
ydy=(-227y-g)dy

Integrating

When O = - 12" = -(&)(2n) rad = - ,2094 rad,8 = y = 0. We can


360
then solve for the constant of integration using y = .3 8.

L J

Hence,

SNote that a positive B gives negative values for F ; and F; on M and vice versa. It is for
this reason that we require the minus signs.
528 C H A PTER 1 2 PAKTICL~.U Y N A M I ~ S

Example 12.7 (Continued)


For the stiitic equilihrium configuratior of the rod. we require firoin
Fig. 12.12(al

Suhstituting values irim Eqs. (a) and noting that we are only using the
magnitudes of the forces ahiive ii)r the required ncSativc ino~iiciitswc get

-(SI(9,Xl)(.3) - (300B,/ j(.3) - ~ 1 2 0 B , ~ , l l ~=


. l l0

Solving for (I,,(,

BE</ = -. 1-1-13 rad

Hcncc
y ,,,, = (.3)(-. 1443) = -.0432x 111

Now gii to Eq. ( d j and suhstitutc :,/. Wc get

y,2<#= ,r[(-l13.5)(-.0432X)' - ('~.X1~(-.04328)- ,16831


112

The desired result i s then

YE. = 0.968 m / s

._ .. .. .

12.4 A Comment
111 Part A . we haw considcrcd only rccliliiiwr inotiiins iif particles. Actu;rlly
i n Chapter I I, we coiisidercd the coplanar tiiotiiiii of particle having a ciin-
stili11 acceleriition ( 1 1 grabity i n tlic minus :dircctiiin nnd x r o ;rcceleration iii
the I. direction. These were the hulli.sfic. prohlcms. We treated them earlicr i n
Chapter I I because rhc considcl-;itioiis were priniarily kinematic i n iiature. In
[lie p r e x i i t chaplcr. thcy ciirrcspond to the coplanar niotiiiti 0 1 a particle hav-
ing ii constilnl iorce in the ininus :direction ;rlong with an initial velocity
coniponent iii this direction, plus a zero tioire i n thc I. dircctiiin, with a possi-
ble initial veliicity compiinent i n (his dircctioii. Therelure. i n Ihc cimtcxt ( i t
Chapter 12 we would hn\c intcgratcd two scalar equations of Newton's law
i n rectangular ciimpiinents (Hq\, 12.3) lor ii single particlc. The resulling inw
tion i s soinctiiiics called <.urvilim,,ir traiislation.
12.1. A particle of mass 1 slug is moving in a constant Sorce 12.6. Do Problem 12.5 with the belt system inclined 15" with
field given as the horizontal so that end B is above end A.
F = 3i+ l 0 j Sklb ~

The particle starts from rest at position (3, 5 , -4). What is the 12.7. A drag racer can develop a t u q u e of 200 Ft-lb on each of
pasitian and velocity of the particle at time I = 8 sec? What is the the rear wheels. If we assume that this maximum torque is main-
position when the particle is moving at a speed of 20 ftlsec? tained and that there is no wind friction, what is the time to travel
a quarter mile from a standing start'? What is the speed of the vehi-
12.2. A particle of mass m is moving i n a constant force field
cle at the quarter-mile mark? The weight of the racer and the driver
given as
combined is 1,600Ih. For simplicity, neglect the rotational effects
F = 2mi ~ I2mjN of the wheels.
Give the vector equation for r(r) of the panicle if, at time r = 0, it
has a vzlocity y) given as
y , = hi + I2j + 3k misec
Also, at time I = 0. it has a position given as
ri, = 3i + 2 j + 4k m Figure P.12.7.
What are coordinates of the body at the instant that the body
reaches its maximum height, yn,,,'! 12.8. A truck is moving down a 10" incline. The driver strongly
12.3. A block is permitted to slide down an inclined surface. applies his brakes to avoid a collision and the truck decelerates at
The coefficient of friction is .05. If the velocity of the block is 30 the steady rate of I d s e c 2 . If the static coefficient of friction p,
ftJsec on reaching the bottom of the incline, how far up was it between the load Wand the truck trailer is .3, will the load slide or
released and how many seconds has it traveled? remain stationary relative to the truck trailer? The weight of W is
4,500 N and it is not held to the truck by cables.

Figure P.12.3.
12.4. An arrow is shot upward with an initial speed of 80 ftisec. Figure P.12.8.
How high UP does it go and how long does it take to reach the
maximum elevation if we neglect friction'? 12.9. A simple device for measuring reasonably uniform accel-
12.5. A mass D at I = 0 is moving to the left at a speed of .6 erations is the pendulum. Calibrate Oof the pendulum for vehicle
mlsec relative to the ground on a belt that is moving at constant accelerations of 5 St/sec2, 10 ftlsec2, and 20 f!Jsec2. The bob
speed to the right at 1.6 misec. If there is coulombic friction p~ weighs I Ih. The bob is connected to a post with a flexible string.
sent with N,, = 3,how long does it take before the speed of D rel-
ative In the belt is .3 mlsec to the left?

A B
Figure P.12.5. Figure P.12.9.

529
12.10. A piston is bcing moved through a cylinder. The piston is
y,
moved at a canstant speed ol .6 mlsec relative to the ground hy
a force F,The cylinder is free to move along the ground on small
wheels. There is a coulombic friction fbrce between the piston and 30 iILd = .4
the cylinder such that p,j = .3. What distance d must the piston
', F - IOON
move relative to the ground to advancc .01 m along the cylinder if
the cylinder is stationary at thc outset? The piston has a mass of
2.5 kg and the cylinder has a mass 5 kg.
Figure P.12.14.

12.15 A block A of niass M is heing pullcd up an incline by a


force F. If p,j is 3,at what angle a will the force F cause the max-
imum steady accrlrrafirm'?
Figure P.12.10.
12.11. A force F of 5,000 N is suddcnly applied to mass A .
What is the speed after A has moved . I m? Mass B is a triangular
block of uniform thickness.

&f4= 20 kg
+d = .3
F = 5,000 N

Figure P.12.15.

Figure P.12.11. 12.16. A IO-kN force is applied


.. to hody B whose mass is 15 kg.
Body A has a mass of 20 kg. What is the speed of B after it moves
12.12. A fighter plane is moving on the ground at a speed of 350
3 m? Take p(, = .2X. The center uf gravity of body A is at its geo-
k d h r when the oilot deolovs the brakine oarachutc. How far does
L I - I
metric center
the plane move to get down to a speed of 200 km/hr'! The plane has
a mass of 8 Mg.The drag is 27.SV2 with Vin m/s ( 1 A4g = IO'kg).

12.13. Blocks A and A are initially stationary. How far does A


move d u n g B if A moves .2 m relative 10 the ground' Figure P.12.16.

12.17. A constant fnrcc F is applied to the hody A when 11 is in


thc position shown What should F be if A is to attain a velocity of
2 mli after moving I m'!The spring is unstretched at the position
shown.

v
K I ,.' ,A K = 5,000 Nlm
Figure P.12.13. W, = 480 N
x IiL = 775 N
12.14. A 30-N block at lhe vmition \how" ha* a furce t = Io0 N u , = 36
applied suddenly. what is i t q velocity after moving I m? Also, how
far does the block move before st~pplllg?Member AB weighs 200M. Figure P.12.17.

530
12.18. Two slow moving steam roller vehicles are moving in Force
opposite directions on a straight path. They start at A and B at the
time f = ,O. How far from point A do they pass each other? What
are their speeds when this happens? [Hint: Show that the time for
this is 1.5 hours.] Note f is in hours.
Time
L

r
22,695 km ~

- 5 sec 10sec
Figure P.12.21.
A 'A VB 8
12.22. A body of mass I kg is acted on by a force as shown in
V, = 6f i.q'?; + 3 kmlhr V, = 5 + t2" + 0.Sr"' kmihr
the diagram. If the velocity of the body is zero at r = 0, what is
the velbcity and distance traversed when r = 1 min? The force
Figure P.12.18. acts lor only 45 sec.
12.19. As you learned in chemistry, the cueficirnt ofviscosity g
is a measure, roughly speaking, of the "stickiness" of a fluid. To Force
measure this property for a highly viscous liquid-like oil, we let a
small sphere of metal of radius R descend in a container of the liq-
uid. From fluid mechanics, we know that a drag force will be
developed from the oil given by the formula
F = hnpVR Time
10 sec 30sec 45 sec
This relation is called Stoke's luw. The other forces acting on the Figure P.12.22.
sphere are its weight (take the density of the sphere as psp,,,j and
the buoyant force, which is the weight of the oil displaced (take 12.23. Three coupled streetcars are moving down an incline at a
the density of the oil as poJ. The sphere will reach a constant speed of 20 k d h r when the brakes are applied for a panic stop.
velocity called the tenninul velocity denoted as VTerm,.Show that All the wheels lock except for car B, where due to a malfunction
all the brakes on the front end of the car do not operate. How far
p = -- does the system move and what are the forces in the couplings
9"
g Rk " -Poi,)
Z (Pspherc between the cars? Each streetcar weighs 220 kN and the coeffi-
cient of dynamic friction gd between wheel and rail is 30. Weight
12.20. A force F is applied to a system of light pulleys to pull is equally distributed on the wheels.
body A . If F is 10 kN and A has a mass of 5,000 kg, what is the
speed of A after 1 sec starting from rest'?

Figure P.12.23.

12.24. A body having a mass of 30 Ibm is acted on by a force


given by
F = 30tz + e-' Ib
If the velocity is 10 IVsec at r = 0, what is the body's velocity
and the distance traveled when r = 2 sec?

Figure P.12.20. 12.25. A body of mass 10 kg is acted on by a force in the x


direction, given by the relation F = 10 sin 61 N. If the body has a
12.21. A force represented as shown acts on a body having a velocity of 3 d s e c when f = 0 and is at position x = 0 at that
mass of I slug. What is the position and velocity at f = 30 sec if instant, what is the position reached by the body from the origin at
the body starts from rest at f = O? f = 4 sec? Sketch the displacement-versus-time curve.

531
12.26. A water skier is shown d a n g l i q from a kite that is towed 12.29. A hlock A of m d S S 500 kg is pulled by a force of 10,000
via a light nylon cord by a powerboat at a constdnt speed of 30 N as shown. A second block R of mass 200 kg rests on small fric-
mph. The powerhoat with passenger weighs 700 Ih and the man tionless rollers on top of block A . A wall prevents block B from
and kite together weigh 270 Ih. If we neglect the mass of the moving 10 the left. What is the speed of hlock A after I sec start-
cable, we can take it as a straight line as shown in thc diaeram. ing from a stationary position? The coefficient of friction pd is .4
The horizontal drag from the air on the kite plus man is estimatcd hetween A and the horizontal surface.
from fluid mechanics to he 80 Ih. What is the tension in the cahle'?
If the cable suddenly snaps, what is the instantznerus hurimntal
relative acceleration hetween the kite system and the powerhoar?

Figure P.12.29,

12.30. Block B weighing SOII N rests on block A, which weighs


Figure P.12.26. 300 N. The dynamic coefficient of friction hetween contact sur-
faces i s .4. At wall C there are rollers whose friction we can
12.27. A mdSs M is held hy stiff light telescoping rods that can neglect. What is the acceleration of body A when a force F of
elongate or shorten Sreely hut cannot hcnd. Each rod is pin con- 5,000 N is applied?
nected at the ends A , R . C. and 11. The system is o n a horimntal.
frictionless surface. Two linear springs having spring constants K ,
= 880 N/m and K2 = 1,400 N/m are connected to the rods as
shown in the diagram. If mass M = 3 kg is moved ,003 m to thr
right and i s released from rest, what is the equation for the vcloc-
ity in the x direction as a function of*'? What is the speed of the
mass when it returns to the vertical position of the rods?
y

Figure P.12.30.

12.31. A hndy A of mass I Ibm is forced to move by the device


shown. What total force is exerted on the body at time f = 6 sec?
What is the maximum total force on the body, and when is the first
K , = 880 Niin
timc this force is developed aftzrr = O?
Kz = 1,400 Nlm
M=lkg

1cos 2t ft/sec

Figure P.12.27,
21' fU%C
12.28. A force given as 5 sin 3f Ib acts on a mas!, 01 I slug. What
is the position o f t h e mass at f = 10 sec'? Determine the total dis-
tance traveled. Assume the motion started from rest. Figure P.12.31.

532
12.32. Do Problem 12.10 for the case where there is viscous 12.37. Mass R is on small rollers and moves down the incline. It
friction between piston and cylinder given as 150 NImJsec of rela- is connected to a linear spring, which at the position shown is
tive speed. Also, what is the maximum distance 1 the piston can stretched from its undeformed length of 2 m to a length of 5 m.
advance relative to the cylinder? What is the speed of R after it moves 1 m? Use Newton's law as
well as the x coordinate shown in the diagram.
12.33. The high-speed aerodynamic drag on a car is .02V2 Ib
with V in ftlsec. If the initial speed is 100 mihr, how far will the
car move before its speed is reduced to 60 miihr? The mass of the
car is 2.000 Ibm.

12.34. A block slides on a film of oil. The resistance to motion


of the block is proportional to the speed of the block relative to the
incline at the rate of 7.5 N/m/sec. If the block is released from
rest, what is the rerminul sneed? What is the distance moved after
I O sec?

MA= 40 kg
M B = 20 kg
p d = .2
0" lo = 2 m (""stretched length of spcing)
K = 20 N/m
Figure P.12.34. Figure P.12.37.

1 35. When you study fluid mechanics, you w am th the


drag Don a hody when moving through a fluid with mass density 12.38. A wedge of wood having a specific gravity of 0.6 i s
I
p i s given as ?C#Vz A where Vis the velocity of the body rela- forced into the water by a 150-lb force. The wedge is 2 ft in width.
tive to the fluid A is the frontal area of the object: and C,, is the (a) What is the depth d?
so-called coeficienr of drag usually determined by experiment. (h) What is the speed of the wedge when it has moved
A racing plane on landing is moving at a speed of 350 k d h r upward 0.48 ft after releasing the 150-lb force assuming the
when a braking parachute is deployed. This parachute has a wedge does not turn as it rises? Recall, a buoyant force equals the
frontal area of 70 mz and a C, = I .2. The plane has a frontal area weight of the volume displaced (Archimedes).
of 20 m2 and a C, = 0.4. If the plane and parachute have a com-
bined mass of 8 Mg, how long does it take to go from 350 k m h r
to 200 k m h r by just coasting? Take p = 1.2475 kglm' and
neglect rolling resistance from the tires. There is no wind.

Figure P.12.35. wI

12.36. In the previous problem, what is the largest frontal area


of the braking parachute if the maximum deceleration of the plane
w
-
is to be 58's when at a speed of 350 k d s the parachute is first Y
deployed? Figure P.12.38.

533
12.39. A poistm dart pun i c chrwn. The cross-sectional area 12.44. The spring shnwn i s nrmlmcar. That is, K i s not a COII-
inside the tuhe i s I in?. Thc dart heing hlown wcighs 3 I M The stant. hut i s a function of the extension of the qpring. If K = 2r +
dart gun how haq a viscous icsistilnce given LEI .1 WL pcr (init 3 Ihlin. with ~I ineastired in inches, wh;e i s the speed of the m a ~ s
velocity in ftlszc. The hunter applies a constant pressure p at the when x = 0 alter i t i s released from B state of rest at a poaition 3
mouth i f the gun. Exprc\q the d a t i o n between p, V (velocity). in. firom the equilihrium position?Thc mass olthe body i h I slug.
;md f. What cirnstmt pressure p i\ nccdcd t o cause the dart t u
rcach a speed of hO ftlscc in 2 x c ' ! Aswine Ihe dart pun i\ long
Nonlinear Smooth
enough.

I'
- Figure F.12.44.
Dart gun
Figure P.12.3Y. 12.45. A particle nf mass m i c suhiect tu the following furce
firld:
12.40. Using the diagram for Pnrhlem 12.5. assume that there i s
a luhricant hctwcen the body I ) of maw 5 Ihm and the hclt such F = mi + 4mj + lhmk Ih
thnl there is a viscous friction Iurce given a~ .I Ih pcr unit izlativr I n addition. i t i s suhlectcd to a frictional frxcc f givcn as
velocity between the hodv and the hclt. The helt moves at a uni-
form speed of 5 ftlscc to thc right m d initially the hndy has a J = -mii - myj + 2 r n 3 Ih
speed to the lcft of 2 il/ec relatiw to ground. At what time later
Thc particle i s stationary at the origin at time I = 0. What i s the
docs thc hody have a iero in\lanlaneous vclrrcity relative to the
podion of the particlc at time I = I SCC?
ground'!

cpeed. how long docs i t take lor the hody to \low down to half of
i t s initial speed o f 2 ftlsec r e l a t i w t o the ground'! 12.47. I f in the previous problem, the heehcc has reached a max-
imum height of 92.75 ft, what i s the speed when i t returns to the
12.42. One of thc largest (rt the supertankers in the world today ground, assuming it docs !not reach its teimiiial velocity'? I f i t has
i s the S.S.Clohfik Londo,r. having a weight when fully laaded of ieachcd thc terminal velocity, what i s your answer'?
476,292 tons. The thrust needed to keep this ship moving iit I O
knots i s 50 kN. If the drag on the ?hip from thc watcr i s propor- 12.48. A rocket weighing 5.000 Ih i s fired venically from a te\t
tional t o the speed, how long w'ill it take for thic ship to slow down Eland on thc ground. A constant thrust of 20,000 Ib is developed
from I O knots IO 5 knots :~llerthe engines arc chut down'? (Thr for 20 scconds. l f j u s t as an exercise, we do not tdke intu account
a n s ~ e may
r make you wonder nhmt thc safety of such ships.) the amount of fucl hurned, and if wc ncglect air resistance, h i w
high up does this hypothctical rocket g a ? Note that neglecting luel
12.43. A cantilwcr heam i s shrwn. It i s ohmved that thc verti- conrumption i \ a ceiious error! In the next prohlem WE will inves-
cal detlection of the rnd A i s dircctly p n p r t i o n i t l 10 I I vertical tip tigaie the case of the variahle mas? pmhlem.
load F provided that thih load i s no1 too exce\\ive. A hody H of
inass 200 kg, when attached t i l the end of the heam with F *12.49. Calculate the velocity after 20 seconds for the case
removed, C ~ U S C Sa dcilcction of 5 inni there after all motion has whcrc there i s a rlrrrm.sr of mass of a rocket of 100 Ihmlsc
ceased. What i s the spccd o f this hody if i t i s attachcd suddcnly t o result of cxhaust combustion products leaving the rocket at a spzed
the heam and has dcsccnded 3 mm'! of 6,IH)O ft/sec iclativr til thr rockzt. At the outset the mckct
weighs 5,000 Ih. [Hint; Stan with Newton's law in the form F =
F (d1dI)fmV)where F i s the weight, a vziriahla that decreases as fiiel
i s hurned. The first term o n the right side of this equation i s
m(dV1dl) whcrc m i s the instantaneous mass of thc rockct and u n ~
A
hurned fuel. Now there i s a f m c c on the IO(1 Ihmlsec ofcomhustion
Figure P.12.43. products heing expelled from the rocket at a speed relativc to the

534
rocket of 6,000 ft/sec. The rate of change of linear momentum 12.52. An electron having a charge of -e coulombs is moving
associated with this force clearly must be- (dm/dt)(6,M)o). The between two parallel plates in a vacuum with an impressed voltage
reaction to this force for this momenNm change is on the rocket in E. If at t = 0, the electron has a velocity V, at an angle a. with the
the direccion of flight of the rocket and must he added to m(dV/dt). horizontal in the q plane, what will be the trajectory equation tak-
The force exerted by the exhaust gases on the rocket is a propul- ing the initial conditions to be at the origin ofxy? Show that
sive force and is called the thrust of the rocket. Again, neglect drag
of the atmosphere since it will be small at the outset because of low
velocity and small later because of the thinness of the atmosphere,] y = - eE
+ x2
+xtanao
2m (voc o ~ a , ) ~
12.50. We start with a cylindrical tank with diameter 50 ft con-
taining water up to a depth of 10 ft. Initially the solid movable
cylindrical piston A having a diameter of 20 ft and a centerline where m is the mass of the electron. Note we have neglected grav-
colinear with the centerline of the tank is positioned so that its top ity here since it is very small compared with the electrostatic force.
is flush with the bottom of the tank. Now the cylinder is moved
upward so that the following data apply at the instant of interest
assuming the free surface of the water remains flat:
4 =2ft & = 5 ft/sec i;z = 3 ft/sec2
What is the external force from the ground support on the water Y
needed for this condition not including the force required to sup-
port the dead weight of the water?
-
_r
-
- acuum

Figure P.12.52.

12.53. A system of light pulleys and inextensible wire connects


Figure P.12.50.
bodies A, B, and C a s shown. If the coefficient of friction between
12.51. A sleeve slides downward along a pipe on which there is C and the support is .4, what is the acceleration of each body?
dry friction with pd = .35.A wire having a constant tension of 80 Take 4 as 100 kg, MB as 300 kg, and h& as 80 kg.
N is attached to the sleeve and moves with it always retaining the
same angle a with the horizontal. If the sleeve weighs 60 N, what
should a be for the sleeve to move for I O seconds before stopping
after starting downward with an initial speed of 5 d s ?

I
Y
Figure P.12.51. Figure P.12.53.

535
536 CIIAPTER 12 PARTICI.K IIYNAMICS

Part B: Cylindrical Coordinates: Central


Force Motion
12.5 Newton's Law
for Cylindrical Coordinates
In cylindrical coordinates we caii cxpress Newton's law as follows:
I;_ = ,n(l+ ~ 702)

F" = m(T4 ~ 2i6~


I: =

If the motion is known. it is a simple iniitter lo ascertain tlic lorce coni-


ponents using Eqs. 12.15. Thc inverse prohlcni of determining the inotion
given the forces is particulai-ly difficult i n this casc. The reason lor this diffi-
culty, a s you may havc alrcady learned in your differential equations course.
is that Eqs. 12.15a and 12.15b iirc I I , I I I / ~ I W O ~ fcir
" all lorce fnnctions. For this
reason, we cannot present integration proccdures as in Part A of this chapter.
The following example will sene t o illustrate the kind of prihlem w e are able
to solve with the methods thus far presented in t h i h chapter.

Example 12.8
A platform shown in Fig. 12.13 has a constant angular velocity coequal to
5 radlsec. A mass L( of 2 kg slides in a frictionless chute attached to the
plaU'orm. .The mass is connected via a light inextensible cahle to a linear
spring having a spring constant K of 20 Nlm. A swivel connector at A
allows the cable to turn freely relative to the spring. The spring is un-
stretched when the mass B is at the center ('of the plalltirm. If the mass B
is releascd at I = 200 m m from il stationary position relative to the pia-
form, what i s its speed relative to the platform when it has m o v c d Lo posi-
tion r = 400 min'? What is the transverse force on the hody B at this
position'!
We have hcrc a coplanar motion for which cylindrical coordinates iirc
iniist useful. Because the motion is coplanar. we can use r instead of T with
no ambiguity. Applying Eq. 12.151 first, we have

-20r = 2 ( r - 2 5 r ) Figure 12.13. Slider on mvaiing platform. j


S E C TIO N 12 5 NEWTON'S L AW FOR CYLINDRICAL COORDINATES 531
I Example 12.8 (continued)
Therefore,

r = 15r (a)

As in Example 12.5, we can replace i. so as to allow for a separation of


variables.

Therefore,

Vr dV, = 15rdr

Integrating, we get

I - 15r2
-

2 2 + c,
To determine C,. note that, when r = .20m, = 0. Hence,

600
cl =-2
Equation (b)then becomes

Vj = 15rZ ~ ,600 (C)

When r = .40 m, we get for VFfrom Eq. (c):

v, = 1.

This is the desired velocity relative to the platform.


To get the transverse force G, go to Eq. 12.15b. Substituting the
known data into the equation, we have

Fs = 2[(.40)(0) + (2)(1.342)(5)]

F, = 26.W.N'

This is the transverse force on the mass B.


538 CHAPTER 12 PARTICLE DYNAMICS

Although you will he asked to solve problems similar to the preceding


example, the main use of cylindrical coordinates in Part B of this chapter will
be for gravitational central force motion. We shall first present the basic
physics underlying this motion expressing certain salient characteristics of
the motion, and then we shall amve at a point where we can effectively
employ cylindrical coordinates to describe the motion.

12.6 Central Force Motion-


An Introduction
At this time, we shall consider the motion of a particle on which the resultant
force is always directed toward some point.fired in inertial space. Such forces
are termed centrul forces and the resulting motion of this particle is called
central force motion. A simple example of this is the case of a space vehicle
moving with its engine off in the vicinity of a large planet (see Fig. 12.14).
i

Figure 12.14. Body m rnovins about B planet.

The space vehicle is very small compared to the planet and may be consid-
ered to be a particle. Away from the planet's atmosphere, this vehicle will
experience no frictional forces, and, if no other astronautical bodies are rea-
sonably close, the only force acting on the vehicle will be the gravitational
attraction of the fixed planet.' This force is directed toward the center of the
planet and, from the gravitational law, is given as

In the ensuing problems for this chapter and also for Chapter 14, we
shall need to compute the quantity GM in the equation above. For this pur-
pose, note that, for any particle of mass m at the surface of any planet of mass
M and radius R, by the law of gravitation:

'We are neglecting drag developed from collisions of the space vehicle with solar dwt
partid.%.
SECTION 12.7 GRAVITATIONAL CENTRAL FORCE MOTION 539

where g is the acceleration of gravity at the surface of the planet. Solving for
GM, we get
GM = g R 2 (12.17)
Thus, knowing g and R for a planet, it is a simple matter tu find GM needed
for orbit 'calculations around this planet.
As pointed out earlier, the motion of a space vehicle with power off is
an important example of a central force motion-more precisely a gravitu-
tionul cehtral force motion. The vehicle is usually launched from a planet and
accelereFd to a high speed outside the planet's atmosphere by multistage
rockets (8ee Fig. 12.15). The velocity at the final instant of powered flight is
called the burnout velocity. After burnout, the vehicle undergoes gravitational
central force motion. Depending on the position and velocity at burnout, the
vehicle can go into an orbit around the earth (elliptic and circular orbits are
possible), or it can depart from the earth's influence on a parabolic or a
hyperbolic trajectory In all cases, the motion must be coplanar.

Space
J vehicle

Figure 12.15. Launching a space vehicle

In the following sections, we shall make a careful detailed study of


gravitational central force trajectories. Those who do not have the time for
such a detailed study of the trajectories can still make many useful and inter-
esting calculations in Chapter 14 using energy and momentum methods that
we shall soon undertake.

"12.7 Gravitational Central Force Motion


d--
For gravitational central force motion, we shall employ an inertial reference
q in the plane of the trajectory with the origin of the reference taken at the
point P toward which the central force is directed (see Fig. 12.16). We shall
use cylindrical coordinates r a n d 9for describing the motion. Because z = 0
at all times, these coordinates are also called polar coordinates. Since the mo-
tion is coplanar in plane xy, we can delete the overbar used previously for r Figure 12.16. xy is ineltial reference in plane
with no danger of ambiguity. of the trajectory.
540 ('HAPIER 12 I'AKTICI F DYNAMICS

Imt us consider Nrwron's Iuw for ii body of m i s s in, which i s moving


near a star OS m a s s M:
dV - -(; Min
(12.18)
in
~~~~~

-
dl r2

Canceling m and using cylindrical coordinates and componenls, we can ex-


press the cquatiuti above i n the following manner:

(i' - r d 2 ) E , + i r 8 + 2r8)t, = -
GM ( 12. I9 1
r2
Since trand i arc identical vecturs, the scalar equations o f the preceding cqua-
tion become
r &2 = -GMIr? (12.20a)
,-B + 2i-8 = 0 (12.20hi
Equation 12.20b can he expressed i n the lumi

1 (r28)= 0 (I2.2 I )
Y dl

ah you can readily verify. We ciin conclude from Ey. 12.21 that
. .
r 2 0 = constant = C (12.22)

Equation 12.22 leads to an iniportant conclusion. To estahlish this, coli-


sider the arca swept nut by r during a time dr, which in Fig. 12.17 i s the shaded

I &--
\

Figurc 12.17. Purriclc r w r r p UUI awn

area. B y cnnsidcring Ihis area to hc tliiit OS a triaiigle, we can cxprcss it as

Dividiiig through hy dr. we have

Now dAId1 i s the rate iit which area i s heing swept nut by r : i t i s called uiwril
i.?lwit?. And, sincc $8 i s a cniistiint Sur each gravitational central force
rnolion (see t k . 12.22). wc can conclude that the areal velocity i s a c o i l m i i t
SECTION 12.7 GRAVITATIONAL CENTRAL FORCE MOTION 541

for each gravitational central force motion. (This is Kepler’s second law.)
This means that when r is decreased, 0 must increase, etc. The constant, un-
derstand, will be different for each different trajectory.
In order to determine the general trajectory, we replace the independent
variable f of Eq. 12.20a. Consider first the time derivatives of r :

(12.23)

where we have used Eq. 12.22 to replace d0ldt. Next, consider r in a similar
manner:

(12.24)

Again, wing Eq. 12.22 to replace dO/dt, we get

(12.25)

For convenience, we now introduce a new dependent variable, u = l / r , into


the right side of this equation

By replacing i: in this form in Eq. 12.20a and e2 in the form C2u4from Eq.
12.22, and finally, r by l/u, we get

Canceling terms and dividing through by C 2 , we have

GM (12.26)
C2
This is a simple differential equation that you may have already studied in
your diffqrential equations course. Specifically, it is a second-order differen-
tial equation with constant coefficients and a constant driving function
GMIC2. We want to find the most general function .(e), which when substi-
tuted into the differential equation satisfies the differential equation-i.e.,
renders it an identity. The theory of differential equations indicates that this
general solution is composed of two parts. They are:
542 CHAPTER 12 PARrlCLE DYNAMICS

I . The general solution of the diffcrrntial equation with the right side of the
differcntial equation set equal tu 7e1-(Iand hence given a s

This solution is called thc ~ n i n ~ i l e i n ~ ~ r(or


i l ul ito~~~r r ~ i , g ~ ~ r rsolution,
ous) u,

2. An? solution u,, that satisfies the fiill differential cquation. This part is called
thc purtir.alur .solutio~i.
The desired general solution is then the sum of thc cornplcmentary and par-
ticular solutions. It is a simple matter to show by substitution that the functiun
A sin e wtisfies Eq. 12.27 for any value of A . This is similarly truc for H cos
0 fcir any value of 8.'The theory 01differential equations tells u s that therc arc
two independcnt functions lor thc solutiun ul' Eq. 12.27. The general comple-
mentary solution is then

11, = A sin e + Hcos e (12.28)

where A and B arc arbitrary constants (I!' integration. Considering the full
differential equation (Eq. 12.26). we sec by inspection that a particular
solution is

The general solutinn to the differential equation (Eq. 12.26) is then

By simple trigonoinetiic considerations. we can put the complementary


solution in the equivalent form, D cos ( 0 fi). where I1 and /3 are then
~

the constilnts of integralion.' Wc then have as an alternative fiir~nulation


f o r u (= 1/19:

You may possibly recognize this equation as the general conic equutiun
i n polar coordinates with the focus at Ihe origin. In your iinalytic geo-
SECTION 12.7 GRAVITATIONAL CENTRAL FORCE MOTION 543
metry class, you probably saw the following form for the general conic
eq~ation.~
1 1 1
- = - + -cos(@ - p, (12.37)
' q P
where E is the eccentricity, p is the distance from the focus to the directrix, and
pis the angle between the x axis and the axis of symmetry of the conic section.
Comparing Eqs. 12.31 and 12.37, we see that
I
P=o (1238a)

E = - DC2 (1 2.3%)
GM

Pp
'A conic section is the locus of all points whose distance from a f i e d p o i n l has a consmnl
rnlio to the distance from a fued line. The fixed point is called the/ocus (or focal point) and the D
line is termed the direcfrir. In Fig. 12.18 we have shown paint P, a directrix DD,and a focus 0.
For a conic Section to be traced by P, it must move in a manner that keeps the ratio rim, called
the rccenfricify,a fixed number. Clearly, for every acceptable position P , there will be a mirror
image position P (see the diagram) about a line normal to the directrix and going through the
focal point 0. Thus, the conic section will be symmetrical about axis OC.
Using the letter c to represent the eccentricity, we can say: C P
_ I -- r \
(12.32)
m-€=
p + ,cos Focus
\
\
where p is the distance from the focus to the directrix. Replacing cos q by --cos (e - p), where \
0 (see Fig. 12.18) is the angle between the x axis and the axis of symmetry, we then get \
\
r =c (12.33) \
- rcas(e - p )
D ------------------&p'
X

Directrix
Now. rearrangins the terms in the eauation. we anive at a standard formulation far conic sections:
Figure 12.18. rlw = E E constant for conic
(12.34) section.

Jx2 +).z SP P p +?2

Simple algebraic manipulation permits us to put the preceding equation into the following form:
Dtb
(I - .')x2 + yz + 2 p r ' x - czp2 = 0 (12.36)
x
C.
If c > I , the coefficients of xz and y2 are different in sign and unequal in value. The equa-
tion then represents a hyperbola
If c = I, only one of the squared terms remains and we have aparnhola.
If c < I,the coefficients of the squared terms are unequal but have the same sign. The
curve is that of an ellipse
544 WAPTliK 12 P,\KTICI.I DYNAMIC'S

From our knowledge if conic sections. we can then iay that i f

1": > 1. the trajectiiry i h ii hypcrhola (12.3%)


GM

'Ic' = I, the trajectory i s a piirahiilii (l2.39h)


GM
~~

~~ I"' ~ < I. the trajectiiry ih an ellip\e (I2.39~)


GM
Fb = 0. the trajectory i s a circle (12.3YlI)

Clearly, L)CWM, ~ I i cecccnwicitj. i\ :in exlrcniely iinportant quanlity. Wc


shall next look into the practical applications of the preceding fcrieral theory
to prohlems i n space niechiiiiics.

"12.8 Applications to Space Mechanics


We sliull iiow employ the theory scl rorth i n the previous section to study Ihe
motion o f space vchicles--a prohlciii of great present-day interest. We shall
assume that at the end of powcred flight the puhition r,) ;mil velocity I;;of the
\
.'.. vehicle are known from rocket calculaliotis. The reference cmploycd w i l l he
an inertial relcrence at the ceiitcr of the planet and s o the reference w i l l Irans-
Figui:e 12.20. Launching at axis of symmetry. late with the planet relative tu the "fixed stars." Accordingly. the earth hill
rotate one cycle per day for such a reference. We know that the trajectory of
the hody w i l l l h i ii plme fixed i n iriertiitl space and so, forci~nreniencc.we
take the .r? plane of lhc relerence to he the plane of thc trajectory. I t i s the
usual practice to chixist. the .x axis to hc the axis of cymmctry for the tra,jec-
tory. Ifthere i s a zt'ro rodid vrlociry component at "hurnout," then the
launching clearly occurs at a position along the a x i s of symmetry o f the tra-
jectory (i.e., along the .r axis). This ciise lias hcen shown in Fig. 11.20.
wherein the suhscript 0 denotes launch d;ita. If. on thc other hand, a ]radial
component (v),,
i s present at hurnouc. then the launch condition occurs ill
somc piisition O,,from the .x axis. as shown i n Fig. 12.21. We generally do not
know e,,
a priori, since its value depends un the cqu;itioii of thc trajectory.
Finally, the angle n s h o k n i n the diagram w i l l he called the l i i i r n d ~ i n j iL i i i , y I e
in the ensuing discussion.
Since the .r axis has heen chosen to he the a x i s of symmetry. the q u a -
tion of motion of the vehicle aflcr powercd Ilight i s given in lcrnis of x h i -
Irary conslants C and D h y Eq. 12.31 with the anglc set equal to zero.
\ Thus. we have
\

'\
.'. 1 = + Dco,H (12.401
Figure 12.21. Burnout with radial velocity r (-2
present.
StCTION I2 8 AI’PLICATIONS TO SPACE MECHANIC.\ 545

The problem is to find the constants C and D from launching data. We shall
illustrate this step in the examples following this section. Note that when
these constants are evaluated, the value of the eccentricity E = DC2/CM is
then available so that we can state immediately the general characteristics of
the trajectory.
Furthermore, if the vehicle goes into orbit, we can readily compute the
orbital time z for one cycle around a planet. We know from the theory that
the aerial velocity is constant and given as

But r%equals the constant C in accordance with Eq. 12.22. Hence,

c
dA = - dt (1 2.42)
2

The area swept out for one cycle is the area of an ellipse given as nub, where
u and b are the semimajor and semiminor diameters of the ellipse, respec-
tively. Hence, we have on integrating Eq. 12.42:

Therefore,

2nab
z = -~ (12.43)
C

We have shown in Appendix I11 thar

a=-
EP (12.44~1)
I -$
b = u(l - € * ) ‘ I 2 (12.44h)

Replacing p by 1/11in accordance with Eq. 12.38a, we then get

(12.45a)

( I 2.45b)

Thus, we can get the orbital time T quite easily once the constants of the
trajectory, D and C , are evaluated.
54h C'HAP'JER 12 PAKrlCI,F. UYNAMICS

To illustrate many of the previous general remarks in a most simple


manner, we now examine the special case where, a s shown in F i g 12.22, var-
ious launching.; ii.c., burnout conditions) are made from a given point a such
that the launching angle a = 0. Clearly ( V ) , , = 0 f(ir these cases and the
launching axis corresponds to the axis of symmetry (if the various trajectories.
v,
Only will be varied in this discussioii.

.x 3 \

I I

Figure 12.22. Various laurrchinys liom the earth or some other planer.

The c ~ ~ i s t a i iC
t sand U arc readily available for thesc trajectories. Thus.
we have from Eq. 12.22:

v
C = r ? @ = r HV -- r 11 n (12.46)

And Sroni ELI. 12.40. setting r = q) when I3 = e,, = 0. we gct, on solving for 0:

(I2.47)

Since C and I1 ahove, for a given ro. depend only on V,,, we conclude that the
eccentricity here is dependent only on C;, lor a given ro.
If V,, is so large that DCZ/GM exceeds unity, the vehicle will have the
trajcctory 111 a hyperbola (curve I ) and will eventually leavc the intluence of
the earth. If V,, is decreased to a valuc such that the eccentricity is unity. the
trajcctory becorncs a parabola (curve 2 ) . Sincc a further decrease in the value
of yl will cause the vehicle tu orbit. curve 2 is the limiting trajectory with our
launching conditions for outer-space night. The launching velocity for this
case is accordingly called the rscapr ~elocir\ and is denoted as We can
SECTION 12.8 APPLICATIONS 1'0 SPACE MECHANICS 547

solve for ( y J Efor this launching by substituting for C and D from Eqs. 12.46
and 12.47 into the equation DC21GM = I . We get

(12.48)

a result that is correct for more general launching conditions (i,e., for cases
where launching angle a # 0). Thus, launching a vehicle with a speed equal-
ing or exceeding the value above for a given r,, will cause the vehicle to leave
the earth until such time as the vehicle is influenced by other astronomical
bodies or by its own propulsion system. If V, is less than the escape velocity,
the vehicle will move in the trajectory of an ellipse (curve 3). The closest
point t o the earth is called perigee; the farthest point is called apogee.
Clearly, these points lie along the axis of symmetry. Such an orbiting vehicle
is often called a space satellite. (Kepler, in his famous first law of planetary
motion, explained the motion of planets about the sun in this same manner.)
One focus for the aforementioned conic curves is at the center of the planet.
Another f o c u s , r now moves in from infinity for the satellite trajectories. As
the launching speed is decreased,f' moves t o w a r d j When the foci coincide,
the trajectory is clearly a circle and, as pointed out earlier (see Eq. 12.39d).
the eccentricity E is zero. Accordingly, the constant D must be zero (the con-
stant C clearly will not be zero) and, from 9.12.47, the speed for a circular
orbit (l(JC is

For launching velocities less than the preceding value for a given ro, the
eccentricity becomes negative and the focus f' moves to the left of the earth's
center. Again, the trajectory is that of an ellipse (curve 5). However, the satel-
lite will now come closer to the earth at position b, which now becomes the
perigee, than at the launching position, which up to now had been the mini-
mum distance from the earth." If friction is encountered, the satellite will
slow up, spiral in toward the atmosphere, and either burn up or crash. If Vu is
small enough, the satellite will not go into even a temporary orbit but will
plummet to the earth (curve 6). However, for a reasonably accurate descrip-
tion of this trajectory, we must consider friction from the earth's atmosphere.
Since this type of force is a function of the velocity of the satellite and is not
a central force, we cannot use the results here in such situations for other than
approximate calculations.

"'Note that with Ihr positive I axis going through perigee, I i s minimum when 0 = 0.
From Eq. 12.40. we can conclude for this case (0 is measured here from perigee) thil, to m i 6
miLe r. the conatam D mUSl be posilive. me eccentricity must then he positive for 0 measured
from perigee. If the positive x axis goes through apogee, then r is marimurnwhen 0 = 0. From
Eq. 12.40 we can conclude that D must be negative for this case (0 is here measured from
apogee). Thus, the eccentricity is negative fof 0 measured from apogee. This is clearly the case
for curve 5.
Example 12.9
The first American satcllile. the V a n p a r d . win launched at ii velocity 01
18.000 milhr at an altitude 01 400 mi (see Fig. 12.23). I I the "humout"
velocity of the last stage is parallel to the earth's \iirface. compute tlic
inaximum iiltitudc from the a i - t h ' s surface that the Vanguard iatcllite will
reach. Consider the earth to hc perfectly spherical with a radius O S 3.960
mi (ti) is therefore 4.360 mi).

Figure 12.23. 1.aunching 01ilie V : i n p a r ~ lsiitrllit~.

We m u h t now compute thc quantitich GM, C. and D lrom thc initial


data and other known data. To detcrmint. GM. we employ Eq. 12. I 7 and i n
terms units of iiiilcs and hours wc get

= 1.1.3Lj x [(I" inii/hr'

The ccinstmt C i \ readily dctcriiiincd directly froin initial data a:,


<' = q,y, = (4.3h0)~18.001))
= 7.85 x 10'mi2/hr

Finally. the cimstaiit I1 i:, available Srom Eq. 12.47:

= . Z Xx~ ((1 n i i ~I
The eccentricity 1)C'IGM can nriu he computed iis

The Vanguard will thus definitely riot e x a p e into outel- s p x z


The tra,jectory 01. this n i v l j ~ u iis fiirnied from tk.12.41:

__..x__I_ ..",, ..... -, . . .... . . . "___ .


SECTION 12.8 APPLICATIONS TO SPACE MECHANICS 549

I Example 12.9 (Continued)


Therefore,
I = 2.01 x i o 4 + ,283 x i o 4 case
~

r (e)

We can compute the maximum distance from the eaith’s surface by setting
0 = Kin the equation above:
I - (2.01 - ,283) X IO-‘
-~ = 1.727 x 10” mi-’
rn,,

Therefore,

r- = 5,790 mi

By subtracting 3,960 mi from this result, we find that the highest point in
the trajectory is 1,830 mi from the earth’s surface.

I Example 12.10
In Example 12.9, first compute the escape velocity and then the velocity
for a dircular orbit at burnout.
Using Eq. 12.48, we have for the escape velocity:

2(1 239 X IO”)]”’


\ ‘il 4,360

(V& = 23,840 mi/hr

For a circular orbit, we have from Eq. 12.49:

(V& = E =1 milhr

Thus, the Vanguard is almost in a circular orbit.


550 CllhPTER I ? PAKTICL.1: IDYNAMICS

Example 12.11
Determine the orhital time i n Examplc 12.1) Sor the Viinguard siitellitc.
Wc employ Eys. 12.44 for the semimajor and semiminor axe\ OS the
elliptic orbit. Thus, recallinp t h a t l ~= lill we have
I
i

x 5,080 ini

/I = dl - e l ) ’ / ? = 5,080(1 -,1408?)”’

Theretiire, from E q 12.43 wc have f o r the oi-hitiil time:

z = 2.05 hr = 122.7 min

Example 12.12
A space vehicle i \ i n ii circular “parking” orhit around the pliinet Vcnus. ,
320 km ahovc the surtace o f thiq planet. The radius o f Venus i a 6.160 kin,
and the escape velocity at the surticc i s 1.026 x IOi mlsec. A retro-rockct
i s fired to a l i w the vehicle \n that i t w i l l cnine within 12 kin of the planet.
If we consider that the rocket changes the speed d t h e vehicle w e r a com-
paratively short distance ot its tmvcl, what i s this change of apeed? What
i s the speed ofthe vehicle at i t s closest position tu the s u r f x c of Venua’!
We show the vehicle in a circular parking nrhit i n Fig. 12.24. We
shall considcr that the rctro-rocketa are fircd at position A SO as Lo estahlibh
a new elliptic orhit with apogee at A and perigee at l j .
As e first step, we shell compute GM using the escape-velocity equa-
tion 12.48. Thus, we havc Figure 12.24. Ch,ingc “1 orbit

Thereforc,

= 4.20 x IO’? krn’ihr’


SECTION 12.8 APPLICATIONS TO SPACE MECHANICS 55 1

Example 12.12 (Continued)


The equation for the new elliptic orbit is given as
~ I - -GM + D c o s e (a)
r cZ
Note that when
e = 0, r = r,, = 6,480 km (h)
e = ff, r = r,,, = 6,192 km (C)
To determine the constant C, we subject Eq. (a) to the conditions (b) and
(c). Thus,
1 4.20 x IO1* +

6,480 = c*
1 4.20 x IO'* -
6,192 = c2

Adding these equations, we eliminate D and can solve for C. Thus;


8.40 x loLz- I ~1
C* - 6,480'6,192

Therefore,
C = 1.631 x 108kmz/h~
Accordingly, for the new orbit,
r,V, = 1.631 x lo8
Therefore,
V, = 25,168 km/hr
For the circular parking orbit the velocity y. is
~~~

v c =j#EM
r,
I-=
1
14.20 x loLz
6,480
= 25,458 km/h~
The change in velocity that the retro-rocket must induce is then

AV = 25,168 - 25,458 =

The velocity at the perigee at B is easily computed since


rBVB= C = 1.631 x IO8
Therefore,
V, = (1 631 X 108)/6,192 =
Now l e t us consider more general launching conditions where the
launching angle a i\ not 7,ero (see Fig. 12.25. The canslant C is still eahily
cvaluated (sce Eq. (12.46)) in tcnns of launching data as ro(K,)l,. To get D.
we write Eq. 12.40 lor lauiichinf condition\. Tliur.

Figure 12.25. I.aunch witti d i a l \elricify.

The value of 4, i\ not yet known. Thus. we have two unknown quantities in
this equation, namcly I1 and qr
Differentiating Eq. 12.40 with respect to time
and siilving for r, we get
i = W8sinH = DCsinH (12.51)
Noting Lhatk i s equal t o ", and submitting the preceding equation t o launching
conditions. we then form a accond equation for the e\'aluation n l the unknown
coiistiint\ D and 4,. Thus.
(y = DCsiii B,, ( I2.52 1

Rearranging Eq. 12.50. we havc

5)
I ~ w
C?
= ,g c<,\ e,, (12.51)

Divide both sides 01 Eq. 12.52 by C. Now. squaring Eqs. 12.52 and 12.53,
adding terms, and using the lact tliat sin2 e,, + cos' Olj = I. we get for the
constant Ll the result : I '
SECTION 12.8 APPLICATIONS TO SPACE MECHANICS 553
Having taken the positive root for D,we note (see footnote #IO on page 545)
that 0 is to be medwred from perigee. The eccentricity is

First, bringing C’ into the bracket and then replacing C by r0(V,), in the entire
equation, we get the eccentricity conveniently in terms of launching data:

One can show, using the preceding formulations, that the equation for
the escape velocity developed earlier, namely

is valid for any launching angle a.Remember that % in this equation is mea-
sured from a reference xyz at the center of the planet translating in inertial
space. The velocity attainable by a rocket system relative to the planet’s sur-
face does not depend on the position of firing on the earth. but depends pri-
marily on the rocket system and trajectory of flight. However, the velocity
attainable by a rocket system relative to the aforementioned reference xyz
di~esdepend on the position of firing on the planet’s surface. This position,
accordingly, is important in determining whether an escape velocity can be
reached. The extreme situations of a launching at the equator and at the North
Pole are shown in Fig. 12.26 and should clarify this point. Note that the
motion of the planet’s surface adds to the final vehicle velocity at the equator.
but that no such gain is achieved at the North Pole.

Figure 12.26. Launching at equator and North Pole.


554 CHAFTER 12 PARTICLE DYNAMICS

Example 12.13
Suppose that the Vanguard satellite in Example 12.9 is off course hy an
angle a = 5" at the time of launching but otherwise has the same initial
data. Determine whether the satellite giies into orbit. If so, determine the
maximum and minimum distances from the earth's surface.
The initial data for thc launching are

7, = 4,360 mi, y, = 18,000 miihr

Hence,

(V,),, = (18.000)sinrx = (1X,OOO~(O.O872j


= 1.569 mi/hr

[V,j,, = (lX.Il00)cosa = (IX,OOO)(O.Y96i

= 17,930 milhr

To determine whether we have an orbit, we would have to show first


that the eccentricity E is less than unity. This condition would preclude the
possibility of an escape from the earth. Furthermore. we must he sure that
the perigee of the orbit is far enough from the carth's surface to ensure a
reasonahly permanent orbit. Actually, for both questions we need only cdl-
culate r for B = 0 and e= ?I. An infinite value of one of the r ' s will
mean that we have an escape condition, and a value not sufficiently large
will mean il crash or a decaying orbit due to atmospheric friction.
Using the value of GM as 1.239 x 10" mi3/hrz from Example 12.9
and using Eq. 12.54 for the constant D ,we can express the trajectory of the
satellite (Eq. 12.40) as
SECTION 12.8 APPLICATIONS TO SPACE MECHANICS 555

Example 12.13 (Continued)


Therefore,

I = 2.03 x I O F 4 + 3.33 x IO-' cosomi-l


~

(a)

Set 0 = 0:

= 20.3 x IO-' + 3.33 x lO-'mi-'


4)

Hence,

r', , = 4 ni

Thus, after being launched at a position 400 mi above the earth's sur-
face, the satellite comes within 270 & of the earth as a result of a 5"
change in the launching angle. This satellite, therefore, must he
launched almost parallel to the earth if it is to attain a reasonably per-
manent orbit.
Now, setting 0 = n,we get

Hence,

'ma, = 5,893 mi

Obviously, the maximum dntance from the earth's burface is


54. A d w i c e uscd at amucemcnt parks cnnsists of a circular ueight W. What i s the distancc of thr plane otthc tra.jectrry of the
m that i s made t o r e ~ o l v eahout its :,xi\ 01 \ymmctry. People hoh lrnrn thc support at o?
~d up against the wall, as shown i n the diagram. Altcr rhc whole
m has been hmught up t o spccd, thc flooi~i\ lowcrcd. What
timum angular s p e d i s required to c n s ~ i i ethat a p c ~ n w
n ~ l not
l
, dciwn the w a l l when the tloor i s Iuwrred? 'lake pb = .3.

,
I' I

-. -_- ,,
Figure P.12.56.

12.57. A \haft AH mt:itcs 11 an angular velocity nf 100 rpm. A


hody E of m a s IO kg can move without friction along rod CI)
lixcd to AI(. I l t h c hody E i\ to remain mtionary d a t i v e 10 ('1) at
any position along CD. how m i i s 1 the spring cnnstant K vary'? The
tlistancc 5, frum the a x i i i\ thc onstl-ctchcd length n f t h c spring.
Figure P.12.54

55. A tlywhccl is rotating at a s p e d 1110, = IO radlceu and -


at this instant a rate n l changu o l spceil 0 of 5 rsdlsec'. A A
m o i d at thi5 instnnt m w c s a valve toward the centerline i f t h c c
,wheel at a speed 0 1 I .S imlrcc and i s decelerating at rhc rate 01
nlsec'. The \-alve haa il mils\ OS I kg and i c .3 tm f r o m the axis
rotatian at the timc of interest. What i\ the total forur on thc
ve'!
C > lO(1 rpm
A
- __
Figure P.12.57.

12.58. A drvicc u m \ i s t \ 01three m a l l miisics. thrzc wrightle\r


mk. and ii linrilr y i n p with K = 200 N l m The system i s rot at^
trig in thc g v r n fixed configuration at :i conctant rpecd w = 10
rad/\ i n a lhorimntiil plme. 'The li>llowingdata apply:
I
M , = 2 kg M,j = 3 kg M,. = 2 kg
Figure P.12.55.
If thr spi~inpi\ \trctchcd h) an a m r u n t .(I25 m. dcterminc the total
56. :mica1 pendulum of Icngth 1 i s > w nThe lurce components :sting o n thc miisr at ('and the tenqile force in
nadc tn rotate ill a constant angular spccd of wahoo mcmher /),4 [ I l i n i ('onwicr a single panicle. then a \y\tem 0 1
axis. Compute the tension in the cord if thc pcndulum huh ha! pmticIc\; I;\ and OH arc pin connec1ed.l

5
12.61. A platform rotates at 2 radhec. A body C weighing 450 N
rests on the platform and is connected by a flexible weightless
cord In a mass weighing 225 N, which is prevented from swinging
out by pan of the platform. For what range of values o f x will bod-
ies C and B remain stationary relative to the platform? The static
coefficient of friction fix a11 surfaces is .4.

x-

_-- .',
Figure P.12.58.

12.59. In the preceding problem consider that member DA is wL,=.4


welded to the sphere at A . Now, at the instant of interest, there is for 811 surfac
also an angular acceleration of the system having the value of .28 Figure P.12.61.
rad/sec* counterclockwise. What are the force components acting
on panicle C. and what are the force components from rod AD
acting on panicle A'? See hint given in the preceding problem.
12.62. A particle moves under gravitational influence about a
body M, the center of which can he taken as the origin of an iner-
12.60. A device called a flyhall governor is used to regulate the tial reference. The mass of the particle is 50 slugs. At time t, the
speed o f such devices as steam engines and turbines. As the gov- particle is at il position 4,500 mi from the center of M with direc-
ernor is made to rotate through a system of gears by the device to tion cosines I = .5, m = -3. n = ,707. The panicle is moving
he controlled, the halls will attain a configuration given by the at a speed of 17,000 milhr along the direction E, = .Xi + .2j +
angle 6'. which is dependent on both the angular speed w of the .Shhk. What is the direction of the normal t o the plane of the
governor and the force P acting on the collar hearing at A. The up- trajectory?
and-down mntion ofthe bearing at A in response to a change in w
is then used to open or close a valve to regulate the speed of the
device. Find the angular velocity required to maintain the config-
uration of the flyhall governor for 8 = 30". Neglect friction.

Figure P.12.62.

12.63. If the position of the particle in Problem 12.62 were to


reach a distance of 4,300 mi from the center of hody M, what
Figure P.12.60. would the transverse velocity V, of the particle be?

551
12.64. Use Eqs. 12.38h and 12.40 t o show' that i f t h c eccentricity
is x r u , the trujectoq nmsl he that of a circle.

12.65. A satellite ha\ at m c t i m e during its flight around thc


caith a radial crrmpment 01velocity 3.200 krnlhl- and a tlans\.cr\e
cm~poneril0 1 2h.XIO km/hr. I1 the s;ilrllitc i \ at a distanvc 01
7.040 krn frtmm tlic cciitzr 01 the eimrth. u'hal is i l \ arral velocity'!

12.66. Compute the c s u p e velocit) ;it :I pnsition X.000 In, f i r m


the center of the sarlh. What q x c d i s needcd to inninlain il circw
tar orhit at that di.;tance from the earth's center? Derive Ihc c q u a ~
tiaii for the speed riccdcd fur il circular orhit direclly from
Neuston's law without ucing infill-malioo iibrrut ecccnlricilieh. ctc.

Figure P.12.69.

sonnection I

Figure P.12.67.

i5X
12.72. Consider a satellite of mass m in a circular orbit around the 12.78. The satellite Hyperion about the planet Saturn has a
earth at a radius R, from the center of the earth. Using the universal motion with an eccentricity known to he ,1043. At its closest dis-
law of gravitation (Eq. 1.1 I ) with M as the mass of the eanh and tance from Saturn, Hyperion is 1.485 x IO6 km away (measured
using Newron's law in a direction normal to the path, show that from center to center). What is the period of Hyperion about Sat-
urn? The acceleration of zravitv of Saturn is 13.93 m/recz at its
" I
-
IGM surface. The radius of Saturn is 57,600 km
= '-
"ctrc.
4 Ro
12.79. Two satellite stations, each in a circular orbit around the
for a circular orbit. Now at the earth's surface use the earth, are shown. A small vehicle is shot out of the station at A
gravitational law again and the weight ,f the body, to show that tangential to the trajectory in order to "hit" station B when it is at
CM = gRE.ar,,, where y is the acceleration of gravity. a position E 120" from the x axis as shown in the diagram. What
is the velocity of the vehicle relative to station A when it leaves?
The circular orbits are 200 miles and 400 miles, respectively, from
12.73. The acceleration of gravity on the planet Mars is about the earth's
,385 times the acceleration of gravity on earth, and the radius of
Mars is about ,532 times that of the earth. What is the escape veloc-
ity from Mars at a position 100 mi from the surface of the planet?

12.74. In 1971 Mariner 9 was placed in orbit around Mars with


an eccentricity of .5. At the lowest point in the orbit. Mariner 9 is
320 km from the surface of Mars.
(a) Compute the maximum velocity of the space vehicle
relative to the center of Mars.
(b) Compute the time of one cycle.
x
Use the data in Problem 12.73 for Mars.

12.75. A man is in orbit around the earth in a space-shuttle vehi-


cle. At his lowest possible position, he is moving with a speed of
18,500 mihr at an altitude of 200 mi. When he wants to come
back to earth, he fires a retro-rocket straight ahead when he is at
the aforementioned lowest position and slows himself down. If he Figure P.12.79.
wishes subsequently to get within SO mi from the earth's surface
during the first cycle after firing his retro-rocket, what must his 12.80. In Problem 12.79, determine the total velocity of the
decrease in velocity be? (Neglect air resistance.) vehicle as it arrives at E as seen by an observer in the satellite B .
The values of C and D for the vehicle from Problem 12.79 are
7.292 x IO' m i 2 h and 7.373 x mi-', respectively.
12.76. The Pioneer 10 space vehicle approaches the planet
Jupiter with a trajectory having an eccentricity of 3. The vehicle
comes to within 1,000 mi of the surface of Jupiter. What is the 12.81. The Viking I space probe is approaching Mars. When it is
speed of the vehicle at this instant? The acceleration of gravity of 80,650 km from the center of Mars, it has a speed of 16,130 kmihr
Jupiter is 90.79 ftlsec' at the surface and the radius is 43,400 mi. with a component (V,) toward the center of Mars of 15,800 kmJhr.
Does Viking I crash into Mars, go into orbit, or have one pass in
the vicinity of Mars? If there is no crash, how close to Mars does it
12.77. If the moon has a motion about the earth that has an come? The acceleration of gravity on the surface of Mars is 4.13
eccentricity of ,0549 and a period of 27.3 days, what is the closest m/sec2, and its radius is 3,400 km. Do not use formula for D as
distance of the moon to the earth in its trajectory? given by Eq. 12.54, but work from the trajectory equations.

559
12.83. 110 I'mhlcm 12.U2 u'ilh the ilitl of Eq. 12.14.

Figure l'.l2.87.

12.85. Do Prohleni 12.84 with the aid of Eq. 12.54.

Figure P.12.88.
SECTION 12.9 NEWTON’S LAW FOR PATH VARIABLES 561

Part C: Path Variables


12.9 Newton’s Law for Path Variables
We cm express Newton’s law lor path variables as follows:
< = m , d2s (12.57a)
dt

Notice that the second of these equations is always nonlinear, as discussed in


Section 12.5.’’ This condition results from both the squared term and the
radius of curvature R. It is therefore difficult to integrate this differential equa-
tion. Accordingly, we shall be restricted to reasonably simple cases. We now
illustrate the use of the preceding equations.

‘%quation 12.57a could also he nonlinear, depending on Lhe nillure of the function $.

Example 12.14
A portion of a roller coaster that one finds in an amusement park is shown
in Fig. 12.27(a). The portion of the track shown is coplanar. The curve from
A to the right on which the vehicle moves is that of a parabola, given as

(y - loop = loox (a)


v ,,’
, ,
,,

I:1 / / I ’
,

n
n

P,
x

(a) (b)
Figure 12.27. Roller coaster trajectory.
562 CHAPTER 12 PARTI(’1.E DYNAMICS

Example 12.14 (Continued)


with x and y in feet. If the train of cars is moving at a speed of 40 ft/sec
when thc front car is 60 fl above the ground, what is the total normal force
exerted hy a 200-1h occupant nf thc front car on the seat and floor of
lhe car’!
Since we requirc only the force F normal to the path, we need only
he concerned with u,~.Thus, we have

Wc can compute R from analytic geometry as follows:

wherein from Eq. (a) we have

d\ SO
&=m

Substituting into Eq. ( c ) ,we have

AI the p o w o n of intere\t. we get


SECTION 12.9 NEWTONS LAW FOR PATH VARlABLES 563

Example 12.14 (Continued)


Accordingly, we now have for y,, as required by Newton's law:

Nnte that I;; is the total force component normal to the trajectory
needed on the occupant for maintaining his motion on the given trajectory.
This force component comes from the action of gravity and the forces from
the seat arid floor of the car. These forces have been shown in Fig. 12.27(h),
where P, and p a r e the normal and tangential force components from the
car acting on the occupant. The resultant of this force system must, accord-
ingly, have a component along n equal to 94.6 Ib. Thus,

-200 cos + P, = 94.6 (h)

To get p, nnle with the help of Eq. (d) that

Therefore.
/3 = 51.3"

Suhstituting into Eq. (h) and solving for P,. we get

9, = 200 COS S I.30 + 94.6

This is the force component from the vehicle onto the passenger. Tne reac-
tion to this force is the force component from the passenger onto the vehicle.
564 CHAPTER I ? PARTICLE DYNAMICS

Part D: A System of Particles


12.10 The General Motion of a System
of Particles
I.et us examine a system of n particles (Fig. 12.28) that has inlcractions
between thc particles fiir which Newton '.s thit-d lobe of motion (action equals

Figure 12.28. Force\ on ith pairiclr of the system


reaction) applies. Newror~'.ssrt.ond /ai?.for any particle (lcl us say thc ith par-
ticle) is then

(12.58)

,*I

wherc4.;. is the force on particle i from particle j and is thus considered an


internal force for the system of particles. Clearly. the,, = i term of thc suni-
mation musf be deleted since tlic ith particle cilnnoi exert force iin itself. The
force F, reprcscnts the resultant force on the ilh particle from the forccs < w c , i -
nrrl to thc syslem of paniclcs.
If thehe equations are added for all n particlcs, we have

(12.59)

Carrying out the double summation and excluding terms with rcpeakd indexes,
such as&,,&,. etc., we find that lor each term with any one set o f indexes
there will he a term with Ihe reverse of thcse indexes present. For example.
lor the force.(,, it lorcef2, will ex is^. Considering the ineming iifthe indexes.
we see thatf..,.I andJ, represent action and reaction lorccs between a pair of
particles. Thus, as a result of N e w o n ' s third Irrw. thc double summation i n
Eq. 12.59 should add LIPt u zero. N < w t r n i ' .srmrtd
~ law lor a system iif paiticlcs
then becomes:

I2.60 1

where F now rcprehenls the vector sum of all the r,rtr,ruol forccs acting on all
the panicles of the system.
SECTION 12.i o THE GENERAL MOTION OF A SYSTEMOF PARTICLES 565

To make further useful simplifications, we use the first moment of mass


of a system of n particles about a fixed point A in inertial space given as

first moment vector = C miri


i=l

where 7 represents the position vector from the point A to the ith particle
(Fig. 12.29). As explained in Chapter 8, we can find a position, called the

Figure 12.29. Center of mass of system

center of mass of the system, with position vector r,, where the entire mass of
the system of particles can be concentrated to give the correct first moment.
Thus,

Therefore,

(1 2.61)

Let us reconsider Newton's law using the center-of-mass concept. To


do this, replace m,r( by Mr, in Eq. 12.60. Thus,

(12.62)

We see that the center ofmass of any aggregate ofparticles has a motion that
can he computed by methodr already ser,forth, since fhis i.7 a problem involv-
ing a single hypothetical particle of mass M . You will recall that we have
alluded to this important relationship several times earlier to justify the use of
the particle concept in the analysis of many dynamics problems. We must
realize for such an undertaking that F is the total external force acting on all
the particles.
566 CHAPTER 12 PARTlCLt DYNAMICS

Example 12.15
Three charged particles i n a vacuum are shiiwn in Fig. 12.30. Particle I
has a mass of 1W5 kg and a charge o f 4 x IO-' C (coulomhs) and i s at the
origin at the instanl (ifinterest. Particlcs 2 and 3 each have a mass of 2 x
1 0 kg and a charge o f 5 x 10 C and are located. respectively, at the

rP?
Figure 12.30. Char& particles in field E .

inslant of interest I ni d i m g t h e y axis and 3 m along the :axis. An elec-


tric field E given a s

E = 2.ti + 3 r j + 3(r + .?)k NIC (a)


i s imposed from thc nutsidc. Compute: (a) the position [ifthe center 01
mass for the system. (h) the acceleration o f the center o f mass, and (c) the
acceleratinn o f particle I
To get the position [if the ccnter of mass, we merely equate moments
of the masses ahnut the origin with that of R particle having a mass equal
to the sum o f masses of the system. Thus.

(I+ 2 + 2)x IO ' r , = ( 2 x 10 i ) j+ ( 2 x 1Wi)3k

Therefore,
rc = .4j+ 1.2km (h)

To get the acceleration of the mass center. we must find the sum of
the extrmal forccs acting on thc particles. T w o cxternal forccs act on each
particle: the force o f gravity and the electrostatic force from the external
field. Recall from physics the1 this electrostatic force i s given as 4E, where
4 i s the charge on the particle. Hcnce, the total exlemal force for each par-
ticle i s given a s Sollows:

Fl = -(9.X1)(11i~7)k+ 0 N (C)

Fz =-(9,Xlj(2x 1 0 ~ ~ j k + ( 5 ~ 1 0 ~ ~ j ( 3 k ) N (d)
F3 = -(9.81)(2 x jk + (5 x I O s ) ( 9 j + 27k) N (e)
SECTION 12.10 THE GENERAL MOTION OF A SYSTEM OF PARTICLES 561
Example 12.15 (Continued)
The sum of these forces FT is
F~ = 45 x io-5j + 100.9 x 10-5k N (f)
Accordingly, we have for<:
..
rc =
45 x 10-5j + 100.9 x 10"k
s x 10-5

Finally, to get the acceleration of particle I , we must include the


coulombic forces from particles 2 and 3. As you leamed in physics, this
force is given between two particles a and b with charges q, and qb as fol-
lows:

where P is the unit vector between the particles, and eo is the dielectric
constant equal to 8.854 x lO~'*F/m (farads per meter) for a vacuum. Note
that the coulombic force is repulsive between like charges. The total cou-
lombic force 4 from particles 2 and 3 is

= - I S j - 2kN

The total force acting on particle 1 is then

, .
( FI )T -- -(9.81)(10-5)k
from
weight
,+ -- 0
from
external
field
+ (-18j
from
- 2k)N
l"f0rnal
field
(i)

Clearly, the internal field dominates here. Newton's law then gives us

fl
-18j - 2k
10-5

We see here from Eqs. (g) and (j) that although the particles tend to
"scramble" away from each other due to very strong internal coulombic
forces, the center of mass accelerates slowly by comparison.
568 CHAPICK I 2 PAKllCLE DYNAMICS

Example 12.16
A young man i s standing i n a canoe awaiting a young lady (Fig. 12.3 I ) .
The !man weigh:, 150 Ih. and, a s shown. i s positioncd ticiir the end of the
canoe, which weighs 200 Ih. When the ynung lady appear:,, he quickly
scramble:, forward to greet her, hut when hc has moved 20 fl 10 the f i r -
ward end nf thc canoe. l i c finds (nnt having htudied mcclianich) that he
cannot reach her. How far i s the tip of the ciinoc from the dock after our
hem has made the 20-ft dash? The ciinoc is i n tin way ticd to the dock and
there are no water currents. Neglect friction frnm (lie water on the canoe.

Figure 12.31. Man in i.anor awaits hi, date.

The center o l iiias'i ofthc inan plus the canoe cannot change posilioii
during this action sincc there i s 110 iict external lorcc acting nn (hi:, hystem
during this action. Hencc thc firht mnincnt of mass about a n y fixed posi-
tion r n u b t rcmain constant during this action. I n Fig. 12.32 we have shnwn
the man i n the forward position and we choose the position at the tip of the
dock to equate ~ i ~ o ~ i i coft i tilass
t iil the beginning <if the action and ,iu\t
when the inan has moved the 20 fc. We then can say, noting that we arc
denoting the unspecified distance hetween the tip of the canoc and the for-
ward position o1'Lhe iiiaii as d as shown i n Figs. 12.31 and 12.32.

Conccling terms where possible we then liiive

.
7511, = 7,0._
0., .
0. ... ,.
I -.- ....
R571
, ft
12.90. A wamor of old is turning a sling in a vertical plane. A with x and y in feet. A small one-passenger vehicle is designed to
rock of mass ..3 kg is held ill the sling prior to releasing it against an move along the catenary to facilitate repair and painting of the
enemy. What is the minimum speed u t o hold the rock in the sling? bridge. Consider that the vehicle moves at uniform speed of 10
ft/sec along the curve. If the vehicle and passenger have a com-
bined mass of 250 Ibm, what is the force normal to the curve as a
function of position x ?
F _

Figure P.12.90.

12.91. A car is traveling at a speed of 55 mi/hr along a banked


highway having a radius of curvature of 500 ft. At what angle Figure P.12.94.
should the road he bdnked in order that a zero friction force is
needed for the car to go around this curve? 12.95. A rod CD rotates with shaft G-G at an angular speed u
of 300 rpm. A sleeve A of mass 500 g slides on CD. If no friction
12.92. A car weighing 20 kN is moving at a speed V v f 60 k d r is present between A and CI), what is the distances for no relative
on a road having a vertical radius vf curvature of 200 m as shown. motion between A and CD?
At the instant shown, what is the maximum deceleration possible
from the brakes along the road for the vehicle if the coefficient of
dynamic friction between tires and the road is .55?

200 ni

Figure P.12.92.

12.93. A particle moves at uniform speed o f 1 d s e c along a


plane sinusoidal path given as
y = 5 sin lix m G
Figure P.12.95.
What is the pusition between x = 0 and x = 1 m for the maxi-
mum fbrce normal to the curve? What is this force if the mass of 12.96. In Problem 12.95. what is the range of values for S for
the particle is I kg? which A will remain stationary relative to CD if there is coulom-
hic friction hetween A and CD such that p,5 = .4?
12.94. A catenary curve is formed by the cable of a suspension
bridge. The equation of this curve relative to the axes shown can 12.97. A circular rod EB rotates at constant angular speed u of
he given it\ 50 rpm. A Fleeve A of mass 2 Ibm slides on the circular rod. At
y = 5 (e" + e-") = a cosh M
what position B will sleeve A remain stationary relative to the rod
ELI if there is no friction?

569
what is the velocity of each particle relative to the center of mass
nf the system after 2 sec have elapsed'! Each particle has a weight
of . I O L .

12.101, A stationary uniform block of ice is acted on by forces


that maintain constant magnitude and direction at all times. If

F; = (25,y)N
5 = (log) N

F? = (15g) N

what is the velocity ofthe center of mass ofthe block after 10 sec'!
Neglect friction. The density OS ice is 56 Ihm/fti.

C
Figure P.12.97.

12.98. In Problem 12.91 assume that thcre is coulombic friction


between A and EB with p,$= .3. Show that the minimum value
of Ofor which the sleeve will remain stationary relative to the rod
is 75.45".

12.99. The fbllowing data for a system of particles are given a1 Figure P.12.101.
time t = 0

M , = SO kg at position ( I , 1.3, -3) m 12.102, A space vehicle decelerates downward ( Z direction) at


1 ,h I3 kmlhrisec while moving in a translalory manner relative to
M2 = 25 kg at position (-.6, 1.3, -2.6) m inertial space. Inside the vehicle is a rod BC rotating in the plane
of the paper at a rate of SO radisec relative to the vehicle. Two
M3 = 5 kg at position (-2.6, 5.3, 1 ) m masses wtate at the rille of 20 radisec around BC on rod EF. The
The particles are acted an by the following respective external masses are cach 300 mm from C. Determine the force transmitted
forces: at C hetween BC and EF if the mass of each of the rotating bodies
is 5 kg and the mass of rod E F is I kg. BC is in the vertical posi-
6= 5Oj + l0rk N (particle 1 ) tion at the time of interest. Neglect gravity.
F2 = 50kN (particle 2)

F, = 5t2i N (particlc 3)

What is the velocity of M , relative to the mass center after 5 sec,


assuming that at f = 0. thc particles are at rest?

*12.100. Given the following force field:


F = -2xi + 3j - zk lbislug

what is the force on any particle in the field per unit mass of the
particle. If we havc two particles initially stationary in the field
with position vcctors
r , = 3i + 2j ft
X
Py
I

r2 = 4i - 2j + 4k ft Figure P.12.102.

570
12.103. Two men climb aboard a barge at A to shift a load with
the aid of a fork lift. The barge has a mass of 20,000 kg and is 10
m long. The load consists of four containers each with a mass of
1,300 kg and each having a length of 1 m. The men shift the con-
tainers tv the opposite end of the barge, put the fork lift where
they found it, and prepare to step off the barge at A , where they
came on. If the barge has not been constrained and if we neglect
water friction, currents, wind, and so on, how far has the barge
shifted its position? The fork lift has a mass of 1,000 kg.
Figure P.IZ.104.
12.105. Two identical adjacent tanks are each 10 ft long, 5 ft
high, and 5 ft wide. Originally, the left tank is completely full of
water while the right tank is empty. Water is pumped by an inter-
nal pump from the left tank to the right tank. At the instant of
interest, the rate of flow Q is 20 ft3/sec,whileQ is 5 ft3/sec2.What
Figure P.12.103. horizontal force on the tanks is needed at this instant from the
foundation? Assume that the water surface in the tanks remains
horizontal. The specific weight of water is 62.4 Iblft’.

I--IO’- 1 - 1 0 ’ 4
12.104. An astronaut on a space walk pulls a mass A of 100 kg
toward him and shonens the distance d by 5 m. If the astronaut
weighs 660 N on earth, how far does the mass A move from its
original position? Neglect the mass of the cord.
Figure P.12.105.

12.11 Closure
In this chapter, we integrated Newton’s law for various coordinate systems.
Also, with the aid of the mass center concept, we formulated Newton’s law
for any aggregate of panicles. In the next two chapters, we shall present alter-
native procedures for more efficient treatment of certain classes of dynamics
problems for particles. You will note that, since the new concepts are all
derived from Newton’s law, whatever problems can be solved by these new
methods could also be solved by the methods we have already presented. A
separate and thorough study of these topics is warranted by the gain in insight
into dynamics and the greater facility in solving problems that can be achieved
by examining these alternative methods and their accompanying concepts. As
in this chapter, we will make certain generalizations applicable to any aggre-
gate of particles.

57 1

-
12.106. A hlock A of mass 10 kg rests on a second block R of -"
mass 8 kg. A force F equal to 100 N pulls block A . The coefficient
of friction between A and A is .S; between B and the ground. . I
What is the speed of block A relative to block B in 0.1 sec if the
system starts from rest?
Figure P.12.108.

12.109. A ipring requires a fiircr x2 N for a deilection UIX ~mm,


where 1 is the deflection of the spring from the undeiurmcd georri-
et?. Because the deflection i'i n a l propottimiil to .li t o t h r Iirsi
power, the spring is C d k d a rLo,ilitieor spring. If a I(lO-kg hlock is
suddenlv, released on the undetnrmrd sormg.
~~
~~
~~ ~
-. what i s the meed of
~~~~ ~

Figure P.12.106. the block after il has descended I O mn'!

*12.107. A block B slides from A to F along a rectangular chute


where there is coulombic friction on the faces of the chute. The
coefficient of dynamic friction is .4. The bottom face of the chute
is parallel to face EACF (a plane surface) and the other two faces
are perpendicular to EACF. The body weighs 5 Ib. How long does
it take R to go from A to F starting from rest'?
Figure P.12.109.

1Z.IJU. A horifontal platform is rotating at il coilstant angular


speed 0 ot 5 radls. Fixed to the platiorni is a triclionlcw chute i n
which two identical masses each of 2 kg are constrained hy a pair
01lincar spring, cach 01 q x i n p conitant K = 250 Nlm. If the
unstrctched length lo of rach o i thc qxings i b . I K m, \how that at
?teddy stiltc the anglc 0 must hilvc the value 36x7". Springs are
fixed to the platform at A.

/'Z K = 250 Nlm

Figure P.12.107.

12.108. A tugboat is pushing a barge at a steady speed of X


knots. The thrust from the tugboat needed for this motion is 800
Ih. The barge with load weighs I00 tons. If the wilier resisrancr 10
the barge is proportional to the speed of the barge. how l w p will
it take the barge to slow to 5 knots after the tugboat ceascs to
push? (Note: 1 knot equals 1.152 milhr.) Figure P.12.110.

572
12.111. What is the velocity and altitude of a communications 12.116. The following data are giveii for the flyhall governor
satellite that remains in the same position above the equator rela- (read Problem 12.60 for details on how the governor works):
tive to the earth's surface? I = ,215 m
D = 50mm
12.112. A satellite is launched and attains a velocity of 19,000 o = 300rpm
mihr relative to the center of the earth at a distance of 240 mi e = 45"
from the earth's surface. The satellite has been guided into a path
that is parallel to the earth's surface at burnout.
(a) What kind of trajectory will it have'?
(h) What is its farthest position from the earth's surface?
(c) 11it is in orhit, compute the time it takes to go from
the minimum point (perigee) to the maximum point (apo-
gee) from the earth's sutiace.
(d) What is the minimum escape velocity for this posi-
tion of launching?

12.113. A rocket system is capable of giving a satellite a veloc-


ity of 35,200 km/hr relative to the earth's surface at an elevation
of 320 km above the earth's surface. What would be its maximum
distance h from the surface of the earth if it were launched ( I )
from the North Pole region or (2) from the equator, utilizing the
spin of the earth as an aid?

12.114. A space vehicle is to change frnm a circular parlang


orbit 320 km above the surface of Venus to one that is 1,620 h P
above this surface. This motion will be accomplished by two fK- Figure P.12.116.
~

ings of the rocket system of the vehicle. The first firing causes the
vehicle attain an apogee that is km above the surface of What is the force P acting on frictionless collar A if each ball has
a mass of I kg and we neglect the weight of all other moving
At this apogee, a second firing is accomplished so as
members Of the system?
achieve the desired circular orbit. What is the change - in swed
demanded for each firing if the thmst is maintained in each ~2.117. A spy to observe the united states
is put into a
instance over a small portion of the trajectory of the vehicle? circular orbit about the North and South Poles. The satellite is to
Neglect friction. The radius Of Venus IS 6,160 km, and the escape make 10 (24 hr), What must he the distance from the
velocity at the surface is 1.026 x I O 4 mlsec2. surface of the earth for this satellite?
12.115. Weights A and B are held by light pulleys. If released N
from rest, what is the speed of each weight after 1 sec? Weight A
is 10 Ib and weight B is 40 Ih.

S
Figure P.12.115. Figure P.12.117.

513
12.118. A skylah i s in a circular w h i t ahout the earth at a dir-
ance of 500 km a h w e the earth's surface. A space shuttle has
.endezvoused with the skylab and now, wishing tu dcpart, dcoou-
,les and fires its rockets to move more slowly than thc skylah. If
he rockets are fircd vver il shon time interval, what should the
.elalive speed between thc spdcc shuttle and skylah he at thc end
~f rocket fire ifthe space shuttle ir tu come as cluse as IO0 k m tu
he earth's surface in auhxqurnt ballistic (rocket motoii off1
light'!

12.119. A space vehiclc is launched at a speed of 19,001)milhi


d a t i v e to the earth's center at a position 250 mi a h w e the earth'\
iutiace. If the vehicle has a radial velocity component of 3,000
nilhr toward the earth's center, what is the eccentricity o i the t r a ~
ectory'! What i s the maximum elevation a h w e the earth's a u r f c c
a c h e d by the vehicle'? Do not usc Eq. 12.54.

12.120. A skier is moving down a hill at a speed of 30 milhr


when he is at the position shown. I i the skicr weighs I X O Ih, what
uta1 force do his skis exert 011 thc m u w surikcr? Assumc that thc (h)
:oefficient of friction is . I . The hill Can hc taken a h a paldhdiu Figure 1'. 12.121
surface.

50' ___/
Figure P.12.120.

12.121. A submarine is moving at cunstant speed of 15 knuli


ielow the surface of the ocean. The sub i s at the same time de-
,tending downward while remaining horimntal wnh an accelera-
ion of , 0 2 3 ~ In
. the submarine a tlyball gvvernor opcrates with
weights having a mass each of 500g. Thc governor i s rotating with
ipeed w of 5 r d s e c . If at time I. 0 = 30", 0 = .2 radlaec, and 0
= I rad/sec2, what i s the fwce developed on the upport of guver-
lor system as a result solely of the mution iif the wcights at thia
nstant? Figure 1'. 12.122.

i74
12.123. Three bodies have the following weights and positions 12.125. A small body M of mass 1 kg slides along a wire from A
at timet: to B. There is coulombic friction between the mass M and the
wire. The dynamic coefficient of friction is .4. How long does it
W, = IOlb, x, = 6ft, take to go from A to B?
y , = 10 ft,
ZI = 10 ft
W, = 5 Ib, x2 = 5 ft,
y1 = 6 ft,
z2 = 0
W, = 8 Ib, x3 = 0,
y., = -4 ft,
zj = 0
Determine the position vector of the center of mass at time t.
Determine the velwity of the center of mass if the bodies have the
following velocities:

V, = 6i + 3jfUsec
V, = 1Oi - 3kftisec

V, = 6k ft/sec

Figure P.12.125.
z 12.126. F o r M = I slug and K = 10 Ibhn., what is the speed at
x = 1 in. if a force ot 5 Ib in the x direction is applied suddenly to

/L;;.
the massspring system and then maintained constant? Neglect
the mass of the spring and friction.
e Y

w3 X w2

Figure P.12.123. X

Figure P.12.126.
12.124. In Problem 12,123, the following external forces act on
the respective particles: 12.127. A rod B of mass 500 kg rests on a block A of mass 50 kg.
A force F of 10,ooO N is applied suddenly to block A at the position
6 = 6fi + 3 j - 1Ok Ih (particle 1) shown. If the coefficient of friction pd is .4 for all contact sutiaces,
what is the speed ofA when it has moved 3 m to the end of the rod?
F2 = l5i - 3 j l b (particle 2)
F,, = OIb (particle 3)
What is the acceleration of the center of mass, and what is its posi-
tion after I O sec from that given initially? From Problem 12.123 at
t = o

rc = 3.1%+ 4.26j + 4.35k ft


V, = 4.7% + 1.304j + 1.435k ft/sec Figure P.12.127.
I
12.128. A simply supported beam i s shown You will learn in
your course on strength of materials that a vertical furcc I applicd
at the center cause.: a dellection 6at the center giveii a\

If a mdSS of 200 Ihm, fd\tened to the hsam at i t s midpoint. is sud-


denly relcased. what will its speed hc when the dellrction i\ in.'!
Neglect the mass of the heam. The lcngth of the ham, L. i s 20 it. W(j
Young's modulus E is 30 x IO" psi. and the moment of incrtia 0 1
thc cross bection I i\ 20 in?. Figure P. 12.13I.

L
MA = 101!kg M,# = KOks M , = 5Ohg
Figure P.12.128.

12.129. A piston is shown mainlaining air ill a pressure of X psi


ahore thal ofthe almo.sphrre. I I the piston is all~iwrd1,) ~ccsleraleto
the left, Whdl i s the speed of the piston a h it I ~ O Y C S3 in.? Thc pis-
ton assembly has a mass 013 lhin. Assume that the air rxpends ndi~
ahuticdly (i.e.. with no heat transfer). This meenh that :it all times
-
(,Vi = constant, where V i ? thc volume of the gas and k ib a coil-

I'
stant which f a r air cquals I .4. Neglect the incrtiill elfects of the air

I f
Figure P.lZ.I.32.

Figure P.12.129.

*12.130. In Example 12.6 assume that there are adiabatic expan-


s i o n s and compressions of the gave, (i.c.. that = constant
with k = 1.4). Compare thc 1esu1ts for thc speed of the piston.
Explain why yuur result should bc higher or l m v w than h r the
isothermal case.
t i . . f, 30'
I ~ L.x
.I., 100 kg
M,, .~60 kg
12.131. Body A and hvdy B are connected hy an incxtenrihle f ~ 3.000 N
curd as shown. If hoth bodies are released cimultanetiu\ly. what
dislance do they move in i e c ? Take MA = 25 kg and Ma = 35
kg. The coefficient of friction p,, is .3. Figure P.12.133.
12.134. The system shown is released from rest. What distance
does the body C drop in 2 sec? The cable is inextensible. The co-
efficient of dynamic friction pd is .4 for contact surfaces of bodies
A and A.

Figure P.12.137.

12.138. A car is moving at a constant speed of 65 kmlhr on i


road pan of which (A-R) is paraholic and part (if which (C-D
is circular with a radius vf 3 kin. If the car has an anti-lock brak~
ing system and the static coefficient of friction LI, between the
road and the tires is 0.6, what is the maximum deceleration p o s i -
Figure P.12.134. ble at the x = 2 km position and at the .x = I O km position'? The
total vehicle weight is 12,000 N.
12.135. Do Problem 12.134 for the case where there ic viscou\
damping for the cmtact surfaces of bodies A and B given as .5V
Ih, with V i n ftlsec.

12.136. Two biidies A and A are shown having masses of 40 kg


and 30 kg, respectively. The cables are inextensible. Neglecting
the inertia of the cable and pulleys at C and D, what is the speed
of the block A I sec after the system has been released from rest'?
The dynamic coefficient of friction p,, for the contact surface of
body A is 3. [Hint: From your earlier work in physics, recall that
pulley I ) is instantaneously rotating about point ( I and hence point c 2km
, I

I O km

lnnves at a speed that is twice that of point h.] Figure P.12.138.

12.139. A mass rrf 3 kg is moving along a vertically oriented


. linear spring with K
parabolic rod whose equalion i s ? = 3 . 4 ~ ' A
= 550 Nim connects to the mass and is unstretched when the
mass is at the bottom of the rod having an unstretched length & =
I m. When the spring ccnterline is 30" from the vertical, a< shown
i n the diagram, the mass is moving at 2.8 mls. At thih instant, what
is the force component on the rnd directed normal tn the rod'!

I
L 2 4r'
.. ~

M-3kg
Figure P.12.136. K = sso N/,,,

12.137. Bodies A , A, and C have weights, of 100 Ib, 200 Ih, and
- -x
150 Ib, respectively. If released from rest, what are the respective
speeds of the bodies after I sec? Neglect the weight of pulleys. Figure P.12.139.

577
12.140. A heated cathode gives off electnins which are attracted *12.141. A weightless cord supports two identical milh\es cauh
to thc pusitivc anode. Some go through a s m d 1 hole and enter the o l weight W . The cord i s heing pulled at a constdnt speed y, by a
parallel plales at an anglc with the hori/ontal o f a,, = 0 and a force I.'. Formulate im equation for F ill terms of l{j,
L, i. W , and h .
velcrcily ofvr Dctrrrninc the horizontal and ve!iical motiorls of Detmmine t for the filllowing condition\:
the declron inside the plates as a function o f time. Letting r = /.
find thc time that the clectron i s in the parallel plalc rcgion and \{, = 2.2 nil\ W = $0 N
then "blain thc exit vertical velucily. Assuming straight-line motion
until the electrm~hits thc screen. show that the vcnicill position of L = 3.3 111 I, = .I6 m
impact, assuming thc screen i s flat. i s
/ = .2h 111

Location of
sinall hole

Figure P.12.140. Figure P.12.141.


Energy Methods
for Particles

Part A Analysis for a Single Particle


13.1 Introduction
In Chapter 12, we integrated the differential equation derived from Newton's
law to yield velocity and position as functions of time. At this time, we shall
present an alternative procedure, that of the method of energy, and we shall z
see that certain classes of problems can be more easily handled by this
method in that we shall not need to integrate a differential equation.
To set forth the basic equation underlying this approach, we start with
Newton's law for a particle moving relative to an inertial reference, as shown
in Fig. 13.1. Thus,
1
F = m -d z r - mdV (13.1)
dt? dt X

Multiply each side of this equation by dr as a dot product and integrate from Figure 13.1. Particle moving relative to an
inertial reference.
r, to rr along the path of motion:

In the last integral, we multiplied and divided by dt, thus changing the var-
able of integration to t . Since drldt = V . we then have

519
580 CHAPTER I3 ENERGY METHODS FOR PART1CLb.S

On carrying out the integration, we arrive at the familiar equation

(I3.2)

where the left side i s the well-known expression for work (to be denoted :it
1
times as ?li-2)l and the right side i s clearly the change in kinetic. enrr,q? as
the mass moves from position rI to position r2.
We shall see in Section 13.7 that for any system ofparticles, including. of
course, rigid bodies. we get a work-energy equation o f the form 13.2, where
the velocity i s that of the mass center, the force i s the resultant external force on
the system, and the path of intcgration i s that of the mass center. Clearly, then.
we can use a single particle model (and consequently Eq. 13.2) for:
I. A rigid hody movirig without nmtion. Such a motion was discussed in
Chapter I I and i s called traiislatioii. Note that line:, in a translating body
remain parallel lo their original directions, and points i n the body move
over a path which has identically the same form for all points. This condi-
tion i s illustrated in Fig. 13.2 for two points A and B. Furthermore, each
point in the body has at any ins1:int oftiinc Ithe same vel(ici1y as any other
point. Clearly the motion o f the center o f mass fully characterizes the
motion o f the body and Eq. 13.2 w i l l hc used often for this hituation.
2. Sometimes for a bod)>whose s i i e is sniull c.o,izporrd to i t s t r ( ~ j r l r c t i ~Here
r~.
Figure 13.2. lranslating hody. the paths of points in the body d i l t r very little from that of the mass cen-
ter and knowing where the center o i i n a s s i s tells us with sufficient accu-
racy all we need tu know about the position o f the body. However, keep in
mind that the v e k ~ i t yand ucwl6'mliivJ 1-el;itive to the center of mass of a
pan of the body may be Very large. irrespective o f how small the body
may be when compared to the trajectory OS i t b center of mass. Then, infor-
mation about the velocity and acccleration of this part o f the body relative
to the center of mass would require a more detailed consideration beyond
a simple one-particle model centered around the ccnter o f mass.
Thus, as i n our considcrations or Newton':, law in Chapter 12. when the
motion of the in as^ center characterizes with sufficient accuracy what we
want to know about thc motion of a body. we USE a particle at the mass cen-
ter for energy considerations.
Next, suppose that we have a component OS Newton's law in one direc-
tion. say the x direction:
SECTION 13.1 INTRODUCTION 581
Taking the dot product of each side of this equation with h i + dyj + dzk
(= dr), we get, after integrating in the manner set forth at the outset:

Similarly,

(13.3b)

Thus, the foregoing equations demonstrate that the work done on a particle in
any direction equals the change in kinetic energy associated with the compo-
nent of velocity in that direction.
Instead of employing Newton’s law, we can now use the energy equa-
tions developed in this section for solving certain classes of problems. This
energy approach is particularly handy when velocities are desired and forces
are functions of position. However, please understand that any problem solv-
able with the energy equation can he solved from Newton’s law; the choice
between the two is mainly a question of convenience and the manner in
which the information is given.

ExamDle 13.1
An automobile is moving at 60 mihr (see Fig. 13.3) when the driver jams
on his brakes and goes into a skid in the direction of motion. The car weighs 4.oM) Ib
4,000 lb, and the dynamic coefficient of friction between the rubber tires
and the concrete road is .60. How far, 1, will the car move before stopping?
A constant friction force acts, which from Coulombs law is pdN =
(.60)(4,000) = 2,400 Ih. This force is the only force performing work, and
c l e d y it is changing the kinetic energy of the vehicle from that corre-
sponding to the speed of 60 mihr (or 88 ft/sec) to zero. (You will learn in
thermodynamics that this work facilitates a transfer of kinetic energy of Figure 13.3. Car moving with brakes
the vehicle to an increase of internal energy of the vehicle, the road, and locked.
the air, as well as the wear of brake parts) From the work-energy equa-
tion 13.2, we get2
1 4,000
-2,4001 = - -- ( 0 - 88*)
2 g
Hence,
I =

(Perhaps every driver should solve this problem periodically.)

‘Note that the sign of the work done is negative since the friction force is opposite in
s m s e to the motion.
582 CHAPTER I 3 ENERGY METHODS FOR PARTK'LES

Example 13.2
Shown in Fig. 11.4 i s a light platSorm R guided hy vertical rods, Thc plat-
form i s positioned so that the spring has been compressed 1 0 mm. In thir
configuration a body A weighing 100 N i s placed on the platiorm and re-
leased suddenly. If the guide rods give a total ciinstant resistance forccf to
downward movement CIS the platform 1ir 5 N, what i r the largest distancc
that the wcight f i l l s ' ? The spring used here i s il rionliricor spring requiring
.Sx2 N of f i x x for il deflection of x mm.
We take as the position OS interest for thc body the location 6 helo\u
the initial configuration at which Iiication thc body A reaches x r o velocity
for the f i r s t lime alter having been released. The change i n kinctic encrgy
ovci- the interval i s accordingly zerii. Thus, zero net work IYd i m hy the
fiirces acting on the body A during diydacemcnl 6. Thcse forces comprihc
the force ofgravity. the friction force Sroin the guides. and finally the force
from the spring. Using as thc origin for our tne:tsuretnenls the rindrfiwmi4
top end position 01 the spring,' we can say:

Therefiirc,
6'+ 306' - 2706 = 0 (L )

One solution to Eq. (c) i s 6 = 0. Clearly, no work i s done if there i s no


detlection. But this solution has no meaning Tor this problem since the force
in the spring i s only .5x2 = .5(10)2 = SO N, when the weight of 100 N i s
released. Therefore, there must be a non7,erii positive valuc of 6that satislics
the equation and has physical meaning. Factoring out onc 6 from the equa-
tion, we then set the resulting quadratic expression equal 10 7.erci. Two roots
result and the positive root 6 = 7.25 mm i s the one with physical meaning.
6 = 7.25 mm
'Since the force in the apring i \ il lunction 01 lhc rlongalion ut the ipiiiig from i t \ i,n,k,~
formed gmnetry. we must pul Ihe origin ot mu referenre at a p a s i l i i m c ~ r m p m ~ l i n10p ilic
undelormcd geometry. At this position. both I and the bpriog h l ~ arc c KIC ~~,,,~,l,~,,,~,,~,~l~

In the f ~ i l l o w i n gexample we deal with two bodies which can he ciiii-


sidrred as pnrticles, lathcr than with one body as lids been the case in the pre-
vious examples. We shall deal with these biidies separately in t h i s example.
Later i n the chapter. we shall consider s?.srenn of particles, and in that con-
text we w i l l he ahlc t i i consider this problem a\ a system of particles with less
work needed ti1 reach a siilutiiin.
SECTION 13.1 INTRODUCTION 583
Example 13.3
In Fig. 13.5, we have shown bodies A and B interconnected through a block
and pulley system. Body B has a mass of 100 kg, whereas body A has a
mass of 900 kg. Initially the system is stationary with B held at rest. What
speed will B have when it reaches the ground at a distance h = 3 m below
after being released? What will he the corresponding speed of A? Neglect
the masses of the pulleys and the rope. Consider the rope to he inextensihle.

I
'r I
r c
'XB h

Figure 13.5. System of blocks and pulleys.

You will note from Fig. 13.5 that, as the bodies move, only the distances
l, and lA change; the other distances involving the ropes do not change. And
because the rope is taken as inextensible, we conclude that at all times
l, + 41A = constant (a)
Differentiating with respect to time, we can find that
l, + 41, =0

Therefore,

in = -4i, (b)
On inspecting Fig. 13.5, you should have no trouble in concluding that
= -V, and that in = V,. Hence, from Eq. (h), we can conclude that

v, = 45 (C)
Next take the differential of Eq. (a):
dl, + 4dlA = 0
Therefore,
dlB = -4dl, (d)
584 CHAPIBR I3 ENEKGY M t T I l O D S I'OK PARTICLES

Example 13.3 (Continued)


?
~ and lhat 'It,, = -dl,l. Hencc we szc Irom Eq. (dl that
N o k that d ~ =, (/IH
i8 :I niovcnicnt magnitudc A, 0 1 hody A rcsults i n a no\clnent ningnilude.
4A,. of hwly H :
I
A,j = 4A,, IC)

: With these kinemaLic;ll conclusions as a hackground. we arc now rcady to


pnicced with llie workbenergy considerations.

4
For lhis purpose, wc liave shown a lrcc-hody diagram of body /I
i n Fig. 13.6. Thc work-energy equation for hody /I can then he givcn 21s
I~lll~>w5:
r
'3

Therefore.
(981 ~-T)i3) = IOOV; if)

Now consider thc Iree-body diagram of hody A in Fig. 13.7. The


p work-energy equation for hotly A i s then
(47)iA,,) = i9ilOV: cg)

I And according to Eq. IC).


? \/ L \/ (i)
.I ~I R

!
Suhslituting thc results Ironr Eqs. ( h ) and (i) into (gl. MC gel
SECTION 13.2 POWER CONSIDERATIONS 58s

i Example 13.3 (Continued)


Adding Eqs.(f) and (j), we can eliminate T to form the following equation
with V, as the only unknown:
(981)(3) = f ( V i ) ( l O O + F)
Therefore,

V,, = 6.14 d s e c downward

Hence,

V, = 1.534 d s e c to the left

13.2 Power Considerations


The rate at which work is performed is calledpowrr and is a vely useful concept
for engineering purposes. Employing the notation <wk
to represent work, we have

Since dwk
for any given force F. is <. - 4.,
we can say that the power
being developed by a system o f n forces at time f is, for a reference xyz,

(13.5)

where is the velocity of the point of application of the ith force at time I as
seen from reference . ~ y z . ~
In the following example we shall illustrate the use of the power con-
ccpt. Note, however, that we shall find use of Newton’s law advantageous in
certain phases of the computation,

“We could haw defined work % iof power as follows:


in terms

When the force acts on a particular particle. the result ahove hecomcs the familiar 5,: F * dr.
where I is the pohition vestor uf the panicle since V dr = dr. Thcrc are times when the force acls
on ionrinuourly <hanging particles as time pasaer (see Section 13.8).The more general fur mu la^
lion above can then be used effectively.
586 CHAPTER 13 ENERGY METHODS FOR PARTICLES

Example 13.4
In hilly terrain, motors of an electric train are sometimes advantageously
employed as hrakes, particularly on downhill runs. This is accomplished
hy switching devices that change the electrical connections of the motors
so as 10 comespond to connections for generators. This allow? power
developed during hraking to he returned to the power source. In this way,
we save much of the energy 1051 when employing conventional hrakcs-a
considerable saving in every round trip. Such a train consisting of B single
car is shown in Fig. 13.8 moving down a 15" incline at an initial speed of
3 mlsec. This car has a mass of 20,000 kg and has a cogwheel drive. If the
conductor maintains an adjustment of the fields in his generators s o as to
develop a constant powcr O M ~ ~ of U I 50 kW, how long does it take before
the car moves at the rate of S nilsec'? Neglect the wind resistance and rota-
tional effects of the wheels. The efficiency of the generators is 90%

Figure 133. Train moving downhill with generators acting as brakes

We have shown all the forces acting on the car in the diagram.
Newton's law along the direction of the incline can he given as

W s i n l Y - / = M dV (a)
dt
where ,f is the traction force from the rails developed by the generator
action. Multiplying hy V to gel power, we get

W s i n 1 5 ° V - , f V = M Vd ~V (h)
dt
If the efficiency of the generators (i.e., the power output divided by the
power input) is .YO. we can computc.fV. which is the power input to
the generators from the wheels. in the following manner:
generator output
~
~~~~~

.90 - .fV (c)


SECTION 13.2 POWER CONSIDERATIONS 587
Example 13.4 (Continued)
Hence

Equation Ibj can now be given as5

(2O,OoO)(Y.81)(.25Y)V - 55,560 = 20,000 V$

Therefore.

2.54V - 2.78 = V-dV (e)


dt
We can separate the variable5 as follows:
V dV
dt =
2.5411 - 2.78
Integrating, using formula I in Appendix I, we get
1
f = -[2.541/
2.54=
- 2.78 + 2.78ln (2.54V - 2.78)] + C (g)

To get the constant of integration C, note that when t = 0, V = 3 d s e c .


Hence,
1
0 = -{(2.54)(3)
2.54=
- 2.78 + 2.78 In [(2.54)(3) - 2.78]} + C
Therefore.
C = -1.430
We thus have for Eq. (g):

f = - [2.54V - 2.78 + 2.78 In(2.54V - 2.78)] - 1.430


2.54=
When V = 5 mlsec, we get for the desired value off:

f=-- I {(2 .54)(5) - 2.78 + 2.78In[(2.54)(5) - 2.78]} - 1.430


2.542

t = l

watt (W) is I Jlsec, where J =joule, which in turn is I N-m.


13.1. What value of constant force P is required to bring the
100-lb body, which starts fmm rest, to a velocity of 30 ft/sec in
20 f t ? Neglect friction.

Figure P.13.1.
Figure P.13.4.

13.5. A 50-kg mas5 on a spring is maved so that it extends the


13.2. A light cable passes over a frictionless pulley. Determinz spring 50 mm frnm its unextended position. If the dynamic cveffi-
the velocity of the 100-lh block after it has moved 30 ft from rest. cient of friction hetwecn thc mass and the supporting surface is 3.
Neglect the inertia of the pulley. The dynamic cocfficienl of fric- (a) What is the velocity of the mass as it returns to the
tion between block and incline i s 0.2 undeformed configuration of the spring?
(b) How far will the spring be campressed when the mass
stops inskmtaneously beforc starting to the left'?

F,, = .3
Higure P.13.5.

13.6. A truck-trailer is shwm carrying three crushed junk auto-


F,, = 2 mobile cubes each weighing 2,500 Ih. An electromagnet i s used to
pick up the cubes as the truck moves by. Suppose the truck starts
Figure P.13.2.
at pasition I by applying a constant 600 in.-lb total torque on the
drive wheels. The magnet picks up only one cuhe C during the
process. What will the velocity of the truck he when it has maved
a total of 100 It? l h e truck unloaded weighs 5,0130 Ib and has a
13.3. In Problem 13.2, the pulley has a radius o f I ft and has a
tire diameter of I 8 in. Neglect the rotational effects of the tires
resisting torque at the bearing af I O Ib-ft. Neglect the inertia of the
and wind friction.
pulley and the mass of the cable. Compute the kinetic energy of
the 100-lb block after it has moved 30 ft frvm rest.

13.4. A light cahle is wrapped around two dmms fixed between


a pair of blocks. The system has a mass of 50 kg. If a 250-N ten-
sion is exerted on the free end of the cable, what is the velocity
25'
A -I
' l " ~ l 0 '
Position I
change of the system after 3 m of travel down the incline? The
body starts from rest. Take u~,for all surfaces as .OS. Figure P.13.6.

588
13.7. Do Problem 13.6 if the first cube B and the last cube D are 13.11. A 1,000 N force is applied to a 3,000-N block at the posi-
removed as they go by the magnet. tion shown. What is the speed of the block after it moves 2 m?
There is Coulomb friction present. Assume at all times that the
13.8. A passenger ferry is shown moving into its dock to unload pressure at the bottom of the block is uniform. Neglect the height
passengers. As it approaches the dock, it has a speed of 3 knots of the block in your calculations. Roller at right end moves with
(1 knot = ,563 d s e c ) . If the pilot reverses his engines just as the the block.
front of the ferry comes abreast of the first pilings at A, what con-
stant reverse thrust will stop the feny just as it reaches the ramp
B? The ferry weighs 4,450kN. Assume that the ferry does not hit
the aide pilings and undergoes no resistance from them. Neglect
the drag of the water.
p n = .2

Figure P.13.11.

13.12. Two blocks A and B are connected by an inextensible


chord running over a frictionless and massless pulley at E. The
system starts from rest. What is the velocity of the system after it
has moved 3 ft? The coefficient of dynamic friction fid equals .22
for bodies A and U .

W, = 50lb

Figure P.13.12.

Figure P.13.8. 13.13. What are the velocities of blocks A and B when, after
stalting from rest, block U moves a distance of .3 ft? The dynamic
13.9. Do Problem 13.8 assuming that the ferry rubs against the coefficient of friction is .2 at all sudaces.
pilings as a result of' a poor entrance and undergoes a resistance
against its forward motion given as Y
f = 9(x + 50) N
where I is measured in meters from the first pilings at A to the
front of the ferry.

13.10. A freight cdr weighing 90 kN is rolling at a speed of


1.7 d s e c toward a spring-stop system. If the spring is nonlinear
such that it develops a .0450x2-kN force for a deflection of x mm,
what is the maximum deceleration that the car A undergoes?

Figure P.13.10. Figure P.13.13.

589
13.14. A particle of mass 10 Ihm is acted on hy the following
Forcc field:

F = 5xi + (Ih + 2y)j + 2Ok Ih


When it is at the origin. the particle has a vclricity y , given iis
v, = Si + l0j + Xkftisrc

What is ils kinetic energy when it reaches positiun (20. 5 . I O )


while moving along a frictionless path'! Does the shape of llie path
xtween the origin and (20, 5, I O ) affect the resull'?
Figure P.13.17.
13.15. A plate AA is held down by screws C and 11 xi that a
'nrce of 245 N is developed in cach spring. Mass M of 100 kg is 13.1% A classroom demonstration unit is used i o illustrate
ilaced on plate AA and released suddenly. What is the inaxiiniim vihration': and interactions of bodies. Body A has a mass 01.5 kg
iistance that plate AA descends if the plate can slide freely down and is moving to the left at a s p e d of 1.6 iiilsec at the position
:he vertical guide rods'! Take K = 3,600 Nlm. indicated. 'The body rides o n il cushion of air supplied from thc
t u k H through \mall openings in the tube. If there is a ~ ~ n s i a n i
frictioii force of . I N, what speed will A have when it returns ID
thc position shown in the diagram'! Thcrc are two spring? at (',
each having a ~ p n t i pconstant nf 15 Nlm.
A A

Figure P.13.15.

13.16. A 200-1h block is dropped o n the system of springs. I f


Y, = 600 Iblft and K2 = 200 Iblft, what is the niaxinium force
Figure P.13.18.
leveloped (in the body'!
13.19. A n clcctmn mwes i n a circulx orbit in a plane at right
anglcs to Ihe direction of a uniform magnetic field N . I S the
strength of I3 is slowly changed si) that thc radius of the orbit is
halved, what is the I d h OS the final t o the initial angular speed of
the electron'! Explain the steps you take. The force F on a chu-ged
particle is yV x H , where q is the chargc and Vis the veloclty d
5'
the p;sticle.
I

H
X X X x x X
Magnaio
J Field
Figure P.13.16. x X

13.17. A block weighing SO Ih i'i shown on an inclined surfacz. X X x x


The block is released at the position shown at a rest condition.
Nhat is the maximum compression of the spring'? The spring har
I spring constant K of 10 Iblin., and the dynamic coefficient 0 1 x x x x x x
,.
riction between the hlock and the incline is .3. Figure P.13.19.

i90
13.20. A light rod CD rotates about pin C under the action of
constant torque T of 1.000 N-m. Body A having a mass of 100 kg
slides an the lhorizontal surface for which the dynamic coefficient
of friction is .4. If rod CD starts from rest. what angular speed is
attained in one complete revolution? The entire weight of A is
borne by the horizontal surface.

'1 Figure P.13.22.


\ 13.23. A conveyor has drum D driven by a torque of 50 ft-lb.
Bodies A and B on the conveyor each weigh 30 Ib. The dynamic
coefficient of friction between the conveyor belt and the conveyor
bed is .2. If the conveyor starts from rest, how fast along the con-
vevor do A and B move after traveline 2 ft? Drum C rotates freely,
~

and the tension in the belt on the underside of the conveyor is


20 Ib. The diameter of both drums I S 1 ft. Neglect the mass of
1 Top view drums and belt. A and B do not slip on belt.
Figure P.13.20.

13.21. An astronaut is attached to his orbiting space laboratory


by a light wire. The astronaut is propelled by a small attached
compressed air device. The propulsive force is in the direction of
the man's height from foot to head. When the wire is extended its
full length of 20 ft, the propulsion system is started, giving the
astronaut a steady push of 5 Ib. If this push is at right angles to the
wire at all times, what speed will the astronaut have in one revolu-
tion about A ? The weight on earth of the astronaut plus equipment
is 250 Ib. The mass of the laboratory is large compared to that of Figure P.13.23.
the man and his equipment.
13.24. Bodies A and B are connected to each other through two
light pulleys. Body A has a mass of 500 kg, whereas body B has
a mass of 200 kg. A constant force F of value 10,000N is applied
to body A whose surface of contact has a dynamic coefficient of
friction equal to .4. If the system starts from rest, what distanced
does B ascend before it has a speed of 2 mlsec'! [Hinr: Consider-
ing pulley E, we have instantaneous rotation about point e. Hence,
v, = fy.1

Figure P.13.21.

13.22. Body A , having a mass of 100 kg, is connected to body B e


F
by an inextensible light cable. Body B has a mass of 80 kg and is
on small whcels. The dynamic coefficient of friction between A
and the horizontal surface is .2. If the system is released from rest,
how far d must B move along the incline before reaching a speed
of 2 d s e c ? Figure P.13.24.

591
Vigure P.13.28.

Figure P.13.29.

Figure P.1.3.27.
the path. The spring is unstretched when P is released. Neglect 13.34. A 15-ton streetcar accelerates from rest at a constant rate
friction and find how far P drops. Take 7 = 7~12,A = C = 1 a,, until it reaches a speed V , , at which time there is zero accelera-
tion. The wind resistance is given as KV2. Formulate expressions
for power developed for the stated ranges of operation.

Figure P.13.34.

13.35. What is the maximum horsepower that can be developed


Figure P.13.30.
on a streetcar weighing 133.5 kN? The car has a coefficient of sta-
13.31. A body A of mash 1 Ibm is moving at time f = 0 with a tic friction of .20 between wheels and rail and a drag given as
speed V gf I ft/sec on a smooth cylinder as shown. What is the 32V2 N, where Vis in d s e c . All wheels are drive wheels.
speed of (he body when it arrives at E! Take I = 2 ft.
13.36. A 7,500-kg streetcar starts from rest when the conductor
draws 5 kW of power from the line. If this input is maintained
constant and if the mechanical efficiency of the motors is 90%
how long does the streetcar take to reach a speed of 10 k d h r ?
Neglect wind resistance. ( I kW = 1.341 hp.)

13.37. A children's boat ride can be found in many amusement


parks. Small boats each weighing 100 Ib areTotated in a tank of
water. If the system is rotating with a speed 0 of 10 rpm, what is
the kinetic energy of the system? Assume that each boat has two
Figure P.13.31.
60-lb children on board and that the kinetic energy of the support-
13.32. 4 n automobile engine under test is rotating at 4,400 rpm ing structure can be accounted for by "lumping" an additional
and develops a torque of 40 N-m. What is the horsepower devel- 30 Ibm into each boat. II a wattmeter indicates that 4 kW of power
oped by *e engine'? If the system has a mechanical efficiency of is being absorbed by the motor turning the system, what is the
.90, wha( is the kilowatt output of the generator'? [Hinr: The drag for each boat? Take the mechanical efficiency of the motor to
4
work of torque equals the torque times the angle of rotation in be 80% (1 kW = 1.341 hp.)
radianq.1
~~ ~~

Figure P.13.32.

13.33. A rocket is undergoing static thrust tests in a test stand. A


thrust of h ( H ) , 0 0 0 Ib is developed while 300 gal of fuel (specific
gravity 2)is burned per second. The exhaust products of combus-
tion ha"$ a speed of 5,000 Wsec relative to the rocket. What
power is emg developed on the rocket'! What is the power d e w -
b
oped on t , e exhaust gases'! ( I gal = ,1337 ft'.) Figure P.13.37.

593
594 CHAPTER I? t:NER(iY METHOIS FOR PARTICLES

,' W 13.3 Conservative Force Fields


i', In Section 10.6 we discussed an important class [if fnrccs called conservatiw
fiirces. For convenience. wc shall now repeat this discussion.
Consider first a hody acted on only by gravity W a s an active force (i.c.. ii
fiirce that citn do wnrk) and moving along a frictionless path from position I
to position 2, a s shown in Fig. 13.9. The vmrk done by gravity Tt: i s tllcn
2
2' 0 x i*~)~ = f l Z ~ . ( ~ r = ~ 1 2 ( - ~ ) . ( ~ r ~ = ~

Figure 13.9. Panicle moving along (13.6)


= =W(y, - V I ) = W(., = ,.?I
frictimless path.
Note that the work done dops iiof d(,pmil on the path, but depends only oil the
positions of the end points of the path. f:orw.fieldy ~ ~ O workS P like , y ~ - ~ i b , i f ?i.\
iridependmr of fhf, p a f h are c.a/led wnscrvative ,/orce firld,s. I n general. we
can say f o r conservative force field F(n. y, :) that, along any path hetween
positions I and 2, the work i s
~ ~ =1~~ ~ . i 1l r = =~I , ~. . (.2~. )r- \ ? ( x1 , y , ; )
(13.7)

where \?is a function [if position of the end points and i s called the poferifiol
f~mction."We may rewrite Eq. 13.7 as follows:

-Jl'F.dr=\-:(n, (13.R)

Note that the potential energy, X'(.x, y, z ) , depends on the reference .qused or.
a s we shall often say. the dmum used. However, the <.hungein potential cncrgy,
AX), i s in&pmdmr o f the datum used? Since we shall hc using the change in
potential energy. the datum i s arbitrary and i s chosen f(ir convenience. From Eq.
I3.X, we can say that the chongP in potenrial energy, A I ' ( = I .! - of it
conservative force field is rlir nrgutive of r l i ~work (lone hv this coir.wn'arii,e
lorwfield on i i purfide in p i n g from pmifiim I fo po.yitio,, 2 nlon,? any patli.
For any do.sed path. clearly the work done hy a cnnservative lbrce field F i s then

$ ~ . d r= O ( I3.9)

Hence. this i s a second way to define a conservative force field. How i s


the potential energy function %)related to F ? To answer this query, consider
that an infinitesimal path dr stiifls from point I . We can then give Eq. 13.8 a s
F - dr = -dl i (13.10)
SECTION 13.3 CONSERVATTVE FORCE FIELD 595
E x p r e s s ~ gthe dot product on the left side in terms of components, and
expressing d v a s a total differential, we get

, FA&+Fydv+Fd7=- (13.11)

We can tonclude from this equation that

(13.12)

In other Lords.

av. av
-JrV+ .- - ~ + - k
ax ay az
(I 3.13)

The opetator grad or V that we have introduced 13 Cdlled the gradient opera-
tor8 and IS given as follows for rectangular coordinates:

(I 3.14)

We can now say as a third definition that a conservariveforcejield must


be a fun+tiun of position and expressible as the gradient of a scalarfunction.
The invebse to this statement is also valid. That is, $a forcefield is a function
of positi n and the gradient of a scalarfield, it must then be a conservative
,force&
T d o examples of conservative force fields will now be presented and
discusse#.

C n n s t a j t Force Field. If the force field is constant at all positions, it

4
can alw ys be expressed as the gradient of a scalar function of the form
7 / = -( + by + cz), where a, b, and c are constants. The constant force
field, then, is F = ai + bj + ck.
In limited changes of position ne% the earth’s surface (a common situ-
ation), d e can consider the gravitational force on a panicle of mass, m, as a

The~gradientoperator comes up in many situations in engineering and physics. In short.


the gradie t repre\enta a driving action. Thus. in the present case. the gradient is a driving action
to cause A s s to k v e . And, the gradient of temperature causes heat to tlow. Finally, the gradi-
ent ofelec(ric potential causes electric charge to tlow.
596 CHAPTER I 7 ENRROY METHODS FOR PARTICLES

constant force field given by -ingk (or -Wk). Thus, the constants for the
general force field given abovc are u = h = 0 and c = -mg. Clearly.
PE = m g for this case.

Force Proportional to Linear Displacements. Consider a hody limited by


constraints to move along a straight line. Along this line is developed a force
dircctly proportional tu the displacemcnt of the body from some position 0 at
x = 0 along the line. Furthermore, this force is always directed toward point
0; it is then termed a wstoriiig force. We can give this force as

F = -Kxi (13. IS)

where .x is the displacement from point 0. An example of this force is that of


the linear spring (Fig. 13.I O ) discussed in Section 12.3. The potential energy
of this force field is given as follows wherein x is measured from the unde-
formed geometry (don't forget this important factor) of the spring:

configuration

Figure 13.10. Linear spring.

What is the physical meaning of the term PE'? Note that the change in
potential energy has been defined (>reEq. 13.81 as the negative of the work
done by a conservative furce as the particle o n which it acts goes from one
position to another. Clearly, the change in the potential energy is then direct/!
equal 10 the work donc by the rmction to thc conscrvative furce during this
diqplacenient. In the case of the .spring. the rcaction force would be the furce
,fron7 the surroundings acting 0 1 7 the spring at point B (Fig. 13.10). During
extension or ciimprcssion of the spring from thc undeformed position, this
force (from the surroundings) does a positive amount of work. This work can
bc considered as a nieasure uf the energy storm1 in the spring. Why'! Because
when allowed to return to its original position, the spring will do this amwnt
01 positive work on the surroundings at B , provided that the return motion is
slow enough to prevent oscillations; and so on. Clearly then. since PE equals
work of the surroundings on the spring, then PE is in effect thc stored energy
in the spring. I n a general case, PE is the energy stored in the force field as
mcasurcd from a given datum.
SECTION 13.3 CONSERVATIVE FORCE RELD 597

In' previous chapters, several additional force fields were introduced


the gra$tational central force field, the electrostatic field, and the magnetic
field. Let us see which we can add to our list of conservative force fields.
Cinsider first the central gravitational force field where particle m,
shown ib Fig. 13.11, experiences a force given by the equation
Mm
F =4 - f (13.17)
r2

Figure 13.11. Central force on m.

Clearly, this force field is a function of spatial coordinates and can easily be
expressed as the gradient of a scalar function in the following manner:

F = -grad (-F) (13.1 8)

Hence, this is a conservative force field. The potential energy is then


GMm
PE = -~ (13.19)
r

Next, the force on a particle of unit positive charge from a particle of


charge q, is given by Coulomb's law as

(13.20)

Since this equation has the same form as Eq. 13.17 (Le., is also a function of
l/r2), we see immediately that the force field from q , is conservative. The
potential energy per unit charge is then

(13.21)

The remaining field introduced was the magnetic field where


F = qV x B. For this field, the force on a charged particle depends on the
velocity of the particle. The condition that the force be a function of position
is not satisfied, therefore, and the magnetic field does not form a conservative
force field.
598 CllhPTEK 13 ENERGY METHODS FOK PARTICLES

13.4 Conservation of Mechanical Energy


1x1 tis iiow consider the niotion of a particle upon which only a co~iscr~~ittivc
fiirce field does work. W e btart with Eq. 11.2:
F. dr = InjV?
2 2
~ tnlV’
-
I (13.221

Using the definitiiin of potential energy, we replace the left side of the equa-
tioii in the following manner:
(PE), ~ (PE),-= !,mVt
. .
~~ imV; (11.231
Rearranging terms. wc rcach the fdlowing tr~cltrIrehti(1n:

-$nq = (PE), + $rnq ( 13.24)

Since positions I and 2 are arhitrdry, obviously rlrr .sitni ~ f r l w I i m i i t i r i l enrr,y?.


und the kinetic. ow’rgy,fi,r a purricle rmrnim < oiisfaiit ut r i l l rimes d u r i q the
morion of I h P p r r i d e Thir statement is sometimes called the Iukc o / ( ’ o r i . s ~ r ~
varion of n z ~ h u , i i c u lm e r g y , f i i r ~nn.s(,ri,Nrivt,,swe,n.s. The usefulness 01 this
relation ciiii he denionstrated by the lollowing examples.

Example 13.5
A particle is dropped with Levo initial rclocity down a frictionless chute
(Fig. 13.12). What is the magnitude of its velocity if the vertical drop dur-
ing the niotion is h ft’?
For small trajectorics. we cat1 assume a unifiirm force field -m.yi.
Sincc this is the only force that can pertomi work on the particle (the nor-
mal force lrom the chutc docs 110 work). we can employ the conservation-
of-mechanical-energy equation. I f we take positii~n2 as a datum. wc then r)atum -0 I

havc from Eq. 13.24: Figure 13.12. Paiticlc on irictionlrrs chute


mg/i + 0 = 0 + -I inVi
Solving for V’, we get

v, = SZaR
The advantages o f the energy approach fiir conservative ficlds
become appai-ent li-om this prohleni. That is. not all thc lirrccc need he
considered in computing velocities, and the path, howevcr complicated. is
of n o conccrn If friction were present. a n ~ n c ~ n ~ e r v i i tfwce
i v c would per-
form work, and we would have ti1 g11 back t~ the pencral relation given hy
Eq. 11.2for thc analysis.
SECTION 13.4 CONSERVATTON OF MECHANICAL ENERGY 599

I EXafnple 13.6
A mass is dropped onto a spring that has a spring constant K and a negligible
mass (see Fig. 13.13). What is the maximum deflection S? Neglect the effects
of permanent deformation of the mass and any vibration that may occur.
In this problem, only conservative forces act on the body as it falls.
Using the lowest position of the body as a datum, we see that the body
falls a distance h + 8. We shall equate the mechanical energies at the
uppermost and lowest positions of the body. Thus,
mg(h+S)+ 0 + 0 = 0 fKSz +
0 + (a) Figure 13.13. Mass dropped on spring
-
PE gravity
-
PE spfinng KF.
+ -
PEgravify
-
PE spnDg KE
- - -

Rearranging the terms,

We may solve for a physically meaningful Sfrom this equation by using the
quadratic formula.

EXafnple 13.7
A ski jumper moves down the ramp aided only by gravity (Fig. 13.14). If
the skier moves 33 m in the horizontal direction and is to land very
smoothly at B, what must be the angle 0 for the landing incline? Neglect
friction. Also determine h .
Y

Figure 13.14. A ski jump with a landing ramp at an angle 0 to be determined.


We first use conservation of mechanical energy along the ramp. Thus
( m g ) ( 1 7 )= i m V 2
_-
:. V = 4(2g)(17) = 18.26 d s
600 C'HAPI'EK I3 ENFR(;Y MKIHOOS TOR PARTI('I.FX

Example 13.7 (Continued)


Using a reference t A a s hhown in Fig. 13.14 and nieasuring time fnin1
the instant thal thc nkiei- is at the origin. we tiow use Newton's law for the
frcc flight. Thus
i; = -9.Xl
i= -9.x I1 + c,
1' = -<).XI
I2
~

2
+ ( ' ] I + <;
When I = 0. \. = 0. and we take 1' = 0.Hcncc.
<, I = (,., = 0

Also.
j; = 0
= c
~X = C,l + C,+
Whcn f = 0,.i= 18.26, ;ind .Y = 0,
:_
C3 = 18.26 r, = o
Thus wc have
i. = - 0 . X l l (21) i = IX.26 (C)
12
1' = -9.81 - (b) x = IX.26t (d)

To get 11, h e t .X = 33 iii Eq. (d) and solve Ihr lhc h i e t.

:. 33 = IX.?6/ 1 = 1.807 scc


Hence, going t o Eq. ( h ) we get

/I = -9 81(' 'r2)~ = i6.01m

Now gct $ at landing. Using Eq. (a) we havc


i= -(9,Xl)(I,Xl~7)= -17.73 rnls
Also, we have at all tiinch
i = 18.26 1111s
Fur best landing, Vis parallel to incliiic

t3 = 44.15"
SECTION 13.4 CONSERVATION OF MECHANICAL ENERGY 601
Example 13.8
A block A of mass 200 kg slides on a frictionless surface as shown in Fig.
13. IS. The spring constant Kl is 25 Nlm and initially, at the position shown,
it is stretched .40 m. An elastic cord connects the top support to point C on
A . It has a spring constant K2 of 10.26 Nlm. Furthermore, the cord discon-
nects from C a t the instant that C reaches point G at the end of the straight
portion of the incline. If A is released from rest at the indicated position,
what value of 0 corresponds to the end position B where A just loses con-
tact with the surface? The elastic cord (at the top) is initially unstretched.

,~,~-~ I
(.Y2)(707) mrn

-
Datum

Figure 13.15. Mass A slides along frictionless surface.

We have conservative forces performing work on A so we have


conservation of mechanical energy. Using the datum at 6 and using 1, as
the unstretched length of the spring with 6 as the elongation of the spring,
we then say that

where the last term is the energy in the elastic cord when it disconnects at
G . Therefore, noting that = .94 m and that OB = .92 m, we have on
ohyerving vertical distances in Fig. 13.15:

(.200)(9.SIJ[(.Y2)(.707) + (.92)(.707) + (.92Jsin@]+ 0 + $(25)(.40)Z


= 0 + 1(.20)V: + &(25)(.92- /o)2 + 4(10.26)(.94)2 (a)
602 CHAPTER 13 ENERGY METHODS FOR PARTICLES

Example 13.8 (Continued)


To get I , , examine the initial configuration of the system. With an initial
stretch of .40 m for the spring, we can say observing again vertical dis-
tances in Fig. 13.15:
1, = [(.92)(.707) + (.92)(.707)] - .40
= ,901 m
Equation (a) can then he written as
V: = .I490 + 18.05sin0 (b)
We now use Newton’s law at the point of interest B where A just
loses contact. This condition is shown in detail in Fig. 13.16. where you
will notice that the contact force N has been taken as zeru and thus deleted
from the free-body diagram. In the radial direction. we have

Figure 13.16. Contdcl I \ fir71 lost at 0

Therefore,

This equation can be written as


V: = 2.20 ~ 9.03 sin 8
Solving Eqs. (b) and (c) simultaneously for 0, we get

e = 4.349
SECTION 13.5 ALTERNATIVE FORM OF WORK-ENERGY EQUATION 603

13.5 Alternative Form


of Work-Energy Equation
With the aid of the material in Section 13.4, we shall now set forth an alter-
native energy equation which has much physical appeal and which resembles
thefirst law of thermodynamics as used in other courses. Let us take the case
where certain of the forces acting on a particle are conservative while others
are not. Remember that for conservative forces the negative of the change in
potential energy between positions 1 and 2 equals the work done by these
forces as the particle goes from position 1 to position 2 along any path. Thus,
we can restate Eq. 13.2 in the following way:

f F dr ~ AW‘E)l,2 = A ( W l , 2 (13.25)

where the integral represents the work of nunconservative forces and the A
represents the final state minus the initial state. Calling the integral 5%-2, we
than have, on rearranging the equation:

(13.26)

In this form, we say that the work of nunconservative forces goes into chang-
ing the kinetic energy plus the potential energy for the particle. Since potential
energies of such common forces as linear restoring forces, coulombic forces,
and gravitational forces are so well known, the formulation above is useful in
solving problems if it is understood thoroughly and applied properly.’

YEquatim 13.26. you may notice. is actually a form of the first law of thermodynamics for
the case of no heat transfer.

Example 13.9
Three coupled streetcars (Fig. 13.17) are moving at a speed of 32 km/hr
I
down a 7” incline. Each car has a weight of 198 kN. Specifications from

Figure 13.17 Coupled streetcars.


604 CHAPTER 13 ENERGY METHODS FOR PARTICLES

Example 13.9 (Continued)


the buyer requires that the cars must stop within SO m beyond the position
where the brakes are fully applied so as to cause the wheels to lock. What
is the maximum number of brake failures that can he tolerated and still
satisfy this specification? We will assume for simplicity that the weight is
loaded equally among all the wheels of the system. There are 24 brake
systems, one for each wheel. Take p,, = .45.
The friction force f on any one wheel where the brake has operated
is ascertained from Coulomb’s law as

We now consider the work-energy relation 13.26 for the case where a
minimum number of good brakes, n, just causes the trains to stop in SO m.
We shall neglect the kinetic energy due to rotation of the rather small
wheels. This assumption permits us to use a single particle to represent Lhe
three cars, wherein this particle moves a distance of 50 m. Using the end
configuration of the train as the datum for potential energy of gravity, we
have for Eq. 13.26:

AKE + APE = wl-2

= -(w)(l 1,050)(50)

>I = 10.89

The number of brake failures that cdn accordingly be tolerated is


24 - I I = 13.

N e fa 13

Another example of conservation of mechanical energy will he in the


next section (Example 13.1 I ) for the case of a system of particles.
13.38. A railroad car traveling 5 kmmr runs into a stop at a rai- 13.42. In Problem 13.41, a weight W of 225 N is released sud-
road terminal. A vehicle having a mass of 1,800 kg is held by a denly from rest on the nonlinear spring. What is the maximum
linear restoring force system that has an equivalent spring con- deflection of the spring?
stant of 20.000 Nlm. If the railroad car is assumed to stop sud-
denly and if the wheels in the vehicle are free to turn, what is the 13.43. A vector operator that you will learn more about in fluid
maximum force developed by the spring system'? Neglect rotd- mechanics and electromagnetic theory is the curl vector operator.
tional inertia of the wheels of the vehicle. This operator is defined for rectangular coordinates in terms of its
action on V a s follows:
5 km/hr

curl V(x, y. z ) = -- -
(2 2). I

Figure P.13.38.
13.39. A mass of one slug is moving at a speed of 50 ft/sec
along a horizontal frictionless surface, which later inclines upward
at an angle 45". A spring of constant K = 5 Iblin. is present along
the incline. How high does the mass move,? (When the curl is applied to a fluid velocity field V a s above, the
resulting vector field is twice the angular velocity field of infini-
tesimal elements in the flow.) Show that if F is expressible as
V 4 ( x , y , z ) , then it must follow that curl F = 0. The converse is
also true, namely that ifcurl F = 0, then F = V$ (x, y. z ) and is
thus a conservative force field.
Figure P.13.39.
13.40. A block weighing 10 Ib is released from rest where the 13.44. Determine whether the following force fields are conser-
springs acting on the body are horizontal and have a tension of vative or not.
10 Ib each. What is the velocity of the block after it has descended
4 in. if each spring bas a spring constant K = 5 Iblin.?
(a) F = (1Oz + y j i + (15yz + x ) j + [ lox + I:")
~ k

ltl(Y'+lo+
(b) F = ( z sin x + y ) i + ( 4 y z + x ) j + ( 2 y 2 - 5 cos x ) k
See Problem 13.43 before doing this problem.
A B
13.45. Given the following conservative force field:

F = (102 + y ) i + (15yz + x ) j + lox + 9k N


Figure P.13.40. 2 1
13.41. A nonlinear spring develops a force given as ,063 N, find the force potential to within an arbitrary constant. What work is
where x is the amount of compression of the spring in millimeters. done by the force field on a particle going from r, = 1Oi + 2 j +
Does such a spring develop a conservative force? If so, what is the 3k m to r2 = -2 + 4 j - 3k m? [Hint: Note that if w d x equals
potential energy stored in the spring for a deflection of 60 mm? some function (xy2 + I), then we can say on integrating that
X?jJ
4 = 2 + ui + P(Y, 2 )
where ~ ( y z ,) is an arbitrary function of y and z. Note we have
held y and z constant during the integration.]
13.46. If the following force field is conservative,
Figure P.13.41. F = (52 sin x + y)i + (4yz + x)j + (2y2 - 5 cos x)k Ib

605
(where x. y . and I arc i n ft), find the lorce potential up to an arhi-
trary ciinstanl. What i s thc wtirh doric on B partick \tarring at the
origin and moving in a circular path of radius 2 ft tu 1mn a s e m -
circle alung the positive x axis'! (See the hint in Problem 13.15.)
13.47. A body A can slide i n a frictionlesi manner along it s t i l t
rod CD. At the position shown, the Ypring along CD has been
compressed 6 in. and A is at ii d i m n c e o f 4 ft from 11. 'The spring
connecting A to E has been elongated I in. What is the spccd 01
A after it moves I ft? .The Fpring cmstanla are K , = 1.0 lhiin.
and K , = .5 Iblin. The mass oSA is 30 I b m

Figure P.13.47.
13.48. A collar A uf i n a h s 10 Ihm slides un il frictionless tubs.
The collar is cimnectetl to a IiiiCar spring whose spring cnnstant
K is 5.0 Ihiin. If the c(illiir i s released frum rest at the position tiigiire P.13.50
shown, what i?i t s speed when the \ p i n g is at c l w i i l i m h Y ? The
i glhe lclt iit L: 5pccd 012 i n k c .
13.51. A slotled rod A i \ ~ m w ~ i IO
spring is stretched 3 in. at thc initial posilinn of the collar.
Pins arc moved 10 the left by this rud. 'I h e w pin\ must slidr in a
slnt under the cod as shown i n the diagram. The pins are coil-
nccted hy a spring having ii spring constant K 011.500 Nim. Thc
spring is uiihtrctched in thr conliguration shown What distance d
dc the pills rcach heflirt. \lnppinp iiistantanci,usly'? 'Ibe niaw of
the slutted rod i\ IO kg. 'The spring is held i n thc .;lotled rod XI a
inot to buckle outw:ird. Neglect the mass 01lhc pin\.

Figure P.13.48.
13.49. A mass M of20 kg slides with no friction along a vertical
rod. Two springs each of spring constant K , = 2 Nimm and a
third spring having a spring constant K , = 1 Nlmm are attached
to the mass M .At the starting position when 6 = 30". the springs
are unstretched. What is thc velocity of M after it descends a dis-
tance d of ,112 in? Fipure P.13.51.

606
13.52. The top view of a slotted bar of mass 30 Ibm is shown. 13.55. A meteor has a speed of 56,000 k d h r when it is 320,000
Two pins guided by the slotted bar ride in slots which have the km from the center of the earth. What will be its speed when it is
equation of a hyperbola xy = 5, where x and y are in feet. The 160 km from the earth's surface?
pins are connected by a linear spring having a spring constant K
13.56 Do Problem 13.2 using the energy equation in the usual
of 5 Iblin. When the pins are 2 ft from the y axis, the spring is
form of the first law of thermodynamics.
stretched 8 in. and. the slotted bar is moving to the right at a speed of
2 ftlsec. What is V ofthe bar? [Him: Differentiate energy equation.] 13.57. Do Problem 13.5 using the energy equation in the usual
form of the first law of thermodynamics.
v
13.58. Do Problem 13.17 usine the enerev eauation in the usual
I I, 1

form of the tirat law of thermodynamics.


13.59. Do Problem 13.18 using the energy equation in the usual
form of the first law of thermodynamics.

x
13.60. A constant-torque electric motor A is hoisting a weight W of
30 Ib. An inextensible cable connects the weight W to the motm over
a stationary drum of diameter D = 1 ft The diameter d of the motor
drive is 6 in., and the delivered torque is I50 Ib-ft. The dynamic coef-
ficient of friction between the drum and cable is .2. If the system is
started from rest, what is the speed of the weight W after it has been
I r a i d 5 ft?
Figure P.13.52.
13.53. In Problem 13.52, what is the speed of the slatted bar
when x = 2.25 ft?
13.54. Perhaps many of you as children constructed toy guns
from half a clothespin, B wooden block, and bands of rubber cut
from the inner tube of an automobile tire [see diagram (a)]. Rub-
ber band A holds the half-clothespin to the wooden "gun stock."
The "ammunition" is a rubber band B held by the clothespin at C
by friction and suetched to go around the block at the other end.
The rubber band B when laid flat as in (b) has a length of 7 in. To
Figure P.13.60.
"load the ammunition'' takes a force of 20 Ib at C. If the gun is
pointed upward, estimate how high the fired rubber band will go 13.61. A weighing 10 Ib, can slide i ig a fixed rod
when " tired if it weighs 4 oz. To "fire" the gun you push lowest B-B. A spring is connected between fixed point C and the mass.
part of clothespin toward the nail (see diagram) to release at C. AC is 2 ft in length when the spring is unextended. If the body is
released from rest at the configuration shown. what is its speed
when it reaches the y axis? Assume that a constant friction force
of 6 OL acts on the body A. The spring constant K is 1 Ih/in.

I
1Nail
14" 7
Half (a)
clothespin

x
(b) B C
Figure P.13.54. Figure P.13.61.

607
13.62. A hody A is releascd from rcst on il vcitical circular path E
as shown. IIa constant resisrance force 01 I N acts along thr path. (,ioule)
what i c the speed of the hndy when i t reaches li? The rnasr of thr
bod!' is .S kg and the radiw r ofthc path i s I .h In.
A

Figure P.13.62.
13.63. A cylinder slides down a rod. What is the distance fithat
the qpring is deflected at the instant that the disk stops inFtnnta-
newsly'?T a k r p,, = .i.
W ~ 500 N

8 ' K = IO.II(X1 N l

Figure P.13.63.
13.64. In ordnancc work a very v i k d tebt for equipmcnl i s the
attack teit, in which a piccc of equipment i i whjectcd t o a certain Figure P.13.65.
l e v d of accrleiiltiun of shoii duration. A comrnor technique for
thi? test is Ihe drop fmf.The specimen is mounled o n a ripid car-
riage, which upon release is dropprd along guide rods onto il XI 13.66. Suppose in Example l j 4 thal wI! tlic hr&?s t i t i train 11
of lead pads resting irn a heairy rigid anvil. 'The pads dchrrn and opcratc and lock. What 1s thc distance il helore stopping? A l w .
ahiorh the energy 01 the carriage and specimen. We estiniatc dctermine the lorcc in each coupling o i the system.
through other tests that the energy F ahsorhed hy a pad \ersii%
compression distvncc S is given as shown, where the curve can bc
takcn as a pwabala. For four such pads, each placed dircclly on
the anvil, and a height h of 3 111. what is the compressinn 0 1 the
pads'! The carriage mil cpecimen together wrigh SO,? N. Ncglrct
the friction of thc guides. (NoIP: I I = I N-m.)

Figure P.13.67.

608
SECTION 13.6 WORK~ENERGYEQCJATIONS 609

Part 6: Svstems of Particles


13.6 Work-Energy Equations
We shall now examine a system of particles from an energy viewpoint. A Z
general aggregate of n particles is shown in Fig. 1.3. I X. Considering the ith e
particle, we can say, by employing Eq. 13.2:

where, as in Chapter 12, Aj is the force from the j t h particle onto the ith part- x/ Inertial reference
cle, as illustrated in the diagram, and is thus an internal force. In contrast, F Figure 13,18. System of
represents the total external force on the ith particle. In words, Eq. 13.27 says
that for a displacement between r1 and rz along some path, the energy rela-
tions for the ith particle are:
external work + internal work
= (change in kinetic energy relative to X Y Z ) ( I 3.28)
Furthermore, we can adopt the point of view set forth in Section 13.5 and
identify conservative forces, both external and internal, so 3s to utilize potential
energies for these lorces in the energy equation. To qualify
force, an internal force would have to be a function of only the spatial configu-
ration of the system and expressible as the gradient of a scalar function. Clearly,
forces arising from the gravitational attraction between the particles, electrosta-
tic forces from electric charges on the panicles, and forces from elastic connec-
tors between the particles (such as springs) are all conservative internal forces.
We now sum Eqs. 13.27 for all the particles in the system to get the
energy equation for a .v.vvstem ofparricles. We do nor necessarily get a cancel-
lation of contributions of the internal forces as we did for Newton’s law in
Chapter 12 because we are now adding the work done by each internal force
on each particle. And even though we have pairs of internal forces that are
equal and opposite, the movemem of the corresponding particles in general
are nut equal. The result is that the work done by a pair of equal and opposite
internal forces is not always zero. However, in the case of a rigid body, the
contact forces between pairs of particles making up the body have the same
motion, and so in this case the internal work is zero from such~forces.1°Also, if
there is a system of rigid bodies interconnected by p i n y 6 a l l joint connections,
and if there is no friction at these movable connecf’ons, then again there will
be no internal work. (Why?) We can then say for the system of particles that
A(KE + PE) = ‘M.j-, i 13.29)

“’We shall show this more directly in Chapter 17.


6I O CHAITEK I 3 ivtimtoiis FOK P A RTIC L E S
~ZNEKGY

where 'kL:~represents the net work done by internul und exremu/ nonconser-
valive forces. and PE represents the total potcntial energy of the conscrvative
inlrrnul u r d exlrmol forces. Clearly. i f thzre are no nonconselvative forces
present then Eq. ( 13.291 degenerates to the conservation-of-mechanic;~l-eiiergy
principle. As pointed out earlier. since wc are employing the i~kangein poten-
tiiil energy. the dalums choscn for measuring PE are of littlc significance
herc." For instance. any convenient datum for meahusing the potential energy
due to gravity of the carth yields the same rcsult for thc term APE.
Looking hack on Eq. ( 13.27). which o n buiiitnatiun over a11 thc particles
pave rise to Eq. ( 13.291, namely the equation 10 he used fora system O S parti-
cles, we wish to make the following point. I t is the fact that the work contri-
bution of each force Stems from the mnwineirr of rudi f i ) r c r wilh ill .spcific
puiri~o/uppliwlioii. This should he clear from the 11% oSdr,. with i identily-
ing tach particlc. This will be an important considcration later.
Let us now consider the action of gravity on a system of particles. The
I.
potcntial energy relative to a datum pI"ne, q, for such a system (see Fig.
13.19) is simply

PE = C n l , ~ ; ,

Notc that the right side o f this equation represents the first moment of the
Figure 13.19. Pil-ticlei a b o w refcnencr
planc.
weight of the system ahoul the .rj plane. This quantity can he given i n teriiis
of the center of gravity and the entire weight of W a s follows:
PE = Wr,
where :, is the vertical distance from thc datum plane to the center of gravity.
Note that if g is comtant, the center of gravity corresponds to lhe center of
mass. And so for any Yystem of particles. the change in potential energy i\
readily found hy concentrating the entire weight at the center of gravity or. as
is almost always the case, at the center OS mass.
Before proceeding with the problems we wish to emphasize certain
salient features governing the w o r k m e r g y principle for a system of
particles.

5 the mass center.


SECTION 13.6 WORK-kNEKGY EQIJATIONS 61 I

Example 13.10
In Fig. 13.20, two blocks have weights W, and W,. respectively. They are
connected by a flexible, elasrii. cahle of negligible mass which has an
equivalent spring constant of Kl. Body I is connected to the wall by a spring
having a spring constant K2 and slides along a horizontal s u r f x e for which
the dynamic coefficient of friction with the body is p8 Body 2 is supported
initially by some external agent so that, at the outset of the problem, the
spring and cable are unstretched. What is the total kinetic energy of the
system when, after release, body 2 has moved a distance d2 and body 1 has
moved a smaller distanced,?
Use Eq. 13.29. Only one nonconservative force exists in the system. 'I
the external friction force on body I . Therefore, the work term of the equa-
tion becomes Figure 13.20. Elastically connected badizs.

w2 = -W,P<,dl (a)

Three conservative forces are present; the spring force and the gravita-
tional force are extrrnal and the force from the elastic cable is inrrrnul.
(We neglect mutual gravitational forces between the bodies.) Using the
initial position of W, as the datum for gravitational potential energy, we
have, for the total change in potential energy:

APE = [$K,d: - 01 + [ i K , ( d , ~ d , )2 ~ 01 + [0 - W,d,]

We can compute the desired change in kinetic energy from Eq. 13.29 as

As an additional exercise, you should arrive at this result by using


the basic Eq. 13.28, where you cannot rely on familiar formulas for polen-
tial energies.

In the following example, we will see how using a system of particles


approach can make for great simplification in a problem over the procedure
of dealing with particles individually. Also we will have a case where there i n
no nonconservative work, which then results in a conservation of mechanical
energy.
Example 13.11
Masses A and H . each having a mass of 7 5 kg, are constrained Lo move i n
frictionless slots (see Fig. 13.21).They are connected hy ii light rod of length
I = 300 mm. Mass B is connected LO two niassless linear springs, each
having a spring conslant K = 900 Nlm. The springs are unstretched when
the connecting rod LO massesA m d l j i\ vertical. What are thc velocities of
H and A when A descends 3 distance of 75 mni? There Is no friction in the
end connections of thc rod."

Figure 13.21. 'IV," intrrconrirctrd IIIBSSCS cwnlrained


hy Iinciir \pring\.
W e shall use a system of particles approach f o r this case. This will
eliniinatc the need to calculate thc work of the rod on cach ma\\ that WL'
would need had we elected tu dcal with cach mass separately. For a syhtrm of
particles approach, this work is inlemal hetveen rigid hodies, tiwing 7ero
value as a r e d ( of Newton's third law and having ideal pin-conoccted ,joints.
Wc n e x t note that only coiisciwa~iveforces arc prcsenl (giravilalional
force and spring forces;) s o the first law form of our energy equation de-
generates to conhervation of mcchanicid energy. I n Fig. 13.22. we show
SECTION 13.6 WORK-ENERGY EQUATIONS 61 3

Example 13.11 (Continued)


the system in a configuration where mass A has dropped a distance of
,025 m. We can then say for the beginning and end configurations using
the datum shown in Fig. 13.22,

A[KE + PEI = w_2= 0

($MAV2- 0 ) + (;M,V; - 0) +
[Mag(.3 - ,025) - M,g(.3)] + [2f(900)(SZ) ~ 0, : 0 (a)

We have three unknowns here. They are 6, V,, and V,. Observing the
shaded triangle in Fig. 13.22 and using the Pythagorean theorem, we have

l; + 62 = .32 (h)

Taking the time derivative we get

ziAi, + 268 = o
We note that i, = V, and that S = 4. We then see from the preceding
equation that

Now, returning to Fig. 13.22, we can compute 6 for the case at hand.
Noting that A has descended a distance of ,025 m, thus making
1, = .3 ,025 = ,275 m, we next go to Eq. (h) tu get 6. Thus
~

(.275)' + S2 = .3'
:. S = . I I99 m

Substituting data from Eqs. (c) and (d) into Eq. (a) (conserving mechanical
energy) we get

V, = -. 1524 m l s from (c), V, =


:_ - .I199 VA = ,3496 m l s

Thus,

V, f ,1524 m l s down V, = ,3496 m l s to the right or the left


SECTION 13.7 KINETIC ENERGY EXPRESSION BASED ON CENTER OF MASS 615
the relation above into the expression for kinetic energy, Eq. 13.30,
we get

K E = $ ~ ~ , ( v+P,,)*
~ = ~ ~ r n ~ ( V ~ + P ~ ~ ) . ( v ~ + P ~ ~ )
,=I ,=I

Carrying out the dot product, we have

Since y. is common for all values of the summation index, we can extract it
from the summation operation, and this leaves

Perform the following replacements:

We then have

KE = $MV: + V; c
d n m,pci + f C mip2i
n
(13.34)
,=I i=l

But the expression

represents the first moment of mass of the system about the center of mass for
the system. Clearly by definition, this quantity must always be zero. The
expression for kinetic energy becomes

(13.35)

Thus, we see that the kinetic energy for some reference can be considered to
be composed of two parts: ( I ) rhe kinetic energy of the total mass moving rel-
ative to that reference with the velocity of the mass center, plus ( 2 ) the kinetic
energy of the morion of the particles relative io the mass center.
6 16 ('HAI'I'CR 13 1:NliKGY M1:'IHODS FOK I'ARTICl.tS

p Example 13.12
I

j A hyprithctical vchiclc i s niiiving at specd ",,in Fig. 13.24. (111 this \chicle
: are l w o hodics ciich of i i i a s s 111 diding :dong a liorizonlal rod at a speed 1 '
i relative to the rod. This rod i s rotating at an angular specd w l a d k c rela-
i
tivc to the vehicle. What i s the kinetic cnergy of the two hodies relative 1 0
the g r w n d (XYZ) when they arc iit II clistancc I- froin point A?
Clearly. the cciitcr 01 niass c(irresponds to point A and i s thus miwing
at a spccd V, relatiYc to tlie ground. Hence. we liiivc tis part of thc kinetic
I cnergy the tei-m

2!MV', 7 ,nVi (:I)

The velocity o f cach hill rcliitive to thc center of iiiass i s e x i l y


f1,rmcd using cylindrical components. Thus. imagining a reference .x?: at A
translating with thc vehicle relative to XYZ. we h a w lor the vclocity of
each hall rcl;ilive to s ; r

P' = p2 + ( o r ) ' = 1.2 + (OJI.)? (hJ

The t01iiJ kinetic cncrg!, of thc ~ M : Oni;isse> r c l a l i x Lo tlic griw~idi s thcn

KE = rnVi + rnlt;' + (Wr)'] (e)

111 k;xiiniple 13.12, wc co~rsidcrcdii casc where thc hodics involved


constituted a finitc number of d i w r c , l ~ ,particle\. In the nexl cxamplc. we coil-
sidcr ii case wliei-e w c h a w a m,zlitzuuni o l particles forming ii rigid hody.
The formulatiiin given by Eq. 13.35 can still he uscd hut iiow. iiistcad of sum-
ming 1ir a finite nuinher 01discrete particles. we imust integratc to accuunt
f o r the infinite numher of infinitesimal particles comprising thc syslem. We
arc thus tiiking a glimpse. 101- simple ciises, 11l' rigid-hody dynamick 10 be
sludicd latei- i n the tcxt. Those that iki nut have time fiir studying such energy
prohlenx i n detail w i l l hc able to solvc simple hut useful rigid-body dynam-
ics prohlcins on the hiisis of thcsc examples as ucll as liitet- exaiiiples in this
chapter.
SECTION 13.7 KINETIC ENERGY EXPRESSION BASED ON CBNTEK OF MASS 617
Example 13.13
A thin uniform hoop of radius R is rolling without slipping such that 0,the
mass center, moves at a speed V (Fig. 13.25). If the hoop weighs W Ib,
what is the kinetic energy of the hoop relative to the ground?
Clearly, the hoop cannot be considered as a finite number of discrete
finite particles as in the previous example, and so we must consider an
infinity of infinitesimal contiguous particles. It is simplest to employ here
the center-of-mass approach. The main problem then is to find the kinetic
energy of the hoop relative to the mass Center 0, that is, relative to a refer-
ence q translating with the mass center as seen from the ground reference
X Y (see Fig. 13.26). The motion relative to xy is clearly simple rotation;
accordingly, we must find the angular velocity of the hoop for this refer-
ence. The no slipping condition means that the point of contact of the hoop
A
with the ground has instantaneously a zero velocity. Observe the motion
from a stationary reference X Y . As you may have learned in physics, and Figure 13.25. Rolling hoop
as will later he shown (Chapter 15), the body has a pure instantaneous
rututioizal motion about the point of contact. The angular vclocity w for
this motion is then easily evaluated by considering point 0 rotating about
the instantaneous center of rotation A . Thus.

Since reference .ry translures relative to reference XU, an observer on


xy sees the ,same angular velocify w for the hoop as the observer on
X Y . Accordingly, we can now readily evaluate the second term on the
right side of Eq. 13.35. As particles, use elements of the hoop which are
R d0 in length, as shown in Fig. 13.26, and which have a mass per unit
length of Wl(27rh'g). We then have, on replacing summation by integration,
the result

X
A
Figure 13.26. . ~ yLranblaleb with 0
relative to X Y .

The kinetic energy of the hoop is then in accordance with Eq. 13.35:
6 18 CHAPTER I3 ENERGY METHODS FOR PARTICLES

Example 13.13 (Continued)


Suppose that the body were a generalized cylinder of mass M (see Fig.
13.27) such as a tire of radius R having 0 as the center of mass with
iixisymmetrical distribution of mass ahout the axis at 0 . Then, we wnuld I
express Eq. (h) 21s follows:

$ T m , P ? , = +JJ&m,iroP id)

You will recall from Chapter 9 that

JJI, dm
IZ

is the sccond mornrnl of inrrtiu of the body taken ahout the Iaxis at 0.
That i s .
Figure 13.27. Rolling generalized cylinder
of mass M.

Thus, we have lor the kinetic energy of such a body:

K E = - IM V 2 + ~11 ; z o 2
2 (e)

You may also recall from Chapter 9 that we could employ the mdius /$
,~vrufionk to express IC; as follows:
i-. = k2M cn
Hence, Eq. ( e )can he given as

We shall examine the kinetic energy formulations of rigid hodies care-


fully in Chapter 17. Here, we have used certain familiar results Srom physics
pertaining to kinematics of plane motion of B nonslipping rolling rigid body.
For a more general undertaking. we shall have to carefully consider more
general aspects of kinematics of rigid-body motion. T h k will be done in
Chapter I S . Also, in the last example we see one term of the inertia tensor I,,
showing up. The vital role of the inertia tensor i n the dynamics o l rigid hod-
ies will soon be seen.
SIXTION 13.8 WORK~KINETICENERGY EXPRESSIONS BASED ON CE<NTEROF MASS 619

13.8 Work-Kinetic Energy Expressions


Based on Center of Mass
The work-kinetic energy expressions of Section 13.6 were developed for a
system of piitticles without regard to the mass center. We shall now introduce
this point inio the work-kinetic energy formulations. You will recall from
Chapter 12 that N ~ W I O law
I Z ' .for
~ the mass center of an) system of particles is
F = Mi, (13.36)
where F is the total external forcc on the system of particlcs. By the same
development as presented in Section 13. I , we can readily amive at the follow-
ing equation:

p dr, = (&%!fv?)2
- (:MVZ)I (13.37)

It is vital to understand from the left side of Eq. 13.37. where we note the
term dr , that the e.rternal.fiirces mmr ail movr with the center uJnioss for the
computation of the proper work term in this equation.'d We wish next to
point out that the single particle model represents a special case of the use of
Eq. 13.37. Specifically. the single particle model represents the case where
the motion of the center of mass of a body sufficiently describes the motion
of the body and where the external forces on the body essentially mnve with
the center of mass of the body. Such cases were set forth in Section 13.1.
Before proceeding to the examples, let us consider for a moment the
case of the cylinder rolling without slipping down an incline (see Fig. 13.28).
We shall consider the cylinder as an ufifirefiatrofparticles which form a rigid
hody-namely a cylinder. When using such an appruiach, we require that ull
thej%rce.r horh extrrnal and intenial inlist ~ O V Pwith their reipective points of
applkurion. Let us then consider the external work done on the particles mak-
ing up the cylinder other than the work done by gravity. Clearly, only particles
on the rim of the cylinder are acted on by external forces other than gravity.
Consider one such particle during one rotation of the cylinder. This pasticle will
have acting on it a friction Corce.fand a normal force N at the insrant when the
particle is in contacr with the inclined surface. The particle will have zero exter- Figure 13.28. Cylinder on incline
nal force (except for gravity) at a11 other positions during the cycle. Now, at the
instdnt of this contact, the normal force N has zero velricity in its direction
because of the rigidity of the bodies. Therefore, N transmits no power and does
no work on the particle during the cycle under consideration. Also, the friction
620 CHAPTER 13 ENERGY MIiTIIODS FOR PAKTlCl.liS

1orcc.facts on a particle having zero velocity at the instant of contact because of


the no .slipping rondition. Accordingly.,IIransniii\ no power and does 110 wnrk
on the panicle during thi? cycle." This result must he true for each and evcry
pai'icle on the rim of the cylinder. Thus, clcarly,,fand N do no work when the
cylinder rolls down the incline. Also. because (if the rigidity of the body the
internal forces do no wo pointed out carlisr. Thus. only gravity docs work.
Howevcr. in consi ng the motion of the w i r e r o f n i ~ i s s C of the cyl-
inder in Fig. I3.2X. wc noie that forcc fnow mow^ with C and hence do^ work.
At the risk of heing repetitive, w c now summarize the key lealures 1 1 r
properly using the center-or-mass approtach.

I. Only external forces are involved.


2. 8 all move with the r of m&ps when computing work (see

ic energy of the center of maas is used.

Example 13.14
A cylinder with a mass o f 25 kg is released frorn rest on an incline, a h
shown in Fig. 13.29. The diameter of the cylinder is .hO m . If the cylinder
rolls without slipping, compute the speed of thc centerline C after i t has
moved 1.6 m along the incline . Also. ascertain the friction force acting 011
the cylinder. Use the result from Problem 13.76 that the kinetic energy of
a cylinder rotating aboul its own stationary axis is a M R 2 ~ 'where
, rn i E
the angular speed in radisec.
In Fig. 13.29 we have shown the free budy of the cylinder. We pro-
ceed to use thc work-energy equation for a system of particles. Recall
that w e can concentrate the weigh1 at the center of gravity (Scctiiin 13.6).
Accordingly, using the luwest position as a datum and noting from our
earlier discussion that the friction forcc,/diies no work \tc have
AiPE + KE) = '71: ~
SECTION 13.x WORK-KINETIC ENERGY EXPRESSIONS BASED ON CENTER O F M A SS 621

Example 13.14 (Continued)


where the kinetic energy of the cylinder is given as the kinetic energy of
the mass taken at the mass center (straight line motion of C ) plus kinetic
energy of the cylinder relative to the center of mass (pure rotation about C ) .
Noting from Example 13.13 that
o=
V -=li
R .30
we substitute into Eq. (a) and solve for y.. We get

Now to findf, we consider the motion of the mass center of the cylin-
der. This means that we use Eq. 13.37 for the center of mass. Now all ex-
ternal.forces maSt move with the center of mass; thus, .f does work. Since
the center of mass moves along a path always at right angles to N , this force
still does no work. Accordingly, we can say:

-.f(l.6)+ W(1.6sin30") = fMVZ


-f'(I.6) + (25)(9.81)(1.6)sin3Oo = $(25)(3.23*)
fa

Before going further, let us consider the two cylinders and the block in
Fig. 13.30 as simply a system of particles. If there is no slipping between the
block and the cylinders, the velocities of the particles on the block and the
cylinders at the points of contact between these bodies have the same velocity
at any time t. Furthermore, the friction force on the cylinder from the block is
equal and opposite to the friction force on the block from the cylinder at the
point of contact. We can then conclude that there is zero net work done by the
friction forces between block and cylinders when considering them as an
aggregate of particles.
Figure 13.30. Three rigid bodies moving Also, in the next problem, we will consider as a system of particles,
without slipping at any of the contact points.
rigid bodies which are joined by rigid connectors with frictionless inter-
connections.
622 C'HAITLK I 1 I:WR(;Y MHTHOI)S to^ I'AKI'IC'I.I:S

Example 13.15
An extcriiiil lorquc 7 <,I50 N-in i s applied to ii solid cylindcr I1 ( x c Fig.
13.31). which I i i ~ hi~ tii its$ of 30 hg iiiid ii radius o i .2 111. Thc cylinder roll'
willioiit dippiiig. Block A, hitving ii iiiii%o I 20 kg, i s dr;iggcd LIiJ the 15
incline. Thc dynamic c d f i c i c n t o f iriction ki,, between hloch A and thc
incline i \ .25. The coiiiiectioii\ iit (' iiiid I ) iirr Iriclionlehs.

( a ) What i\ the \cIocity of the \ystcm :iller miiving ii d i i t i i i i w il


2I ~ ~ ?
()i
(I))Whal i s tlic lrictiirii llricc on the cyliiider?
Neglect thc !niihh o i thc coniiccting rod

Wc show ii Srcc-hody diagrairi o i l l i e !,ywiii in Pig. 13.32. Wc hrgin


by employing ii syslem of particles point o i vicu. Note tlierc :m pair\ o S
intcrnal forccs prcscnt hclwccn the r(id ('11 i i i i d hody 4 ill (tie c o i i t x t point
SECTION 13.x WORK-KINETIC ENERGY EXPRESSIONS BASED ON CENTER OF M A SS 623

Example 13.15 (Continued)


and similarly between CD and cylinder B. These force pairs are equal and
opposite because of Newton's third law. And because the forces in each
pair move exactly the same distance at the respective points of contact,
there will be zero internal work from these force pairs. Hence, using the
uppermost configuration as the datum,

%:+: = APE + AKE


TO - ( p d N A ) ( d )= [(WA + W,)(d)(sin 15") - 0]

Note that as the cylinder moves without slipping a distance d along the
incline, the circumference of the cylinder must come into contact with the
incline along the very same distance d. Hence, by dividing d by the radius
r, we get the rotation of the cylinder in radians associated with the move-
ment of its center.

0=d
--
r
We then get for Eq. (a), on substituting data for the problem

(SO)[ - (.25)[(2Og)(cos 150)](2) = [(5Og)(2)(.2588)]

+
c (50)1
v2
+ z(30)(.22)-
(.2Y"' 1
Next, use the center-of-mass approach. We have on noting that a
couple which is translating does no work. (Why?)

f F * drc = +MTo,a,(V; V:) ~

- ( . 2 5 ) ( N A ) ( d )-(W, + W,)(sinIS")(d) + fd = f(50)(2.158')


-(.25)[(2Og)(cos 1So)](2) (SOg)(.2588)(2)
~ + ,f(2) = 116.4

f = 232.5
624 C I I A P T I R I3 E U H t ( ; Y \IETHOlYi FOR l ' A 1 ~ ~ l ~ ' L E S

Example 13.16
111 Example 13.15. suppcxe that cylinder II i s .slippitig. What i s Ihc
dyn;iinic ciicSSicierit or Sriclioii ( p,,In hetween the cylinder wid the iii-
cline cn tliiit the system reaches a speed iif I .5 mlc after miiving il distaiicc
: d = 2 111 starting from rest?
Usiiig ~ h ccnter-of-mass
c apprmrch. w c thaw

(pd)H= ,7122

111 the next example. we shall coiisider a case where i , , / ~ , , ~ , , ' i i , ~ , ~ ~ , ~ , ~


do work.

Example 13.17
A die.;el-powered electric triiiii movex up ii 7'' grirde in Fig. 13.31. If ii
torque of 750 N-m i s developed i i t eiicli of i t s s i x pair, of drive u'heels.
what i s the iricrcasc of spccd of thc tiniii aftcr il ~ i i o v c \100 iii'?l i i i t i i i l l y .
thc lriiin ha\ a spccd 01 16 knilhr. The lrain weighs 00 k N . 'I'hc drive
whccls h a w a diameter of hilO min. Neglect tlie rotational energy of the
drivc whccls.

Figure 1.4.33. Ilic\clLcIccIric Iraiii.

Wc shall consider thc train as ii tern of particles including thc


h pairs of whccls arid the body. We have shown tlic I n i n iii Fig. 13.34 \\ilh
!
13,34, L:xlcln;,l i,,rL.r,,~,l fc,rccs
tlic cxtcriiiil 1orces. W. N. and/: In addition. %'e ha\c shiiwii cc~rliiiiiiiilcriial :mi r ~ r q u c ~ .
SECTION 13.8 WORK-KINETIC ENERGY EXPRESSIONS BASED ON CENTER OF MASS 625

Example 13.17 (Continued)


torques 7:lhThe torques shown act on the rutor,y of the motors, and, as the
train moves, these torques rotate and accordingly do work. The reucfiuns to
these torques are equal and opposite to T according to Newton's third law
and act on the sfuturs of the motors (Le.. the field coils). The stators are sta-
tionaly, and so the reactions to T do nu work as the train moves. Thus we
have an example wherein, using a system of particles approach, internal
forces pelform a nonzero amount of work. We now employ Eq. 13.29. Thus
APE + KE = w,,,, (a)
For the rolling without slipping condition, the friction forces f do no work.
We then have

[(90,000J(100sin7"- O)] + I 90,000 (16)(1,000)


2 s [-3,600 ]?)
= (6)(750)(8) (b)
where 0 is the clockwise rotation of the rotor in radians. Assuming direct
drive from rotor to wheel, we can compute Bas follows for the 100-m dis-
tance d over which the train moves:
d = 100 = 333.3 rad
B=- ~~~

(C)
r .3
Substituting into Eq. (b) and solving for V, we get
V = 10.38 m/sec
Hence, the increase of speed of the train is

To determine the friction f o r c e s j we now adopt a center-of-mass


approach. Thus all forces now move with the center of mass. And they
must be e.rtemul,fi,rces. Accordingly we have
[6f - (90,000)(sin 7")](1OOJ
I 90,ow I 90 000 (16)(1,000)
-
- -~ (10.38), --A
2 9.81 2 9.81 ( 3,600

'"Figure I?34 accordingly. 19 not a free-body dngram


13.68. A chain of total length L is relcased from res1 on a
smooth support as shown. Delerminr the veliicily of tlic chain
when the last link m w e s off the horizonVal wrtacr. In this
prohlem, neglect the friction. Also, d o n o t attempt to accnunt
for centrirugal cffecth ctemining f r < m the chain links rounding
the corner.

Figure P.13.71)
13.71. A device is mountcd mi 3 plntfnrm that I S rotating with an
anguliir s p d 01 10 nldlarc. The devicc consists of t w i masse\
(each i \ ,I 'lug) rotating o n a spindle with an angular specd of
5 rad-crc relativr to the platfbmi. The m a w s arc iiwving radially
Figure P.13.68. outward with a ?peed of I O ftlsrc, and the cntire platf<>lmis being
raised at a speed rrf S fllsec. Compule thc kinetic encrgy n1 the
system of two particles when they are I ft from the qpindlc.
13.69. A chain is SO ft long and wcighs IN)Ih. A force PUT 80 Ih +,IC radlsec
has been applied at the configuratian shown. What is the s p d of ~ A S radlsec
the chain after force P has moved IO fl! 'The dynamic coefticiznl
of friction hetween the chain and the cupporting surface i q .3.
Utilize an apprvximatc snlilysis.

Each m a u ~~ 0. I d u g
Figure P.13.71.
13.72. A hoop. with four spoke&.rolls without slipping such that
Ihc ccntcr C moves at a bpced V of I .7 mlsec. The diameter of the
hixrp i h 3.3 m and Ihe weight pcr unit length o l t h e rim is 14 Nlni.
The y o k c 5 arc uniform rods also having a wright p ~ l unit
- length
of 14 Nlm. A w m c that rini and spokes arc t h i n What is the
kinetic energy ot thu body'!

Figure P.13.69.

13.70. A hullet of weight is fired into a hlock of wood weigh


ing W, Ih. The bullet lodges in the wood, and both hodies then
move to the dashed Dosition indicated in the diamam before
falling back. Compute the amount 01 internal work done during
the action. Discuss the effects of this work. .The hullet has il apecd
V,, hefore hitting the black. Neglect the mass o f t h e supporting rrid
and friction at A . Figure P.13.72.

626
13.73. Three weights A , L1, and C slide frictionlessly along the 13.75. A tank is moving at the speed Vof 16 k d h r . What is the
system of connected rods. The bodies are connected by a light, kinetic energy of each of the treads for this tank if they each have
llexihlc, inextensible wire that is directed by frictionless small a mass per unit length of 300 kgim'?
pulleys at E and F . If the system is released from rest, what is its
speed after it has moved 300 mm? Employ the following data firr
the body mas5e.s:

Body A : 5 kg

Body H : 4 kg
-l
Body C 7.5 kg Figure P.13.75.

13.76. A cylinder of radius R rotates about its own axis with an


angular speed of w. If the total mass is M , show that the kinetic
energy is iMRW.

13.77. Cylinders A and C each weigh 100 Ih and have a diame-


ter of 2 ft. Body A, weighing 300 Ih, rides on these cylinders. If
there is nu slipping anywhere, what is the kinetic energy of the
system when the body A is moving at a speed Vof 10 fvsec'? Use
result of Problem 13.76.

Figure P.13.73.

Figure P.13.77.
13.74. B d i c s E and F slide in frictionless grooves. They are
interconnected by a light, flexible, inextensible cable (not shown). 13.78. A pendulum has a hob with a comparatively large uni-
What i s the speed of the system after it has moved 2 ft? The form disc of diameter 2 ft and mass M of 3 Ibm. At the instant
weights of bodies E and F a r e 10 Ih and 20 Ih, respectively. A is shown, the system has an angular speed e of .3 radlsec. If we
equidistant from A and C. E remains in top groove. neglect the mass of the rod, what is the kinetic energy of the pen-
dulum at this instant? What error is incurred if one considers the
hob lo be a particle as we have done earlier for smaller hobs'? Use
the result of Problem 13.76.

x
Figure P.13.74. Figure P.13.78.

627
13.79. In Problem 13.7X compute the maximum angle that the
pendulum rises.

13.80. Do Example 13.3 hy treating a s an aggregate ofpitrliclc\.

13.81. Do Problem 13.27 hy treatmg iis an aggregate ofpwticles.

13.R2. Do Prohlem 13.22 hy treating a c a n agprrgatc of paniclrc.

13.83. Do Problcm 13.24 hy treating a\ an aggrcptc of p a l t i c k \ . Figure P.13.86.

13.84. A constant force P' is applicd t o the nxic of a cylinder, as


shown, causing thc axis to increasc its speed from I ftisec trr 3 Slliec 13.87. Cylindcrs A and B w u h havc a mass <if 25 kg and a d i m -
in 10 ft without slipping. What i s the friction force acting on the eter of 100 mm. Block C, riding on A and H. has a mass of 100 kg.
cylinder'? The cylinder weighs 100 Ih. I f the ~ y c t e mis released fmni rc\t at thc configuratinn chown.
what i s the speed of 1.attcr the cylindera h w c made hall a revdii-
Lion'! Use thc r e w l t 01Pmhlrm I3.70.

Figure P.13.84.

13.85. A cylinder with a maw nf 25 kg i\ releaced from rest m :in


incline, a i shown. 'The inner diameter 11 01the cylindcr i s 30(1 mm.
If the cylinder rolls without 'lipping, compute the peed nf the cen-
terline 0 after the cylinder has muwd I .h m almg the incline.
Figure P.13.X7.
Ascertain the friction Ibrce acting on the cylinder. The radius 01
gyration h at 0 i s .30/\'2 in
13.88. Shown arc two iilsnliual hlocks A and H , a c h weighing
SO Ih. A force /.'of 100 Ih i s applied Lo thc lower hlrick, causing it
i n n u x 10 the right. Blrrck A . Ihowever. is rcitrained hy thc wall
('. I f hlock H rcaches a speed of I O ttlscc 1n 2 11 starling from rcit
at thc pri\ition shown in thc diagram. \*hat i~ thc I-cctraining lorce
from thc mall'! The dynamic coefficient 01friction hctwecn H and
the grciund w1.111cci\ .3. L>o this p h l e n , firs1 by using Eq. 1 3 . X
Then check thc r c w l t h) using scparatc lrce-hody diagrams.
and 511 o n

Figure P.13.85.

13.86. A uniform cylinder having a diameter o f 2 ft and a wright


of 100 Ih TOIIS down a 30" incline without slipping. as shown.
What is the speed o f t h e center after it has mrwcd 20 ft'! Compare
this result with that fnr the case whcn thcre i\ no friction present.
[Hint: Use the result of Problem 13.76.1 Figure P.13.XX.

I 628
13.89. What is the tension T to accelerate the end of the cable
downward at the rate of 1.5 mlsec'? From body C, weighing 508
,Pad
N, is lowered a body D weighing 1 2 . 5 ~N at the rate of 1.5 m/sec2 w,= w,= i nwr
relative to body C. Neglect the inertia of pulleys A and R and the K = m n Nimm
cable. [Hint; From e i l i e r courses in physics, recall that pulley B
i s rotating instantaneously ahout p i n t e, and hence point b has an 6 = 20 0 mrn
acceleration half that of pointf. We will consider such relations
carefully at a later time.]
Figure P.13.91.

(a) What is the velocity of the vehicle after it moves a


distance of I .7 m staning from rest?

(b) What is the total friction f0rce.f on the cylinders from


the ground?
T

"f e
13.92. A cylinder weighing 500 N rolls without slipping, first on
a horizontal surface and then along a 30" incline.

(a) How far up the incline does it move?

(b) What are the friction forces on the cylinder along the
horizontal surface and along the incline'?

Figure P.13.89.

13.90. Cylinder C is connected by a light rod AR and can roll


without slipping along the stationary cylinder D. Cylinder C weighs
10 N. A constant torque T = 20 N-m is applied to AB when it is
vertical and stationary. What is the angular speed of AB when it
has rotated YI)"? The system of bodies is in the vertical plane. Figure P.13.92.
Recall from physics that a body which is rolling without slipping
has instantaneous rotation about the point of contact. 13.93. A hoop with four spokes is released from rest from a ver-
tical position.

(a) What is the velocity of point C after it moves 1.3 m?

(h) What is the tension in the wire?

The rim and the spokes each have a weight per unit length of 15 Nlm
and are to be considered as thin. The wire is wrapped around the
hoop and is the sole support

Figure P.13.90.

13.91. An 800-N force F is pulling the vehicle. The cylinders A


and Reach weigh I,OoO N and roll without slipping. The indicated
spring has a spring constant K equal to 50.0 Nlmm and is com-
t
5m
pressed a distance S of 20.0 mm. The pad slides on the upper
guide with a dynamic coefficient of friction p,, equal to 3. Neglect
all musses except the cylindcrs, whose diameter D is .2 m. Figure P.13.93.

629
I l4pure l'.l.3.Y4.
Figure P.13.W.

(hi W1i;it arc lhe iricrion ii~l-ccs1cmr11 tlir grliiiiiitl OII each
cylinder A'!
M,,= 2(10 hp
2 M,,= SO kg
M , = 30 kg

Figure P.13.95.

I=500 N

13.96. A cylinder is i l h 0 ~ 1t u roll down an incline without slip^


SECTION 13.9 CLOSURE 631

13.9 Closure
In this chapter, we presented the energy method as applied to particles. In
Part A, we presented three forms of the energy equation applied to a single
particle. The basic equation was

J 1 2 F . d r =*' (M V Z) , - f ( M V 2 ) , (13.38)

For the case of only conservative forces acting, we presented the equation for
the consemuion of mechanical energy:
(PE), + WE), = (PE), + (KE), (13.39)
Finally, for both conservative and nonconservative forces, we presented an
equation resembling thefirst law of thermodynamics as it is usually employed:
A(PE + KE) = 'Wy.',, (13.40)
In Pan 8 , we considered a system of particles and presented the above
equation again, but this time the work and potential-energy terms are from
both internal and external force systems.'? Furthermore, all work and poten-
tial-energy terms are evaluated by using the actual movement of the points of
application of internal and external forces.
Next, we presented the work-energy equation for the center of mass of
any system of particles:

jlzF-dr,:= $ ( M V Z ) , - ~ ( I W V : ) ~ (13.41)

where F , the resultant external force, moves with the center of mass in the
computation of the work expression. We pointed out that the single particle
model is a special case of the use of Eq. 13.41 applicable when the motion
of the center of mass of a body sufficiently describes the motion of a body
and where the external forces on the body move with the center of mass of
the body.
To illustrate the use of the work+nergy equation for a system of parti-
cles, we considered various elementary plane motions of simple rigid bodies.
A more extensive treatment of the energy method applied to rigid bodies is
found in Chapter 17.
We now turn to yet another useful set of relations derived from Newton's
law, namely the methods of linear impulse-momentum and angular impulse-
momentum for a particle and systems of panicles.
Figurr P.13.98.

..-

Figure P.13.101.

,I

Figure P.13.102.

Figure 1'.13.103.
532
13.104. A self-propelled vehicle A ha? a weight of & ton. A gaso- 13.109. A 100-lh boy climbs up a rope in gym in I O sec and
slides down in 4 sec after he reaches uniform speed downward.
line engine develops toque on the drive wheels to help muveA up the
What is the horsepower developed by the boy going up'! What is
incline. A countenveight B of 300 Ib is also shown in the diagram.
What horsepower is needed when A is moving UP at a speed of 2 ftlsec the average horsepower dissipated on the rope by the boy going
and has an acceleration of 3 ftlsec2? Neglect the weight of the pulley. down after reaching uniform speed'? The diqtance moved before
[Hint: The pulley rolls along c o d dg without slipping. It therefore has
reaching uniform speed downward is 2 ft.
an instantaneous center of rotation at d. What does this mean about the
relative value of velwity of point h on the pulley and p i n t a?]

Figure P.13.109.
Figure P.13.104.
13.110. An aircraft carrier is shown in the process of launching
*13.105. Set up an integro-differential equation (involving deriv- an airplane via a catapult mechanism. Before leaving the catapult,
atives and integrals) for B i n Problem 13.31 if there is Coulombic the plane has a speed of 192 k d h r relative to the ship. If the plane
friction with pz, = .2. is accelerating at the rate of I g and if it has a mass of IR,000 kg,
13.106. At what angle QdoesbodyA of Problem 13.31 leave the what horsepower is bring developed hy the catapult system at the
circular surface'? end of launch on the plane if we neglect drag? The thrust from the
jet engines of the plane is 100,000 N.
*13.107. Show that the workxnergy equation for a particle can
be expressed in the following way:

Integrating the right side by parts," and using relativistic mass


m,l<l V z / c ' , where m,, is the rest mms and c is the speed of
Figure P.13.110.
~

light, show that a relativistic form of this equation can be given as

so that the rdntivistic kinetic energy i s


KE = n x 2 ~ m,c2
*13.108. By combining the kinetic energy as given in Problem
13.107 and m,,? to form E , the total energy, we get the famous
furmula of Einstein:
E = mc2 Therefore

in which energy is equetrd with mass. How much energy is eqUiVd-


lent to 6 x Ihm of matter'? How high could a weight of 100 Ib
be lifted with such energy? The l a i t formulation i?called integration by parls.
633
13.111. Vehiclz B , weighing 25 kN, is to g o down a 30" incline. 13.115. Cylinders A and B havc mtas\c~of 50 kg cach. Cylindcr
The "chicle is connecled to hody A through light pulleys and il A can ouly roLil1.e about a stalionary axis while cylinder B rolls
capstan. Whilt should body A weigh if starting from rest it restricts without slipping. Block C has a mass of 100 kg. Slarting from
hody B 111 a speed of 5 mlsec when R m o w c 3 in? There are two rest, what is the speed of C after nioviiig . I it? Force P is 500 N
wraps of rope around the capstan. and the diainetcr of the cylinders is .2 n,.

Figure P.13.115
13.116. A ryslrm o f 4 d i d cylinder\ and a heavy hluck move
F i g u r e P.13.111. vcrtically downward aidcd by a 1,00(1-N forcr F. What is the
angular ?peed of the whecli after thc systcin descends .5 m after
13.112. A jet pussenger phne is moving along the runway for a mrting fnrm rest'! What is thc friction friicc Irum Itit. walls on
takeoff. If cach of ils four engine\ is developing 44.5 kN olthrust. each wheel'! The wheels roll without slipping.
what is the horsrpowcr dcvcloprd w h m the plimr is moving a1 a
speed of 240 kmlhr?
13.113. Block R, with a n a s i of 200 kg. i s being pulled up an
inclinc. A inotor C' pulls on one cable, developing 3 hp. 'The other
cable is connected t o a counterweight A having a inass of 150 kg.
If B is moving at li s p e d of 2 mlscc, what is its acceleration?
[Hinr: Stalt with Newton's law lor A and B . ]

I
Figure P.13.116.
F i g u r e P.13.113.
13.117. A wllilr H having a inass uf IO0 g moves along a frktion-
13.114. A block G slidcs along a frictionlcss path as shown. less curved rod in a vertical plane. A light rubbri~band cunnccts B to
What is the minimum initial speed that G should have along the path a lixed p i n t A . T h r rubber band is 230 intn in length when
if it is to izniain in contact when it gcts ton, the uppermost positirrn unmetched. A force of 30 N is required io exlend Ihe band 50 mm.It
ofthe path? 'The block weigh\ 9 N. Whilt is the nulmal Surcr ou the thc collar is released from rest. what distance muht d he so that the
path when forthe condition descrihed the hlock is at position H? downward nrrrinal h r c c on the rod at C is 20 N?

I-!'+-!
Figure P.13.Il4. Figure P.13.117.
h34
13.118. When your author was B graduate student he built a sys- from rest from a position where the elastic cord is unstretchcd,
tem for examining the effects of high-speed moving loads over what is body B's speed after it tnoves 3 m?
elastically supported beams (see the diagram). A "vehicle" slides
along a slightly lubricated square tube guide. At the base of the
vehicle is a spring-loaded light wheel which will run over the
beam (no1 shown). The vehicle is catapulted to a high speed by a
strelched elastic cord (shock cord) which i s pulled back from
position A-A to the position B shown prior to "firing." At A-A thr
shock cord is elongated 10 in., while at the firing position it is
elongated 30 in. A fbrce of I O Ib is required for each inch ofelon-
Eation of the cord. If the cord weighs a total of 1.5 Ib and the v e h i ~
cle weighs 10 O L , what is the speed of the vehicle when the cord
reaches A-A after firing? Take into account in some reasonable
way the kinetic energy of the cord, but neglecl friction.

/H

Figure P.13.119.
S
13.120. A collar slides o n a frictianless tube as shown. The
spring is unstretched when i n thr hurimntal position and has a
Side view
spring constant of I .O Iblin. What is the minimum weight u f A to
(a)
just reach A' when released from rest from the pusitiun shown in
the diagram? What is the force o n the tube when A has traveled
half the distance to A'?

Figure P.13.120.
13.121. A 15-kg vehicle has t w bodies
~ (each with mass I kgj
mounted on it, and there bodies nitate at an angular speed of
50 radsec relative to the vehicle. If a 500-N force acts on the
vehicle for a distance of 17 m, what is the kinetic energy of the
system, assuming that the vehicle starts from rest and the bodies
in the vehicle have constant rotational speed? Neglect frictivn and
the inertia of the wheels.
100 mm 3oll mm
1-64
Figure P.13.118.

13.119. A body B of mass 60 kg slides in a frictionless slot on


an inclined surface as shown. An elastic cord connects B to A . The
cord has a "spring constant" of 360 N/m. If the body B is released Figure P.13.121.
635
13.122. T w o identical solid cylindcrs each weiehing 100 N &up- 13.125. Two discs move ou il horimntnl Srictiunlcss aurface
port a load A wcighing SO N. If ii force F nf 300 N acts as shown. h ~ w luokiiig
n down from ahuvc. Each djsc wighs 20 N . A rec-
what i q the speed 01 the vehicle after rmwing S m? Alsu. what i s tangular rncmber B weighing SO N i'i pullrd hy i~ fiwcr F having ii
the total friction iorce on each wheel'! Nrglect the inass nl the viiliie ut 2I)O N. If there is no slipping anywhcre cxccpt , i n thc
wpporting system connecting the cylindesr. Note that thc kinetic horimatal \upport surfacc, what 15 thc speed of B aftrr it 1110va
e n e r g uf the angular m r t i o n of a cylinder about it\ own axis i h I 8 c m ? Determine the i r i c i i w lol-ce\ t r i m the wall\ onto the
i M K L u ' . l h e sy\tcrn stiirts from st. cylinders.

Figure P.13.125.

Figure P.13.123

13.124. 'l'hrcc block, arc conncctcd hy an Inextensible tlexihlr


cahle. The hlocki arc rcleaied from L: r m t configuration with thc
cable taut. I t A can only fall a disrance h equal 10 2 11, what IS the
velocity of bodics c' and B after each har moved a distance u t
3 ft? Each hody beighs 100 Ih. The cozSfiuent of dynamic fric-
tion fur body C i s .3 and lor body B i s .2.

Figure P.13.124. Figure P.13.126.


Methods of
Momentum for
Particles
Part A: Linear Momentum
14.1 Impulse and Momentum Relations
for a Particle
In Section 12.3, we integrated differential equations of motion for particles
that are acted upon by forces that are functions of time. In this chapter, we
shall again consider such problems and shall present alternative formulations,
638 CHAPTER 18 METHODS OF MOMENTlli FOR PARTICLES

Example 14.1
A particlc initially
i s shown graphicall
constrained tv n i w c rectilinearly in the dii-ectinn 01' the l i m e . what i\ the ,L
speed after I S sec?
From the definiliiin of the irnpuhc. the area under the force-time
curve will, i n the one-dirncnhional example. equal the impulse magnitudc.
I
J
Thus, we ?imply compulc this area hclween the times I = 0 and I = I C sec:

impulse =
--
4 +
(10)(10)
,llCil I
(5)(15) = 125 Ih-sec
iri
./,<a 2
IO\CC
I
15 \ec
I
:

, , , , ~ j~ t , , , ~ ~
Figere 14.1. l , ~ , ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~plot.
T L . t:-..l
~ t h , ~ , - ic
.,-l,~,.;+>, ,/c
Example 141
II
- SECTION 14.1 IMPULSE AND MOMENTUM RELATIONS FOR A PARTICLE

rZ prticle A with a mass of I ke- has an initiai velocitv I!:1Oi + ,


6j d s e c . After particle A strikes particle B , the velocity becomes V =
16i - 3j + 4k d s e c . If the time of encounter is IO msec, what average
"
639

force was exerted on the particle A ? What is the change of linear momen-
tum of particle B?
The impulse I acting on A is immediately determined by computing
the change in linear momentum during the encounter:

ZA = (1)(16i - 3j + 4k) - ( I ) ( l O i + 6j)


= 6i - 9j + 4k N-sec

Since

/,: FAdt = IAAt

the average force (Fa&becomes

(<JA(O.OIO] = 6i - 9j + 4k

Therefore,
Example 14.3
Two bodies, I and 2. are connected hy an inextensihle and weightless cord
(Fig. 14.2). Initially, the bodies are at rest. If the dynamic cocnicient of fric-
tion is pd for body I on the surface inclined at angle a, compute the velocity
of the bodies at any time f before body 1 has reached the end of the incline.

Figure 14.2. Two bodics corinectsd hy il cord.

Since only constilnt forces exist and since a time interviil has hcen
specified, we can use momentum considerations advantageously. The
free-body diagrams of bodies I and 2 are shown i n Fig. 14.3. Equilihrium
considerations lead to the conclusion that Nl = W, cos a,s o the frictiiin
forcef; is
~~~

W; \ i n (I
{,
,fi = p d N , = pdWi cos a
)*P
Fnr hndv I take the cnmuonent of the linear impulse-momentum equii- W.
N,
SECTION 14.1 IMPULSE 4 N D MOMENTUM RELATIONS FOR A PARTICLE 641

By adding Eqs. (a) and (h), we can el;m;nate T and solve for the desired
unknown V . Thus,
V
( - ~ c , W , c o s a + W , s i n n + W , ) r = ~ ( W+, W 2 )
g

Therefore.

Note that we have used considerations of linear momentum for a sin-


gle particle each time in solving this problem.

Example 14.4
A conveyor belt is moving from left to right at a constant speed V of
1 ftlsec in Fig. 14.4. Two hoppers drop objects onto the belt at the total
rate II of 4 per second. The objects each have a weight W of 2 Ib and fall a
height h of I ft before landing on the conveyor belt. Farther along the belt
(not shown) the objects are removed by personnel so that, for steady-state
operation, the number N of objects on the belt at any time is IO. If the
dynamic coefficient of friction between belt and conveyor bed is .2, esti-
mate the average difference in tension T2 - T , of the belt to maintain this
operation. The weight of the belt on the conveyor bed is I O Ib.
642 CHAP'rER I4 METHODS Or MOMENTUM FOR PARTICLES

Example 14.4 (Continued)


We shall superimpose the fdlowing effects to get the dcsired result.
1. A friction force from the bed onto the belt results from the static weight
of the ten ohjccts riding on the belt and the weight of the portion of belt
(in the hed.
2. A friction I i r c e froin the bed ontu tlic hclt results from the force in
tlie directinn needed tu change the r r r l i c u l linear tmnmentuni of the
fillling ohjccls from a value corresp<indingto the free-fall velocity just
before impact ( , 2 ~ : / c to ) a value nf z c r ~after impact.
3. Finally, the h e l l must supply a foi-ce in thc .idirection to change the
lm,-i:o,ild liiiear iiinmcmum of the lhlling objects from it value of zero
to it value c w r e ~ p o n d i n pLO tlie speed of the helt.

Thus. wc have for the first contriholicin. which we dunale as A T . the fol-
lowing result:

AT, = ( N W + lO)p<(= 1(10)(2) + 10](.2) = 6 Ih (a1


As for the Yecond con~ributii~ri.
w e can only compute an average value
hy iiiiting that each impacting oh.ject i s given a vertical change in
litiear iiioiiientum equal to
W ,~~
vertical change i n linear rnoiiientiini per object = ~ (,,28/1)
fi
7
= 7 ,(2g)(I)
fi
= ,498 Ib-sec
where we have assumed a free kill sparling with zero velocity at the hop-
per. For fiiur i n i p x t h per second. we have as lhe total vertical change
in h i e a r iiio~iicntuinper second Lhc v ~ l u e(4)(.498) = 1.994 Ih-scc. The
average vertical forcc during thc I-scc interval tu give the impulse needed
for this change i i i linear m~iinenturnis clearly 1.994 Ib. Sincc this result is
enrrect f o r rvzry \econd, I .994 Ih is tlic avcrage normal force that the bed
of the conveyor must Lransmit to I t for arresting the vertical motion
.. . ,. ... , . -.
I . .. ., , ,. . . F c . ~ . ~
~ ~
SECTION 14.2 LINEAR-MOMENTUM CONSIDERATIONS FOR A SYSTEM OF PARTICLES 643

Example 14.4 (Continued)


For four impacts per second we have as the total horizontal change in lin-
ear momentum developed by the belt during 1 sec the value (4)(.0621) =
,248 Ib-sec. The average horizontal force during I sec needed for this
change in linear momentum is clearly ,248 Ib. Thus, we have

[(AT),lav = ,248 Ib (C)

The total average difference in tension is then

(AT)="= 6 + 399 + 248 = lb

14.2 LineaFMomentum Considerations


for a System of Particles
In Section 14. I , we considered impulse-momentum relations for a single
particle. Although Examples 14.3 and 14.4 involved more than one particle,
nevertheless the impulse-momentum considerations were made on one particle
at a time. We now wish to set forth impulse-momentum relations for a system
of particles.
Let us accordingly consider a system of n particles. We may start with
Newton's law as developed previously for a system of particles:
n dV.
~ = z mI dt
. - (14.3)
j=l

Since we know that the internal forces cancel, F must be the total external
force on the system of n particles. Multiplying by dt, as before, and integrat-
ing between ti and 5, we write:

Thus, we see that the impulse of the total external force on the system of
particles during a time interval equals the sum of the changes of the linear-
momentum vecturs of the particles during the time interval.
We now consider an example.
644 CHAPTER 1.1 MET H O D S OF M O ME N T U M FOR PARTICI.FS

Example 14.5
A 3-ton truck is moving at a speed 0160 inilhr. [See Fig. 14.S(a).l The
driver suddenly applies his hrakes at time f = 0 so as to lock his wheels
in a panic stop. Load A weighing I ton breaks loose from its ropes and at
time f = 4 sec is sliding rrlufivi, 10 rhr rrirck at a speed of 3 ftlsec. What
is the speed of the truck at that time? Tdke ,u,/ between thc lires and pave-
ment to hc .4.
Since we do tzot kriow the nature of the forces hctween thc truck and ~-
IiiadA whilc the latter is breaking loose, it is easiest to consider the
01 two particles comprising the truck and the load simultaneously whereby
the af<)rementiorredforccs become iiiterr~dand arc imf considered. Accord-
ingly. we have shown the system with all the external loads i n Fig. 14.Xh).
Clearly. N = (4)(2,000) = 8,000 Ih and tlic friction force is (.4)(8.0001 =
3,200 Ih. We now employ Eq. 14.4 in the ~Idirection as follows: (b)

1% =[?.;.’
d -[Zn!vJ]
Figure 14.5. l i u c h u n d c r p i n g panic
\10p.

Ii
2 1
(3)i 2,000 I (I)(?.ilOO)
~~~ v, + ~~~ ~~~~

(V. + 31 (21)
,s

Note that the first quantity inside the first brackets on the right side 01 Eq.
(a) is the inomenturn of h e truck at f = 4 sec. and the second quantity
inside Ihe same hrackels is the miiineiituin o f t h c Imid a1 this instant. We
may readily solve f o r V,:

V, = 35.7 ftlsec

Introducing ni(i.s.s-wtirt’r quantities inti, Eq. 14.4 is easy and sometimes


ad\,antageous. Y o u u’ill reinemher that:

Mr, = C r n , r , (14.5)
i=l

Diffcrcnliating with respect lo lime. we get

MV = -pl,V) (14.6)
!-I

Thus, we see from this cqualion that rlir rorul lirrrar nio~nrrir~trn o f 0 vysrem of
/xirlic/e.s c,yriol.s fhr lirieor I ~ n partidc, ihur has rhr fotul muss 01
I ? I U I I I P ? I ~of
SECTION 14.2 LINEAR-MOMENTUM CONSIDERATIONS FOR A SYSrEM OF PARTICLES 645

the system and that moves with the velocily of the mass center. Using Eq. 14.6
to replace the right side of Eq. 14.4, we can say:

Thus, the total external impuke on a s.ystem ofparticles equa1.T the change in
linear momentum af a hypothetical particle having the mass oj the entire
aggregate and moving with [he mass center.
When the separate motions of the individual particles are reasonably
simple, as a result of constraints, and the motion of the mass center is not eas-
ily available, then Eq. 14.4 can he employed for linear-momentum considera-
tions as was the case for Example 14.5. On the other hand, when the motions
of the particles individually are very complex and the motion of the mass cen-
ter of the system is reasonably simple, then clearly Eq. 14.7 can he of great
value for linear-momentum considerations. Also, as in the case of energy
considerations, we note that the single-particle model is really a special cast
of the center-of-mass formulation above, wherein the motion of the center of
mass of a body describes sufficiently the motion of the body in question.

I Example 14.6
A truck in Fig. 14.6 has two rectangular compartments of identical size for
the purpose of transporting water. Each compartment has the dimensions
20 ft x 10 ft x 8 ft. Initially, tank A is full and tank B is empty. A pump
in tank A begins to pump water from A to B at the rate Q , of I O cfs (cubic
feet per second) and IO sec later is delivering water at the rate Q2 of 30
cfs. If the level of the water in the tanks remains horizontal, what is the
average horizontal force needed to restrain the truck from moving during
this interval?

Figure 14.6. Truck with tank compartments.


646 CHAPTER I ? METHODS OF MOMFNTIJM FOR PAUTICLES

Example 14.6 (Continued)


In this setup, the mess center 11f the water in the tanks is moving
from left tn right and niiiving noniin(f0rrnly during the time interval 0 1
interest. We show thc water in Fig. 14.7 at home tiinc f where the level i n

v
Water surface
t area = 20’ x 8’

tank A has dropped an amnunt ’1 while, hy conservalion of niass, the levcl


in tank B has risen exactly the same amount q. The position x, of the cell-
ter of mass at [his instant can he readily calculated in terms of 7. Thus.
using the basic dcfinition of the center of mass, we can say:
M.t-, = iM,,)(.r,,) + W&,J

= ~ i z o ) ( x ~ i-
1(20)(x)(in)i(pj(~~) i o rl)i(p)(io)
+ 1120i(8)(rl~l(P)(~Oi (>I)

Since we are interested in the time n~tcof change of I< so that wc cat1
profitably employ Eq. 14.7, we next diflerentiate wilh respect t u lime as
follows:
[(20)(8)(IO)](pj(i.)= -[(2O)(Xj h](p)(IO) + [(ZOjCX)(i~~l(p)(30)
(h)

But (ZOj(8)O is the volume of flow2 from tank A tc> tank B at time 1. Using
Q lo represent lhis volume flow, we get for the equation above:
= -(P)ilO)Q
~(20)(8)(lolI(~”r< + (p)i3o)Q = (2o)(pic)
Solving foric,we have
i =I ~ Q
(C)
.‘ XI)

‘Remember r h a ~20 fl x X fl 1s the irra of the lop water surf8tcc in each tank. a\ r h u w n
in Fig. 14.7.
SECTION 14.2 LINEAR-MOMENTUM CONSIDE RATIONS FOR A’SYSTEM OF PARTICLES 647

Example 14.6 (Continued)


Now consider the momentum equation in the x direction for the
water using the center of mass. We can say from Eq. 14.7:

where we have used Eq. (c) in the last step. Putting in Q, = 30 cfs and
Q , = IO cfs, we then get for the average force during the IO-sec interval
of interest on using p = 62.4/g slugdft’:

(e)

This is the average horizontal force that the truck exerts on the water.
Clearly, this force is also what the ground must exert on the truck in
the horizontal direction to prevent motion of the truck during the water
transfer operation.
From another viewpoint, this system is not unlike a propulsion
system like a jet engine to be studied with the aid of a control volume (see
Section 5.4)in your fluids course.

If the total external force on a system of panicles is zero, it is clear from


the previous discussion that there can he no change in the linear momentum
of the system. This is the principle of conservation of linear momentum,
which means, furthermore, that with a zero total impulse on an aggregate of
particles, there can be no change in the velocity of the mass center. If at some
time to the velocity of the mass center of such a system of particles is zero,
then this velocity must remain zero if the impulse on the system of particles
is zero. That is, no matter what movements and gyrations the elements of the
system may have, they must he such that the center of mass must remain
stationary. We reached the same conclusion in Chapter 12, where we found
from Newton’s law that if the total external force on a system of particles is
zero. then the acceleration of the center of mass is zero.’

’Problems 12.103 and 12.104 are examples of this condition.


14.3 Impulsive Forces
1x1 its iiow cxaininc the action involved i n the explosiiin o f a h i m h that is i n -
tially snspmdcil fi-nin a wire. a s shown in Fig. 14.8. Firht, consider thc hitua-
tion directly i4fie.r tlic explosion has been set off. Since very large forces are
present from expanding gases. a / r r r p n r f t f of tlic honih receivcs ;in xpprecia-
hlc impul\e during this short time irileiwal. A l w . directly alter the explosion.
the gravitatiiinal forccs itre no longer countcractcd hy the sitppiirting wire. s o

thcrc is an additional impulse acting on the fragmcnt. But sincc the gravit;i-
tional force i h snia11 coniparcd to fcirces from the esplobion. the gravilalional
impul\e on ii friignrent can he considcrcd negligibly small for the short period
of time under discuhsion coniparcd to that [ i f the expanding gases acting (in
the lragiiient. A plot of thc impulsiuc force (fmni the explosiiin) arid the f w c c
o f gravity on a fragmcnt i \ shown i n Fig. 14.1). It is clear from this diagram
SECTION 14.3 IMPULSIVE FORCES 649

that the impulse from the explosion lasts for a very short time At and can he
significant, whereas the impulse from gravity during the same short time is by
comparison negligible. Forces that act Over a very short time hut have never-
theless appreciable impulse are called impulsiwforces. In actions involving
very small time intervals, we need only consider impulsive forces. Further-
more, during a very short time At an impulsive force acting on a particle can
change the velocity of the particle i n accordance with the impulse-momentum
equation an appreciable amount while the particle undergoes very little
change in position during the time At.'' It is simplest in many cases to con-
sider the change in velocity of a purticle from an impulsive .force to occur
over zero distunce.
Up to now, we have only considered a fragment of the bomb. Now let
us consider a11 the fragments nf the bomb taken as a system of particles.
Since the explosive action is inferno1 to the bomb, the action causes
impulses that for any direction have equal and opposite counterparts, and
thus the total impulse on the bomb due tu the explosion is zero. We can thus
conclude that directly ufter the explosion the center of mass of the bomb ha,y
not moved uppreciubly despite the high velocity of the fragments in all
directions, as illustrated in Fig. 14.8. As time progresses beyond the short
time interval described above, the gravitational impulse increases and has
significant effect. If there were no friction, the center of mass would descend
from the position of support as a freely falling particle under this action
of gravity.
The following problems will illustrate these ideas.

iThis idealization can he explained more preciacly ab fullows. For an impulsive force F
acting on a hody of milss M. we ciln say from the linear momentum equation

The tnvrimuiu iiiovement of the hody M during this time interval according LO N c w a n ' s law on
using the above result for V i s then

Nulc that V,,,,," i h proportimill 10 At while x is proponional to (AI)>, Clearly for a v e q inwli inter^
"ill Ar the value of the movement x of the mass M can he considered ~ e c v n dorder cumpared tu
; the value of the velocity V . For simpliciry. with minimal error, we can say that the mash M d w s
,.' mi move while underpin8 ' 8 dzun8r qfveiuciiy in rrrponse to on impuisivr force.
650 C H A PTER 1 4 METHODS OF MOME,WTUM OR P A R T I C ~ S

Example 14.7
Some top-flight tennis players hit the ball on a service at the instant that
the hall is at thc top of its trajectory after being released by the free hand.
The ball i s often given a speed V o f 120 milhr by the racquet directly after
the impact i s complete. I f the time 01duration of the impact process is .On5
scc, what is thc magnitude o f the average force from thc racquet on the
hall during this time interval'? Take the weight of the ball as 1.5 OL.

Figure 14.10. Impact of a rciinis hall at service.

We have here acting o n the ball during a very small time interval an
impulsive force and [he force of gravity. We will ignore the gravity force
during the timc of impact and wc will consider that the b a l l achieves a post
impact velocity while not moving. as explained earlier in the model for
impulsive force behavior. As shown in Fig. 14.10, the impulse I generated
o n the hall by the racquet accordingly is

= ..5124[.99hi ~ . 0 8 7 2 j ) Ib-sec

Next. we go to the impulse momentum equation. Thus

(F,\)(.nns) = .5124(.996i ~ .0872j)

The magnitude of the average furce is l"inally given as follows:

Aster the impact, the hall will havc a trajectory determined hy gravity.
wind furces. and the initial post-impact conditions.
SECTION 14.3 IMPULSIVE FORCES 65 1

Example 14.8
A 9,000-N idealized cannon with a recoil spring (K = 4,000 Nlm) fires a
45-N projectile with a muzzle velocity of 625 mlsec at an angle of SV
(Fig. 14.1 I). Determine the maximum compression of the spring.

Figure 14.11. Idealized cannon..


The firing of the cannon takes place in a very short time interval. The
force on the projectile and the force on the cannon from the explosion are
impulsive forces. As a result, the cannon can be considered to achieve a
recoil velocity instantaneously without having moved appreciably. Like the
exploding bomb, the impulse on the cannon plus projectile is zero, as a result
of the tiring process. Since the linear momentum of the cannon plus projectile
is zero just before firing, this linear momentum must be zero directly after
firing. Thus, just after firing, we can say for the x direction:

(MY)<a""o" + (MV.)proje& = " (a)


Using y. for the cannon velocity along the x axis and 7 = y. + 625 cos S O
for the projectile velocity along the x axis we get

%?! y. + 9[(625)(cos 50') + y , ]= 0


R 8
Solving for y., we get
= -2.00 mlsec (b)
After this initial impulsive action, which results in an instantaneous
velocity being imparted to the cannon, the motion of the cannon is then
impeded by the spring. We may now use conservation of mechanical
energy for a particle in this phase of motion of the cannon. Denoting 6 as
the maximum deflection of the spring, we can say:
'9~000(2.00') = i(4,000)(Sz)
-~
2 R
Therefore.
652 CHAPTER IJ METHODS OF MOMENTUM FOR PARTICI.ES

Example 14.9
For target practice, a 0-N rock i s thrown inti, the air and fired im by a pis-
tol. The pistiit bullet, of m a s s 57 g and moving with a speed of 312 mlsec,
strikes the rock as i t i s descending vcrrically at a specd of 6.25 nilsec. [See
Fig. 14.12(a).] Bolh the velocity of the hullet and the rock are parallcl to
the ~ryplane. Directly after (he hullet hits the rock, the lack hreakh up inti)
two pieces, A weighing 5.78 N and R weighing 3.22 N. Whal i s the veloc-
ity of R after collision for the given coplanar postcollision wliicitics of the
hullet and the piece A shown i n Fig. 14.12(h)'? Thc bodies, thr clarity, are
shown separated in the diagram. Keep i n mind, nevertheless, that they are
very close ti1 cach other at post-impact. I n our model of the impact
process. they would not even have moved relative to each other during lhis
process. The indicated 219-mlsec and 25-mlsec vclocities are in the x?
plane. If we neglect wind resistance, how high up doe? the ccnter of mass
o f the rock and hullet system rise after collision'!

irll
21') rni,rc

Figure 14.12. Bullet striking ii rock.

Linear momentum is conserved during the collision, 50 we can


equate linear momenta directly belore and directly after collision. Thus,

(.057)(312)(.51' + ,866;) + 9 ( - 6 . 2 5 j i
.s
~

= (.057)(219)(-sin2O"i + c r i c 2 0 " J i

+ -5.78 25(.8(i(ii + .5j ) + 3.22 [(I/,,


~~~~

R fi
i + ( v ~ ) , j, ]
SECTION 14.3 IMPULSIVE FORCES 653

We may solve for the desired quantities (V,), and (V’)y to get

We now compute the velocity of the center of mass just before colli-
sion. Thus,

My. = t 1
-~+ .OS7
9
y. = -(-6.2S)j + (.057)(312)(.5i + .866j)

Therefore,
V . = 9.12% + 9.92j d s e c
Hence, for the center of mass there is an initial velocity upward of 9.92
d s e c just before collision. Directly after collision, since there has been no
appreciable external impulse on the system during collision, the center of
mass srill has this upward speed. But now considering larger time inter-
vals, we must take into account the action of gravity, which gives the cen-
ter of mass a downward acceleration of 9.81 d s e c . 2 Thus,

jic = -9.81
yc = -9.81t + C,
y, = -9.81 - + C,t + C,
f2
2

When I = 0, yc = 9.92 and we take y‘ = 0 for convenience. Hence


we have

-v< , = -9.81t + 9.92 (a)


v,= t , + 9.92t
-9.81-
.< 2 (b)

Set 4;, in (a) equal to zero and solve for 1. We get


I = 1.011 sec
Substitute this value of t in Eq. (b) and solve for v(.,which now gives the
desired maximum elevation of the center of mass after collision. Thus,

(C)
14.1. A body wcighing 100 Ib reachcy an incline o f 3 0 ~while it 14.5. It the coefficient of static friction is .S iii Plohlem 14.4 and
ISmoving at SO ft/iec. If the dynamic coefficient of friction is 3, ihe coefficient of dynamic friction i c .i.what is the speed of thc
how long before [he hody stops'! hlock after 2X scc?

14.6. A hody is dropped lrom reil. (a) Dctermine the liillr


rcquired for i t IO acquire a vclocity of I h mi\ec. ( h ) Determinc thr
timc nerdcd tu increace its velocity from I 6 misec 10 23 m l w

Figure P.14.1.
14.7. A hody having a m a s s u l 5 lhirr i ? actcd mi by thc fkllow
ing forcc:
14.2. A particle of mass I kg is initially stationary at thc origin
of a reference. A force having a known variation with time acls on
the panicle. That is, F = 8ri + ( 6 + 3 ; l ) j + (16 + 3r')k Ih

F(r) = ?i + (hi + l0)j + I.hi'k N where r is in seconds. What is the velocity 01the hody aftei 5 ccc
where r is in seconds. After 10 sec, what is the whcity of thz body? i f the initial velocity i?
V, = hi + ij ~ Illk ftlsec'!
14.3. A unidirectional force acting o n B particle of mass I6 kg is
plotted. What is the velocity of the particle at 40 sec'! Initially, the
particle is at rest. 14.8. A body with ii masr of If, kg is rl-quirrd t o change
its velocity from V , = 2i + 4 j -. IOk mlsec t o a velocity
V , = IOi - S j + 20k mlsec in I O sec. What average force F,,
over this lime intervill will dc the jrib'!

14.9. In Prohlem 14.X. determine the forcr as ii fiincliun ollitiir


tor the case where f i ~ c evnrics lincarly with lime slarting with ii
10 20 30 ZCIO valuc.
Time (sec)
Figure P.14.3. 14.10. A hockey puck miivcb ai 30 fllwc troin left In right.
The puck is intercepted by a player who whisks it at 80 Illsec
14.4. A 100-lb block is acted 011 by a force P . which varies with toward g o d A . a\ shoun. The puck i s also risks lrom the ice ill
time as shown. What i s the sped of the block atter X O hec'! a rille of I O ftlsec. What is thc impolrc 011 Ihe puck. uhrrhe
Assume that the block stan\ from rest and neglect friction. The weight is 5 o x ' !
time axis gives timc intervals.

30 ftlsec

y
~ 100 Ib
1.1
Figure P.14.4. Figure P.14.10.

654
14.11. Gravel is released from a hopper at the rate of I kglsec.
At the exit of the hopper it bas a speed of . I 5 m i s . The belt is
moving at a constant speed of 3 mis. If there is 20 kg of gravel on
the conveyor helt at all times and if the belt on the conveyor bed
has a weight of 50 N, what is the difference in tension T, - T , for
the belt to maintain operation? The dynamic coefficient of friction Y

between bed and belt is 0.4. Assume that the gravel drops 0.2 m
from the hopper outlet.

-X

Figure P.l

14.16. Two boxes per second each weighing 100 Ih land on a


circular conveyor at a speed of 5 ftlsec in the direction of the
chute. If there are 6 boxes on the circular belt at any one time,
determine the average torque needed to rotate the helt at an
angular speed of .2 radlsec. The dynamic coefficient of fric-
tion between the belt and the conveyer bed is .3. What horse-
power is needed for operating this belt? Neglect the rotational
Figure P.14.11. effect on the boxes themselves as they drop from the chute onto
the conveyor. Also, does the radial change in velocity of the
boxes affect the torque needed by the conveyor? Neglect any
radial slipping of the boxes as they land.
14.12. Do Problem 12.5 by methods of momenhm

v-.
Belt rides on a bed: u = . 3
14.13. Do Problem 12.6 by methods of momentum

14.14. A commuter train made up of two cars is moving at a


speed of 80 k h r . The first car has a mass of 20,000 kg and the
second 15,000 kg.

(a) If the brakes are applied simultaneously to both


cars, determine the minimum time the cars travel
before stopping. The coefficient of static friction
between the wheels and rail is 3.
2 bores per sec.
If the brakes on the first car only are applied, deter- 6 boxes on belt
(b)
mine the time the cars travel before stopping and Chute
w = 2 mdlw
the force F transmitted between the cars.

14.15. Compute the velocity of the bodies after 10 sec if they


start from rest. The cable is inextensihle, and the pulleys are fric-
tionless. For the contact surfaces, pd = .2. Figure P.14.16.

655
Figure P.14.M

556
14.21. In Problem 14.20, compute the impulse on the horimntal 14.25. Two vehicles connected with an inextensible cable are
surface. A moves 4 ft in 1 sec and WB = 20 Ih. rolling along a road. Vehicle A, using a winch, draws A toward it
so that the relative speed is 5 ftfsec at f = 0 and I O ft/sec at
1 = 20 sec. Vehicle A weighs 2,000 Ih and vehicle A weighs
14.22. An antitank airplane fires two 90-N projectiles at a tank 3,000 Ib. Each vehicle has a rolling resistance that is .01 times the
at the same time. The mum12 velocity a f the guns is 1,000 d s e c vehicle's weight. What is the speed of A relative tn the ground
relative to the plane. Ifthe plane before firing weighs 65 kN and is at 1 = 20 sec if A is initially moving tu the right at a speed
moving with a velocity of 320 k d h r , compute the change in its of 30 f t h c ' !
speed when it fires the two projectiles.

14.23. A toboggan has just entered the horizontal pan of its run.
It carries three people weighing 120 Ib, 180 Ih. and 150 Ib, respec-
tively. Suddenly, a pedestrian weighing 200 Ib strays ontn the
course and is turned end for end by the toboggan, landing safely
amvnr! I- .
- thz riders. Since the tohorean Dath is icv.
,, we can nedect
Figure P.14.25.
friction with the toboggan path for all actions descrihed here. If
the toboggan 1s traveling at a speed of 35 mph just before collision
occurs, what is the speed after the collision when the pedestrian
has become a rider'? The tobuggan weighs 30 Ih. 14.26. Treat Example 14.3 as a two-particle system in the
impulse-momentum considerations. Verify the results of Example
14.3 for V. (Be sure to include all external forces far the system.)

14.27. Determine the velocity of body A and body A after 3 sec


Figure P.14.23. if the system is released from rest. Neglect friction and the inertia
of the pulleys.

14.24. An 890-N rowboat containing a hhX-N man is pushed off


the dock by an 800-N man. The speed that is imparted to the boat
is .30 mlsec by this push. The man then leaps into the boat from
the dock with a speed of .60 mlsec relative to the dock in the
direction of motion of the boat. When the two men have settled
down i i i the boat and before rowing crimmences, what is the speed
of the boat'! Keglect water resistance.

Figure P.14.27.

Figure P.14.24. A and E . )

657
14.29. A 40-kN (ruck i s cnoving at the speed of 40 km/hr carry-
ing a 15-kN load A . ‘The load is restrained only by friction with the
floor of the truck whcie there i i a dynamic coefficient o f friction of
.2 and thc static cuelficicnt of friction is 3. The driver suddenly
jams his hrahes on si) as t o loch all wheels for I .5 sec. At the cnd
ofthis interval, the hraker arc rslcased. What is the final speed Vuf
the truck neglecting wind reristance and rotational inertia of the
wheels after load A stops slipping’! The dynamic ctrefficient of fric-
tion hetwcen the tire? and the road is .4.

Figure P.14.32
Figure P.14.29.
14.33. A device to be detonated i s shown in (a) suspended above
14.30. A I ,300-kg Jeep is carrying thrcc 100-kg passengers. The the ground. Ten seconds after detonation, there are four fragments
Jeep is in Sour-wheel drive and i s under test to see what maximum having the following masses and position vectors relative to refer-
speed i s posrihlc in 5 sec from a start on an icy mad surface for ence X Y Z :
which
$ I . != . I .Compute ,,,, at I = 5 sec. m, = 5 kg
r ; = l,(A%Ji + XoOj + 90M m
tn, =3 kg
ri = 80Oi + l,XiKlj + 2,500k m
ini= 4hg
rl = 400i + I ,000j + 2,OOiJk m
Figure P.14.30. m, = 6 kg
r, = X 4 i + Y,j + Z4k
14.31. Two ad.jacrnt tanks A and B are qhown. Both tanks are
rectangular with a width of 4 ni. Cawline from tank A is heing Find the position ri if thc center of mass of the device is initially
pumped into tank B . When the level of lank A i s .7 m frum the top, at position r(,,where
the rate of flow Q frum A to R is 1 O i l livrslsec, and 1 0 sec Iatcr
i t i s 500 literslsec. What is the average horizontal force from the
T,, = 600i + 12iJij + 2,300k m
fluids onto the tank during this IO-sec timc interval? The density Neglect wind reqistance.
of thc gasoline i s .R x IO’ hg/m’. Tank A is originally full and
tank H is originally empty.

Figure P.14.31.
14.32. Two tanks A and H are shown. Tank A is originally full of
water ( p = 62.4 Ibmlft’), while tank B ic empty. Water is pumped
from A to R. If initinlly 100 cfs of water is heing pumped and if this
flow incrcasu at the rate of 10 cfslsec’ For 30 sec thereafter. what
is the average verticil1 force onto the tiinks from the watcr during
this timc period, itside from thc static dead weight of thc water!
X
i Figure P.14.33.
SECTION 14.4 IMPACT 659

14.4 Impact
In Section 14.3, we discussed impulsive forces. We shall in this section discuss
in detail an action in which impulsive forces are present. This situation occurs
when two bodies collide but do not break. The time interval during collision is
vely small, and comparatively large forces are developed on the bodies during
the small time interval. This action is called impact. For such actions with such
short time intervals, the force of gravity generally causes a negligible impulse.
The impact forces on the colliding bodies are always equal and opposite to each
other, so the net impulse on the pair of bodies during collision is zero. This
means that the total linear momentum directly after impact (postimpact) equals
the total linear momentum directly before impact (preimpact).
We shall consider at this time two types of impact for which certain
definitions are needed. We shall call the normal to the plane of contact during Plane of Line of
the collision of two bodies the line cfimpuct. If the centers of mass of the two
colliding bodies lie along the line of impact, the action is called central
impact and is shown for the case of two spheres in Fig. 14.13.5 If, in addi-
tion, the velocity vectors of the mass centers approaching the collision are
collinear with the line of impact, the action is called direct central impact.
This action is illustrated by V, and V, in Fig 14.13. Should one (or both) of y'OO
the velocities have a line of action not collinear with the line impact-for Central impact
example, VI and/or V'-the action is termed ublique central impact. Figure 14.13. Central impact of two
In either case, linear momentum is conserved during the short time 'pheres.
interval from directly before the collision (indicated with the subscript i ) to
directly after the collision (indicated with suhscriptf). That is,
(mIVl); + (m,VJ, = ( m l y ) , + (m,V,), (14.8)
In the direct-.central-impact case for .smooth bodies (i.e., bodies with no fric-
tion), this equation becomes a single scalar equation since (V,)fand (V,),are
collinear with the line of impact. Usually, the initial velocities are known and
the final values are desired, which means that we have for this case one scalar
equation involving two unknowns. Clearly, we must know more about the
manner of interaction of the bodies, since Eq. 14.8 as it stands is valid for
materials of any deformahility (e& putty or hardened steel) and takes no
account of such important considerations. Thus, we cannot consider the bod-
ies undergoing impact only as particles as has been the case thus far, hut
must, in addition, consider them as deformable bodies of finite size in order
to generate enough information to solve the problem at hand.
For the oblique-impact case, we can write components of the linear-
momentum equation along the line of impact and for smooth (frictionless) bod-
ies, along two other directions at right angles to the line of impact. If we know
the initial velocities, then we have six unknown final velocity components and
only three equations. Thus, we need even more information to establish fully
the final velocities after this more general type of impact. We now consider
each of these cases in more detail in order to establish these additional relations.

'Noncentral or e c w n f r k impact i s examined in Chapter 17 for the case of plane motion.


660 CHAPTER 14 MbTHODS 01.MOMENTUM FOR PARTICLES

Case 1. Direct Central Impact. Let us first examine the direct-central-


impact casc. We shall consider the period of collision to be made up of two
subintervals of timc. The period (?fdeformation refers to the duration of the
collision. starting from initial contact of the bodies and ending at the instant
of maximum deformation. During this period, we shall consider that impulse
ID df acts oppositely on each of the bodies. The second period, covering the
time from the maximum deformation condition to the instant at which the
bodies just separate? we shall term the period ofrestitution. The impulse act-
ing oppositely on each body during lhis period we shall indicate as R dt. If I
the bodies are perfec.t/y elastic, they will reestablish their initial shapes during
the period of restitution (if we neglect the internal vibrations of the bodies),
as shown in Fig. 14.14(a). When the bodies do not reestablish their initial
shapes [Fig. 14.14(b)], we say that plastic deformation has taken place.

1 deformation ' restitution


Pcrfrctly elastic collisinn
'
(ai

,
f Penodof Periodof-4
deformation restitution
Inelastic collision
(h)
Figure 14.14. Collision process

Thc ratio of the impulse during the rcstitution period R dt to the


I
impulse during the deformation period D dt is a number E, which depends
mainly on the physical properties of the bodies in collision. We call this num-
ber thc coeficirnr 4 rmtitntion. Thus,

impulse during restitution -


e = -
j Rdr
impulw dunng deformation
~~

] "; (14 9)

We must strongly point out that the coefficient of restitution depends also on
the size, shape, and approach velocities of the bodies before impact. These
dependencies result from the fact that plastic deformation is related to the
magnitude and nature o f thc force distributions in the bodies and also to the
rate of loading. However, values of E have been established for different
materials and can he used for approximate results in the kind of computations

VI( thcy don'l separate. the end of the second pcriod occun \,hen the hodiet cease to
deform. Wc call such B process B plaStir impact.
SECnON 14.4 IMPACT 661

to follow, We shall now formulate the relation between the coefficient of


restitution and the initial and final velocities of the bodies undergoing impact.
Let us consider one of the bodies during the two phases of the collision.
If we call the velocity at the maximum deformation condition (VID, we can
say for mass I :

Ddr = [(m,V,), -(m,V,),] = -ml[(Vl)i -(VI),] (14.10)

During the period of restitution, we find that

Dividing Eq. 14. I1 by Eq. 14. IO, canceling out m,, and noting the definition
in Eq. 14.9, we can say:

(14.12)

A similar analysis for the other mass (2) gives

In this last expression, we have changed the sign of numerator and denomina-
tor. At the intermediate position at the end of deformation and the beginning
of restitution the masses have essentially the same velocity. Thus, (VI), =
(VJD.Since the quotients in Eqs. 14.12 and 14.13 are equal to each other, we
can add numerators and denominators to form another equal quotient, as you
can demonstrate yourself. Noting the abovementioned equality of the
yj terms, we have the desired result:

This equation involves the coefficient E , which is presumably known or esti-


mated, and the initial and final velocities of the bodies undergoing impact.
Thus, with this equation we can solve for the final velocities of the bodies
after collision when we use the linear-momentum equation 14.8 for the case
of direct central impact.
During a perfectly elasric collision, the impulse for the period of resti-
tution equals the impulse for the period of deformation? so the Coefficient of
restitution is unit?, for this case. For inelastic collisions, the coefficient of
restitution is less than unity since the impulse is diminished on restitution as a

’The impulses are equal kcause during the period of restitution the body can k consid-
ered to undergo identically the reverse of the process corresponding to the deformation period.
Thus. from a thermodynamics poinl of view, wc are considering the elastic impact to k a
rcvcrsiblr process.
662 CHAPTER 14 METHODS OF MOMENTUM FOR PARTICLES

result of the failure of the bodies to resume their original geometries. For a
s t i i . e = 0 1i.e.. (V2), = ( V , ) , ] and the bodies remain in
i ) ~ , ~ ~ ~ r l y / ) l oimpact,
contact. Thus t ranges from 0 tu I

Case 2. Oblique Central Impact. Lct us now consider the case of oblique
central impact. The velocity components along the line of impact can be
related by the scalar component of [he linear-momentum equation 14.8 in this
direction and also by Eq. 14.14, where velocity componcnls along the line of
impact are used and where the coefficient of reslilution may he considered
(for smooth bodies) lo be thc same as for the direct-central-impact case. If we
know lhe initial conditions, we can accordingly solve for those velocity com-
ponents after impact in the direction of the line of impact. As for the other
rectangular components of velocity, we can say that for smooth bodies, these
velocity components are unaffected by the collision. since no impulses act in
these directions on either hody. That is, the velocity components normal to
the line of impact for cacli hody are the samc immediately after impact as
hefore. Thus, the final velocity components of both hiidies can be established,
and the motions of thc hodies can he determined within the liniils of the
discussion. The following examples are used to illustrate the use of thc pre-
ceding fiirmulations.

Note that the mass and iiiaterials of the colliding bodies for both direct
or ohlique central impact can he different from each other.

Example 14.10
Two hilliard hall? (of the same sizc and mass) collide with the velocities of
approach shown in Fig. 14.15. For a coefficient of restilutioii of .90. what
are the final velocities of the halls directly after they part? What is the loss
in kinetic energy?
i

5 t
--x

7,,,7I ftisec \ I O Rlscc


Figure 14.15. Ohlique CZIIII~Iimpact.

A reference is established si1 that the .x axis is iilong line (if impact
and they axis is in the plane of contact such that the reference plane I S par-
SECTION 14.4 IMPACT 663

Example 14.10 (Continued)


allel to the billiard table. The approach velocities have been decomposed
into components along these axes. The velocity components Cy), and (V,),,
are unchanged during the action. Along the line of impact, linear-momen-
turn considerations lead to
5m - 7.07~1= mt(V,)J, + m~W2)J, (a)
Using the coefficient-of-restitution relation (Eq. 14.14). we have

We thus have two equations, (a) and (b), for the unknown components in
then direction. Simplifying these equations, we have
[(v1)~i,+ ~(VJJ, = -2.07 (C)

I(V,)J, + [(VJJ, = -10.86 (d)


Adding, we get
[(V,)J, = - 6.47 ft/sec
Solving for [(V,)J, in Eq. (c), we write
[(VJJ- 6.47 = -2.07
Therefore,
[(V,)J, = 4.40 ft/sec
The final velocities after collision are then

The loss in kinetic energy is given as


(KE), - ( K E ) f = ( $ 5 2 + 4m1O2) - [im6.472 + 1m(7.072 + 4.402)]
AKE=$m[25 + 100 - (41.9 + 50.0 + 19.33)]

Please note that mechanical energy is conserved only if E is unity (i.e., a


perfectly elastic impact). For all other cases, there is always dissipation of
mechanical energy into heat and permanent deformation. However, all
impacts involve conservation of linear momentum for the system.
664 CHAPTER 14 Mtl'HODS O F MOMENIUM FOR PAKTICI.ES

Example 14.11
A pile driver is used to forcc a pile A into the ground (Fig. 14.16) as part
of a program to properly prepare the foundation for a Lall building. The
device consists of a piston C on which a pressurc p is developed from
steam or air.
The piston i s connected t n a I ,000-lh hanrriier R. The assembly is
suddcnly released and accelerates downward a distance h n l 2 ft 10
impact on pile A weighing 400 Ih. If the earth develops a constant
resisting forcc to inoverncnt of 25,000 Ih, what distance d will the pile
niovc Cor a drop involving 110 contribution Crmr 11 (which is then 0 psig).
Take thc impact as plnstic.. The weight of the piston and the connecting
rod is 100 Ib.
We begin hy using conservation of mechanical energy lor the
freely falling system to a position just before impact (preinipact). Using
the initial configuration as the datum we have

0 + (1.000 + 100)i2) = 7I ('J,o"!vz + 0


I

:, v= ,'2R/L = ,'(2)[32.2)(2)= 11.35 ftisec

Now we get to the impact process. We have conservation of linear


momentum while the bodies remain hypnthc1ic;llly a1 the p~~silionat
which contact is first made. Thus, for plastic impact we can say Figure 14.16. S ~ e n n - d l - i v mpilc driver.

Finally. we come to the post-impact process where we shall use thc work
energy equation for the pile driver and the pilc.

where the terin nn the left side must he negative hecause the ~nctforce
on the system (23,500 Ih) is in the nppositc direction to the rno~ion
(see Eq. 13.2). Solving f o r d wc get

d = ,0686 ft = 3'2.3 in
SECTION 14.5 COLLISION OF A PARTKLE WITH A MASSIVE RIGID BODY 665

"14.5 Collision of a Particle


with a Massive Rigid Body
In Section 14.4, we employed conservation-of-momentum considerations and
the concept of the coefficient of restitution to examine the impact of two
smooth bodies of comparable size. Now we shall extend this approach to
include the impact of a spherical body with a much larger and more massive
rigid body, as shown in Fig. 14.17.

Figure 14.17. Small body collides with large body

The procedure we shall follow is to consider the massive body to be a


spherical body of i&ite mass with a radius equal to the local radius of cur-
vature of the surface of the massive body at the point of contact A . This con-
dition is shown in Fig. 14.18, The line of impact then becomes identical with
the normal n to the surface of the massive body at the point of impact. Note
that the case we show in the diagram corresponds to oblique central impact.
With no friction, clearly only the components along the line of impact n can
change as a result of impact. But in this case, the velocity of the sphere repre-
senting the massive body must undergo no change in value after impact
because of its infinite m a w RWe cannot make good use here of the conserva-
tion of the linear-momentum equation in the n direction because the infinite
mass of the hypothetical body (2) will render the equation indeterminate.
However, we can use Eq. 14.14, assuming we have a coefficient of restitution
E for the action. Noting that the velocity of the massive body does not change,
we accordingly get

(14.15)

Thus, knowing the velocities of the bodies before impact, as well as the quan-
tity E , we are able to compute the velocity of the particle after impact. If the

"Otherwise. there would he an infinite change in momentum for chis bphere,


666 CHAPTER 1 4 METHODS 01-MOMENTUM m u PARTICLES
collision is perfectly elastic. E = I, and we see from Eq. 14. IS that for a sta-
tionary massive body

I I
I I
I I
I
\
\ ,I

\
,, ,I
,
,. ,,

Figure 14.18. Anglc of i m j d m c e and angle of retlection.

This means that the angle of incidence 0 equals the angle of reflection p. For
E c I (i.e., for an inelastic collision), the angle of reflection p will clearly
exceed 0 as shown in Fig. 14.18.
We now illustrate the use of these formulations

Example 14.12
A ball is dropped unto a concrete floor from height h (Fig. 14.19). If the
coefficient of restitution is .90 for the action, to what height h' will the ball
rise on the rebound:)
Here the massive body has an infinite radius at the surface. Further- h
more, we have a direct central impacl. Accordingly. from Eq. 14.15 we have
( v ) - 0 = ,/2gh'
<=---l _
(VI,- t i $3
~~~ ~

~
1
Figure 14.19. Ball dropped on concrete
floor.
Solving for h', we get

3h = 81h
SECTION 14.5 COLLISION OF A PARTICLE WITH A MASSIVE RIGID BODY 661

In the following interesting example as well as in some homework prob-


lems, we will have to determine, for a given uniform distribution of stationary
particles in space, how many of these particles collide per unit time with a rigid
body translating through this cloud of particles at constant speed V,. To illus-
trate how this may be accomplished easily, we have shown a cone-cylinder
moving through such a cloud of particles at constant speed y, in Fig. 14.20.

Figure 14.20. A conexylinder moving through a cloud of particles

During a time interval Ai, the cone A moves a distance V, At, colliding with
all the particles in the volume swept out by the conical surface during this
time interval as shown in Fig. 14.21, where this region is outlined with
dashed lines. This volume can easily be calculated. It is that of a right circu-
f-
lar cylinder shown in Fig. 14.22 having a cross section corresponding to the
projected area of the cone taken along the axis parallel to the direction of
_fi
motion of the moving body. Clearly, by adding the volume of cone A to the
right circular cylinder along its axis at the forward end and then deleting the
Figure 14.21. Dashed region is volume
same volume at the rear end, we reproduce the dashed volume in Fig 14.21 swept oUt by the coneA during At,
during the time interval Ai. In general, the volume swept out by a body during
a time interval can readily he found by using the projected area of the body in
the direction of motion. We then use this area to sweep out a volume during
this time interval. This negates having to deal with the actual more compli-
cated three-dimensional end surface itself. We shall make use of this proce-
dure in the following example.

I- VOAt I-
Figure 14.22. Volume swept by cone A
668 CHAPTER 14 METHODS OF MOMENKJM FOR PARTICLES

Example 14.13
A satellite in the fnrm of a sphere with radius K [Fig. 14.23(a)l is n ~ i v i n g
above the earth’s surface i n a region of highly rarefied atmosphere. We
wish to estimate the drag on the satellite. Neglect the cmtribution from
the antennas.

ihl iC)

Figure 14.23. Satellite imoving at high spccd i n space.

In this highly rarefied atmosphere, we shall assume that the average


spacing of the molecules is large enough relative to the satellite that ue
cannot use the continuum approach of fluid dynamics, wherein mntter is
assumed to be continuously distributed. Instead, we must consider colli-
sions of the individual molecules with the satellite, which is a n ~ n c o i i -
tinuum approach, 21s discussed in Section I .7. The mass per molecule is in
slugs and the number density of the molecules is uniformly 11 moleculesift.’
Since the siltellite is moving with a speed much g r a t e r than the speed of
the molecules (the inolecules move at about the speed of sound), we can
assume that the molecules are staiionary relative to inertial space reference
XYZ and that only the satcllite is moving. Furthcrmore, we assume that
when the satellite hits a inolecule there is an elastic. Irictionlcss collision
To study this prohlem, we have shown ;I section of the wtrllite in
Fig. 14.23(b). A referencexx is fixed tu the satellite at its center. We shall
consider this refercnce a l s o to be an inertial relcrence--a step that for
small drag will introduce littlc error for the ensuing calculations. Kelalive
ti) this refcrmce. the molecules approach the satellite with :I horizontal
velocity v, as shown lor one molecule. ‘They then collidc with the surlice
SECTION 14.5 COLLISION OF A PARTICLE WITH A MASSIVE RIGID BODY 669

Example 14.13 (Continued)


with an angle of incidence measured by the polar coordinate 8. Finally,
they deflect with an equal angle of reflection of 8. The component of the
impulse given to the molecule in the x direction (I,,,), is
(Im0JA= ( m y cos 28) - (-my) = (my (I + cos 28) (a)
This is the impulse component that would he given to any molecule hitting
a strip that is R d8 in width and which is revolved around the x axis as
shown in Fig. 14.23(c). The number of such collisions per second for this
strip can readily be calculated as follow^:^
collisions for strip per second
projected area distance the
= of the strip strip moves
[in x direction ][in 1 sec
= [(R d8 cos B)(2nRsin B ) ] [ y ] [ n ]
[I number of
molecules per
unit volume ] (b)

= 2nR2nV7sin 8 cos B d8
The impulse component dl, provided by the stnp in 1 sec is the product of
the right sides of Eqs. (a) and (b). Thus,
dIx = 2nmnR2V3 (sin @cos8)(1 + cos 28) d8 (c)

Noting that 2 sin OcosB = sin 20, we have


d', = nmnRZV?(sin20+sin2Bcos28)dB

2
Integrating from 8 = 0 to 8 = n/2,1° we get the total impulse for 1 sec by
the where:

The average force needed to give this impulse by the satellite is clearly
nmnRZV:, and so the reaction to this force is the desired drag. RdO cos H

YAs is shown here the volume swept out by the strip in one second will be a right
circular tube of length V, Ac = (<)(I) and thickneas R d 8 cos 8 and having a radius equal to ~

R sin 8.
# W eintegrate only up to 7112 because collisions take place only on thefront part of the
sphere. (Note also, we are already rotating for any 8 completely around the axis of the
sphere.) This is so since. in our model, the molecules are moving only trom left to right
toward !he sphere with no collisions possible beyond 8 = n12.
14.43. Cylinder A , weighing 20 Ib, is moving at a speed of 14.46. Two identical cylinders, each of mass 5 kg, slide on a fric-
20 ftlsec when it is at a distance 10 ft from cylinder B, which is tionless rod. Each is fastened to a linear spring ( K = 5,000 N/m)
stationary. Cylinder B weighs 15 Ih and has a dynamic coefficient whose unstretched length is .65 m. The spring mass is negligible. If
of friction with the rod on which it rides of .3. Cylinder A has a the cylinders are released from rest by raising the restraints,
dynamic coefficient of friction of .I with the rod. What is the (a) What is their speed just after colliding with a coeffi-
coefficient of restitution if cylinder B comes to rest after collision cient of restitution of .6?
at a distance 12 ft to the right of the initial position? (b) How close do they come to the walls'?

Restraints
k I O ' 4
Q&&@
Figure P.14.43. M=5kg
e= 6
14.44. A load is being lowered at a speed of 2 d s e c into a
barge. The barge weighs 1,000kN, and the load weighs 100 ldu. If Figure P.14.46.
the load hits the barge at 2 d s e c and the collision is plastic, what
is the maximum depth that the barge is lowered into the water,
assuming that the position of loading is such as to maintain the 14.47. A light ann,connected to a mass A, is released from re51
barge in a horizontal position? The width of the barge is 10 m. at a horizontal orientation. Determine the maximum deflection of
What are the weaknesses (if any) of your analysis? The density of the linear spring ( K = 3,000 N/m) after A impacts with body B
water is 1,000 kglm.' [Hint: Recall the Archimedes Principle] with a coefficient of restitution equal to .8.If body B does not
reach the spring, indicate this fact. Note that there is Coulomb
friction between the body B and the floor with pd = .6. Consider
Chains
bodies A and B to be small.

ej B Im
.02
I-- 3 0 m + f T
Figure P.14.44.

14.45. A tractor-trailer weighing 50 kN without a load canies a


1
.3 m
MA= l 0 k g
LO-kN load A as shown. The driver jams on his brakes until they
MB=7kg
lock for a panic stop. The load A breaks loose from its ropes. c = .8
When the truck has stopped the load is 3 m from the left end of the K = 3,000 N/m
trailer wall (see diagram) and is moving at a speed of 4 d s e c rel-
ative to the buck. The coefficient of dynamic friction between the
load A and the trailer is .2 and between the tires and road is .5. If
there is a plastic impact between A and the trailer and the driver
keeps his brakes locked, how far d does the truck then move? Figure P.14.47.

14.48. Mass M,,, slides down the frictionless rod and hits mass
M,, which rests on a linear spring. The coefficient of restitution e
for the impact is .8.What is the total maximum deflection 6 of the
Figure P.14.45. spring?

67 I
Figure 1'.14.54.
*14.55. A neutrvn N is moving toward a stationary helium 14.57. Masses A and LI slide on a rod which is frictionless. The
nucleus He (atomic number 2) with kinetic energy I O MeV. If the spring is initially compressed from .8 m to the position shown.
collision is inelastic, causing a loss of 20% of the kinetic energy, The system is released from rest. A and LI undergo a plastic
what is the angle 0 after collision? See the first paragraph (only) impact. The spring is mdSskss.
of Prohlem 14.54. [Hinr: There is no need (if one is clever) to (a) What is the speed of the masses after B moves .2 m'!
have to convert the atomic number to kilograms.] (h) What is the loss in mechanical energy for the system?

I n

M x = 1 kg
i t 4 M .I m K = 1,000 N/m
Figure P.14.57.
Hefrm collision After collision
Figure P.14.55.
14.58. A ball is thrown against a floor at an angle of 6 0 ~with
a speed at impact of 16 m/sec. What is the angle of rebound a if
t = .7? Neglect friction.
14.56. Cylinders A and 6: are free to slide without friction along
a rod. Cylinder A is released from rest with spring K , to which it
is connected initially unstretched. The impact with cylinder B has
a coef'ficient of restitution E equal tu .X. Cylinder B is at rest
hefore the impact supported in the position shown by spring K2.
Assume springs are massless.
(a) How much is the lower spring cornpressed initially?
(h) How much does cylinder B descend after impact
before reaching its lowest position?
Figure P.14.58.

14.59. A ball strikes the xy plane of a handhall court at r =


3i + l j ft. The ball has initially a velocity V, = -IOi - l O j -
15k fricec. The ctiefficient of restitution is .8. Determine the final
velocity V, after it hounces off the xy, yz, and xz planes once.
Neglect gravity and friction.

K, = I.000 Nlm
K z = 11.000Nlm
t = .x
x
Figure P.14.56. Figure P.14.59.

673
14.60. A cpace vehiclc i n the shape of a cone ~ c y l i n d r ri s lilov- 14.63. C u n d c r a parallel heam of light having a n cnergy
ing at B \peed V mlcec, many times the spccd of sound thrvugh flux of S wilt ti in^^. shining nornial t o a Oat surface that c o n -
highly rarefied atmosphere. I f r a c h molecule of the pas has a mass plctely ahsorhr the cnergy. You leiirned in physics that an
m kg and if therc are. on thc average, n moleculcs per cubic meter. impulre d l is devclopcd on the suidacc during titne dl given hy
unmputz thc drag i m the cone-cylinder. Thc cone half-angle i b the formula
3V. Take the collision to he perrcctly ~ l i i i t i c .

where < IS the rpacd of light in V ~ C U Oi n mdsec. If the surfacc


retlecti the light, then we have an impulse ill developed on the
~ r f i u t given
. as

Compute the fcirce uteinming tiom the rellection of light


Figure P.14.60. \hinine n ~ r r n a l10 il perfectly retlecting mirror having an area of
I tm2, The light has an cnergy flux S 01 20 W i d Take the apeed
(' = 3 x IOx mlsec. Whet is the iililiation prrsbnre ,,ad on the
14.61. 110 Problem 14.00 lor a cake wheic the cnllisiiins arc mirror'!
assumed tu be inelastic. Assumr the cocfficieiii of restitution 10 be .E.

14.62. A double-wedge ikiifoil rection for a space g k h i s


s h o w n If the glidcr riiove~in highly rarcfield atmosphere at il
speed V many t i m s grrater than the hpccd d r o u n d . what is thr
drag per unit length o f t h i s airfoil? Asiunie thc ciillision to he pcr- *14.64. Thc Echo satellite when put inlo orhit is inllated trr a
l c t l y elastic. There are ,I niolecuIes pcr It'. each having IIn ~ a ' i hti, 4S-iii-diamctcr hphcre having a skiti nude up of a Imindte u l
in slugs. aluiniiium ovcr mylar ovci alutnioum. .This \kin is highly reflec-
taiit of light. Bccause of the m a l l mass 111 this satellite. i t may
he nt~lectcdhy s m a l l forces such as that vternming firm tht: rellec-
lion of light. If a parallel h a i n of light having an energy drnrity
S of .SO Wlmm' impinges on the Echo satdlite. what total firer
i \ dcvclq,cd on the hatrllite from this soul-CC?Fmm physics
(hcc Pnrhlcm 14.63). thc radiation pressure, /,r,,cr on a reflecting

t rurtice frolr a hcain ollight inrlincd hy 8' from the iwrnial to the
surlxe i\
4- 2
V
i

Figure P.14.62.

614
SECTION 14.6 MOMENT~OF-MOMENTUMEQUATION FOR A SINGLE PARTICLE 615

Path of particle
z 3

Inertial reference
X
Figure 14.24. Point a fixed in inertial space

If this point ti is positioned at a fixed location in XYZ, we can simplify the


right side of Eq. 14.16. Accordingly, examine the expression (d/dt)(p= X P):

%p,
dr x P ) = p" x P+&' x P (14.17)

But the expression p, x P can he written as p , x m i . The vectors p,, and I


are measured in the same reference from a fixed point a to the panicle and
676 CHAPTER 14 METHODS OF M O M I N I U M FOR PARTICLFS

lrom the origin to the particle. respectively (sce Fig. 14.25). They are thus
different at all tinies to the extent o f a constilnt vector&. Note that

r = GI + p,,

Figure 14.25. Pocitim vector5 111 ni and ii

'Therefore.
r = b,,
Accordingly. the expression fi', X m i is zcro. Thus. Ey. 14.11 becomes

and Eq. 14.16 ciiii he Nritteii in the form

Therelcxc

where M. is the torque 01 the total external fiirce about the z axis ;ind H: is the
moment of the rnoiiieiitiiin (or ;rngular moincntuni) ahout the .: axis.
SECTION 14 6 MOMENT-OF~MOMENTUMEQUATION FOR A S1NC;I.E PARTICLE 677

Example 14.14
A boat containing a man is moving near a dock (see Fig. 14.26). He throws out
a light line and lassos a piling on the dock at A. He starts drawing in on the line
so that when he is in the position shown in the diagram, the line is taut and has
a length of 25 ft. His speed V, is 5 ft/sec in a direction normal to the line. If the
net horizontal force F on the boat from tension in the line and from water
resistance is maintained at 50 Ib essentially in the direction of the line, what is
the component of his velocity toward piling A (i.e., 4) after the man has
pulled in 3 ft of line? The boat and the man have a combined weight of 350 Ih.
We may consider the boat and man as a particle for which we can
apply the moment of momentum equation. Thus,
MA = H;, (a)
Figure 14.26. Man pulls toward piling
Clearly, here MA = 0 since F goes through A at all times. Thus. HA is a
constant-that is, the angular monientum about A must be constant.
Observing Fig. 14.27, we can say accordingly

r , X mV, = r2 X mV2
Since rl is perpendicular to V, and r2 is perpendicular to (V,),,we get a
simple scalar product from above. Thus
(25l(m)(5) = (22l(ml(V,),
Therefore,
(V,), = 5.68 ft/sec (bl
We need more information to get the desired result V, toward the
piling. We have not yet used the fact that F = 50 Ib. Accordingly, we now
employ the work-kinetic energy equation from Chapter 13. Thus,
j: F * dr = ( ; M y 2 ) ’ - (k MV2)
I
y
Figure 14.27. Boa1 a l po\itions I and 2.
1350 I350
( 5 0 ) ( 3 )= - - ( V , ) ’ ---(25)
2 8 2 8
Therefore,
V, = 7.25 Wsec (cl
Now V, is the total velocity of the boat at position 2. To get the desired
component % toward the piling, we can say, using Eqs. (b) and (c):
v: = (VJ? + v;
(7.25)’ = (5.68)’ + V i
Therefore,
678 CHAPTER I 4 MCTHOlX OF LIOMENTIIM I'OR PhKIICl.ES

14.7 More on Space Mechanics


M a n y problems o i cpacc mechanics can be ~(rlvedby using energy and angii-
Iar-momentuni method\ of thi5 and thc preceding chapter without considering
the detailed trajectory equations ol' Chapter 12. I.et Lis thereliire set forth
s o m e d i e n t Factors concerning the motion of a space vehicle moving in the
vicinity o i ii pl;inet or star with the cngine s h u t ~ i l i a n d with negligible I"-iction
from the outside."
After the .;pace veliicle hiis heen propelled ;it great spced by i t s r o c k t
engines ti1 a positiiiii oiitside the planel's atmiiqiherc (the final piiwered
vclocity i\ called the tmmoiif vcliicity), thc vehiclc then imdergiies plane.
gravitational. w i i t r u l : / i ) r w motioii (Section 12.6).If i t continue5 to go around
the planet. the vehicle i s said to go in10 orhi! and the trajcctiiry i s that of a cir-
cle or that of iiii ellipse. IF. on the other hand. the vehicle scapes frmn the
influence of thc plaiiet. then the tra,jectol-y will either bc :I parabola or a hyper-
bola. In the case 0 1 xi elliptic orhit. the pmilion closest 111 the curlicr o l the
planet i s called I w r i p c (see Fig. 14.2X) and the position Fartheqt friini the cur-
I c e of tlic plaiict i s called u/xi,qf'f'. Notice that iit apogcu and perigcc the
vclocity vectors V , and y, rilthc veliicle are parallel to the surface oi the planet
and s o at the% points (and m l y at thcsc points)

v 1 L' H , ", = 0

,-
I n thc case OF ii <,ircuIor orbit OF radius and relocity V..we ciin use New-
t m ' s law and the grwit;itional law to state

where M i c the mass of tlie planet and io i c the angular speed of the radius
vector ti1 the vehiclc. K e p l a c i q the acceleration lcrin NO' by V'irand solving
for y, we get

vc = l r
(14.20)

Knowing GM and r. we can readily ciimpute the spced L: for a particular


circular orhit. In Section 12.6 we showed that GM can he ea5ily computed
iisiiip (he r e l i i t i m

CM = gR2 ( 14.211
SECTION 14.7 MORE ON SPACE MECHANICS 619

where g is the acceleration of gravity at the surface of the planet and R is the
radius of the planet.
In gravitational central-force motion, only the conservative force of
gravity is involved, and so we must have conservation of mechanical energy.
Furthermore, since this force is directed to 0, the center of the planet, at all
times (see Fig. 14.28), then the moment about 0 of the gravitational force
must he zero. As a consequence, we must have conservation of angular
momentum about 0."

ee
x

Figure 14.28. Elliptic orbit with perigee and apogee

We shall illustrate in the next example the dual use of the conserva-
tion-of-angular-momentum principle and the conservation-of-mechanical-
energy principle for space mechanics problems. In the homework problems
you will he asked to solve again some of the space problems of Chapter 12
using the principles above without getting involved with the trajectory
equations. Such problems, you will then realize, are sometimes more easily
solved by using the two principles discussed above rather than by using the
trajectory equations.

"Those who have studied the Vajeclory equations of Chapter 12 mighl realize that
c= rva = CDnStant
is actually a statement of the conservation of angular momentum since mrV, is the moment ahout
0 of the linear momentum relative lo 0.
680 ('HAPTER 1-1 METIIOIX ni: MOM+.KTLIM rot?P.%KTI('I.I~S

Example 14.15
A space-shutlle vehicle 011 a iresciic ~iiissiiiii(hcc Fig, 14.29) i \ sell1 into a
circular orhil ;it ii distiincc of 1.200 kin above the earth'\ surface. Thih
orbit is inserted so as 10 be in the same plane as that of a spii i
i rocket engines will not start, thus preventing it from initiating a priicedure
T f(1r returning to earth. Thc goal of thc shuttle is to enter a ti-ajcctory that
will permit docking with the disahled spacecraft and then to rescue the
iiccupant\. The timing of insertion of the circtilar orhit of the space shuttle
h;is ho been chosen thal Ihc space shuttle by firing i l h rockets at rhe piisi-
j tion shown can. by thc proper change ot. speed. rcacli apiigec at the siiinl:
I time and sanie location a\ docs thc cripplcd \pace vehicle. At thih lime.
! docking proccdures caii he carried O U I . Considcring tlliit the rocket
engines o l the spau-\huttle vchicle iiperalc during ii w i : v shorl < l i s r m ~ ~ ,
of travclli to achieve the proper velocity V,, fiir the mission. determinc the
i change in speed that thc \pace chuttle intist achieve. The radiuh of the earth
j i \ 6,373 kni.
SECTION 14.7 M O RE ON SPACE MECHANICS 68 I

Example 14.15 (Continued)


We shall first compute GM. Thus, working with kilometers
and hours,

(6,373)2 = 5.16 x km’/hr2

The velocity for the circular orbit for the space shuttle is (hen

From conservation of angular momentum for the space-shuttle


rescue orbit we can say

mr,,c;, = m(rV).pop..
(7.573)(c;$ = (Io’ooo)(v)ap”gc~
Therefore,

c;, = 1.320v>p<>gee (b)

where V, is the speed of the space shuttle just afer firing rockets. Next, we
use the principle of conservation of mechanical energy for the rescue
orbit. Thus,

Substitute for yp,>gce


using Eq. (b) and solve for V,. We get

V,, = 27,861 k m h r

Hence, using Eq. (a), we can say:

AV = 27,861 - 26,105 = 1,756km/hr


14.65. A particle mfates at 30 radlscc along a frictionlcss sui- 14.69. A hody A weighing I O Ib is moving initially at a speed of
'ace at a distance 2 ft from the center. A tlcxihlc card restrains the V , n f 2 0 ftisec on ii frictionless surface. An elastic cordA0, which
iarticlc. If this cord is pulled so that the particle moves inward at ha\ a length / nf 20 ft. hccnmes taut hut not stretched at the posi-
I velocity of 5 ftlsec, what i s the magnitudt: of the total vzlncity tion shown in the diagram. What is the radial speed toward 0 of
when the panicle is I ft from the center'! the hody whcn the c r m l is strctched 2 ft? The cord has an cqui\,a-
leiit spring convtant of 3 Ihlin

"3
0

tsftiscc
Figure P.14.65.

14.66. satellite has an apogee of 7.12X k m I t i ? mov

;peed 36,4X(1
iatelliteofwhen I =kmlhr.
6,970 km'?
What is the transverse velocity of atthea __ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _ .~

14.67. A system is shown rotating lieely with an angular speed "I


JI ,if 2 rad/sec. A inass A of 1.5 kg is held against II spring such Figure P.14.6Y.
hat the spring is cmnpressed 100 mm. If thc devicc <iholding the
nass in position is suddenly rrmirved. determine how far taward 14,70, A hall Ih is n,tating a YertiCal
he vertical axis of the system the mass will move. 'The spring at a speed (u, nf The ball is hearings
:onstant K is ,531 Nlmm. Neglect all friction and inertia of the shaf, by light inextensible strings a length , o f ft.
u r . The spring is not connected to the m a s . ' l h c m g l c 8, is 30'. Wh:a is the angular speed o,of the hall if
hearing A is moved up 6 in:!

. .
so "In?

Figure Y.14.67.

14.68. Do Pmhlem 14.67 fix the case where therr is Coulombic


.riction
. hctwcen the mass A and the horimnral rod with a constant
I,, cqual to .4. Figure P.14.70.

i82
14.71. A mass m uf I kg is swinging freely about the I axis at a 14.73. A space vehicle is moving at a speed of 37,000 km/hr at
speed w , of O
I radlsec. The length I , of the string is 250 mm. If position A, which is perigee at a distance of 250 km from the
the tube A through which the connecting string passcs is moved earth's surface. What are the radial and transverse velocity com-
down a distance rl of 90 mm,what is w2 of the mass'? You should ponents as well as the distance from the eerth's surface at R? The
get a fourth-order equation for w2 which has as the desired root trajectory is in the xy plane.
w2 = 21.05 radlsec.
~V

Perigee

Figure P.14.73.
i
14.74. A space vehicle is in orbit A around the eanh. At position
Figure P.14.71. ( I ) it is 5,000 miles from the center of the earth and has a velocity
of20,000 milhr. The transvene velocity at ( I ) is 15,000 milhr. At
apogee, it is desired to continue in the circular arbit shown
dashed. What change in speed is needed to change orbits when
firing at apogee?
14.72. A small 2-lb ball B is rotating at angular speed w , of
10 radlsec about a horimntal shaft. The ball is connected 10 the
bearings with light elastic cords which when unstretched are each
12 in. in length. A force of 15 Ih is required to stretch the cord
I in. The distance d , between the bearings is originally 20 in. If
bearing A is moved to shorten d by 6 in., what is the angular
velocity w2 of the ball? Neglect the effects of gravity and the mass / \
I \
of the elastic <:or& [Hint;You should arrive at a transcendental I
equation for t17 whose solution is 54.49~.]

++ 4
Figure P.14.72. Figure P.14.74.

683
14.75. Dc Prohlem 12.75 using the principles ofconserwtion of
momentum and con\eiwiltim o f mcchanical cnerpy. R = 6,373 km
<I~ I,200 km
L.; 5,000 kmlhr
1

14.76. 111 Prrrhlcm 12.Xh iind thc radial velocity hy using the
method of wnservatim of angol;il- nimnenlum and mechanical
energy.

Figure F.14.82.
14.77. Do Prohlem 12.82 hy the method 01 conrervatiiin id
angular mnmentuni and mechanical energy.

14.83. A space vzhiclr i s i n a circular parking orhit 300 mile\


ahovc thc w r t a c r ,if the earth IIthe vehicle i c tu reach an aniierr
. L

In Prohlrm 12.87, find the height of the hulk1 above the


at locatinti 2 uhich i q 5 0 0 nilc.; a h w r the earth's suriace. what
14.78.
increaw in velocity mu\1 the vehicle attain hy firing Its rockets f i x
surfnce of the hy the c,fcilnscrvati,m
ii \hart timc at Incation I'! The radiw n l the earth i s 3.'9hO miles.
momentum and mechanical energy.

14.79. In Problem 12.1 19, find thc maximum e l w a t i m ahove


the canh's surface hy the methods n l cunscwation rrf angular 0
mmnentuin and mcchanical rncrgy.

14.80. 110 Prohlem 12.1 14 hy m e t h d s ( 1 1 unnserwlinii of an- 3 1 0 miles


p l a r mnrnentuin a n d mechanical energy. [Hint: The ercape
= ,?_(:MI, = ,, 2 1: .I

I
14.81. Do Prohlrm 12.1 13 using the principles of conservation
encrgy.
of angular inmientuni and mechanical

14.82. A \pace vchiclc i c i n a circular orhit 1.200 km a h w e 14.84. A cp;ioc stiltion i c i n it circular parking mhit iiruund
the suifacc 0 1 rhr earth. A prnjcctiic is \hot liar thi'i space v c h - the earth ;at a tli'itancc 0 1 5.000 mi from thc crntri. A pl-nicctilr
cle at a specd relative t o the vchiclc of 5.000 kmlhr i n 21 radial ih fired ahead in t i dircctiim taugunrial to the tra,jactnry of thc

direction a \ secn from the vehicle. What are the q q q nd the upace tii it inti with ii \peed of 5.000 milhr relative tn the space
distances from the cenier or the earth lnr the trajector? of statioii. W h a t i \ the miixiniuin distance frnm earth reached hy
rhc prnjectilc'? the pn>,jcctilc'!
14.85. A skylab is in a circular orhit about the earth 500 km
above the earth’s surface. A space-shuttle vehicle has ren-
dezvoused with the skylah and now, after disengaging from
the skylab, its rocket engines are fired so as to move the vehi-
cle with a speed of 800 mlsec relative l o the skylab in the
opposite direction to that of the skylab. Assume that the firing
of the rocket takes place over a short distance and does not
affect the skylab. What speed would the space-shuttle vehicle A
have when it encounters appreciable atmosphere at ahout 5 0
km above the earth’s surface? What is the radial velocity at
this position?

I
,,
/

, ,/
,
-_/’
Figure P.14.86.

14.87. In Problem 14.86, a midcourse correction is to be made


to get the probe within 1,000 mi from the surface of Mars. I f V, at
ro = 50,Wll mi is still to be 10,000 milhr, what should be the
radial velocity component (v);!
14.88. The Apollo command module is in a circular parking
orbit about the moon at a distance of 161.0 km above the sur-
face of the moon. The lunar exploratory module is to detach
from the command module. The lunar-module rockets are fired
briefly to give a velocity V , relative to the command module in
the opposite direction. If the lunar module is l o have a trans-
verse velocity of 1,500 miiec when it is 80 km from the surface
Figure P.14.85. of the moon before rockets are fired again, what must V, be?
What is the radial velocity at this position? The radius of the
moon is 1,733 km. and the acceleration of gravity is 1.700
misec’ at the surface.

14.86. A space probe is approaching Mars. When the probe


is 50,000 mi from the center of Mars it has a speed V, nf
10,000 milhr with a component (V,), toward the center of Mars
of 9,800 milhr. How close does the probe come to the surface
of Mars’? If retro-rockets are fired at this lowest position A ,
what change i n speed is needed to alter the trajectory into a
circular orbit as shown? The acceleration of gravity at the sur-
face of Mars is 12.40 ft/sec2, and the radius R of the planet is
2,107 mi. Figure P.14.88.

685
685 < IIAf’I tR I4 MTTHODS O r MO”VlrNT11M IO K P A R I I C Lt 5

14.8 MOment-Of-MOmentUm Equations


I
for a System of Particles
m
0
We shall now develop the n i i ~ ~ i i c n t ~ ~ i l ~ t n ~ icquetion\
~ i i c n l i ~ for
~ n an aggrcgatc
(if particlcs. The rcwltiiig cquatiiins w i l l hc of vital imporkincc when we
apply then1 to rigid hodies in later chapters. We shall consider ii number
0 of cases.

0
’ Case 1. Fixed Reference Point in Inertial Space. An aggregate of n par-
ticles a n d a n incrtiiil rclercnce are shown in Fig. 14.30. The moiiictit
o l tnonicnluni cquetiiin for the ith particle i\ now written about the origin of
X thih rcfcrcncc:
Figure 14.30. Systcrn of ii particles. i 1

i where. a\ uwal.J, i s the internal force froni ttic.jth particle on the ith particle.
We now sum (hi\ equation for all n particles:

,,
+ cc(r,
/I

,=I ,=I
X .f;!I = $ [ g ( r , XI‘,)] = k,,,k,l(14.23)

Y where the suninlation operation hxs heen put after the dillcrcntiation on
the right side (perniishible because of the distrihutive property of difreren-
X tiation with respect to addition). For any pair of particles. the intcrn;tl
Figure 14.31. Inlernal equal and forces w i l l hc equal and oppiisitc mil collinear (see Fig. 14.31). Hence,
nppmitc forces. the forces w i l l have a ~ c r oiiioincnt ahiiut the origin. (This result i s most
easily understood by reinemhering that, for purposes of taking moments
ahout a point. forces w e tmn\mi\\iblc.) W e can Ihcn conclude that the
expi-ession

in Ciis equation i s x I o . Rcaliritif l l i i i t c r , x I ; i s the tiital tiiorneiil of the


exlemal forces ahout the origin, we have iis ii 1-esult fiir Eq. 14.23:

Ma = H a (14.24)
SECTION 14.8 MOMENT-OF-MOMENTUM EQUATIONS FOR A SYSTEM OF PARTICLES 687

where this moment is taken about the aforementioned point a.I4

point can he given as the angular momentum of the center of

ri = rc + pcj (14.25)

X 0
Figure 14.32. c is center of mass of aggregate

The ar ir momentum for the aggregate of particles about 0 is then

Carry .he cross product and extract r‘ from the summations:

4 1 =

But si] I is the center of mass, it follows that

Id u could also be moving with a constant velocity y , relative to inertial reference


XYZ. H
m er, a would then be fined in another inertial reference X’Y’Z’, which is translating
with res to XYZ at a speed Yr
Going hack to Eq. 14.27, we that the second and third expressions o n the
righr %ideare t~ he delered and we get then the desired result lor H , ) :

H,, = r, x ~ r +El?,
; x I I I , ~ ,= r, x M?, + H,

where H i\ the inomeiit ;ihour the center of i n i i c s n i the linear tnoineiituni as


seen from the center iif ]miss for the aggregate." 'l'his n a y he rewritten and
cxprccced for (itty lixcd point (i whcrc, u\ing (,, a\ tlic positiiin vectni from
f i x e d point (1 t o the center of tiiiiss c', we have

I I , , = I I , + ',, x Mi,,, (14.2)


Thus, i n ii rniiiiiier analogcius to thc c a w 01kinetic enerfy (see Section 13.7).
the rnoinciit iif riioiiiciiluin ahiiut point ti is llic \uin (if the imiiiiciit (if iiionieii-
tuin rcliiti\'c to the cciitcr o l r i i i i s i plus ihc iiioniciit o i inoiiicntum o i the cc11-
ter of inash ahiiut point ( I . Note tha1 i s the \'elocity (if ( ' reliitive rn fixed
point <I and i s thus c q u i t o the d o c i V o i the n m s center ~-eliiti\'cti1 XYZ.
Thus. we ciin express k l l . (14.2Xl a s

Furthermore. we have fiir l t , :


H,, = H, + r,< x MI;:
whcre wc hiivc u\cd thc tact that r,,( = V to delete one expression Note in
efiect wc h a c put d w ovci-H,, H , and V in Eq ( 14.3) to reach to iihove equa-
tiim. We may now reet:ite E q 14.24 fni- ( i . f i . i d p , ~ i t i ~i
r ils iulliiws o n replacing
I f , uhiiig the iihove equation. Then. uhing a, lir V wc have the desired rcsult:

M, = Hc + <,c X Ma, ( 14.30)

Case 2. Reference Point at the Center of Mass. We ciin use Eq. 14.30 for
thih purpose. I'int. we will replace M,, usins the left side of Eq. 14.23. BUI i n
s o doing. we w i l l rephce 5 iii the fii-st expression hy (< + tic,). Note next thiit
Eq. 14.30 calls fix stationary point (1. Wc w i l l want to he the origin 0 o i
XYZ arid si) {,, hecoiiici 'itiiply 5 . l:iiiiilly. \+e replace a, hy i;' i n liq. 14.30
;ind w e have altcr thc\c steps

The internal force\ 'f'.I f i w LCIO contrihutiiin in this cqiiatiiin a s explained

earlier and we Ihii\,c on i-c;irranging the remaining ternis i n thc cqu;itim


~ SECTION 14.8 MOMENT-OF-MOMENTUM EQUATIONS FOR A SYSTEM OF PARTICLES 689

wton's law for the center of mass, we know that F, = Mi, and so
on the left and right sides of the equation above cancel. The
on the left side of the equation is the moment about the
external forces. We then get

M, = Hc (14.31)

the same formulation for the center of mass as for a fixed point
Please note that H,. is the moment about the center of mass
of niass but that the time

Toward or Away from the Mass Center. There


to he considered and that is a point a acceler-
mass center of the aggregate (Fig. 14.33).

0 0

i
Figure 14.33. Point ii accelerates toward or away from c

For such a point, we can again give the same simple equation presented for
cases I a d 2. Thus,

1
M a = H" (14.32)

where is taken relative to point u (i.e., relative to axes xyz translating


with poi t u ) . Wc have asked for the derivation of this equation in Prob-
lem 14.9
Th component of the equation M,, = Hu for any one of the three cases
in say th x direction,
I hf, = H c
ry useful. Here, M,, is the torque about the x axis, and Hr is the
f momentum (angular momenturn) about the x axis. We now exam-
problem in the following example.
690 CHAF'TEK 14 METHODS OF MOMENTIJM FOR PARlICLES

Example 14.16
A heavy chain of length 20 ft lies on a light plate A which is freely rotating
at ;in angular specd of I r a d k c (see Fig. 14.34). A channel C acts as a
guide lor the chain on the plate, and a stationary pipc acts as a guide for thc
chain helow the plate. What is the speed of the chain after it moves 5 fr .stan-
ing froin rest relative to the platform'? Neglect friction. thc angular mornen-
tum of the platc, and the angular momentum of the vertical section of the
chain ahout its own axis. The chain weight per unit length, n', is I O IhMi.
We \hall first apply the moment-of-momentum equation about
paint 11 f(ir the chain and plate. Taking the component of this equation
a l m g the I axis. we can say:
M; =
Clearly M: = 0. and so we havc conservation of angular momentum.
That is,

(h) Fieure 14.34. Sliding chain

whcre I and 2 refer to the initial condition and the condition after the chain
moves 5 ft. We can then say:

Therefore,
wr = 8 radsec (cl
To find the speed iir iiiovemerit of the chain, we musr next gii 10
energy considcrations. Because only conservative forces are acting here,
we may employ the conservation-of-mechanical-energy principle. In so
doing. we shall use as a datum the end of the chain R at the initial condi-
tion (see Fig. 14.34). We can then say:
(PE), = (IO)(W,)(IOJ + (in)(w)(s) = i.snnSt-lh
Observing Fig. 14.35. wc can say for condition 2:
(PE), = (S)(M.)(IO) + (IO)(w,)(5) ~ (S)(w)(2.5)
= 875 ft-lb

As for kinetic energy. we have


I
SECTION 14.8 MOMENT-OF-MOMENTUM EQUATIONS FOR A SYSTEM OF PARTICLES 691

Exa ple 14.16 (Continued)


wher the first two expressions on the right side give the kinetic energy
from the motion relative to the channel and pipe, respectively. The lasl
expr ssion is the kinetic energy due to rotation of that part of the chain that
is i n he channel. Clearly, V&rl = V . = 0 initially, and so we have
w e
I (KE), = +(lJ2[Y)j i " r Z d r = 51.Xft-lb

Furthbrmore, at condition 2, we have (see Fig. 14.35)

Notelhat (yhannr,)2
= ( V . ) Simply calling this quantity V2, we have
P W 2'

i =3.11V:+414 Datum

1 :
We c n now state
I i

i
WE), + WE), = (PW, + WE), Figure 14.35. Chain after motion of 5 ft.
1,500 + 51.8 = 875 + (3.11 V; + 414)
Ther fore,
v* i
: 9.19

a speed of 9.19 ft/sec along


that the plate A is rotating al

i
M ch time will he spent later in the text in applying Ma = fie to a rigid
body. T ere, the rigid body is considered to he made up of an infinite number
of conti uous elements. Summations then give way to integration, and so on.
The fin equations of this section accordingly are among the most important
in mech nics.
In the homework assignments, we have included, as in Chapter 13,
several ery simple rigid-body problems to illustrate the use of the equation
M, = and to give an early introduction to rigid-body mechanics.'h We
now illu trate such a problem.

instructor may wish not to get into rigid-body dynamics at this time. T h i s approach
692 CHAPTER 14 METHODS OT'MOMENTI'M FOR PARTICLES

Example 14.17
A uniform cylinder of radius 400 mm and mass 100 kg is acted on a1 its
center by a force of SO0 N (hee Fig. 14.36).What is the (tiction force.f?
Takefi> = .2.

/
z
Figure 14.36. Rolling cylinder.
We have shown a free-hody diagram of the cylinder in Fig. 14.37. A
reference xy: with origin al C translates with the center 0 1 mass. We first
apply Newton's law relative t o iiiertial reference XYZ.17 Thus. for the X
direction we have for the center of mass C:

N
Figure 14.37. Free hody
Next, we write the moment-of-momentum cquation about the :axis,
which goes through the wnrr,,- of mass. Thus, noting that we have simple
circular motion relative to the ? a x i \ for a11 narticles of thc cvlinder and
I SECTION 14.8 MOMENT-OF-MOMENTUM EQUATIONS FOR A SYSTEM OF PARTICLES 693
ple 14.17 (Continued)
the cylinder and I is the thickness of the
and differentiating with respect to time as

.40.f = - ( p l ) ( 2 z ) ( h ) [ q ]
f = -.I 005(p/)d

M = 100 = ( p I ) [ ~ ( . 4 0 ) ~ ]
pl = 198.9kg/m2 (C)

1
Ther fore,
(.40)0 = -x

I (.40)W = - X

Subs ituting for pI and r3 in Eq. (b) using Eqs. (c) and (d), we get

,f = (-.1005)(198.9)
[
-~
.fO)

Now solve for X from Eq. (a) and substitute into Eq. (e):

f = ( . 1 0 0 5 ) ( 1 9 58 -
. 9. O) (l f7' )

I
Solvi g for j,we get
f = 166.6N

We must now check to see whether our no-slipping assumption i s


valid The maximum possible friction force clearly is
fmax = (100)(9.81)(.2) = 196.2 N

6
whic is greater than the actual friction force, so that the no-slip assump-
tion i consistent with our results.
694 CHAPTER 14 METHODS 0 1 ' MOMENTUM FOR PAKTICLES

"14.9 looking Ahead-


Basic Laws of Continua
In the preceding tlircc chapters, we have presented three alternate ;Ipplo;lches.
They were. broadly speaking:

1. Direct applic;ition of N e w l ~ i n ' slaw.


2. Energy mcth(ids.
3. I.inear-momcntuin methods and moiiient~of-miiiiicntumimettiod~

Thesc all conic from a c o n m o i l source (i.e.. Newton'\ law) iind si1 w e can u\e
any one for particle imtl rigid-body pnihlcms.
Later, when you study more cmiiplcx cunlinua such a s a tl(iwing iluid
wilh heat transfer and compression you w i l l have Lo salisfy four hasic laws.
Thcsc hasic laws are:

1. Coiiservati(in 111 mass.


2. Linear momcntum and moment 01 momentum (Ihese are now Newton's
law).
3. First law of Lhermodyiiamics.
4. Second law of thermodynamics.

For more general ciintinua. the above nientimicd fmir hasic laws" ire itid?-
p n i l r . , ~of each other (i.e., they must he separ;itely catisfied) whereas in par-
t i c k and rigid-body mechanics that wc have bccn studying. 2 and 3 directly
ahove. are cquivalenr to each other; I i s satisfied by simply keeping the ma\\
M constant: and 4 i s satisfied by making sure that friction impede\ the rela-
tive motion hctwccn two bodies i n contact.
Funhermore, we applied the approaches of the preceding thrcc chapters
to free bodies, For more general continuuni studies. such iis lluid Ilou'. we
can apply thc I.riur hasic law\ to systems (i.c., frcc bodies) and also to so-
called coiitrol volumes (fixed voIumes i n space) as discussed i n the I.ooking
Ahead Section 5.4.
, e are conqidering a very simplc phzisc [if coii-
Thus. in this b ~ i o k w
tinuuni mechanics whcrehy. in effect. we need only consider explicitly
one of the basic laws. Your view w i l l hriiaden a s you move thriiogh thc
curriculum
In some mechanics hooks there i s presented a n elementary preseimtion
lor determining the force develiiped by ii stream of wiitcr or orher fluid on a
SECTION 14.9 LOOKING AHEAD BASIC LAWS OF CONTINUA 695

ng a similar approach, the other basic laws are developed in the

r the conservation of mass, we equate the net efflux rate of mass

author believes these laws in the above form should be taken up

f the basic laws needed in fluid mechanicsl9 and

IYSek I.H. Shames. Mechanics ofF/uid.r,McGraw-Hill. 3rd ed., 1992, Chapters 5 and 6 .
4.89. A system u r particles i \ shown at time t moving in thc ,r!
I n,
#lane.Thc following datir apply:

m , = I Lg. V, = Si + Sj mlscc
m2 = 0.7 Lg. V, = -4i + 3,j mlscc
,>I,= 2 kg. V, = - 4 j mlscc
rnd = I .S hg. V, = 3i 4 j mlsec
~

(a) What i \ thc total linear momentum of the \ystem'!


(h) What i s Ihc linear momentum ofthe ccntcr OS m a s s ?
(c) What i s the total inirrnent of mmlentum of the
svstem about the origin i i n d ahout point ( 2 , 6)'!

Figure P.14.90.

14.91. A system 01 particles :it t i m e f , ha'i ~masscsV I , = 2 Ihm.


I I Z ~= I Ihm. in, = 3 lhm and location< and vdocitic\ a\ shown
i n ( a ) . The cnmc system of musscs 15 \houri i n (h) a1 lime I,.What
i q the total linear impulse o n the sysrcm durinp thib time intenal'!
VIq
(- 2.2
1
What is the total angular impulse M d i during thih timc i n t r n a l
ahwl thc origin'?

\ "4

Figure P.14.89.

14.90. A \ystem of particles at time f has the following veloci-


.ies and masse\:

V, = 20 fVsec, m , = I lhm
V, = I X ftlsrc. mz = 3 Ihm
V, = I S ftlscc. m , = 2 Ihm
v, = 5 ftlsec. = I Ihm xftkc
Determine (a) the total linear momentum of the bystctn, (hJ the
mgular mtrmentum rrf the systcnl ahout the wigin, and IC)
the angu-
lar momcntum nf the systrm ahout point (1.

s90
14.93. A mechanical system is composed of three identical bod
ies A , B, and C each of mass 3 Ibm moving along frictionless rod
1 2 0 ~apart on a wheel. Each of these bodies is connected with ai
inextensihle cord ti) the freely hanging weight D. The connectioi
of the cords to L) is such that no torque can be transmitted to D
Initially, the three masses A , B , and Care held at a distance of 2 f
from the centerline while the wheel rotates at 3 radlsec. What ii
the angular speed of the wheel and the velocity of descent of I
if, after release of the radial bodies, body D moves I ft? Assumi
that body D is initially stationary &e., is not rotating). Body L
weighs 100 Ib.

45".
-1

m. I
n
Figure P.14.93.

(b) Time f2 14.94. Two sets of particles a , b, and L', d (each particle of mass
m) are moving along two shafts AB and CD, which are, in turn
Figure P.14.91-b. rigidly attached to a crossbar EF. All particles are moving at a
constant speed V, away from EF, and their positions at the
14.92. YO masses slide alvng bar AB at a constant speed 01 moment of interest are as shown. The system is rotating about G,
I .5 "11. Bar AB rotates freely about axis CD. Consider only the and a constant torque of magnitude Tis acting in the plane of the
mass (I : sliding bodies to determine the angular acceleriltion 01 system. Assume that all masses other than the concentrated
AB whs l e hodies are 1.5 m from CU if the angular velocity 81 masses are negligible and that the angular velocity of the system
that ins is I O radliec. at the instant of discussion is w. Determine the instantaneous
angular acceleration in terms of m, T, w,9,.and s2.
C

D
Figure P.14.92.
w
Figure P.14.94.

697
14.95. A uniform rod with a makc of 7 kglm lies flat on a fiic- 14.97. A unifbrm cylinder of cadius I 111 r d l s without dipping
tionless surface. A fhrce of 250 N act? on the rod as shown in down a 30" incline. What i s tllc angular acccleriltion of thc cylin-
the diagram. What i s the angiilar accclcralion o f the rod'! What is der i f i t has ii ~nlilss01SO kp''
thc acceleration o f t h c m

Figure P.14.97.

14.98. A cylinder of lungth i m a i d r n 5 kg i q acted o n by a


torque T = ( I 1.251 + ? I t ' ) N - m iwhcre I i s in seconds) about its
gcomrtric %xi\. What i s the anpular speed aftcr 10 SCC? The cylin-
der i\ ill irc\t uhcn the torqur ih ;appllcd.

Figure P.14.95
_ X ~~ ~ ~
7~ 7
~~~~~~~~ ~ , ~

A
*14.96. Consider an aggregate of particles with C i l k thc mass ,- mm
centcr and m i n t A iiccelcratinz- toward o r :LW:IY f n m C'. Starl wlth
the expression for H ahout 0 given :IS I*-- 3 111
Figure P.14.98.
X P = xp,,,)x*l'
14.99. 4 conmiit torque 7 of 800 N-m is :ipplied tu il uniform
cyliiidcr 01mdiur 400 cmn and mass 50 kp. A 1.500-kN weight is
Formulate Mi, in term, of I; arid use Newton's law to rlirninatr
iiitached 10 thc cylindcr with ii liglil cable. What is the accclcration
terms. Next show from the vxiltinp equation that
UI W !

I M,, = € I ,
I

I 'x
Figure P.14.96.
14.101. A u m t i i n t t m p e Tu1 500 i w l h i \ applied til a uniform
cylinder of r;itliii\ I it. A light inrxtcnsihlr cable i\ urapped part])
connected to a block W
of W if the cable doe.s not
the hlock. For the cylin-

Figure P.14.103.
14.104. Do Problem 14.103 for the case where a force given as:
& = .1
F = S0i + 7SjN
Figure P.14.101.
is applied at point u instead of the 500-N force.
14.102 canal with a rectangular cross section is shown having
14.105. A cylinder weighing 50 Ib lies on a frictionless surface.
a widtt " and a depth Of ". The Of water is Two forces are applied simultaneously as shown in the diagram.
assume be zero at the banks and 10 V Z Y Parabolically over the What is the angular acceleration of the cylinder'? What is the
section iown in the diagram. If 6 i s the radial distance from the of the center?
center1 f the channel, the transverse velocity Vs is given as
V, = $225 ~ a*) ft/sec
What i angular momentum Ha about 0 at any time f of the
water i circular portion of the canal (Le., between the x and y
axes)? radial component v i s zero.
Y

i
i
(
Figure P.14.105.
14.106. A thin uniform hoop rolls without slipping down a 3V
incline. The hoop material weighs 5 Ib/ft and has a radius R of
4 ft. What is the angular acceleration of the hoop?

Figure P.14.102.

14.103 hoop with mass per unit length 6.5 kg/m lies flat on a
frictior surface. A 500-N force is suddenly applied. What is
the an$ acceleration of the hoop? What is the acceleration of
the ma; nter? Figure P.14.106.

699
700 CHAPTtK I 4 MFTHODS O b M O M t N T U M FOR PAKTICLtb

14.10 Closure
One o l t h e topics studied i n this chapler i s the impact of bodies under certiaiia
restricted conditions. For such problems, we can consider the bodies as parti-
cles before and after impact, but during impact tlic bodies act as deformahlc
media for which a particlc model i s n o t meaningful or sufficient. By making
an clcmcntnry piclure of the action. we introduce the coefficient of restitutiun
to yield additional infiirmation we need tii determine velocities after impact.
This i s an empirical approach. s o our analyses are limited to simple prohlems.
T u handle more complex prohlems or to do the siinplc ones more precisely.
we would have ti1 makc a more rational invcstigation o f the deformatioii
actions taking place during impst- that is. i a continuum approach (11 part 111
thc problem would he rcquircd. However, we cannut makc a careful rtudy 01
the deformation aspects i n this text since the suhject 111 h i g h p e e d defornaa-
tion of solids i s ii difficult one that i s s t i l l under careful study by engineers
and physicists.
Note in the last two chapterr we started with Newton‘s law F = Mu
and pcrformed the fiillowing operations:

1. ‘Took tlic dot pruduct of hotti sides using piisilion vcclur r .


2. Multiplied both sides by ilr and integr:iicd.
3. Took thc cross product of both sidcs using position Yector r .
These steps permitted a surprisingly large number of very useful t?irmulaliiins
and concepts that have occupied us for some considerable time. These wcrc
thc energy methods. the lincar-momentum methods. and the moment-of-
niomentuiii methods. It should now be clear that Newton’s law requires coti-
siderable study tu fully explore i t s use.
In our study o f moment of tiiwneiiturn fur a system o f particles. we set
foith one o f the kcy equations nf inechanics, M,, = HA. and we inlroduced i n
the examples several considerations whose mure cai-eful and complete study
w i l l occupy a good purtiim o f the remainder of the tcxt. Thus, i n Example
14.17 we have “in miniature.” as i t were. the major cleinents involved i n the
rludy of much of rigid-body dynamics. Recall khat “c employed Newton’i
law for the mass center and thc n i ~ i n i e n t ~ o f ~ i r ~ o i n eequation
r ~ t u ~ i ~ about the
mass center to reach the desired rcsults. In 50 doing. however. we had to
make use of certain elementary kinematical idcas from our carlicr work i n
physics. Accordingly. ti1 prepare ourselvcs fur rigid-body dynamics in Chap
ters I 6 and 17. we shall dcvote ourselves in Chapter I S to a rather ciareful
examination o f the general kinematics of a rigid body.
Although we shall he much conccrned i n Chapter 15 with the kinemat-
ics of rigid budies. we shall nut cczse to consider particles. You will see that
an understanding of rigid-body kinematics w i l l pcrmit us 10 formulate very
powerful rclatiuiis for the gcncral relative motions o f ;I particle involving
references that niuve i n any arbitrary manner with respect to each other.
x

Figure P.14.109.

14.110. A space ship is in a circular parking orbit around the


1 Figure P.14.107. earth at 200 miles above the earth's surface. At space headquar-
ters, they wish to get the vehicle to a position 10,ooO miles from the
center of the earth with a velucity at this position of 25,000 miihr.
= (100 + 5 0 ~ 'Ib
) The command is given to fire rockets directly to the rear for a
"; = 30 Ib, W, = 60 Ib, and W, = 50 Ib, what is the specified shon time interval. What is the change in speed needed
force'? The dynamic for this maneuver? What are the radial and tangential velocity
components of the 25,000 mi/hr velocity vector?

,, .,
Figure P.14.108. I
,
i
f
I
I
\
\
\

. - _
,
_ /

200 km'! Figure P.14.110.

70 1
14.111. A small clastic ball is dropped from a height o f 5 m onto strikes 1.5 rn above the .r axib and if the c o l l i i i m is pe~ltcllyela\-
a rigid cylindrical body having a radius of 1.5 111.At what position tic, what i \ the maximum height rcached hy the bullet as It iico-
on thex axis does the hall land after the cullision with thc cylinder? chets'! Nrglcct air rmihtanoc and rake thc belocity 01 the hullct on
impact as 700 m/scc with a dircctiw thdt I S p ~ r a l l etlo the I axis.
1.
v

I Figure P.14.115
5m

I 14.116. I n Plohleni 14.1 15. ilsbunic an inela'tic impact with


t = .h. A t what position along ,x does the bullet strike the p a r a h h
after the irnpxr'?

14.117. A >pace \rehick is in a circular "parking" orhit ( I


aruund the earth 200 k m above the earth's hurfacr. I t i \ lo lransfrr
x
t u another circular orbit (2) 500 k m ahow the earth's surface. The
Figure P.14.111. transfer t o the second orhit i s dune in two stage,.

I 14.112. Do Problem 14.1 I I for an inelastic impact with t = .h. 1. Fire rucheth so the vehicle has an upoper cquill tu the r d i u 0 1
the sccond circular urhit. Whal uhangc of speed i\ required l o i ~
14.113. A small elastic sphere i s dropped fiom pusitiun (2, 3, this
- a radiub of 5 ft positiuned
30) f t onto a hard soherical body havine
so that the I axis of the reference shown i s along a diameter. Far a 2. At u ~ i o p wrockets are (ired again t i l get
into the second circu-
perfectly elastic collision, give the speed of the s m d 1 sphere lar orhit. Whal i s thi\ srcund change of hpced?
directly after impact.
500 k m ,, ~- .
.~.
~~

0
I
\,',_---.-
.,.
- \

1
I
I
I
I
I
I

200km- ~.
- ~~ ~ ~~
,
,

Figure P.14.117.

*14.118. A tugbwdt weighing 100 tuns is moving toward a statiuii-


ay buge weighing 200 tom and c u y i n g a load C wcighing 50 ton&.
/ The tug ib moving at 5 knots and its propellers arc devcloping a thrust
of 5,000 Ib when it cwlacts the huge. Ai a result of thc soft padding
Figure P.14.113.
at the nose of the tug. consider that there i s plastic impact. If the load
14.114, D~ problem 14,113 for an inelasticimpact with = ,6, C I S not tied in any way to the huge and has B dynamic coefticient of
friction o f . I with the slippery deck of the harge, what i\ the sped V
14.115. A bullet hits a smooth, hard, massive two-dimensional of the barge 2 sec after the tug first contacts the barge'! 'The load C
body whose boundary has been shown as a parabola. If ihe bullet slips during a I-see internal starting at the beginning ofthe contact.
3i + 1j mlsec. After impingement three droplets are formed mov-

x i ing parallel to the ry plane. We have the following information:


D , = .6 mm,
D, = 1.2 mm,
V, = 2 d s e c ,
V, = I mlsec,
8, = 45’
0, = 3W
Find D,, V,, and 8,.

I Figure P.14.118.

3 mlsec
7 1 m/sec

(a) (b)
Figure P.14.121.

14.122. If the coefficient of restitution is .8 for the two spheres,


what are the maximum angles from the vertical that the spheres
will reach after the first impact? Neglect the mass of the cables.

I Figure P.14.119.
14.120. A body A weighing 2 tons is allowed to slide down an
incline o a barge as shown. Body A moves a distance of 25 ft
along the incline before it is stopped at E . If we neglect water
resistanc how far does the baree shift in the horizontal direction?
2.5 kg
Figure P.14.122.

123. Thin discs A and B slide along a :tior s surface.


Each disc has a radius of 25 mm. Disc ~A has a mass of 85 g,
whereas disc B has a mass of 227 g. What are the speeds of the
discs after collision for c = .7? Assume that the discs slide on a

1
frictionless surface.
\/ 25’ -4 I . , . ,

. ..... . ..- -. _____~

i
Figure P.14.120.

14.121. A water droplet of diameter 2 mm is falling in the atmos-


phere at t e rate of 2 d s e c . As a result of an updraft, a second water
droplet o I _
diameter 1 mm impinges on the aforementioned droplet. ;
The vel ity of the second droplet just prior to impingement is Figure P.14.123.

703
14.124. A BB i\ shot at the hard, rigid surface. The speed o l l l i c 14.127. Cmipnle thc angular cmonicntiim uhout 0 01a uniform
pellet is 3110 fisec a\ i t strikrs the suriace. If the directimi of Irrd, of Icngth L = 3 rii iind n i t w pcr unit Icnglh nr (11 7.5 hs/rn.
the velocity for the prllel i s @\en hy thc i d l o w i n g unit vector: ill l l i e i n a i i i f Nhcn i t i i \erticitl iind h a \ a n a n g ~ i l aspeed
~ ~ (0 (6
t = -.6i - .Xk 3 i-adlscc.
what is thc final velocity \'ectoi of thc pcllet lor ii collision havinz
E = .7? 0
I 7-
k w

,/ A 5'

Figure P. 14.124.
!5. A chain 0 1 wrriught i1on, with length o f 7 111 and il n i a v Figure P.14.127.
of 100 kg, is held so thal i t jus1 touches the \upport AB. I l t l i e ~ h i i i r i
i s rclcased, determine the total impulse driririg 2 sec in thc wrtic:il
directinn cxpcrienced by thc support if the impiicl i\ plastic (i.u.,
the chain does not bounce up) arid i f we m w t : thz support \(I that
thc links land UI the platfimn and 1not 011 each othcr'! IHirit: Notc
that any chain wrsrin*. on AH dclivcrc a vcrtiCal impulsc. Also
check 10 see if thc entire chaiii lands 01, A H hcfiire 2 sec.]

Figure P.14.125.
Fieurc P.14.12X.
14.126. Two trucks x e shown moving up ii I O incliiir. Tmck ,A
weighs 26.7 kN and i s developing il 13.30-kN driving lorce on thc
road. Truck R wzighs 17.8 hN and i \ curinccled with an incxtensihle
cable to truck A. By operating a winch h, truck B approaches truck A
with a conmnt acceleratim oi 3 m/xc.'llill lime f = 0 both r l u c k ~
have a speed of 10 mlsrc. what arc their ipeeil\ a1 timer = 15 scc?

Figure P.14.126.

704
i
14.130. closed container is full of water. By rotating the 14.132. A spacecraft has a burnout velocity Vo of 8,300 mlsec
container or some time and then suddenly holding the container at an elevation of 80 km above the earth's sulface. The launch
stationary we develop a rotational motion of the water, which, angle a is 1 5 ~What
. is the maximum elevation h from the earth's
you will I am in fluid mechanics, resembles a vunex. If the veloc- surface for the spacecraft?
ity of the uid elements is zero in the radial direction and is given
as 101r f sec in the transverse direction, what is the angular
momentu of the water?

1Ill'
Figure P.14.132,

14.133. A set of particles, each having a mass o f 112 slug,


rotates about axis A--A. The masses are moving out radially at a
constant speed of 5 ft/sec at the same time that they are rotat-
ing about the A-A, axis. When they are I ft from A-A, the
angular velocity is 5 radlsec and at that instant a torque is
applied i n the direction of motion which varies with time f in
seconds as
Figure P.14.130.
torque = ( 6 1 +
~ l o t ) lb-ft
14.131. dentical thin masses A and B slide on a light horimntal What is the angular velocity when the masses have moved out
rod that i' attached to a freely turning light vertical shaft. When
radially at constant speed to 2 f t ?
the masse; are in the position shown in the diagram, the system
mtates at ;Ispeed w o f 5 radlsec. The masses are released suddenly
from this position and move out toward the identical springs.
which have a spring constant K = 800 Iblin. Set up the equation
for the CO npression 6 of the spring once all motions of the bodie?
relative tu the rod have damped out. The mass of each body ii
1 0 Ibm. Neglect the mass of the rods and coulombic friction
Show that S = .OX361 in. satisfies your equation.
Torque

Figure P.14.133.

14.134. A torpedo hoat weighing 100,000 Ib moves at 40 knots


( I knot = 6,080 ftlhr) away from an engagement. To gv even
faster, all four 50-caliber machine guns are ordered to fire simul-
taneously toward thc rear. Each weapon fires at a muzzle veloc-
ity of 3,000 ftlsec and fires 500 rounds per minute. Each slug
weighs 2 0%.How much is the average force o n the boat
increased by this action'? Neglect the rate of change of the total
I Figure P.14.131. mass of boat.
I

705
14.135 A devicc to be detunatcd with a small charge ir t o the war of 10 Wsec relative tu the initial spccd uf thc octopus.
suspended in space [ser ( a ) ] .Dircctly after detonation. lour frag- What horicpowcr is hcing dcvckrped hy the octopus in thc ahme
ments are formed moving away from the paint of suspension. The action i T it occurs in I rec'!
following information is known ahout thcse fragments:
*14.138. I n the ,fission procebs i n a iiuclziir reactor, a risU
m, = I Ihm
nucleus first ahsorhs (11 captures a neutron lsee (a)]. A short tinic
v, = 200; ~ l0O.j f l k c
later. the "'U nucleu5 hreakr up into lission products plus ncu-
m , = 2 lhm troiis, which may suhsequently he captured by ulher 23'U nuclei
= 123 + IXOj ~ 100k Wsec and inaintain a <.kiiiw r r w l i o n . Energy is rcleased in each fiwion.
m , = 1.6 lhm 111(h) we have shown the results of a possible fission.The fnllnw-
V , = 200; + l S O j
~ + 1X0k fUsec ing information is known fnr this fission:
= 3.2 Ibm
Kinetic
What is the vclacity <'! Maw Energy
No. (MeV) Direction of V

Prr,duct A I3X E E,, = .3i - .2j + .YXk


Prclduct n 96 90 eH = l,i + m8j + n,$
Neutron I I IO E, = .hi + .8j
Neutron 2 I IO E, = .4i - .hj - .hWk

What i s the energy E of product A in MeV and what is the V C C ~ O ~


E" for the velocity of product B? Assume that before fissiun the
nuclcus of 235U plus captured neutrons is stationary: [Hinr: You
do not h u e to aclually ciinvert MeV to j d c s or atomic number to
kilogram5 to cilrry out the pnihlem.]

Figure P.14.135.
f Y4
14.136. A hawk is a predatory h i d which olten auacks snvallei
birds in flight. A hawk having a inass of 1.3 kg is swooping down
nn a sparrow having a mass of I S 0 g. Just hcfore sei~ingthe rpar-
row with its claws. the hawk is moving downward with a speed VH
of 20 kmlhr. l h r spnrrow i s moving horizontally at a speed C; of
I S kmlhr. Directly after cei7.ure. what is the speed of the hawk and
its prey'! What i c the loss in kinetic energy in J~xdes'!

14.137. The principal mode of propulsion of an ~ c t o p u ai s tu


take in water through the mouth and then after closing the inlet
to cject the water to the rear. If a 5-lh octopus after taking in I Ih
X lb)
of water is moving at a spccd of 3 ftlscc, what is its \peed directly
after ejecting the water'? The water is ejcctcd at an average \peed Figure Y.14.138.

706
Kinematics
of /Rigid Bodies:
Relative Motion
Introduction

ble to analyze complicated motions in a more simple systematic


several references. Second, the motion of a particle is often

set the stage for our main effort in the remaining ponion

15.2

I Translation and Rotation of


Rigid Bodies
For pu ses of dynamics, a rigid body is considered to be composed of a
continuo s distribution of particles having fixed distances between each

I 707
708 CHAPTER 15 KlNEMAllCS OF RIGID BODIES: RELAI'IVC MOTION

,dl
Figure 15.1. TrJnrlation of il hod?

Rotation. I1ii ripid hmly IIIOK\ s o that alonx wmc \tlaight line all [he px-
ticks of thc body. ( I I ~II 1hypothctic;il r x i e m i o ~o ~f t l i c hod). have veloc-
ity relative io w n i e refcrcnce. lhe hody 15 said to he ill roiolron rclatiw to
this relrrencu. 'l'he line o l atation:uy p x l i c l e i i i called thc irris qt m r ~ r r i o , ~ .
M
J \\\

,\ We shall now conhider how wc nleahure the rotation of a body. A sill-


\ gle revoIution i h defined as the iiiilount of rotiitiun in either a clockwise or a
\ -
,\
counterclockwisc direction ahout the n i s of rotation that hrings the hody
f back ti1 its original position. Partial revolution\ ciin ciinveniently he rneasurcd
hy obserbing riny line segmenl cuch :IS ,113 i n thc hody (Fig. 15.2) from a
vicwpoint M-M directed along the asis 0 1 rcrlation. I n Fig. 15.3, we have
hhown this vizw of AB at thc bcgititiiiig of the partial rotation as seen along
/' Ihz axis of rotation. as well iis the \,ien' A'H' iit 1hc end of the paitial rotation.
0
TIE angle fl that these line\ f<rrni w i l l he the same lirr the initial and final
Firure 15.2. Ilotatim u t a hody.

Figure 15.3. Mrnsurc of a partial wlatiun.


SECTION 15.3 CHASLES' THEOREM 709

e angle so formed

, so that infinitesimal rotations d p are vector quantities. There-


magnitude dpldt with

15.3 Chasles' Theorem

e displacement vector for this translation is shown at

ngle A$ about an axis of rotation which is normal to the plane and


ses through point E'.

1 Figure 15.4. Translation and rotation of a rigid body.


710 CHAPTER 15 KINEMATICS OF RIGID BODIES RELATIVC MOTlOh

What changes would occur had we chosen some lither point C for such
a procedure? Consider Fig. 15.5, where we have included an alternative
procedure by translating the body so that point C reaches the correct final
position C'. Next. we must rotate the hody an amount A@ ahout an axis of
rotation which is normal to the plane and which passes through C' in order k 1
get to the final orientation of the body. Thus, we have indicated twu routes.
We conclude from the diagram that ihc displacement ARC differs from AR,.
hut there is no difference in the amount of rotation A@, Thus, in general. AR
arid rhe axis of rototion will drpend on rlir poiiit ,,ho.rrn. uliilr rhr r i i n ~ i i i i f01
rotation A@4 1 he the .same.for rill such pobit.r.

!
A R,

Figure 15.5. Tmnslatim and rotiition of a rigid body u\inp point\ N ; ~ n dC'.

Consider now the ratios ARlAr and A@IAt. Thcsc quantities can he
regarded as an average translational velociiy and an average rotational speed,
respectively, of the body, which WE could soperpme to get from the initial
position to the final posilion in the timc AI. Thus, ARIA/ and A@lAl rcprescnt
an average measure o f the miitiiin during the time interval At. Ifwe go io rhr
limit by letring A I + 0, use have in.rruntunrous tran.slutional and angular
velocities which, when superposed, give the iristantrineuus motion qfrhr body.
The displacement vector of the chosen point B in the previous discussion rep-
resents the translation of the body during the time A/. Furthermore. the chosen
point B undergoes no other n~otionduring At oiher than that occurring during
translation. Thus, we can conclude that, in the limit, the trun.rlntionu1 velor.i/y
used for the hody corresponds to the acrual insrurrrurleous velocity of the cho-
sen point B at time t. The angular velocily w t o be used i n the movement US the
body, as described ahove. is the ~ a m vector
e for d l puints B chosen Accord-
ingly, w is the instantaneous ungular velocity of the body.
We have thus far considered the movenient of the body along a plane
surface. The same cunclusioiis can he reached for the general motion of an
arbitrary rigid body in space. We can then make the following statements for
the description of the general motion of a rigid body relative to some refer-
ence at time t These statements comprise Chasles' theorem.
1. Select any poinl B in the body. Assume that all particles of the hody havc
at the time r a velocity equal to V,, the aciual velocity of the poini B.
2. Superpose a pure rotational velocity w about an axis of rotation going
through point B.
SECTION 15.4 DERIVATIVX OF A VECTOR FIXED IN A MOVING REFERENCE 71 1

V , and w, the actual instantaneous motion of the body is deter-


w will be the same for all points B which might be chosen. Thus,
velocity and the axis of rotation change when different

15.4 Derivative of a Vector Fixed in a


Moving Reference
arbitrarily relative to each other in Fig.

equal to the velocity of 0, onto a rota-


axis of rotation through 0.

Figure 15.6. Vector A fixed in xyz moving relative to XYZ.

suppose that we have a vector A of fixed length and of fixed o n -


reference xyz. We say that such a vector is "fixed" in
Clearly, the time rate of change of A as seen from reference
can express this statement mathematically as

Howeve), as seen from XYZ,the time rate of change A will not necessarily
be zero. To evaluate (dAldt),, we make use of Chasles' theorem in the
followin ;manner:
1. Consider the translational motion k.This motion does not alter the direc-
tion o'A as seen from XYZ. Also, the magnitude of A is fixed; thus, vector
A cannot change as a result of this motion.'
2. We nt:xt consider solely a pure rotation about a stationary axis collinear
with (1) and passing through point 0.
'The line of action of A, however. will change as seen from X Y Z . But a change of line of
action doe, not signify a change in the vector, as pointed out in Chapter I on the discussion
O f equality of "Cctors.
To best observe this rotation, we shall employ at 0 a srationury refer-
cncc X’Y’Z’ po\itimed sci lhar %’ coincides with the axis of rotation. This ref-
erence i s shown in Fig. 15.7. N o w thc vcctorA i s rotaling ill this instant abiiul

X /’
I4gwe 15.7. (~‘ylindrica comlxmcnts f i r i \cccor A

h e Z‘ axis. We h a v e \tiown cylindrical coordinates to the end o f A (Le.. iit


point ( 1 ) ; :mil hiivc shown cylindrical components Ai. A,,. and A., In Fif.
15.8. we h a w sh(iun point i i with unil vcctors E?. e a . and e7,, for cylindrical
coiirdinatcs a1 thih point. Wc can accordingly cxpress A as
A = A,€, + AH€#+ AL.e7

Y’

X
Figure 15.8. Unit vectors fbr cylindriual coordinate

Clcarly, 3s A rotales ah(iu1 z‘.the values of the cylindrical scalar componcncs


o l A for X’Y’Z’. namely Ai, A,. and A,,. do not change. Hence. as seen from
SECTION 15.4 DERIVATIVE OF A VECTOR FIXED IN A MOVING REFERENCE 7 13

4
~

X'Y'Z, = A, = A, = 0. Also, noting that iZ,


= 0, we can say that

1.
We have already evaluated the time derivatives of the unit vectors for cylin-
drical c rdinates. Hence, using Eqs. I 1 2 8 and 11.32 and noting that '
correspo ds to 0,we have
6

side is simply the cross product of w andA as you can see


cross product with cylindrical components. Thus,

!
We conc ude that

relative to XYZ, we would observe the same time


reference as from the former reference. That is,
and we can conclude that

(15.1)

Thc: foregoing result gives the time rate of change of a vectorA fixed in
reference x.yz moving arbitrarily relative to reference XYZ. From this result,
we see that (dAldi),, depends only on the vectors w and A and not on their
lines of action. Thus, we can conclude that the time rate of change of A fixed
in q z i s lot altered when:

1. The v x t o r A is fixed at some other location in xyz provided the vector


itself s not changed.
2. The a:tual axis of rotation of the xyz system is shifted to a new parallel
position.
We can differentiate the terms in Eq. 15.1 a second time. We thus get
714 CHAPTER is KINEMATICS OF RIGID BODIES: RELATIVE MOTION

Using Eq. 15.1 to replace (dAldrJ,, and using & to replace (dwldt),,,
since the reference being used for this derivative is clear,2 we get

You can compute higher-order derivatives by continuing the process. We


suggest that only Eq. 15.1 be remembered and that all subsequent higher-
order derivatives he evaluated when needed.
In this discussion thus far, we have considered a vectorA fixed in a ref-
erence hyz. But a reference xyz is a rigid system and can he considered a rigid
body. Thus, the words ‘!fixed in a rsferencr xyz” in the previous discussion
can he replaced by the words ‘ : f w d in a rigid body.” The angular velocity w
used in Eq. 15.1 is then the angular velocity of the rigid body in which A is
fixed. We shall illustrate this condition in the following examples, which you
are urged to study very carefully. An understanding of these examples is vital
for attaining a good working grasp of rigid-body kinematics.
As an aid in carrying out computations involving the triple cross prod-
uct, we wish to point out that the product
o,k x (@,k x cj) = - 0 ; c j
That is, the product is minus the product of the scalars and has a direction
corresponding to the last unit vectnr, j . Remembering this will greatly facili-
tate our computations.3
Additionally, consider a situation where the angular velocity of body A
relative to body B is given as wI, while the angular velocity of body B rela-
tive to the ground is w2. What is the total angular velocity w7 of body A rel-
ative to the ground? In such a case, we must rememher that the angular
velocity wI of body A relative to body B is actually the difference between
the total angular velocity w,of hody A as seen from the ground and the angu-
lar velocity w2 of body B as seen from the ground. Thus.
w1 = WT -w2

Solving for w y we get


w7 = w 1 + W2

We see from above that to get the total angular velocity w T ,we simply add the
various relative angular velocities just as we would with any pair of vectors.

‘When it is clear from the discussion what reference is involved fur a time derivative. we
shall use the dot to indicate a time derivativc.
’Of course, i f t h e j vector weie a k vector, then clearly we would amiw at a iiull value for
the triple vector product.
SECTION I5.4 DERIVATIVE OF A VECTOR FIXED I N A MOVING REFERENCE 115

Exal pie 15.1


A dis 7 is mounted on a shaft AB in Fig. 15.9. The shaft and disc rotate
with onstant angular speed wz of 10 radlsec relative to the platform to
whicl earings A and B are attached. Meanwhile, the platform rotates at a
const angular speed wIof 5 radlsec relative to the ground in a direction
paral' to the Z axis of the ground reference XYZ. What is the angular
veloc vectorw for the disc C relative to XYZ? What are (dwldt)xrz and
2
(d2w )xyz?
ie total angular velocity w of the disc relative to the ground is eas-
ily gi 1 at all times as follows:

w = w, + w 2 radlsec
At th istant of interest as depicted by Fig. 15.9, we have for w :

Disk C
&wJf

I I Platforin

Ground
Reference
Figure 15.9. Rotating disc on rotating platform.

To g the first time derivative of w, we go back to Eq. (a), which is


alwa: valid and hence can be differentiated with respect to time. Using a
dot ti :present the time derivative as seen from XYZ, we have
ri, = ri,, + & J 2 (b)
Cons 'r now the vector w2. Note that this vector is constrained in direction
to he ways collinear with the axis AB of the bearings of the shaft. This
chr is a physical requirement. Also, since q is of constant value, we
may nk of the vector w2 as $red to the platform along AB. Therefore,
since 2 platform has an angular velocity of w I relative to XUZ, we can say:

G2 = w , x w 2 (C)
7 16 C H A P T ~ KI S KINEMATK'S or' RIC;I) Bouifs KEI.ATIVI: MOTION

Example 15.1 (Continued)

As Cor W,, namely the other vector i n Eq. (b). wc iiotc Lhal iis s e m frnm
XYZ, w , i s a cnnslant veclur and si) at all times r U , = 0. Hcncc Eq. ( h ) can
be written 21s Si)llows:
& = w l xu, ((1)

This equatinn i s valid at all times and s o can he differentiated again. A I the
instant of intercut as depicted by Fig. 15.9. w c liavc for W:

To get &, we ~ i o wdifferentiate (d) with respect to time. W c llavc


ij = W l x w 2 + w , x &>
(1)
=0 + w I x l w ,x W , i
where we have wed the Sac1 that h , = 0 at all times a s well a s ti.( c ) I i r
W,.A t the instant nf
interest, we have

ij = Sk x ( 5 k x lO.ji = -2Mjradsec3

Example 15.2
In Example 15.1, consider a position vector p hctween two points nn the
rotating disc (see Fig. 1 5 . 1 0 ) . The length o f p i s 100 rnm and. at the instanl
of interest, i s in the vertical direction. What are the l i n t and hecond time
derivatives o f p at this instan( as seen from the ground referencc'?
It should he ohvious that the vector p i s fixed ti) the disc which has
at all times an angular velocity relatiw ti) X Y Z equal to w , + w,. Hencc.
at all times we can say:
p = tw, t w ? ) X p ia)
Figure 15.10. Displaccrnrnl V ~ C I Op~
A t the instant o f interest. w e have noting that p = IOOk in disc.

ii = (Sk + lOji x IO(lk = 1,000imdsec (hi

. back (11 Eq. (a) and diSkreiitiate:


To get the secnnd derivalivc n t ~ )go
p = (&, + & > I x p + ( w , + W 2 ) x p
I1
SECTlON 15.4 DERIVATIVE OF A VECTOR FEED IN A MOVING REFERENCES 7 17

I Exa ple 15.2 (Continued)


Notin that cbl = 0 at all times and, as discussed in Example 15.1, that
w2 is ixed in the platform, we can sdy:
p = (0 +WI x w 2 ) x p + (wl +w:) x p (C)
At th instant of interest we have, on noting Eq. (b):
p = (Sk x l O j ) X lOOk + (5k + I O j ) x 1,000imm/sec2

!
AI hough we shall later formally examine the case of the time deriva-
tive of v ctorA as seen from XYZ when A is notfixed in a body or a reference
xy:, we an handle such cases less formally with what we already know. We
illustrate this in the following example.

'
I Exa pie 15.3
For t e disc in Fig. 15.9, oz = 6 radlsec and d2 = 2 rad/sec2, both rela-
tive the platform at the instant of interest. At this instant, wI = 2
radls c and hl = -3 rad/sec2 for the platform relative to the ground. Find
the a gular acceleration vector dJ for the disc relative to the ground at the
insta t of interest.
The angular velocity of the disc relative to the ground at all times is

For 4 , we can then say


w=01+w2 (a)

i dJ = cbl + c b 2 (b)
It is pparent on inspecting Fig. 15.1 I that at all times w I is vertical, and
so w , can say:
71 8 CHAPTER I S KINEMATK‘S 0 1 : RIGID BODIES: Rlil.ATIVE M U I I O N

Example 15.3 (Continued)


However, w2 is changing direction and, mnst imporlantly. is changing
magnitude. Because of the latter, w2 cannot he considercd lixcd i n ii refer-
ence or a rigid body Sor pui-poses of computing b2.To get around this diS-
ficulty, we fix a unit vector j ’ 011f0 tlw plu!fi,rm to he colliiiciir with the
centerline of the shaft A B as shown in Fig. 15.1 I. Wc know the ;In_pular
velocity of this unit vector; it is w , at all Limes. We can then express o2i n
the following manner, which is valid at all time\:
w2 = w2j’ (d)

X relerenie
Figure 15.11. Unit veclorj’ fixed Lo platform.

We can differentiate the above wilh respect to time as follow\:


b2= [b7j ’ + w2 J’
Butj’ is fixed to the platlorin which ha\ angular vclocily w , relalive 10
XYZ at all times. Hence. we have for thc above.
G 2 = (b2j‘ + 0 2 ( w I x j ’ ) (e)
Thus, Eq. (b) then can be L’
w e n ns
b = w , k + o i 2 j ’ + m 2 ( w ,X j ’ )

This expression is valid at all Limcs and could he differentiated agnio. At


the instant of interest, we can say. noting thatj’ = j ifit this instant,
b = -3k + 2 j + b(2k xj)

2j -Yrds
15.1. Is the motion of the cabin of a ferris wheel rotational or
translational if the wheel moves at uniform speed and the occu- i I
pants cause no disturbances? Why?
15.2. A cylinder rolls without slipping down an inclined surface. Z
What is the actual axis of rotation at any instant? Why? How is
this axis moving?
15.3. A reference xyz is moving such that the origin 0 has at x
time t a velocity relative to reference XYZ given as
V, = 6 i + 12j + 13kftlsec

The xyz reference has an angular velocity w relative to X Y Z at


time t given as X /
o = 1Oi + 12j + 2kradIsec Figure P.15.4.

What is the time rate of change relative to XYZ of a directed line 15.5. Find the second derivatives as seen from XYZ of the vector
segment p going from position (3,2,-5) to (-2.4.6) in xyz? What is p and the unit vector i’ specified in Problem 15.3. The angular
the time rate of change relative to XYZ of position vectors i’ and k’? acceleration of qi relative to XYZ at the instant of interest is
z &=5i+2j+3krad/sec2

15.6. Find the second derivative as seen from X Y Z of the vector


P , , ~specified in Problem 15.4. Take the angular acceleration of
xyz relative to X Y Z at the instant of interest as

& = 1% - 2k rad/secz

15.7. A platform is rotating with a constant speed 0,of IO


radlsec relative to the ground. A shaft is mounted on the platform
and rotates relative to the platform at a speed o2of 5 radlsec.
What is the angular velocity of the shaft relative to the ground?
What are the first and second time derivatives of the angular
/ velocity of the shaft relative to the ground!
X’
Figure P.15.3.
15.4. A reference xyz is moving relative to X Y Z with a velocity
of the origin given at time I as
V, = 6i + 4j + 6kdsec

The angular velocity of reference xyz relative to XYZ is C;-


w = 3i + 14j + 2kradlsec
What is the time rare of changc as SCCCT from XYZ of a directed

Py
~ xyz going from position 1 to position 2 where
line segment P , , in
the position vectors in r y z for these points are, respectively,
p , = 2i’+3j‘m X
p7 = 3 i ‘ - 4 j ’ + Z k ’ m Figure P.15.7.

7 1‘
15.8. In I'rohlem 11.7, what are the f i n 1 mil second t i m e
derivati\!ec of il dircctcd line segment p i n the disc at thc instant
[hill the \ystem has thc gewncir) \Iiown? 'The x c t o r p i \ 01
length I O inin

Figure 1'.15.11.

Figure P.15.Y.

Figure P.15.12.
X ry
Y

Figure P.lS.15.

15.16. A cone is rolling without slipping such that its centerline


rotates at the rate w , of 5 revolutions per second about the Z axis.
Figure P.15.13. What is the angular velocity w of the body relative to the ground?
What is the angular acceleration vector for the body?
15.14. An electric motor M is mounted on a plate A which is
welded to a shaft D. The motor has a constant angular speed w2
relative to plate A of 1,750 rpm. Plate A at the instant of interest is
in a vertical position as shown and i s rotating with an angular
speed w , equal to 100 rpm and a rate of change of angular speed
b, equal to 30 rpmlsec-all relative to the ground. The normal
projection of the centerline of the motor shaft onto the plate A is at
an angle of 45" wilh the edge of the plate FE. Compute the first
and second lime derivatives of w, the angular velocity of the
motor, as seen from thc ground. X
Figure P.15.16.
Z
15.17. A small cone A is rolling without slipping inside a large
conical cavity B . What is the angular velocity w of cone A relative
to the large cone cavity B if the centerline of A undergoes an
angular speed w , of 5 rotations per sccund about the Z axis?

Z
C
\ I 0 1

Figure P.15.14.

15.15. A racing car is moving at a constant speed of 200 milhr


when the driver turns his front wheels at an increasing rate, W , , of
.02 radlsec2. If w , = ,0168 radscc at the instant of interest, what
are w and cb of the front wheels at this instant? The diameter of /xi.
the tires is 11:l in. Figure P.15.17.

12 1
15.18. An amusement park ride comisis of a staiionary verlical
tower with arms that can swing outward from the Lower and a1 the
same time can rotate about thc tower. At the ends of the arms,
cockpits containing passenger5 can rotate relatiw to ihe arms.
Consider the case where cockpit A rotales at angular speed wz rel-

I
~

ative to arm BC, which rotates at angular speed m1relative lo the


tower. If % i s fixed at YO", what are the total angular velocity and
the angular acceleration of the cockpit relative til the ground? Use
o, = .2 radisec and w? = .h rad/sec. 1,
l

Figure P.15.20.

15.21. In PI-rrhlem 15.18, find & of the cockpit A for the case
whcrc 0,= .2 rad/secz and i-l, = .3 rad/iei2.

15.22. In Prohlem 15.13, find & o l bcem AB relative to the


ground it a1 the instant shown the fbllowing data apply:

Y wl = .3 radlsec
W ,= .2 r a d k e c '
X <u2 = .6 rad/sec
Figure P.15.18. W? = - .I rad/sec2

15.19. In Prohlem 15.18. find i, of the cockpit for the case In Pr~,hlem find the angular acceleration
where 0 = m, = .8 radlsec at the instant that 0 = Yo". for the gun harrel, if, for the instant shown in the diagram. the fnl-
lowing data apply:

15.20. Mass A is connected 10 an inextensihle wire. Supports C I$ = 3 0 radlsec. B = 20"


and D a r e moving as shown.
4 = .26 r a d / s e c 2 , q$ = 30"
(a) What is the velocity vector of m a s A? 6 = . I7 radlsec
(b) If cylinder G is free to rotate and there is no slipping, what is 8 = -.34 radlsec'
its angular velocity'?

l'he following data apply: 15.24. I n Problem 15.1 1. find V if at the instani shown in the
diagram:
h=2m ( V ,. 1., = .24 Lm/F
L=3m ( V , , ) , = 2 1 rn/\ wI = 5 rad/sec
1=2m R-lm W. = IO rad/sec2
( V $ ) , = .5 t d s a = 45' W, = 2 radlsec
CV, j, = .6 m/s
W, = 3 radlsec'
l'he last four problems of this SPI w e d w i p d /Or those .stu
V = IO mlsec
dents who huvr studied Example 15.1. 0 = s m/sec2
SECTION 15.5 APPLICATIONS OF THE FIXED-VECTOR CONCEPT 123

15.5 Applications of the Fixed-Vector


Concept
In Section 15.4, we considered the time derivative, as seen from a reference
XYZ, o f a vector A fixed in a rigid body or fixed in reference xyz. The result
was a simple formula: ’
A=wXA
where w is the angular velocity relative to XYZ of the body or the reference in
whichA is fined. In this section, we shall use the preceding formula for a vec-
tor connecting mu points a and b in a rigid body (see Fig. 15.12). This vector,
which we denote as pclh,clearly is fixed in the rigid body. The body in accor-
dance with Chasles’ theorem has a velocityR relative to XYZ corresponding
to some point 0 in the body plus an angular velocity w relative to XYZ with x
the axis of rotation going through 0.We can then say on observing from X Y Z :
Figure 15.12. pabfixed in rigid body.
fob = fob (15.4)

Now consider position vectors at a and b as shown in Fig. 15.13. We can say:
‘0 + Pnb = ‘h

Taking the time derivative as seen from XYZ, we have

($1 XIZ
+(+)=[%) XYZ
XYZ

This equation can be written as

(“I;;“) XYZ
=V,-Va (15 5 )
X
Since (dpa,ldt),, is the difference between the velocity of point b and that at Figure
point a as noted above, we can say that (dpabldt),, is the velocity of point h
relative to point Next, using Eq. 15.4 to replace (dpab/dt)xyz,we have, on
rearranging terms, a very useful equation:

(15.6)

In using the foregoing equation. we must he sure that we get the sequence of
subscripts correct on p since a change in ordering brings about a change in
sign (i,e., pab = -p,,J. This equation is a statement of the physically obvious
result that the velocity of particle b o f a rigid body a s seen from XYZ equals
the velocity of any other particle a of this body as seen from XYZ plus the
velocity ojpurticle b relative to particle a.

‘That is, (dpaJdt)xn i s the velocity of h as seen by an ohserver translating relative to XYZ
with point a. i.e , as seen hy a nonrotating observer moving with a.
124 CHAPTER I? KINEMA.IICS 01: KICIIl HODIFS REI.ATIVB MOTION

Differentiating Eq. 15.6 again. we can get a relation involving the


acceleration vectors nf two points on a rigid body:

Hence, we have on using Eq. 15.4 in the last cxprcssion

ah = a, + &L”paa
+ w YI. (157)

We have thus formulated relations between rhr morioris of two poinrs of a


rigid body as s e m f r o m a .single referenm. Such relations can he very useful
i n the study nf machine elements.
Before going lo the examples, let us now consider the case of a circular
cylinder rolling wifhoul slipping (see Fig. 15.14). The point of contact A of
the cylinder with the ground has instantaneously zero velocity and hence we
have pure instantaneous rotalion at any time f ahout an instantaneous axis of
rotation at the line of contact. Thc velocity of any point B of the cylinder can
then easily he found by using Eq. 15.6 for points R and A . Thus:
v, = v, + w x P*rr
Figure 15.14. Cylinder rnlling w i t h w t Thcrcforc.
slipping on il flat sutixc.
v, = 0 +w x p,,n = w x pa,{

From the ahnvc cquatinn it is clear that fnr ciimputing the velocity of any point
on the cylinder we can think nf the cylinder as hinged at the point of contact.
In particular tor point 0. the center of the cylinder. we get from ahove:
V, = --w Ri

If the velocity is known. clearly the angular velocity has a magnitude of K I R .


Another way nf relating V and w is to realize that the distance s that 0
moves must equal the length lit. circumference coming into contact with the
ground. That is, measuring 0 from the X axis to the Y axis:
,Y = - RO
Differentiating we get:
VI1 - - R B = - R o
~

thus reprnducing the previous result. Differentiating again, we get


..
(i0 =-RB=-Ra (15.8)

relating now the acceleration of 0 and the angular acceleration a. Clearly, the
accclcration vector fnr 0 must he parallel to the ground. Again, for comput-
ing a,,, we have a simple situation.
SECTION I 5.5 APPLICATIONS OF THE FIXED-VECTOR CONCEPT 725

Next, let us determine the acceleration vector for the point of contacf A
of the cylinder. Thus, we can say for points A and 0
a , = aA + & x pAo + w x ( w x pAo)

Therefore,
- R e i = a A + e k x Rj + 6k x (ok x R j ) (15.9)

Carrying out the products:


- R e i = aA- Rei - RO2j
Therefore, cancelling terms, we get
aA = R e 2 j (IS.IO)
We see thatpoinf A is accelerafing upward toward the center of the cylinder.'
This information will be valuable for us in Chapter 16 when we study rigid-
body dynamics.

T h i s conclusion must apply also to a sphere rolling without slipping on a flat surface.
As lor acceleration of other points of the cylinder, we do not have a simple formula but
must insen data Ibr these points into the accderiltim formula valid for two points of a rigid body.

Example 15.4
Wheel D rotates at an angular speed wI of 2 radsec counterclockwise in
Fig. 15.15. Find the angular speed oEof gear E relative to the ground at
the instant shown in the diagram.
-I 3.5'4

Figure 15.15. Two-dimensional device

We have information about two points of one of the rigid bodies,


namely AB, of the device. At B, the velocity must be downward u*ith the
726 ('HAI'TER 15 KINEMATICS OF RI(;lLI BODIES: K E L A T I V E M J T 1 0 N

Example 15.4 (Continued)


value of ( m , ) ( r 1 , ) = 4 ftlscc as shown i n Fig. 15.16. Furthermore, since
point A must travel a circular path of radius GA we know that A has ~ e l o c -
ity V, with a direction at right angles Lo GA. Acctirdingly. since the anglc
hetween G A and the vertical is ('IO" - 45" a ) = (45" - n) as can
~

readily he seen on inspecting Fig. 15.16. thcn the angle bctween V, and the
horizontal must a l s o he (45" ~ a)because of the muruol per~'nni~.rriorii?
of the sidcs of these angles. If wc can determinc vclocity V,, we can get the

-
desired angiilar qpeed 01 gear A imrncdiately.

-1 3.5' 1

Figure 15.lh. V c l i ~ i l yY C C ~ O ~lor


S IWO point? r i f o rigid hod? s h ~ w n .

Before cxamining rigid body AB. we have some geomctrical steps to


take. Considcring triangle GAR in Fig. 15.16, we can first sol^ fiir n
using the law olhines iis hollows:

Therefore, since &Gli4 = 45'

Solving for a. we get


a = 15.37" (h)
The angle 0is then casily evaluated considering tiic angles i n the triangle
GBA. Thus,
p = 180" ~ a ~ &GRA
= 180" - 15.37" ~ 45" = 119.6" (e)

_XI__
-- ..
SECTION 15.5 APPLICATIONS OF THE FIXED-VECTOR CONCEPT 727

Example 15.4 (Continued)


Finally, we can determine AB of the hiangle, again using the law of sines.
Thus,
AB - G A
s i n p sin4Y
AB -~4
sin 119.6" - .707
Solving for AB, we get
AB = 4.92 ft (d)
We now can consider bar AB as our rigid body. For the points A and
B on this body, we can say:
'A = 'E + wAB PEA

Noting that the motion is coplanar and that was must then be normal to the
plane of motion, we have6
VA[cos(45"- a)i - sin(45" - a ) j ]
= - 4 j + wABkX 4.92.- cos 4 5 3 - sin 4 Y j )

Inserting the value w = 15.37", we then get the following vector equation:
VA(.869)i- VA(.4Y4)j = - 4 j - 3.48wA,j + 3.48wA,i (e)
The scalar equations are
.86YV, = 3 . 4 8 ~ ~ ~
-.494vA = -4 - 3.480,, (f)
Solving, we get'
V, = -10.66 ftlsec
wAB= -2.66 rad/sec (9)

Thus, point A moves in a direction opposite to that shown in Fig. 15.16.


We now can readily evaluate w,, which clearly must have a value of

in the counterclockwise direction.

*Our practice will be to consider unknown angular velocities as positive. The sign for
the unknown angular velocity coming out of the computations will then correspond to the
actual cowention sign for the angular velocity.
'By having assumed mAB as positive and thus counterclockwise for the reference xy
employed, we conclude from the presence of the minus sign that the assumption is wrong and
that mABmust be clockwise for the reference used. It is significant to note that as a result of
the initial positive assumption, the result mAB = -2.66 rad/sec gives at the same time the cor-
recf conwntion sign for the actual angular velocity for the reference used.
72X CHAPTER 15 KINHMATICS OF RIGID RODIES: KEI.AlIVE MOTION

Example 15.5
In the device in Fig. I S . 17, find the angular velocities and angular acceler-
ations OS both hars.

-I
I.3 11, ~

Figure 15.17. Two-dimensional dcvice


W e shall consider points A and 6: 01 bar AB. Note first that at the
instant shown:
V,, - ( . 3 0 0 ) ( u l i ~ . )ni/sec
= j
V" = (21(.30O)i
= .6OOi m/sec

Noting that wIIj m u h t he oriented in the Z direction hccaust: we have plane


motion in the X Y plane, we have for Eq. 15.6:

VI, = "A + WAR x P,IH


-.3OOo,,.,j = .6OOi + (w,,k) x ( i + .?OOjl (C)
-.300wl,,.j = .hOOi + w,,,j - .3OOo,,i

Note we have assumed wHc.and wAxas positive and thus counterclockwise.


The scalar equations are:
600 = 3 0 0 0 " ,
- 300Wl,, = W A R
W e then get
= 2 radlsec
@lx= -6.67 radlsec

Thcrcftirc. wnRi h counterclockwise while oxr.must be clockwise.


I,et us now turn tu the angular acceleratim considerations Iiir the
hars. W e consider separately now points A and B CIS bar AB. Thus,
a?,= ( r o ? ) , j= ( . 3 0 0 ) ( 2 2 ) , j= 1.200jni/scc2
a], = ~ , p $ +~pil i ( ~ ~ l i c ! - . i )
= (.300)(-6.67*)i - .300hli,.j
= 13.33i - .300hl,c.j
SECTION 15.5 APPLICATIONS OF THE FIXED~VECTORCONCEFT 729

Example 15.5 (Continued)

Again, we have assumed W H cpositive and thus counterclockwise. Cunsid-


ering bar AB, we can say fur Eq. 15.7:
x pAR+ wABx (oAB
a n = aA + bAB x pas) (f)
Noting that hAH
must be in the Z direction, we have for the foregoing
equation:
13.33i -.300hR,j
= 1.2OOj + h A 8 k X (i + . 3 0 0 j ) + ( 2 k ) X [ 2 k X (i + .3OOj)] (g)
The scalar equations are
17.33 = -.300hA,
- . 3 0 0 b B , = hAB
We get

Clearly, for the reference used, hAH


must be clockwise and hHC
must be
counterclockwise.

I Example 15.6
(a) In Example 15.5, find the instantaneous axis ($rotation for the
rod AB.
The intersection of the instantaneous axis of rotation with the xy
plane will be a point E in a hypothetical rigid-body extension of bar AB
having zero velocity at the instant of interest. We can accordingly say:
v, = VA + W A H x PAE

Therefore,
0 = .60i + ( 2 k ) x (hi
+ Ayj) (a)

where and Ay are the components of the directed line segment from
point A to the center of rotation E. The scalar equations are:

0 = .60 - 2Ay
0 = 2hx
Clearly, A? = .3 and Ax = 0. Thus, the center of rotation is point 0.
730 CHAPTER I S KINEMATICS OF RIGID BODIES: RELATIVE MOTION

Example 15.6 (Continued)


We could have casily deduced this result by inspection in this case.
The velocity ofcach point of bar AH must be at right angles to a line from
the center of rotation to the point. The velocity of point A is in the hori-
zontal direction and the velocity of point LI is in the vertical direction.
Clearly, as seen from Fig. 15.18, point 0 is the only point from which
lines to points A and H are normal to the velocities at these points.

v,
B

Y I
=7

L, {
LilllOL
...a = 73.3"

Figure 15.18. Instantaneous axis of rotation of AH.

(b) Now using the instantaneouh axis of rotation, find the magiii-
tudes of the velocity and acceleration of point D (Fig. 15.IX) using data
from the previous example.
In Fig. 15.19, we show the velocity vector normal to line OD. Uhing
the law of cosines for triangle AOD, we can find OD which is a key distance
for this example. Thus noting from Fig. I S . 18 that a = 73.3". we have

= [.7' + 3' - (2)(.7)(.3)(cns73.3")]"* = ,6777 in

..
Figure 15.19. Velocity vector tor point 11.

We then say from rotational motion ahout the instantaneous center of rota-
tion 0.
v,, = (.6777)(~,,) = (.6777)(2) =~i:52hnh
SECTION 15.5 APPLICATTONS OF THE FIXED~VECTORCONCEPT 73 I
Example 15.6 (Continued)
For the acceleration, we have (see Fig. 15.20)
112
a, = [(a,,): +(a,):]
where (uEJC and (uD),,respectively, are the centripetal and tangential com-
ponents of acceleration at point D . Noting that r for point D is ,6777 m, we
get for the above

= {[N)'
+ [(.6777)(57.8)]'
r
We now get the vectors V, and a,. For this purpose we determine the
= 39.26 idsz

angle p of the tinted triangle in Fig. 15.20 by first using the law of sines
(h)

for triangle AOD


.7 - ,6777
sin(90O - p) sin 73.3"
~~ ~

:. /3 = 8.373'

90' - y ) = 8.373" = 0
Figure 15.20. Acceleration components of point D.

Hence, looking at the tinted triangle it is clear that y = 90" - 8.373" = 8 1.639
We can now give ";, (see Fig. 15.19).
V, = V,(cosyi + s i n y j ) = 1.355(cos81.63i + sin81.63j)
732 CHAPTEK I S KINEMATICS OF RIGID BOUIES: RELATIVE MOTION

Example 15.6 (Continued)


For thc acceleration vector, wc rcfer back to Eq. (b) til-components ofa,,
Noting Fig. 15.20, we havc
V'
a,, = 1 . ( ( ; ) ~ ~ ) [ c o s ~ i + s i n y jI1 + ~ ' [ ~ c i ) s P i + \ i n 1 3 j )
= (.6777)(-57.8)lc~isX I , 6 3 3 + sin 81.63"i I

*Example 15.7
A disk b: i s rotating ahout a fixed axih HG at a coiistilnt angular
spccd o,015 radlsec i n Fig. 15.21. A har CD is held by the wheel at D by
a hall-joint connection and is guided along il rod AB cantilevered at A and
I3 by a collar at C having a second hall-joint connection with CD. as shown
i n thc diagram. Compute the velocity of C.

1.7 m -

Figure 15.21. 'l'hree-dioiensioiial dcvicc.

We shall need the vector p,,<.Thus,

._"I..
SECTION 15.5 APPLICATIONS OF THE FIXED~VECTOR
CONCEPT 133

Example 15.7 (Continued)


Now employ Eq. 15.6 for rod CD. Thus,
vc = v, + WCD x PDC

Therefore, assuming C i s going from B to A


Vc(cos 3O"i - sin 30"k)
= (5)(.30)k+ ( f o r i+ w,j + w-k)X (-.1590i - 1.7j + ,265k)
V,.(.866i - .500k)= 1.50k - 1.70rk - .265wxj + ,1590wvk
+.265w,,i - .IS90oi j + I .7w$
The scalar equations are:
+ ~1 .7wZ
.866Vc = , 2 6 5 ~ (a)
0 = -.265wx - , 1 5 9 0 ~ ~ (b)
-.500Vc = 1.50 - 1.70, + .1590wv (c)
From these equations, we cannot solve for w,. w,, and w, because the spin
of CD about its own axis (allowed by the ball joints) can have any value
without affecting the velocity of slider C. However, we can determine V,,
as we shall now demonstrate.
In Eq. (b), solve for w, in terms of w,.
6.1, = -.600wZ (d)

In Eq. (a), solve for my in terms of wz:


my = 3.27Vc - 6 . 4 1 5 ~ ~ (e)

Substitute for w, and w, in Eq. (c) using the foregoing results:


-.500Vc = 1.50 - (1.7)(-.600w7)+ (.1590)(3.27Vc - 6 . 4 1 5 ~ ~ )
Therefore,
-1.020vc = 1.5 + 1.020wz - 1.020wz
V, = -1.471 mlsec

Hence,
Vc = -1.471(cos 30"i - sin30"k)

Clearly, contrary to our assumption C is going from A to B


134 CHAPTER IS KINEMATICS O F R I C ~ I DROUICS: RELATIVE MOTION

Before going on ti) thc next section, we wish lo point out a simple
relation that will he of usc i n thc remainder of thc chapler. Suppose that you
have a moving particle whose piisition vector r hiis a magnitude that is
constant (see Fig. 15.22). 'This position vector. however. has an angular
velocity w rclativc to .I?:, We w i y h 10 know the velocity of thc particle /'
relative to ".;

We could iinaginu for this purposc that particlc P is part of a rigid body
attached to .xSz 211 0 and rotating with angular velocity w. This situation is
shown in Fig. 15.23. ([sing Eq. 15.6, we can then say:

v,,= v,,+ w x Pi,,>

Figure 15.23. P iiuw conbidered a\ a point i n il rigid body


attached at 0 and having angular vclouty w.

But VI = 0 and pop is simply r . Hcnce, we have


V,=wXr

We thus have a simple formula for the vclocity of a particle moving at


a fixed distance from the origin o f .rvz. This velocity is simply the cross
product of the angular velocity w of the position vector ahiiut xyz and the
position vector r.
15.25. A body is spinning about an axis having direction cosines z
I = .5, m = .5, and n = ,707. The angular speed is 50 radlsec. I

What is the velocity of a point in the body having a position


vector r = 6i + 4 j ft?

Figure P.15.29.
15.30. A piston P is shown moving downward at the constant
speed of 1 ftlsec. What is the speed of slider A at the instant of
interest'?

Figure P.15.25.

15.26. In Problem 15.25, what is the relative velocity between a


point in the body at position x = I O m, y = 6 m, z = 3 m and
a point in the body at position x = 2 m, y = -3 m, z = 0 m?

15.27. If the body in Problem 15.25 is given an additivnal


angular velocity w2 = 6j + 1Ok radlsec, what is the direction of
the axis of rotation? Compute the velocity at r = l0j + 3k ft if
the actual axis of rotation goes through the origin.

15.28. A wheel is rolling along at 17 mlsec without slipping.


What is the angular speed? What is the velocity of point B on the
rim of the wheel at the instant shown?
Figure P.15.30.
15.31. A rod AB is I m in length. If the end A slides down the
surface at a speed V, of 3 mlsec, what is the angular speed of AB
at the instant shown?
Y

Figure P.15.28.

15.29. A flexible cord is wrapped around a spool and is pulled at


a velocity of 10 ftlsec relative to the ground. If there is no slipping
at C, what is the velocity of points 0 and D at the instant shown? Figure P.15.31.
corner I)?

Figure P.15.32.

II

cc

I Figure P.15.33.

I- ~

bigwe P.15.37.
15.38. A wheel rotates with an angular speed of 20 radlsec. A 15.41. Member A B is rotating at a constant speed of 4 radlsec in
connecting rod connects points A on the wheel with a slider at B. a counterclockwise direction. What is the angular velocity of bar
Compute the angular velocity of the connecting rod and the veloc- RC for the position shown in the diagram? What is the velocity of
ity of the slider when the apparatus is in the position shown in the point 1) at the center of bar BC? Bar BC is 3 ft in length.
diagram.

Figure P.15.38.
Z
Figure P.15.41.
15.39. In Pioblem 15.38, if V , = 14.30 d s e c and was =
-Y.33 radlsec, where is the instanfdneous axis o f rotation of con-
necting rod AB'?
15.42. In Problem 15.41, determine in the simplest manner the
instantaneous axis of rotation for bar BC.
15.40. A piston, connecting rod, and crankshaft of an engine are
represented schematically. The engine is rotating at 3,000 rpm. At
the position shown. what is the velocity of pin A relative to the
15.43. Suppose that bilr A B of Problem 15.41 has an angular
engine block and what is the angular velocity of the connecting
velocity of 3 radlsec counterclockwise and a counterclockwise
rod AR?
angular acceleration of 5 radlsec'. What is the angular accelera-
tion of bar BC, which is 3 It in length?

15.44. A rod is moving on a horizontal surface and is shown at


time f. What is Vv of end A and w of the rod at the instant shown'?
[Hinr: Use the fact that the rod is inextensible.]

A x

V, =-2i + V,j d s e c
C
Figure P.15.40. Figure P.15.44.

131
15.45. A plate AfK'II inovcs un a horirontal surface. At time I 15.48. A mcchanism with two sliders is shown. Slider A at the
:omen A and H have the fnllowinp velocities: instiltit of interest has a speed of 3 inisec and is accelerating at
V, = 3i + 2 j mlszc the rate of I .7 nrlsec2. Ifmcmher AB is 2.5 m in length. what lire
V,, = CV,)-i + Sj mlscc the angular velocity and :iogular acceleratinn for this member'!

Find the IuCation of the instiintiinews u i \ 01 rotation

i il'\
n B

2 "7

A
Figure P.15.45.

15.46. t i n d the velocity and accclcliitiiin relative to the ground


.,f pin H un the wheel. 'The u'heel rolls without slipping. Also, find
.he angular velocity 01 thc ilottcd bar in which the pin H of the
whcel slides when H o f thc hac i \ 30".

Figure P.15.48.

15.49. In Pmhlcm 15.4X find the instantaneous center of rutation


of bar All i f V, is 2.7 mlsec.

15.50. The velocity nf c o r n a A of the black is known t o he at


Figure P.15.46.
timc I :
15.47. 11~0,= S r:idlwc and&, = 3 radlsec' h r h w C1). compute
:he angular velocity iwd angular accclcration of thc g c a 11 relative to V, = IOi + 4j - 3 k mlsec
:he ground. Salvc the problem wing Eq\. 15.6 and 15.7, and then
:heck thc result by considering simple cilcular motion Of point [). 'fhe angular speed about edge ATj i s 2 rad/sec, and the ang~~lar
speeds abaut the diagonals and arc known tu he 3 radlsec
Y
I and 6 md/\ec. rrspectibely. What i \ thc vclocity of corner B at this
instant'!

J I

Figure P.15.47, Figure P.15.SO.

71x
15.51. A rigid sphere is moving in space. The velocities for two 15.53. A conveyor element nioves down an incline at a speed of
points A and B on the surface have the values at time f: 15 mlsec. A plate hangs down from the conveyor element and, at
the instant of interest shown in the diagram, is spinning about AB
V,, = 6i + 3j + 2k ftlsec at the rate of 5 radlsec. Also, the axis AB swings in the YZ plane at
V, = ( V J j + 6j 4k ftlsec
~
the rate w , of I O radlsec and 6,= .iradlaec’ at the instant of
interest. DB is parallel to the X axis at this instant. Find the veloc-
The position vectors for points A and LI are at time f: ity and acceleration of point D at the instant shown.

r, = IOi + I S j + 1 2 k f t
r, = 7i + 20j + 18k ft

What is the angular velocity of the sphere? At the instant of inter- Z


est the sphere has zero spin about axis z, , = I O radlsec in YZ plane
I &. w2 = 5 radlsec ahout AB axis
X 3m

X PY Figure P.15.51.
Figure P.15.53.

15.54. A cylinder rolls without slipping. It has an angular veloc-


15.52. A conveyor element moves down the incline at a speed of ity w = .3 radlsec and an angular acceleration b = ,014 rad/sec2.
5 ftlsec. A shaft and platform move with the conveyor element What are the angular velocity and angular acceleration of
hut have a spin of .5 radlsec about the centerline AB. Also, the member AB’?
shaft swings in the YZ plane at a speed w, of I radlsec. What is
the velocity and acceleration of point D on the platform at the
instant it is in the YZ plane, as shown in the diagram’?Note that at
the instant of interest AB is vertical.

I 1
Figure P.15.52 Figure P.15.54.

139
15.55. Slider A moves in a parabolic slot with speed i= 3 mis
and S = I mls' at the instant shown in the diagram. Cylinder E is
connected to A by rod AB.

(a) Find the angular velocity of cylinder E at the time of interest.

(h) Also, find the angular acceleration of cylinder E and rod AB a1


this instant

Figure P.15.56.

15.57. Find the velocity and acceleration 01the center o f A

\ = 2.5 111 /.: Y = Jx2


\
Figure P.15.57.

15.58. What is the angular velocity of rud Am! What is the mag-
nitude of the velocity 01point (' of rod AD'! Rod RC is vertical at
thr instant of iiiterest.

v = .6 rndr

Figure P.15.55.

-/

15.56. Find mA and i, ,


a1 the , shown. The following data
instant
v
apply:

K, = .3 m K, = .2 m <'/I = Cm V, = .2 mis

Disc A rolls without slipping. Figure P.15.58.

740
15.59. What are the angular velocities of the two rods? Slider A
has a speed of .4 d s e c , whereas slider C has a speed of 1.2 d s e c .

1.2 m/s

tj = 2 raddisec
8 = 3 radlsec'
t.2 m
I

A
Figure P.15.59.
Figure P.15.62.
15.60. In Problem 15.33, find the instantaneous center 0 of 15.63. A cylinder rolls without slipping. Develop a formula for
rotation for rod CB in the simplest possible manner. What is the ag in terms ofV,, v,),and R. Then get a formula fora, in terms of
speed of the midpoint of CB found using O? From Problem V,, Po, R, and d.
15.33, osc= 2.89 raUsec.

15.61. Find o& and 4 at the instant shown.

Figure P.15.63.
15.64. Two stationary half-cylinders I-- and I are shown, on
which roll cylinders G and H. If the motion is such that line BA
hdS an angular speed of 2 radlsec clockwise, what is the angular
speed and the angular acceleration of cylinder H relative to the
ground? The cylinders roll without slipping.

Figure P.15.61.

15.62. A bent rod is pinned to a slider at A and a cylinder at B. I

Find the velocity and acceleration of the slider at the instant -8.75' -4
depicted in the diagram. Figure P.15.64.

74 I
15.65. In Problem 15.64, :issum that cylinder G is rotating a1 a 15.68. Mcmher AH connect\ twu sliders I{ and H . If y8 = 5 mi\
speed o f 5 I-adiscc clockwise as seen from the ground. What i s the and V,, = 3 mi+. what are [u,4x and hA,,at the confiyuration
rpccd and intc 01 change 01 speed uf point C rclativc 10 thc shown'!
ground'? Assume that (no slipping OCCLIIS.

15.66. A wheel I1 01 radius K , = 6 in. rnti?les ill il sprcd [u, = 5


radlsec as shown A sccond wheel Cis connectcd ti) wheel I1 by COO-
necting rod AH. What is thc angular speed of whccl C a t the instant
ihmvn? TICradius K. = 12 in 'The wheel5 ire scparalrd hy a dis-
tancc d = 2 ft. At A and at H there are hall-and-socket cnnnectms.

I "1

X
.Y
Figure P.15.66. Figure P.15.68.

/ y 15.69. and a).,,(. Cylinder 11 rolls without slipping with


Find u,~"

Figure P.15.67. Figure P.15.69.

'42
SECTION 15.6 GENERAL RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN TIME DERIVATIVES OF A VECTOR FOR DIFFERENT REFERENCES 143

15.6 General Relationship Between Time


Derivatives of a vector for
Different References
In Section 15.4, we considered the time derivatives of a vectorA “fixed” in a
reference xyz moving arbitrarily relative to XYZ.Our conclusions were:

We now wish to extend these considerations to include time derivatives of a vec-


tor A which is not necessarily fixed in reference xyz. Primarily, our intention in
this section is to relate time derivatives of such vectors A as seen both from refer-
ence xyz and from XYZ, two references moving arbitrarily relative to each other.
For this purpose, consider Fig. 15.24, where we show a moving particle
P with a position vector p in reference xyz. ReferenFe xyz moves arbitrarily
relative to reference XYZ with translational velocity R and angular velocity w
in accordance with Chasles’ theorem. We shall now form a relation between
(dpldt), and (dpldr),, We shall then extend this result so as to relate the
time denvative of any vector A as seen from any two references.

Figure 15.24. xyz moves relative to XYZ


To reach the desired results effectively, we shall express the vector p in
terms of components parallel to the q z reference:
p = xi + y j + zk (15.11)
where i, j, and k are unit vectors for reference xyz. Differentiating this equa-
tion with respect tn time for the xyz reference, we have!

(1 5.12)

sNote that i, j , and 2 are time derivatives of scalars and accordingly there is no identifica
tion with any reference as far as the time derivative operation is concerned.
If we next take the derivative o l p w i t h respect to l i m e l o r the XYZ r e l -
erc~ice.we niust remember that i, j, and k of Eq. 15.1 I g c n c r d l y w i l l ciich hc
a function of time. since these tors w i l l generally have soinc rotational
motion relative f o the XYZ reterence. Thus, it diits arc used lor the time
derivatives:

(<e) =(.ii+ij+~k)+(,,i+?-J+;kj 115.13)


(If YY/

Thc unit \cctor i i s a bector,fi.w/ i n reference .!~K. and :iccordingly squills


w X i. The siiiiie conclusions apply to j and k . .The l a s t expression in paren-
can thcn I l C staled a s

lri + \-J + : k ) = x(w x i j + y ( w x j ) + :iw x k)


= w X ( x i )+ w X ( j j l + w X (;k) (15.14)
= w x i.ri + v,j + : k l = w x 1)

In Eq. 15.11 we can Ieplace (.ii + :j + t k ) b y (dpldtl,v:, in accordance


with Eq. 15.12. wid ( r i + y j + :k ) by w X p. i n accimlance with t<q.
15.14. Hence.

We c x i generalize the preceding rcsull fix any vector A :

(15.16)

15.7 Relationship Between Velocities of


a Particle for Different References
We shall now define the velocity of a particle again i n the presence o l
several references:

The velocity of a particle relative to a reference is the derivative as seen


from this reje,rcnce ufthe position vector of the
SECTION 15.1 RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN VELOCITIES OF A PARTICLE FOR DIFFERENT REFERENCES 745

In Fig. 15.24, the velocities of the particle P relative to the XYZ and the xyz
references are, respectively,Y

Since a vector can always be decomposed into any set of orthogonal compo-
nents, V,, can be expressed in components parallel to the x w reference at
any time t while y>z may be expressed in components parallel to the XYZ ref-
erence at any time t.
Now, we shall relate these velocities by first noting that
r =R i p (15.18)
Differentiating with respect to time for the XYZ reference, we have

The tcrm (dRldt),, is clearly the velocity of the origin of the xyz reference
relative to the XYZ reference, according to our definitions, and we denote this
velocity as R . The term (dpldt),, can be replaced, by use of Eq. 15.15, in
which (dpldt)tvzis the velocity of the particle relative to the xyz reference.
Denoting (dpldf)~rvi simply as yYz, we find that the foregoing equation then
becomes the desired relation:

(15.20)
We reiterate the understanding that w without subscripts represents the
angular velocity of xyz relative to XYZ. This w always goes into the last
expression of Eq. 15.20.
Note that in Sections 15.4 and 15.5 we considered the motion of two
particles in a rigid body as seen from a .single reference. Now we are consid-
ering the motion of a single particle as seen from two references.
The multireference approach can be very useful. For instance, we could
know the motion of a particle relative to some device, such as a rocket, to
which we attach a reference qz. Furthermore. from telemetering devices, we
know the translational and rotational motion (Chasles' theorem) of the rocket
(and hence x.yz) relative to an inertial reference X Z . It is often imponant to
know the motion of the aforementioned particle relative directly to the inertial
reference. The multireference approach clearly is invaluable for such problems.
We now illustrate the use of Eq. 15.20. We shall proceed in a particular
methodical way which we encourage you to follow in your homework prob-
lems. In these problems, we remind you the dot over a vector generally repre-
sents a time derviative as seen from XYZ.

"Generally, we have employed I as a position vector and p as a displacernenr vector. With


two references, we shall often use p to denote a position vector lor one of the references.
746 CHAPI'EK I S KINEMAIMX OF RIGID BODIES RELATIVF. MOTION

Example 15.8 Y
I
An aii-plane moving at 200 Itlsec is undergoing a roll of 2 radlmin (Fig.
15.25). Whcn the plane is horizontal, an antenna is moving out at a speed
of 8 filsec relative to thc plane and is at a position of 10 ft from the cen-
terline of thc plane. If wc assume that the axis of roll corresponds to the
centerline, what i s the vclocity of the antenna end relative to the ground
when the plane is horiz~intal'?
A srarionon rq'erencr XYZ on (he ground is shown in the diagram.
A moving reference xyz i,s@d 10 h e plunr with the x axis along the axis
of roll and the y axis collinear with the antenna. We announce this h r -
mally as f o l l ~ ~ w s :
Fi
Fi /
Z
We then proceed in the following manner: Figure 15.25. xyz fixed to plane: XYZ
fixed to ground.
A. Motion of particle (antenna end) relative to xyz'"
p = IOjft
V?vyL 8 j ft/sec

B. Motion of xyz (moving reference) relative to XYZ (fixed reference)


R = 200i mScc
w = - 2 i = - L i rad/scc
hn ill

We now employ Eq. 15.20 to get

v,, = vn; = R + w x p
= 8 j + 200i + (-&) x (I0.j)

..

,V = 2OOi + 8 j - ik ftlsec

Note lrom the preceding example that in Part A, we are using the
dynamics ut' a pluticle as presented in Chapters 11-14, while in Part B we are
implementing Chasles' theorem as presented in this chapter. Your author
based on long experience urges the student to work i n this methodical manner.
SECTION 15.7 RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN VELOCITIES OF A PARTICLE FOR DIFFERENT REFERENCES 141
Example 15.9
A tank is moving up an incline with a speed of 10 k m h r in Fig. 15.26. The
turret is rotating at a speed w, of 2 radlsec relative to the tank, and the gun
barrel is being lowered (rotating) at a speed o2of .3 rad/sec relative to the
turret. What is the velocity of point A of the gun barrel relative to the tank
and relative to the ground? The gun barrel is 3 m in length. We proceed as
follows (see Fig. 15.27).

A
A. Motion of particle relative to xyz
p = COS 307 + sin 30"k) = 2.60j + 1.50k m
Since p is fixed in the gun barrel, which has an angular velocity w2 rela-
tive to xyz, we have

V";z = ($1 xy7


= w2 x p = (- 3i) x (2.60j + 1.5k)

= -.780k + .45j mlsec


B. Motion of xyz relative to XYZ Figure 15.26. Tank with turret and gun
barrel in motion.
R = .65j
Since R is fixed in the turret, which is rotating with angular speed w I rel-
ative to XYZ, we have
R = w I X R = 2k X .65j = -1.3idsec
w = w , = 2k radlsec A

We can now substitute into the basic equation relating y~vr


to VxYz That is,
v, = VI?? + R + w x p
= (-,780k + . 4 5 j ) - 1.3i + ( 2 k ) X (2.60j + 1.50k)

This result is the desired velocity ofA relative to the tank. Since the tank is
moving with a speed of (10)(1,0OO)l(3,600)= 2.78 d s e c relative to the
ground, we can say that A has a velocity relative to the ground given as X
V,,,,,, = V,, + 2.781 Figure 15.27. xyz fixed to turret; XYZ
fixed to tank.
748 CHAPTEK 15 KINEMATICS 01’ RltilD BOIIIES: RELATIVE MOrlON

Example 15.10
A gunboat in heavy seas is firing its main battery (sec Fig. 15.28). The gun
barrel has an angular velocity w , relative to the tumet, while the turret has
an angular velocity w2 relative to the ship. If we wish to h a w the velocity
components of the emerging shell to bc zero in the slationary X and Z
directions at a certain specific Lime I. what should w , and u2he at this
instant? At this instant, the ship has a translational vclocity given as
VSJr,,,= .02i + ,016kmIs
Take the inclination o l t h e harrel to he 0 = 30”. Determine also the vcloc-
ity of the gun barrel tip A .

Figure 15.28. A gunboat i n heavy sea\ firing its main battery

We proceed to solve this problem by the following positioning of


axes shown on Fig. 15.28.

We can now procced with the detailed nnalysis of the prohlem

A. Mution of A relative to xyz


p = -(4)(.X66)j + (4)(.5)k = -3.464j + 2k m
V,,: = w , X p = w,i X (-3.4645’ + 2 k ) = -3.464w,k - 2 u , j i d s
SECllON 15.7 RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN VELOCITIES OF A PARTICLE FOR DIFFERENT REFERENCES 149

B. Motion of xyz relative to XYZ


R = -3jm
l? = w,k x (- 3j) + (.02i+ ,016k) = ( 3 0 , + .02)i+ .016k mls
w = o , k rad/s

We can now proceed with the calculations.

v, = V,,? + + w x P
= (-3.4640,k - 20,j) + (30, + ,023 + .016k + ( w , k ) x (-3.4641 + 2
= -3.4640,k - 20,i + 3 0 4 + .02i + .Olbk + 3.4640,i
:. V,, = (3w, + 3.4640, + ,023 + ( - 2 0 , ) j + (-3.4640, + .016)km/s

Let (V,,), = 0

.: 6.4640, = -.02

:. -3.464w, = -.016

In some of the homework problem diagrams, in the remainder of the


chapter, a set of axes *yz has been shown as a suggestion for use by the stu-
dent. This has been done to help clarify the geometry of the diagram. Also, if
the student chooses to use these axes helshe will be able to compare more
easily hisher solution with that of the author as presented in the instructor’s
manual. However, (and note this carefully) the student must decide indepen-
dently as to how to fa this reference and to state clearly as we have done in
the examples how this reference has beenfixed.
Also, we strongly urge the student to make careful clear diagrams and
to follow the orderly progression of steps (A. Motion of particle etc., etc.
followed by B. Motion of xyz etc., etc.).
15.70. A space lahimtory. in order lo \imultite gravity, rotata rcl- 15.72. A paniclc rotiitcs at a con\lJnt angular spced 01 I O
ative 10 inerlial reference X y 7 at a rate 0,. For occupant A to ieel ladlsec o n II platfwm. while thc pliltfimn roti~leswith a u m t i l i i t
comfonahle, what should W , he? Clearly, at the center room R, thcre imguliir \peed of SO radlsec 'thwt a x i s &A. What i s thc velocity
i s closc to ~ e r ogravity for rcro-i: enpcriments. A conveyor along of thr particle P ai rhc instant thc plallwm i c i n the X Y plan? and
One of the spokes transpart\ items from thr living quaiters at the the radius veclor t u the particle forms an ;ingle of 30" with the Y
periphery to the erwgravity Inbormrry at thc center. In pimicular, a iixis a s chow'.'
particlc D has a velocity toward R of 5 mlsec relalive to the space
s t a t i m What is irs velocity rclative to Ihe inertial rcference XYZ?

,
X'
Figure P.15.72.

15.73. A p l a t f o r r A IS mtiiting with wnstmt ;ingular \pecil (0)


01 I radlcec. A sccond platform H ride, on A. m n t i i i r i i a row ol
test tubes, and hac a con\tanr angular speed W , 01.2 I-adiw lrla-
t i v r to the platform A. A third platfkmm C i s in no way cunncctcd
with platfimns A and R. E < i n platfwm C ii positioned above A
Figure P.15.70 and tl and carries di\penszrs 01chcmicalb which are electrically
operated at pi~opel-times t o dispensc drops into the test tuhes held
15.71. Birdies ~iand h slide away from each other each with a hy R belrrw What shuuld the angular speed 0 , hc fnr platform E
:onstmt velocity OS 5 fllsec along thc axis C-C mountcd on a plat- at instant qhown if i t i \ t o dispense :I drop nf chemical having ti
lorn. The platfbrm rotatcs relativc to the ground rcfercnce X Y Z at zero 1;ingenlial vclocity r c l a t i w to the test tuhe helow?
m angular velocity of 1 0 radlscc ahout axis & E and ha?,ail angular
icceleration of S radisec' relarive 10 the ground relercnce XYZ at
!he time whcn the hodirs arc a t a distance r = 3 ft from E-E.
Determine thc vclocity if panicle h relative to the ground reference.

i
I
L

k. I
5 radl\ec'

IO radlsci

Figure P.15.73.

15.74. In an amiiscmerit park ride, the cixkpil containing iwo


occupants can mrarc at an angular spced rclativtl to the inain ann
OB. The illin can lnriite with angular spced W , rclativz t o the prr,und.
For the p s i t i o n shown in the diagrern and fbr W , = 2 radlccc
and W2 = .2 rurlisei.. i i n d thc velocity o f p r i i i i t A (corresponding
Figure P.15.71. to the position (if thc eyrs of an occupant) relalive t o the groun~l.

150
15.76. A tank is moving over rough terrain while firing its main
gun at a fixed target. The barrel and turret of the gun partly com-
pensate for the motion of the tank proper by giving the barrel an
angular velocity w , relative to the turret and, simultaneously, by
giving the turret an angular velocity w2 relative to the tank proper
such that any instant the velocity of end A of the barrel has zero
velocity in the X and Z directions relative to the ground reference.
What should these angular velocities be for the following transla-
Itional motion of the tank:

V,,,, = IOi + 4k mis

z XYZstationary

-1 b.65rn
Figure P.15.74.

15.75. A water sprinkler has .4 cfs (cubic ftlsec) of water fed


into the base. The sprinkler turns at the rate 0 ,of I radlsec. What
Figure P.15.76.
is the speed of the jet of water relative to the ground at the exits?
The outlet area of the nozzle cmss section is .75 in2. [ H i m The
volume of flow through a cross section is VA, where V is the 15.77. We can show that Eq. 15.6 is actudlly a special case of
velocity and A is the area of the cross section.] Eq. 15.20. For this purpose, consider a rigid body moving relative
to X Y Z . Choose two points a and h in the body. The body has a
translational velocity corresponding to the velocity of point a and
a rotational velocity w as shown in the diagram. Now embed a
reference xyz into the body with origin at point a. Next, use this
diagram and consider point h to show that Eq. 15.20 can be refor-
mulated to be identical to &. 15.6.

Top view
Figure P.15.75. Figure P.15.77.

75 1
752
15.85. In a merry-go-round, the main platform rotates at the
rate w , of 10 revolutions per minute. A set of 45" bevel gears
causes U to rotate at an angular speed 0 relative to the platform.
The horse is mvunted on AR, which slides in a slot at C and is
moved at A by shaft B, as indicated in the diagram, where part of
the merry-go-round is shown. If AB = 1 ft and AC = 15 ft,
compute the velocity of point C relative to the platform. Then,
compute the velocity of point C relative to the ground. Take 0 =
45" at the instant of interest. What is the angular velocity of the
horse relative to the platform and relative to the ground at the
instant of interest?
H
Im
Figure P.15.82.
15.83. A cone is rolling without slipping about the Z axis such
that its centerline rotates at the rate w , of 5 radlsec. Use a mul-
tireference approach to determine the total angular velocity of the
body relative to the ground.

X 4' +
Figure P.15.83.
15.84. Find the velocity of gear tooth A relative to the ground
reference XYZ. Note that W , and W2 are both relative to the
ground. Bevel gear A is free to rotate in the collar at C. Take W , =
2 radlsec and w2 = 4 radlsec.
2

Ai
I "

w2 = 4 rad/sec (b)
Figure P.15.84. Figure P.15.85.

753
15.86. Rod H O intales at a cntislant angular s p e d 0 o i 5 radlsec
clockwise. A collar A on thc rod i s pinned tn a slidcr C, which
moves in the groiwc shown i n the diagram. Whcn B = 60". corn-
pule the spced of the c o l l i i i ~A rclntivc io thz ground. What is (hi.
speed n i c o l l a r A rcliiti\c t n thc mil!

-I 1.6 111 I-
Figure P.IS.XX.

15.89. In Problmi I5.XX. a s u n l e , i n addition in the rotatimi ot


bar AD, that pin A i s moving at ii spced of 1.6 mlrec up the
gromrd incline.
I* I I)'
Figure P.IS.86. 15.YO. Rnd AC' i s cmnectud to il gear I ) and is guided by a
hearing R . Bcaring H can rntdte only i n the planc 01the p a r \ . I i
the mgular speed of AC i h 5 radlscc cluckwisc. whvt is the angw
.
1.'11 . bpced of gear I1 relative t o the gl-nund'! The diarneler of gcer
I1 is 2 ft.

15.87. Wurk Prohlem 1S.Xh assuming thiit pin 0 is mi I.IIIICIS


moving to thc right at ii speed of 3 ftlscc ireliltive to the gnrund. I n
addition, O R rotates at a cunstimt anpuliii~spced H oi 5 radlscc
clockwix all a1 the iiistanl of i n t c r \ t .

1S.XX. R o d A D rotale\ at :I conslilnt speed 4 o f 2 mdlscc. Col-


lar C. on the rod DA i h constrained to m o w in the circular
grno\'e shnun i n Ihe diagram. Whcn the rod is a1 thc porition
shown, compotc the \peed of colliir C' rclative to the gnmnd.
What i s the \peed of c o l l a r C reliitivc tn the rod AI).! Frlint /I i \
SECTION 15.8 ACCELERATION OF A PARTICLE FOR DIFFZRENT REFERENCES 755

15.8 Acceleration of a Particle for


Different References
The accrleration of a particle relative to a coordinate system is simply the
time derivative, a s s r m f r o m the coordinate .system, of the velocity relative to
the coordinarr system. Thus, observing Fig. 15.29, we can say:

(15.21)

~~

Figure 15.29. xyz moves arbitrarily relative to XYZ.

"his notation may at first seem cumbersome to you, but it will soon he sim-
plified.
Let us now relate the acceleration vectors of a particle for two refer-
ences moving arbitrarily relative to each other. We do this by differentiating
with respect to time the terms in Eq. 15.20 for the XYZ reference. Thus,

Now cany out the derivative of the cross product using the product rule.
756 CHAPTER 15 KINEMAIICX O F RIGID BODIES: RELATIVE MOTION

To introduce more phyyically mcaningful terms, we can replace

using Eq. 15.16 in the following way:

Substituting into Eq. 15.23, wc get

+ w x (w x p ) + (%IXYL p

You will notc that ( d V J d t i t J 2 is aY>:;that (dp/dtjrycis Vrvz;and that


(dw/dtj,yvzis 6.
Hence, rcarranging terms, we have

where w and 6 are the angular velocity and acceleration, respectively. of the
xvz reference relalive l o the XYZ reference. The vector 2(w x Vxvz) is called
the Cnrin1i.s nccdei-ntion \'error; we shall examine its interesting effects in
Section 15.10.
Although Eq. 15.24 may seem somewhat terrifying at first, you will
find that, by using it, prohlems that would otherwise he tremendously diffi-
cult can readily he carried ouI in a systematic manner. You should keep in
mind when solving problems thnt nny ($the methods developed in Chapter
I 1 ('nn be i i s ~ d . f i i rdetermining the motirin ofthe particle relntiue to the xyz
rpferencr or.for determining the motion nf the origin of x y i relative to the
XYZ re/krmce. We shall now examine several problems, in which we shall
use the notation, w,. w L ,etc.. to denote the various angular velocities
involved. The notalion, w (i.e., without subscripts), however, will we repeat
hc reserved to represent the angular velocity of the .I?:reference relative to
the XYZ reference.
SECTION 15.8 ACCELERATION OF A PARTICLE FOR DIFFERENT REFERENCES 151

Example 15.11
A stationary huck is canying a cockpit for a worker who repairs overhead fix-
tures. At the instant shown in Fig. 15.30, the base D is rotating at angular speed
o+ of .I radsec with 4 = .2 rad/secZrelative to the truck. Ann AB is rotating
at angular speed o1of .2 rad/sec with hl = .8rad/sec2relative to DA. Cockpit
C is rotating relative to AB so as to always keep the man upright. What are the
velocity and acceleration vectors of the man relative to the ground if a = 45'
and p = 30" at the instant of interest? Take DA = 13 m.
(4 6.

Figure 15.30.Truck with moving cockpit.

Because of the rotation of the cockpit C relative to arm AB to keep


the man vertical, clearly, each particle in that body including the man has
the same motion as point B of arm AB. Therefore, we shall concentrate our
attention on this point.

This situation is shown in Fig. 15.31.

A:! 1" x

Figure 15.31. xyz fixed to DA; X Y Z fixed to tmck

A. Motion of B relative to xyz


p = 3(cospi - s i n p j ) = 2.60i ~ 1.5jm
758 CHAPTER 15 KINEMATICS OF K l G l l I HOIIIES: K F I . A T I V F MOT10N

Example 15.11 (Continued)


Since Ii i s fixed in A f j . which ha? a ~ i gvclocity
~ ~ lw ~ , reliitive t o x ~we
, have

V b r=
~ w, X ti = (.ZkJX (2.6Oi - I . S j )
= ,520 i + 3; d s e c

As seen froin .r??, only thc valuc 111w , and not i t s direction i s changing.
Also note that (flpIdfJ~~:= yvT.Hence.
= ( . 8 k ) x (2.hOi ~ LSj) + ( . 2 k )X (.52OJ + 3)
= 1.OYi + 2.14j misec?
B. Motion of x y relative to XYZ
R = 13(.707i + ,707.j) = 9.1Yi + 9.19j in
Since R i s fixed in DA. and since DA rotates with angular velocity w, re1
ative to X Y Z we havc
R = w z x R = (.l,j)X ( 9 . I Y i + Y . l 9 j )
= -.9 19k in lhec
R = 61- x R + w, x R
= ( . 2 j ) X ( 9 . 1 9 i + Y . I S , j J + ( . I j ~ X (-.‘119k)
= -1.83Xk .O91Yim1sec2
~

w = w 2 = . Ij rad lsec
&= = .2jrad/sec2

Hence,
v,, = Vav: + R +w x p
= 320j + .3i ~ .919k + ( . l j )x (2.hOi ~ l3jJ

V,, = .3i + 3 2 0 j - 1.179kmlsec


..
a,, = a , v 7+ R + 2w X V,y: + & x p +w X (w X pJ
=1.O9i + 2.14j - 1.818k .0919i ~

+2(.l,j)x(.52Oj+.3i1+(.2j)X (2.60i-I.Sj)
+ ( . l j )x l ( . l j )X (2.60i- I . S j ) l

axlz = ,9781 + 2.14j - 2.42k mlsec?

Notice that thc cssenlial aspects of thc analysis come in thc consideration
of parts A and R of the problem, whilc thc remaining portion involves
dircct suhstitution and vector algehraic operations.
SECTION 15.8 ACCELERATION OF A PARTICLE FOR DIFFERENT REFERENCES 159

Example 15.12
A wheel rotates with an angular speed w2of 5 radlsec on a platform Z ?
which rotates with a speed wI of 10 rad/sec relative to the ground as
shown in Fig. 15.32. A valve gate A moves down the spoke of the wheel,
and when the spoke is vertical the valve gate has a speed of 20 ft/sec, an
acceleration of 10 ft/sec2 along the spoke, and is 1 ft from the shaft cen-
krline of the wheel. Compute the velocity and acceleration of the valve
gate relative to the ground at this instant.
to the platform.
Figure 15.32. qi fixed to wheel; XYZ
fixed to ground.

A. Motion of particle relative to xyz


p = kft
Vqz = -20k ft /sec

axYz
= -10k ft/sec2

B. Motion of xyz relative to XYZ


R = 5jft
Since R is fixed to the platform:
= w I x R = (-10k) x ( 5 j ) = 50ift/sec
= cb, X R + w , X k
= 0 + (-IOk) X ( 5 0 i ) = -500jft/sec2
w = w 2 + w I = 5 i - 10k radlsec
cb = h2+ d l

Note that w2 is of constant magnitude hut, because of the hearings of the


wheel, w2 must rotate with the platform. In short, we can say that w2 is
fixed to the platform and so h2 = w, x w2. Hence,
h = w1 x w2 + o
= (-10k) x ( 5 i ) = -50jrad/sec2

We then have
v, = vqz + k + w x p
= -20k + 50i + ( 5 i - 10k) x k

,v = - si -
760 CIlAPTIiR I S K1Nk:MA'IICS 01 K K i l l l HOIIIES: RFI.ATIVF MOT10ii

Example 15.12 (Continued)


Also,
flXYL = a"; + R + 2w x Vr1: + 6l x p +w x (W x p)
= -IOk - 5OOj + 2 ( 5 i - Ink) x
(-20k) + (-S0.j) x k
+(5i-IOk~X~(5i-1OklXk]

ax. = -1oOi - 300j - 35k ft/sec2


iI
_ _ _ _ .... ~. .. , ~ .__._ ......
._____._I" .. , , .,... . . . . ~ I.... I
,,

Example 15.13
In Example 15.12. thc wheel accelerates at thc instant under discushion
with f& = 5 radlscc'. arid the platlorn1 xccleriltes with Ui, = 10 firdlscc'
(see Fig. 15.32). Find the velocity and acceleration of the wl\,e gate A .
If wc rc\'icw the contents of parts A and B o f Example 15.12. i t w i l l
he clcar that only R and 6l are affcctcd hy the fact that Ui, = I O radlsec'
and ih2 = 5 radlsec'. 111 this regard, consider w2. It i s 110 longer oi con-
stant value and cannot he considered as.fi.wd i n the platform. However we
can express w, a s w j ' (11 ull tinim. wherein i' is,fi.wd i n the platform a s
shown i n Fig. 15.32. Thus, we cim say for w :
1 w = w,i' + wI
I !
Therelore.
6l = oj2i' + w,i' + 611
= S i ' + S(w, X i ' ) - IOk
=Si'+S(-lOk~xi'-lOk

A t the instant o i interest, i' = i . Hcncc.

6 = 51 - 5Oj - IOkrad/sec2

Hence. we usc the ahove 6l i n part H o f Exmaplc IS. I 2 to compute V,y,,


, and ax)./.Thc computation o f R is straightforward and so we can compute
i
~
oxy, accordingly, We lrave the details to the rcadcr.
SECTION 15.8 ACCELERATION OF A PARTICLE FOR DIFFERENT REFERENCES 761

An understanding of Examples 15.11, 15.12, and 15.13, involving two


angular velocities of component parts is sufficient for most of the homework
problems of this section covering a wide range of applications. In the next
example, we have three angular velocities to deal with. We urge you to exam-
ine it carefully if time allows. It is an interesting problem, and comprehension
of the three different analyses given will ensure a strong grasp of multirefer-
ence kinematics.

Example 15.14"
To simulate the flight conditions of a space vehicle, engineers have devcl-
oped the cenfi-ijzrge, shown diagrammatically in Fig. 15.33.A main arm,40 ft
long, rotates about the A-A axis. The pilot sits in a cockpit, which can rotate
about axis C-C. The sear for the pilot can rotate inside the cockpit about an
axis shown as R-R. These rotations are controlled by a computer that is set
to simulate certain maneuvers corresponding to the entsy and exit from the
earth's atmosphere, malfunctions of the control system, and so on. When a
pilot sits in the cockpit, hislher head has a position which is 3 ft from the seat
as shown in Fig. 15.33. At the instant of interest the main arm is rotating at 10
rpm and accelerating at 5 q m 2 . The cockpit is rotating at a constant speed
about C-Crelative to the main arm at 10 rpm. Finally, the seat is rotating at a
constant speed of 5 rpm relative to the cockpit about axis B-B. How many g's
of acceleration relative to the ground is the pilot's head subject to?I2 Note that
the three axes, A-A, C-C, and B-B, are orthogonal to each other at time 1.
A

A
Figure 15.33. Centrifuge for simulating flight conditions

"Example 15.14 was given as two homework problems in both the first and second
editions of this LCXI. They were so instructive thvt for aubsequent editions the author decided
ID move the problems into the main lext.
"A g 01 acceleration is an amount of acceleration equal to that of gravity (32.2 ftlsec'
or 9.81 misec'). Thus. a 4g ilcceleration is equivalent to an acceleration of 128.8 fUsec'.
162 CHAPTER 15 KINEMATICS O F RIGID BODIES: REL.ATIVCM O TIO N

Example 15.14 (Continued)


In Fig. 15.14 the arm O S the ccntriluge rolales relalive 10 the ground
at an angular vclocity i)C 0,.The cockpit meanwhile rotates relative to the
arm with angular s p e d wz. Finally, thc seat rotates rclativc to the cockpit
at an angular speed w,. For constant wz. we see that, bccause of bearings
i n the arm, thc vcctor w2 is "fixed" i n the ann. Also. Cor constant a?.
because of hearings in the cockpit. the vector o1i h '%sed" in the cockpit.
Before we examine the acceleration of the pilot's head. note that at the
instilnt of interest:

4
IZ

C Y

A
Figure 15.34. Ccnvilhge listing w's.

wI = w2 = 10 rpin = 1.048 rad/scc


&, = 5 rpm2 = .00873 rad/sec'
w,, = 5 rpin = 524 radiscc

We shall do this problem using three different kinds of moving


referenccs q z .

ANAI.YSIS 1

Fix nyz to ann.


Fix X Y Z to ground

Nolc in Fig. 15.35 that ~q?and the arm to which i t is fixed arc shown dark.
Notc also that the axes XY: and XYZ are parallcl to cach othcr at the instant
of interest.
SECTION 15.8 ACCELERATION OF A PARTICLE FOR DIFFERENT REFERENCES 163

Example 15.14 (Continued)


A

Figure 15.35. Centrifuge with xy; fixed to arm.

A. Motion of particle relative to xyz


p = 3kft
Note that p is “fixed” to the seat and that the seat has an angular velocity
of (w,- + w,) relative to the arm and thus to xyz. Hence,
Vxv: = ( w * + 0 , ) x P
= (l.048j + ,5241) X 3k = 3.141 - 1.572jftlsec

Clearly, relative to the ann, and thus toxyz, w2 is constant. And w, is fixed in
the cockpit that has an angular velocity of w2 relative to xyz. Thus, we have
= (0 + w* x w,) x P + ( w * + w,) x vmz
= (1.048j x ,5241) x 3k + (1.048j + ,5241) X (3.141 - 1.5721)
= -4.12k ft/sec2

B. Motion of xyz relative to XYZ


R = - 4Ojft
Note that R is fixed in the arm, which has an angular velocity w I relative
to XYZ. Hence,
k = wl X R = 1.048k X (- 40j) = 41.9iftlsec
k = wI X k + & , X R
= 1.048k X 41.9i + .00873k X (-4Oj)
= 43.95’ + 3 4 % ft/sec2
w = o,= 1.048k radlsec
& = &, = .00873k rad/sec2
764 CHAPTER 15 KINEMATICS OF K l ( i l l 1 ROnlES: RELATIVE MOTION

Example 15.14 (Continued)


We can now substilute into the following equation:

axyz = arvc+ R + 2w x Vav: + Cb x p +w x (w x p )

Thcrcfore.
ax,,/ = 3.64; + S0.Sj - 4.12k ftisec?

ANALYSIS I1

@xxyz to cockpit
XPIZ to ground.

This silualioii is shown in Fig. 15.36

,4 ... ,
Cockpit

Figure 15.36. Ccntrifuge with .XJ: lined til cockpit

A. Motion uf particle relative to xyz


p = 3k I t
Note that p i s llxed to the seat, which has an angular velociiy of wi rela
tive to thc cockpil and thus relativc LO xyz. Hence,
V>yr= wi X p = 324; X 3k = -1.572jftisec

But w3 i h ~ ~ r i ~ l iasl i sccn


it from [he cockpit and thus from xy;. Hence,
acv7= nx p + wi x v<\:= ,524; x (-1.572;)
= -.824k Stisec’
SECTION 15.8 ACCELERATION OF A PARTICLE FOR DIFFERENT REFERENCES 165

Example 15.14 (Continued)


B. Motion of xyz relative to XYZ. The origin of xyz in this analysis has
the same motion as the origin of xyz in the previous analysis. Thus, we use
the results of analysis I for R and its time derivatives.
R = -40j ft
R = 41.9i ft/sec
it = 43.9j + ,3491'ft/sec2
w = w I+ w 2 = 1.048j + 1.04% rad/sec
Ch = Ch, +Ch7

We are given &, about the Z axis and wz is fixed in the arm, which is
rotating with angular velocity wI relative to the XYZ reference. Hence,
6= + w, X w2 = .00873k + (1.048k X 1.048j)
= -1.098i + .00873k rad/secZ
We can now substitute into the key equation, 15.24:

axYZ =%yz + R + 2 w x Vqz + C h x p + w x (w x p )


= 3.64i + 50.5j - 4.12k ftlsec'

ANALYSIS 111

This situation is shown in Fig. 15.37.


z

Figure 15.37. Centrifuge with xyz fixed to seat.


166 CHAPTER I S KINEMATICS OF RIGID BODIES: KE1.ATIVE MOTION

Example 15.14 (Continued)


A. Motion of particle relative to xyz
p = 3k I t

Since the patticlc is fixcd to thc seat and is thuh fixed i n .XK. we can h a y :
vltc= n
a > , := 0

R. Motion ofxyz relative to X Y Z . Again. the origin olxy; has idenlically


the same motion as in thc prcviouc analyses. Thus. we have the samc
results as hefclre lor R and its derivatives.

R = -4Oj ft
R = 41.y; Itisec
+
i2 = 43.yj .MY; It/sec'
w = w , w,+ +
col = 1.04Xk + 1.04Xj + ,524;
lh = cb1 + l h 2 + h a

Note that h , is given. Also, w2 i h fixed i n the arm. which rolakcs with
angular speed w 1 rclalive to XYZ. Finally, w j is fixed iii the cockpit. which
has an angular vclucity w2 + w I relative to XYZ. Thus,

h = h 2 + w 1x w , + ( w I + w 2 ) x w i
+
= .00X73k (1.048k x 1.048j) + (1.048k + 1.04X.j) x 1.524;)
= -I.OYXi +
5 4 Y j ,540.k
~

Wc now go to the basic equation, IS 24

Substituting, we gel
axy7 = 3.64; + S O S j - 4.12k ltlsecz

In the final example o l this series, we have a case where it is advanta-


geous to use cylindrical coordinates in parts or thc problem arid lhcn latcr IO
convert to rectangular coordinate\.
SECTION 15.8 ACCELERATION OF A PARTICLE FOR DIFFERENT REFERENCES 161
Example 15.15
A submersible (see Fig. 15.38) is moving relative to the ground reference
XYZ so as to have the following motion at the instant of interest for point
A fixed to shaft which in turn is fixed to the submersible:
V = 3i + .6j mls
a = 2i + 3 j - .5k mls2

Figure 15.38. Rotating device inside a moving submersible. E is fixed to


the submersible.

At the instant of interest, the vessel has an angular speed of rotation ff =


.3 radls about the centerline of as seen from the ground reference. A
horizontal rod m has the following angular motion about m:
6= .3 rad/s 8 = .4 rad/s2
Two spheres, each of mass 1 kg, are mounted on a rod turning about m
with the following angular motion
fi = .2 radls fl = .5 radls2
Also, the rod and the attached spherical masses advance toward at the
following rate:
i. = -3 mls i' = -2 mlsZ
at a time when r = .25 m. Finally, at the instant of interest, the horizontal
rod moves up along vertical rod with a speed of .5 mls and a fate
of change of speed of .2 m/sZ. What force must rod exert at point G at
this instant due only to the motion of the two spheres?
768 CHAPTFK I S KI N EM A TI C S 01: RI G ID B O DIE S : I<ELATIVC MOTIOK

Example 15.15 (Continued)


We will first consider thc motion of the 1.ntter i f i i i ~ . sof~ the rotat-
in& spheres which cle;irly must hc G. We now proceed to ?el the accelel-a-
tion of G relative to X Y Z (see Fig. 15.3Y).

Fix xyz to the vessel at A.


Fix XYZ to the ground.

A. Motion of C relative to xyz (using cylindrical coordinates). Use Figs.


15.38 and 15.39.
p = ,256, = .25j in
Vn; = Pr, + rdr, + I 6 = - 3 E r + (.2S1L3Jre+ .?E
= - 3j - ,075+ .Sk = -.I175 - 3 j + .Sk m / s

= ( y - ~ B ' I E+ ~(rii + 2 f B ) t , +

= [- 2 -- ( . 2 ? ) ( . 3 ) ' ] € ,+ [(.251(.4)
+ (2)(-3I(.3l]rfl+ . 2 t ~
= -2.0236, - 1.7~"+ . 2 t ~= I.7i - 2.023j + .2k m i s ?

B. Motion ofxyz relative to X Y Z


R = 3i + .hj m/s
R = 2i + 3 j - .Sk mis?
w = .3k rndis
&I = n radis'

We may now express a x y , lor point G. Thus

a x y z= u t > :+ R + 2w x v,,:+ 6 x p + w x ( w x pl
= (1.7i- 2.023j + . 2 k ) t (2i + ? j - . 5 k ) + 2 ( . i k )
X (-.075i- i j + . S k ) + 0 x 11 + (.RkJ x ( . 3 k x . 2 5 j )

= 5 . 5+ .909?j - .3k m/s2


Now we apply Newton's law to the inass ccntcr G at the imtmt of inter-
csl. Denoting the force fr0m the rod AD onto <; a s F,,,,,,. WL' get
F,,(,,)- 2 m g k = 5 . 5 + .YrOOSj - .3k
:. = (2lil)(Y.8llk + 5 . 5 + .YOY5j - .3k

FROD
= 5.5 + ,90953+ 19.32kN

This is our desired result


15.91. A truck has ii speed V of 20 milhr ;md an acceleration $ 15.95. In Problem 15.74, find the accelcration of pointA relative
of 3 milhrlsec at time I. A cylinder of radius equal tu 2 St is rolling to the ground.
without slipping at time f such that relative to the truck it has an
angular speed LO, and angular acceleration (6, of 2 radlsec and I
radlsec’, respectively. Determine the velocity and acceleration of 15.96. In Prohlem 15.79. find the acceleration of the tip of the
thz center of the cylinder relative to the ground. propeller relative to the ground reference. Take the yaw rotation to
be zero and the loop rotation radius r tu he 500 m.

15.97. In Problem 15.80, find the acceleration of point R relative


to the ground.

15.98. In Problem 15.80, find the ilccelcriltiun of paint LI relative


Figure P.15.91.
t u the ground for the fdlowing data at the instant of interest
sliowri i n the d i a p m t .

15.92. A wheel rotates with an angular speed o2of 5 radlsec CO, = .2 radlsec
relative lo a platform, which rotates with a speed wI of 10 raUsec o j = -.Iradkec’
relative to the ground as shown. A collar moves down the spoke w2 = .4 radlsec
of the wheel, ;md, when the spoke is vertical, the collar has a 2;[ = .3 radlsec?
speed of 20 ftliec, an acceleration of 10 Stlsec2 along the spoke.
and is positioned I ft from the shaft centerline of the wheel. Cam-
pute the velocity and acceleration of the collar relative to the
15.99. In Prohlem 15.82, determine the acceleration of the top
ground at this instant. Fix xyz to platform and use cylindrical coor-
tip of the gun relativc to the ground.
dinates.

15.100. In Problem 15.74, find the acceleration of point A rela-


tive tu the ground for the contiguration shown. Take w , = 2 radlsec
~, = 7 radlsec’. wi = . I radlsec, and h2 = 2 radlsec’. How
inany g’s of acceleration is this puinl subject to?

15.101. I n Prohlem 15.81, find the acceleration o S 0 relative to


the ground. IHbrr; Use two pvsitivii vectors to get p.1

Figure P.15.92. 15.102. Find the accelcration of gear tooth A relative to the
ground in Problem 15.84.

15.93. In Problem 15.71, determine the acceleration of the part-


cle at the instant uf interest. 15.103. In Problem 15.92, the wheel accelerateq at the instant
under discussion with 5 radlsec2 relative to the platform, and the
nlatform increases itb aneular meed at 10 radlsec’ relative to the
15.94. In Problem 15.72, find the acceleration of the particle P ground. Find the velocity and acceleration of the collar relative to
relative to the ground reference. the ground.

169
15.104. As uilli llie vrlucily e q u a l ~ ~15.20.
r w e can easily show
thatEq. 15.1. relating i i c ~ e l e r ~ t i ~hctuccn
ns t w o points 011 il rigid
body, is actuiilly a \pccial case u l Eq. 15.24. Thus, conridcr Ihc
diagiim showing it rigid body moving arhitiarily r e l a t i w tu XYZ.
C h o o x t w > p o i n t h c r arid h i n the body a n d cnihed a refrrrncc r?;
in the body w i l h thc origjji at ( i . Nom cxpresb the acceleratirm of
p i n t h as x e n from the t w o relerences. Shmu horn, this equalion
can bc rcfwmulutcd a\ I?+ 15.7.

Figure P.15.108.

*15.109. I n Exilmplt' 15.14. \uppose at thz ilistiult of illtcrest


that lherr i \ an angular acceleration ih, = 3 radlsec2 of the cockpit
d a t i v e til thc a m and that tlirre i s an ;in&!uI:u ncceleratioii ih8 = .2
vadliec' 01the seat iclntive to the cockpit. Find the number o f p ' s
ti) which the pilot's head i s subjected. Follow analysis 1 in the
exaniple. [Hinr: The angular vclncily w , can idways bc c x p l - ~ h ~ d
X a\ w,f, where E is a unit vector fixed io rhc cockpir having a d i r e c ~
liigure P.15.104. tioii along the ~rax(\ iit the in&timlnl interest.1

15.I05. Solve Pniblcm I . X I lor the fnllowing data 15.110. A fin-is wheel is out 01contn)l. At the iiiitilnt shuwn, i t
IO, = .3 r;rdi\ec has an angular speed u1equal ti1 .Z radlsec and a rillr of change of
&J, = .zlrad/sec' angular speed G, of SI4 redlsec' i r ~ l a l i v eti1 the ground. At this
iiJ-= .JOr;ld/XC in~ianta "chair" hhuwn i n the diagram has 311 angular %peedu,
61, = .1l1radlsr.c' relative to the terris wheel equal to 2 5 radlsec nnd a rate chanfe
w; = . I S radlsec ofspccd 6,. again relative to the fenii wheel. equal to .(I1radlsrc'.
cb2 = .2 I-adkc' 111 thc figure, wc have hhown details of the parmiyel~at t h i s

instant. Note that the hingc of the seat i s at A . How many ,q'\ of
15.106. 111 Problem IS.X2. find the i.rrmpnnent 01 acceleriitioti acceleriltiun i s the passenger's head subject Id
of the prrijectilc d a t i v e to the grouiiil which I S normal to the gun
Y
hamel at the itistiint that the pr,,jeclili. ju.1 Isilvcs the bnrrel. IJse
thc lollowing dillii:
iu, = .3 r ~ < l l \ c c 1I11
i J , = .2 rad/scc'
(0, = -.h I-adiscc
ih, = -.4 rad/sx' x

15.107, In Pmhlcm 15.XX. find Ihe magnitude of the


<' w l a t i w t o the ground Cor thc fr>llowing data at the
tion of c o l l i u
instant ~ W I I :
H = 2 radlscc
ii = 5 r;!d/scc'
Figure P.15.110.
15.108. A truck is mwing at ii constant specd V = 1.7 mlscc at
t i m e I . 'Ihr truck Ionding comparlnimt has at thic instant a constaiit 15.111. A shalt IK' mtates ielatiLe t i l platform A iit a spccd
;mgular speed H 01 . I radlicc at an anglc H = 45". A cylinder of = 3 4 radlsec. A rod is wclded 10 HC'and is vertical iu the instanl
radius 100 nim rolls ielalivu 10 the compartment at a speed w , of interest. A tube i s fixed to the vertical rod in which a small pis-
o i I I-adkc. accelerating at a rate ih, of .5 ladlsec' at time r. What ton head is moving rclative to the tube at a speed V uf 3 inlicc wilh
are the velocity and accclerilti~iiiof the ccnter 01Ihr cylinder rela- a rate uf change of speed V o l .J mlscc'. Thc platfirm A has an
t i v e til the ground at t i m e I ? The distaicc d ut tiinc i i s 5 (11. angular velocity relative to the ground givw as w, = .X radlstc

770
with a rate o f change of speed of .5 radlsec2. Find the acceleration 15.113. A particle moves in a slot of a gear with speed V = 2
vector of the piston head relative to the ground. mls and a rate of change of speed = 1.2 mls2 both relative to
the gear. Find the acceleration vector for the particle at the coniig-
"ration shown relative to the ground reference X Y Z
Z
V = 3 m/sec
V = .4 rnlsec' 1REL TO
TUBE
w , = .34 radlsec 1 REL TO A
o2= .8radlsec
'u,= .5 rildlszc' 1REL TO
GND.

XJ' x'
Figure P.15.111.
V = 2 m i s relative to gear
15.112. A communications satellite haa the following motion V = 1.2 m/s2 relative to gear
relative to an inertial reference XYZ. w , = ,118 radls
W , = ,112 radls'
w, = 3i + 4j + 10kradIs d , = 2i + 3kradls: r =.15m
y ) = a() = 0 Figure P.15.113.

A wheel at A i s rotating relative to the satellite at a constant sped w2


= 5 radls. What i s the acceleration of p i n t 0 on the wheel relative 15.114. A submarine i s undergoing an evasive maneuver. At the
to XYZ at the inatant shown'?The following additional data apply: instant of interest, i t hds a speed = 10 m l i and an acceleration
u,, = I S mls' at i t s center of mass. I t alsti has an angular velocity
U A = I rn A D = .2 m about its center of mass C of o, = .5 radls and an angular accel-
eration 6,= .02 radls'. Inside is a part of an inertial guidance
Z
system that consists of a wheel spinning with speed w2 = 20
radls about a vertical axis of the ship. Along a spoke shown at the
instant of interest, a particle i s moving toward the center with r, i-
and ?as given in the diagram. What i s the acceleration of the par-
ticle relative to inertial reference XYZ? Just write out the formula-
tions for nXYZbut do not carry out the cross products.

-Y

the
time I
Figure P.15.112. Figure P.15.114.

I11
15.115. Find V a n d a 01 H ielillivr 111 XYZ. The single blade p w
lion AB i s rutating as shown relative tu the helicoprer with \peed U J ~
about an axis parallel to theXaxi\ at the iiistnnt 01intercst while the
cntire blade sysiem i s rotating about the veitical axis with spccd 0,

,
i,U),

x ,L
Cmund relerence

Figure P.15.115.

15.116. A n F-lh fightcr plane i\ moving at a c o i i i t m ~s p e d o i


S O 0 kinlhr while undergoing a loop a\ \hrrwn in !lie diagram. At
the instant of interehl, i t has an angular roll vclociry w-. 01 5
radlmin relativr 10 thc ground. A solenoid i s aclivaled :it this
iiislilnt and miwcs the m n i n g portion o f a pate v a l ~ cd~wnw:irdat
.I speed ot 3 mi\ with iiii a ~ ~ e l e r ~ t of n m / s L all rcI:itive 1n thc
iii5
~lilnr.What i h the tolal external force on the moving piwtinn nf
:he gale valve if i t i s 1 n, abuvr the axis of roll ill the instant 01
interest? 'She moving portiun nf the Y$\C har il wcight r r f IO N .

Figure P.15.1 I 6

15.1 17. A robot innves a body held by its ",jaws" G a s shown i n


he diagram. WhaL i s the velocity and acceleration of point A at
he instant shown r e l a t i ~ e10 the glound? Ami EH i\ welded to the
ierlicill shaft MN. Arm H K G i s i w e rigid mcmher which rotate5
ibout EH. How do you want to fir .tr..-'l Figure P.15.118.

772
SECTION 15.9 A NEW LOOK AT NEWTON'S LAW 113

"15.9 A New look at Newton's l a w


The proper form of Newton's law has been presented 2s
F =m
aX Y Z (15.25)

where the acceleration is measured relative to an inertial reference. There are


times when the motion of a particle is known and makes sense only relative to
a noninertial reference. Such a case would arise, for example, in an airplane
or rocket, where machine elements rnust move in a certain way relative to the
vehicle in order to function properly. Therefore. the motion of the machine
element relative to the vehicle is known. If, however, the vehicle is undergo-
ing a severe maneuver relative to inertial space, we cannot use Eq. 15.25 with
the acceleration of the machine element measured relative to the vehicle. This
is so since the vehicle is not at that instant an inertial reference, and to disre-
gard this fact will lead to erroneous results. In such problems, the motion of
the vehicle may he known relative to inertial space, and we can employ to
good advantage the multirefeience analysis of the previous section. Attaching
the reference xyz to the vehicle and X Y Z to inertial space, we can then use
Newton's law in the following way:

F = in[anL + k + 2w X Vry,:+ ri, X p +w X ( w X p ) ] (15.26)

Clearly, the bracketed expression is the required quantity aXYZneeded for


Newton's law. It is the usual practice to write Eq. 15.26 i n the following
form:

F - m[R + 2w X V, +itX p + o

This equation may now be considered as Newton'a law written for a norriner-
rial reference xyz. 'The terms -rrr -m(2w x VXyJ and so on, are then con-
sidered as forces and are termed inertial fiirces. Thus, we can take the
viewpoint that for a nonineitial reference, xyz, we can still say force F equals
mass times acceleration, a_z,provided that we include with the applied force
F . all the inertial forces. Indeed, we shall adopt this viewpoint in this text.
The inertial force --2mw X yvz is the very interesting Coriolis furce, which
we shall later discuss in some detail.
'The inertial forces result in haftling actions that are sometimes contrary
to our intuition. Most of us during our lives have been involved in actions
where the reference used (knowingly or not ) has heen with sufficient accu-
racy an inertial reference, usually the earth's surface. We have, accordingly,
become conditioned to associating an acceleration proportional to, and in the
same direction as, the applied force. Occasions do arise when we find our-
selves relating our motions to a reference that is highly noninertial. For exam-
ple, fighter pilots and stunt pilots carry out actions in a cockpit of a plane
while the plane i s undergoing severe tnnneuucrs. Llnexpected i e w l t s l i e -
queiitly occur for flyers il thcy use thc cockpit interior as a reference I i r their
iictioiis. Thus. to nime their hatids from m e posiliiin t o ;iniilhcr relative to t i i t
circkpit siimctinics rcquires :in exertion that i k iiot thc (me anticipated. caiisitif
concidcrahlc conlusioii. The next cxaniple w i l l illustrate thi\. and the scctiwis
that follow w i l l cxplorc further some of these interesting efI'ccts.l3

Example 15.16
The plan view of a routing platfiirni i s shown in Fig. 15.40. A tiiiiii i s
seated at the Iposition Iiihclcd A and i s facing point 0 or the platform. He i\
carrying ti nia% of j\, sliig at (lie late of 10 I l l i c c in ii dircctiiin strxight
ahead of liiiii (i.c.. Iiiward the center of. the plallorm). If this platform has
an angular spccd of 10 radlsec and an angulx acceleration of 5 r;idisz$
rcliilivc to ~ h cground at thi, instiitit, what Ixce F niiist he exert to cause
thc mass tii accelerate 5 tilsecz toward tlic center?
Y. !

Figure 1540. Rutating plnrfonn

For purposts of deteitnining iiicrtiiil force\, wtl pnicced a s fiillcw\:

Fix q z to platform.
Fix XYZ to ground.
SECTION 15.9 A N E W LOOK A T NEWTON’S LAW 115

Example 15.16 (Continued)


A. Motion of mass relative to xyz reference

p = 10ift, V,, = -1Oi ftlsec, a = - 5i ft/sec2


wz

B. Motion of xyz relative to XYZ

k = 0, k = 0, w = -10k radlsec, ch = -5k rad lsec2

Hence,
-Si + 2 ( - l O k ) x ( - l O i ) + ( - S k ) x
aXYZ= 1Oi +(-lOk)x(-lOkXIOi)

Therefore,
a,, = -Si + (200j - 5Oj - 1,OoOi)
Employing Newton’s law (Eq. 15.27) for the mass, we get
F - h ( 2 0 0 j - 5Oj - 1,OOOi) = $(-5i)
Solving for F, we get
F = 3j -20. li Ib
This force F is the total external force on the mass. Since the man must
exert this lorce and also withstand the pull of gravity (the weight) in the -k
direction, the force exerted by the man on the mass is

If the platform were not rotating at all, it could serve as an inertial


reference. Then, we would have for the total external force F’:
F’ L
so( - 5 i ) = -‘iIb
IO

The force exerted by the man, FLan,is then

This force is considerably different from that given in Eq. (a).


As a matter of interest, we note that aviators of World War I were
required to carry out such maneuvers on a rapidly rotating and accelerating
platform so as to introduce them safely to these “peculiar” effects.
HOI)II:S K l i l ATIVR M O I I O N

*15.10 The Coriolis Force


0 1 ' gre;it inicrc\t i\ tlie Coriolis liircc. dclined i n Scctiiin l5.cl. particularly as
i t relates IO cei&iin terrestrial actiwis. For iiiaiiy of our Iiroblenis. thc cilrth's
curf:lce serves with wfficielit iiccuriicy :IS 311 inertial I-efcrcnce. Howcccr.
where Lhe tiiiie i n t e n d of interest i s largc (such as in the llight of rockcth. or
the l l o w 111 rivers. o i the ino\cincnt of winds a n d ocriiii currents). we inuct
consider such :I relcrcn 15 iionimr1i:iI i n cei-tiiiii iiislanccs ;ind accordingly.

when using Newton's law. w e inus1 include \<)meor iill of the inertial forces
given in Et]. 15.27. For \uch prohlenis ( t i \ you will recall Iron1 Chiiptcr I I. n e
o l t c i i iise iui incrtiiil rclerencc that lias iin origin ill the center o l t h e earih ( x c
Fig. 15.41) with tlie L i i x i s c ~ i l l i n c i i rwith ttic K S axi\ of the cartli u i d 1110~-
ing cuch that the cartli r<itate\ m e rcvoluliiiii Ipcr 24 hr rekitive to the refer-
ence. Thus. tlic relkrence appr(i;iches :I tran\liiliiry niotimi iilxiut the sun. TIIii
high ilcprrr of accuracy. il i s iui inertiiil rclcrcnce.
We start hy considering particles tliiit iiic stiitioiiiiry rcliitive to thc c x t h
We cliomc ii relerence .xy: l'ixed to the earth ill the cquntor a s shown i n Fig.
11.12. The aiiguliir \ c l o c i t y i i l ' f ~ i x e d~;uiy\vlici-e
~ on the cilrth". curlacc cim
rc;idily he c\,iiluiitcd ;is follmv~:

, tlie lbriri o l Eq. IS.27. loi ii "stationary" particle positiiined


i V w r o i i '.s ~ u w in
ill tlie origin o f ~ r : ~ :\iniplilicc to

F - mn = 0 (IS.?X)

\itice 11. V , , , , and a , , : :ire zcro ceclors:. I,cl 11' next cv:iIuatc the inertial force.
-mR. lor the particle. usins R = 3.960 ]mi:

-tiin = iri(i.')h0)(5.2801(1.27x ll)F5)',j


= ~.,iil-JR'(uL,j)
/ = ,U.I l(l51.j I17
I

C l e x l y . [hi\ ii ii "centriiugiil Iirce." iis we learned in physics. Note i n Fig.


15.13 that llic direction of t h i s fiirce i s collineai- L c i h thc gr:ivitiitiiinal forcc
on ii particle. hut with opposite sense. Note lurthel- thiit tlic centriiugxl force
Iiiis ii magnitude that is (.I 1115 ml32.2 nij x 101i = 31% of the grabitational
it the iiiilicalcd location. Thus. clearly. i n the u u a l engineering [itoh-
Iciiis. such cftcctr iiic iicglcctcd.
A\sumc that the p;~rliclei s restriiined lriim rcctinf (111 the s u ~ f i ~ ofc e thc
ciiith by a tlexihlc col-d. 111 iiccordance with E q 15.28. the exieriial fol-ce I'
( w h i c h include\ gra! itatioiial iitlriiclioii aid the fiircc lIwn Ihe cord) and thc
centrilufal lwce -rriR add up l o L ~ W and , licnce these Ibrces are in e l p i l i b -
riiini. They arc shuwn i n Fig. 15.13 i n which T reprcscnts the contribution 01
SECTION 1.5.10 THE CORIOLIS FORCE 777

the cord. Clearly, a force T radially out from the center of the earth will
restrain the particle, and so the direction of the flexible cord will point toward
the center of the earth. On the other hand, at a nonequatorial location this will
not be true. The gravity force points toward the center of the earth (see Fig.
15.44), but the centrifugal force-now having the value m[R(sin @ ) 0 2 ] -
points radially out from the Z axis, and thus T. the restraining force, must be
inclined somewhat from a direction toward the center of the earth. Therefore,
except at the equator or at the poles (where the centrifugal force is zero), a
plumh hoh does not paint directly toward the center of the earth. This devia-
tion is very sinall and is negligible for most but not a11 engineering work.

Figure 15.45. Free fnll at the equdtor.


S
Figure 15.44. Plumb bob doe\ not point to center of Cdlth

Consider now a body that is held above the earth’s surface so as to


always be above the same point on the earth’s surface. (The body thus moves
with the earth with the same angular motion.) If the body is released we have
what is called a.frer,fall.The body will attain initially a downward velocity
Figure 15.46. Direction uf Coriolis forcc.
Vtvz relative to the earth’s surface (see Fig. 15.45). Now in addition to a cen-
trifugal force described earlier, we have a Corioh,forcr given as

In Fig. 15.46 we have shown the w and vectors. The Coriolis force milst
point to the right as you should verify (do not forget the minus sign). If we
dropped a mass from a position in q z above a target, therefore, the mass as a
result of the Coriolis force would curve slightly away from the target (see
Fig. 15.47) even if there were no friction, wind, etc., to complicate matters.
Furthermore, the induced motion in the x direction itself induces Coriolis-
force components of a smaller order in they direction, and so forth. You will
surely begin to appreciate how difficult a “free fall” can really become when
great precision is attempted.
Finally, consider a current of air or a current of water moving in the Figure 15.47. Primary Coriolis effect on frrec
Northern Hemisphere, In the absence of a Coriolis force, the iluid would fall.
778 CHAPTER I S KINEMATICS OF KKilD BODIES: KFl.ATIVf MOTION

move in the direction o l the pressurc drop. I n Fig. 15.48 the pressure drop has
been shnwn for simplicity along a meridian line pointing toward the equator.
For fluid motion in thi? direction. a Coriolis force will he present in the nega-
tivc J direction and so the tluid will follow the dashed-line path RA. The
prinie induced motion i a to tlie right ot tlie direction of tlow developed by the
pressure alone. By similar argument. you can demonstrate that, in the South-
ern Hcmisphere. thc Coriolis force induces a motion to the left of the flow
lhat would he present under the actinn of the pressure drop alone. Such
effects are of significance in meteorology and oceanography."

S
Figure 15.48. C'ilridis c f f r c l on wind.

44L+7 The concli~sin~is i n Ihc preceding paragraph explain why cyclones and
whirlpools rotate in ii counterclockwise dircction in thc Northern Hemisphere
and ii clockwise direction in thc Southern Hemisphere. In nrder to start, ii
whirlpool in cyclone needs a low-pressure region with pressure increasing

yy\ ~rcssurrdrop radially oulward. The pressure drops are shown ah full line\ in Fig. 15.49. For
such a prcssure distrihulion. the air will begin to niovc radially inward. As
thih happen?. the Coriolis force causes the Iluid in the Northern Hetnispherc
to swerve to the right of i t s motion. as indicated by the dashed lines. This
irewll i s the heginning o l a counterclockwisc motion. You can readily demon-
Figure 15.49. Heginning of q!hirlpuol. strate (hiit in the Southern Hemisphere a clockwisc rotation will be induced.
15.119. A reference xyz is attached to a space prohe, which
has thc fallowing motion relative to an inertial reference X Y Z
at a time I when the corresponding axes of the references arc
t> u j = 5 radlsec'
parallel: e w , = IOradIsec
o2= 15 radsec
R = 100jm/sec2
w = 101' radsec
6 = -8k rad/sec2

If a force F given as

F = 500i + 200j -3OOk N


Figure P.15.121.
acts on a particle of mass I kg at position

p = .Si + Ij m 15.122. In Problem 15.91, what is the total external force acting
on the cylinder for the CdSe when
what is the ac~elerationvector relative to the probe'? The panicle
has a velocity V relative to xyz of v = 5 ftlsec
V = -2 ft/sec2
V = IOi + 20j d s e c w, = 2 radlsec
h, = 1 rad/sec2'?

The mass of the cylinder is 100 Ibm

15.120. In the space prohe of Prohlem 15.1 19, what must the 15.123. A truck is at speed v of 10 ,,,i1hr. A
velocity vector Vr,,:of the particle be to have the acceleration crane AB is at time t at 0 = 45" with 0 = I radlsec and e = .2
rad/sec2. Also at time f, the base of AB rotates with speed 0 , = I
a,&\:= 495.21' + lO0j dsec' radlsec relative to the truck. If AB is 30 ft in length, what is the
axial force along AB as a result of mass M of 100 Ihm at B?
if all other conditions are the same? Is there a component of yvz
that can have any value for this problem?

15.121. A mash A weighing 4 oz is made to rotate at a constant


angular speed of wz = 15 radkec relative to a platform. This
motion is in the plane of the platform, which, at the instant of
interest, is rotating at an angular speed 0 , = I O radlsec and
decelerating iit a rate of 5 radisec2 relative to the ground. If we
ncglect the mass of the rod supporting the mass A, what are the
axial force and shear force at the base of the rod (i.e., at O)? The
rad at the instant of interest is shown in the diagram. The shear
force is the total force acting on a cross-section of the member in
-
a direction trtngent io the section. Figure P.15.123.

715
"
.,,-
".I .. . ......___^__I.

15.124. An cxplaratory pmhc shot from the earth ii rettoning 10


the earth. On cntzring the earth'\ atmnrpherr, i t ha* a conqtanl angw
lar velocity coniponent (ti, of IO radlscc ahorit an axis nonnnl I n thr
page and a conslatit comprment n i , of SO radlscc ahout the Lertical
axis. The velocity of the pinbe at thc timc of interest i s I.300 mlsec
vertically downward with a decclcration of I60 mlsec'. A wm11
sphcre i s rotating ill w, = 5 radlsec inside the pnrhc, as s h o w n At
the time of intcrect, the prnhe i s orientrd sn that the trajectory [ifthe
sphere in the probe is in the plane of the page and the arm i s \icrticaI.
What are the axial force 111 the arni and the hending mirinenr nl i t \
h a w (neglect the mass of the arm) at thi\ instant of time, if the sphel-c
has a mass of 300 p'! (The hending moment i s the cniiple rniinicnt
acting on the c m s ~section of the hear".)

Figure P.15.124.
I
15.125. A river flows at 2 ftlsec avei~agev r l x i t y i n Ihe Norlhi.iii
Hemisphere at a latitude 0140" in the north -roulh direction. What
i s the Coriolis acceleration of the walrr relative to the ccntcr of
the earth'?What i s the Coriolir: force on I lhin 01 watcr?

m ~= 7,'JLO
t ~ ~ ~ ~rzmh ~ ~ ,111
c r ~ ~ l
Figure 1'.15.125.
15.126. A clutch aswmhly i s shown. R o d < A H are pinned Iu a
disc at H, which Tolate\ at an a n p l n r speed w , = I radlsrc and
i i , = 2 radlsec' at time I . .These rods extend lhnwgh a roil EF,
which rotates with the rods and at the same time i s moving to the
left with a speed 1'01 I mlsec. At the instant ?hewn. corresprmrl~
ing to time f, what i s the axial Iurce o n the niemher AH a c a result
of the motion of particle A having a niass o f .h kg'?

7x0
SECTION 15.11 CLOSURE 781

15.11 closure
In this chapter, we first presented Chasles' theorem for describing the motion
of a rigid body. Making use of Chasles' theorem for describing the motion of
a reference xyz moving relative to a second reference XYZ, we presented next
a simple but much used differentiation formula for vectors A .fixed in the ref-
erence xyz or a rigid body. Thus,
(--)
dA = w X A
XYZ

where w is the angular velocity of xyz or the rigid body relative to XYZ.
We next considered two points,fi.red in a rigid hody in the presence of
a single reference. We can relate velocities and accelerations of the points
relative to the aforementioned reference as follows:
'1, yz + PCih
a,, = a<z+ b X +0X (w x pnh)

where w is the angular velocity of the body relative to the single reference.
These relations can he valuable in studies of kinematics of machine elements.
We then considered one particle in the presence <$two r e f e r e n i z ~v z
and XYZ. We expressed the velocity and acceleration as seen from the two
references as follows:

v,, VXFZ+ + w x P
=
a X Y Z= alii + ii + 2w x vxYz
+bx p+w x (w x p)

In computing y~sc, R, and R, we use the various techniques pre-


sented in Chapter I I for computing the velocity and acceleration of a particle
relative to a given reference. Thus, use can be made of Cartesian components,
path components. and cylindrical components as presented in that chapter.
We then explored some interesting and often unexpected effects that occur
when we use a noninertial reference.
You will have occasion to use these twn important formulations in your
basic studies of solid and fluid mechanics as well as in your courses in kine-
matics of machines and machine design.
Now that we can express the motion of a rigid body in terms of a veloc-
ity vector R and an angular velocity vector w, our next job will he to relate
these quantities with the forces acting nn the body. You may recall from your
physics course and from the end of Chapter 14 that for a body rotating about
a fixed axis in an inertial reference, we could relate the torque T and the angu-
lar acceleration a as
T = Icr
where I is the mass moment of inertia of the body about the axis of rotation.
In Chapter 16, we shall see that this motion is a special case of plane motion,
which itself is a special case of general motion.
I/

Figure P.15.129.

I.'
Figure 1'. 15. I32
15.133. A wheel is rotating with a constant angular speed w , of *15.136. In Problem 15.86. find the acceleration of the collar C
I O radlsec relative to a platform, which in turn is rotating with a relative to the ground iffor the configuration shown:
constant angular speed m2 of 5 radlsec relative to the ground. Find
the velocity and acceleration relative to the ground at a point h on
the wheel at the instant when it is directly vertically above point a.
0 = 5 radlsec
0 = X radisec'

15.137. In Example 1 5 . 1 1 , find axial force for the beam AB at A


resulting from cockpit C. which weighs (with occupant) 136y N.
The following data apply:

p = 200
Figure P.15.133. a = 60"
w, = .2rad/sec
w2 = .Iradlsec
*15.134. Solve Problem 15.133 for the case where 0,is increas-
ing in value at the rate of 5 rad/sec2 and where w2 is increasing in
value at the rate of 10 rad/sec2.

*15.135. A barge is shown with a derrick arrangement. The main 15.138. Fin OB and hBif ma and hAare, respectiv
beam AB is 40 ft in length. The whole system at the instant of and 3 rad/s2 counterclockwise.
interest is rotating with a speed 0,of 1 radlsec and an acceleriition
ht of 2 rad/sec2 relative to the barge. Also, at this instant 0 = 45",
6 = 2 radlsec, and 4 = I rad/secz. What are the velocity and accel-
eration of point B relative to the barge?

, ^",
Figure P.15.138.

783
Figure 1'. 15.I41.

Figure 1'. IS.I .MI Figure P.15.142.

'84
15.143. A vehicle on a monorail has a speed S = I O m / s and an 15.144. Cylinder A rolls without slipping. What are wxc, h8,..
acceleration S = 4 m/sZ relative to the ground reference XYZ and hCD ' = 5 mls and V
At the instant shown, V ' = 3 m/s2. Use
when if reaches point A . Inside the vehicle, a 3 kg mass slider an intuitive approach only as a check over a formal approach.
along a rod which at the time of interest is parallel to the X axis.
This rod rotates about a vertical axis with o = I radls and 6 = 2
rad/s2 relative to the vehicle at the time of interest. Also at this
time, the radial distance rl a f the mass is .2 m and its radial v e l w
ity i: = .4 mls inward. What is the dynamic force on the mass at
this instant'?

Figure P.15.144.

15.145. What is the magnitude of the velocity of the slider C a t


the instant shown in the diagram?

s
.......

.,' Vehicle at A

I v=.4m/s I
d=.2m

S=lOm/s
s=4m/s2
Relative to groundXYZ L\
Figure P.15.143. Figure P.15.145.

785
15.146. Rod AH i c mounted un a vertical rod A K fixed to a hori- 15.147. A conveyor system i s shown. Rod AB i s welded to plate
Lonlnl platform I1 which rotates with a n p l a r s p e d w, reldtive to D. End A i s connected to a vehicle which moves with velocity V,
thz ground rererencc XYZ. The shaft AH meanwhile rotates relative alang a rail. System A H and connected plate D hare angular
to thr platfrmn with \peed w2. Diqc (7 mtatcs ielativc to nrd AH with velocities w, and w2 relative 10 the vehicle A aE shown in !he dia-
iprrd w x whohe valuc can hc drtermined hy IIn o slipping condition gram. On plate I),a particle (i has motion given as V, and V, along
for the &\c and platform contact sutiace. Find the velocity and spoke RE which a1 Ihe instant of interest i s parallel to the X axis ot
acceleration vectors for point E on the disc G relative to XYZ. ISug- the stationary reference XYZ. Determine the acceleration of parti-
Srstion: Fix a \econd refcrencc til the shaft A H 2s, \hown.l d e (7 at the time of interest. Use as a second reference .r~vzfixed In
Y the plate with the origin at 8 .

,Vehicle

w, = 3 rad/s
w? = 2 rad/s
V, = 3.5 m/s
5m
I V , = I . X m/s’

/
-/
Z .X m
Figure P.15.147.

786
Kinetics
of Plane Motion
of Rigid Bodies
16.1 Introduction
In kinematics we learned that the motion of a rigid body at any time f can be
considered to be a superposition of a translational motion and a rotational
motion. The translational motion may have the actual instantaneous velocity
of any point of the body, and the angular velocity of the rotation, w, then has
its axis of rotation through the chosen point. A convenient point is, of course,
the center of mass of the rigid body. The translatory motion can then he found
from particle dynamics. You will recall that the motion of the center of mass
of any aggregate of particles (this includes a rigid body) is related to the total
external force by the equation
F = Me. (16.1)
where M is the total mass of the aggregate. Integrating this equation, we get
the motion of the center of mass. To ascertain fully the motion of the body,
we must next find w. As we saw in Chapter 14,
MA = P A (16.2)
for any system of particles where the point A about which moments of force
and linear momentum are to be taken can be ( I ) the mass center, (2) a point
fixed in an inertial reference, or (3) a point accelerating toward or away from
the mass center. For these points, we shall later show that the angular velocity
vector o is involved in the equation above when it is applied to rigid bodies.
Also, the inertia tensor will he involved. After we find the motion of the mass
center from Eq. 16.1 and the angular velocity w from Eq. 16.2, we get the
instantaneous motion by letting the entire body have the velocity y, plus the
angular velocity w, with the axis of rotation going through the center of mass!
'Thosereaders imdlor inslructors who wish to go to the three-dimensional approach first so P I
to have plane motion merge ah a special case, should now go to Chapter 18. After the general devel-
opment and after loking at the solution of three-dimensional problems, m e may wish to come back
to Chapter 16 tu study plane motion dynamics in detail. This approach is entirely optional.
787
16.2 Moment-of-Momentum Equations
Consider now a rigid hody wherein each particle o f the body nioves parallel
to a planc. Such a hndy i s said to he i n plaiie i n o l h i reliilivc Lo this plane. We
\hall consider that a x e s X Y are i n the aforcmcntinncd plane i n the ensuing dis-
cussion. The Z axis i s then normal to !he velocity vcctor of each point i n the
body. Furthermore. we considcr only the hiluatinn whcrc X Y Z is an inertial
, c / t , r o i w A hody undcrguing plane motion relative to XYZ as desei-ihed ahovc
i s shown in Fif. 1h.l

Figure 16.1. Body nndrr?oin:i p l ; m m x i m p x d l e l 11, X Y plane.


< q { ~ r a n s l a ~ c 'will) A .

Chiime \ome point A which is part 0 1 this hody or a hypothetical mass-


less rigid body cxtcnsinn o i this body. A n elenicnt (hiof the hody is shown at
ii positinn p from 4 . The velocity V' of dnr rclative tu A is simply the velocity
nf hi relative I ( I an? refeience E I T ~ wliicli
. , s A relative tn X Y Z .
t r t i i ~ s l ~ i f cwith
Similarly, the linear iiinmentuni of ihn relati\'e to A (i.e.. V ' d m ) i s the lineal-
inoinerituni of ilm relatiw to ;qc ti-anslating with A . We can now give the
miimcnt 01 this Inicimcntum (i.c.. the angul;ir niomcntum) dH, iihiiut A a s

H u l hince A i i lixed i n die hody (or i n a hypolhetic;il niasslesh exlension of


thc body) iuid dm i \ ii par1 O S thc h d y having m a s s . Ihc Ycctnr p must be
fixed i n the hody mil. accordingly.

where w i \ the angular \elocity (11thc h(riiy rcliitivc 10 <q<. However. since
<!1< tr~uhsl~itesreliitiw to X Y L w i s the angular \elocity of the body relative
1 0 X Y Z a s McII.Hcncc. we ciin \ay:

(lfl.,= p X (w X pidm (16.3)


SECTION 16.2 MOMENT-OF-MOMENTUM EQUATIONS 789

Note that the angular velocity w for the plane motion relative to the XY plane
must have a direction normal to the X Y plane.
Having helped us reach Eq. (16.3), we no longer need reference 5 ~ 5
and so we now dispense with it. Instead w e f i reference q z to the body at
point A such that the z axis is normal to the plane of motion while the other
two axes have arbitrary orientations normal to z (see Fig. 16.2).

Figure 16.2. Reference q z fixed to body at A; reference XYZ is inertial

Note that the z axis will remain normal to XY as the body moves because of
the plane motion restriction. Next, we evaluate Eq. 16.3 in terms of components
relative to x w as follows:
+ W",J + ( d f & ) z k
(&).ti
= (xi + yj +zk) X [ ( w k )X (xi + y j + zkjldrn
The scalar equations resulting from the foregoing vector equations are
( d H A ) I = -wxzdm
( ~ I Y ' )=~-ww dm
(dH, j? = o ( x 2 + y 2 j dm

Integrating over the entire body, we get'

'Note that the massless extension of the rigid hady has zero density and hence does not
contribute to the integration.
SECTION 16.3 PURE ROTATION OF A BODY OF REVOLUTION ABOUT ITS AXIS OF REVOUJTION 791

It is important to note emphatically that the angular velocity as given by w (and


later b y e ) is always taken relative to the inertial reference XYZ, whereas the
moments of forces (as given by (MA)r,(MA)),and (MJZas well as the inertia
tensor components are always taken about the axes xyz f a e d to the body at A
(Eqs. (16.6). Eqs. (16.6) are the general angular momentum equations for
plane morion. The last equation is probably familiar to you from your work in
physics. There you expressed it as
T = la (1 6.7)
or as T = I@ (16.8)
We shall now consider special cases of plane motion, starting with the
most simple case and going toward the most general case. However, please
remember that for all plane motions relative to an inertial reference, the
moment of the forces about the z axis at A always equals lZz& The other two
equations of 16.6 may get simplified for various special plane motions.
Also, to use Eqs. 16.6, we must remember that point A is part of the body
(because we took p to be fixed in the body so we could use dpldt = w x p ) and
is also one of the three acceptable points presented in Chapter 14. Further-
more, the xyz axes are fued to the body to render the inertia tensor compo-
nents constant.
Finally, we note from the derivation that w,e, and their derivatives are
measured from the inertial reference XYZ.

16.3 Pure Rotation of a Body


of Revolution About
I t s Axis of Revolution
A uniform body of revolution is shown in Fig. 16.3. If the body undergoe?
pure rotation about the axis of revolution fixed in inertial space reference
X Y Z , we then have plane motion parallel to any plane for which the axis of
revolution is a normal. A reference xyz is fixed to the body such that the 7
axis is collinear with the axis of revolution. Since all points along the axis
of revolution are fixed in inertial space X Y Z , we can choose for the origin
of reference xyz any point A along this axis. The x and y axes forming a
right handed triad then have arbitrary orientation. For simplicity, we choose
xyz collinear with axes X Y Z at time t. Clearly, the plane zy is a plane of
Figure 16.3. Rigid uniform body of
symmetry for this body, and the x axis is normal to this plane of symmetry. revolution at time f .
From OUT work in Chapter 9, recall5 that, as a consequence, I,? = I,, = 0.

sWe pointed out in Chapter 9 that if an axis, such as the x anis, is normal 10 a plane of s y m ~
metry, then the products of inertia with x as a subscript must be zero. This is similarly true for
other axes n o m d to a plane of symmetry.
792 CHAPTER l(i KINETIC'S O b PI.ANh MOTION OF Rl(;lD HOIIII-S

Similarly. with ? iiorinal to ii plane of symmetry. x;, we conclude that


I)\ = <:= 11. Hcncc, ~ry: iire principal axes. Returning 111 Eq. 16.6. we
find that only onc equation ot. the set has n(inzeri) miilnciil. and ttial I S
the familiar cquatiirn

M. =L.cb.
. .
(16.9)

Thc olhcr pair of cquatirms froln 16.6 yicld

N o h wc tiirii to Niwin,r'a I < i i ~ .For . this w c niiiht uie the inci-ti:il ref-
crciicc XYZ. Note that at the instant I shown i n Fig. 16.3. axe\ ,ry; and axch
XYZ have heen taken iis ciillincar. This i n e m \ that iit thi\ instant the forcer
on the body needed i n Newtiin's law such iih Fx can he denoted a s I.; since
(he direction5 o f X and I arc thc sanic t h i s inStan1 and i t i%only Llie
direction that i s significant hcrc. Since Ihc centcr of 111
staliwxiry at all l i n i n ( i t i s on the a s i i i i f riitation). \\IC ciin accordingly h a y
from N < > w t o i i ' sl a i i . :

El;=(I
I.; = 0 (Ih.lII

=(I

Thus. Ihc applied f w c m at any t i m e 1. the supporting forces. and thc wcight 01
thc body of rcvoIution satisfy <ill the equation\ of cquilihrium c.u'('pt for
motion a h m l the i i x i i of re\olution u'lieirt l i q If>.<)
applies.
Notice thal Lhe key equation (16.9) has the .w,ne/i,rnz a s Newton's linv
for t-uriliiicwr frirti,si~iriiiiiof a panicle along iiii axis. h a y thc .K u i s . We writc
hoth equations together as f i ) l l o w s :

iI6.12a)
(16.12h)

111 ('hnpter 12 we integrated Eq. I h . l ? h i i i r viirious kinds 01 l w r c func-


lions: tinic functionc, velocity functions. and position functions. The same
Icchniques used then 10 inlegrille Eq. 16.12h can n o w he u\ed 10 intcgratc
Cq. 16.I2a. where [tie t i i o n i e i i t functioii\ caii a l s o hc liiiic iuiictiirn\. iingii-
lar velocity functions. and angular position functions.
We illustrate these possibilities i n the following exaniples. The first
I kirquc wliicli iii part i s : Ifunction 01 angular piisition 0.
SECTION 16.3 PURE ROTATION OF A BODY OF REVOLUTION ABOUT ITS AXIS OF REVOLUTION 193

Example 16.1
A stepped cylinder having a radius of gyration k = .40 m and a mass of
200 kg is shown in Fig. 16.4. The cylinder supports a weight W of mass
100 kg with an inextensible cord and is restrained by a linear spring
whose constant K is 2 Nlmm. What is the angular acceleration of the
stepped cylinder when it has rotated 10" after it is released from a state of
rest? The spring is initially unstretched. What are the supporting forces at
this time'?
We have shown free-body diagrams of the stepped cylinder and the
weight Win Fig. 16.5. A tension T from the cord is shown acting both on W = 1 OOg N
the weight Wand the stepped cylinder. We have here for the stepped cylin-
der a body of revolution rotating about its axis of symmetry along which
we have chosen point A . Axes x y i are fixed to the body at A with i along Figure 16.4. Stepped cylinder
the axis of rotation. Furthermore we have shown inertial axes XYZ at A
cnllinear with xyz at the time f.

Figure 16.5. Free-body diagrams of components at time f.

We can accordingly apply the moment-of-momentum equation about


the centerline of the cylinder:

TR, - KR:0 = I 0 = ( M k 2 ) 0
T ( . 3 0 )- [(2)(1,000)](.60)2r9= (200)(.40)20 (a)

where as indicated earlier 0 is the angular velocity of the body relative to


stationary axes XYZ and where 0 is the rotation of the cylinder in radians
from a position corresponding to the unstretched condition of the spring.
794 CHAPTER I6 KINETICS OF PLANE MOTION OF RIGID RODIES

Example 16.1 (Continued)


Now considering the weight W. which is in a translatory molion, we can
say, from Newton's law using inertial rclcrencc XYZ as required by
Newton's law
T-W=ML'
Therefore,
T-(ino)(wi) = rooY (h)
Froin kinematics we note that
..
K,@ -y
'Therefore.

Substituting for Tin Eq. (a) using Eq. (h) and for Y using Eq. (c), we then
have

When @ = (1O0)(21r/36O"i = ,1735 rad, we get for 6 iron1 Eq. (d) the
desired result:

0 = 4.11 rad/

From Eqs. (h) and (c), we (hen have for T:


T = 981 - 123.3 = 8 5 8 N
We next use Newton's law for lhc center of mass A of the Ftepped
cylindcr. Thus. considering Fig. 16.5. realizing that lhe center of mass is in
equilibrium and assuming collinear orientation of the two sets of axes at
time t, we can say A, 3 A x and A, A,, at time t since only direction is
involved here. Thus summing h r c c s .

AY = 2,820N

-Ar + ((2)(1,000)](.60)(.1745)= 0

A, = 2U9N
SECTION 16.3 PURE ROTATION OF A BODY OF REVOLUTION ABOUT ITS AXIS OF REVOLUTION 795

It should he clear on examining Fig. 16.4 that the motion of the cylinder,
after W is released from rest, will he rotational oscillation. This motion ensues ,, K
because the spring develops a restoring torque much as the spring in the classic \/\I\/\/\
spring-mass system (Fig. 16.6) supplies a restoring Iorce. We shall study tor-
sional oscillation or vibration in Chapter 19 when we consider vibrations. The
key concepts and mathematical techniques for both motions you will find to Figure 16,6,Classic spring-mass system,
he identical.
The torque in the next example is, in part, a function of time.

I Example 16.2
A cylinder A is rotating at a speed w of 1,750 rpm (see Fig. 16.7) when the
light handbrake system is applied using force F = (10f + 300) N with f
in seconds. If the cylinder has a radius of gyration of 200 mm and a mass
of 500 kg, how long a time does it take to halve the speed of the cylinder?
The dynamic coefficient of friction between the belt and the cylinder is .3.
We start by showing the free body of the cylinder and of the brake
lever in Fig. 16.8. From the belt formula of Chapter I , we can say for the
belt tensions on the cylinder
7
L= =
(31($)(2X)
p = 4.1 I
T2
:. = 4.11T2
Figure 16.7. Cylinder and
handbrake system.

F B D I1
Figure 16.8. Free-hody diagrams of cylinder and handbrake lever.
I
7% CHAPTER 16 KINETIrS OI'Pl.ANI? MOTION OF KIGIU H0L)IES

.' Example 16.2 (Continued)


N o w going to the handbrake lever in F.H.1). I1 and taking iiiotiients ahool
L
point B. we gct from equilibrium
-P-(.sOo) + T(.200) t 7;(.200) = 0
1
I Inscrting F = IOr + 100 N. we get for (7; + 7;j
j q + T, = 2.S( IOr + 300) lh)
t
! Substitute for using Eq. (a).
i 4.1 IT2 + T2 = 2.5(10r + 300)
:. T2 = .489(10t + 300) IC)

j from (a)
AI~O
7; = (4.1 1)(.489)i10r + 301)) = 2.01(10r + 300) (d)
! N o w going lo F.B.1). 1 i n Fig. 16.8 and using axes ,tyr fined to the
; cylinder at 0, we i i e x t write the moment-of-momentum eqoation.
-qi.3ooj + T 2 ( . 3 ~ l l l=j (500)(.200)~(e)
Using Eqs. IC) and (d) we then have
1.489 - 2.01)(111t + 300)(.300) = (500)(.200)'ti
I
' Hcncc
e = -.02283(lO/ + 300)
Inkgrating

4 = -.I12283 lor2 +3 m ) + (', le)


( 2
c When t = 0.

e = (1,75O)(g) = 183.3 lad/\ .; c', = 183.3

Thus
!
I e = -.02283(51' + 300t) + 183.3
Sei

e = ($)( 183.3) = 9 I .h3 l d / S and solve for r


. Example 16.2 (Continued)
Rearranging, we get
SECTION 16.4 PURE ROTATION OF A BODY WITH TWO ORTHOGONAL PLANES OF SYMMETRY 191

I’ + 60t - 803 = 0
Using the quadratic formula, we have
+ (4)(803)
~~

-60 f 460’
I =
2

t = 11.27 s e c

16.4 Pure Rotation of a Body with Two


Orthogonal Planes of Symmetry
Consider next a uniform body having two orthogonal planes of symmetry. Such
a body is shown in Fig. 16.9, where in (a) we have shown the aforementioned
planes of symmetry and in (b) we have shown a view along the intersection of
the planes of symmetry. We shall consider pure rotation of such a body about
a stationaly axis collinear with the intersection of the planes of symmetry,
which we Ydke as the z axis. The origin A can be taken anywhere along the
axis of rotation, and the x and y axes are fixed in the planes of symmetry, as
shown in the diagram. X Y Z is taken collinear with xyz at time f. We leave it to
the redder to show that the identical equations apply to this case as to the pre-
vious case of a body of revolution.

I x. x
(a) (b)
Figure 16.Y. Body with two orthogonal planes of syrnmctry at time t

The torque in the next example is a function of angular speed.b

“Fmm now on it will be understud that in the diagrams xy; will be lixrd tu the body and
that XYL will be fixed to the ground and hence to be an inertial reference. This will avoid clut-
tering the diagrams unnecessarily.
798 CHAPTER I h KINEIICS OF PLANC MOTIOL OF RIGID B0DlF.S

Example 16.3
A thin-walled shaft is shown in Fig. Ih.10. On i t are welded identical
plates A and E . each having a miss of 10 kg. Also wcldcd onto thc \haft
at right angles to A and B are two identical plates C and D. cach having il
mass of 6 kg. The thin-walled shaft is of diameter 1(K1 mni and has a miiss
of 15 kg. The wind resistance to rotation of this systcni is given fni- siiiiill
angular velocities as .26 N-in. with 6 in rad/sec. Starting from rest, what
is the time required for thc syhtem tu reach 100 rpm i f a torque T of
5 N-m is applied'! What are the forces 011 the hearings G and E when this
speed is reached?
We have here a body with twii vrthogonal planes of symmetry. The
body is rotating about the axis nt' synimetry which we rake as the: axis for
axes xyz fixed to the body at 1;. As usual we position ~y:at time I to bc
collinear with inertial relerence XYZ.
The mument-of-momentum equati(in about the :ahis is given 8s
follows using moment of inertia formulas t'vr plates (see inhide covers)
along with the parallel-axis formula and noting h r the thin-walled \haft
that we use 1:; = M r L where, as an approximativn. we take thc outsidc x.I
radius for r . Figure 16.10. Dwicc with rolationd
rSii\filllce.
i - .26 = {(15)(.05)2 + 2 [ i ~ ( ~ o ~+( .oI?)
. m ~+ IOI.~O)']
+ 2[& l 6 ) l . l 0 L + , 0 1 2 ) + (6)(.10)']}8 (a:

This becomes

We can separate the variables as follows:

Now make the following substitution:

5 - .2e = 17

Therefore, taking the differential

Hence, we have for Eq. (h):


SECTION 16.4 PURE ROTATION OF A BODY WITH TWO ORTHOGONAL PLANES OF SYMMETRY 799

Example 16.3 (Continued)


Integrate to get
-5.59 In q = t + C,
Hence, replacing q
-5.59ln(5 - .28) = f + C, (C)
When f = 0 . 6 = 0, and we have for C , :
-5.59ln(S) = C,
Therefore,
C , = -8.99
Hence, Eq. (c) becomes

Let b = (100/60)(2z) = 10.47 radsec in the above equation. The desired


time t for this speed to be reached then is

We now consider the supporting forces for the system. For reasons
set forth in Section 16.3 we know that
M, = 0
M" = 0
for the other moment of momentum equations. Also from Newton's law,
while noting that xyz and XYZ are collinear at time f.

for the center of mass. Clearly, the dead weights of bodies (in the z direction)
give rise to a constant supporting force of [2( I O + 6) + 1S]g = 461 N at
hearing E. All other forces are zero.
800 CHAPTEK I 6 K I N K I K ' S O b PI.ANC MO'I'ION OF KlGIU BODIES

16.5 Pure Rotation of Slablike Bodies


We now consider hodics that ha\e ii .siii,q/e pliiiic (ii\yiiimctry, w c h ;is i \
shown i n Fig, 16. I I, Such bodicr w c shall ci111 .,/uh/ikr hodics. Wc hn\'c
oriented the body i n Fig. 16.8 s o t h a t thi, plane (11 symiiietry i s parallel to
the X Y plane. We shall now consider [tic pure iotiition o i h u c h ii hodq
about ii f i x c d axis iiormiil t o llic XY planc and goins throuph ii point A iii
thc planc of \ymmctry o f the hody. We f i k ii icfcieiice .sy: t o the body 2 1
point A with ~y i n lhc p l m e of syinmctry and :iilong [hc i i x i s 01' rotillion

The angular velocity w i s tlieii alons tlie :axis. Siiici. :i i m r n i a l lo the


planc of s y i i i m c ~ r y .i t i s clciir imiiicdiiitcly that I , , = I , = 0. Arid s o the
, n o r n ~v /~m o m i + i ~ ~ iequations
n, become for thi\ c a w :

If the center of inah5 i s nul at a posilion along the axis of rotation. theii we 110
longer have equilihriuin ciinditions for tlie center of niah\. I t \ b i l l hc utidergw
ing circular motion. However. thniugh NPWIOII '.i/ U M wc c a n rcI:itc the c x k r

iiiil ioi~ccson 1lic body to thc iicuAcratioii of tlie n i a s cziitei. Wc may then
have to use the kinrwulics of rigid-body iriotiwi lo yield cnuuph equations to
solve the problem. Wc now illustrate this c a e .
SECTION 16.5 PURE ROTATION OF SLARLUKE BODIES 801

Example 16.4
A uniform rod of weight Wand length L supported by a pin connection at
A and a wire at B is shown in Fig. 16.12. What is the force on pin A at the
instant that the wire is released? What is the force at A when the rod has
rotated 45"7
-T
Part A. A free-body diagram o f the rod is shown in Fig. 16.13 at the R
instant that the wire is rcleased at B. We fix x)'z to the body at A. XYZ is Figure 16.12. R i d \uppoiled hy wire
stationary. The moment-of-momentum equation about the axis of mta-
lion at A. on using the formula for I of a rod about a transverse axis at the
cnd, yields

Therefore,

e = -23- gL
"
attimef=O (a)
\. Y

Figure 16.13. Wire suddenly cut.


Using simple kinematics of plane circular motion, we can determine the
acceleration of the mass center at f = 0. Thus, using the inertial reference

where we have used Eq. (a) in the last step. Next express Newton's law
for the mass center using A ) = A,, A r = A,:'

Accordingly, at time f = 0 we have, on noting Eqs. (b):

Thus, we see that at the instant of releasing the wire there is an upward
I
force of 4 W o n the left support.

'Note that wc can replace A, by A > ,etc.. becausc of the common direction d X and? as
well as the other comsponding axes at timc I. However, we cannot replacc 2 by ,?and Y by
r. r e reason for thi.9 i*[hot while the orientations of the rtspeclive axes B E the same at time
I . the 1act rcrnains that hecnuse 01 the rotational motion 01 xyz r e l a t i w 10 XYZ. the velwilies
and i~cccIcriltionsof il particle relstivc to "'r and X Y Z will he different requiring us to use only
the XYZ axes when deilling with deriviitives uf the panicle coordinates in newton'^ law.
802 ('HAPIEK I 6 KINETICS OF PLANE MOTION OF KI(;II> BOUIES

P Example 16.4 (Continued)


! Part B. We next express the momenl-of-momentum equation Cor the rod
at ;iny arhitrary position 0. Observing Fig. 16.14, we gel
= 1 w
--,Lo 7.-

2 3 s
i Therefore.

j (ill ih)
1 lcigure 16.14. (a) Rod a1 pmition H: (h) rod a1 0 - 35".
1'
Consequently. at H = 45" we have

= ( I .5)(.707l 'L = I .O6O f (el

Wc shall also nced d, and accordingly we now rewrite Eq. (d) as


: follows:

i Separating variables, we get


f 3 s .
i dde =
2 -LoSHd8
~

1'
! wlilch we integrate to get

: When 8 = 0,8 = 0 ; accordingly. C = 0. We then liave

i
!
0' = 3K
Lc' in8 (g)
i
: At the instant o f interest. H = 45" and we get for6':
= 3 " ( 707) = 2.12 8 (h)
i I. L
For H = 45", wc can now givc the acceleriltion component u I of the
ccnlcr (if mass directed ~iormal10 the rod and coiriponent [I? directed i~long
SECTION 16.5 PURE ROTATION OF SLABLIKE tlOD1E.S 803

Example 16.4 (Continued)


the rod [see Fig. 16.14(b)]. From kinematics we can say. using Eqs. (e)
and (h):

a, = 7 0 = 7 1.0601' = , 5 3 0 , ~
L" L(

Now, employing Newton's law for the mass center, we have on noting
that xy is no longer collinear with X Y .

A - ( - a , sin 45" - a, cos 45')


x - g
Therefore, using Eqs. (i)

A, = -1.124W

Also, from Newton's law

-A, +W = ~
W (-a2 sin 45" + a, cos 45")
g
Therefore, again using Eq. (i)

A,. = 1.375W (j)

Consider next the case of a body undergoing pure rotation about an axis
which, for some point A in the body (or massless hypothetical extension of
the body), is a principal axis (see Fig. 16.15). For a reference xyz fixed at A
with z collinear with the axis of rotation, it is clear that = I?, = 0, and
hence the moment of momentum equations simplify to the exact same forms
as presented here for the rotation of slablike bodies.

p,,-Pfincipd axis

r,, ,section
Cross

X
Figure 16.15. Axis z is a principal axis for point A.
h

I'ieure F.lh.5.

Figure P.16.3.
Figure P.16.9.

16.10. Two cylinders and a rod are oriented in the vertical plane.
The rod is guided by hearings (not shown) to move vertically. The
following arc the weighls of the three bodies:
W, = 1,000 N W, = 300 N W, = 200 N
What is the acceleration if the rod? There is rolling without slipping.
w
Figure P.16.7.

16.8. A pulley A and its rofating accessories have a mass of


1,000 kg and a radius of gyration of .25 m. A simple hand brake is
applied a$ shown using a force P. If the dynamic coefficient of
friction between belt and pulley is .2, what must force P he to
change w from 1,750 rpm to 300 rpm in 60 sec?

Figure P.16.10.

16.11. A har A weighing 80 Ih is supported at one end by rollers


that move with the bar and a stationary cylinder B weighing 68 Ib
that rotates freely. A 100 Ib force is applied to the end of the bar.
P What i s the friction force between the bar and the cylinder as a

1
function of x'? Indicate the ranges for nrm-slipping and slipping
conditions. Take p < = . S and ut, = .3.

"
~3
1

l a 0 0 mm
Figure P.16.8.

16.9. A tlywheel is shown. There is a viscoub damping


torque due to wind and bearing friction which is known to he
-.04w N-m, where w is in radisec. If a torque T = 100 N-m is
applied, what i s the speed in 5 min after starting from rest''
The mass of the wheel is 500 kg, and the radius of gyration is
.SO m. Figure P.16.11.

805
I

Figure P.lh.16.
16.17. Do Problem 16.16 for the case where at the instant of
interest wD = 2 rad/sec counterclockwise.

16.111. A torque 7of 50 N-m is applied to the device shown. The


bent rods are of mass per unit length 5 kg/m. Neglecting the iner-
tia of the shaft, how many rotations does the system make in I O sec?
Are there forces coming onto the bearings other than from the
dead weights of the system?

Figure P.16.20.

*16.21. In Problem 16.20, consider that the mass per unit length
varies linearly from 5 Ibm/ft at I = 1 ft (at the bottom of the rod)
/-6OO mm to 6 Ibm/ft at I = 3 ft (at the top of the rod). Find T,, at any poii-
Figure P.16.18. tion r and then compute I,, for I = 1.5 ft.

16.19. An idealized torque-versus-angular-speed curve for a 16.22. A plate weighing 3 Ib/ft* is supported at A and H. What
shunt, direct-current motor is shown as cuwe A. The motor drives are the force components at H at the instant support A is
a pump which has a resisting torque-versus-speed curve shvwn in removed'?
the diagram as curve H. Find the angular speed of the system as a
function of time, after starting, over the range of speeds given in
the diagram. Take the moment of inertia of motor. connectine
shaft, and pump to be I .

Torque

ie
Figure P.16.22.

16.23. When the uniform ngid bar is horizontal, the spring at C


0 is compressed 3 in. If the bar weighs 50 Ib, what is the force
Angular speed 8 at B when support A is removed suddenly'? The spring constant
Figure P.16.19. is 50 Ib/in.

16.20. Rods of length L have been welded onto a rigid drum A .


The system is rotating at a speed w of 5,000 rpm. By this lime,
you may have studied stress in a rod in your strength of materials A
A C
class. In any case, the stress is the normal force per unit area of
cross section of the rod. If the cross-sectional area of the rod is
2 in? and the mass per unit length is 5 Ibm/ft, what is the normal
stress f, on a section at any position r'?The length L of the rods is >
2 ft. What is 5,at I = 1 . 5 ft? Consider the upper rud when it is f-
vertical. Figure P.16.23.

807
Figure P.Ih.27
16.28. A hollow cylinder A of mass 100 kg can rotate over a sed- a = 45"? The weight of the member A B is W. What is the angular
tionary solid cylinder B having a mass of 70 kg. The surface of acceleration of the bar for these conditions at the instant of interest'?
cmtilct is lubricated s? that there is,a resisting torque between the
bodies given as 0.28,4 N-m with 0, in radians per second. The
outer cylinder is connected to a device at C which supplies a force
equal to -SO?N. Starting from a counter-clockwise angular speed
of I radlsec, what is the angular speed of cylinder A after the force
at C starts to move downward and moves 0.7 m'!

Figure P.16.30.
*16.31. A rod AB is welded t o a rod CD, which i n turn is welded
to a shaft as shown. The shaft has the following angular motion ill
time I :
w = 10 radlsec
h = 40 rad/sec:!
Wire
What are the shear force, axial force, and bending moment along
CD at time f as a function of r'! The rods have a mas? per unit
length of S kgim. Neglect gravity.

Figure P.16.28.
I -50 Y

16.29. A hox C weighing 150 Ib rests on a conveyor belt. The


driving drum H has a mass of 100 Ibm and a radius of gyration of
4 in. The driven drum A has a mass of 70 Ibm and a radius of
gyration of 3 in. The helt weighs 3 Ib/ft. Supporting the belt on the
top side is a set of 20 rollers each with a mass of 3 Ihm, a diame- Figure P.16.31.
ter of2 in., and a radius of gyration of .8 in. If a torque T of SO ft-lb
16.32. A four-bar linkage is shown (the ground is the Courth
is developed on the driving drum, what distance does C travel in
linkage). Each memher is 300 mm long and has a mass per unit
I sec starting from rest? Assume that no slipping occurs.
length of I O kglm. A torque T o f 5 N-m is applied to ililch of bars
AB and DC. What is the angular acceleration of hm AH and Cl)?

I- 20'
Figure P.16.29.

16.30. A uniform slender member is supported by a hinge at A . A


force P is suddenly applied at an angle a w i t h the horizontal. What
value should t' have and at what distance d should it be applied to
result in zero reactive forces at A at the configuration shown if Figure P.lh.32

809
16.6 Rolling Slablike Bodies
We now consider the rolling witlinul slipping i i S slahlike hodies such as cylin-
ders. spheres, nr plane gears. As wc have indicated i n Chapter 15, the point OS
contact of the hody has insrantaneiiusly 3uro vrlociry, and we havc pure i i i -
. S I N I I I ~ I ~ P O rol(rriort
I~S nhoirr t h i s uinfrrcr point. We pointed out that Sor getling
velocities of points o n such a rolling body, we could imagine that there i s ii
h i r r p at the piiinl 111 contacI. Also, the iiccclciatioti i i l the center (if a riilling
withiiut slipping sphere or cylinder can he computed using the simple for-
mula-KB. Finally. yini can rcadily show that if the angular speed i s zerii, wc
c u i coinpiire the ;icceler;itinn CIS a n y pnint i n the cylinder o r sphere hy again
imagining a h i n p at the point (IS cnntiict. Fix other cases. we must use more
dctailcd kinematics, as discussed i n Chapter I S .
A vcry important cnncIu~ionwe reached i n Chapter 15 Sor cylinders
and spheres was (hat for rolling without slipping the acceleration of the coli-
tact point o n the cylinder o r Yphere i s /(iwwrd thu ~ r o m ~ , . f i criitri- -ii. ($ the
i:diti(li,r 0 ) ,sph(,ri,. If the centel- of mas.; OS the hody lies anywhere along the
linc A 0 froin the contact point A to the geometric center 0. then clearly we
can usc Eq. 16.6 h r the point A . 'This action i h justified since point A i s thcn
iiti example 01 case 1 i n Section 16.2 (A accelerates toward the mass center
and i s part of the cylinder). Thus, for the body i n Fig. 16.16 t'nr n o slipping
wc can use T = In iihiiot the point (if contact A nf the cylinder at the instant
shown. However. in Fig. 16.17 we c;inniit do this hecause the point of contact
A of the cylinder i s not accelerating toward the center ol.niass as i n the prcvi-
tius case. We can use T = la about the i'eiili'r nf'nz(i.s.s i n the latter casc.

Figure 16.16. Point A ~ ~ C C C I C ~ C toward


C center of rnasc.

We shall now examinc a problem involving rolling without slipping.


The equations of motim, you can readily dcducc. arc ths same as i n the pre-
vious cection.

Figure 16.17. F'oinl A doer n o t a ~ ~ ~ l c r i towmrd


iti. center of miass
SECTION 16.6 ROLLING SLABLIKE BODIES 81 1

Example 16.5
A steam roller is shown going up a 5' incline in Fig. 16.18. Wheels A have
a radius of gyration of 1.5 ft and a weight each of 500 Ih, whereas roller B
has a radius of gyration of I f t and a weight of 5,000 Ib. The vehicle, minus
the wheels and roller but including the operator, has a weight of 7,000 Ib
with a center of mass positioned as shown in the diagram. The steam roller
is to accelerate at the rate of I ftlsec'. In part A of the problem, we are to
determine the torque T,, from the engine onto the drive wheels.

Figure 16.18. Steam roller moving up incline.

Part A. In Fig, 16.19, we have shown free-body diagrams of the drive


wheels and the roller. Note we have combined the two drive wheels into a
single 1.000-lb wheel. In each case, the point of contact on the wheel
accelerates toward the mass center of the wheel and we can put to good

Figure 16.19. Free-body diagrams of driving wheels and roller.

use thc moment-of-momentum equation (16.9) for the points of contact


on the cylinders. Accordingly, we fix xyz to cylinder A and we fix another

___
8 12 CH.\PTEI< 16 K I N I T K ' S O F PI.ANF: hlO'IlON 0 1 ' RIGID RODIES

Example 16.5 (Continued)


reference~iy: to cylinder N :it their respective points of contiict a s has heen
shown." Hence. liir cylindcr A wc have

<At + 1.OOllsinS"l(2) - T& = ~.000(1.5'


fi
,~
>2)fji (ai

where wc havc employed the parallel-axis theorcin in computing the rnoiiient


of iiiertiii ;ihi)iit the line 01 cmtitct at <'. Similarly, foi- the roller. u'e have
T 000
~ . ' --(I'
(5,1)00sin~"- R > ) ( I . s= ~
R
+ I.+~G,# ( h)

W e havc hcrc two equations and no fcwei- than five unknown?. By ciinsid-
cring the free hody of the vehicle minus wheels shoun diagrammatically
in Fig. 16.20, we can say friini Newton's law noting once again that A,
A , , etc., hecausc of the parallel orientation of axes XYZ with axes .ry: of
Fig. I f i l Y ( a ) and Fig. I6.lY(h) at titile i
7,000
A ! - E x - 7,011(lsin 5" = (1) (e)
s

1- ~-1,
I'
Figure 16.20. Free-hdy diagram o i vehicle without w~heelsand mllcr.

Finally. from kinematics wc can say:

.1 -
x
F,,
=
- '
2
= -.s riidlulc'
(d)
= x
-~ = .. I = -.hh7 r a d k c '
I1 r,# 1.5
where ,y = I ftlsec' i s the acceleration o f the vchicle up the incline. W e
can now readily mIve thc eqoalirrnc. Wc get l3\ directly from Eq. (h) on
SECTION Ih.6 ROLLING SLAFLIKE BODIES 8 13

Example 16.5 (continued)


replacing 8, by -.667. Next, we get AA from Eq. (c). Finally, going back to
Eq. (a), we can solve for <,,g. The results are:

Cng = 3,250ft-lb
Ax = 1,4871b
BX = 660 lb

Part B. Determine ne) the normal forces N, and Nz at the wheels arid
roller, respectively.
We can express Newton's law for the wheels and roller in the direction
normal to the incline by using the free-body diagrams of Fig. 16.19. Thus,
N, - A v - 1,000cos 5' =0 (e)
N , - B y - 5,000 cos 5" = 0 (o
Next, we consider the free body of the vehicle without the wheels and
roller (Fig. 16.20). Newton's law in they direction for the center of mass
then becomes
Av + B, - 7,000 cos 5" = 0 (9)
The moment-of-momentum equation about the center of mass of the
vehicle without wheels and roller is
A r ( 2 ) - R ~ r ( 2 . 5+) A y ( I ) + Br(l I)+ Te,,e = 0 (h)
We have four equations in four unknowns. Solve for A v in Eq. (g), and
substitute into Eq. (h). Insertin& known values forAr, B,>.and Trig, we have
(1,487)(2)- (660)(2.5)+ 7 , 0 0 0 c o ~ 5-~Ex,+ Bv(l I)+ 3,250 = 0

Therefore,
E, = 1.155 Ib
Now from Eq. (g) we get A?:
A v = 7,000cos.5" + 1,155 = 8,12X Ib
Finally, from Eqs. (e) and (0 we get N , and N2

N, = 8,128 + 1,000cos5" = 9,1201b

N2 = - I , I55 + 5,000 COS 5" = 3,830 Ib

Hence, on each wheel wc have a normal force of 4,560 Ib, and for the
roller we have a normal force of 3.830 Ib.
8 14 CHAPTI;K 16 KINI:I'IC5 01; PLANK MiYIION 01: Rl(;lD r30011:.<

'4 *Example 16.6


A gear A weighing 100 N i s connected to a stcpped cylinder H (scc Fig.
16.21) hy a light rod / I C . Thc stepped cylinder weighs 1 hN and has a
radius of gyration or 250 iiiin aliing i t s centerline. Tile g e ~ hiis
A a radius
of gyration of 120 niin ;ilong l i s ccnterlinr. A fol-ce F = 1,500 N i s applied
t o the gear ill I ) . What i s thc coniprcc\ive force i n mcmhcr D c i l , at the
i i i s f a i i t that F i s applicd, Ihc system i s cr;ition;iry?

i! Noting that I ) ( ' is ;Itwo-Sorce compressiw mcmhcr. we drau the


l lrcc -body diagrams for the gear and the stepped cylindcr i l l Fip. 16.22.

-
Figure 16.22. R c e - h d y d i q x m o f f c a r and cylinder.

' The moment-of-momentum equations about tlie c o i i t x r points Sor both


: hodie\ (points ( I and h. respectively) iire
x

:
.-. . . , ....
...._I_^x_" .... ... . . ~- . - . ~
SECTION 16.6 ROLLING SLABLIKE BODIES 8 15

Example 16.6 (Continued)

-(IO0 + I,SOO)(.lS) + DC(sin20")(.15) = (g)[(.12)2 + (.15)2]8A


(DCsin20" + I,000)(sin30")(.10) - (DCcos20°)(.30 + .10cos30°)

These equations simplify to the following pair:


,0513DC - 240 = ,3768, (a)
-.3462DC + SO = 1.398, (b)
Clearly, we need an equation from kinematics at this time. Considering
rod DC, we can say:9
ac = a, + h j n cx PDC + wIlc x (wDc x P i x )
e,k x [(.3O + .1Ocos3O")j - (.lOsin30")i]
= FDj+ &,,k X (cos 20"i - sin 20"j) +0
The scalar equations are
-38668, = .342hDc (C)
-.058, = y, + .940h,, (d)

Also, from kinematics we can say. considering gear A :


..
Y~=
, .neA (e)
Multiply Eq. (c) by .940/.342 and rewrite Eq. (d) below it with %replaced
by using 1%. (e):
- I ,0638, = .940hlJ,
-.OSOB - . 15eA = .940d1,~:

Subtracting, we get
-1.0138, + =0

Therefore,
= 6.1Se, (fl
Solving Eq. (a), (b), and (0simultaneously gives us for DC the result

Also, note that Y cnmes out negative indicating that D accelerates downward.

Wote that because cylinder B has zero angular velocity. we can imagine i t to be hinged
at b for computing a? Also, we do not know the sign of FD
and so we leave i t as positive and
thus let the mechanics yield the correct sign at the end of the CdCUlationS.
x
/
SECTION 16.7 GENERAL PLANE MOTION OF A SLABLIKE BODY 8 17

Example 16.7
Find the acceleration of block B shown in Fig. 16.24. The system is in a
vertical plane and is released from rest. The cylinders roll without slipping I 0 Guide
rod
along the vertical walls and along body B. Neglect friction along the guide
rod. The I 50 N-m torque MA is applied to cylinder A .
We first draw free-body diagrams of the three bodies comprising the
system as shown in Fig. 16.25 where it will he noticed that we have
deleted the horizontal forces since they play no role in this problem. As
usual, X Y Z is our inertial reference. Points a,b, d, and e in F.B.D. I and
F.B.D. 111, respectively, are contact points in the respective bodies where,
we repeat, there is rolling without slipping. Furthermore, it should be clear
that points u and b are accelerating toward respective mass centers.
Accordingly we fix xyz to the cylinders at these points.

Data
W, = 100 N
W , = 300 N
W,.=S0N
MA= IS0 N-m
F.U.D. I P.R.D. I1 F.B.D. 111
Figure 16.24. A block and two c:
Figure 16.25. Free-body diagrams rrf the system elements with horizontal forces in a vertical plane.
deleted.
We may immediately write the moment-of-momentum equations
for the two cylinders about their respective points of contact a and h. Thus

F.B.D. I

..
:. -31; - 165 = ,3448, (a)

F.B.D. 111

(f2)(.2)+(50)(.1) =
50
+--(.l)2pc
R
81 8 CHAPTER I6 KINETICS OF PLANE MOTION OF 131G11) RODlES

Example 16.7 (Continued)


Next going to F.R.D. I1 we employ Newton's law since we have simplc
translation. Refelmirig now Io tlic incrtid reference XYZ w e have

F.H.D. I1

Since the three bodies are interconnected hy nonslip rolling conditions we


must next consider the kinematics of the system. Thus
.. ..
38, = Y,
.2 ti,. = - Y;,

Using the ahove rcwlts to replace G,, and gc.in Eqs. (a) and (b) wc get

N o w solve for.( and/z in thc above equations and suhstitutc into Eq. ( c )
We get

:. = -24.10m/sz

Now from Eqs. (d) and (c) we can determinef, and f,.

,f, = -457.9 N ,f, = 21.07 N


Thus. cylinder A fcirccs hiirly H downward whilc cylinder C resists this
motion.

Notice, unless we want tu determine the friction fiirces at the walls therc i s
no need to use Newton's law for the cylinders. Also note that we could not
use the moment-of-momentum equations for points ( ' and d of the cylinders
even lhough there i s rolling without slipping there. The reason for thiq. :is
you must know. i s that these points d o not rrccckmte towurd o r u w m f r o m
t h mn,m cenrer,~of thc r$iriden.
.... . .. . . .,.. __ , .. .., . . . , ..
SECTION I6.7 GENERAL PLANE M O TIO N OF A SLABLIKE B O DY 8 19

Example 16.8
A stepped cylinder having a weight of 450 N and a radius of gyration k of
300 mm is shown in Fig. 16.26(a). The radii R , and R, are, respectively,
300 mm and 600 mm. A total pull Tequal to 180 N is exerted on the ropes
attached to the inncr cylinder. What is the ensuing motion'? The coeffi-
cients of static and dynamic friction hetween the cylinder and the ground
are, respectively, .I and .OX.

Y, Y
R . = 300 rnrn I

Figure 16.26. (a) Stepped cylinder; (b) free-body diagram of cylinder. XYis
stationary.

A free-body diagram of the cylinder is shown in Fig. 16.26(h). Let us assume


first that there is no slipping at the contact surface. Of course, we will have
to later check this supposition. We have then pure instantaneous rotation
ahout contact point A . Fix x y z to the body at A. X Y Z as usual is stationary.
We can then say for the moment-of-momentum equation ahout the axis
of contact:

T ( / $ - R,)= ("s k 2 +;.:)e


wherein we have used the parallel-axis theorem for moment of inertia.
Inserting numerical values. we can solve directly for 0 at the instant that
the force T i s applied. Thus,

Therefore,
0 = 2.62 radlsec' (b)
1x0 + / 7 wx IC1
s

j Thus. Sor no \lipping. we n i t t \ t he ;ihlc t n ( k w l o p ;I friction Iorcc of 1117.9


i N. Thc miixiiniini lriclion Irircz lh;it u’e can have. however. is. according
‘ 10 Coulomb’s law.
= Wjl, ~ (450)(.11 = 45 N le!

[ Accordingly, u’c niii\r cnncliidc: that the cylindrr h m slip. and UK nimt re-
examine the prohlem ;IS :I , q m 6 , u d ~ ~ i ( ~ i ~ ~ ~prohlem.
- i i i ~ ~ i ; ~ ~ i ~

! Using AI,, = .OX. wc now takc.jto hc 36 N and employ the moment-


of-momentum eqtl;ition for t h r rentrr of mas4 with w: iinw fixed ar the
center of mass. We thcn h a w IF]?. l6.26(h)i

..
X = -3.14 rnlsec* 11)
SECTTON 16.7 GENERAL PLANE MOTION OF A SLABLIKE BODY 821

Example 16.9
A 4.905-kN flywheel rotating at a speed o of 200 rpm (see Fig. 16.27)
breaks away from the steam engine that drives it and falls on the floor. If
the coefficient of dynamic friction between the floor and the flywheel sur-
face i s .4, at what speed will the flywheel axis move after 2 sec? At what
speed will it hit the wall A? The radius of gyration of the flywheel is 1 m
and its diameter is 2.30 m. Do not consider effects of bouncing in your
analysis. Neglect rolling resistance (Section 7.7) and wind friction losses.

Figure 16.27. Runaway flywheel at initial position

We assume slipping occurs when the flywheel first touches the floor
(see Fig. 16.28).Newton’s law for the center of mass of the flywheel is
(.4)N = (4;’ki:5j
-- x

Therefore,
I N = 500g
X = 3.92 mlsec, Figure 16.28. xv fixed at initial position.
Integrate twice:
X = 3.921 + C, (a)
X = 1.962t2 + C,t + C, (b)
At r = 0, .i‘ = 0 and X = 0. Hence, C, = 0 and C, = 0. The moment-of-
momentum equation for axes fixed to the body at the center of mass is next
given.

Therefore,
8 = 4.51 rad/sec2
Integrate twice:
e = 4.51t + c, (C)
0 = 2.261’ + C,t + C, (dl
822 ('HAPTER I6 KIVI:'I'ICS OF PL.hNk. blUrlON OF RI(;III tl0l)lF.S

Example 16.9 (Continued) I-.*-

When I = 0. 6 = 0. ;ind 6 = -(200)(2n/f/hO) = -2O.W r;idlsec. llcncc.


C., = -20.94 and C,; = 0.
We now ask when does the slipping stop? Clearly, i t stops whcn thcrc
01 the point of contiicI 01' the c)linder."' Friinn kinematics
i s :PTO w l w i l ~
we havc for this condilirm:

y + (2$!)8 = (el

Substituting from Eq. (:I) and ( c j 111-k and d, respectively. w~have 111-
Eq. (e):

3.92/ + (2.$)(4.5
- I, -- 20.041 :0

Thrrclore.
I = 2.64 scc
Since we get a Lime tiers greater than Lcro. we ciin be iissurcd that (tic iiii-
tial slipping aswmption i s valid. Thc position X, ill ltic lime o i iiiitiiil
no-slipping i s deduced f h n i Eq. (h). Thus.

i
I
9
X, s, = ( I .Oh2ji2.64)' = 13.67 111

Accordingly, thc flywheel hits the wall ((ficri t stiirts rolling withoof dip-
ping. At f = 2 sec, thcrc i s s l i l l slipping. and U c ciiii L I ~ C Eq. (;I) t o find X
at this instant. Thus.

(a,,,,,= (3.92)(2) = 7.85 mlsec


The spred. once ihcre i s no further slipping. i s cwulaiit, ;ind 5 0 the s p n d
a t the wall i s f o u n d hy using i = 2.64 scc in k1.
( i l l . Thus,

(&, = (3.92)(2.64) = 10.35 mlsec


16.33. A stepped cylinder is released from a rest configuration 16.35. The cylinder shown is acted on by a 100-lb force. At the
where the spring is stretched 200 mm. A constant force F of contact point A , there is viscous friction such that the friction
360 N acts on the cylinder, as shown. The cylinder has a mass force is given as
of 146 kg and has a radius of gyration of I m. What is the fric-
tion force at the instant the stepped cylinder is released? Take f = .0sv,
p > = .3 for the coefficient of friction. The spring constant K is
270 N/m. where % is the velocity of the cylinder at the contact point in
ft/sec. The weight of the cylinder is 30 Ih, and the radius of gyra-
tion k is l ft. Set up a third-order differential equation for finding
the position of 0 as a function of time.

Figure P.16.33.
Figure P.16.35.
16.34. A stepped cylinder is held on an incline with an inexten-
sible cord wrapped around the inner cylinder and an outside agent
(not shown). If the tension T o n the cord at the instant that the
cylinder is released hy the outside agent from the position shown
is 100 Ib, what is the initial angular acceleration'? What is the
16.36. The cylinder shown weighs 445 N and has a radius of
acceleration rd'the mass center? Use the following data: gyration of .27 m. What is the minimum coefficient of friction at
A that will prevent the body from moving'? Using half of this coef-
W = 300lb ficient of friction, how far d does Doint 0 move in 1.2 sec if the
k = 3ft cylinder is released from rest?
R, = 2ft
R, = 4 f t
p = .I

45"

Figure P.16.34. Figure P.16.36.

82:
16.37. Thc >cIocitic\ point\
~ W O 0 1 a cylindcr, namcly A and 16.39. A light rod AH connect\ a platc C with il cylinder 0
B , are which may roll without slipping. A torque 7 of \ d u e XI ft-I17 i s
applied t o plate C'. What i s the angular accclcratiiin of cylinder I I
Vi = 6 111 /\ y j = 2 111I\ when the torque i s applied'! The plate ueiphs 100 Ih arid the cyliii-
What i s the velocity 01 pninl /I? Ii tlre cylinder hila il mass vi dcr weighs 200 Ih.
4.2 kc, what i \ tlir ancolar iiccelcriition for il dynamic cucfficient I'

I'

Figure P.lh.39.
16.40. A semicircular cylinder A i s shou'tr. 'ihe iliiiniclcr ut A I C
I fl. ;and the wright is 100 Ih. What i s thc mgukir :iccelcmtim of
A at the QC,\ili<nl \ h o w l if at this instant llicrc i b no slipping and
the semicylinder is stationary'!

Figure P.16.37.

16.38. A thin ring liaving a m a s 01 0.4 kg i i released from rest


and rolls without slipping undcr tlir action r r f a IO-N force. Two
Figure P.16.40.
identical tirctal scctors caclr o t m a s s 0.83 kg arc attached to the
ring,Wh;,t i, thr ;infu];Lr C li CCICn
,ltil rlfthe Each scctclr has 16.41. A 20 kg ha, Ab' cilnncct'i two gcav G and ti. These gears
1 radius of g y r a t i m :it it, ocntroid cqual to h = 0.1 8 m. each have a mass of 5 kg and a diamctci of 300 m m . A torque 7oi
5 N-m i s applied t r i gear H . What i s the angular \peed of / I a f t c i ~
211 sec if thr Yyytem starts Rom rest'! The b n t e i i i i s i n a troriionrill
plane. Bar AH i c 2 m long.

X
Figure P.lh.3X. Figure P.lh.41.

324
16.42. A bar C weighing 445 N rolls on cylinders A and B, each 16.47. A pulley system is shown. Sheave A has a mass of 25 kg
weighing 223 N. What i s the acceleration of bar C when the 90-N and has a radius of gyration of 250 mm. Sheave 8 has a mass of
force is applied as shown'! There is no slipping. 15 kg and has a radius of gyration of 150 mm. If released from
rest, what is the acceleration of the 50-kg block'? There is no
slipping.
f3.2 m--3
1 2m
.'
-3 2m
' 90N

Figure P.16.42.

16.43. In Problem 16.42, at what position of the bar relative to


the wheels does slipping first occur after the force is applied?
Take p,$ = .2 for the bottom contact surface and p,$ = . I for the
contact surface between bar and cylinders. From Problem 16.42,
i. = 1.442 m/sec2.

16.44. A platform 8, of weight 30 Ih and carrying block A of


weight 100 Ib, rides on gears D and E as shown. If each gear
weighs 30 Ib, what distance w i l l platform 8 move in . I sec after
the application of a 100-lb force as shown?

Figure P.16.47.

16.48. A steam locomotive drive system is shown. Each drive


wheel weighs 5 kN and has a radius of gyration of 400 mm. At the
instant shown, a pressure p = .50 N/mm2 above atmospheric acts
Figure P.16.44. on the piston to drive the train backward. Ifthe train is moving at
1 d s e c backward at the instant shown, what is its acceleration'!
16.45. A crude cart is shown. A horizontal force P of LOO Ih is Members AB and RC are to he considered stiff but light in com-
applied to the cart. The coefficient of static friction between parison to other parts of the engine. Also, the piston assembly can
wheels and ground i s .6. If D = 3 ft, what is the acceleration of be considered light. Only the driving car is in action in this prob-
the cart to the right'! The wheels weigh 50 Ib each. Neglect friction lem. It has one driving system, on each side ofthe locomotive as
in the axle bearings. The total weight of cart with load is 322 Ih. shown below. It has two additional wheels of the size and mass
Treat the whecls as simple snlid cylinders. described above on each side of the locomotive plus additional
small wheels whose rotational inertia we shall neglect. The drive
train minus its eight large wheels has a weight of 150 kN. Assume
no slipping, and neglect friction in the piston assembly.

Figure P.16.45.
400 m
16.46. What minimum force component P is required to cause
the cart in Problem 16.45 to move so that the wheels slip rather
than roll without slipping? Figure P.16.48.

825
16.49. A system of intcrconnected gears is shown. Gear B
rotates about a fixed axis, and gear I ) is stationary. If a torque T r,t
2.5 N-ni is applied ti) gear B at the configuratian shown, what is
the angular acceleration of gear A'! Gcar A has ii mass of 1.36 kg
while gear R has a mass of 4.55 kg. The system is in a vertical ori-
entation relative t o the ground. What vcrtical force i \ transrriitted
to stationary gear W?

Figure ILlh.51
16.52. A thin-walled cylinder is shown held in pnsitian by a cord
AB. The cylinder has ii mash of I O kg and has an outside diameter of
600 mm.What tire the nuiiilal and frictiirn firrccs at ihe conliict p i n t
C a t the instalit that cord AH i \ cut'! Asmmc ihal no slipping occurs.

Figurc P.16.49.
Figurc P.16.52.
16.53. A bent rod CBL'I. is wrldcd 1,) a chaft. At thc end5 C and
16.50. A solid semicircular cylinder of weight Wand radius H is F arc idenlical g e m G and H . each of r m a ~ s3 kg and radius <>f
released from rest liom the porition shown. What is the friction gyration 70 inin. The g e m mmli with rl large stational-y pearl). A
Force at that instant'? lorqnr T uf 50 N ~ m is applied til the shalt. What is the angular
*peed of the >haft after I O 5ec i f the \y\trni i \ initially at rest'! The
bent rnd has a milss pcr unit lcnplh of 5 hplm. Will there hc forces
:an the hcil-ings 0 1 the shali other than tliuw from gravity'? Why?

Figure P.lh.50.

16.51. A cylinder is shown made up of two semicylinders A and


Y weighing 15 Ih and 10 Ib, respeclively. If the cylinder ha\ a
liamerer of 3 in, what is the angular acceleration when ii is
.eleased friim it stationary configuration at the position shown?
kssume n u slipping.

326
16.56. A cable is wrapped around two pulleys A and U . A force
T i s applied tu the end of the cables at G. Each pulley weighs 5 Ib
and has a radius of gyration of 4 in. The diameter of the pulleys is
12 in. A body C weighing 100 Ib i s supported by pulley B. Sus-
pended from body Cis il body /I weighing 25 Ib. Body 1) i s Iow-
ered from body C s o as tu accelerate at the rate of 5 ftlsec'
relative to body C. What force T i s then needed to pull the cable
downward at C at the increasing rdte of 5 ftlsec'?

1 - - 1
IhOmm
Figure P.16.53.

16.54. A tractor and driver has a mass of 1,350 kg. I f a total torque
T of 300 N-m i s developed on the two drive wheels by the motor,
what is the acceleration of the tractor"? The large drive wheels each
have a mass of YO kg. a diameter of I m, and a radius of gyrativn of
400 nim. The small wheels each have a mass 20 kg and have a diam-
eter of 300 mm with a radius of gyration of 100 mm. A
Figure
16.57. A cylinder A is acted on by a torque T of 1,000 N-m. The
cylinder has a mass of 75 kg and a radius of gyration of 400 mm.
A light rod CD connects cylinder A with a second cylinder tJhav-
Figure P.16.54. ins a mass of 50 kz
c
ZWdtlOn of 200 mm. What is
and a radius of I,
the force in member CD when torque T i\ applied'! The system is
16.55. A hlock weighing 100 Ih rides [in two identical cylin- stationari at the the torque is Assume no slipping
d e n C and D weighing 50 Ib each as shown. On top of block U is of cylinder along the illcline.
a block A weighing 100 Ib. Block A is prevented from moving to
the left by a wall. If we neglect friction between A and U and
between A and the wall and we consider no slipping at the contact
surfaces of the cylinders, what is the angular sptcd ufthe cylinders
after 2 sec for P = X0 Ib'!

Figure P.16.55. Figure P36.57.


A

400 N
Figuru P.lh.58. Figure P.lh.61.

500 N
450 A
A

Im
S
Figure P.16.59.
Bigure l'.lh.62.

828
16.67. In the preceding problem the disc is in the vertical plane
and is held up by a horimrital surface where the coefficients ot
frictian are ps = .005 and p,, = ,003. What are the initial linear
acceleration of the center of niav and the initial angular accelera-
tion of the disc? Start by assuming 110 slipping.

16.68. A cylinder A slide5 off the flatbed of a truck (Fig.


P. 16.68.) onto the r o d with zero angular velocity. The niasi of the
cylinder is 100 kg; its redius is I m; and its radius ofgyretion about
the axis through the center of mass is 0.75 m. The coefficient of
friction 1,)betwccn the cylinder and the pavement is 0.6. If marks
on the pavemetit from the cylinder while it is sliding extend over a
distance along the road of 3 rn. and if the axis of the cylinder re-
mains perpendicular to the sides of the road during the action,
what was the approximate s p e d of the truck when the cylinder
slid off. Ncglcct the apeed of the cylinder relative to the truck
whcn it slides off. [Hinr; What do thc pavcmcnt marks signify'?]

Figure P.16.64.

Neglect the mass of the slider at C, hut do not consider it to he


frictionless. A strain gauge informs us that there is a torque of 20 Figure P.16.68.
ft-lb actine on rod AB at A .
Y

16.6Y. Three forces act on a plate resting on a frictionless sur-


16.66. A circular disc is shown with a circuhr hole. It rests on a face, They are F, = )()() Ib, p2 = 200 Ih, and a fr,rce T~ = 35" (h
frictionless surface and the view shown is from above. A force F ,,,hose direction @ i s t,> be determined so that the ,,late has a c O u n ~
= .MIb acts on the disc. The thickness of the disc is 2 in and the terclockwice angular acceleration of ,204 red/st.ct. ~~~~~~~i~~ aiso
specific weight is 350 Ih/ft3. What is the initial linear acceleration the aCcelerillion for the centel of mBbS of the ,,late, The
of the center of mass and the angular acceleration of the disc'! mass of the ,,late is 178 Ihnl.
Y
t=2in
I Y=350 Iblfl'

tI4 = 2W Ib
6'

Figure P.16.69.

16.70. In Pruhleni 16.63, what force P is needed to uniformly


accelerate the cart so that the cylinder A tmoves 1 m i n 2 sec rcla-
tive to the cart. Cart R has a mass of 10 kg. Neglecl the inertia
o f the small rollers wppolling the a r t , and assume there is nn
Figure P.16.66. slipping.

829
16.71. A wcdgc H i s shown u d h ii cylinder A of ~ r i i i i s20 kg and
diameter SO0 mm o n the incliLw The wedge i s givcn a cimsLm1
acceleration of 20 mlsrc2 t o the right. How far d doe\ lhc cylinilci
muve in scc relative tu Ihc incline i t there i\ 110 lipp pin^'! 'TI,?
systcin starts froin rest.

Figure P.16.71.

16.72. A block weighing 100 N i s hcld h> I h i ~ e rincxlemihli. guy


wires. What arc the toroes i n wires ,AC and H I ) at lhc i i i s l m l 1 1 ~ 1
wire EC i s cut?

'1
Figure P.16.72.

16.73. A buwlrr relzilscs his ball at il speed nf 3 m l c c c . If thc


ball has a diameter ot 250 m n , what spin (I) h > u l d he ~ U on
I ihc
bull 50 there is 110 blipping? It he puts un unly half of this spin w.
keeping the same speed of 3 mlscc, w h t l i\ thc final (teinminitl)
speed of the ball? What i s thc speed after 3 x c ' ? .lhe ball hiis a
"lass of 1.8 kg and a dynamic coefficient of triclioii with thr 1 1 , ~ ~
of .I.Neglect wind resistance :ind rolling resi\tance (a\ d i s c w \ e d
in Section 7.7).

Figure P.16.73. Figure P.16.76.


16.77. The great English liner, the Queen Elizabeth (QE 11). is 16.79. A cylinder of mass 20 kg can rotate inside a block B whose
the last transatlantic luxury ship left. All the others have been mass is 35 kg. There is a constant resisting torque for this rotation
either scrapped or made into pleasure excursion ships. The QE I1 given as 200 N-m. A horizontal 1,000-N force is applied to a cable
is 700 ft long and weighs 60,000 tons. firmly wrapped around the cylinder. What is the velocity of the
block after moving 0.5 m'? What is the angular velocity of the cylin-
(a) At a top speed of 4o knots, with the engines produc- der when the block reaches this The coefficient ofdyn&c
ing I 103000 what is the thrust coming friction between block B and the flour is 0.3. The system is shown in
from the propellers? a vertical orientation.
(b) In a harbor, two tugboats are turning an initially sta-
tionary QE I1 as shown in the diagram. Determine an
approximate value for the angular acceleration of the
ship. Consider the ship to be a long uniform rod.
Include an additional one fourth of the mass of the
ship to account for the water which must be moved to
accommodate the movement of the ship. Each tug
develops a force of 5,000 Ib. Y
(c) If the tugs remain perpendicular to the QE 11, and if
we assume constant angular acceleration, how many
minutes are required to turn the ship IO degrees?

Figure P.16.79.
Lx
16.80. A rod AB of length 3 m and weight 445 N is shown
immediately after it has been released from rest. Compute the ten-
sion in wires EA and DB at this instant.

16.78. A cable supports cylinder A of mass 40 kg and then


wraps around a light cylinder B and finally supports cylinder C of
mass 20 kg. If the system is released from rest, what are the accel- Figure P.16.80.
erations of the centers of A and C?There is no slipping.
16.81. Rod AB is released from the configuration shown. What
are the supporting forces at this instant if we neglect friction'! The
Y rod weighs 200 Ib and is 20 ft in length.

Lx
Figure P.16.78. Figure P.16.81.

83 I
Figure P.lh.Xh.

832
Figure P.16.88.
Figure P.16.90.

16.91. In Prohlcm 15.48, wjc determined the following results


16.89. We are looking down from above at a baseball player from kinematics:
swinging his bat in a horizontal plane in the process of hitting a wAx = -509 rads V, = 4.3X mis
baseball at point B. The player is holding the bat such that the
resultant of the force from his hands is at point A. At what dis-
hA,,= 14.71 radlszc' &! = -31.28 d s 2
tance d should the ball hit the bat to render as zero the normal The mass rif rod AB is 1 0 kg. If we neflect the muses of the slid-
force component from the batter's hands onto the centerline of the ers, what are the forces coming onto the end pins of the rod'! The
bat'? This point B is called the retrfrr of percussion. Because this horizontal slot in which slider A is moving is frictionless.
kind of hit feels effortless to the batter it is often called the "sweet
cpot" by athletes in both baseball and tennis. The radius of gyra-
tion ahout the center of mass is k..

x
Y

Figure P.16.89.

A
16.90. A torque 7 = 10 N-m is applied to body C. If there is no Figure P.16.91.
slipping, how many rotations does cylinder B make in I sec if the
system starts from rest'? A is stationary at all times. The system 16.92. In the preceding problem. the ilider at A no longer moves
starts from rest. We are observing the system from above. The fol- in the slot without friction and we do not know the friction f k c e
lowing data apply. there. However, we have a strain gage mounted nn rod AB giving
data indicating a 200 N compressive axial force at A . Using the
Mc = 50 kg MB = 30 kg data of the previous problem, compute the force components at
k, = .2m k,* = . I m the ends of the rod.

x33
16.8 Pure Rotation of an
Arbitrary Rigid Body
We now consider ii body having an arhitriiry d i h h u t i o n of mass rotating a b ~ u t
an axis of rotation fixed i n inertial space. We consider this axis to he the :
axis fixed i n the body a\ well a h being an incrtial ciiordiiiate axis %. We can
take the origin ofr:~;anywhere along the :axis since all such points are fixed
i n i n c l t i d space. The , I I O n ? P , 1 1 - 0 f l f l O I n r l l f l ( n l equations tu be used will now hc
the general equations 16.6 hilice I, nnd I ~w> ~ i l l generally 1101 equal zerti. I f the
center of inass i s along the :axis. then i t oh\,iously has no acceleration. and
50 we can then apply tlic rulcs 01 statics to the ccntcr of mass. For othei- cases
we shall often need t u use N(WIOII'SI r i w iur tlic cciiter of niass. I n this !regard
i t w i l l he helpful to nole lroni the definition 01 the centcr of mass that ibr a
\ysteiii of rigid bodies such ii\ i\ i h o w n i n Fig. 16.29

where ,)I, i s the mass iif the ith rigid body, r, i s the positioii vectnr to the cen-
ter of mass of the ith ]rigid hndy, M i s the tnlal mass, and <
i \ the position vec-
tnr LO Ihe ~ e i i l e rof n i a h h of the system. We can then say on differrentiatiiig:

111 Ncw~on'.,Iuw fiir the mass czntrr (if ii bystcni of rigid hodics. wc coiicludc
that we can use the centers nf inass 01 the component parts of the system as
given on h e right side of Eq. 16.18 rather than the ccntcr n l inash of the Iutiil
Inas\.
SECTION 16.8 PURE ROTATION OF AN ARBITRARY RlGlD BODY 835

Example 16.10
A shaft has protruding arms each of which weighs 40 Nlm (see Fig.
16.30). A torque T gives the shaft an angular acceleration h of 2 rad/sec2.
At the instant shown in the diagram, o is 5 radlsec. If the shaft without
x. x

Figure 16.30. Rotating shaft with arms

arms weighs 180 N, compute the vertical and horizontal forces at bearings
A and 5 (see Fig. 16.31j. Note that we have numbered the various arms for
convenient identification.
x, x
I

Figure 16.31. Supporting forces

We first fix a reference xyz to the shaft at A. Also at A we fix an iner-


tial reference XYZ to the ground. We can directly use Eqs. 16.6a and 16.6b
about poitit A . For this reason, we shall compute the required products of
inertla of the shaft system for reference xyz. Accordingly, using the parallel-
axis theorem, we have:

(/xz =0 + 0(.3[(.6)(.3)] = .440 kg-m2


8

Hence, for the system, I,, = ,440 kg-m2.


We next consider I.,. Accordingly, we have
836 1 6 KINETICS OF PLANE MOTION OF R I G I D HOI)I~.S
CHAVIEK

Example 16.10 (Continued)

KJ,,,~,,= n + o = o

Hence, for the system, 5,. = 4.62 kg-in'.


We can now cmploy the moment of momentum equations (Eqr.
16.6) to get the required moment:, M, and M,,about point A needed fol-the
motion we are considering. Thus, we have

MA = -(2)(.440) + (S'J(4.62) = 114.7 N-m (a)


M, = -(21(4.62) - (5')(.4401 = - 20.2 N-III (hi

Summing moments of all the forces acting on the system ;ihout the axis
at A , we can say (see Fig. 16.3I!:

M3 = -20.2 = -~40)(.60J(.601
- (40)(.60)(1.9)

-(40)(.60)(2.7)- (180)(1.6) + ( B , l(3.2)

Therefore, we require

Summing moments about the s axis at A. we can say

M r = 114.7 = -B>(1.?)

Therefore, we require

Wc next usc Newton's law considering the three arms to be three


particles at their mass centers a s ha\ heen shown in Fig. 16.32. In the ~i
SECTION 16.8 PURE ROTATION OF AN ARBIlRARY RIGID BODY 837

Example 16.10 (Continued)

Figure 16.32. Arms replaced by mass centers.

direction at time f we have, using Eq. 16.18 and noting that each of the
aforementioned particles has circular motion:

118.9 + Ax - 180 - (3)[(40)(.60)] = - (40)(.60) (,30)(02)


8

Setting w = 5 radsec and Ci, = 2 radsec*, we get

In they direction, we can say similarly at time f

Av - 35.8 =
0"0)(.30)(h) - --(.30)(w2)
(40K.60) - (40)(.60) (,60)(02
R R R

Therefore,

The forces acting on the shaft are shown in Fig. 16.33. The reactions to
these forces are then the desired forces on the bearings. In the z direction it
should be clear that there is no force on the bearings.

llON 118.9 N

17.78 N 35.8N

A B
Figure 16.33. Forces on shaft.
Ii.i n the last cxamplc. wc had ignored the constant lorcch o i p i v i l y .
wc would lriivc dclcrmincd lorcc\ at hearings A and /I that are due entirely 1 0
the nitrlion 01 the hody. Forces c~~nipiited in thi< \\':I)' ai-c ciillcd h.iwnri~.,fiin.~,.\.
It tlrc hody a c r e rotating with constant speed w. lhcse lorce\ would clearly
h i i constililt
~ viilucs in the .c and y directions. Since the i~ axes are riitaling
with the hody rclativc to the ground 1-efercncc XYZ. such dynamic forces inust
d s o rotate relative to the ground ahout the a x i s 01rotation with the spccd (oot
thc hody. This iiieans that. i n any l i r r i l direcfioii iroriiiiil 10 the h i l i ill ii hcar-
~~~~~ a~
iiig, llicre w i l l be a . ~ ; I I ~ . ~ ~ i~w ;r i~< /i i~i with , frequency
/ ~ J ~ ~ correaponding
~ ~ ~
to the angular rotiitioii 0 1 the shaft. Such force\ can induce vibrations 11i Iwge
;iiiiplitudc i n lhc s~rucxiircor support i l ii natural irequency or multiplc 01 a
natural frequency i s reached in these hodie?.' I Wlrcn a shall creates rotating
iorces on the hcxings hy virtue 01' i t s own rotation, the shah i s m i d 111 h e
uiibalanced. We shall set up critcriii lor halancing ii rotating hody i n Ihe next
scclion

"16.9 Balancing
We shall iiow \el iorth lhc critcriii ior the condilion of dynamic bal;incc i n ii
I-otaling body. 'l'lic~i. w e h l l XI iorth llic rcq~iirc~iicnts needed to achie\c
halance i n a rotating body. Consider thcn ~ m i arhitl-ary c rigid body rotating
with angular speed (0and ii iriitc of change 0 1 angular speed ahout axis AH
(Pig. 16.34).We shall set up general cqualioiis lor dctcnnining the supporling
iot-ces at the hearings. Considci- point ( i on llic i i x i s o f rotation at the hc;iring
A :urd establish a \et o l iixcs I.!: l i x r d 10 the rotating hody wilh the :iixis cor-
responding ttr !he u i h o l rotation Thc .( nnd !axes are chosen lor convc-
nience. Axes XYZ are, iis usi1~1.inertial iixcs. Ilsing the i i i ( , l l i n , i ~ ( 1 - i ~ i , i I 1 P l i f i i l ) i
equations ( a ) and ( h ) i n Eq. 16.6 and including only (Iyiiarriic lorces. we get
ior p i n t 1,:

/?>I= -I$ + /$ ( I 6. I%I I


H / rz -1 v: (i, . ~I.I; (01 (Ih.lc)b)
SECTION 16.9 BALANCING 839

If the axis of rotation is a principal M ~ S at hearing A, then {,z = 5, = 0 in


accordance with the results of Chapter 9. The dynamic forces at hearing B are
then zero.
Next, we shall show that if in addition the center of mass lies alonx
the axis of rotation, this axis is a principal axis for all points on it. In Fig.
16.35 a set of axes x’y’r’ fixed to the body and parallel to the xyz axes has
been set up at an arbitrary point E along the axis of rotation. We can see
from the arrangement of the axes that for any element of the body dm:
y‘ = y. x’ = x, z‘= D+z (16.20)

Figure 16.35. Reference x’v’z’ fixed at E.

Also, we know for the xyz reference that

xzdm = 0, lvz= I M y z d m = 0 (16.21)

And if the center of mass is along the centerline, we can say:

I M y d m = I,y’dm = My, = 0 (16.22)

I,xdm = I,x’dm = Mxc = 0

We shall now show that all products of inertia involving the z’axis at E are
zero under these conditions and, consequently, that the z’axis is a principal
axis at E . Substituting from Eqs. 16.20 into 16.21, we get

I,x‘(z’- Djdm = 0 (a)

jMy,(z’-Djdm=0 (b)

If we cany out the multiplication in the integrand of the above Eqs. (a) and (b),
we get

1, x’z’ dm ~ DIMx’ dm = 0 (C)

y’z’dm - D J y’dm = 0 (d)


M
As a result of Eq. 16.22. thc sccond integrals of Eqs. (c) and (d) are zero, and
w e conclude that the product5 of inertia I1..and I>,,.,arc Lero. Now tlie.ty axes
and hence the ~ n i ' iixcs can have irny orientiition as long a s they are norinal to
the axis of rotiitim. This means that at I<the ;' axis yields ii zer11 psiiduct 01
incrtia for all axes nornid to it. As a result of our deliberations of Chaptcr 9.
we ciin concludc lhat ;' is :I principal axis for point t . And since E is any
point on the axis of rolntion. w e can say the follii\ving:

I f the axis uf rotation is a principal axis at any point along this axis and if
the center af ma&s is on the axis of rotation, then the axis ijf rutation is a
principal axis at ullpointr on it.

Wc now consider Fig. 16.36. where reference ~X~Y'Z'is set u p at bcaring / I . Wr


ciin ncxl cniploy the moment-of-rnomentuni cquation ( 16.6) f o r these axes
ill I(. w c get
1 -I$,:,h
- ~ A 3= + 18,;,co'
-,$,I = - / s , / b - /).;.o?

With lhc :axis ii principal axis at .'iand thc ccntcs of inass along the axis 0 1
rotalion. the 7' iixi5 at B n i i i s t he a pi-incipal a A , and licnce Ir,:, = I > , , . = 0.
The dynamic Icirces iit bcaring A. thcrcforc. arc zcro. Thc solatins system is
t h i i b balanced.
w c can llOM conclll~lcthat:

For a rotating system to be &namically balanced, ir is necessary and


sufficient ( I ) that at any point along the axis of rotation this axis is
principal axis and (2) that the renter ofmass is along the axis of rotation.

We next illustrate how w e can inake use 01 lheie r c d i s tu balancc a rotating


bodv.
SECTION 1b.Y BALANCING 841

r Example 16.11
A rotating member carries two particles having weights W, = 5 Ib and A Balancing n
W,- = 8 Ih at radial distances r l = 1 ft and r2 = I ' h ft, respectively. The ,/ planes

weights and a reference xyz fixed to the shaft are shown in Fig. 16.37. ,-
y'wi
They are to be balanced by two other particles having weights W, and W,
'I
1- -r;,
(shown dashed) which are to be placed in the balancing Ganes A and ~ I >
, If the weights are olaced in these olanes at a distance of I ft
resoectivelv.
> ~~ L
... I
from the axis of rotation, determine the value of these weights and their _ / . +w4
position relative to the q z reference. 3'
We have two unknown weights and two unknown angles, that is, four 2'
unknowns [see Fig. 16.37(b)], to evaluate in this problem. The condition (a)
that the mass center he on the centerline yields the following relations:"

(h)
When the numerical values of r,, r2,etc., are inserted, these equations become
Figure 16.37. Rotating system tu
w,coso, + W , ~ O S ~ ,= 13.18 (a) he balanced.
W, sin 6, - W, sin 6, = -6.77 (b)
Now we require that the products of inertia ivzand lxz
be zero for the
in the balancing plane B.
xyz refere,nce positioned so that xy is
I_ = 0 :

!R ( h ) ( - r , sin 20") + -2WK ( 2 ) ( r zsin 450) + 3


W
R
(9)(r3s i n e 3 ) = o (c)
ly7= 0 :

1W- ( 6 ) ( r ,cos20")+--?(2)(rzcos45")+-(Y)(-r,cos8,)
W w1 =0 (d)
K R 6
Equations (c) and (d) can be put in the form
9r% sine, = -6.71
9w1 COS^, = 45.2

'>We are considering the weights to he pilnicles in this dircursion. In solile homework
problems you will he asked to halance rotating systems fhc which the partick model will not
he proper. You will then have to carry out integrations andlor employ thc formulas and trani~
fer theorems for first moments of m a s and products of inrrlia.
842 CHAPTER 16 K1NI:TICS OF PI.ANF. MOTION 01: Kl(ill1 ROD1F.S

Example 16.11 (Continued)


Dividing Eq. (flinto Eq. (e). wc gct

Ian H3 = -. 1486

e, = 171.~0
or 351.6"

a n d so. from Eq. i t ) .

In order to have I positive weight W,. we chose 0, to he 35 I .6" rather than


171.5". Now we return 10 Eqs. (a) and (h). We can then say. on suh\tituling
known values of W, and 8,:

W ~ C ~ , S C ) ,= 13.18-5.01 - 8 . 1 6 ipl
W, sin = 6.77 - .75 = 6.02 ihJ

Dividing Eq. (g) into Eq. (hJ. we get


tan 0, = ,738

e, = 36.4" or 216.4"

Hence. from b q (g), we have

where we iise b,' = 36.4" rather than 216.4" to prevcnt a negative W,. Thc
linal orientation of the halanced system is shown in Fig. l6.3X.

Figure 16.38. Balanced sysit.m.


16.93. A shaft shown supported by bearings A and B i s rotating 16.95. Do Problem 16.94 for the case i n which w = 20 rad/sec
at a speed w of 3 radisec. Identical blocks C and D weighing 30 Ih and h = 38 rad/icc2 at the iiiitant of interest as shown.
each are attached to the shaft by light structural members. What
are the hearing reactions in the x and y directions if we neglect the 16.96. A uniform wooden panel is shown supported by hearings
weight of the shaft'? 4 and 8.A 100-1h weight i s connected with an inextensihle cable
to the panel at point G over a light pulley I). If the system is re-
leased from rest at the configuration shown, what is the angular
X 2' acceleration of the panel, and what are the forces at the bearings?
The panel weiFhs 60 Ib.

F 3 ' 4 /
12,,
Figure P.16.93.

16.94. Shaft A B is rotating at a constant speed w of 20 radlsec.


Two rods having a weight of I O N each are welded to the shaft
and suppolr a disc D weighing 30 N. What w e the suppolting forces
at the instant shuwn'!

100 Ih
I Figure P.16.96.
I 16.97. Do Problem 16.96 when there is a frictional torque at
the hearings of 10 ft-lh and the pulley has a radius of I ft and a
moment of inertia of IOm-fl'.

16.98. A thin rectangular plate weighing SO N is rotating about


its diameter at il speed w of 25 radlsec. What are the supporting
forces in the .r and s directions at the instant shown when the plate
is parallel to t h e y plane?

.r
I

4 300 mm
YO0 mm

2
y
Figure P.16.94. Figure P.16.98.

84:
16.99. A shaft is shown rotating at a speed of 20 radlsec. What 16.101. A bent shaft has applied to it a torque 7 including grav~
are the supporting forces at the bearings? The rods welded to the ity piven iis
shaft weight 40 Nim. The shaft weighs XO N.
7 = IO + 5 r N-m

where 1 is in scconds. What are thc supporting forces at the bear-


ings i n the r and? directions when i = 3 S C C ? The shaft is made
from a rod 20 inin in diamctcr and weighing 70 Nlm. At i = 3 sec.
the pnsilion of the .;haft i h a b shown.

Figure P.16.101.
Fipure P.16.99.

16.100. A cylinder is shown mounted at an angle 0130" to a


shaft. The cylinder weighs 400 N. If a torque T of 20 N-m is *l6.102. A ?halt has an angolar velocity o of 10 rad/scc and an
applied, what is the angular acceleration of the system? What arc accclcratlOn 0 "1 5 rad/scc: at the instant <jfi,,,e,est, what
the supporting forces in the x and j directions at the configuration thz bending this inslant about .I ilxeS just
shown wherein the system is stationary! Neglect the mass of the [he right thz bearing at A ' ? ~ l what~ arc ~ ,
shaft. The centerline of the cylinder is in the x7 plane at the instant ,nr,mcnt a,,d shear r,,rces ~h~ \haft and rr,ds have
yhown. it diameter 0120 nim and a weight per unit lrnpih of50 N / m

Figure P.16.100. Pigure P.16.102.


16.103. Balance the system in planes A and R at a distance 1 ft 16.107. Balance the shaft described in Problem 16.106 by
from centerline. Use two weights. removing a small chunk of metal from each of the end faces
of the 100-lb cylinder at a position I O in from the shaft cen-
terline. What are the weights of these chunks and what are their
orientations?

16.108. Balance the shaft in Problem 16.99 using balancing


planes just next to hearings A and B. At hearing B use a small bal-
ancing sphere of weight 30 N and at heanng A use a rod having a
weight per unit length of 35 N/m.

Figure P.16.103.

16.109. A disc is shown mounted off-center at B on a shaft CD


that rotates with angular speed 0.The diameter of the shaft is 2 in.
16.104. Balance the system in Problem 16.103 by using a
The disc weighs 50 Ib and has a diameter of 6 ft. Balance the sys-
weight in plane A of I'h Ih and a weight in plane B of I Ib. You
tem using two rods, each weighing 10 Ih/ft and having a diameter
may choose suitable radii in these planes.
of 2 in. The rods are to be attached normal to the shaft at position
1 ft in from bearing C and 2 ft. in from hearing D.Determine the
lengths of these rods and their inclination.

16.105. Balance the shaft of Problem 16.94 using rods weighing


50 N/m and welded to the shaft normal to the centerline just next
to bearings A and E . Determine the lengths of these rods and their
orientations relative to the xv axes.

16.106. A disc and a cylinder are mounted on a shaft. The disc X


has been mounted eccentrically so that the center of mass is '12 in
from the centerline of the shaft. Balance the shaft using balancing
planes 5 ft in from hearing A and 3 ft in from hearing B , respec- Figure P.16.109.
tively. The balancing masses each weigh 3 Ih and can be regarded
as particles. Give the proper position of the balancing masses in
these planes.

16.110. Balance the shaft shown for Problem 16.101. Use a hal-
ancing plane just next to bearing A and one just next to hearing B.
Attach a circular plate normal to the shaft at each bearing, and cut
a hole with diameter 60 mm at the proper position in the plate to
balance the system. The plates are 30 mm thick and have a spe-
F i t u r e P.16.106. cific weight of 8 x IO-' N/mm'.

845
16.10 Closure
I n this chapter, we Iuve dcvcloped the moment~oE~moiiiciitum equations fnr
plane motion o f i i rigid body. We applied this cqiiation to viirioiis case? of plane
inotioii starting fi-om the simple,l case iind going ti) the i i i n s t difficult case.
Many pi-nhlcins I)( engineering interest can he taken i i s pl;inr-motiiin priiblemc:
thr results of this chapter are hence quite iniportant. The use 01MA = H,
applied ti) ttiree-diineiision;il miltion of a rigid body is considered i n Chapter
I X (starred chapter). Students wliii cover that chapter will find the devclop-
ment of the key cquntion\ (the Euler equation\) \cry similar to the dcvcliip-
inent of Eqs. 16.6. !he kcy cquationc for plane inotion.
Ketal next that in Chapter I3 u:e considcred the work-energy equa-
tion\ fnr the p l m c 111i)tiiinof siniplc bodics in the process of riilling without
slipping. Wc did this to help illutriite the use nf tlie work+iicrpy cqualioii\
Ifor an aggregate of piirticlcs. Alsii. t h i s iindcrtaking served ti) inolivalc ii ininre
detailed study of kinemeiics of irigid bodies and tn set forth i n iiiiniaturc the
more general pioccdurcs t u come liitei. We arc therefore 110w ready l o exiiiii-
ine energy inethods i i s applied to rigid bodies i n a ininre gcticral way. 'I'hi,
will bc done i n Part A of Chapter 17. We shall d lop the work-energy
cquatiiins for three-di~irrnsi~i~ial ~ n i i i t i n i i ;ind apply tlicni to all kind\ 01
iiintions, including plane iniifiniis. The student should not lime difficulty i n
going dircclly to tlie g e n e r i c a x : indccd. ii better undcrstandinf of the suh-
icct should result.
I n Part H of Chapter 17. we \hall consider the impulse-momeiitu~ii
equations lor rigid hiidies. This will he an extension of the uscful iinpulx-
niniiieiitiini methods discussed i n Ch;iptcr I4 for particle\ ;ind ;iggregates 01
particles. Again, w e \hall h e able to go to thc general case and lhcn apply the
results tci thee- and Iwi)~diiiiciirioti;il i i i i i t i o i i s (plane motions).
16.111. A circular plate A is used in electric meters to damp out
rotations of a shaft by rotating in a bath of nil. The plate and its
shaft have a mass of 300 g and a radius of gyration of 100 mm. If
the shaft and plate very thin down from 30 rpm to 20 rpm in 5 sec,
what angular acceleration can be developed by a ,005 N-m torque
when o o f the shaft is 10 rpm? Assume that the damping torque is
proportional to the angular speed.

Figure P.16.113.

16.114. A platform A has B torque T applied about its axis


of rotation. The platform has a mass of 1,000 kg and a radius of
Figure P.16.111. gyration of 2 m. A block B rests on the platform hut i s prevented
from sliding off by very thin stops C and D. The block has a mass
of I kg and has dimensions 200 mm x 200 mm x 200 mm. The
center of mass of the block is at ita geometric center. If a torque
16.112. The dynamic coefficient of friction for contact surfaces T = 20t2 + 501 N-m is applied with f i n seconds, when and how
E and G is .2 and for A is .3. If a force P of 250 Ib is applied, what does the block first tip? (Because of the small size and mass of R,
will he the tension in the cord HB? Start hy assuming no slipping consider the system to he a slablike body.)
at A . Check your asaumption at the end of the calculation.

Figure P.16.112.

16.113. A torque T of 15 N-m is applied to a rod A B as


shown. At B there is a pin which slides in a frictionless slot in
a disc E whose mass i s 10 kg and a'hore radius o f gyration is
100 mm. If the system is at rest at the instant shown, what
i s the angular acceleratinn of the rod and the disc? The rod has
a mass of 18 kg. Figure P.16.114.

847
c

Figure 1'.16.115,
16.121. Rod AB of length I m and mass 10 kg is pinned to a
disc 11 having a mass of 20 kg and a diameter of .5 m. A torque
T = 15 N-m is applied to the disc. What are the angular accelera-
tions of the rod AB and disc at this instant'!

.., ... 16.122. A four-bar linkage is shown. Bar A B has the following
angular motion at the instant shown.
Figure P.16.119.

W, = 2 rddlsec
Oi, = 3 rad/iec2
16.120. Rod AB of length 20 ft and weight 200 Ib is released
from rest at the cvnliguration shown. A C is a weightless wire, and What are the forces at at this for the follow^
the incline at B is frictionless. What is the tension in the wire AC ing data?
at this instant'!

mass of AB = 4 kg
mass of BC = 3 kg
mass of CD = 6 kg

Figure P.lh.120. Figure P.16.122.


16.123. Starting from T w t , find the acceleration of device A
when the 10,000 N forcr i\ applied. Plncced as follows:
la) Draw and label lour free-body diapams.
(h) Wrire a sys1t.m of eqoationc \n.hmc n u m h r r equals
the numhcl- of unknriwni.
( c ) Do not solve the equ;itions hut do put in any numeri-
Cid daca.

/)<,la:
M, (for 2 w'heels) = 50 hg
M,, (for 2 wheels) = 100 kg
v,, 220 kg
=
M,. = 40 kg
ME (lor 2 whecls) = 100 kg
k, = .ox "I
kp, = 0.I2 "I

L), = 0.2 ni
I),, = 0.3 m

Figure P.16.124.

-
IO.000 N

Loose
pin
16.125. I n E x m p l c 15.5 decerminr thc forcc components at plns
A and R. The iniaqs (if rod A 8 I S X hg and the rmns o l RC i s S kg.
Ilse the kinematic results of the exuinplr.

16.126. A IO-m I-hcnm having a inass ul400 kx i s heing pullcil


hy a n ilstrmiiiit with his space propulsion rip as shoun. The lwce
X
is 40 N i i ~ isl alwayc i n thc siliiir d r c c t i w t . Initially, the hzar i s
N o slipping ti stationary relati\'e 10 the aslmnaut. and the connecting cord i s at
right angles to the heam. Consider the heam to hu ii long slender
Figure 1'. 16. I23 rod. What IS the anpular acceleration whcn thc hcarn ha\ rotated
IS"'! What I\ tlic p m i t i m o l tlir centci of mar\ alter 10 scu? (Can
y n u integmle the dilicrentia cqoatiori lor H t o pct t i m i l i a r f u i c -
tiom? l i x p l o i n . )

.6.124. A cylinder A can rotale ireely ahout its fixed cerilerline.


ywo sinaller idcntical cylinders H have axcs of latation nn cyltn-
ler A and initially w i l l s t a l l to roll wilhout slipping along the i n d -
,ated walls. What I S the initial angular acceleration of cylinder A
tnrting from rest under the action of a torque 7 = 5 N - m ? The
ystrm i s in B vertical plane. The following dau apply:

Figure P.lh.126.
16.127. A rectangular box having a mass of 20 kg is being trans- 16.130. Do Problem 16.129 for the case where end A is moving
ported on a conveyor belt. The center of gravity of the box is 150 downward at a speed of I O ftlsec at the instant shown and where
mm above the conveyor belt, as shown. What is the maximum stalt- fl,, = .2.
ing torque 7 for which the box will nor tip? The belt has a mass per
unit length of 2 kglm, and the driving and driven drums have a 16.131. In Problem 16.129, find by inspection the instantaneous
mass of 5 kg each and a radius of gyration of 130 mm. The dynamic axis of rotation for the rod. What are the magnitude and direction
of the acceleration vector for the axis of rotation at the instant the

I-
coefficient of friction between the belt and conveyor bed is .2.
rod is released? We know from Problem 16.129 that b = 3.107
300 m radlsec' and a? = 7.1% ~ 13.43 fVsec2 for the center of mass.
rl 16.132. Identical bars AB and BC are pinned as shown with fric-
tionless pins. Each bar is 2.3 m in length and has a mass of 9 kg.
A force of 450 N is exerted at C when the bars are inclined at 60".
What is the angular acceleration of the bars?

.I -
m
5 <
Figure P.16.127.

16.128. A ring is shown supported by wire AB and a smooth sur-


fdcc. The ring has a mass of 10 kg and a mean radius of 2 m. A
body D having a mass of 3 kg is fixed to the ring a6 shown. If the
wire is severed, what is the acceleration of body n?

B\ Figure P.16.132.
16.133. A compressor is shown. Member AB is rotating at a con-
stant speed w, of 100 rpm. Member BC has a mass of 2 kg and piston
C has a mass of I kg. The pressure p on the piston is 10,ooO Pa. At
the instant shown, what are the forces transmitted by pins B and C?
n

Figure P.16.128.

16.129. If the md shown is released from rest at the configurd-


tion shown, what are the supporting forces at A and B at that
instant? The rod weighs 100 Ib and is 10 ft long. The static coeffi-
cient of friction is .2 for dl surface cuntacts.

I50 mm
Figure P.16.129. Figure P.16.133.

85 I
*16.134. A thin vcnicill shalt i ~ t i u e swith angular cpecd 1u of 5 16.137. A X l h cylindcl- which i s spinning a1 a rate w0 of 500 rpm
r d s e c in heuings A and n ac chmm i n the diagnm. A uniform i s nlacrd o n an 8 deerce inclinc. Thc coefficicnts of frictioil are
platc H urighing 50 Ih i s atrachcd to the \halt us i \ ii disc C u'eighing p , = .4 and p,, = .3. HOM.far does the cyliiidsr mo\'e before therr
30 Ih. What ire the hearine reactions at thc confi!!oration shown?
I
i s rolling without slipping.'! How much rime elapses hefore the
The shaft weighs 20 Ih and the Ihicinrw ofili\c and platc is 2 111. cylinder stops moving instantanwusly?

I
ow Y
I
I)
tt
,
.i
h" t
3'
I

8'
Figure P.16.137.

Figure P.lh.134. 16.138. 111 Example 15.1 I . takc wiand h2hoth equal tu zrlu hut
*16.135. Do Prohlcm Ih. 100 for the car ~ h c i t w
: = 5 ir;d/sei kccp all other data. Detemme the lorce system at A knowing that
ill lhe imtimt of intcrcst. the Idlowing data apply:

*lh.136. In Example 16.lO. halance the rotating systcin hy Y H= 800 N &,,,~,,,ck ,, = 135 kg
pmpcrly placing 3h-N spherical rnilbscs in halmcing plane, 300
m n insidc f r o m the hearings A and Lj. Asaume thai the halancilig Note that the inan and cockpit are translating and can hc consid-
inasses are particlcc crcd a\ II partick of mass 135 kp.
Energy and
Impulse-Momentum
Methods for Rigid Bodies
17.1 Introduction
Let us pause to reflect on where we have been thus far in dynamics and where
we are about to go. In Chapter 12, you will recall, we worked directly with
Newton's law and integrated it several times to consider the motion of a par-
ticle. Then, in Chapter 13 and 14, we formulated certain useful integrated
forms from Newton's law and thereby presented the energy methods and the
linear impulse-momentum methods also for aparticle. At the end of Chapter 14,
we derived the important angular momentum equation, MA = HA. In Chapter
16, we returned to Newton's law and along with the angular momentum
equation, MA= H A carried
, out integrations to solve plane motion problems of
rigid bodies. In the present chapter, we shall come back to energy methods
and linear impulse-momentum methods-this time for the general motion of
rigid bodies. In addition, we shall use a certain integrated form of the angular
momentum equation MA =HA,namely the angular impulse-momentum equa-
tion. These equations at times will be applied to a single rigid body. At other
times, we shall apply them to several interconnected rigid bodies considered
as a whole. When we do the latter, we say we are dealing with a system of rigid
bodies. We shall consider energy methods first.

Part A:
Energy Methods
17.2 Kinetic Energy of a Rigid Body
First, we shall derive a convenient expression for the kinetic energy of a rigid
body. We have already found (Section 13.7) that the kinetic energy of an

853
854 (‘HAPTER 17 ENEKGY ANI1 IMI’UI.S~~MOMFNTI!MMETHODS FOK KIGII) n O r I l l 3

aggregate of particles relative lo a n y referencc is thc suin of two parts, which


we list again a s :
1. The kinetic cncrgy 01a hypothetical particle that has a mass cqual to thc
total mass of the systcm and a inoti(iii corresponding to that of the mas\
center of the system. plus
2. The kinctic cncrgy 01 the particles relativc to thc mia ass ccntcr.
Mathematically

/ I

whcre is thc position vector Sroni the mass center tn the ith particle.
Let us now consider the foregoing equation tis applicd to ia rigid body
which is a special “aggregate of particles” (Fig. 17. I i. 111 such a case. the
velocity of any particlc relatiw to lhc mass center becomes
fi = W X 11, (17.21

h’iaii = >M

X
F i p r e 17.1. Rigid h d y .

where w is the angular velocity of the hody relative to reference XYZ in which
we are computing the kinetic energy. For the rigid body. the discrete particles
of mass m , hccomc a continuum of infinitesimal particles each of mass (h.
and the sumination in Eq. 17. I then hecomes an integration Thus, we can say
for the rigid body. replacing li i 2 hy V:.

where p represents the pocition vectoi- f’rom the center of mass to any element
o f mass dm. Let us iiow choose a set of orthogonal directions ,rj: at the cen-
ter of mass. s o wc can carry o u t the preceding intcffiation in tcrnis 01. thc
scalar components o f w and p. This step is illustratcd in Fig. 17.2. We first
express the intcgral in Eq. 17.3 i n the fiillowinf nimncr:
SECTION 17.2 KINETIC ENERGY OF A RIGID BODY 85s

Figure 17.2. Fix xyz at center of mass.

Inserting the scalar components, we get:

*[(mxi + w y j + m z k ) x ( M + yj + & ) ] } d m

Carrying out first the cross products and then the dot product in the integrand
and collecting terms, we form the following relation on extracting the w’s
from the integrals.

You will recognize that the integrals are the moments and products of inertia
for the xyz reference. Thus,’

111l o x p ( dm
M
2
= I,@: - 1,mp, - Ixzm,mz

-I”xm,m, + 1,m: - Iy$oymz


- l $ p x - 1,ozm, + lam;

#Note that we have deliberately used a matrixlike array for ease in remembering the
formulation.
We can now give the kinetic energy of a rigid hody in Ihc following lorni:

1,uxu, - Ixpxuz
+ IYY 6 2Y - I V. Z U , W Z (17.5)
- I,U~,U, + 1,p;t

Note that the f i r s t expression on the right side of the preceding equation i s the
kinetic energy of translation of the rigid body using the center of mass, while
the second expression i s thc kinetic energy o f rotation ol the rigid hody about
its center of mass. IS principal axe? are chosen, Eq. 17.5 hecomes

KE = MV' + t ( l , , u :+ I \ > U .. . (17.61

Note that lor chis condition the kinetic ene1.g.y ternis for rotation have the
same form as the kinetic energy term that i s due to translation. with the
moment o f inertia coi-responding to iiiass and angular vclocicy corrcsponding
tn linear velocity.

As a special case. we shall consider the calculation of kinetic energy n l


any rigid hody undergoing p r w n m t i o n relative lo X U with angular \'cIoc-
ity w about an actual axis of rowtion' going through part o f the body or
through a rigid hypothetical n i a s s l e w extension of the body. We have shown
this situation in Fig. 17.3. where the Z axis i s chosen tn bc collinear with thc
w vector and the axis o f rotaticin The reference .LE ;it thc cciitcr of mass i s
chosen parallel to X Y Z . Clearly. ut= UJ? = (1 and O I = ~ 01 s o t<q. 17.5 hecome,

KE = iM V 2 + i ILoJ?
..
~
SECTlON 17.2 KINETIC ENERGY OF A RIGID BODY 857

where IZz is about an axis which goes through the mass center parallel to 2.
Note that y. = wd, where d i s the distance between the axis of rotation Z and
the z axis at the center of mass. We then have

KE = +flrzo2
f(MdZ)w2
= 4 (Izz+ M d 2 ) w 2
But the bracketed expression is the moment of inertia of the body about the
axis of rotation Z. Denoting this moment of inertia simply as I , we get for the
kinetic energy:

KE = + f a 2 (17.7)

This simple expression for pure rotation is completely analogous to the


kinetic energy of a body in pure translation.

Figure 17.4. Plane motion relative to the X Y plane.

For a body undergoing general plane motion (see Fig. 17.4) parallel to
the X Y plane, where xyz are taken at the center of mass and oriented parallel
to X Y Z . we get from Eq. 17.5:

(17.8)

We now illustrate the calculation of the kinetic energy in the following example
8.58 CHAPTEK 17 ENRK(;Y AND IMPULSE-MOMENTUM MKIHOL)S FOR R K l U BODIES

Example 17.1
Compute the kinetic energy of the crank sysleni i n tlic configuration
shown in Fig. 17.5. Piston A weighs 2 Ib. rod AH is 2 ft long and weigh:,
~

5 Ib, and flywheel D weighs 100 Ib with a radius of gyration of 1.2 ft. The
~
radius r is 1 ft. At the instant of interest. piston A is moving to the right at
a speed V of I O itlsec.

Figure 17.5. Crmk \y\tem

We have here a translalory motiori (piston A). a plane motion (rod AB).
and a pure rotation (tlywhecl D). Thus. for piston A we have f o r the kinetic
energy:
I
- IO') = 3.1 I ft-lh
( K E ) , = ? M V 2 = 2(m)(
'
(a)

For the rod AB. we must first consider k i n e m u r i d aspects of the motion.
For this purpose we have :,hown rod AH again in Fig. 17.6, where V, is the
known velocity of poinlA and V, is the velocity vector fkr point B oriented
at an angle a such that l$ i!, perpendicular to OB. We can readily find v
for the configuration 01inkrest by trigonometric considerations of triangle
AHO. To do this, we use the law o f sines to Sirst compute the angle p:

Figure 17.6. Kincmaticr 01rod A H .

-~2 - I
sin 0 \in 27)"

Therelore,
/J = 41 2"
. .. ., ~ ...... " .., .. ..,
"._x"_."_^~. . ..,..
I I_x__.."
SECTION 17.2 KINETIC ENERGY OF A RIGID BODY 859

Example 17.1 (Continued)


Because V, is at right angles to OB, we have for the angle a:
a = 90" ~ p = 46.8" (c)

From kinematics of a rigid body we can now say:

V, = V, + ( w , , k ) x pAH

Hence,
V , ( c o s a i + s i n a j j = IOi+w,,kx(2cos20"i+2sin20"jj
V,(.64Xi
:_ + .729jj = IOi + 1.X790A,j - .684w,,i (dj

From this we solve for on, and V., Thus,


";I = 10.53 ftlsec
a
,, = 4.09 radlsec

To get the velocity of the mass center C of A B , we proceed as follows:

V,. = V, + ( w A , k ) x p A , .
= IOi + 4.09k x (.940i + ,342j j (0
= I O i + 3.843' 1.399i = 8.60i + 3.84jftlsec
~

We can now calculate (KE),,, the kinetic energy of the rod:

(KE),, = 2I MA,V: + 2I 171Wi,


(8.602 + 3.84* j + 1(A& 2')(4.09'j (gj

= 7.32 ft-lh

Finally, we consider the flywheel D.The angular speed m, can easily be


computed using V, of Eq. (e). Thus,

% =
' - ' O f 3 = 10.53 radsec
r- - ~~
(hj

Accordingly, we get for (KE),:

(KE), = [ ~ ( ~ ) ( 1 . 2 2 ) ] ( 1 0 . 5 3 2=) 248 ft-lh (i)

The total kinetic energy of the system can now be given as


KE = (KE), + (KE),, + (KW,

= 3.1 I + 7.32 + 248 = 298 ft-Ib (jj


860 CHAPTER 17 ENERGY AND IMPULSE-MOMENTUM METHODS FOR RIGID BODIES

17.3 Work-Energy Relations


We presented in Cliaptcr 13 thc wiirkkcncrgy r c l i i t i ~ nfix a .sin,yle panicle mi ill
a system o l n panicles (see Fig. 17.7) to rcach the f(~llowingequalion:

Sdr, +[l’tSi ‘dr, = l(m,V,’j? ~ J(m,y’j, = (AKE), (17.9)


,=I
I#,

where f is the f k e from particle j iinto particle i and i s an internal force.


(Note that since a particle caiiiiiit exert ii force on itself,J, = 0.) Now consider
that the particle ni, i s part of a rigid body. as shown in Fig. 17.8. From New-
ton’s third law we can say that

.f,,= Yf,, ( 17. IO)

X
..
/
Figure 17.7. Splznr 01particle\.

I t might he intuitively iihviiius t o the reader that for any miition o f a rigid
body the totality of internal forcesx, can do no work. If not. read the follow
ing proof tn verify this c l a i m
Suppose the rigid hody m o v e s xi infinitesimal amount. We employ
Chasles’ theorem, whcrchy w e give the entire hody a displaccmcnt dr corre-
hponding Lo the actual displacement o f particle WI, (sec Fig. 17.8). The total
work done h y f ; , and f,,i\ clearly L X I for this displacement a s a result of

X/
Figure 17% Particles of a rigid hody.
SECTION 17.3 WORK-ENERGY RELATIONS 861

Eq. 17.10. In addition, we will have a rotation dq5 about an axis of rotation
going through mi. We can decompose dq5 into orthogonal components, such
that one component d@, is along the line between mi and mi (and thus
collinear withJ,) and two components are at right angles to this line (see Fig.
17.9). Clearly, the work done by the forcesfq andfi, for d+, is zero. Also, the
movement of mj for the other components of dq5 is at right angles tofi,, and
again there is no work done. Consequently, the work done by f, andfi; is zero
during the total infinitesimal movement. And since a finite movement is a
sum of such infinitesimal movements, the work done for a finite movement of
mi and mj is zero. But a rigid body consists of pairs of interacting particles
such as mi and m,. Hence, on summing Eq. 17.9 for all particles of a rigid
body, we can conclude that the work done by.furces internal to a rigid budy
for any rigid-body movement is always zeru.

Figure 17.9. Rectangular components of d+.

We must clearly point out here that although the internal forces in a
rigid body can do no work, forces between rigid bodies of a system of rigid
bodies can do a net amount of work even though Newton's third law applies
and even though these forces are internal to the system. We shall say more
ahout this later when we discuss systems of rigid bodies.
We accordingly compute the work done on a rigid body in moving
from configuration I to configuration IIby summing the work terms for all
the external forces. Thus, for the body shown in Fig. 11.10, we can express
the work between I and IIin the following manner:

(work),,,, = 4 * ds, + j:' F, * ds, +


SECTION 17.3 WORK-ENERGY RELATIONS 863

In this case the torque T and angular speed 6 are about the same axis. The
generalization of Eq. 17.12 for any moment M and any angular velocity w
- 17.12) then is
(see Fig.

wK= y M * w d t
11
(17.13)

We thus have formulations for finding the work done by external forces
and couples on a rigid body. For the conservative forces, we know from
Chapter 13 that we can use for work a quantitv that is minus the change in I

potential energy from I to 11 without having to specify the path taken. Figure 17.12. dwK= M * w df
Using this information for computing work, we can then say for any
rigid body:

bItoII=AKE (17.14)

where W??is the work by external forces.


If there are only conservative external forces present, we can also say
for the rigid body:

If both conservative and nonconservative external forces are present, we can say:

no (17 16)

These three equations parallel the three we developed for a particle in Chap-
ter 13.
The foregoing equations are expressed for a single rigid body. For a
system of inferconnecred rigid bodies, we distinguish between two types of
forces internal to the system. They are
1. Forces internal to any rigid body of the system
2. Forces befween rigid bodies of the system.
Fur a system of bodies, as in the case of a single rigid body, forces of category
I can do no work. However, if the forces between two bodies of 2 system do
not move the same distance over the same path, then there may be a net
amount of work done on the system by these internal forces. We must include
such work contributions when employing Eqs. 17.14-17.16 for a system of
inferconnecred rigid bodes.’ Example 17.4 is an example of this situation.

‘Recall from Chapter 13, lhilt Eq. 17.16 and hence Eqr. 17.14 and 17.15 are valid for any
aggregate of panicles provided we include lhe work of internal forcra both conservative and nun-
conservative.
864 CHAPI'ER 17 ENk.KGY AND IMI'III.ST~MOMENII~MMETHOIIS TOR RIGII) HODIES

ExamDle 17.2
i
Neglect the weight ol the cable i n Fig. 17.13. aild find tlic speed of thc
450-N block A alter it has miivcd 1.7 111 along Lhc incline lrom 21 position
of rest. The static coefficient (if lriction along the incline is 3 2 . and the
dynamic coefficient of friction i \ 30. Consider the pulley B t o be :I Lini-
f k m cylinder

We musl lirst decide which way the hlock nioves along the incline.
To overcomc friction and move down the incline, the block m u s l create a
force in the downward direction of the cable exceeding 90/2 = 45 N. Con-
sidering the block A alone (see Fig. 17.14). we can readily decide tlxlt the
maximum fcirce 7., to allow A Lo start sliding downward is

, ~-(.12) N
( T , ) , , ! ~= +4~0sin30~
= -(.32)(450) cos 30" + 450 sin 30" = 100.3 h

Clearly, the block goes down the iiiclinc. X


We now use the work-kinetic energy equation separately t o r each
hody. Thus. f01- Lhe block wc have. using now thc dynamic coefficient (if Figure 17.14. Ficu body 01hlock
lriction
I 450
- Ti1.7) = 7-Vf
(450sin30")(1.7) - (45~~)1ci)s~0"11.30)(1.7)
- s
Therefore.

7; = I0X.I - I3.491/,' (ill


SECTION 17.3 WORK-ENERGY RELATIONS 865

Example 17.2 (Continued)


We now consider the cylinder for which the free-body diagram is displayed
in Fig. 17.15. Note that the cylinder i s in effect rolling without slipping
along the light supporting cable. Hence, Tz does no work as explained in
Chapter 13.4 Thus, the work-kinetic energy equation is as follows using
Y

i 7
the formula $ M r 2 for I of the cylinder:
~ .tt
YON
Therefore, Figure 17.15. Free body of cylinder

= 45 + 2.70V; + , 1 2 1 4 0 ~ (b)

From kinematics we can conclude on inspection that

Subtracting Eq. (b) from Eq. (a) to eliminate T,, and then substituting from
Eq. (c) and Eq. (dj for V, and w, we then get for 4:

v,=2 (e)

This problem can readily be solved as a system, i.e, without discon-


necting the bodies. You are asked to do this in Problem 17.25.

4Recull that the point of contact of the cylinder has zero velocity. and hence the friction
force (in [hi, cue, T J transmitsno power to the cylinder.

In the previous example, we considered the problem to be composed of


two discrete bodies. We proceeded by expressing equations for each body sep-
arately. In the following example, we will consider a .system of bodies expressing
equations for the whole system directly. In this problem, the forces between any
two bodies of the system have the .surne velocity: consequently, from Newton's
third law, we can conclude that these forces contribute zero net work. We shall
illustrate a case where this condition is not so i n Example 17.5.
866 CHAPTIX 17 tNRRCY A N U IMPLLSF. MOMENTIIM Mk:lHOI)S ['OK KI(;II) H0L)IIIS

Example 17.3
i A conveyor i s rnovinp a weigh1 WoI64.4 Ih i n Fig. 17.16. CylindcrsA ;ind
H have ii diameter of I ft and weigh 32.2 Ih each. A h , they each have :I
' radius of gyration of .4 1.1. Rullers C', I ) , I:. F, and G cach hii\e a diamclcr
4 o f 3 in.. weigh 10 Ih each, iind have a riidius ulgyratioii of I i n Whal cuii-
1 stant torque w i l l increase the spccd 01W from I ftisec of 3 fl/\ec i n 5 ft o l
: travel? Thcrc i s no slipping at any of the rollers anit driiiiir. The helt

We shall use the work-kinetic energy reliitiun \pcciiicil in Eq. 11.14


1
! fur this prohlcm. Only cnlernal forces and turqucs do work foi- the systcm:
the interactivc lorccs hetweeii hodies do work in a i i i u i i t i t s th:it clearly c x -
ccI each other hecause ul' the conditioii of n o slipping. Ilcncc.

TH- M/(5)(sin30"j = (KEI, -iKEj, iil)

' whcrc T i s the applied torque. Thc general expression for thc hitictic cncrzy
j is

1
From kinematics we ciiii say:
SECTION 17.3 WORK-ENERGY RELATIONS 867

Example 17.3 (Continued)


Using these results, we can give the kinetic energy at the end and at the
beginning of the interval of interest as

Substituting these results into Eq. (a), we get

TO - (64.4)(S)(sin 30”) = 21.4 ~ 2.37 (c)

From kinematics again we can say for 0, on considering the rotation of a


cylinder and the distance traveled by the belt:

(rcyl)(0)= 5
Therefore,

O =
S
~ = I O rad
~
I
2

Substituting back into Eq. (c), we can then solve for the desired torque T:

T = &[21.4 - 2.37 + (64.4)(S)(sin 30”)]

T = 18.00 ft-fb

In the next example, we have a case of internal forces between bodies that
satisfy Newton’s third law but do not have identical velocities
868 W A V l t K 17 E N E R G Y A N I 1 I L I I ' I I I S I I ~ M O M ~ U ' I I I MMCTtKIIX I-OK IKKilf) HOlllES

Example 17.&
A diesel-powered electric train ~ i ~ n v ue ps ii 7
' grade in Fig. 11.11.I f a Iorque
of750 N-in i s developed ;it each of its six pairs uldrive wheels. u l i a l i\ thc
incrcdsc OS speed of thc twin after i t Iiinves 100 ni? Initially. the train has a
speed of. 16 kniihr. The train wcighs YO kN. The drive wheels time :I dianic-
ter US h(K) mni. Neglect lhc rutatinnal energy US Ihc drive wheel\.

We shall cunsider the t u i n as ii .\WCIII of ri,qirl I,,i~lic~.siiicluding


the 6 pairs of whccl.: m d the hody. Wc have sliuw~ithe liiiiii iii Fig,
17.IX with the externid kir , W. N. ;ind f : 111 addition, wc have shown
ceniiin internal torques M." The tiiIque\ \tiown act on thc r o i ~ r :of~ thc
motors. and. a s the triiiii move\. these torques rotate :rnd accordingly
do work. The , r ( ~ t i o r i s to thcsc torques are equal and uppohite to M
according t u Newton's third law and act on {tie i i ~ i i oor~ illc motor\
.
(;.e.. the field coil\). The statim are \t;itionary. and 'io the re'.lL110115 10
M do no work iis the train iiiuve'i. Thus. we have :in example o f cqual
and oppositc incernal forces hetueen hodics US i i system perlorniing ii
nonzcru net amount of work. Wc now ernploy k:q. 17.16. Thus.

APE + AKE = (il)

Ilhing the iiiilial configurdliun iis the datuiii. UF I1:1vc7


SECTION 17.3 WORK-ENERGY RELATIONS 869

Example 17.4 (Continued)


where 0 is the clockwise rotation of the rotor in radians. Assuming direct
drive from rotor to wheel, we can compute 0 as follows for the 100-m dis-
tance over which the train moves:
0 = I O 0 (2n) = -r ad (c)
.30
-ii
re" radire"
Substituting into Eq. (b) and solving for V , we get
V = 10.38 m/sec
Hence,
(10.38)(3,600)
AV = 16 21,4 km,hr
IO00
~

In Chapter 13, we also developed a work-energy equation involving the


mass center of any system of pasticles. You will recall that

(1 7.l7a)

where F is the toto1 externalforce [only!) which hypothetically moves with the
cenfer oj' mass. This equation applies to a rigid body. Note that an external
torque makes no work contribution here since equal and opposite forces each
having identical motion (that of the mass center) can do no net amount of work.
For a system of interconnected rigid bodies, we can say:

The force F includes only externalforces (internal forces between interconnect-


ing bodies are equal and opposite and must move with the mass center of the
system; hence they contribute no work to the left side of the foregoing equa-
tion). On the other hand, external friction forces on wheels rolling without slip-
ping must move with the mass center of the system in this formulation and thus
can d o work, in contrast to the previous approach, in which the mass center is
not used. On the right side, we have summed the kinetic energies of each of the
mass centers of the constituent bodies of the system8 We now illustrate the use
of Eq. 17.1711.

XWrdixusaed this topic in Section 16.8.


870 CHAPl'EK 17 ENCR(;Y ANI1 IMI'l:I.St:~~MOMr.NT~!MhlliT1101lS I'OK IRlGll) II0T)lF.S

Example 17.5

has four-wheel drive ;and wciglis 22.5 k N . Each wlieel weighs 2 k N ha\ ii
diameter ol 2.5 in and has ii rndius i l l gyration o l I X O mni. It ex11 whccl
gel\ a torque of 100 N-m. what i s the ?peed after 20 in of tra\cI \tartin:
from res('! A l w . deterniinc the friction force Ti-oiii tlie groiind o n eiich
whecl. The weight i i l the vehiclc includch that of pxsseiigers and haggage.
Neglect rolling resi\tance since the vchiclc i n this problem is i n w i n g (in i~
Ihrd surlace. Consider riilliny witlioiit slipping.

Figure 17.19. I\ \cIticIc u x d in swilmpliinil.

We liave shown the free-hod) diagrmi ol'thc sy?tem i i i Fig. 17.20. 22 5 kN


We %illfirst use the system of particles approach. 'This includes internal
lorques from tlie vchiclc lriinic tmto lhc wheels iiiid the reiiction lorquc\
from the wheel\ onlo llic fr;unc. .The former w i l l d c internal w ) r k because
Lhcx torques rotate wit11 thc wheels. Thc reaction torque\ on thc 1 r m e &I
no( rot;ite and obviously do iio worh. Also. because 1 1 1 t h ~1111 slippine coil-
dilion, the friction h r c e s from the ground o n m lhc lircs do no work CIS has
been explained a l length i n Chapter 13. Hcncc, we can say

(4l(T)(H)= IKEI, ~ (KEJ,

Recalling thal H = dislancclriidios. w e gcl

:. V = 2.354 nils

To get the iricliiin liirces,/(u'liy are they the same lor tach whccl'll wc use
the center 11f mass approach. T h u s
W, = (AKEJ,.,,,

:. j= 79.4 N
In rhe follow in^ prohlenrs. neglect frictiori unless orhewise 17.3. A thin disc weighing 450 N is suspended from an over-
inrrructed. head conveyor moving at a speed of 10 misec. Ifthe disc rotates at
a speed o f 5 radisec i n the plane of the page (i.e.. ZY plane), com-
pute the kinetic energy of the disc relative to the ground.

17.1. A unifbrm solid cylinder of radius 2 ft and weight 200 Ib


rolls without slipping down a 45" incline and drags the 100-lb
block 8 with it. What is the kinetic energy of the system if block
R is moving at a speed of I O ftlsec? Neglect the mass of connect-
ing agents between the bodies.

300 mm
X

Figure P.17.3.

17.4. Two slender rods CD and EA ilte pinned together at B. Rod


EA is rotating at a speed w equal to 2 radlsec. Rod CD rides in a ver-
Figure P.17.1 tical slot at D. For the configuration shown in the diagram, compute
the kinetic energy of the rods. Rod CII wcipha 50 N and rod EA
weighs 80 N.

17.2. A steam roller with driver weighs 5 tons. Wheel A weighs


I ton and has a radius of gyration of .8 ft. Drive wheels B have a E
total mass of 1.000 Ib and a radius of gyration of 1.6 ft. If the
steam roller i s coasting at a speed af 5 ftlsec with motor discon-
nected, what is the total kinetic energy of the system?

k I'

n D

Figure P.17.2. Figure P.17.4.

87
17.5. Consider thc connecting rod AH io he a slender rod weigh- 17.9. A cone H weighing 20 Ih rolls without slipping inside a
ing 2 Ih. and compote i t s kinetic energy for the d a h given. conical cavil) C. The coni' hiis a Icngh rrf IO ft. The centerline 01
lhi. COIIC rol:itc\ u i t h ;in ;in@ol;il- speed (u, o f S r d l s c c h m l the Y
i i x i c . Compute the kinctic cncrgy o1 thc cone.

M
Figure P.17.8 Figure 1'.17.11.

172
17.12. Three identical bars, each of length 1 and weight W, are con- itant K is , I 8 Nlmm. If the system is released from a configuration
nected to rach other and to a wall with smooth pins at A, h, C, and D. of rest, what is the angular speed of the cylinder after it has rotated
A spring having spring constant K is connected to the center of bar 90°? The radius of gyration for the stepped cylinder is I m and its
BC at E and to a pi? iit F, which is free to slide in the slot, Compute mass is 36 kg. The spring ih unstretched in the position shown
the angular speed 8 as B function of time if the system is released
from rest when AB and DC are at right angles to the wall. The spring
is unslrctched at the outset of the motion. Neglect friction. l+lm+

Figure P.17.12.

17.13. A 3-ni rod A B weighing 225 N is guided atA by a slot and


at B by a smooth horizontal surfdce. Neglect the mass of the slider 17.15. A cylinder of dialmeter ft is composed of ,wo Semi.
at A , and find the speed of B when A has moved 1 m along the s h t c and D weighing 50 ~b 80 ~ b respectively,
, ~ ~ d
after starting from a rest configuration shown in the diagram. A and h, weighing 20 Ib and 50 Ib, respectively. are connected by
a light, flrxible cable that I’UIIS over the cylinder. If the system is
released from rest for the configuration shown, what is the speed
// of B when the cylinder has rotated YO’? Assume n o slipping.

h
Figure P.17.13.

17.14. A stepped cylinder has radii of 600 mm for the smaller


radius and 1.3 m for the larger radius. A rectangular block A
weighing 225 N is welded to the cylinder at B . The spring con- Figure P.17.15.

873
c'

liigure P.17.16

I Figure 1'.17.18.

30 Ih

W = 200 lh
Figure P.17.17. Figure P.17.20.

873
17.21. Two identical members, AB and BC, are pinned together What is the angular speed of the centerline of the cone when it has
at 6.Also member BC is pinned to the wall at C. Each member its maximum kinetic energy'?
weighs 32.2 Ib and is 20 ft long. A spring having a spring constant
K = 20 Iblft is connected to the centers of the members. A force
z
P = 100 Ib is applied to member AB at A . IS initially the members
are inclined 45" to the ground and the spring is unitretched, what
i s p afterA has moved 2 ft'? System is in a vertical plane.

C X
,,,
.
Figure P.17.24.
Figure P.17.21.

17.22. A tlexihle cord of total length 50 ft and weighing 50 Ib is 17.25. Work Example 17.2 by considering the system to he the
pinned to a wall at A and is wrapped around a cylinder having a block, pulley, and cable.
radius of 4 ft and weighing 30 Ib. A 50-lb force is applied to the
end of the cord. What is the speed of the cylinder after the end of
the cord has moved 10 ft? The system stalls from rest in the con-
figuration shown in the diagram. Neglect potential energy consid-
erations arising from the sag of the upper cord. 17.26. A weight W, is held with alight flexihle wire. The wire
runs over a stationary semicylinder of radius R equal to I ft. A
pulley weighing 32.2 Ib and having a radius of gyration of unity
rides on the wire and supports a weight W, of 16.I Ib. If W, weighs
128.8 Ib and the dynamic coefficient nf friction for the semicylin-
der and wire is .2 what is the drop i n the weight I+for
; an increase
in speed of 5 ftlsec of weight starting from rest? The diameter
d of the small pulley is I ft.
Figure P.17.22.

17.23. In Problem 17.5, suppose that an average pressure o f


20 psig (above atmosphere) exists in the cylinder. What is the rpm
after the crankshaft has rotated 60" from position shown? The
crank rod OB weighs I Ib and has a radius of gyration about 0 of
2 in. The diameter of the piston is 4 in., and its weight is 8 oz.The
crankshaft is rotating at 3,000 rpm at the position shown. Take the
center of mass of the crank rod at the midpoint of OB.

17.24. A right circular cone of weight 32.2 Ib, height 4 ft, and
cone angle 20" is allowed to roll without slipping on a plane sur-
face inclined at an angle of 30" to the horizontal. The cone is
started from rest when the line of contact is parallel to the X axis. Figure P.17.26.

875
17.27. A solid unifrmm hlock A moves along two fnctl~mlrss
angle-iron \upports at a speed of 6 m i i c c . Onc nf the wppml\ is
inclincd at an angle if 20" lioin the horimnta at 8 :ind C:ILISCS thc
hlock to rotate ahout it, front IOU,CI rdgc a? it ~movehto the right
of R . What is thc s p e d o f t h e block aster it moves 300 mm t o thc
right of R (meawred horimntally)? The block weighs 4511 N.
Consider that n o hinding occurs hctu'ccn the hlnck and thc anglc-
iron supports.

Neglcct inertia of the worm g c x , and consider an energy Iosc of


Ill<%of the input due t u friction Note the italicixd mtcment 01
Plohlem 17.30. and treat thc pl-ohlem 11s ii \ystrm of hodie,.

Figure P.17.27.

17.28. In Prohlern 11.21,u'ill the block rcach an inrtantaneiw


i e ~ nvelocity and then slid? hack o r will it lip n x r onlo face A'!

17.29. A torque l = ,311 N-m is applied tn a bevel f w r R. Bcvcl


gear /I meshes with g c x R and d r i w s a pump A . <;car R ha\ a
radius of gyration of I SO m m and a uxight of SO N. whereas gear
I1 and the impeller of pump A have a comhined radios of gyration
o f 5 0 mm and a weight of IO0 N. Show that the work q f t h e c o i i ~
mcf fbn.r.v hrtwrm griin R nnd I ) i.r zt'ro. Next. find how n n n y Figure P.17.30.
revolutions of gear H arc necdcd ti) get the pump up I O 200 irpin
from I C C ~ .Treat the prohlem a s it cystem of hodies.

17.31. A fwce F o f AS11 N X'IF ~ r nhlock A wel&!hing 435 N .


Block A ride\ o n identtoal unifcrnm cylindcrs H and C.rach weigh-
ing 290 N ;and having a radius u t 300 cmn,. I i thew i s (noslipping,
u hat i \ the speed oi'A alter it ~nwvesI m?

Figure P.17.29.

17.30. A t o r q ~ x7'nf .5 N-m acts on worm gear E, which m e s h e


with gear ,A, which drives a geai- train. Aftcr five r e w l u t i c m of Figure P.17.31.
17.32. Work Example 17.5 using the center-of-mass approach of gyration of300 mm screws onto the shaft. A torque Tof 45 N-m
for the whole system. What are the friction furces on the wheels is applied to A as shown. What is the angular speed ofA after three
from the ground? revolutions starting from a rest configuration'! Neglect friction.

17.33. An electric train (one car) uses its motors as electric gen-
erators for braking action. Suppose that this train is moving down
a 15" incline at a speed initially of 10 m/sec and, during the next
100 m.the generators develop 1.5 kW-hr of energy. What is the
speed of the train at the end of this interval'? The train with pas-
sengers weighs 200 kN. Each of the eight wheels weighs 900 N
and has a radius of gyration of ?SO mm and a diameter of 600 mm.
Neglect wind resistance, and consider that there is no slipping.
The efficiency of the generators fur developing power is 90%.
[Hint: One watt is I N-mlsec.] Do not use center of mass approach.
Figure P.17.36.
17.37. A uniform block A weighing 64.4 Ih is pulled by a force P
17,34, Work 17,33using the center ofmass approach for o f 5 0 Ib as shown. The block moves along the rails on small, light
the whole Also, find the average friction force from the rail wheels. One rail descends at an angle nf IS" at point B . If the force
Onto the Consider that each wheel is attached to a P always remains horizontal, what is the speed of the block after it
has moved S ft in the horizontal direction'? The hlock is stationary
at the position shown. Assume that the block does not tilt forward.

17.35. A windlass has a mating part which weighs 75 Ih and


hai a radius of gyratinn of I ft. When the suspended weight of
20 Ib is dropping at a speed of 20 ftisec, a 100-1h force is applied
to the lever at A. This action applies the brake shoe at B , where
there is a coefficient of friction of .5. How far will the 20-lh
weight drop before stopping'?
1-1'4
Figure P.17.37.
17.38. A solid uniform rod AB connects two light slider hearings
A and B. which move in a frictionless manner along the indicated
guide rods. The rod AB has a mdss of 150 lhm and a diameter of
2 in. Smooth hall-joint connections exist between the rod and the
hearings. If the rod is released from rest at the configuration shown,
what is the speed of the hearing A when it has dropped 2 ft?

Figure P.17.35.

17.36. A square-threaded screw has a diameter of SO mm and is


inclined 45" to the horizontal, The pitch of the thread is 5 mm, and
it is single-threaded. A body A weighing 290 N and having a radius Figure P.17.38.

877
Impulse-Momentum Methods
17.4 Angular Momentum of a Rigid
Body About Any Point in the Body
AI we g11 to thrcc dimeiirioiis. we will need lormulati~~iis Sor linciir inionion-
tuin and angular ini~mentutnof rigid hodich. The liiieiir ini~nientumi s simply

115 V din = M V . We shall now fi~rmulateiui cxprcssion for Lhc more coin-
plicakd angular momentum H of a rigid body about a point. For this purpose.
we choose ii point A in ii rigid body 111 hypiithrtical massless cxtcnsion ofthe
rigid body tis shiiwii iii Fig. 17.21. An eleinciil of mass dm at ii position p
from A i s shown. Thc velocity V' (if drn reliitive lo A i h simply the velocity of
d m relative to reference j t ] < which I ~ W ~ . S / U Iwith
~ S A relative 10 XYZ. Sinii
larly, the linear moincntuiii of dni rclativc to A i s the linciir iiionicntuni of hi
i-elativc to a reierciicc 505 lranslating with A . We caii niiw givc the angular
inornenuim dH,, for elemen1 hi ahout ,I a s

But since A i s lixcd in the body (or in thc liypothctical inahslcss extcnsioii 01
thc hody). thc vector p m u s t he f i x e d i n the body. Accordingly. ( i l p l d i ) ~ =
,,~
w X p. where w i h the angular velocity of the body rclative l o < r ] [ . H o w
cvcr. since {I]< translates with rcspcct ttr XYZ, w i s u/.sc t/w irnjiulur iv/oc.i/>
o//lwhody w/otii,e I o XYZ LIS w,//. Hence. we can say:

</Hi= p x ( W x $11 <OlI (17.IXh)

Wc shall find i t coiivcnient to exprew Eq. 17.18 in terms o f orthogonal


ciiniponcnts. For this p u t p o w . imagine an arbitrary rclirciice
hiidy or rigid-hody exlcnsion of the hody iaviiig the origin iit /I and any arhitrary
SECTION 17.4 ANGULAR MOMENTUM OF A RIGID BOUY ABOUT ANY POJNT IN THE BOUY 879

X
' Hypothctical inassless
extension of rigid hudy
Figure 17.22. Reference xyr at A.

orientation relative to X U ? as shown in Fig. 17.22. We next decompose each


of the vectors in Eq. 17.18b into rectangular components in the i , j , and k
directions associated with the x, y. and z axes, respectively. Thus,
dU, = ( d H , ) ~ i + ( d H , ) ~ j + ( d H , ) : k (17.19a)
p = xi + yj + zk (17.19b)
w = oxi+ o,j + o , k (17.19~)

We then have for Eq. 17.18b:


(dHA),ri+ (dHAIvj+ (dH')?k = ( x i i yj + zk) x
[(a)+ o,j i w z k ) X (xi + j j + &)]dm (17.20)

Carrying out the cross products and collecting terms, we have


(dH,), 2 ) d m - q x y d m - ozxzdm
= ~ , ~ ( iy i * (17.21a)
(dH,), = - o , y x d m + w , ( x ' +z2)dm-o,y:dm (17.21h)
(dH,); = - w , p d m - o p d m + o.(x' + ?.')dm (1 7.2 IC)

If we integrate these relations for all the mass elements dm of the rigid body,
we see that the components of the inertia tensor for point A appear:

(I 7.22a)
( 17.22h)
(17.22~)

We thus have components of the angular momentum vector HA for a rigid body
about point A in terms of an arbitrary set of directions x, y. and z at point A.
We now illustrate the calculation of HA in the following example.

c.
yAl this time we can forget about the axes 5. 7, and They only become necessilry when
we ask the question: Whill i s the velocity or linear momentum "fa particle rclative to point A. To
repeal. the velocity or linear momentum of a panicle relative to point A is the velocity or inomcn~
tum relative to a reference < q [ translating with point A as seen from XYZ or, in other words. rel-
ative to a nonrotating observer moving with A .
880 A N I ) iRiriii.siI~~Ri(~I\.ii~Nt
( W A I ~ II ~ K1 7 INI.IU;Y tlni MI' HOIX FOR i i ~ i i t uot)ir<s
)

Example 17.6
A disc H has a i n a h \ M and i s riitaling ariiund centerliiie /:-E i n Fig. 17.21
iil a speed iuI relati\e to E--E. Ccnterline 1-1.meanwhile, h a s an a~igul;~l-
speed (02about the \crticill axis. Compute the angular momentum of the
disc about poinl A as seen f r m i ground refel-encc XYZ.
! The ;ingular veliicity lit. the disc i-cliitivc IO the ground i\
w = coli + w,j (a)

Figure 17.23. Rolating d i x


i
1 Consider ii ccI of axe\ .cy7 with Ihc iirigiri at A arid lixcd Io [lie h d y ha^-
! in2 cylinder B. At the in\tiinl of interest. thc .q:.axes iirc parallel to the
iiicrtiiil Ictcrcnce XYZ and we can say (see Fig. 17.24):

10%= wl. = CO?. (0. = 0 ib)


II
Ttic incl-tia teiiror for the disc taken at A i s next prcsented. .
',
---+

It$ = +MK' =
I$> o I&: = 0
lVI
= (1 I s ,= { M K ? + Mrl' I,, = 0 ic)
I.< = 0 1.) = 0 /. = ji MRJ + Md'

Note that the priidoct~ofiricrti~i terms arc 7cro because the .xy and the .x:
planes are planes [if symmetry. Clearly, inumcnls of inertia for the .xy;
I . i i w going to Eg. 17.22, we lia\'e
&xes arc priricipal m~irncntsof i i i e r l i i ~ K
SECTION 17.4 ANGULAR MOMENTVM OF A RIGID BODY ABOUT ANY POINT IN THE BODY 881

An seen in Example 17.5, when xyz are principul axes, HAsimplifies to

HA = c a w t i+ lvpJ+ l.p$ (17.23)

which is analogous to the linear momentum vector P. That is,


P = M V L i + My,j + MVk
Note that mass plays the same role as does I , and V plays the same role as
does w.
In Chapter 16, we considered with some care the plane motion of a
slablike body, the motion being parallel to the plane of symmetry of the body.
We have shown such a case in Fig. 17.25. A reference xyz is shown fixed to
the body at A with xy at the midplane of the body and with the z axis oriented
normal to the plane of motion. Recall now that for a slahlike body the plane
x y must be a plane of symmetry or he a principal plane, and consequently that
I:,? = I:?= I). Also, the only nonzero component of w is w:. Going back to
Eq. 17.22, we see that only (HAjris nonzero, with the result

Because of the importance of plane motion of slablike bodies, we shall often


use the foregoing simple formula.

i
I

X /
Figure 17.25. Slablike body in plane motion

We leave it for you to show that the Eq. 17.24 also applies to a body of
revolution rotating about its axis of symmetry in inertial space, where z is
taken along this axis. Also, Eq. 17.24 is valid for a body having two orthogo-
nal planes of symmetry rotating about an axis corresponding to the intersec-
tion of these planes of symmetry in inertial space, where z is taken along this
axis. We are now ready to relate linear and angular momenta with force sys-
tem causing the motion.
882 CHAI'TT'R 17 FNERCiY A N D IMPUI SF- MOMENTUM METHODS FOK KlGll) BOIIIES

17.5 Impulse-Momentum Equations


You w i l l rcciill that Newrton's law for thc cenler or i ~ i a s sof any hiidy i s

s the lirrrirr ir?ipul.sc,. For a system of


where I , bi n n rigid hiidies w e have, lor
the foregoing equation:

where F is the totiil errrr-nrrl force on the systcm. M , i s the mahs 0 1 the ill]
hody, and (v~), i\ Ihc velocity of the center 01 mass o l the ith body. We are
justified i n forming the preceding equation :is a result [if Eq. 16.17.
For the mxiflur in~~iir/.sr~rnornrnluni n e, ciinsidcr poiills A
~ q u o ~ i ow
which are par1 01the rigid hody or m less extension of the ]rigid hody and
which. i n addilion. are either:

1. The center of mass.


2. A point fixed or iiioving a1 c i i n s m t V i n inertial space.
3. A point accelerating towird or away from the center nf mass

I n such cases we can say:

Ml = H,,

where Hpli s given by Eq. 17.22. Intcgrating with respect tii time. u e then get
the desired urr,qulur i ~ ~ ~ ~ i i c l s r - r ~ i o n rryuuri,iii:
~~i~trrrr~
SECTION 17.5 IMPIJLSE-MOMENTUM EQUATIONS 883

Example 17.7
A thin bent rod is sliding along a smooth surface (Fig. 17.26). The center
of mass has the velocity
V,. = I 0 i + 15j m/sec
and the angular speed o is 5 rad/sec counterclockwise. At the configura-
700 I
tion shown. the rod is given two simultaneous impacts as a result of a COIL
lision. These impacts have the following impulse values:

5,: Fz dt = 3 Nsec

What is the angular speed of the rod and the linear velocity of the iiiass
center, directly after the impact? The rod weighs 35 N/m.
The velocity of the mass center after the impact can easily be determined
using the linear impulse-momentum equation (Eq. 17.25). Thus, we have

Si + 3 s i n 6 0 " j - 3cos60°i
Solving for V,:
= (.7
CI
+ .7 + .6) ~~ (V2 - 1Oi ~ ISj)
Figure 17.26. Bent rod slides o n smooth
hrwirontdl surface.

V, = 10.49i + 1136jmlsec; (a)

For the angular velocity, we use the angular impulse momentum


equation (Eq. 17.27) simplified for the case of plane motion of a slablike
body. Again using the center of mass at which wc fix xyz, we have for Eq.
(17.27):

Putting in numerical data and canceling k , we get


-(5)(.7O) + (3)(sin60°)(.30) - (3)(coc60°)(.70)= 1.;(w2
.. ~ 5 ) (c)

We next compute at C :

(.70)(.30' + .352)
= 1.330 kg-mz

Going bark to Eq. (c). we can now give 02'

e2= 2.16 radlsec


8x4 CHAPTER 17 ENER(;Y 4ii11 I M P I I t . S ~ , ~ M O M ~ N I IMkTHOIIS
IM FOR RIGID BOUIES

s- Example 17.8 :

1
A solid hlock weighing 300 N is suspcndcd lriini a wire (see Fig.
I
17.27) and is staliiinary when ii hi~rimiitaliinpiilsc F d f cqiial 10 100 N-sec
i s applied to the hody a c a restilt of an impact. What is the velocity ofcor-
ner A of the hlock,just after impact: Docs thc wire remain taut’?
i
I-
~~

Figurr 17.27. Stationary hlock


undcr impact.

For the linear momentum equation we can say for the center of
niacs (ccc Fig. 17.2X) i n lhc
i. .I. and ?‘ directions:

-01
- 1 0 0 \ i n 3 0 ”3-0’0 ~ ~ j i ~ ) ~
i:

I ,
... ,

7 I--.
SECTION 17.5 IMPULSE-MOMENTUM EQUATIONS 885

Example 17.8 (Continued)


From these equations, we get
v. = -2.R3i - 1.63Sk m/sec (b)
For the angular momentum equation about C , we can say, on not.
ing that xyr are principal axes:

-(100)(sin 30")(.2S) = /,w, -0


(100)(sin3O0)(.S) - 100(cos30")(f)3 = /p,0 -
(C)
(100)(cos30")(.25) = /?;cu. - 0

Note that

We then get for w as seen from XYZ from Eq. ( c ) :


w = -14.43i + 4.321 + 6.79k radlsec
Hence, for the velocity of point A, we have
y = y. + w x pc.
= -2.831 - 1.63Sk + (-14.43i + 4 . 3 2 j + 6 . 7 9 k )
x (-.Si + .2Sj + .15k)
=;-3.881 - 1.2301 - 3
Finally, to decide if wire remains taut, find the velocity of point D
after impact.
y1 = v, + w x pCn
= -2.8% - 1.635k + (-14.431 + 4 . 3 2 j + 6.79k) X (.25j)
= - 4 3 3 - 5.24k mlsec
Since there is zero velocity component in the y direction stemming from
the given impulse, we can conclude that the wire remains tdut.

In the following example we consider a problem involving a system of


interconnected hodie?.
8x6 (~'HAPTFR 17 + . N t K ( i Y ANI) I h l P I ~ I . S l ~ . ~ M O h l F N T l"r1ilHOL)S
Jhl I ~ O KR I G I D BODIES

Example 17.9
A tractor wcighs 2.000 Ib. including the drircr (Fig. 17.29). T h e large dri-
ver wheels each weigh 200 Ib with ii riidius of 2 f t and a radius of gyi-iition
: of 1.8 i t . The m a l l wheels wcigh -10Ib cach, with il radiw of I I1 and a
radiuh of gyration of 10 i n Tlic tractor i i pulling ii hale of cotton wciFhing
300 Ih. The coefficient 01 iriclimi hetween the hale iind the ground is .?.
What torque i s needed on the drivc whcclh iroiii the inotor for the tliicior
to go irom 5 i t l s x 10 I O i t k c i n 25 see'.) Assumc Ihal thc tirci d o iiot \lip.

Fignre 17.29. Tractw pulling h d c of colloii

We have shown ii irec-body diag'arn o f the system i n Fig. 17.30.


Noting (in inspection [hat N , = 300 cos 5". we cui give llic linear mo-
mentum equation i o r Ihc Yyitein i n the X direction in

2000 Ih

Therefore.

,f2 ~ f , = 275 (ill


SECTION 17.5 IMPULSE-MOMENTUM EQUATIONS 887

Example 17.9 (Continued)


We next consider free-body diagrams of the wheels in Fig. 17.31.
The impulse-angular momentum equation for the drive wheels then can
x x
be given about the center of mass as

Noting from kinematics that on = -V/2, we have


-T + 2,fz = -4.025 (b)
Figure 17.31. Free-body diagrams of
wheels. xy axes are fixed tn wheels.
The impulse-angular momentum equation about the center of mass for
the front wheels is then

Noting from kinematics again that or = -V/l, we get from the equation
above:
,f, = ,345 Ib (C)
From Eq. (a) we may now solve for.f2. Thus,
,f, = ,345 + 275 = 275.3 Ib

Finally, from Eq. (b) we get the desired torque T:


T = 4.025 + (2)(275.3)
-1b

In Example 17.X, there was no obvious convenient stationary point or sta-


tionary axis which could he considered as part of a rigid-body extension of all
the bodies at any time. Therefore, in order to use the formulas for H given by
Eq. 17.22, we considered rigid bodies separately. In the following example, we
have a case where there is a stationary axis present which can he considered as
part of (or a hypothetical rigid-body extension of) all bodies in the system at the
instants of interest. And for this reason, we shall consider the angular momen-
tum equation for the entire system using this stationary axis. Also, if the torque
about such a common axis for a system of bodies is zero, then the angular
momentum of the system about the aforestated axis must he conserved. In the
example to follow, we shall also illustrate conservation of angular momentum
about an axis for such a case.
888 CIIAPTER 17 ENERGY A N U IMPULSE-MOMENI'UM METHOIX POI< RIGID RODIIS

Example 17.10
A llyhall-governor apparatus (Fig. 17.32) consists of lour idcntical arms
(solid rods) cach 0 1 wcight IO N and two spheres of wcight 18 N and
radius o f gyration 30 min about a diamcler. A t the hasc and rot;iting with
the system i s ii cylinder B o f weight 20 N and radius o f gyration along its
axis o f SO n i m Initially, thc system i s rotating at a spccd wI of SO0 rpm fur
0 = 45". A lorce F a t the hasc B maintains the configuration shown. I f the
force i s changed so as to decrease H from 45" to Xi", what i s the angul;o-
velocily of thc systcni?
Clearly, there i\ zeini torquc Srom external forces about the stationary
axis FD which we take SI: :I Z ~ r x i sat all times. Henrc. w e have coiiservii-
Lion of angular momentum about this a x i s at all times. And, since the axis
i s an axis of rotation lor all hodiec of the systeni,"' we can usc Eq. 17.22
for coinpuling H about FD for iill bodies in the system. As a first stcp we
shall need /Lzfor thc incinhzrr of the system. z
Consider first member FG. which i s shown i n Fig. 17.33. The axes Figure 17.32. I'lyhnii p<,vcrnol- apparatus:
arc principal axes 0 1 incrtia for the rod at F. The rj axis i s collinear Y u i \ i \ l l ~ l r l n d 1'' IVW
with the Y axis, aiid thew arc normal lo the page. The axes X Y I iirc
reached hy <q< by rotating @7< ahout ~ l i cIJ a x i s an anglc R Using the
transformation cquationh l o r I, (scc Eq. Y. 13). we can say:

iI,)c>l = OS)? (c)


z
S
Figure 17.33. til{ arc principal arc\ ,if

Conservation of angular momentum ahinit the Z tixis then pi-escrihcs thc 'Gat '-.
following:
SECTION 17.5 IMPULSE-MOMENTUM EQUATIONS 889

Example 17.10 (Continued)


Substituting from Eqs. (a), (b), and (c), we have

I10

+ ---(.007S)2(.866)2
= (4[ff(.30)2(.5)2 I IO
2 g 1
Therefore,

92.4 Fadl

Before closing the section, we note that we have worked with fixed
points or axes in inertial space and with the mass center. What about a poinl
acceleratinx toward the mass center? A common example of such a point is
the point of contact A of a cylinder rolling without slipping on a circular arc
with the center of mass of the cylinder coinciding with the geometric center
of the cylinder. We can then say:
MA = H A
The question then arises: Can we form the familiar angular momentum equa-
tion from above about point A? In other words, is the following equation
valid for plane motion'?

The reason we might hesitate to do this is that the point of contact continually
changes during a time interval when the cylinder is rolling. However, we
have asked you to prove in Problem 17.60 that for rolling without slipping
along a circular or straight path, the equation above is still valid." At times it
can he very useful.

"The statement is actually valid for point A when there is rolling of the cylinder without
slipping on a ~ u n r r u path.
l
17.39. A uniform cylinder C of radius of 1 ft and thicknrh 3 i n
wlls without slipping at i t s cenler plane on flic st;ition;ily platform
K such lhdl the centerline of CD makes 2 re\,dutions per ~ecorid
d a t i v e to the platform. What i s the ungulal- momentum v c c t o ~l w
~
.he cylinder ahout thc ccntcr of milss c11the cylinder? The cylinder
wcighs 64.4 Ib.

&

A
Figure P . 1 7 3

17.40. In Pmblcin 17.39, find thc angular momenturn ot thr disc


thout the slationdry puirir 0 alorig the veiticnl xxis A 4 .

17.41. A platfixin wtiltes ill ail angular speed 01 10,. whilc a


:ylinder or radius I and Icngth a mounted o n the platlorm r o ~ c \
-clativc ti) thc plvtlvrm at an angular speed of (u,. When the axis
>f thc cylindcr i s callincur wilh the mtionary Y u i h , what is that
mgular momentum w d o r UT the cylindcr ahout the ccntrr ,if mais
)Ithe cylinder'! The III:LSF u f t h c cylindcr is M .

Figure P.17.47.
17.48. Work Problem 11.41 for the case where the upward force 17.51. A steam roller with driver weighs 5 tons. Wheel A
from the ground on the plane during the first second after touch- weighs 2 tons and has a radius of gyration of .8 ft. Drive wheels B
down is have a total weight of 1 ton and a radius of gyration of I .5 ft. If a
total torque of 400 ft-lb is developed by the engine on the drive
N = 8,000r2 N
wheels, what is the speed of the steam roller after I O sec starting
where r is in seconds after touchdown from rest? There is no slipping.

17.4Y. A circular conveyor carries cylinders a from position A


through a heat treatment furnace. The cylinders are dropped onto
the conveyor at A from a stationary position above and picked up
at B. The conveyor is to turn at an average speed w of 2 rpm. The
cylinders are dropped onto the conveyor at the rate of 9 per
n
minute. If the resisting torque due to friction is 1 N-m, what aver-
agc torque T i s needed to maintain the prcscrihed angular motion?
Each cylinder weighs 300 N and has a radius of gyration of IS0 mm
about its axis.

Figure P.17.51.

17.52. An electric motor D drives gears C, B, and device A. The


diameters of gears C and B arc 6 in. and I6 in., respectively. The
Figure P.17.49.
mass of A is 200 Ibm. Thc cnmbined mass of the motor armature
and gear C is 50 Ibm, while the radius of gyration of this combi-
nation is 8 in. Also, the mass of B is 20 Ibm. If a constant counter-
17.50. A circular rowing tank has a main arm A which has a
clockwise torque of 60 Ib-ft is developed on the armature of the
mass of 1,000 kg and a radius of gyration of I m. On the arm rides
motor, what is the speed of A in 2 sec after starting from rest?
the model support B, having a mass of 200 kg and having a radius
Neglect the inertia of the small wheels under A.
of gyration about the Y C l t i C d l axis at Its mass center of 600 mm.
If a torque T of SO N-m is developed on A when B is at position
I = I.8 m, what will be the angular speed 5 sec later if B moves
out at a constant radial speed of .Im/sec. The initial angular speed
of the arm A is 2 'pm. Neglect the drag of the model.

Figure P.17.50. Figure P.17.52.

89 I
17.57. A turbine is rotating freely with a speed wof 6,000 rpm. A
blade breaks off at its base at the position shown. What is the veloc-
ity of the center of mass of the hlade just after the fracture? Does the
blade have an angular velocity just after fracture assuming that no
impulsive torques or forces occur at the fracture? Explain.

Turbine blade

Figure P.17.59.
- __ - -
Figure P.17.57.

17.60. Prove that you can apply the angular momentum equa-
tion about the contact point A on a cylinder rolling without dip-
ping on a circular (and hence including B straight) path. A force P
17.58. Two rods are welded to a dmm which has an angular always normal to OA acts on the cylinder as do a couple moment
velocity of exactly 2,000 rpm. The rod A breaks at the base at the T and weight W. Specifically, prove that
position shown. If we neglect wind friction, how high up does the
center of mass of the rod go? What is the angular orientation of J,: +
( 2 ~ r Wsinor + ~ ) d =t M ( P + r2)(co2 ~ 0,) (a
the rod at the instant that the center of mass reaches its apex'!
Assume that there are no impulsive torques or forces at fracture. where o is the total angular speed of the cylinder. [Hint:Express
The Y axis is vertical. Neglect friction. Use exact value of 2.000 rpm the u n p l u r momentum equation about C and then, from Newton's
throughout. law using the cylindrical component in the transverse direction,
show on integrating that
Y
I,: (f + P + Wsin8)dt = - M ( K - r)(ti, - 4 , )

where f is the friction force at the point of cnntact. Now let .rj
.X rotate with line OC. From kinemutics first show that H B = -3,
where $ i s the rotatian a f the cylinder relative to xy. Then, show
that w = - [ ( R - r ) / r ] @ From these three considerations, you
should readily be able to derive Eq. (a).]
Figure P.17.58.

17.59. A stepped cylinder i s released on a 45" incline where the


dynamic coefficient of friction at the contact is .2 and the static
coefficicnt of friction is .22. What is the angular speed of the
stepped cylinder after 4 sec? The stepped cylinder has a weight of
5 0 0 N and a radius of gyration about its axis of 250 mm. Be Sure w '.
to check to see if the cylinder moves at all! Figure P.17.60.

893
I 8y4
SECTION 17.6 IMPULSIVE FORCES AND TORQUES: ECCENTRIC IMPACT 895

17.6 Impulsive Forces and Torques:


Eccentric Impact
In Chapter 14, we introduced the concept of an impulsivefurce. Recall that an
impulsive force F a c t s over a very short time interval At but has a very high
value during this interval such that the impulse 1 F d t is significant. The
At

n
impulse of other ordinary forces (not having very high peaks during At) is
usually neglected for the short interval At. The same concept applies to
torques, so that we have impulsive torques. The impulsive force and impulsive
torque concepts are most valuable for the consideration of impact of bodies.
Here, the collision forces and torques are impulsive while the other forces,
such as gravity forces, have negligible impulse during collision.
In Chapter 14, we considered the case of central impact between bodies.
Recall that for such problems the mass centers of the colliding bodies lie along
the line of impact.’? At this time, we shall consider the eccentric impact of slab-
like bodies undergoing plane motion such as shown in Fig. 17.34. For eccentric
impact, at least one ofthe mas.7 center.7 dues nut lie along line of impact. The
bodies in Fig. 17.32 have just begun contact whereby point A of one body has
just touched point B of the other body. The velocity of point A just before con-
tact (preimpact) is given as (V,),, while the velocity just before contact for point
B is ( VB)?(The i stands for “initial,” as in earlier work.) We shall consider only
smooth bodies, so that the impulsive forces acting on the body at the point of
contact are collinear with the line of impact. As a result of the impulsive forces, Figure 17.34. Eccentric impact between
there is aperiod ofdeformation, as in our earlier studies, and aperiod ofrestitu- two bodies.
tion. In the period of deformation, the bodies are deforming, while in the period
of restitution there is a complete or partial recovery of the original geometries.
At the end of the period of deformation, the points A and B have the same veloc-
ity and we denote this velocity a? y7 Directly after impact (post impact), the
velocities of points A and B are denoted as (%),and c)p
respectively, where the
subscript f is used to connote the final velocity resulting solely from the impact
process. We shall be able to use the linear impuke-momentum equation and the
angular impulse-momentum equation to relate the velocities, both linear and
angular, for preimpact and postimpact states. These equations do not take into
account the nature of the material of the colliding bodies, and so additional in-
formation is needed for solving these problems.
For this reason, we use the ratio between the impulse on each body
during the period of restitution,l R dt, and the impulse on each body during
the period of deformation, D dt. As in central impact, the ratio is a number
E , called the cueficient of restitution, which depends primarily on the materi-
als of the bodies in collision. Thus,
IRdt
E =
1
Ddt
(17.29)

”The line of impact is normal to the plane of contact between the hodies
Wc shall now show that the components along the line of impact ii-rz of V ,
and V,. taken iit prc- a n d po\liriiptict, are related t o t h y the \'cry same relation
that we lhad for ceiilriil imp;icl. Th;it is.

(17.30)

Recall that the nunici-ator rcprcscnl\ thc relative velocity of. separation along
II of ihc pciinth of. contact. uhcrc:is llic dcnoiniiiat(ir t-cpresents the relative
velocity of approach alon$ II of these points.
We h ~ lf ilr s t considcr hi‘ c a x where the hodies are i n 110 wuy ('oil-
. s i ~ - ~ n i i iirni l their plmc o1 iiiotioii: we can then neglect all inipulscs cxccpt lhiil
coming irom the iinptict. We timv con\ider the hody hiiving cont;ict point A
j
In Fiz. 17.35 wc h a w shown (hi\ hody with iiiipulse D dl a. i.l t'i i f LI v, ' n f the
,

component o f tlic 1 ; t i w i - i i i o i i w i i l i i i i i qii(i~imalong line 01 impact 11-11. u c


can say for tlie ccnler o i m i s s :

Figure 17.35. Impulw acliiig tin otic of thc whcrc (v.!, rcl'crs
10 tlie preimpact velocity of the cciilcr (11' mass ;ind whcrc
horlies. ( y.)li i s
the vclocily 0 1 the center of m a s s at the end o f the deformatioii
period. Siniilxly. l'br thc pcriud or restitution, we have

,, q!vi.!l>],,
JK'lf = M[(V,.!,]- (17.12)

For angu1;ir nioiiietiluiii. we CUI say 1.111- the dcl(irmalion period using I- a s the
distancc Iron? the center of m a s s to PI-11:

ri = i(d)lj
- i(O, (17.13)

Similarly. for the period (11 resliltition:

Ij K i l t =: I ( O , - /(o,j (17.34)

Now, suhstitutc thc rifht \ides of Eqs. 17.3 I and 17.32 into Eq. 17.29. We gel
(in cimcclliitioii 0 1 M :

Next. suhslitiite lor lhc inipulscs ill Eq. 17.29 iihing Eqh. 17.33 iind 17.34. We
cet 011 canceling oiily I :
c

(17.36)
SECTION 17.6 IMPULSIVE FORCES AND TORQUES: ECCENTRIC IMPACT 897

Adding the numerators and denominators of Eqs. 17.35 and 17.36, we can
then say on rcaranging the terms:

We pause now to consider the kinematics of the motion. We can relate


the velocities of points A and C o n the body (see Fig. 17.36) as follows:
VA = v,. + w x pcA (17.38)

Note that the magnitude of pcA is R as shown in the diagram. Since w is nor-
mal to the plane of symmetry of the body and thus to pCa, the value of the
last term in Eq. 17.38 is Rw with a direction normal to R as has been shown
in Fig. 17.36. The components of the vectors in Eq. 17.38 in direction n can
then he given as follows:
Figure 17.36. Slab with lpcAl as R.
(v,),, = (y.)n+ o R c o s 0 (17.39)

Since R cos e= r (see Fig. 17.36), we conclude that


(V,),, = (V,), + rw (17.40)

With the preceding result applied to the initial condition (i), the final
condition 0, and the intermediate condition ( D ) , we can now go hack to Eq.
17.37 and replace the expressions inside the braces (( )) by the left side of
Eq. 17.40 as Follows:

( I 7.41)

A similar procers for the body having contact point B will yield the preceding
equation with subscript B replacing subscript A:

Now add the numerators and denominators of the right side of Eq. 17.41 and
the extreme right side of Eq. 17.42. Noting that

we get Eq. 17.30, thus demonstrating the validity of that equation.


Let us next consider the case where one or both bodies undergoing
impact is constrained to mrate about a ,fued axis. We have shown such a
body in Fig. 17.37 where 0 is the axis of rotation and point A is the contact
point. If an impulse is developed at the point of contact A (we have shown the
impulse during the period of deformation), then clearly there will be an
898 CHAPTER 17 ENERGY AND IMPULSE-MOMENTUM METHODS FOR RIGID BOL>II?S

impulsive force at 0, as shown in the diagram. We shall employ the uiigulor


inipulsr~momriirumequation ahout the fixed point 0. Thus. we have for the
period of delormatioir and the period of restitution:

r j D ~ =I /,,wf, - /p,
r j K d f = /,,of- I,,o,,

Now solve for the impulses in the equation ahove, and substitute into Eq. 17.29.
Canceling I(,, the moment of inertia about the axis of rotation at 0, we get

In Fig. 17.38 we see that


Figure 17.31. impact for a body
under constraint at 0 . V,, = Rw

Thcrcfore.
(V,, I,, = Rw cos 0 = IUO

Using thc above result in Eq. 17.44, we get

But this expression is identical to Eq. 17.41. And by considering the second
hody. which is either frce or constrained to rotate, we get an equation corre-
sponding to Eq. 17.42. We can then conclude that Eq. 17.30 is valid for
impact where one or both bodies are constrained to rotate about ii fixcd axis.
In a typical impact problem, the motion of the bodies preimpact is
given and the motion of the bodies postimpact is desired. Thus, thcrc could bc
Figure 17.38. Velocity of point A four unknowns-two velocities nf the mass centers of the bodies plus t w o
is R w angular velocities. The required equations for solving the problem are formed
from linear and angular momcntum considerations of the bodies taken sepa-
rately or taken its a system. Only impulsive forces are taken into considefii-
tioii during the time interval spanning the impact. I S the bodics are considered
separately, we simply use the formulations of Section 17.5, rcmenibering to
observe Newtiin’s third law at the point of impact between the two bodies.
Furthermore, we must use the coefficient of restitution equation 17.30. Gen-
erally. kinematic considerations are also needed to solvc the problcm. Whcn
there are n o other impulsive forces other than those occurring at the point of
impact, i t might he profitable to consider the hodies as one system. Then.
clearly, as a result of Newton’s third law, we must have cons~rvufionof lift-
eur momenrum relative to an inertial reference, and also we must have cuii-
servafion of angular mumrnfum about any one axis fixed in incrtial space.
We now illustrate these rcmarks in thc following scries of examples.
SECTION 17.6 IMPULSIVE FORCES AND TORQUES: ECCENTRIC IMPACT 899

Example 17.11
A rectangular plate A weighing 20 N has two identical rods weighing I0 N
each attached to it (see Fig. 17.39). The plate moves on a plane smooth
surface at a speed of 5 mlsec. Moving oppositely at 10 mlsec is disc B ,
weighing 10 N. A perfectly elastic collision (E = I ) takes place at G. What
is the speed of the center of mass of the plate just after collision (postim-
pact):’ Solve the problem two ways: consider the bodies separately and
consider the bodies as a system

5 dsec

Figure 17.39. Colliding bodies.

tiun We can consider the disc to be a particle ce this will


only translate. Let point G be the point of contact on the rod. U then
have, for Eq. 17.30:

Therefore,
(VGIi - ( V B ) , = 15 (a)
Now, consider linear and angular momentum for each of the bodies. For this
purpose we have shown the bodies in Fig. 17.40 with only impulsive forces
acting. We might call such a diagram an “impulsive freebody diagram.” We
then see that C, must move in the plus or minus y direction after impact. We
can then say for body A, using linear impulse-momentum and angular
impulse-momentum equations (the latter about the center of mass):
Y

I
For body /I we Iiii\,c Sur the linear impulse-momentum equation.

tdi

We have iiinv ii coiiiplcte set of equations which wc can


solvc. We get:
iv,. j = ~-.305lll/sCc
1 1

Solution 2. Equation ( a ) ahovc Stoiii the coellicieiit of rcstitiilioii and Eq.


!Q, iii
( e )ahove Srmi kirieinaticc a l s o apply to solutioii 2. Suhctitiitiiig 111-
Eq. (a) of scilutiun I using Eq. ( e ) of soliiticvi I . M.C get lor snlutioii 2:
iv,
,I
)# + .130Jl -(L')#), = 1s !ai

Conservation US linear niornentuin for the system leads to thc I-equire-


~iientiii t i l e y dircction that

Wiercforc.

-uL;.l,i, i iL,#I, - ~111 (hl

Alsu angular momentum is conserved about any fixcd 2. axis. We choose


the axis at the positioii corresponding lo (1, at LIic lime (if itlipact. Noting
that I for the plate and i i i m h i s . ( M Y 6 kg-311~
f'ioin s o l u t i o n I (sec liq. ( e ) )
and noting that R caii he considcicd a s a paiticle. w e have
SECTION 17.6 IMPULSIVE FORCES AND TORQUES: ECCENTRIC IMPACT 901

Example 17.11 (Continued)


~(IO)(.l3=
) (.0496)0, + -(Vflj,(.13j
10
R R
_ c _ -
""gUIU mgular
mumenium mOmenfYm
prrirnpacr p"stimpacr

Therefore.
w A = -2.67(Vfl), + 26.7
Solving Eqs. (a), (b), and (c) simultaneously we get:

We leave it to you to demonstrate there has been ronservutiun .f


mechanicd e r i e r p during this perfectly elastic impact. We could have
used this iact in place of Eq. (a) in solution I .

Note that there was some saving of time and labor in using the system
approach throughout for the preceding problem wherein a rigid body, namely
the plate and its arms, collided with a body, the disc, which could he consid-
ered as a particle. In problems involving two colliding rigid bodies neither of
which can be considered a particle, we must consider the bodies separately
since the system approach does not yield a sufficient number of independent
equations as you can yourself demonstrate,
In the preceding example, the bodies were not constrained except to
move in a plane. If one or both colliding bodies is pinned, the procedure for
solving the problem may be a little different than what was shown in Exam-
ple 17.1 1 . Note that there will he unknown supporting impulsive forces at the
pin of any pinned body. If we are not interested in the supposting impulsive
force for a pinned body, we only consider angular mowirrilurn about the pin
for that pinned body; in this way the undesired unknown supporting irnpul-
sive forces at the pin do not enter the calculations. Other than this one factor,
the calculations are the same as in the previous example.
You will recall from momentum considerations of particles that we
considered the collision of a comparatively small body with a very massive
one. We could not use the conservation of momentum equation for the colli-
sion between such bodies since the velocity change of the massive body went
to zero as the mass (mathematically speaking) went tu infinity, thus produc-
ing an indeterminacy in our idealized formulations. We shall next illustrate
the procedure for the collision of a very massive body with a much smaller
one. You will note that we cannot consider a system approach for linear or
angular momentum conservation for the same reasons set foi th in Cliaptcr 14.
In cithcr casc, lhc vclocity 0 1 cnd B preimp;ut is

Vlj = ,\?,y/I = ,, ( 2 ) ( 3 2 . 2 ) ( 2 )= 11.35 ft/scc t I


i
i I
j we now consider each cake sepal-;rrcly.
I Case A. Equation 17.30 can be uscd here. ' I h u \ .

: Thcrcforc.
[ ( v , ~ ) , ] = I 1.3s it/\ti. iil I

~ . linear impulse- ;Ind


Ncxl, considering rod AB i n Fig. 17.42 we 1 1 3 ~l1)r I
angular impulse-momentum considerations (the latter ahiiut an axi\ at

L
i
I
the center of mass).

pi/,10i I!,.)(
= ''
h'
(-I 1.3511 (h)
(
-

-(2)(cos30")Jmr = i I2 20
)(qu,
Fieure 17.12. Inlpuisivr lirce-hud) ?
From kinematics. we have" diagrmi

lVl$J, = (V(.Il + w, x I)(.)+


[ ( V , , i ~ ] l i + 1 1 . 3 S=j i V , j , j + m f k x (ZJ(-.X66i-.5j)
[1 V ) ] i + I I3 S . j
H I /
= ( V,, I j - ,
I , 7 3 2 ~ 0j + (u ,i

i
t
SECTION 17.6 IMPULSIVE FORCES AND TORQUES: ECCENTRIC IMPACT 903

Example 17.12 (Continued)

We now have a complete set of equations considering F dt as an unknown.


Solving, we have for the desired unknowns:
A
wI = -9.07 radlsec
[ ( V B ) x ] l= -9.07 ftlsec

You can demonstrate that energy has been conserved in this action. We
could have used this fact in lieu of Eq. (a) for this problem.
S
Case B. Here we have no slipping on the rough surface and zero vertical
movement of point E . Accordingly, we have shown rod EA with vertical
and horizontal impulses in Fig. 17.43. The linear momentum equations Figure 17.43. Impulsive free-body
diagram.
for the center of mass then are

The angular impulse-momentum equation about the center of mass is

-2(cos30°)j F, dt + 2(sin30°)1 F2 dt =

From kinematics, noting that at postimpact there is pure rotation about


point E , we have
[(VC)J,= C COS ~O")(W,) = 1.732~~ 0)
[(V,),], = -2(sin 30")(0,) = -a, (i)
Substitute for F, dr and 1F2 dr from Eqs. (0 and (8) into Eq. (h). We get
on then employing Eqs. (i) and (i):

(1.732~, + 11.35) + (2)(.5)(?)(-0,) =

Therefore,
0

Y
H
-1 600 mm 4
G
I)
I x &
I Figure P.17.71).
17.72. A stiff bent rod is dropped so that end A strikes a heavy mass of the drumstick is 200 g. Idealize the drumstick as a
table 11. If the impact is plastic and there is no sliding at A, what is uniform slender rod.
the postimpact speed of end R'? The rod weighs per unit length

I
300 mm
I
M

'I ~

Figure P.17.72. (h) 70 mm


Figure P.17.74.

17.73. Solve Problem 17.72 for an elastic impact at A . Take the


surface of contact to be smooth. Demonstrate that energy has been
conscrved.
17.75. A hlock of ice I It x I ft x $ ft slides along a surface
at a speed of I O ftlsec. The hlock strikes slop D in a plastic
impact. Does the block turn over after the impact? What is the
highest angular speed reached? Take y = 62.4 Ib/ft2.

17.74. A drumstick and a wooden learner's drum are shown I'


i n (a) of the diagram. At the beginning of a drum roll, the
drumstick is horizontal. The action of the drummer's hand is
simulated by form components I;; and F,. which make A a sta-
tionary axis of rotation. Also, there is a constant couple M of
.5 N-m. Ifthe action starts from a stationary position shown,
what i \ the frequency of the drum roll far perfectly elastic col- r)
lision hetween the drumstick and the learner's drum? The Figure P.17.75.

905
17.76. A hnrimntal rigid rod i s dropped from a height IO fi
above a hcavy tahle. The end of the rod collides with the tahle. II
the coefficient nf impact t hetwcen the end <>1 the rod and the cor
ncr of the tahle i s .h, what i s the postimpact angular velocity of the
rod? Also. what i i the velocity n1 the center n l mass postimpact
The rod i s I It in length and weighs 1.5 Ih.

-I 1,-1

Figure P.17.78

Figure P.17.76.

17.77. A rod A 1s dnrpped from a height of 120 mm ahove H. II 17.79. An annw mwing esientially horirmtally a1 a speed ot
an elastic cnllisinn takes place at 8, at what timc A i kiter doe\ a 2 0 mAec impinges on ii statinnary w<ii)den hlnck which can rotate
second cnllision with support 11 take placc'! Thc rod weighs 40 N . frccly ahout light rods D E and GH. The arnrwhend weighs 1.5 N,
; ~ n dthe shaft, which i s 250 mm long. weighs .7 N . If thc hloch
l---400 m m I- wciph? Ill N. uhat i s the angular velocity o l thc block just after
~

thc armwhrild hrcrmes stuck in thc wood'? The arrowhead sinks


I20 mm
I. A ?n mm into the w m d at point A such that the shalt sticks out 250 mm
t n m thc surface ofthe wood.

1) I1

E
Figure P.17.77.

400 mm A

17.78. A packing crate fall, on the side of a hill at a place where


there i s smooth rock. If 6 = .X. determine the speed of the center
of the crate just after impact. The clate weigh.; 400 N and has a
radius of gyration ahout ai axis through thc center and nnimal t n H H
thc face in the diagram uf $ 2 m. Fizure P.17.79.
SECTION 17.7 CLOSURE 907

17.7 Closure
Let us now pause for an overview of the text up to this point. Recall the fol-
lowing:
(a) In Chapter 13, we studied energy methods for single particles and sys-
tems of particles with a short introduction to coplanar rigid body motions.
(b) Then in Chapter 14, we presented linear and angular momentum pnnci-
ples for a single particle and systems of particles with again a short introduc-
tion to plane motion of rigid bodies.
These methods are derived from Newton's law. In short, they are integrated
forms of Newton's law which bring in useful concepts and greater ease in
solving many problems. Next, after studying Chasles' theorem and kinemat-
ics of rigid bodies in Chapter 15, we went to Chapter 16.
(c) In Chapter 16, we studied the dynamics of plane motion for rigid bodies
using Newton's law and the equation MA = HAdirectly rather than integrated
of forms of these equations, namely the energy and momentum equations.
Now in Chapter 17, we went through a partial recycle of the above
steps. That is, we went back to Chapters 13 and 14 this time for three-dimen-
sional formulations and focused on rigid bodies and systems of rigid bodies.
Naturally, there is an overlap with those earlier chapters plus an expansion of
viewpoints to include a general formulation and use of H and a look at eccen-
tric coplanar impact of more complex bodies. Again, with the aforementioned
integrated forms of N e w o n ' s law, we were able to solve some interesting
problems.
We are now at a stage comparable to what we were in just preceding
Chapter 16. [n Chapter 18, we go back again to Newton's law and MA = fiA,
this time for the dynamics of general three-dimensional motion of rigid bod-
ies. This is considered the province of a second course in Dynamics and
accordingly is a starred chapter. Interested students who go ahead will unlock
the mysteries of gyroscopic motion and the performance of gyros among
other interesting applications and concepts. In the process, those students will
meet the famous Euler equations of motion whose simplified, special form
we have been using up to this point.
lelepiped r e l a t i w IO the ground'? after i t rotale\ 9Il"'! Acsumc that the cylinder ~ I I uithoril
E slipping.

l e 4, --I

Figure P.17.81

17.82. A rod .4B is held ill a nositiiin H = 1 5 ' :~ndI L I


17.84. A tractor with driver weighs 3,000 Ib. If a torque of *17.88. A rod weighing 90 N is guided by two slider bearings A
200 ft-lb is developed an each of the drive wheels by the motor, and B. Smooth ball joints connect the I-od to the bearings. A force
what is the speed of the tractor after it moves 10 ft? The large F of 45 N acts on hearing A . What is the speed o f A after it has
drive wheels each weigh 200 Ih and have a diameter of 3 ft and a moved 200 mm? The system is stationary for the configuration
radius of gyration of I ft. The small wheels each weigh 40 Ib and shown. Neglect friction.
have a diameter of I ft with a radius of gyration of .4 ft. Do not
use the center-of-mass approach for the whole system. Y

Figure P.17.84.

17.85. Work Problem 17.84 using the center of mass of the


whole system. Find the friction forces on each wheel.

17.86. What is the angular momentum vector about the center of Figure P.17.88.
mass of a homogeneous rectangular parallelepiped rotating with
an angular velocity uf 10 rad/sec about a main diagonal? The sides
of the rectangular parallelepiped are I ft, 2 ft, and 4 ft, as shown,
and the weight is 4,000 Ib. e17.89. A device with thin walls ciinlains water. The device is
supported on a platform on which a torque 1 of .5 N-m is applied
" 10 rad/sec for 2 sec and is zero thereafier. What is the angular velocity w o f the
system at the end of 2 sec assuming that, as a result of low viscos-
ity, the water has no rotation relative to the ground in the vertical
tubes. The system of tubes and platform have a weight of SON and
a radius of gyration of 200 mm. [Hint: The pressure in the liquid is
equal at all times to the specific weight ytimes the distance d below
the free surface of the liquid.] Note that for water y = 9,810 Nlm?.
Note: water heights in the tuhes change with angular speed.
Figure P.17.86.

17.87. A force P of 200 N is applied to a cart The cart minus


the four wheels weighs 150 N. Each wheel has a weight of 50 N,
a diameter of 400 Rim. and a radius of gyration of 150 mm. The
-~~20 mm

load A weighs 500 N. If the cart starts from rest, what is its speed
in 20 sec? The wheels roll without slipping.

Figure P.17.87. Figure P.17.89.

909
30 mm

j F dr
Figure P.17.92. Figure 1'.17.95.
Dynamics of General
Rigid-Body Motion

18.1 Introduction’
Consider a rigid body moving arbitrarily relative to an inertial reference X Y Z
as shown inFig. 18.1.

X’
/ 5’
Figure 18.1. A rigid body undergoin arbitrary motion relative to
inertial reference XYZ. Reference &translates with A .

Choose some point A in this body or in a hypothetical massless extension


of this body. An element dm of the body is shown at a position p from A. The
velocity V’ of dm relative to A is simply the velocity of dm relative to a refer-
ence ET)^ which translates with A relative to XYZ. Similarly, the linear mnmen-
tum of dm relative to A (Le., V’ dm) is the linear momentum of dm relative to

lUntil Eq 18.1, we will be repeating the development of the formulations of the compo^
nents of HAfirst done in Section 16.2. This will eliminate the inconvenience of having 10 turn
hack at various times as we move along in Chapter 18.

91 1
tqctranslatinp with A . We can now give the moment ofthis momentum (i.e..
the angular momentum) dH, about A a s

but since A is l'ixed in the body lor i n a hypothctical m a d e % extenbioii of thc


hody) the vector iiiusl hc lihcd i n the h d ) ;ind. acc<irdingly.
SECTION I x. I INTRODUCTION 913

We next integrate the above equations over the domain of the rigid body delet-
ing of course the massless hypothetical extension. We see on noting the defin-
itions of the mass moments and products of inertia that we get the components
of HA along a n arbitrary set of axes xyz at A. We thus have at any time f

whcrc we repeat w is the angular velocity of the body relative to XYZ at time f.
Now the axes xyz served only to give a set of directions for HAat time I.
Thc reference syz remember could have any angular velocity relative to
XYZ.
Note that the angular velocity 0 did not enter the formulations for HA at
time f . The reason for this result is that the values of the components of HA
along xy7 at time f do not in any way depend on angular velocity a-they
depend only on the instanlaneous orientation of xyz at time 1. To illustrate this
point, suppose that we have two sets of axes x y z and x>’z’ at point A in
Fig. 18.3. At time I they coincide as has been shown in the diagram, but x y z
has zero angular velocity relative to XYZ, whereas x>’z’ has an angular veloc-
ity 0 relative to XYZ. Clearly, one can say at time t:

However, the rime drrivutives of the corresponding components will not be


equal 10 each other at time I . Accordingly, in the next section, whereHA is
treated, we must properly account for f L

X
/
Figure 18.3. .r?z and x’y’z’ coincide at time 1.
914 CHAPTER 18 OYNAMICS O r GENTRAI RIGID BODY MOTlOh

18.2 Euler's Equations of Motion


We shall now restrict point A of Section 18. I further, as we did i n Chapter 17.
by ciinsidcring only Ihohe points for which thc equation M, = If,i s valid:

1. .The inass center.


2. Points fixed or miiving with constant V at time I in inertial space (i.e.,
points having zero acceleration at time f relative to inertial reference X Y a .
3. A point accelerating toward or away Sroni thc mas$ centel-.
We learned i n Chapter 15 that derivatives of a vector as seen from dif-
ferent references could he related as follows:

where w i h the angular velocity 0 f . x ~ : rcliitivc 10 X Y Z . We shall employ this


equation in the hasic mi,munf-ifl~n,,niPnliimuq11urion to shili the obscrvalion
reference fnim X Y Z to .x?: i n the following way where now R represents thc
mgular vclocity o f .ryz. Thus

The idea tiow i s to choiisc the angular velocity R o f reference .zS: at A i n such
a way that (dH,,/dr),, i s most easily evaluated. With this accomplished. the
next qtep is to attempt the integration of the resulting differential equation.
With regard t~ attempts at integration, we point out at this early stage that
Eq. 18.3 i s valid only a s king as point A i s one of the three qualified points just
discussed. Clearly. if A i s the mass ccntcr, then Eq. 18.3 i s valid at all times and
can he integrated with respect l o time provided that the mathematics are not
too difticult. However. if for es (2) and ( 3 ) point A qualifies only at time f.
then Eq. 18.3 i s valid only at tinic 1 and accordingly c ~ n ~ ihe o t integratcd. If.
on the lither hand. liir case (2). there i s an axih o f rotation fixed i n inertial
space. then Eq. 18.3 i s valid at a11 times for any point A along the axis ofriita-
tioii and accordingly can hc intrgrated. We have already done this in Chapter
16. If, furthermore. the axis of r ~ t a t i o nalways p e s thriiugh the fixed point A
hut does not have a fixed orientation i n inertial space (see Fig. 18.4). we can
again use Eq. 18.3 at all times and attcmpt to integrate it with respect to time.
W The carrying out 01 huch inlegrations may he quite dillicult, however.'
Returning to Eq. 18.3, we can work directly with this equation selecting a
rcfcrcncc xyz for each problcm tu yield thc siinplcst working equation. On the
Figure 18.4. Axis of rotation goes other hand, we can develop Eq. 18.3 further for certain classes o f refkrences
throueh fixed point A . xy;. For example, we could have .vy: translate relative to X Y Z . This would
SECTION 18.2 EULER'S EQUATIONS OF MOTION 915

mean that = 0 so that Eq. 18.3 would seem to be more simple for such
cases.' However, the body will be rotating relative to x y and the moments and
products of inertia measured about xyz will then he time functions. Since the
computation of these terms as lime functions is generally difficult, such an
approach has limited value. On the other hand, the procedure offixing xyz in
the body (as we did for the case of plane motion i n Chapter 16) does lead to
very useful forms of Eq. lX.3, and we shall accordingly examine these equa-
tions with great care. Note first that the moments and products of inertia will
be constants for this case and that 0 = w. Hence. we have

MA=(%) +OXHA (18.4)


M

'We shall liilcr find il advanPagcous not to fin xyc to the body for ccrlilin problems
Thi, i\ iiideed a frirmidable set [if equations. For the impiirtant special case of
pliinr nioliori the :axis i h always iimnal to the X Y planc which is the plane
o l niotioti. Hence w inusi he iiormal to plane XY and thus collinear with the
r iixic. Thus replacing < by (0and setting the other components equal l o zero. we
Thus we haye
get the w m w i f ofmiiii i i ~ t i ~qi ii d o i u for jioimii pliriir iii~i~im.

(MA).T
= -I,$ + I&
(MAJ y = -lYza
- I,:W2
(MAJ=
y I$

The reader n a y no\+ or iil any tinie liiter go h;ick to Chapter 16 ior a raiher
c~irefuI\tiid), 01 tlic use < I ( !lie ahovc plane motion w m e , i I a / nioimvifuiii
equations. Wc now continue n'ith !lie I1iree~diiiirnsi~)naI approach.
Note ncw that if we choose reierence S:K 111 he pr;iic;pol axes of the hody
iit point 11. ltieri i t i s clear thei the products of inertia iirc all zero i n the system
01' cqu;itions 18.5. and this iw enables u s 111 siinpliiy the equations consider-
ably. The rcsultinF equations given helou' are the fiinious Eider- q u o t i o m of
tilotion. Niitc tliiit these equatiiins relate the 1iigul;ir velocity and thc angular
wceleraiion l o lhc !nomen1 01 ihc cxtcrml fiirces ;ahout the point A .

MR= ',,", + m p r ( f z : - I>?) 118.h;~)


M,, = I>$,,
. . + ap,(IU - ( I 8.6h)
M: = lzpjz+ m p s ( l v x-, I x x J (18.hc)

111 hoth set\ d Eq\. 18.5 iiiid 18.h. we l i i i ~ cthree siniultaiieous tint-order dif-
krenti;il equiiiicms. It the inorion ( i t Ihe hody ahout point A i s known. we can
easily compute the required tiioiiien1s ahoul point A . On the other hand. if the
iiioineiils are knowii function.; 01 iinic and the angular velocity i s desired, w e
have the difficult prohleiii of siilvinf siiiiultancous lioiilincar differential
equation\ for the uiiknowni (05. coy. and (or. However. in practical problem?.
we oitcii kiiow soiiic of Ihc angular velocity and accclcratioii componcnh
ircm constrilitits or Fiveti data. so. with the restrictions mentioned earlier. we
ciin s<rmetitiies intcsratc tlic cquatioiis readily as we did i n Chapter I 6 for
[il;ine iixiti<in.At othcr limes LIZ use them to siilvc for ccrtain desired i i t , s r u i i -
tiirvnu.c w l u ' s of the unknown\.
We \hall inow discuss the use of Euler', equations.

18.3 Application of Ewler's Equations


In this scclion, we shall apply the Euler equations I o a numhcr oiproblems.
Rciore laking up these prohlems. let u c l i n t c;ircfully considcr how to chprccs
thc c o n i p o t i c n t s ~ ~ , , ~ ~ , , for iise i n Ruler's equations. First note that ha.
~iiiil~i~
ir),. and io^ arc time dcrivaiivcs iih sccn Iron1X Y 7 o f the components ot'w along
SECTION 18.3 APPLICATION OF EULER'S EQUATIONS 9 17

reference xyx. A possible procedure then is to express mA, q,and w, first in a


way that ensures that these quantities are correctly stated over a time interval
rather than at some instantaneous configuration. Once this is done, we can
simply differentiate these scalar quantities with respect to time in this interval
to get hx,hy, and&?.
To illustrate this procedure, consider in Fig. 18.5 the case of a block E
rotating about rod AB, which in turn rotates about vertical axis CD. A refer-
ence xvz is fixed to the block at the center of mass so as to coincide with the
principal axes of the block at the center of mass. When the block is vertical as
shown, the angular speed and rate of change of angular speed relative to rod
AB have the known values (w2)" and (h2),.respectively. At that instant, AB
has an angular speed and rate of change of angular speed ahout axis CD of
known values ( w , ) and ~ (hI)",respectively. We can immediately give the
angular velocity components at the instant shown as follows:
ox = 0
mv = (w*)i]
w z = (a,)"
But to get the quantities (hx)o, (h&, and (h7)o for the instant of interest4 we
must first express w,, w,, and cu. as genera1,funcfion.y of time in order to per-
mit differentiation with respect io time.

D
Figure 18.5. Block at time to

To do this differentiating, we have shown the system at some arbitrary


time in Fig. 18.6. Note that the x axis is at some angle p from the horizontal. D
When p become9 zero. we arrive back at the configuration of intereyt, and a,, Figure 18.6. Block at time f

'You may he tempted IO say (ha),, = 0. (hJ, = (hJWand (h7)(,= (h,),)


by just inspect-
ing the diagram. You will now learn that this will not be correct.
9 18 (‘tIAPTEK I X DYNAMICS (IF GENF.R/\L KlGlD-BODY MOTI(1iX

&I,, o,,and (i2 heclime known valucs to,)(,. ((02io.and (h21il. respec-
tively: The angnl;rr velocity coniponents Tor this arlitimry s i l ~ ~ a t i oare:
n
m, = 01, s i i i 0. a), = ( 0 ~ . to. = mi CO S 0 !18.7)

Since thcse relatims iire valid over the tiiiic inlcrval oi interest. wc can dir-
ferentiate them with respect to time and get
(ht = ci), sin /j + (illcos /?j
hs =<;I, (18.X)
(b. = (ilc o s 0 - (O \in [J/j
It should be clear upon inspectin@the diaflam that p = -(u,. and so
the preccding tcrms hecoiric
~ (b,
c i = ~ sin 0 - q ( 0 2c m / ?
h, ~= cb, (1X.W
h~= ci), c o i /? .t q o , siii p
If wc now k t /I become z e r a u.e reach the ~ ‘ i ~ n f i ~ u r ai tdi ~ ii~
iiilercsl ;md uc
get from Eqs. 18.7 ;ind 18.8 thc proper viilucs of the mgular d o c i t y compo-
nents and their time dcriv;iti\es at t h i s configuratioii:

ywkl
(0, =o, h, = -io1),i((l)2)(l
OI, = (to2Ili. h s := ((i)>!,,

_j 01. 7 (all),,. (2. = !f2, i , ,


Actually. MK &I not have to employ such ii procedurc 111- the e\aluation
of these quantitiec. There is :I simple direct ;ipproach that can he uscd. hut wc
must prelacc thc discussion of this method by mnie gcncral remiirks ahout
the time derivative, as wen ironi thr XYZ;ixcs. o i i i vector A . I h i ? vcctorA i s
expressed in terms oicompiincnti ;ilways parallel I U the ~ 1 ~ :rcferenrr. which
X R
~iiovesrclaliw to XYZ (Fig. 18.7). Wc can then say. considcrinf i. j . and k :I’
Figure 18.7. Crrmpmrnt.; r f A along ~ry;. unit veclors for reference .rx::

= / i , i . t A , / + ; \ ; k + A ~ i w X i ! + A , i w x . j ! + A( w X k ) (IX.IOl

I i we decompose the vector (dA/dflXyzinlo ciimponcnts parallcl I V the ~t?:


axes at rime I and carry i n i t the cross productr o n the right side i n terms of.i,;
components. then we get. ;iller collecting term\ and cxpressing the re\ults as
scular equations:
SECTION 18.3 APPLICATION OF EIJLER'S EQUATIONS 919

We can learn an important lesson from these equations. If you take the time
derivative of a vector A with respect to a reference XYZ and express the com-
ponent! of this vector parallel to the axes of a reference x y z rotating relative
to XYZ (these are the terms on the left side of the above equations), then the
results are in general not the .same asfir.!t taking the components of the vec-
tor A along the directions x y z and then taking time derivatives of these
scalars. Thus,

How does this result relate to our problem where we are considering
h,, by,and hr?Clearly, these expressions are time derivatives of the compo-
nents of the vector w along the moving x y z axes, and so in this respect they
correspond to the terms on the right side of inequality 18.12. Let us then con-
sider vector A to be w and examine Eq. 18.11 :

(1 8.13)

We see that the last two terms on the right side in each equation cancel for
this case, leaving us

(18.14)

We see that for the vector o (i,e., the angular velocity of the x y z reference
relative to the XYZ reference), we have an exception to the rule stated earlier
(Eq. 18.12). Here is the one case where the derivative of a vector as seen from
one set of axes XYZ has components along the directions of another set of
axes x y z rotating relative to XYZ, wherein these components are respectively
equal to the simple time derivatives of the scalar components of the vector
along the xyz directions. In other words, you can take the derivative of w first
from the XYZ axes and then take scalar components along xyz, or you can
take scalar components along x y z first and then take simple time derivatives
of the scalar components, and the results are the same.
I f we.ful/y understand the exceptional nature of Eq. 18.14, we can cum-
pute h? 0, and hzin a straightforward manner b y simplyfirst determining
SECTION 18.1 APPLICATION OF EILER‘S E Q UATIONS 92 I
Example 18.1
In Fig. 18.8 a thin disc of radius R = 4 ft and weight 322 Ib rotates at an
angular spced w2of 100 radlsec relativc to a platform. The platform rotates
with an angular speed w , of 20 radlsec relative to the ground. Compute
the bearing reactions at A and B. Neglect the mass of the shaft and assume
that bearing A restrains the system in the radial direction.
Clearly, we shall need t u use Euler’s equations as part of the s o h -
tion to this problem, and so we f i x a reference xyz to the center of mass of
thc disc as shown in Fig. 18.8. XYZ isfixed t~ the ground. In using Euler’s
equations, the key slep is to get the angular velocity components and their
time derivatives for the body as seen from XYZ. Accordingly, we have

w = w, + w z = -20k + IOOjradlsec Figure 18.8. Rotating disc on platfbrm.

Hence, we have for the xyz components:

(Or =0
my = 100 radlsec
(0.= -20 radlsec

Next, we have
Ch = Ch, + h 2= 0 + wlx w2
= (-20k) X (100j) = 2.000i radlsec?

We thus havc for the nyz components:

h,\ = 2,000 rad/sec2


il, = 0
6. = 0

Before going to the Euler’s equations, we shall need the principal


moments of inertia of the disc. Using formulas from the front inside covers,
we get
I ’? = I2 Wg R 2 = $(10)(16) = 8 0 slug-ft’
I W
I,,,, = I.. = - - R’ = 40 slUg-it*
‘. 4 fi

We can now substitute into the Euler’s equations.

M r = (40)(2,000)+ (100)(-20)(40 - 8 0 ) = 160,000ft-lb


M v = (80)(0)+ (0)(-20)(40 - 40) = 0
M’: = (40)(0)+ (0)(100)(80 - 40) = 0
922 CHAI'TER IH r1YNAMICS OF GIINEHAI. KLCIr)-HOUY MO'IION

Example 18.1 (Continued)


Now the monicnt components ahoue i r e generated by the hearing-force z
component:, (sec Fig. 1X.Y). Hencc, we ciiii bay:

We have effectively iwo equutions (or four unknowns


We next use Newton's law fur the inash centcl:
Figure 18.9. Bearing forma

The first two cquations are cquilihriuin equation:,. The third cquation
relata the radial fiircc Ay, from the barring A. and the radial i i c c ~ l e l a t i ~ n
0 l l h e center of mash of the disc which you will iiotice is iii bimplc circular
motion about the Z axis. We now have enough equations for all the tin-
knuwns. It is then a simple milter to evaluate the fixces from the hearing:,.
They are:

Ax = B, = 0
Av = 32,0001b
B, = 20,161 Ib
A7 = -19.839 Ib

The rrai./iii,w.s to thesc forces arc the desired forces mito thc hearing:,

In Example I X. I . you may have heen surpriccd at the large value of the
hearing furccs in the i direction. Actually. if we did not include the weight of
Ihc disc. then A~ uid B. would have funned a sizable couple. This couple
stcins from the fact that a hudy having a high angular momentum about one
axis i h madc Lo move such that the aforementioned axis rotates about yet a
becond axis. Such ia couple i s called a ,yymscopIi: couplr. It occurs in no small
mcasurr for thc lront whccls of ii car that i h steered while moving ai high
spceds. It occurs in thc jet engine of 21 plenc that is changing its direction of
flight. You will h;i\,e opportunity tu investigatc these effect5 in the homework
problems.
SECTION 18.3 APPLICATION OF EIJLERS EQUATIONS 923
Example 18.2
A cylinder AB is rotating in bearings mounted on a platform (Fig. 18.10).
The cylinder has an angular speed w2 and a rate of change of speed W2,
both quantities being relative to the platform. The platform rotates with an
angular speed wI and has a rate of change of speed W,, both quantities
being relative to the ground. Compute the moment of the supporting forces
of the cylinder A B about the center of mass of the cylinder in terms of the
aforementioned quantities and the moments of inertia of the cylinder.
We shall do this problem by two methods, one using axes fixed to
the body and using Euler’s equations, and the other using axes fixed to
the platfni-rn and using Eq. 18.2.

Method I: Reference fixed to cylinder. In Fig. 18.10 we have fixed axes Figure 18.10. Rotating cylinder on
platform
xyz to the cylinder at the mass center. To get components ofhfpardlel to the
inertial relerence, WE consider the problem when the x y z reference is pard-
le1 to the X Y Z reference. The angular velocity vector w for the body is then
w = w I +w, =w,k+o,j

Hcnce,
COr = 0 radlsec
mv = o2radlsec (a)
w. = wI radlsec

Also, we can say noting t h a t j is fixed to the centerline of the cylinder

h = hi + h2 = h i k + ($)rrz(N)2j)
= h , k + h2j + w , ( w , x j )
= h , k + h 2 j + w,(w,k x j )
= h , k + h2j - w p , i

Accordingly, we have at the instant of interest


hx = -w,w2 radlsec,
hv = h, radlsec,
hz = W ,radlsec2

Since I z , = ,I we see that I,(-o,w2)) cancels w,w21z,in Eq. (c), and we


then have (he desired result:
924 CHAFER I8 DYNAMICS 01' GENERAL RI(;IU~BODY MI~ITION

Example 18.2 (Continued)

M = -I,,yw,w,i + I y y w 2 j + Iadlk ( 1)

I
t Method 11: Reference fixed to platform. We shall now di1 this problem
1 i the mass center C of the cylinder again, hut now fixed to the
by having . c ~ at
platlorin. In other words, the cylinder rotates relative L o the ~ r y reference
r
'
j
with angular speed w2. Keeping this in mind, we can still refer to Fig. I X. I O .
Obviously. we cannot uhe Euler's equations here and must retui-n to
i Ecl. 18.2.

'
Hcc;iuse the cylinder i s a body of revolution about the s axis. the products
of inertia ltv.I\:,and are always zero. and l,~<. I,,..and 1.. arc u m s f m r s at
a11 times. Were these conditions riot present. this method ( 1 1 approach
wiiuld bc very difficult, hilice we would have Io ascertilirl the lime dcriva~
, tives of these inertia ternis. Thus. using Eq. 18.2, rrrnembcring that w. thc
1 a n p l a r velocity o f t h c body, goes into H , . while (1 i s the angular \'clocity
I o t ~ r y z we
. bee that

j Note that i, j . and k arc conslants as scen froin ,ryr. Only wl and w2 are
; tinic lunctions and undergo simple time diflerentiatior 0 1 scalars. Thlls.
i

1 Noting further that $1 = w , k . we have 011 rubsliluting Eq. ( c ) into Eq. ( a ) :


M L Iv,d,j+ I . ~ c , k+ o , k X ( H , i + f l J +Hk)
= I ~ ~ r ~ , j + i . . r ~ l k + w , k x ( O i + I , I~L ~u iu, k, )j + (di

I
i M = -Iyyw,w2i + Iyyhj
+ Iyyw,k
j
I
i This equation is identical to the one obtained using method I
18.1. The moving pans of a jet engine consist of a compressor 18.3. The left front tire of a car moving at 55 niilhr along an
and a turbine connected to a common shaft. Suppose that this sys- unbanked road along a circular path having a mean radius of
tem is rotating at a speed w , of 10,000 rpm and the plane it is in 150 yd. The tire i s 26 in. in diameter. The rim plus tire weighs
moves at a speed of 600 milhr in a circular loop of radius 2 mi. 10 Ib and has a combined radius of gyration of 9 in. about its axis.
What is the direction and magnitude of the gyroscopic torque Normal to the axis, the radius of gyration i s 7.5 in. What is thz
transmitted to the plane from the engine through hearings A and gyrtiscopic torque on the hearings of this front wheel coming
B ? The engine has a weight of 200 Ih and a radius of gyration solely from the motion of the front wheel'?
about its axis of rotation of I ft. The radius of gyration at the cen-
ter of mass for an axis normal to the centerline is 1.5 ft. What 18.4. In Problem 18.3, suppose that the driver is turning the front
advantage is achieved by using two oppositely turning jet engines wheel at a rale m3 <if .2 I-adlsec at the instant where the radius of
instead of one large one? curvature of the path is 150 yd. What is then the torque needed o n
the wheel solely from the motion of the wheel'?

Compressor
SwgE

/'
,' R = 2 m i
Turbine

\ 150yd

0 1
Figure P.18.1.
Figure P.18.4.
18.2. A space capsule (unmanned) is tumbling in apace due to
18.5. A student is holding a rapidly rotating wheel in front of
malfunctioning of its control system such that at time t, w , = 3
him. He is standing on a platform that can turn freely. If the stu-
radlsec, w2 = 5 radlsec, and mi = 4 radlsec. At this instant,
dent exerts a torque M , as shown, what begins to happen initially'?
small jets are creating a torque T of 30 N-m. What are the angular
acceleration components at this instant? The vehicle is a body What happens a little later'!
of revolution with k~ = I m,k> = k, = I .h m, and has a mass of
1.000 kg.

L
I c M,

Figure P.18.2. Figure P.18.S.

925
x

- 21lO rmn
.A.

X /'

Figurc P.IX.7

Figure P.lX.11.
18.12. Explain how the roll of a ship can be stabilized by the *18.16. Work Problem 18.15 for the following data:
action of a heavy rapidly spinning disc (gyroscope) rotating in a
set of bearings in the ship as shown. ~, = 3 radlsec'
h2 = -2 rad/sec2
fb, = 4 radlsec'

The other data are the hame

Figure P.18.12.
18.17. A thin disc has its axis inclined to the vertical by an angle
18.13. A IO-kg disc rotates with speed w , = 10 radlsec relative 8 and rolls without slipping with an angular speed w , about the
to rod AB. Rod AB rotates with speed O2 = 4 radlsec relative ti) supporting rod held at B with a ball-and-socket joint. I f 1 = 10 ft,
the vertical shaft, which rotates with specd w? = 2 radlsec relative r = 2 ft, e = 45",and 0,= IO rddlsec, compute the anguldr
to the ground. What is the torque coming unto the beaings atB due to velocity of the rod BC about axis 0.0.If the disc weighs 40 Ib,
the motion at a time when 8 = 60"? Take u, = G2 = Ui, = 0. what is the total moment about point B from a11 forces acting on
the system? Neglect the mass of the rod UC. [Hint: Use a reference
xyz at B when two of the axes are in the plane of 0-0 and OC.]

Y
0 ,

Figure P.18.13. Figure P.18.17.


18.14. Solve Problem 18.13 forthecase where b, = 2 radlsec2,
h2 = 3 radlsec', and ch3 = 4 rad/sec2 in the directions shown. 18.18. A gage indicator CD in an instrument is 20 mm long and
is rotating relative to platform A at the rate a, = .3 radlsec. The
18.15. A man is seated i n a centrifuge of the type described platform A Is fixed to a space vehicle which is rotating at speed
in Example 15.14. If w , = 2 radlsec, w2 = 3 radlsec, and w3 = w2 = I radlsec about vertical axis LM. At the instant shown,
4 radlsec, what torque must the seat develop about the center of what are the moment components from the bearings E and G
mass of the man as a result of the motion? The man weighs 700 N about the center of mass of CD needed for the motion of CD and
and has the following radii of gyration as determined by expen- EG? The indicator weighs .25 N, and the shaft EG weighs .30 N,
ment while sitting in the seat: has a diameter of I mm, and a length of 10 mm.

Figure P.18.15. Figure P.18.18.

921
18.19. An eight-bladed fan i s used i n a wind tunncl to drive thc 11\11,

iir. The angular velocity w , ofthe fan i s 120 p n . A t the inrtanl (11
ntercst, each hladc is rotating about its own axis :(in order to
:hange the a n g l e d attack of thr blade) such that w1 = I r n d l x c
m d Ui, i s .5 rddisec2. Each blade weighs 200 N and has the Sol-
awing radii of gyration at the miss center (C.M.):

k 5 = (NU) mm
k 5 = 5XOmm
k = 100 tnm

:<insider only the dynamics of the system (and not the :wo-
jynarnics) to find the torque required about the i anis of the hl:idc.
[ f a couple intrment of 4 N-m is develuped i n thc ,r direction a1 the
3ase of the blade, what force component< i ? nredcd at thc hasc of
:he blade for the mution rlescrihcd?

Figure P.lX.20.

Figure P.18.19

18.20. A swing-wing fighter planc i s imwing with a specd ol


Mach 1.3. (Note that Milch I cormpands trr a speed ol iih(iu1
1,200 km/hr.) The pilot iit the instant shown i s Fwinpinp his wings
back at the rate ml of .3 raillsec. At the s a n e time he is rillling at
il rate w, of .6 radlsec and is performing a loop :IS s h o w n T h e
wing weighs 6.S kN and haa lhc fblluwing radii of gyration at the
enter of mass:
k k = .X in
k) = 4 m
k~ = h m

Yhat i s the moment that the lllselage must develap about the CLIW
cr of miss of the wing to accomplish the dynamics of Ihe
lescribed molions'! Do not consider arrdynamich.

I28
18.22. You will learn in fluid mechanics that when air moves *18.24. Solve Problem 18.23 for the case when h, = 2 radlsec'
across a rotating cylinder a force is developed normal to the axis and h2 = 6 rad/sec2 at the instant of interest.
of the cylinder (the Mupnus rffecf). In 1Y2h Flettner used this
principlc to "sail" a vessel across the Atlantic. Two cylinders were 18.25. A rod D weighing 2 N and having a length 01 200 mm and
kcpt at a cunrtant rotational speed by B motor of w, = 200 rpm a diameter of 10 mm rotates relative to platform K a t a speed w, of
relative to the ship. Suppose that in rough seas the ship is rolling 120 radlsec. The platform is in a space vehicle and turns at a speed
about the axis of the ship with a speed 0,of .E radlsec. What con- wi of 50 radlsec relative to the vehicle. The vehicle rotates at a
ple moment components must the ship transmit to the base of the speed w, of 30 radlsec relative to iiiertial space about the axis
cylinder as a result only of the motion of the ship? Each cylinder shown. What are the bearing forcer at A and B normal to the axis AR
weighs 700 Ib and has a radius of gyration along the axis of 2 ft resulting from the motion of rod u'! What torque I is needed about
and normal to the axis at the center of mass of I O ft. AB to maintain a constant value of w, at the inmnt of interest'?

Flettneis ship
Figure P.18.22.
I00 mm
*18.23. Part of a clutch system consists of idenlical rods AB and
AC rotating relative to a shaft at the speed w2 = 3 radlsec while X#?
the shaft rotates relative to the ground at a speed w , = 40 radlsec.
As a result of the motion what are the bending moment com-
ponents at the base of each rod if each rod weighs 10 N? Figure P.18.25.

Y
18.26. Solve Problem 18.6 using a reference at the center of
mass of the armature hut not fixed to the annature.

18.27. In Problem 18.10, find the miiment about the C.M. of the
disc using a reference x y i fixed to the rod A B and not to the disc.
Take I%, = 10 radlsecl and h2 = 30 radliec2.

18.28. Work Problem 18.11 using refercnce .ryi tixed to the *hip
with the origin at the center of mass nf the turbine. Do not use
Euler's equations.

18.29. Solve Problem 18.13 using il set of axes xyr at the center
of mass of the disc hut fixed to arm AB.

18.30. Work Problem 18.11 by using a reference xyz fixed


to the arm at the center of mass of the disc for the case where
h, = 2 radlsec2, h2 = 3 rad/secz, and 6, = 4 rad/sec2 in direc-
Figure P.18.23. tions shown.

929
18.4 Necessary and Sufficient
Conditions for Equilibrium
of a Rigid Body
In this chapter. we ha\,c emplvyed Newton's law :it the mass center as well iis
the equation M , = H,.+ and Sroin i t we dcrived Euler's equations for rigid
bodies. We can now go hack to our worh in Chapter 5 and put on firm ground
the lnct that M = 0 and 1: = 0 are necessary conditions for cquilihriuiri 111 a
rigid hody. ( Y o u will recall we accepted lliese equations for statics ar tliiil
timc hy intuitioii, pending a prvof to cvtne 1:ttcr.j
A particle is in cquilihrium. you will reciill. i l i t i s stationary or moviiig
with constant speed along a straight line in inertial spiicc. To he in a state of
cquilihrium. cvcry point i n ii rigid body must acciirdingly he stationary o r he
moving at uniform speed along straight lines in iiiertial space. The rigidity
requirement thus limits a rigid hody in equilibrium to trilnsliitional motion
along a stmight line at constant speed i n inertial space. I h i h ineans that C; = 0
and w = 0 for equilihrium and so, from New/oi~'slmn and Eirler's cqiiutioii\.
' X we see that b' = bf, = 0 are w c ' (7ry conditions for equilihrium.
For il .sufficicwq proof. we go the other way. For a hody initially in
Figure 18.1 I. Body with il fixed point.
equilihriuni. the condition I: = M,A = Os ensures that equilihrium asill hc
maintained. More specifically. we shall stail %ith a hody in equilibrium at
tiinc t and apply ii forcc system ratisfying the preceding cvnditiiins. Wc
address ourselves to the qucstion: Does the body stay in a stilte o f equilih-
riuin? According t v Newton's luw there will he no change in lhe vclocity i i S
the m a s s center since F = 0. And. with w = 0 at timc t. /+h,-',s ~ q i i ~ f i o m
lead 10 the result for M,. = 0, thnl h, = h, = io. = 0. Thus, the angular
velocity must remitin zeni. With the vclocity V I the ccnter of niass constiltit.
and with & = 0 in incrtial space wc know that the hody remains in equilih-
. condition F = 0 and
riuin. 'Thus, i f a hody i' iiiirially in ~ ~ y u i l i h r i u mthe
M,,= 0 i s .si!#ic.imt for maintaining equilihrium.

18.5 Three-Dimensional Motion About


a Fixed Point Euler Angles
We slxill 1i11w exaiiiirie the motion o f sclected rigid hodie, constrained tv
havc a p i n 1 fixed in :in inertial reference (Izie. I X . I I). This tvpic will Iciid to
study (11 an important dcvice-the gyroscopc.
We invw chow that angles VI'i-otation Q t , 6>, and H ~ along
, iirlliogonal
axes 1.y. and :are nor highly suitable for measuring the o;ientation of a hiidy
with a fixed point. Thus. ill Fig. IX.IZ(a)consider it cvniciil surIace:tnd ohserre
straight line OA which i s on this surface and in tllz .tz planc. Kotatc thc c m c

'Wc linw shown 111 svillics t l h i f i t F = U and M , = 0 ;ahout \ i m c point A (11 i n r i i i a space.
ilicii .M = 0 ahnui an) point ii, iiicrtiiil ~ ~ p c e .
SICTION 18.5 THREE-DIMENSIONAL MOTION ABOUT A FIXED POINT; EULER ANGLES 93 1
an angle (A@., thus causing OA to move to OA' shown as dashed. In Fig.
I8.12(b), view line OA along a line of sight corresponding to the x axis. As a
result of the rotation iA6')7 about the I axis. there will clearly he a rotation
of this line ahout the x axis. Thus, we see that and are mutually
dependent and thus not suitable for our use. This result stems from the fact
that we are using directions that have a fixed mutual relative orientation. We
now introduce a set of rotations that are independent. And, not unexpectedly,
the axes for these rotations will not have a fixed relative orientation.
i z

Figure 18.13. Rigid body

Accordingly, consider the rigid body shown in Fig. 18.13. We shall


specify a sequence iif three independent rotations in the following manner:
I . Keep a reference xyr fixed in the body, and rotate the body about the Z
axis through an angle yrshown in Fig. 18.14.
r Z

I
vv

Figure 18.14. First rotation is about Z.

2. Now rotate the body about the x axis through an angle B to reach the con-
figuration in Fig. 18.15. Note that the i , Z , and y axes form a plane 1 nor-
mal to the X Y plane and normal also to the x axis. The axis of rotation for
this rotation (x axis) is called the line <$nudes.
SECTION 18.5 THREE-DIMENSIONAL MOTION ABOUT A FIXED POINT EULER ANGLES 933

We call these angles the Eider an,+, and we assign the following names.
w = angle of precession
0 = angle of nutation
q3 = angle of spin
Furthermore. the z axis is usually called the body axis, and the Z axis is often
called the axis of precession. The line of nodes then is normal to the body
axis and the precession axis.

Figure 18.17. Axes x y i are fixed to body.

We have shown that the position of a body moving with one point fixed
can be established by three independent rotntions given in a certain sequence.
For an infinitesimal change in position, this situation would be a rotation d y
about the Z axis, dB about the line of nodes, and d@about the body axis z.
Because these rotations are infinitesimal, they can be construed as vectors,
and the order mentioned above is no longer required. The limiting ratios of
these changes in angles with respect to time give rise to three angular veloc-
ity vectors (Fig. 18.18). which we express in the following manner:
Z

\ I

X
Line 0 1 nodes
Figure 18.18. Precession. nutation, and w i n velocity vectors
934 ('HAl'I'kK IX 1iYNAMIC.S 0 1 . GFNLRAI. KIG1l)~tlOlIYM 0 1 1 0 h

z
(Fixed)
teJ ;ilong the Z :mi\
6. dirccled along the line of nodcs
4. dirccted aliing the :htdy i i x i i

Note that tlie iiutatioii vclocit) vcctor H i s al\vays inorinill to planc I. and
consequenlly the nutatioii velocity \ector is alw;iys normal 111 the spin veloc-
ity ycctor 6and the preccssion \,eliicily vector 4.
H o w v c r , the spill v e l ~ ~ c i l q
vector 4
w i l l generally ti01 be ill right m g l c s with the precession velocity 4.
and s o this s y \ t e m of iinguI;ir vclocity \'ectors generally i\ i i ~ iflii orttrogoiial
L.inc ~ ~ I i i o t l e s systcm.
Finally. it should lx clciir that llic I-efcrcncc ~ 1 ~Iiio\ci(
: with the body
during precession iuid niitatiim inotion 0 1 the hody. hut \re can choorc that i l

would have, for (he iilorchtatcd condition. iiii anguliir velocity. denoted iix 0.
etluiil IO 4+ 8. The vclocity of the disc rclative IO .ix is. ;rccordingly, 9 k .
Considcr a hody u ilh I W O orthogorial planes of syiiimctry forming :in
axis in the hody. 'The body is moving ahout ii lixed point A 1111 the body ;mi\
(Fig. 18.19~.Hiiw. d c r u c decide wh;it ~ X C Sto usc t o describe the riiiition i n
tesiiis OS spin. precession, iind nut;itioii? Fisst. w e take the axis of lhe hody to
he the :axis: thc a n g u l x speed ahwt this iixis i s then the spin 4.
This \tcp i\
straightliorwnnl for the hiidies that ut! shall consider-. Thc next step is iiol. 131
inspection find ii Z a x i s i n alirrvl diw,.fioti xi i ~ sto form with the aforeinen-
tioried hody m i s ::I planc I whose :ingiil;ir speed ahout the Z axi\ i\ cither
known o r i s sought. Such ;in axis Z i s tllcii the /inw.~s;oii iixis ;ihout u h i c h
we have for thc hody axis :ii precession speed li. 'The i i w r ; / i i o i l ~ . s i s then
(lie axis which at all limes rciiiiiiiis iiiirmil to planc I conl;lining the hody iixi,
:and the precescim a x i \ Z. 'Ihc iiulatiwi speed 0 f i r i d l y ic rhc ;ingttlar speed
ciirnponent of Ihe body axis :;iboul the line of nodes.

18.6 Equations of Motion


Using Euler Angles
Consider next ii hody ha\iiig ii shapc such that. a1 an) point along thr body
:.
i i x k thc iiioiiicnl\ o f inertiii liir a11 axex n(irniiil to the hody i i x i s at this puiirt
have tlie suiic value 1'. Such would. ol~coursc..he triic for thc special c a i e 01
a hody of revolution having lhe :.axis as thc axi\ of hyintiictry." We shall cow
sider the iiiolioii 01 w c h ii body ;ihout :I fixed point 0. which i s smiewhcre
iilong the a x i s :(see Fig. 18.20). A x e s .ry: :ire principal axes. This set i i f a x c s
has the siiiiie nutation ;and prcccssiiin inotioii a b tlie hody hut uill he chosen
SECTION 18.6 EQUATIONS OF MOTION USING EULER ANGLES 935

6
such that the body rotates with angular speed relative to it. Since the refer-
ence is not fixed to the body, we cannot use Euler’s equations hut must go
hack to the equation Mu = Ho, which when carried out in terms of compo-
nents parallel to the xyz reference becomes

Mu = (3)
+
x,i
11 x ( H j + H , j + Hzk) (18.21)

Figure 15.20. Body moving about fined point 0.

Since the xvz axes remain at all times principal axes, we have
H, = Tuz, H, = I‘my, H, = loz (18.22)

where I is the moment of inertia about the axis of symmetry and I’ is the
moment of inertia about an axis normal to the z axis at 0.Considering Fig.
18.20, we can see by inspection that the angular velocity of the body relative
to XYZ is at all times given by components parallel to xyz as follows:
mr =e (1 8.23a)
o ,= *sin0 ( I 8.23h)
o,= Q + * c o s 0 (1 8 . 2 3 ~ )
Hence, the components of the angular momentum at all times are:
( H I ) = 1’8
( H v )= I‘*sinO (18.24)
(Y)= I ( 4 + I)cosO)
We then have for Ho:
Ifo = I ’ ~ i + I ’ ~ s i n O j + I ( B ) + ~ c o s 0 ) k
Remembering that i, j and k are constants as seen from xyz, we can say:
= 1'8; + 1'1vcin H + Wi/eciisO).j + /!$ + v c o s 0 - sin O)h

As for the angular velocity (~Freferencc~r?z.wt! liilve (in considering Eq. 18.24
4
with deleted becauw ~ry; i! lint tined to the body ;I\ far as \pin i s concerricd:

12 = Hi + y s i n e j + y?crisHk (IX.26)

Consequently. we h u e

$1 x i = -@ sin Ok + @cosO j
fL xj=dk-@ccosHi (IX.27)
x k = -6.j + @ sin H i

Substituting the results from Eqs. 18.25, 18.24, and IX.27 into Eq. 18.21. we
get

M ) i + Myj + M.k = I'8i + I ' ( $ i s i r i O + $v6c(i\H)j


+ I ( $ + cos I@ (in Hjk
-

+1'8(-@siiiBk + vic(is#Hj) ( IX.2X)


+ I' 1#7 \in H ( 6 k vi eo\ Hi)
-

+ + @ c o s ~ ) ( - H . j+ @sin6';)
The corresponding scalai- equations w e :

Mx = 1'8 + ( I - l')(p2sinBcos8) + 1&sin0 (18.2i)a)

M v I ' Q S ~ S I S+ 21'& COS@ - I(4 + COS 6)d ( 18.2Yh)

M, = I ( ~ + $ i c o s 0 - 1 @ s i n @ ) (18.291.)

Thc loregoing equalions arc valid at :ill liriies for llir iiiotion (11ii homopc-
iicous body having I\! = lv>= I' moving about a fixed point oil the a x i s OF
the body. Clzarly. thew equations are also applicable for inotioii about tlic
center (if niass for such bodies. Note lhat the cquatioiis iiie iiiinlinear and.
cxcept f o i ~certain \pecial CLISCS. are vcry difficult to integrate. They are. 01
course. vcry uselul as thcy m n d when c(irnputcr methods are to be cinploycd.
As a special C B ~ C , we shall now consider ii motion involving a constiiiit
iiuLalion angle H. a constant spin spccd 4,
and a consvant preccsion spccd @.
Such a motion i s tcrined .srcwl? prrw,ssioii. To detcrniine thc torque M lor a
given steady precession. we set 4. 6, ; i;mi v e i l u ; ~lo~ ~ r (iiii E ~ S .I ~ . X .
Accordingly. we gel the f(illowing rcsiilt:

M, = + @ c o s 8 ) - ~ ' ( i , c o . 81
; sin # (18.30a)
M , = 1) !I8.3llh)
M. = 0 ( I8.30c)
SECTION 18.6 EQUATIONS OF MOTION USING EULER ANGLES 937

We see that for such a motion, we require a constant torque about the line uf
4
node.s as given by Eq. 18.30a. Noting that + @cos 0 = w, from Eq. 18.23c,
this torque may also be given as
M x = (Io. ~ I'@cosB)(i,sinO (18.31)

Examining Fig. 18.20, we can conclude that for the body to maintain a con-
stant spin speed $ about its body axis (Le., relative to xyz) while the body axis
(and also x y i ) is rotating at constant speed $about the Z axis at a fixed angle
0, we require a constant torque M Lhaving a value dependent on the motion of
the body as well as the values of the moments of inertia of the body, and hav-
ing a direction alwuys nurmul tu the body andprecession axe,s (i.e., normal to
plane I). Intuitively you may feel that such a torque should cause a rotation
about its own axis (the torque axis) and should thereby change 0. Instead, the
torque causes a rotation @of the body axis about an axis normal to the torque
axis. As an example, consider the special case where 0 has been chosen as
90" for motion of a disc about its center of mass (see Fig. 18.21). In accordance
with Eq. 18.3 I , we have as a required torque for a steady precession the result
M.r = I w l @ = (18.32)
Here for a given spin, the proper torque M, about the line of nodes maintains
a steady rotation @ o f the spin axis z about an axis (the Z axis), which is at
right angles both to the torque and the spin axes and given by Eq. 18.32.
Because of this unexpected phenomenon, toy manufacturers have developed
various gyroscopic devices to surprise and delight children (as well as their
parents). Here is yet another case where relying solely on intuition may lead
to highly erroneous conclusions.
Z

Figure 18.21. Steady precession: E = 90"

We should strongly point out that steady precessions are not easily ini-
tiated. We must have, at the start, simultaneously the proper precession and
spin speeds as well as the proper 0 for the given applied torque. If these con-
ditions are not properly met initially, a complicated motion ensues.
938 CHAPTEK I X DYNAMICS O F GENERAL RIGID-ROLIY MOTION

Example 18.3
A .sbiRlr-~~,r.Rrr[,.-n/~/r~,[,d[ji~ ,yyro i s shown in Fig. 18.22. l h r spin a x i s 111
dihc E i s held by a gimbal A which can rotate about hcaringc C' and D.
Thcse hearings are supported hy the gyro case, which in turn i s gcncrnlly
clamped ti1 the vehicle Lo he guided. If the gyro case riitalcb ahout a verti-
cal axis (i.e.. i i ~ r i n aLlo its hasc) while the rotor i s spinning, the gimbal A
w i l l tend to rotate ah(iuc CII i n an attempt to align with the vertical. When
gimhal A i s resisted Irom rotation ahout CD by a set o l torsional springs S
with a combincd torsional spring constilnt given as K,. the gyro i s called ii
mi? g y r o If the rotation of the gyro casc is consrant (at speed OJJ. the
gimhal A assumes a fixcd orientation relative 10the vertical a s il result of
the restraining springs and a damper (not sh(iwn). Ahout [he hody axis :
there i?a constant angular rotation (11 the r ~ t 01 ~ rcuI rad/sec maintained
by ti miit01 (not shown). This angular rotation i s clearly i$the spin speed 4.
N e x l . note in Fig. 18.23 t h a the :axis and lhe fixcd vertical a x i s I ronn a
plane (plane I ) which has ii known angular .;peed 0,about this lixcd verti-
cal axis. Clearly, this fixcd vertical axis w i l l he our precession axis, and
the precession speed (irequals (0,.The line of nodes has also hcrn shown;
it must at all times be normal to plane I and is thus collinear with axis C-/l
of gimbal A . With 8 fixed, wc have a case 01 steady prcccssiiin.

Fired i.eilicaI axib

Figure 18.22. S i n ~ r l e ~ d c t . r t . 2 - o i f ~gyro.


~~,~,n

Givcn the following data:


/ = 3 x 10 4 slug-ft2
I' = 1.5 x 10 " slug-ft'
0= 20.000 rad/hec
K, = 4.95 ft-lh/rad
1'/ = I rad/sec
what i s B for lhe condition 01slcady precesslon'! The torsinnal springs are
unstretched when 8 = YO".
Wc have for Eq. 18.30;i:
---____-XI_-- . . ~~ ... .. ~~ " .. ."
~
I_
SECTION 18.6 EQUATIONS OF MOTION USING EULER ANGLES 939

Example 18.3 (Continued)

iwt = ~ , ( ~ - ~ ) = [ ~ ( d , + l i r c o s ~ ) - ~ . l i r c o s ~ ~ l i . s (a)
in~

Line of nodes

Figure 18.23. Gyro showing line of nodes and precession axis.


Putting in numerical values, we have

= [3x IO"(~XIO' +(I)COSO)-(I.SX 10-4)(1)cos~]sin~


Therefore,
4 . 9 5 x 1 0 4 ( ~ - Q ) = ( 6 x 1 0 4+l.ScosQ)sinQ

We can neglect the term (1.5 cos Q ) , and so we have


4.95($-@)=6sinQ

Therefore,
/7
- Q = 1.212sinQ (b)
2
~

Solving by trial and error or by computer, we get

6 = 43" (c)

The way the rate gyro is used in practice is to maintain Q close to 90"
by a small motor. The torque M I developed to maintain this angle is mea-
sured, and from Eq. 18.30a we have available the proper @, which tells us of
the rate of rotation of the gyro case and hence the rate of rotation of the vehi-
cle about an axis normal to the gyro case. Now @need not he constant as was
the case i n this problem. If it does not change very rapidly, the results from
Eq. 18.3Oa can be taken as instantaneously valid even though the equation,
strictly speaking, stems from steady precession where @ should be constant.
___
Figure 1X.24. Two dcgrcc +freed,w gyro

A f ~ ~ ~ f , ~ ~ , 4 V ,/
? l S~
u J / W~ dwwn
is ~ ~ i~ ~ 18.24.
n Fig. - i ! Thc
~ ~ rotor~ I- ~ ~ , ~ ~ ~ / f , , ~ i
rotates in gimbal A. which in turn rotates i n giinhal ('. Note that the :ixes
h-h of the rotor and ( P I , of thc gitnhd C a r e always at right angles to cach
other. Ginihal C is held hy hcarings c siipliortcd hy (he fry" cast. Axes
c ~ iarid
' u u m u s t ~ilwayshe a l right ~inglesto eiicli nther. 21.: ciin easily he
seen from the diagram This hind of suspension 01 the rotor is called a
Crinluri .srr.rppn.sion. If the hearings at 11, h. and ( ' are frictionless, a torque
cannot he transmitted troni the gyro case thc rnlol-7 The rotor i s said t o
he rnryirr:fiw S i x this case.
IF the rotor is given ii rapid spin \.elucily i n a g i w i directim in i n e l -
tial space (such as toward the North Star). then ini- tlie ide;il casc 0 1 fric-
tionless hearings the rotor will maintain this dircction e w r i though the
gyro case i s given rapid a n d complicated motions in inertiiil ~ p a c c .Thi\
constancy (if direction results since 110 tnrque cat1 he transmitted to the
rotor fo alter the direction o f its angular moiiicntitm. Thus. the two-dimen-
sinnal gyrc gives a fixed direction i n ineniiil spicc f o r piirpo.;ec nt giiid-
nnce of a vehiclc mch as a niissile. I n we. the gyri' i'asc i ripdly S i x 4 to
the framc of the tnissile, and iiieasurernents n i the orientation of tlic mis-
sile are accomplished by having pickoffs mounted hetween the gyro case
and the outer gimbal and hetween the niitcr and inner gimhals.
Thc presence of soiiic friction i n tlie gyro bcnriiigs is. id cniirsc. iii-
evitahlc. The corinteractinn 0 1 this friction when possible and, when not.
the accounting for its action is ni much concern to the gyro engineer. Sup-
p m e that the gyro has hcen given a inotinii such that t l ~ espin axis h-h (see
Fig, 18.25) has an angular speed (o i i h ~ i iiixis t (-c nf . 1 revlsec while Inlaill-
taining a fixed orientation o f X 5 ' with axis < ' ~('. Thc gym case is ?t;itionnry.
SECTION 18.6 EQUATIONS OFMOTION USING EULER ANGLES 941

Example 18.4 (Continued)


4
and the spin speed of the disc relative to gimbal A is 10.000 rpm. What
frictional torque must he developed on the rotor for this motion? From
what hearings must such a torque arise? The radius of gyration for the disc
is 5 0 mm for the axis of symmetry and 38 mm for the transverse axes at
the center of mass. The weight of the disc is 4.5 N .

Figure 18.25. Two-degree-of-freedom gyro


with body axis i.

Note in Fig. 18.26 that the spin axis z and fixed axis c-c form a
plane that has a known angular speed w , about axis c-c. Clearly, c-c then
can he taken as the precession axis Z ; the precession speed @ = w, is
then . I O rev/sec. The line of nodes x is along axis u-a at all times. With
# = 85" at all times, we have steady precession. A constant torque Mx is
required to maintain this motion. We can solve for M ~as , follows (see
Eq. 18.30(a)):

M~ = [ 1(4+ p cos e) - cos o]psin 0

_ _9.81
_ (.038)2(.1)(2rr)cos85"
4.5

Figure 18.26. Axis c-c is precession axiy.

M, = .752N-m

Thus, hearings along the ri-u axis interconnecting the two gimbals are
developins the frictional torque.
Figure P.18.34.

/ / ,
X'
Figure P.18.32.

x /
Iciguw P.IX.36
18.37. t h e centerline of the rod rotates uniformly in a horizontal
plane with a constant torque of 2.29 N-m applied about 0. Each
cylinder beighs 225 N and has a radius of 300 mm. The discs
rotate on a bar AB with a speed w , of 5,000 rpm. Bar AB is held at
0 by a b$l-joint connection. The applied torque is always perpen-
dicular t r j AB and can only rotate about the vertical axis. What is
the precession speed of the system'?

, -ik77.5mm kII,~4

Figure P.18.40.

Figure P.18.37. 18.41. A uniform prism has a square cross section. Prove that
I,,, for any angle B equals Lx = 1 ) ) .Thus, in order to use I' = lxx
18.38. @) In Problem 18.37, consider the disc at B to have = l v %a?, was dune in the development in Section 18.6, the body
an angular speed of 5,000 rpm and the disc at A to have a speed need not he a body of revolution. Show in general that if lrr = I v y ,
of 2,500 bm. What is the precession speed for the condition of and if XJZ are principal axes, then I,,,, = t, = lv3,.
steady prbcession?
/b) If the disc at A and the disc at B have angular speeds
of 5,000 Ppm in opposite directions, what is the initial motion of
the systeph when a torque perpendicular to B is suddenly applied'?

18.39. Two discs A and E roll without slipping at their mid-


planes. Ihght shafts cd and ef connect the discs to a centerpost
which rojates at an angular speed a,of rad/sec.
' If each disc
weighs 2(, Ib, what total force downward is developed by the discs
on the gr/,und support?
Figure p.18.41.
18.42. A block weighing SON and having a square cross section is
spinning about its body axis at a rate 0, of I(X1 rdlsec. For an angle
I'
a = 30". what is the precession speed @ of the axis of the block?
Neglect the weight of rod AB. See Problem 18.41 before prmeeding.
I
Figure P.18.39.
Ball
4
18.40. A disc is spinning about its centerline with speed while
the ccnterline is precessing uniformly at fixed angle B about the
vertical axis. The mass of the disc is M. Consider the evaluation
of @, and show that such a state of regular precession is possible if

Also shqw that there are, for every 0, two possible precession
d~
speeds. particular, show that as 01: gets very large, the follow-
ing precdssional speeds are possible:

[Hint: Cpnsider Eq. 18.3I for first part of proof. Then use a power
expansidn of the root when evaluating @.I Figure P.18.42.

943
Vigore P.18.46

Figlire P.18.44.

1. h h H/
SECTION 18.7 TORQUWREE MO T IO N 945

18.7 ~ Torque-Free Motion


We shalu now consider possible torqur:free motion for a body having l x t=
I v y = I’ for axes normal to the body axis. An example of a device that can
approach such motion is the two-degree-of-freedom gyroscope described in
example^ 18.4.
Let us now examine the equations of torque-free motion. First, consider
the genetal relation
M, = H, (18.33)
Since M.,is zero, H, must he constant. Thus.
~

H, = H,, ( I 8.34)
where H,i is the initial angular momentum about the mass center. We shall first
assume +d later justify in this section that a11 torque-free motions will be
steady p+cessions about an axis going through the center of mass and directed
parallel 40 the vector Hll.Accordingly, we choose Z to pass through the center
of mass 4nd to have a direction corresponding to that of H,,.as shown in Fig.
18.27. The axis x‘ normal to axes I and Z forming plane I is then the line of
nodes anB y’ is in plane 1. The reference xyz is fixed to the body and hence
spins abdut the z axis. Axes xy then rotate in the xi.’ plane as shown in the dia-
gram. Uding Fig. 18.27, we can then express Huin terms of its x, y , and z com-
ponents Yaving unit vectors i,j , and k in the following way at all times:
Hi, = HI,sin 0 sin $i + HI,sin Q cos # j + till cos Bk ( I 8.35)
7

Figure 18.27. Two~de~ree~af-freedom gyrvscope illustrating


torque-free motion. Outer gimbal support is not shown.
946 CHAPTER I X LIYNAMK'S OF G E N I K A I . RI(;II>~HOl)Y MOTION

Since ,YK are principal axes. we can a l s o stale:


II,, = I'iqi +I'qi t lok (IX.3hl

Comparing Eqs. IK.35 and 18.36. we tlicn ha^

From Eq. IX.3Xc. it is then clear that

Thus. since H<)end I are constant. we can ciinclude from this equation that rlrr
,~uiaiioriuriglc, is a fixed anglc Now consider Eq. IX.3Xh. using the fict
that H = Canceling H,, and c;irrying oul tlic differcntiation. we gel

-(sin #,, )(sin @)(d)+ I' 1'1


~ ) e,, cos H,, sin @ =
H ~sin o
Therefiirc.

6= ",;~! HI,cos H,, (IX.40)

Thus. the , s l i i i i , s p t d , 9. is coiisLiiiII.


To get the precchsion \peed Vf, note from Fig. 18.27 that
w = lj t $ H,,
coc i

NOWequatc thc right si& o t this equation with Ihc risht side 01 Kq. 18.37~:
SECTION 18.7 TORQUE-FREE MOTION 941

Suhwtuting for 4from Eq 18 40 and zolvlng for I+?, we get

Collectidg terms, we have


I H
~ (IX.42)

The resdlts of the discussion for torque-free motion of the body of revolution
can then!be given as

0 = 60 (18.43a) ..
q = -Ho (18.43b) Figure 18.28. Body of revolution is also
I' symmetric about C.M. where it is supported
~ = ~ H 0 c 0 s 6 0 (18.43c)

v3
SiOce 6, 8, and $are all zero, Eqs. 1X.43 depict a case of steady pre-
cession, land so the assumption made earlier to this effect is completely con-
sistent 4 t h the results emerging from Euler's equation. Thus, we can consider
the assuqption and the ensuing conclusions as correct.
Hdnce, if a body of revolution is torque-free-as, for example, in the
case illugtrated in Fig. 18.28, where the center of mass is fixed and where the
body hab initially any angular momentum vector Hu, then at all times the
angular momentum H is constant and equals Hw Furthermore, the body will
have a rigular precession that consists of a constant angular velocity @of the
centerlinje ahout a Z axis collinear with Ho at a fixed inclination e,, from Z.
4
Finally, there is a constant spin speed about the centerline. Thus, two angu-
lar velodity vectors 4 6, and are present, and the hiful angular velocity w is
at an inblination of E from the Z axis (see Fig. 18.29) and precesses with

.I
angular 'peed @about the Z axis. This must he true, since the direction of one
compo? nt of w, namely 6, precesses in this manner while the other compo-
nent, JI,iis fixed in the Z direction. The vector w then can be considered to
continuqkly sweep out a cone, as illustrated in Fig. 18.29.
7

I.

Figure 18.29. Vector o sweeps


out a conical surface.
We now~illustratethe use of the basic formulations for torque-free motion
Figure 18.30. Space capsule.

i
SECTION 18.7 TORQUE-FREE MOTION 949
Exa+ple 18.5 (Continued)
Therefore,
< = 6.44k + ,3381 ft (a)
To get Hr. we next set up a second reference x’y’z‘ at the center of
mass as shown in Fig. 18.31. In accordance with Eq. 18.2, we have for&,
on noiing that the only nonzero component of w is in the z’ direction:

H , = - l x , p i - lt+oj +I Z p k (b)

To compute /:,:, we proceed as follows, using the decomposed capsule


parts of Fig. 18.32 and employing transfer theorems for moments of inertia:

1 -
(I?,?,
I -
-
i (:‘”)(
- 2.5’ + - 338) 2 = 272 slug-ft2

p ) ( 2 5 ~ ) +I so
(17.f)2 = ~I ( IS0 - ( 338)2 = 7.81
6
(2 5)’ - Is’[( 424)(2 5)12}
R
+-[338+(424)(25)]’
I50 = 1843
R
= 104.0

( / < f ) 5 = - -900
(2S) 2 +-(338)’=1779
900
R 6
(/..‘z’ ’ )6 -
--2I [ -g (2.5)2
300 1 + -(.338)
300
R
2 = 30.2

Accordingly, we have for I.,..: L.

/.‘,.,_ = c(Ir.)r
6

,=I
= 610 slug-ft2 (C)

We proceed in a similar manner to compute I , , . . We will illustrate


this cdmputation for portion I of the system and then give the total result.
Thus, employing the parallel axis theorem, we have

= 0 + (4)(: - -6.44 -
x7;
~~ - - ,338
) = -383 slug-ft2
It is important to remember that the transfer distances (with proper signs)
used @r computing (I7>,), using the parallel-axis theorem are measured
from ,$’yt’, about which you are making the calculution, to the center of
mass &f body I . For the entire system we have, by similar calculations:

/z,z, = -329 slug-ft2


i
SECTION 18.7 TORQUII~FRREF.MOTION 95 1

Let us now examine Eqs. 18.43 for the special case where I = 1'. Here
leaving only one angular motion, 4,
the pre-
about the Z axis so the direction of angular
velocity of the body corresponds to Ho.Since this could he a body of revo-
lution, tde moment-of-inertia condition for this case ( I = 1') means that the
moment4 of inenia for principal axes x, y , and z are mutually equal, and we
can veri$ from Eq. 9. I3 that all axes inclined to the q z reference have the
same mdment of inertia I (and all therefore are principal axes at the point).
Thus, thd body, if homogeneous, could be a sphere, a cube, any regular poly-
hedron, qr any body that possesses point symmetry N o matter how we launch
this hodj, the angular momentum H will be equal to Iw and will thus al>uays
coincide lwith the direction of angular velocity w. This situation cm also be
shown adalytically as follows:
!

H = Hxi + H J + Hzk (18.44)

For prindipal axes, we have

H = wxlni + wvl,,,j + wzlzzk ( I 8.45)

If lxx= kv,, = = I , we have for the foregoing

H = I(wxi+ w v j + w 7 k )= Iw (18.46)

indicatink that H and w must be collinear. The situation just described repre-
sents theicase of a thrown baseball or basketball.
Th&re are two situations for the case I,,, = ly~y,
in which H and w are
4
col1inear.i Examining Eq. 18.43, we thus see that if 8, IS 90", then = 0 = 0,
leaving oplly precession @along the Z axis (see Fig. 18.27). The Z axis for the
analysis {orresponds to the direction of H. We thus see that since w = 4
then w i$ collinear with H . This case corresponds to a proper "drop kick" or
"place kick" of a football [Fig. 18.34(a)1 wherein the body axis i is at right
angles to~theZ axis.
Th&other case consists of 8, = 0. This means that 4 and 4have the
same direction-that is, along the Z direction (see Fig. 18.27) which then
means thjt w and H again are collinear. This case corresponds to a good foot-
ball pass /[Fig. l8.34(b)]. For all other motions of bodies where l _ = I v y , the
angular +docity vector w will nor have the direction of ungular momentum Ho
UpQn further consideration, we can make a simple model of torque-
free motibn. Stan with the fixed cone described earlier (see Fig. 18.29) about
the Zaxia, where the cone surface is that swept out by the total angular veloc-
ity vecto{ w of the torque-free body. Now consider a second cone about the
spin axis~zof the torque-free body (see Fig. 18.35) in direct contact with the
initial stakionary cone. Rotate the second cone about its axis with a speed and
sense co&esponding to d, of the torque-free body and impose a no-slipping
conditioii hclwcen the COIIC\. ('learly. llic sccond c(mc w i l l precess ahout the
Z i i x i h at soiiie spccd $if. Also. the kital angulai- d o c i t y w' OS the inovinf
cone will lic along the line of coiitact hctwecii coiies and i s tliiis colliiieiir with
w. Wc s h a l l iiow s h u tliiit tlic spccil 4' of tlic coiie model equ;ils 4
of the
kirilue-frec hody a i i d . as a coiiscqiieiice. that w' lor the iiioving cone equals w
01 thc lorque-liec hody. W r k n o u iiow that:

1. d, i s the m i i e for hoth llie i l e i i c c ;ind tlic physical ciisc.


2. The direction of rcsiilliiiit ;ingular vcliicicy i', the sanic for hoth caws.
3. Thc direction OS Ihc precession velocity m i l s t hc the same for hoth case\
(i.e.. thc Zdircctioii).

'This situation i i ihown i n Fig. 18.36. Note that 4 i s ltie siiiiie iii hoth (he
physicill case and llic nicclianiciil modcl and that the dircctions o f w and w'iib
R<)Iling-cmr ~niodcl. well as 4 and &' i i i rcspcctivcly.
~ the siliiic for hoth diagrams. Accordinsly,
whcn we coiisidcr the coiistructioii 01. the pcirallclofr;im o f \cctors. u e see
tors w and w' iis WCII iis 4 and Ib' m u s t necessarily bc cqiiaI for
hiith the physical c i i x iiiid !he iiiodcl. rerpecti\ely.
SECTION 18.7 TORQUE-FREE MOTION 953

Physical case Mechanical rnodd


Figure 18.36. Angular vector diagram\.

Wd shall now investigate more carefully the relation between the sense
of rotatiQn for corresponding angular velocities between the model and thc
physical base for certain classes of geometries of the physical body.
1. I' > b. From Eq. I X.43c, we see that when e,, is less than rr12 rad, is pos- 4
itive #or this case."' Thus, the spin must be counterclockwise as we look
alongithe z axis toward the origin. From Eq. 18.43b. we see that *is pos-
itive kind thus counterclockwise as we look toward the origin along Z .
Clear!y, from these stipulations, the rolling-cone model shown in Fig.
18.35:has the proper motion for this case. The motion is lermed r e p l a r
prece)sion.
4
2. I' < 1. Here, the spin will be negative for a nutation angle less than 90"
as stidulated by Eq. 1 8 . 4 3 ~However,
. the precession *must still be posi-
tive i accordance with Eq. 18.43b. The rolling-cone model thus far pre-
1
sente clearly cannot give these proper senses, but if the moving cone is
inside( the stationary cone (Fig. 18.37), we have motion that is consistent
e relations in Eq. 18.43.Such motion is called retroxrude precession.

Figure 18.37. Retrograde


precession.

"'Rekall from Eq. 18.35 that H,,i s just a magnitude. Also. nut? thilt thih CBSC corrc\pond\
to what hilJ hccn shuwn in Fig. I8.29-ramcly. the cilae we have j m t dihcusscd.
'lhc space capsule of Ex;implc 18.5 i s \howti agaiii i n Fig. 18.18 rotating
about i t s axis 01 symmeti-y I i n i n c r t i i space with an ;ingular hpced u.of
2 rad/,ec. As a rcsult of an impact with a meteorite. the capsule i s given an
impulse Io120 Ih-sec at po\ilion A 11s shown i n Ihc diafraiii. Ascertain the
postimpact motion.
The impact w i l l gibe the cylinder- a n angular impulsc:

= ( 2 0 ) 1 7 . i ) j = l i o j slug-ft'isec (a)
Figure 18.38. S p x c cupsulc with
From Ihc angular impulse-momentum cquation we c:in say for the impact: llllplllSZ.

= If, ~ Ha

Therelore,
I S O j = H,. '- I .L .w,k

Thc postimpact angular rrionieiituiii i s Ihcn


H, = I S O j +I (0 k

= ISOj + RISk clug-lt?/sec


Since the ensuing motiw i s forqur:frt,r, we laave thus established the
direction 01 the precession axis (n.
This axis has hccri shown i n Fig. 18.39
coinciding with H 2 i n Ihe yr plane. Furtherinure. we can give H , p o d n i -
pact as follows renienibcring that ,YJ: arc principal axes:?
H, = lS0.j + XISk = W ~ +
I ~, ~~ ~+
l w,.~ ..
l~L k j (C)

Hence. from Ey. ( c ) wc have at postimpnct:

Figure 18.3Y. Conc m d e l : Z i s i n


\: plar1c.

where f(ir I % %we u\ed the value [if 1,; 21s cciinputed i n Eq. ( c )01 Example
~~

1 8 . 5 Hence,

w = ,0652.1' + 2krad/sec (dl


!
SECTION 18.7 TORQUE-FREE MOTION 955

Exa+ple 18.6 (Continued)


'we can now make good use of the cone model representing the
motiop. Accordingly, in Fig. 18.39 corresponding to postimpact we have
showd two cones, one about the body axis z (this is the moving cone) and
one about the Z axis (this is the stationary cone). The line of contact be-
tweed the cones coincides with the total angular velocity vector w. The
capsu/e must subsequently have the same motion as the moving cone as it
rolls ith an angular speed I$ = 2 rad/sec about its own axis without slip-
+'
ping q n the stationary cone having Z as an axis. We can easily compute the
angle$ 0 and E using Eqs. (b) and (d). Thus:

Therefore,
0 = 1043"

Therefore,
E = 8.56"
in
Fig. 18.40 we have shown w, I$, and 9 in the y7 plane correspond-
4,
ing tolpostimpact. Knowing w, E, and 0, we can easily compute @. Thus,
usingithe law of sines, we get
P = w
sin(0 ~ E) sin(n - 0)
X

Figure 18.40. Angular-velocity diagram


Therqfore,

'Thus, we can say that the body continues to spin at 2 radlsec about
its axis, but now the axis precesses about the indicated Z direction at the
rate of ,360 radlsec.
18.48. A dynamical nwdrl 01 il device iii orhit cottsi\ts 01
2,0110-1bm cylindrical shell A o t u n i f i ~ mthickness
~ and ii d i w H rolat-
ing relative tu the shell at a speed w, ut 5,000 radlmin. 'The disc H i h
I 11i n diamctcr and has a mas 01 1111) Ihni. Thc shcll i'i rotating at a
spccd w , US IO radlrnin about axis 11-1) in inriiiill space. Iflhe ahali
FF about which H ruttiltc~is made to line up with 1) 4)by m in(cmill
inechanism, what i h the liriill aiigular in(irnziiturr1 vector fcir thc sys-
lein'! Neglect the m a i s if all hudics except the dire H arid the dicll.

IS'

,'

Vigur-e P.lX.50.

Figure P.18.51.
18.53. 4 rocket casing is in orbit. The casing has a spin of 18.56. A space vehicle has zero rotation relative lo inertial
5 radlsec ?bout its axis of symmetry. The axis of symmetry is ori- space. A jct at A is turned on to give a thrust of 50N fur .8 scc.
ented 30" from the precession axis as shown in the diagram. What Identify the hody axis and the subsequent line of nodes. Then.
is the predession speed and the angular monientum o f the casing? give the nulation angle, thc spin speed 6, and the precession spccd
The casinb has a mass of 909 kg, a radius of gyration <if .hO m @. The vehicle weighs 10 kN and has a rediiir of gyration k. = I m
ahout the pxis of symmetry, and a radius of gyration about trans- and, tiansverse t n the i axis at the centcr of mass, k' = .8 111. Con-
verse axes at its center of mass of I m. sider the thrust 10 he imwlsivc.

Figure P.18.53.
18.54. 14 Problem 18.53 assume that an impulse i n the vertical
direction Bs developed at point A as a result of an impacl with a
meteorite.lIf the imvulse from the imvact is 133 N-sec. what are
the new plecession'axis and the rate bf precession after impact'! Figure P.18.56.
Ho from Problem 18.53 is 2,952 kg-mz/sec.

18.55. 4" object representing dynamically ii space device is made


18.57. An intcrmcdiatc-stage rocket engine i ? separated from the
of three hdmogeneuus blacks A , B , and C each of specific weight
first stage hy activating exploding bolts. 'Thc angular velocity of
on earth df 6,075 Nlm'. Blocks A and C are identical and arc
the spcnt enpinc is givcn as
hinged al+g aa and hh. At the configuration shown, the system ir
in orbit a+ is made to rntate instantaneously about an axis paral-
lel to RR alt a speed w , of 3 radlsec. The block C i s then closed by w = ?i + 3 j + .2k radlscc
an internal mechanism. What are the subsequent precession axis
and rate of precession?
4.
What is, the spin speed the precession speed @. and thc nutation
speed 8?Give dircction ofZaxi5. Identify the line ofnudcs. Notz
x that 1:: = 1.500 kp-n? and = I , , = 2,000 kg-m2.
I

34m
Figure P.18.55. Figure P.18.57.

957
18.8 closure
'This c1i;rptcr hrings to a close our study of thc motion of rigid bodies. In the
final chaplev of this LexI w e sli;i11. 111- the iiiosi part. gii hack 10 particlc
mechanics 10 consides llic dynamics (11 particles conitrained to move ahwl ii
fixed point in a m i a l l domain. This i s thc study t i l sriiall vibration (alluded to
in Chapter 12) which we ha\c held i n ;ihey;incc s o iis to take l u l l advant;ige 01
y o u r course work in differenlial equations.

958
18.60. plane just after takeoff i q flying at a speed 1.' of the disc A on platform G? Bearing K alone supports disc A in the
200 k d h ? and is in the process of retracting its wheels. The hack axial direction (i.e, it acts as a thrust hearing in addition to being
wheels (udder wings) are being rotated at a speed w, of 3 radlsec a regular bearing).
and at the~instantof interest have rotated 30" as shown in the dia-
gram. l'ha plane is rising by followillg a circular trajectory of
radius I,O(lO m. If at the instant shown, is SO kmlhrlsec, what
is the Iota moment coming onto the bearings of the wheel from
the motiol of the wheel'! The diameter of the wheel is 600 mm 200mm 200mm
and its weight is 900 N . The radius of gyration along its axis is L!Lt-L
250 mm &d transverse to its axis is 180 mm. Neglect wind and
hearing frlction.

Figure P.18.61.

18.62. Discs A and B are rolling without slipping at their center-


lines against an upper surface 0. Each disc weighs 40 Ib, and each
spins about a shaft which connects to a centerpost E rotating at an
angular speed w,. If a total of 20 Ib is developed upward on D ,
Figure P.18.60 what is w,'?

18.61. Adisc A weighing I O N and of diameter 100 mm rotates


with constant meed w . = 15 radlsec relative tu G. (A motor
on G, not /hown, ensuris this constant speed.) The shaft of motor 8"
B on C rofates with constant speed w2 = 8 radlsec relative to C
and cause4 platform C to rotate relative to C. Finally, platform A B
,
,
., " >.-
C rotates !with angular speed w, = 3 radlsec relative to the
ground. w h a t are the supporting forces on bearings H and K of Figure P.18.62.

955
liigurr P.IX.63.

ih)
Figure P.IX.64.
Viblrations

19.1 Introduction
You will!recall that in Chapter 12 we said we would dcfer a more general
examination of particle motion about a fixed point until the very end of the
text. We bo this to take full advantage of any course in differential equations
that you b i g h t be taking simultaneously with this course. Accordingly, we
shall noN continue the work begun in Chapter 12.

19.2 ~ Free Vibration


Let us b k i n by reiterating what we have done carlier leading to the study of
vibration$. Recall that we examined the case of a particle in rectilinear trans-
lation acFd on either by a constilnt force, a force given as a function of time,
a force t w t is a function of speed, or, finally. a force that is a function of posi-
tion. In ehch case we could separate the variables and effect a quadrature t o
1
arrive at ?he desired algebraic equations, including constants of integration. In
particulat we considered, as a special case of a force given as a function of
position, !the linear restoring force resulting from the action (or equivalent
action) 01 a linear spring. Thus, for thc spring-mass system shown in Fig. \Frictionless surface
19.1. the idifferential equation of motion was shown to he Figure 19.1. Spring-mass system.

(19.1)

where K 1s the spring constant and where .x is measured lrum the static equi-
librium &sition of the mass. You will now recognize this equation from your
studies id mathematics as a second-order, linear differential equation with
constant coefficients.

961
962 CHAPILK I Y VIBRATIONS

Instead of rearranging the equation IOel.lect a quadrature. as we did i n


the previous C ~ S C wc, ~ shall take a more general viewpoint toward thc sol\inp
O S differential equations.
'To solve a differential equation, we must find a function of time. r l i ) .
which when substituted into the equation satisfics thc cquation (Le.. reduces i t
IO an identity 0 = 0 ) . We can eithcr gucss at ~ x ( / o) r use a fiirinal procedure.
You have learned i n your differential equations course that the most general
solution o i the ahovc cquetion w i l l consist 01 a lineai- combination of two
iunctiuns that c~niiorhe written ;IS niultiplcs 0 1 cach ollicr (i.c. the functions
are linearly independent). There w i l l d s o he two arbitrary constants o f inte-
gratioii. Thus, C, cos ~.K i m 1 and C, sin K l m f w i l l satisfy the equation. as
_j

we can rzadily deniiinstrale hy suhsii;ution. m d are independent in the manner


descrihed. We can therelorc sa)

where and C, are the aforemenlioned conslanth o f integration to he deter-


mined froin the-initial conditions.
We can conveniently represcnl each o f the above functions by cmpliiy-
ing rotating ~ e c t i i r sof magnitudes that correspond to the coefficients of the
functions. This rcpreseiitalion i s shown in Fig. IW. where, if the vector <?,
,
rutatch counterclockwise with an angular velocity of K l i n radians per unil
time and if C, lies along the x axis at time 1 = 0, then the projection of this
vector along the .I axis represents m e o f t h e functions of Eq. 19.2. namely C'l
_
cos Klnr f. Vcct(irs uscd i n this iilanner ilre called phusor.s.

c', cos d! I

Figure 19.2. Philror rcprrsentation

Consider now the functioii C2 sin , ' K h 1. which we can replace hy C, cos
1 ,'Klwtr ~~ 1 2 )iis. we leariied i n elementary trigonometiy. The plrasor rep-
resentation for this function. lhcrc1orc. would he a vector o f magnitude C ,
that rutates with angular velocity ,, Kim and that i s out o f phase by E12 with
SEC TION 19.2 F REE V IBR A TI O N 963
the phasof C , (Fig. 19.3). Thus, the projection of C2 on the x axis is the other
function bf Eq. 19.2. Clearly, because vectors C, and C, rotate at the same
angular speed, we can represent the combined contribution by simply sum-
ming the +tors and considering the projection of the resulting single vector

Figure 19.3. Phasors d 2 out of phase.

along theln axis. This summation i s shown in Fig. 19.4 where vector C, re-
places thd vectors C, and C,. Now we can say:

Figure 19.4. Vector \urn of phaaors

Because ; C , and C , are arbitrary constants, C , and p are also arbitrary


constants; Consequently, we can replace the solution given by Eq. 19.2 by
another ebuivalent form:

(19.4)
964 C H A P T E R I V V IBR A T I O N S

From this fiirin, you prohahly reciigni~ethat the ~ i i o l i o n01 the body i\
hurinonic motion. I n studying this type of motion. we shall use thc following
dcrinitioni:

(.:wlr. The cycle i\ that pol-lion o i :I tiiotioii (or scrics oi event.; in the
inme general osagc) which. when rcpcatcd. imms the n o t i c i n On the phasor
diagrams. ii cycle wiiuld he the niorion ess(ici;ited with onc rcv(iIuti(in oi the
rorating vector.
b ' r c ~ , u ~ ~The
t ~ ; ~Iiumhcr
. 11f cycles per unit timc i s the irequency. The
,
frequency is equal t o K l i r i l l i r I r l - the ahovc ~ i i i i t i o n .hecause , K / i i t ha\
u t i i t s (11 radians per unit tinic. O l l e t ~, Kliii i\ tcrmcd the i i u t u r ~ f l . / i - ~ y u ~ ~ i ~
o f the system i n radians per unit t i t l i e or. when d i \ i d c d hy 211. i n cycle,
per unit t i m c . The iturrrrul Ireqirriicy i s deiiotcd gcncwlly in the f o l l o w -
1ng ways:

fu,, = ,K/m I-adl.


/ = ~~~ I , K /,ti c q c l e s l s l ~ c
J) 211,

Prrkid The period. T. i\ llic tiiiie o l o n e cycle. wid is Ihereliire the re-
ciprocal of frequency. Th:it is.

Atnp/irud~~. The Iargcsl displaceiiient attained hy the hody during a


cycle i s the amplitude. I n this case. the ;impliludc corrcsp~iidrto the coeffi-
cient c,.
Pliuse ut!glc,, Tlie phase anglc is the :ingle hetweeii rhc phiisor and the
~ra x i \ whcn f = 0 ii.e., the m f l c p ) .

A plot (if the niotiuti its a function 01 lime i s presented in Fig. l1J.S.
where certain (if tlicsc viiriow quantities arc sIim\'n graphically.

Figure 19.5. Plot 01liariiiiiiiic miition

I t i s u s u d l y eahier t o use the ciirlier limn iii xilution. Eq. 19.2. rather
lhan Eq. 19.4 i n sati.;iying initial condition\. Acc(irdingly, the position arid
velocity can be &. 'iven a s
SECTION 19.2 FREE VIBRATION 965

The initi4l conditions to he applied to these equations are:

when t = 0 x = co, V = V,
Substituting, we get

Theretorg, the motion IF given as

v,,
~~~

x = I cos :-I
“ K + ==sin :K
<%I (l9.6a)
\m ,;K/,,,
-
v = -.r IK
“Vm
‘K
sin 1-1
\m
+ V , cos \:-t: mK (19.6b)

Wa can generalize from these results by noting that any agent sup-
plying a ~ l i n e a rrestoring force for all rectilinear motions of a mass can
take t h e p l a c e of the spring in the preceding computations. We must
remember, however, that to behave this way the agent must have negligi-
ble m a d Thus, we can associate with such agents an equivalent spring
c o n s m d K e , which we can ascertain if we know the static deflection 6
permitted by the agent on application of some known force F . We can
then say:#

On4e we determine the equivalent spring constant, we immediately


know t h 4 the natural frequency of the system is (112~)1 K J m cycles per
unit time! This natural frequency is the number of cycles the system will
repeat i n ! a unit time if some initial disturbance is imposed on the mass.
Note thad this natural frequency depends only on the “stiffness” of the sys-
tem and dn the mass of the system and is not dependent on the amplitude of
the motiqn.2
We; shall now consider several problems in which we can apply what
we have just learned about harmonic motion.

’ActuUlly. when the amplitude gets coinpararively large, the spring ceases to be linear. and
the inocion @ea depend un the amplitude. Our results do not apply for such a condition.
966 ctihi'i'm i q VIIIYATIOUS

Example 19.1
; A miss b,eighing 45 N i s placed on the spring chown in Fig. IY.6 and i \
!
released x~rryslowly. cxtcnding the spring ii tlistancc (11' SO mm. What i s
the natural frcqucncy 111 the \ystcnr'! If the n i x s i s givcn a velocity iiislail-
1
tanciiusly of 1.60 m l \ c c down from the equilibrium position, what i s thc
equation for displacement a s a function of time'?

.
T-
.

r-
i Figure 19.6. .i mc2iwrcd firom \vatic drilection Ipositioii.
I

The spring cimst;inl i s immcdiately available hy the equation


I

Tlic equation 01' motion for the mass can he written for a reference
whiisc origin i s at the ctatic equilihriunr position shown i n the diagram.
1 'Thus,

where 6 i s the distance from tlie unextendcd position (if the spring to the
origiri ofthe reference. However. I).orii our initial equatiiin, S = F/K = W / K .
Therrforc, wc havc

,
I and (he equation hecome, identical to Eq. 19. I:

Thus, the motion w i l l be an iiscillation ahout the position 0 1 static equilih-


riuni, which i s an cxtended position of the spring. Measurirlg .r from the
srutic equilibrium position and considrring the spring fcirce a i -K~x.we can
thus disregard the weight on the body i n writing Ncwton's law li,r the body
Lo reach Eq. (a) most directly.
SECTION 19.2 FREE VIBRATION 961

r EXalfnple 19.1 (Continued)


,Accordingly, we can use the results stemming from our main dis-
cussion. Employing the notation w, as the natural frequency in units of
radiads per unit time, we have

The motion is now given by the equations


x = C , sin 14.01t + C, cos 14.01f
x = 14.01C, cos 14.01t ~ 14.01C2 sin 14.01t

I From'the specified initial conditions, we know that when f = 0, x = 0,


andx ~= 1.6 mlsec. Therefore, the constants of integration are

II c, = 0 ,
The desired equation, then, is
C, = 1 60 = 1142

I on the end of a slender


considering the motion of

Figure 19.7. Slender cantilever beam with weight at end.

,If we know the geometry and the composition of the cantilever


beami and if the deflection involved is small, we can compute from
beam that results from
ortional to the load. In
I
968 CHAPTI:.K I'J VIBRATIOUS

Example 19.2 (Continued)


j
this case. suppme that we hiiuc computcd ii deflection 01 12.1 111111lor ii
1 lorcc o f 4 N (see Fig. 19.8). What wiiuld he thc ~iiitiiI,ilfrequency (11' tlic
body weighing 22 N liir m i a l l oscillations i n thc verlical direction;'

I
F i g w e 19.X. Bcam :ICIS ;is linear \priiig

Because tlic motion is restricled to siniill :iniplitudzs. \bc ciiii cciii-


1 sidcr the mass to he i n rcctilinciir iiiotiiin i n the veitical direction iii the
: same nianner a s the i i i a s s on tlic spring i n thc pirvious ciisc. Thc heairi
; now supplies the linear restoring lorcc. The formu1:uions 111 thi\ w e t i o n
are orice again applicahle. The cquivalcnl spring constillit i i found to he
!

! The natiirill f.requcncy liir vibration 01 tlic 12-N wcight at l l i e end 0 1 tlic
; emtilever is then

Also, uc \vi+ t o puint mit that. for s i i i i i l l \'iiluci of H. we can approni-


inate sin H hy Hand cos H hy unily. To.jusliiy this. cxpiind sin Hand cos H a c
DOWCI series and rctaiii fir\[ tcriiis.
19.1. ISp 5-kg mass causes an elangation of 50 m m when sus-
pended frhm the end of a spring, determine thc iiilturill frequency
of the spring-inass system.

19.2. (ai Show that the spring constant is douhled if the length
of the spring is halved.

(hi Show that two springs having spring conctants K , and


KZ have a~combinedspring constant of K , + K2 when connected
in parelk(, and have a combined spring constant whose reciprocal
is I I K , + i I / K , when combined in series. Figure P.19.3.
19.4. A mass M Of 100 g rides on a frictionless guide rod. If the
natural frequency with spring K , attached is 5 radlsec, what must
K, be to increase the nilturd frequency to 8 radiiec?

Figure P.19.4.
19.5. For small oscillations, what is the nilturd frequency of the
system in terms of LL h. K , and W? (Neglect the mass of the rod.)

Figure P.19.5.
19.6. A rod is supported on two rotating grooved wheels. The
contact surfaces have a coefficient of friction of p,? Explain how
the rod will oscillafe in the horizontal direction if it is disturbed in
that direction. Compute the natural frequency of the system.
Figure P.19.2.
Mass = ,,I
\
kg rides on a vertical frictionlew guide rod. 1.
K , , the natural frequcncy of the system is
2 r d d k c . ;IS we want to increase the natural frequency threelold,
what musl the spring constant K, of a second spring he! Figure P.19.6.

969
19.7. A mass i s held s o it,iust makes contact with a spring. If the
mass i s releascd suddenly from this position. give the amplitude.
frequency, and the center positiw u i the motian. Firs1 usc thc
u n r k f i m w d positiorr 10 meawre x. Then, do the prohlem using r'
irom thc static equilibrium position.

K = I 7 Nlmm Figure P.1Y.Y.


19.10. A X-ke block i s suspended using t ~ light o wires. What
i s the frequcncy in cycleslsec at which the hloch will swing hack
and iorth in the Y direclion ii i t i s slightly iliWrhed in this direc~
Figure P.19.7. tion'! [ H i n t -For snitdl H. sin 8 = 8 and COT H = I .I

19.8. A hwlrornuter i s a device to measurc thc .spr~(fic, x r m i t ~


of
liquids. The hydrometer weighs 3 6 N, and the diameter of the
cylindrical portion ahovc the hase i s 6 m m . Ifthe hydromztrl~
i s di\turhed in the vertical direction. what i s the frequency of
vibration in cycleslsec as i t hob\ up and down'! Recall frnm
Airhimrdr..s'prinri/7lu that the buoyant force equals the weigh1 of
the water displaced. Water has a density 01 1,000 kglm'.

n .m IIN1 I","
Figure P.lY.10.
H I 19.11. In Prohlrm l~l.lO, what i c thepcrirrdofsmall oscillations inr
n \mall disturbance that causcs thc block to inwe in the :dirrction?

19.12. What i s the natura frcqucnc). r i f motion ior block A for


\mall oscillation? Consider I K 10 have ncplipihlc mass and hod)
A t i l he a p;u'licle. When hody A I s attachcd t o the rod, the static
detlection i s ?S mm. The qpring cnmtant K , I S 1.75 Nlmm. Body
A weighs I ION. What i s K,'!

l-----l
Figure P.19.8.

*19.9. The hydrometer o f Problem 1 4 8 i\ used to test the


spccific gravity of hattery acid in a car battery. What I S
the period of mcrllation in this casc? [ H i n t : Note if hydrome-
t u purr down. the hattery acid surfdce w i l l have t o r i s e a ccr-
tain amount simultaneourly. The hattcry acid has a density of
1,100 kg1m3.l
19.13. I t bar A B C is of negligible mass. what is the natural fre- 19.16. A horizontal platform is rotating with a uniform angular
quency c# free oscillation of the block for small amplitude of speed of w radisec. On the platform is a rod CD on which slides
motion? t h e springs are identical, each having a spring constant K a cylinder A having weight W. The cylinder is connected to C
of 25 I b h . The weight of the block is 10 Ib. The springs are through a linear spring having a spring wnstint K . What is the
unstretchdd when A B i s oriented vertically as shown in the diagram. equation of motion for A relative to the platform after it has been
disturbed! What is the natural frequency of oscillation? Take ro as
the unstretched length of spring.

D
Figure P.19.13. 0

19.14. Work Problem 19.13 fix the case where the springs are
both stretbhed 1 in. when AH is vertical.
19.15. *hat are the differential equation of motion about the
configuration and the natural frequency of
for small motion of BC? Neglect inertial effects
from BC.:The folluwing data apply:
K , = 15 Ib/in.
K , = 20 Ihlin. Figure P.19.16.
K3 = 30 Ibiin.
WA = 30 Ib
19.17. A rigid body A rests on a spring with stiffness K equal to
8.80 Nimm. A lead pad B falls Onto the block A with a speed on

+ .
c impact of 7 misec. If the impact is perfectly plastic, what are the
,
, frequency and amplitude of the motion of the system, provided
h K,
, that lhc lcnd pad sticks 10 A at all times'? Takc W, = 134 N and
W, = 22 N. What is the distance moved by A in .02 sec'! (Cuurion:
Be careful about the initial conditions.)

\ B

5 8,

I
Figure P.19.15. Figure P.19.17.

97 I
19.18. A small sphere of ureight 5 Ih is held hy taut elastic cordq 19.21. A spherical hody A n l mass 2 kg i s attachcd hy a light
on africtionless plane. IS50 I h o f force i s needed tn cause an elon- rad t n a shaft HC' which i\ inclined hy an angle nf 30". For
gation of I ill. for rach cord. w'hat is the natural frequency of \mull, rotational wcillations ahoiit I K , what i\ the natural fru-
small oscillation of the weight i n B transverse direction'! Also. quency nfthc cystcm'! [Hint: Recall that the nmrncnt ahout an axis
determine the natural frequency of the weight in a direutiun d u n g n i s ( r X Fl * *.I
the cord for small oscillatinns. Neglect thc mass of the cord. Thr
tension in the cord in the configuration vhown i\ 100 Ih.

Figure P.19.18.
Figure P.lY.21.

19.19. Body A weighs 445 N and IS connected to a spring ha\,-


ing a spring constant K , of 3.50 N/mm. At the right of A is a
second spring having a spring constant K? of 8.80 N h m . Body "19.22. A cube A , .25 171 II,~ a ,ide, has hpec~ficgravity ill I .IO
A is moved 150 mm to the left from the configuration of static and Is attachitc~to il c,,nr ha\.,ng a specific ,,f
gravity ,8,what i,
equilibrium shown i n the diagram, and i t is released horn rest. the equation for up-and-drr,\n ,,,OtiO,,(,f!hc ~~~l~~~
What i 5 the period of m c i l l a t i o n fix the hody'? Itlinr: Work with ,,,ass and huo)ant fc,rcc fc,r rilcj c,Lj, F ~ \.el-y
~ , c,,,all ,~s,.~~~~~t,~~,,5,
half a cycle.1 what i s the ;ippmximatc natural frequency'!

Figure P.19.19,

19.20. Body A. weighing 5 0 Ih, has r? speed of 20 ftiscc to the


left. If there i s no friction, what i s the period of oscillatinn nf
the hody for the following data:

K , = 20lh/in.
K2 = IO Ihhn.

Figure P.19.20.

972
SECTION 19.3 TORSIONAL VIBRATION 913

19.3 ~ Torsional Vibration


We sho$ed in Section 16.2 that, for a body constrained to rotate about an
axis fixM in inertial space, the angular momentum equation about the fixed
axis is

.. . = l,.O
l..h7 .. = M: (19.9)

Numerobs homework problems involved the determination of 8 and 0 fbr


applied torques which either were constant, varied with time, varied with
speed 0,i or, finally varied with position 8. The analyses paralleled very
closely the corresponding cases for rectilinear translation of Chapter 12. Pri-
marily, the approach was that of separation of variables and then that of car-
rying out one or more quadratures.
Patalleling the case of the linear restoring torce in rectilinear translation
is the important case where M. is a linear restoring torque. For example, con-
sider a c/rcular disc attached Io the end of a light shaft as shown in Fig. 19.9.

A
Figure 19.9. Shaft-disc analog of spring-mass systein.

Note thit the upper end of the shaft is fixed. If the disc is twisted by an exter-
nal age* about the centerline A 4 of the shaft, then the disc will rotate essen-
tially asi a rigid body, whereas the shaft, since it is so much thinner and
longer, +ill twist and supply a restoring torque on the disc that tries to bring
the disc!back to its initial position. In considering the possible motions of
such a skstem disturbed in the aforementioned manner, we idealize the prob-
lem by fkmping all elastic action into the shaft and all inertial effects into the
914 C'HAPTIK I'J VIBKAllOUS

disc. We know from sti-ength (if inateriiils that for a circular shalt o l constant
cross scction thc i i i i i ~ u i i to f twi\t H induced by torque M~ is, i n the elastic
rmgc o f deforniatii~n.

wliere G is the shcnr modulus iif thc shaft miterial, J ih the polar niiimcnt of
area of the shaft cross sectiiin, and L is the length OS thc shalt. Wc can \et
forth the concept of a torsionill spring constant K, &'vven as

For (he case at hand. we h w e

'Thus, the thin shalt has thc siinic roll' iii [hi\ discussiiin ii\ thc light linear
spring 11f Section 19.2. Employing Eq. 1Y.1 I lor M, and using the proper
sign to cnsurc that wc l i a ~ cii rcstoring action. wc ciiii cxprcss Eq. 19.9 iis
ll~ll~l~~s:

Notice that this equatiiin i s identical in form to Eq. 19.1. Accordingly. all thc
conclusions developed i n tliiit discu\sion apply with the appIopriate changes
i n notation. Thus. the disc. once disturbed hy heing given an angular motion.
will have a for.sionu/ iiaturiil oscillation frequency of io,,)
= > ' K , / / . .rad/scc.
The eqiiatioii of motion lor the disc i s

wliere C , and C, are constaiits (if integration to he determined from initial


conditions. Thuslfcir H = H,, and 6 = 6,
at f = 0 we have

In the cxample j u s t presented, the linear restoring torque stemmed l r i i m


long
~i thin shaft. There could he other agents that can dcvclop il linear restor-
ing torque on a systcm cithcrwisc frcc to rotate about an iixis l i x r d i n inertial
*pace. We then talk ahoiit an rquiivrlmf t i i r ~ i o i i i i spring
l constant. We shall
illustrate such case? i n the following examples.
SECTION 19.3 TORSIONAL VIBRATION 915

Example 19.3
What are the equation of motion and the natural frequency of oscillation
for s m d l amplitude of a simple plane pendulum shown in Fig. 19.10? The A
pendulum rod may be considered massless.
Because the pendulum bob is small compared to the radius of curva-
ture of its possible trajectory of motion, we may consider it as a panicle.
The pendulum has one degree of freedom, and we can use 8 as the inde-
pendent coordinate.' Notice from the diagram that there is a restoring
torque about point A developed by gravity given as
Mx = ~ W L sin 8 (a)
where W i s the weight of the bob. If the amplitude of the motion 8 is very
small, we can replace sin 8 by 8 and so for this case we have a linear
restoring torque given as
M~ = -wLe (b) ...

We then have an equivalent torsional spring constant for the system Figure 19.10. Pendulum.

K, = W L (C)

The equation of possible small-amplitude motions for the pendulum is


given as
-WLO = ( ~ ~ 2 1 8 (d)
where we have used the moment-of-momentum equation about the fixed
point A. Rearranging terms, we get

Noting that W = Mg. we have


8+1
1. 8 = 0 (f)

Accordingly, the natural frequency of oscillation is


,~

on = L$
L rad/sec (8)

The equation of motion for this system is

where C, and C, are computed from known conditions at some time to

'One degree of freedom means that one independent coordinate locales the system
1
A stepped disc i s sliown i n Fig. 19.1 I soppiirting ii weight bVI wliilc hcing
; coiiutrained by ii linciir spring having ii spring c o i i h t i i n l K. 'I'hc m i s s of [he
stepped disc i s M and thc radius 01gyration about i t s gciinictric iixih i s k . I
What i s the equation 01 motion for the system if the disc i s rotated a sliiilll
~
anglc 8, counterclockwise from i t s static~equilihriumconligura(iiin and
thcn huddenly released Sroni rcsl? A s \ u i i i e the ~ ~ I hro l ddi i i ~11 ' 1 i s ncight-
less arid perfectly Ilcxiblc.
I1we ineasurc 8 from the static~cquilihriuniIiositioii ii\ \tio\vii i n
I
Fig. 19,I2(aj thc spring i s s l r e l c l ~ r diiii i i i ~ ~ ~ iKi ,i(iHt + Ooj v,licrciii 8,,
i'i the am(iunt 01 rotation induced by the weigh1 U', t o ieiicli the slatic-
cquilihriuiii configuration. Conhcqucntly. applying thc angular nionien-
turn equation IO Ihc stepped disc ahout llic axis 01 r ~ t i i l i i ~wc ~ i .gcl

R,T ~ KlitC8 t O , , ) = Mk'tj (?I)

Next consider tlie suspended weight L I T , . Clearly we hii\c mly triiii\-


lation for this body. i o r which Newton's law gives us

where we h a w made the assunipti(in tliiit [lie cord i\ ;ilw;iys tiluf :ind i h
incntcnsible and have considercd thc kinematics 01 the motion. W e may
replace T i n Eq. (a) uring ELI.( h ) a s i i i l l i i ~ ' s :

Rearranging tcriiis. hi: get

Conhidering tlie static-equilihriurn configuration ( ~ tlicf \y\tcm. wc SIT o n


suiilming nioiiients ;rhout tlic axis 01 r(itatioii tliiil tlic riglit hide 01 the
eqoatiiin ahiivc i s %CI-O. Accordingly. wc Iiinc ior k . (11):

__ ... . . . .. , .. . . ,. .. .. . ..
SECTION 19.3 TORSIONAL VIBRATION 911

Example 19.4 (Continued)


The equation of motion is then

Submitting Eq. (g) to the initial conditions to determine C, and C, we get

It is important to note that we could have reached Eq. (e) more


directly by using 8 measured from the equilibrium configuration. That is,
use the fact that the moment from the weight W, is counteracted by the sta-
tic moment from the stretch R,Bu of the spring. Accordingly, only the
moment Srom the force-R2K8 from further stretch of the spring as well as
the moment from the inertial force-(W,lg)R,8of the hanging weight from
Eq. (b) need be considered in the angular-momentum equation (a). Thus,
we have from this viewpoini:

?
- -~Rye ~ KR,?e = Mk2e (i)
g
Rearranging, we have

@+-Mk2 +KR;
(W,/g)Ry
8=0

Accordingly, we arrive at very same differential equation (e) in a more


direct manner. We can again conclude as in Example 19. I that when the
coordinate i s measured from an equilibrium configuration we can .forget
about conrributions of torqurs that are present f o r the equilibrium config-
uration and indude only new torques developed when there is a departure
.from the equilibrium configuration.

Before you start on the problems, we wish to point out that shafts directly
connected L o each other (see the shafts on the right side of the disc in Fig.
P. 19.23) are analogous to springs in series as far as the equivalent torsional
spring constant is concerned. On the other hand, shafts on opposite sides of the
disc are analogous to springs in parallel as far as the equivalent torsional spring
constant is concerned. You should have no trouble justifying these observations.
19.23. Compulc the equivalent tonioiial \pr!tis coilstant of the
~

;haft <rnthc disc.

1
1.20 m

i
Figure P.19.23.
Figure P.lY.27.
19.24. What is thc equivalent tini<spring constant on thc
l i x ilron> the shaft? 'The modnlu\ of ticity (i lor the shaft\ i q 19.28. A \Icndcr rod wcighing 140 N i\ held hy ii frictionless pin
10 x 10"' Nlni'. Wh;it i s the natural uency 0 1 the ryqern? If at Aand hy il \pring having a spring constant of 8.80 Nlmm :it H
he disc i s twisted I O and then released. what will i t s angular
(a) What is thc natural frequency of mcillarim for sinall
msirion he m I scc? Neglect thc m of rhe <hafts. The disc
vihrations?
weighs 1.13 N .
ih) If point ti of the rod i c deprccsed 2S mm iit i = I1
from the <latic-eqnilihriom position. what w i l l i t s position he
w h m t = .(I? sec'?

-.-.___

Figure P.lV.24.
- I 111 -1
1.? m

7 H

19.25. A small pendulum i s rnountrd in il I-ockrt that i c accclt.~~-


8.80 Nlmm ,5,
ttinp upward at thr rm of 3,q. What i\ the natural frcquuncy of >
,
.xitation o f t h u pendulum i i t h c hoh has :I mass o1 iO,y? Nrflect thc
might 01 the rod. C o n d e r m a l l mcilIati,m\.
i
Figure P.19.28.

t 3 .:"'
19.29. What I S the natural fi-eq~iency01 the pendulum shown for
small oicillauon.;? Take into ilccount Ihe incrtiii of the rod whosc

/IA
mass i \ ,?IAlso, considcl- the hob to hc a sphcrc < f d i a m e t r r1 ) ;mil
ma\\ M, ralhci than a pxticle. Thc length 01the rod i \ I .
1iK1 niin

i
Figure P.19.25.

19.26. Work Prohlrm 10.25 l o i ~the case wherc thc rockrt IS

lecelerating at .hi: i n the YerticaI dil-cctim.

19.27. What i y the natural lrequency h r cmiill occillatmns of the


:ompound pcndulum supported at A'! Figure P.19.29.

)78
.
19.30. A cylinder of mass M and radius R is connected to identi-
cal springs and rotates without friction about 0. For Small vscilla-
Lions, what is the natural frequency? The cord supporting W, is
wrapped around the cylinder.

L-- I
Figure P.19.32.

19.33. In Problem 19.12, do not consider body A to he a particle,


and compute the natural frequency of the system for small vibra-
tions. Take the dimension of A to be that of a 150-mm cube. If w,,
for the particle approach is 19.81 radlsec, what percentage error is
incurred using the particle approach?
Figure P.19.30.

19.34. Gears A and ti weighing 5 0 Ib and 80 Ih, respectively,


19.31. The authur'a 22.f~ Columbia sailboat is suspended by are fixed ti) supports C and 11 as shown. If the shear modulus G
from a crane. The boa[ i s made to swing freely about sup. far the shafts is 15 x 10' psi, what is the natural frequency of
pon A in the ru. plane (the plane of the page). What is the radius uf oscillation for the system?
gyration about the i axis at the center of gravity if the period
of oscillation is 5 sec'? The h i m has a mass of 1,000 kg. Neglect
the weight of supporting wires and belts.
C

Figure P.19.34.

19.35. A four-bar linkage, ABCD, is disturbed slightly so as to


oscillate in the x? plane. What is the frequency of oscillation if
f each bar has a mass of 5.0 g h m ?

Figure P.19.31.
Y

19.32. A uniform bar of length Land weight W is suspended hy


strings. What is the differential equatiun of motion fur small tor-
sional oscillatiun about a vertical axis at the center of mass at C! ,513m
What is the natural frequency'? Figure P.19.35.

979
.xo 111

. .. ~...~ ._
A

Figure P.lY.37 Figure P.19.39,


19.40. What is the natural frequency of torsional vibration for 19.42. A disc B is suspended by a flexible wire. The tension in
the stepped cylinder? The mass of the cylinder is 45 kg, and the the top wire is 4,450 N. If the disc is observed to have a period of
radius of gyration is .4h m. The following data also apply: lateral oscillation of .2 iec for very small amplitude and a period
of torsional oscillation of 5 sec. what is the radius of gyration of
D,= 30 m the disc about its geometric axis? The torsional spring constant for
D, = . 6 0 m each of the wires is 1,470 N-mmlrad.
K , = .X75Nlmm
K2 = 1.8Nimm
WA = 17RN

Figure P.19.42.

19.43. 80 discs are forced together such that, at point of


Figure P.19.40.
contact, a normal force of SO Ibis transmitted from one disc to the
other. Disc A weighs 200 Ib and has a radius of gyration of I.4 ft
about C. whereas disc B weiehs SO Ib and has a radius of evration
I I,

about D of I ft. What is the natural frequency of oscillation for the


19.41. A disc A weighs 445 N and has a radius of gyration of .45 m
system, if disc A is rotated IO" counterclockwise and then released?
about its axis of symmetry. Note that the center of gravity does
The center of gravity of B coincides with the geometric center.
not coincide with the emmetric center. What are the amDlitude of
~

oscillation and frequency of mcillation if, at the instant that the


center of gravity is directly below B, the disc is rotating at a speed
of .O I rad/sec counterclockwise'?

Figure P.19.43.

19.44. In Problem 1Y.43, find the minimum coefficient of


. . .between the discs. From Problem 19.43.
friction fot- no slipping
Figure P.19.41. w, = 3.68 rad/sec.

98 I
"19.4 Examples of Other
Free-Oscillating Motions
In Ihc prcvious sectioiis. we examined the rectiliiiciir translation of a rigid
b ~ l undcr
y the iictioii o f i i linear restoring fiirce a c \\ell ii\ the [pure riitatiiiii 01
a rigid body under the actinii of ii linear restoi-ing Inrque. In this sectinn. we
shall first e~iiniiiiea body with one dcgrcc 0 1 frccdom undergoing p k i w
,notio,i governed hy i i diflerential cquiition o f iniolioii oi thc liirm g i \ m i i i thc
previous section. The dependent variablc for such ii case u r i c ' s lhnrnionically
w i t h time. a i i d u e liii~eii i ~ i h r u ~ o i :pvl i i i w iiio/ioii. Cmsidcr tlic fiilliiwing
cxiirnplc.

Example 19.5
Shown i n Fig. l ! L l 3 ( a i (in an inclined pliinc is ii iiniforni cylindei- iiiaiii-
tnined i n n position o f cquilihriuni by a linear spring having a spring
constant K. I 1 the cylindcr rolls without slipping. what i s the equ;ition o f
inotinn when i t i s distiirhed from its equilihriuni pmilinn?
We have here a case o f plene motinn ahout ii configuration o i c q u -
lihriuin. llsing ~ r ?as. ~ii .rrori~inurvrclcrencc. wc' shall iiicasiir~'the displace-
ment .< o f t h e center of mass from the equilibrium pnsition iiiitl xctrrdingly
shall need to consider nnly thnse fiirces and tnrqucs dcvcl(ipcd iis lhc cylin-
der departs from this position. Accordingly. we have for Newton's law lor
the mass center [ w e Fig. 19.13(b)l:
-1 - K.i = M.i (;I)

\
SECTION 19.4 EXAMPLES OF OTHER FREE-OSCILLATING MOTIONS 983

Example 19.5 (Continued)


Now employ the angular-momentum equation about the geometric axis
of the cylinder at 0.Using 0 to measure the rotation of the cylinder about
this axis from the equilibrium configuration, we get

-f R = i MR28.. (b)

Noting from kinematics that Y = -R0as a result of the no-slipping con.


dition, we have for Eq. (b):

.fR = MR2($)

Therefore.

Substituting forfin Eq. (a) using this result, we have

My = - 1Mx"- Kx

Therefore,

2 K
y + ---* =0
3M

We could also have arrived at the differential equation above by


noting that we have instantaneous pure rotation about the line of contact
A as a result of the no-slipping condition. Thus. the angnlar-mnmen-
t u m equation can be used as follows about the point of contact on the
cylinder:

( i M R Z+ MRz)8 = KxR (e)

Noting as before that e = - ?/R, we get

Therefore., as before
984 CHAPTI(K I O VIRRATIONS

Example 19.5 (Continued)


We may solve the differential equation to give us

(f)

whcrc .xII and i,,are tlie initial position and specd of thc ccntcr of ma\r.
respectively. Sirice Q = -.dR (we have here only m e degree o f freedim'
a': B result of the no-slipping condition), we have for Qfroni Kq. (g):

"19.5 Energy Methods


U p tu iiuw, the procedure has heen primarily to work with N<wro,c'.$lob,. or
the ~ i ~ i ~ u l u r ~ m o m ~ nreaching
r ~ r / ~ ill
(,qiw/i(iii ~ the dillel-entia1 equiitiiin i i l inter-
est. There i s an alternative approach to tlie handling of frec \,ihratiiiii proh-
Icms lhat may he very useful in dealing with simple systems and iii setting u p
approxiinate calculiitionh for more complex s y h t c m h . Suppose we knoiv Ihi ii
iine~degree~of-fi-eedom ':ystcni that 0111) liiicar rchtoring liirces mil tiirques
d o work during pos':ihle motiirns 01 Ihc systcm. Then. thc agents developing
such Sorces arc c o m c r w i i l p fcircc agents aiid nray he ciinsidcrcd to stoic
potential cncrgy. Y<iu will recall froni Section 13.3 that thc rorol ,m,~.Iumi,~ul
'tcnis is ~ . o n . ~ r r wThus,
d . wc habe

PE + KE = constant ( I 9 I(>)
SECTION 19.5 ENERGY METHODS 985
Also, we know from our present study that the system must oscillate harmon-
ically when disturhed and then allowed to move freely with only the linear
restoring agents doing work. Thus, if K is the independent coordinate mea-
sured from the static-equilibrium configuration, we have

K = Asin(m,,t + b) (19.17)
Hence,
K = Am,, cos (mnf + p) (19.18)

Now at the instant when K = 0. we are at the static-equilibrium position and


the potential energy of the system is a minimum. Since the total mechanical
energy must he conserved at all times once such a motion is under way, it is
also clear that the kinetic energy must be at a maximum at that instant. If we
take the lowest potential energy as zero, then we have for the total mechani-
cal energy simply the maximum kinetic energy. Also, when the body is
undergoing a change in direction of its motion at the outer extreme position,
the kinetic energy is zero instantaneously, and accordingly the potentidl
energy must he a maximum and equal to the total mechanical energy of the
system. Thus, we can equate the maximum potential energy with the maxi-
mum kinetic energy.
(KE)max= (PE),ax (19.19)

In computing the (KE)n,ax,we will involve ( k)mdx and hence Am,, whereas
for the (PE),,,z,xwe will involve (K)max and hence A. In this way we can set
up quickly an equation for m,,, the natural frequency of the system. For
example, if we have the simple linear spring-mass system of Fig. 19.1, we
can say:
(PE) = $ Kx2
Therefore,

where we have made use of our knowledge that x = A sin (m,! + p). And,
noting that ,? = Am,, cos (mat + ,@, we have
4
(KEImiIx= f M(imnrl2 = M i A m n)*
Now, equating these expressions, we get
+KA2 = $ M ( A U , , ) ~

Therefore,

which is the expected result. We next illustrate this approach in a more com-
plex problem.
986 CHAPTliK I'J VIKKATIONS

Example 19.6 ,:*m,ive4-"*

A cylinder u i radius r a n d weight W 1ro11s without slipping d u n g a circular


path o i radius K iis shown i n Fig. l(I.l4. Compuic ~ h niitural
c frequency of
oscillation foi- smiill oscillatimi.

Figure lY.14. Vylindcr roils without slippiny.

This system has one degree 0 1 lrccdoni. We can u\e @, the angle oi
rot;ition of the cylinder ahout its iixis oi symmetry. as the independent
coordinatc, or we m a y use H a s shown i n the diagraln. 1 0 rcliitc thcsc vari-
ables ror no slipping we iiiay conclude. on o h s e r v i n ~thc mulion of point
0. thal lor sinall rotation:
(K - ,-)e= ,-0
Therefore,
H = R r I0
~
(a)

The only force that docs u o r k during [he possihle motions oithc sys-
teni i s the lorce of gravily W . Thc torque dcveloped by W ahoul the point of
contact for a given H i s casily delerinined atier exariiining Fig. 10.15 to he

torque = W r sin H = Wrsin (h)


SECTION 19.5 ENERGY METHODS 987

Example 19.6 (Continued)


This is a restoring torque, and because we limit ourselves to small nsrillu-
tions it becomes W[rZ@/(R-r)]. which is clearly a linear restoring torque.
Because the force doing work on the cylinder is conservative. and because
it results in a linear restoring torque, we can employ the energy formula-
tion of this section.
The motion may be considered to be given as follows:

or, using t3q. (a).

Expressing the maximum potential and kinetic energies and using C for
O,mLx and the lowest position of 0 as the datum, we have:

We have used Eq. (d) in the last expression of Eq. (0. Expanding cos C in
a power series and retaining the first two terms (1-Cz/2), we then get, on
equating the right sides of the above equations:

Therefore.,
Figure P.19.45.
19.51. A munometer used for measuring pressures is shown. If
the mercury has a length L in the tube, what is the formulation for Inside diameter
the natural frequency of movement of the mercury? I O mm

1r
5 Inside diametei
50 mm

I I
Figure P.19.53.

Figure P.19.51.

19.54. A stepped cylinder rides o n a circular path. Far sinall


oscillations, what is thc natural frequency'! Take the radius of
19.52. inclined mOnumefel is often used for more gyration about the geometric axis 0 as k and the weight 01 the
pressure measurements. If the mercury in the tube has a length L, cylinder as w.
what i s the natural frequency of oscillation of the mercury in the
tube?

Figure P.19.52.

19.53. A differential manometer is used for measuring high pres-


sures. What is the natural frequency of oscillation of the mercury'? Figure P.19.54.

989
990 CHAPTf K I'J VIBKATIOV

19.6 Linear Restoring Force and a Force


Varying Sinusoidally with Time
Wc shall 110\1 coiisidcr tlic ca\c 01 :I ~ i n u x i i d i i,,!-cc
~l ;icting oil ii :,pring-mass
systc~n(Fig. IC). 16) h i \ w i with \t;itionai-y rcicreiice .KJ. Thc sinusoidal iorcc
has a frequency (11 w (not til hc coiliuvxl w i t h "I,,. thi. iialuriil frequency) and
;in ;implitudc 0 1 6,.At time i = 0. the i n i i i \ w i l l he assunicd lo have s o m e
known veliicity and po\ilioii. iiiid n e \hall investigate tllc eii:,iiing iiiotion.

Meiisuring the p ~ s i t i i i n.I lroin [tie unextended position olthe spring. we


h a w lor Ncwtoii '.v h i w

JJ? = -K.\ + /;) 'iin ui (IC).XJI


</I?

Reiiimiizing the cquiitioii :,(I that thc dcpcndcnt variable and i t s deribativcs
arc on the left-hand side iiiitl dividing through hy tit. wc gel the standard limn:

To get a pai~liciil;il-vjlulioii .I,. u c can scc by inspcctioii that a lunctioii oftht!


Ihrin .I = ( ' *sin wi w i l l give il s,dutiim if the cimstant (-,i s choscn properly.
Suhstiluling t h i s lunctiiin inti, Eq. 19.21. w c thus h i i \ c
SECTION 19.6 LINEAR RESTORING FORCE AND A FORCE VARYING SINUSOIDALLY WITH TIME 991

Clearly, the value of C, must be

(19.23)

We can now express the general solution of the differential equation at hand:

:K IK F,lm
x = C, sin /--I + C2 cos 1-1 + sin w f (19.24)
lm 1m Klm - w 2

Note that there are two arbitrary constants which are determined from the initial
conditions of the problem. Do not use the results of Eq. 19.6 for these constants,
because we n u t now include the panicular solution in ascertaining the constants.
When f = 0, x = xo and x = xo. We apply these conditions to Fq. 19.24

x, = C,
(19.25)

Solving for the constants, we get

c, = 1,)

Returning to Eq. 19.24, notice that we have the, superposition of two


~~~

harmonic motions-ne with a frequency equal to ,/Kim, the natural fre-


quency w,, of the system, and the other with a frequency w of the “driving
function” (i.e., the nonhomogeneous part of the equation). The frequen-
cies w and w, are not the same in the general case. The phasor representa-
tion then leads us to the fact that since the rotating vectors have different
angular speeds, the resulting motion cannot he represented by a single
phasor, and hence the motion is not harmonic. The two parts of the
motion are termed the trunsient part, corresponding to the complementary
solution, and the sfeudy-sfure part, corresponding to the particular solu-
tion, having frequencies w, and w, respectively. With the introduction of
friction (next section), we shall see that the transient part of the motion
dies out while the steady state persists as long as there is a disturbance
present.
Let us now consider the steady-state part of the motion in Eq. 19.24.
Dividing numerator and denominator by Klm, we have for this motion, which
we denote as x,,:
992 CHAPTER I Y VIBK~VI'IONS

I t will bc useful to study with respect to w / W , the var-istion ofthe inagnitudc


01 the cteady-state amplitodc r,. for C / K = I, ~namcly

shown plotted in Fig. 19.17. A s thc fnrcinp frequency apprimchcs Ihr tiiituriil
frequency. this tertii goes to infinity, ;ind thus the amplitude 01 the fwccd
vibration ;ipprmaches infinily. This i s the ciindition 01 rcwtwii('('. Under such
friction. which uc neglect here but which i s alw:~ys pi-esent.
inplitudc. Also. when very l x g c amplitudes are de\cloped. the
propcrties of the resloring elenietit do not rernain liiicilr, s o that the theory
which predicts infinilc ainpliludcs i s inapplicable. Thus. the linear. fric-
tiunless formulations c m i i o t yield correct amplitudes at resonance in rcal
problems. The condition 01 rcsmancc. howevcr. does indicate that larpc
ainplitudcs are t i l hc expected. Furthertnoir. these ;iniplitudcs can he clan-
gernuc. because larfe force umcentiiltions will hc present in parts 111 the
leni :is well 21s i n the moving body and may resiilt in Oisilstrous
thei-eforc important in innst situations to aboid resimince. If a
dicturharice corresponding IO the iiatuiml frequency i s prcscnt and cannut hc
eliminated. we niay find i t ne ;rry to change either the qtiffness or the ~ i i i i s \
of a system in ordcr to avoid resonance.

From Fig. 19.11 we can conclude that the amplitude w i l l hccorrie stiiall
:isthe frcquency of the disturhancc heconies very h i $ Also. considering the
iimplitude C , for steady-statc moliiin (Cq. 19.23). we see that hclow IC~OIIBIICC
the sign o l t l i i s expression i s positive, and above resonance it i s negative. indi-
cating that below rcsonance the molion i s in phuse with the di.sturbuwr and
ahove resmaticc the iiiotim i s directly 180" o i i f (!fplmw with the disferbanw
SECTION I Y . 6 LINEAR RESTORING FORCE A N D A FORCE VARYING SINUS0II)AI.I.Y WITH TIME 993

Example 19.7
A motor mounted o n springs is constrained by the rollers to move only in
the vertical direction (Fig. 19.18). The assembly weighs 2.6 kN and when
placed carefully on the springs causes a deflection of 2.5 mm. Because of
an unbalance in the rotor, a disturbance results that is approximately sinu-
soidal in the vertical dircction with a frequency equal to the angular speed
of the r ~ t o rThe
. amplitude of this disturbance is 130 N when the motor is
rotating at 1,720 rpm. What is the steady-state motion of this system under
these circumstances if we neglect the mass of the springs, the friction, and
the inertia of the rollers?
The spring constant for the system is
.
Figure 19.18. Motor with
unhalanced rotor

and the natural frequency becomes

,' 1 040 x 106


mn= $ 2,60019.81
~~

= 62.6 radlsec = 9.97 cycleslsec

The steady-statc motion is

= - 1 . 7 2 0 ~ 10-ssin180.1tm

xp = -.01720 sin 180.lr

Note that the driving frequency is above the natural frequency. In


starting up motors and turbines, we must sometimes go through a natural
frequency of the system, and it is wise to get through this zone as quickly
as possible to prevent largc amplitudes from building up.
994 ('HAPTtR IU VIHKA7IONC

Example 19.8
A niass on a spring is shown in f'if. 19.19. The support of tlic spring ill .r'
is made til niove with harnmonic inotiori i n thc vertical direction hy sonie
extcriial agent. This mution i s expressed as u \in o f . If ill f = 0 the mas5
is displaced in a downward position a distance of I i n I'rom the static equi-
librium position and i f it has ill this instant a \peed downward of 3 in./\ec.
what is the position of the mass ill f = 5 sec? T&e (2 = 5 in.. w = IO r;idisrc.
K = SO0 Ihill. and rn = I \lug.

,\r
>
.
.,
>.
ti
10 =
= i in
I O radlsec
= I 5lup
Ill
K = SO0 lhill
1

Le1 us express Newton's law Ibr the miibs. Notr th;il the e x ~ e i i ~ i o n
ol the spring is .r-.x'. Hence,

Replacing x ' by the known function of time. we gcl. upon rearranging the
terinx

This is [he sanic form as Eq. 19.21 for lhe casc where the disturhance is
exerted on the niash directly. The solution, thcn, is

Putting in the numerical \ d u e s (if ~ K i n ! . etc.. we have


.K = C, sin 22.41 + S >cos27.4f + 6.24sin lot in
SECTION 19.6 LINEAR RESTORING FORCE AND A FORCE VARYING SINUSOIDALLY WITH TIME 995
Example 19.8 (Continued)
Now impose the initial conditions to get
I= c,
3 = 22.4C, + (6.24)(10)
Therefore,
C , = -2.65
The motion, then, is given as
x = -2.65 sin 22.41 + cos 22.41 + 6.24 sin 101in.
When I = 5 sec, the position of the mass relative to the lower datum is
given as

(x), = -2.65 sin(22.4)(5) + cos(22.4)(5) + 6.24sin 50 = 1.177 in.

You may approximate the setup of this problem profitably with an elastic
band supporting a small body as shown in Fig. 19.20. By oscillating the free
end of the hand with varying frequency from law frequency to high fre-
quency, you can demonstrate the rapid change of phase between the distur-
bance and the excited motion as you pass through resonance. Thus, at low
frequencies both motions will he in phase and at frequencies well above reso-
nance the motion will he close to being 180" out of phase. Without friction
this change, according to the mathematics, is discontinuous, hut with the
presence of friction (i.e., in a real case) there is actually a smooth, although
sometimes rapid, transition between both extremes.

t
GI/ Elastic
hand

Figure 19.20. Simple resonance and change of phase demonstration


Miichinc
Figure P.lY.60.
.

19.61. A vibrograph is attached rigidly to a diesel engine for What is tlie resonance speed yc\ for this case'? From Probleni
which we want to know the vibration amplitude. If the seismic 19.63, we have
spring-mass system has a natural frequency of I O cycles/sec, and
if the seismic mass vibrates relative to the vibrograph with an I' = A . 2nvt
sin ~

amplitude of I .27 mm when the diesel is turning over at I,OoO 'pm, 11 ~ (2?cV/L)2(W/yK)I L
what is the amplitude of vibration of the diesel in the direction of
the vihrograph'? The seismic mass weighs 4.5 N. See Problem 19.65. A cantilever beam of length L has an electric motor A
19.K before doing this problem. weighing 100 N fastened to the end. The tip of the cantilever
beam descends 12 nim when the motor is attached. If the center of
muss of the armature of the niotor is a distance 2 mm from the
19.62. Explain how you could devise an instrument to measure axis of rotation of the motor, what is tlie amplitude of vibration of
torsi(ina1 vihrations of a shaft in a manner analogous to the way the niotor when it is rotating a1 1,750 rpm'! The arinalwe weighs
the vihrograph measures linear vibrations of a machine. Such 40 N. Neglect the mass ofthe beam.
instruments are in wide use and are called torsioyrcrphs. What
would he the relation of the amplitude uf oscillations as picked up
by your apparatus to that of the shaft being measured'? See Proh
lem 19.60 before doing this prublem. A

19.63. A trailer of weight W moves over a washboard road at a I L

constant speed V to the right. The road is approximated by a sinu- Figure P.19.65.
soid of amplitude A and wavelength 1.. Ifthe wheel B is small, the
center of the wheel will have a motion x closely resembling the 19.66. Suppose that a 2-N block is glued to the top of the motor
aforementioned sinusoid. If the trailer is connected to the wheel in Problem 19.65, where the maximum strength of the bond is
through a lineill. spring of stiffness K , fornulate the steady-state 'h N. At what minimuin angular speed w of the motor will the
equation of motion x' for the trailer. List all assumptions. What block fly off'!
speed causes resonance'?
19.67. An important reason for mounting rotating atid recipro-
cating machinery on springs is to decrease the transmission of
vibration to the foundatiun supporting the machine. Show that the
amplitude of force Iranmitted to the gtound, E,w for such cases is
I'

A
X

where 4, isthe disturbing force from lie machine. 'The factor


k-l,+ 11/11 - (fu/WJ2]l is called the relutive tr~msmi.sxionjircror.
Figure P.19.63. Show that, unless the springs are soft, (0 < ~ 0 / 4 2 )the
, use of
springs actually increases the transmission of vibratory lorces
to the foundation.
19.64. In Problem 19.63, compute the amplitude of motion of
the trailer for the following data: 19.68. In Example 19.7, what is the amplitude of the force tiatis-
mitted to the foundation'? What must k of the spring system be t o
W = 5.34kN
decrease the amplitude by one-half? See Problem 19.67.
V = I6 kmihr
19.69. A machine weighing W N COlltdinS a reciprocating mass
K = 43.8 N/mm of weight w N having a vertical motion relative to the machine
1. = IOm given approximately as I' = A sin f u f . l h e machine is mounted
on springs having a total spring constant K . This machine is
A = 100mm guided so thut it can move only in the vertical direction. What is

997
1.

Figure P.19.72.

1Y.73. wo cphcreh each of mass M = 2 kg arc wcldsd I,> ii light


rod that i s p i n n e d at 8.A s e c m d light rod AC i s wcldrd 10 the h t I<
rod. At A we apply a disturbance <, sin 01. At the other end c'. Figure P.lY.75.

998
SECTION 19.1 LINEAR RESTORING FORCE WITH VISCOUS DAMPING 999

19.7 Linear Restoring Force with


Viscous Damping
We shall now consider the case in which a special type o f friction is present.
In the chapters on statics, you will recall, we considered coulombic or dry
friction for the cases of sliding and impending motion. This force was pro-
portional to the normal force at the interface of contact and dependent on the
material of the bodies. At this time. we shall consider the case of bodies sep-
arated from each other by a thin film o f fluid. The frictional force (called a
dumping force) is independent of the material of the bodies but depends on
the nature of the fluid and is proportional for a given fluid to the relative
velocity of the two bodies separated by the film. Thus,

where c is called the coefficient of dumping. The minus sign indicates that the
frictional force opposes the motion (i.e, the friction force must always have a
sign opposite to that of the relative velocity).
In Fig. 19.21 is shown the spring-mass model with damping present.
We shall investigate possible motions consistent with a set of given initial
conditions. The differential equation of motion is

Figure 19.21. Spring-mass system with damping

In standard form, we get

(19.29)

This is a homogeneous, second-order, differential equation with constant


coefficients. We shall expect two independent functions with two arbitrary
constants to form the general solution to this equation. Because of the pres-
ence of the first derivative in the equation, we cannot use sines or cosines for
trial solutions, since the first derivative changes their form and prevents a
cancellation o f the time function. Instead, we use ept wherep is determined so
as to satisfy the equation. Thus, let
x = C!eP'
I1 uill he i c l p i u l IO consider lhrce ciises here.

Case A
SECTION 19.7 LINEAR RESTORING FORCE WITH VlSCOllS DAMPING 1001

Case B

,,' K
- c< -
2m I m

This means that we have a negative quantity under the root in Eq.
19.30. Extracting I-I = i, we can then write p as Ibllows:

The solutiun then becomes

x = exp[-(c/Zm)t]{C, exp[iiK/m - (d2m)' t ]

- ( ~ / 2 r nt]}) ~ (19.33)

From complex-number theory, we know that e'' may he replaced by


cos 8 + i s i n 8 and thus the equation above can he put in the form

Collecting terms and replacing sums and differences of arbitrary constants


including i by olher arbitrary constants, we get the result:

The quantity in brackets represents a harmonic motion which has a frequency


less than the free undamped natural frequency of the system. The exponential
term to the left of the brackets, then, serves to decrease continually the ampli-
tude of this motion. A plot of the displacement against timc for this case is
illustrated i n Fig. 19.23, where the upper dashed envclope corresponds i n lorn1
to the exponential function c , - ' ' ~ ~ ~ 'We
' ' ~ .cidl this motinn ~ ~ m l e ~ l i m ~motinn.
peil

Figure 19.23. Undurdainped motiiiti.

Case C

Since this i s tlic dividing line hctwcen the overdamped case and one i n
which oscillation i s possihlc. thc innlion i s tcrmcd a <.rifii.ull\. rluinpcd
motion. We have here idmriml roots fnr 13 given a s

imd accordingly lor such a case thc gcncral solurinn to Eq. 19.29 according to
the theory of differential equation is then

(19.37)

First we see from this cquation that wc do t i o f have an oscill:itory motion.


Also. you w i l l recall Srnni the calciiluc that iis f goes to infinity an exponential
o f the form r *'. with A a positi\'c constant. goes to Lero faster than Ci goes to
infinity. Accordingly, Fig. 19.22 ciln bc used to pictui-e the plot 0 f . x versus I
lor this case.
The damping constant for this case i s called the ,,,?ticul damping con-
slant arid i s denntcd a s (;.,~.'The m l u c nt'c;., clearly is

c',., = 2 , Krn (19.38)

I t should he clear that. for a damping constant less than ccr, we w i l l have
undcrdainped motion whilc lor il damping cnnstant greater than c ; . ~ we w i l l
have overdamped motion.
In all the preceding cases for damped lrcc vibration. the remaining step
for il cnniplcte evaluation of the snlution i s to compute the arbitrary constants
from the initial condition? nf the particular prnhlem. Note that i n discussing
damped motinn we shall consider the "natural frequency" of the system to he
that OS the corresponding u n d m ~ p c dcase arid shall refer to the iiclual fre-
quency OS the molinn as the frequency (11 Irec. damped inntion.
SECTION 19.7 LINEAR RESTORING FORCE WITH VISCOUS DAMPING 1003

Example 19.9
Springs and dashpots are used in packaging delicate equipment in crating
so that during transit the equipment will be protected from shocks. In Fig.
1'1.24, we have shown a piece of equipment whose weight W is 500 N. It
is SuppOrted in il crate by one spring and two dashpots (or shock
absorbers). The value of K for the spring is 30 N/mm and the coefficient of
dunping, c, is I Nlmmlsec for each dashpot. The crate is held above a
rigid floor at a height h of 150 mm. It is then released and allowed to hit
the floor in a plastic impact. What is the maximum deflection of W relative
to the crate?

.', _n .,".,iLU1-*~Ln
1"
. .
Figure 19.24. Packaging to reduce breakage.

As a first step, we compute the criticul dumping to find what regime


we are in.
. ~~~

ccr = 2 4 K m = 2,(30)(1,000)(500)/~
(8)
= 2,473 N/m/sec

The total damping coefficient for our case is

ells, = (2)(1)(1,000) = 2,000 N/m/sec

We are therefore underdamprd. The motion is then given as follows:

Note that
I..I I-____
SECTION 14 1 LINEAR RESTORING FORCE WITH VISCOUS DAMPING 1005

A block W of 200 N (see Fig. 19.25) moves on a film of oil which is


1 m m in thickness under the block. The area of the boltom surface of
the block is 2 x 10" mm2. The spring constant K is 2 N/m. If the
weight is pulled in the .K direction and released, what is the nature of
the motion'?

. I mm
Figure 19.25. S p k - m a s s on film of oil.

You may have learned in physics that friction force per unit area @e.,
shear stress) on the block W from the oil is given by Newton's viscosity
law as:

where t i s the shear stress (force per unit area), p is the coefficient u f v i s -
cnsify (not to be confused with the coefficient of friction), and &lay is the
slope of the velocity profile at the block surface (see Fig. 19.26). Now the
oil w i l l stick to the surfaces of the block Wand the ground surface. And so

Figure 19.26. Slopc of velocity profile at bottom of W


1006 CHAI'TCK I'J VIBRATIONS

Example 19.10 (Continued)


we ciin ;ipproximatc the \elocity ~profilcas shown i n Fig. 10.27. whcrc wc
j
: h i i uscd straight-linc profile coniiwciiig zerv velocity iit thc hottom and
' ~ ii
vclocicy .i of the hlock W i l t the top. Such ii i".ocedure fives p o d resrilt\
when lhc film of o i l i s ihin as i n the Iprcsciil cat. Thc desircd slope
1
j ( a V I ~ y J , , ,i~s cthen
, approxinialed iis

The coefficieni of viscosity ciiii he I'oiind ill h;rndhooks. For our ciisc. ICI
us say that p = . ~ l O X ON-seclin'.
It i s iiow an easy iiialter to coinpuie ~ l i ccocf(icicnL o l damping
Thus. the friction f i ~ r c ei s

x 10'/10") = -I.6OO.i N (c)

Thiis. (' = 1.600. The critical damping for the prohleiii i s

o = ,311 rad/sec = ,0495 cycleshec


SECTION 19.8 LINEAR RESTORING FORCE, VISCOUS DAMPLING, AND A HARMONIC DISTURBANCE 1007

“19.8 linear Restoring Force, Viscous


Damping, and a Harmonic
Disturbance
In the spring-.mass problem shown in Fig. 19.28 we include driving function
F(, cos wt along with viscous damping. The differential equation in the stan-
dard form then becomes

(19.39)

L F, cos mf

Figure 19.28. Spring-mass system with damping.

Equation 19.39 is a nonhomogeneous equation. The general solutinn will he the


homogeneous solution worked out in Section 19.7, plus any particular solution
of Eq. 19.39.
Beceuse there is a first derivative on the left side of the equation, we
cannot expect a particular solution of the form D cos wi to satisfy the differ-
ential equation. Instead, from the method of undetermined cneficirnts we
shall try the following:
x = Dsinwt+ Ecoswt ( I 9.40)
I’

The constants D and E are tn be adjusted to facilitate a solution. Substituting


into the differential equation, we write
C C
-Dw2sinwt- Ew2coswf + - o D c o s w t - - w E s i n o f
m m
K K F
+ m Dsin wt + m E c o s w t = m coswt
~ ~~

Collecting the terms, we have

We set each coefficient of the time functions equal to zero and thus get two
simultaneous equations in the unknowns E and D:
Rearranging and replacing Khn hy a),,'. we get

I)(Ol~ ~ ( 4 )+ 1: (;;') = 0
SFCTION 19 X LINEAR RESTORING FORCE, VISCOUS DAMPLING. AND A HARMONIC DISTURBANCE 1009

(w' -a:)' + (wclm)'


Figure 19.29. Phamr diagram.

where the ainplitudc A i s given as

and v :re a, the phase angle, is given as

- tan-l w('
(19.45)
K - mw?
We may express the amplitude A in yet another form by dividing
numerator and denominator i n Eq. 19.44 by K and by recalling from Eq.
19.38 that thc ratio 2\iKm/ccr is unity. Thus, we get
F,/K
A =
where b;,/K = a%,,i s the static deflection. The term

is called the I~~I,~II;~,,~~I~;,IJI which i s a dimensionless facloI giving the


,fii<.~,,r
amplitude of steady-state tnntioii per i t t i i t static deflection. Acciirdinply. this
fdctor fhr a given system i s useful for examining thc cffccts of fiequcncy
change\ or damping changes on the steady-state vihration mplitude. A plot
of the magnilicatioti factor versus wlw,, for various wlues of c./ccr i s slinwii in
Fig. 19.30. We scc Irom this plcit that s m a l l vibrations result when co i s kept
far from w,,. Additiiinally. note that niaxiiiiiiiii amplitude does iiot occur at
resonancc hut actually ill Irequencics somewhat hclow resonance. Only wlieli
tlie damping goeh t(i z.ero docs the mixitnuin ;implitudc occur at resoiiaiicc.
However, for light damping we can usually consider that whcn wlw,, = I.
wc lliivr an amplitude very close to the milxiinuni amplitudc possible for tlie
system.
SECTION 19.8 LINEAR RESTORING FORCE, VISCOUS DAMPLINC, AND A HARMONIC DISTURBANCE 101 1

Example 19.11
A vibrating ruble is a machine that can be given harmonic oscillatory
motion over a range of amplitudes and frequencies. It is used as a test
apparatus for imposing a desired sinusoidal motion on a device.
In Fig. 19.31 is shown a vibrating tablr with a device bolted to it.
The device has in it a body B of mass 16. I Ibm supported by two springs
each of stiffness equal to 30 Ibiin. and a dashpot having a damping con-
stant c equal to 6 Iblftkec. If the table has been adjusted for a vertical
motion x’ given as sin 40r in. with f in seconds, compute:
1. The steady-state amplitude of motion for body B .
2. The maximum number of R ’ S acceleration that body B is subjected to
for steady-state motion.
3. The maximum force that body B exerts on the vibrating table during
steady-state motion.

Figure 19.31. A device on a vibrating table.

Measuring the vertical position of body B from the static-equilih-


rium position with coordinate x, we have from Newton’s law:

Mi + K ( x - x’)
+ c ( i - i’) =0 (ai

Using P sin W I to represent .r’for now, we have

Y +- i
K --x = -C-PcO
+ -M os~r KP . Of
+--sin
M M M (bi

Letting CPW = F , and KP = b-2.we have


i
SECTION 19.8 IJNEAR RESTORING FORCE, VISCOUS DAMPLING, AND A HARMONIC DISTURBANCE 1013
Example 19.11 (Continued)
i n= -Am2 cos(mt -a)

= (1,600)(.25) = 400 ft/secz (E)

The maximum force transmitted to the body by the springs and dash-
pot during steady-state motion is established clearly when the body B has
its greatest acceleration in the upward direction. We have for the maxi-
mum force F,, on noting that xp = 0 whenxp is maximum:

= 16.1 .t ($)(400) = 216 Ib (h)

If there were no spring-dashpot system between B and the vibratory


table, the maximum force transmitted to B would be

= 16.1 + ($)[(&)(40jz] = 82.8 Ib (1)

We see from Eq. (f) that the amplitude of the induced motion on B
is three times what it would be if there were no spring-damping system
present to separate B from the table. And from Eqs. (h) and (i) we see that
the presence of the spring-damping system has resulted in a considerable
increase in force acting on body B. Now the use of springs and dashpots
for suspending or packaging equipment is generally for the purpose of
reducing--not increasing-the amplitude of forces acting on the sus-
pended body. The reason for the increase in these quantities for the dis-
turbing frequency of 40 radlsec is the fact that the natural frequency of the
system is 37.8 radlsec, thus putting us just above resonance. To protect the
body B for disturbances of 40 radlsec, we must use considerably softer
springs.
As an exercise at the end of the section you will be asked in Problem
19.90 to compute K for permitting only a maximum of i in. amplitude of
vibration for this problem.
1014 ('HAPTRK 1'4 VIRKAIIOUS

"19.9 Oscillatory Systems with Multi-


Degrees of Freedom
Wc shall coiiccrii oitrscl!cs liere with ii very simple \ystcm lhal l h a h t u o
degree\ o i ircedom. iind we sliall he ahlc t o getiefiili/c i n i m t h i s hilnple ciisc.
In the syhtem o i inashes shown iii Fig. 1 W 2 . the niiisscs arc q u a l . a s are rlie
~ s(he outcr hpririgs. Wc nc:.lecl f r i c h n . iuiiidagc. ctc. H o u
.:pring c o i ~ s t i t i ~01
c:ui we dcscrihe tlic iiiolion 1ii tlie i i i a s w w h w q u r t i l IO an) imposed sct 0 1
iiiitiiil coiiditions'?

I t y w j imagine that tlic miisscs ire at ;my (ither n(iiilrivia1 piisition, you w i l l
srill arrive at ttic a h w c quiitions.
Because h d i dependent \';iriahles appear i t 1 hiith differential equations.
lhcy tire termed ,siijti,l/~i,t~,~,,,,~ dil'lerentiiil equations. Wc rearrange the cquil-
Lion5 to the I d l o w i n g stand;ird lorm:

Finding a solution i s equivalent to iinding two functions o i time .v,(l) and


.x,(/), which when siib\titutcd inlo I I L 1').4X
~ ( a ) and ih) reduce eacli equation
IO iui identity. Only \ccimd ilei-ibativcs and /.erotti dcrivativr:, appeiu i n t l i c x
equations, and wc wuolrl thu.: cxpccl that sine or ciicine f u n c l i ~ i ~ oti s rime
would yield a poshihle sdutioii. And since hoth .\,and ~ t appcar l i n tlic same
SECTION 19.9 OSCILLATORY SYSTEMS WITH MULTI-DEGREES OF FREEDOM 1015

equation, these time functions must he of the same form in order to allow a
cancellation of the time function. A trial solution, therefore, might be:
x, = C, sin(pt + a) (19.49aj
x , = C, sin(pt +a) (19.49b)

where C , , C,,, a,and p are as yet undetermined. Substituting into Eq. 19.48
and canceling out the time function, we get:
K K
- C , p * + -mc , + ~ ' m
(C,-c,)=o (I9.50aj

- c 2 p ~ +K- c 2 - - K2
(cI-C2)=o (19.50b)
m m

Rearranging the above equations, we write:

(I 9.5 la)

One way of ensuring the satisfaction of this equation is to have C , = 0


and C2 = 0. This means, from Eqs. 19.49 (a) and (h), that x, and x2 are
always zero, which corresponds to the static equilibrium position. While this
is a valid solution, since this static equilibrium is a possible motion, the result
is trivial. We now ask: Is there a means of satisfying these equations without
setting C , and C, equal to zero'!
To answer this, solve for C,and C, in terms of the coefficients, as if they
were unknowns in the above equations. Using Cramer's rule, we then have:
10 -K,/m
10 - p 2
__+ Klrn + K,/m
= -p2 + Klrn + K,/m -K,lm
-K,/m -p2 + Kim + K,/m
l-p2 + Kim + K,lm O!

-p2 + Klm + K&


Notice that the determinant in the numeratnr is in each case zero. If the denom-
inator is other than zero, we must have the trivial solution C, = C, = 0, the
significance of which we have just discussed. A necessmy condition for a n o m
trivial solution is that the denominator also he zero, for then we gel the indeter-
minate form 010 for C, and C., Clearly, C , and C , can then have possible
values other than zero, and so the required condition for a nontrivial solution is:
i-p2 + Klrn + K,lm -K,/m
(19.53)
l-K,lm -p2 + Kim + K,/m
Carrying out this determinant multiplication. we gct:

i-,>2 + K
lii
+ "2)-
Ill
~ [t;1- (19.541

Takiiig the roots 01 both sides. wc have:


, K
-,r + 111 + K,,;, = i
K,
( I'l.55)

'ru~~l
values irlpLwtisly the necessary condition wc trnvc inipiised. If u'c usc
the positive ronts. the \'illties cilp are:
,K
11
' = ',* ,,)
,'.
-
= ,,
;11i
,K
~ +
2K,
Ill
~-~ (10.56)

u here and 11. :I-C found l o r tlic pluc and i l i i i r i i s cascs. re\pecti\cly. of the
right side 01Eq. 19.55.
Let u h i i o u return to liqs. 19.5 I ( a ) and (h) t o awe!-tain what furthcr
restrictions we may have to inipohe to cnsure a x i l u t i o l r , hecause t h e w q u a -
tions form the critcrion t o r acceptancc of il set of functions ;IS solutions.
Employing , K i i n I'ijri, i n Eq. I%SI (a). we hii\c:

From this equation u c sce that when we iisc t h i i \ ~ I u co i p i t i s iiccesvary that


C , = C. to satisly the cquation. The w n c conclusions c:in hc reached h)
einploying Eq. l~),?l(h). We can now skrtc il perniissihlc xlutii,n to the dif-
ferential equation. U s i n s A as the anipliludc i n placc 0 1 Cl = C,. we have:

If w c cxamine the sccond \ d u e o l 11. we find th;it t.or [hi. viiluc it is


requircd Illat c', = -C,. '['huh il we use B lor C , and iise :is llic arbitrary
\ d u e in the sinc lunction, ;inother possible solulio1i i i :

Let LIS consider each oJ Ilicsr ioliitioiis. I n the lirrr case. thc i n o l i o i i \ 01
hoth masse\ arc i n phare u'ith ciicli other. haw the same aniplitude. and thus
movc togethcr with simple h;innnnic inotio1i u d i ii tiilltirill lrequcncy K/,u ,
h i -this moIio1i. the ccntcr spi.ing is iii>teulendcd or comprcsscd. and. ?itice
SECTION 19.9 OSCILLATORY SYSTEMS WITH MULTI-DECREES OF FREEDOM 1017

the mass of the spring has been neglected, it has no effect on this motion.
This explains why the natural frequency has such a simple formulation.
The second possihle independent solution is one in which the ampli-
tudes are equal for both masses but the masses are 180" out of phase. Each
mass oscillates harmonically with a natural frequency greater than the pre-
ceding motion. Since the masses move in opposite directions in the manner
described, the center of the middle spring must be stationaly for this motion.
It is a s if each mass were vibrating under the action of a spring of constant K
and the action of half the length of a spring with a spring constant K2 (Fig.
19.33), which explains why the natural frequency for this motion is
< ( K + 2 K , ) / m . (It will be left for you to demonstrate in an exercise that
halving the length of the spring doubles the spring constant,)

Figure 1Y.33. Bodieh IXO" nut of phase

Each of these motions as given by Eqs. 19.58 and 19.59 is called a natural
mode. The first mode refers to the motion of lower natural frequency. and the
second mode identifies the one with the higher natural frequency. It is known
from differential equations that the general solution is the sum of the two
solutions presented:

Four constants are yet to be determined: A. B, a, and p. These are the con-
stants of integration and are determined by the initial conditions of the
motion-that is, the velocity and position of each mass at time r = 0.
From this discussion we can make the following conclusions. The gen-
eral motion nf the system undcr study is the superposition of two modes of
motion of harmonic nature that have distinct natural frequencies with ampli-
tudes and phase angles that are evaluated to fit the initial conditions. Thus the
basic modes are the "building blocks" of the general free motion.
If the masses, as well as the springs, were unequal, the analysis would still
produce two natural frequencies and mode shapes, but these would neither be as
simple as the special Case we have worked out nor, perhaps, as intuitively obvious.
As we discussed in the first paragraph of this section, two natural frequen-
cies correspond to the two degrees of freedom. In the general case of n degrees
of freedom, tlierc will be n natural frequencies, and the general free vibrations
will be the superposition of n modes of motion that have proper amplitudes and
are phased together in such a way that they satisfy 2n initial conditions.
--
,.
: K,
\

Figure P.lY.76.

9.77 In Pruhlem 19.76. !tie follawing datd apply:

W = 44s N
K , = 8.8 Nlirlin
K , = IJ.0 N l m n l
,' = 825 N l m k c
l Y . X l . ,\ rod 01 length 2; 111 and wcight ?OO N i s shown in the
6 the system underdamped. werdalnpcd. o i ~ crilially damped'! If \tatic-cquilihriuni position suppol-tcd hy a spring of stiffness K =
he weight W is released 150 nun above i l s static-eiluilibriutll C o n - 14 Nlmm. 'Shc wd is crmnccted til a dashpot having a damping
'iguratiun. what are the spccd and position 0 1 thc hlock after i m r (. 01 64 Nlml\eo. II an Itnpul.;ivr torque givzs the rod an
I scc'! What force is trammitted to the fbundalion at that instant'! : ~ n p l a rspwd clockwise ,)I 4 radlsec at the position shuwn. what
IS the pmition 01point .1 at I = .2 scc'.'

19.78. The damping ~ ~ n s t i l nc ' lf r r r the body is ! IhlIUvx I f . at


ti equilibrium positim. the hody is suddenly p v c n a velocity o1
I O ftlscc l o the right. what will the Ircquency of i t \ inlolion he?
What i h Ihc positiun 01 the mass a1 r = 5 x c ? r
K = 2 Ihlin
M = I SI"&!

Figure P.lY.78. Figure P.1Y.XI.


19.82. A spherical ball of weight 134 N is welded to a vertical 19.84. A disc A with a mass of 5 kg is constrained during
light rod which in turn is welded at B 10 a horizontal rod. A rotation about its axis hy a torsional Spring having a constant
spring of stiffness K = 8.8 N/mm and a damper c having a value K , equal to 2 x IO-' N-mlrdd. The disc i h in a journal having
179 Nlnilsec are cnnnected t o the horizontal rod. If A is displaced a diameter 2 tnm larger than the disc. Oil having a viscosity
75 mm to thr right, how long docs it take for it to return to its .0085 N-sec/mL fills the outer space between disc and journal.
vertical configuration? If we assume a linear profile tor the oil film, what is the fre-
quency of oscillation o f the disc if it is rotated from its equilih-
iium position and then released'? The diameter of the dirc is
40 mm and its length is 30 mm. The oil acts only on the disc's
outer periphery.

1.6 m

1
Figure P.19.X4.
Figure P.19.82.

19.83. Cylinder A nf weight 200 N slides down a vertical cylin-


19.85. A block W weighing 60 N is released from rest at a
drical chute. .4 film of oil of thickness . I mm separates the
configuration 100 mm above its equilihrium position. It rides
cylinder from the chute. If the air pressure before and behind
on a film of oil whose thickness is .1 mm and whose coeffi-
the cylinder is maintained at the same value of 15 p i g , what is the
cient of viscosity is ,00950 N-sec/m'. If K is 50 N/m, how far
maximum velocity that the cylinder can attain hy gravity?
down the incline will the block move'! The block is .20 m on
The coefficicnl of viscosity of the oil is ,00800 N-sec/m2.
each edge.

Figure P.19.83. Figure P.19.85.

1019
19.86. In Pruhlcm 19.XS. qct up t w o s i r i i ~ l t a n e cquntioni
~~s to
letemiinc the spring cullstant K su that. alter W is rrleascd. W
mnrs hack to its equilibrium position with n o mcillatiun. AI a
hmt proicct, s d v c tor K using a crmputcr.

Figure P.19.89.

I---- IO0 imni I-. .


Figure P.19.87.

19.89. A furcc F = 15 sin 21 N act': on a b l w k having :t weight


01 ?US N . A \pring having stillness K of 550 N l m and a da5hpot
having a dumping factor < ' u l hX N-scclm a i r conncctcd to lllc Figure P.lY.91

IO20
19.92. A platform weighing 222 N deflects the spring 50 mm $19.94. In Problem 19.15, if we include the inertial effects ot
when placed carefully on the spring. A motor weighing 22 N is rod BC, hiiw many degrees of freedom are there? If rod HC
then clamped 011 top of the platform and rotdtes an eccentric mass weighs 5 Ib, set up the differential equations of motion for the
rn which weighs I N. The mass rn is displaced 150 mm from the system.
axis of rotatiim and rotates at an a n g u l i speed of 28 radlsec.
The viscous damping present causes a resistance to the motion of
the platform of 275 N-mlsec. What is the steddy-state amplitude
of thc motion of the platform? See Problem 19.91 before doing
this Droblem.

*19.95 Two bodies of equal inass, M = I slug, are attached i o


w d k by springs having equal spring constants K , = 5 Iblin. and
are connected t u each other by a spring having a spring constant
K z = I Ib/in. If the mass on the left is relcased from a position
(x,)" = 3 in. at f = 0 with zero velocity and the mass at the right
is stationary at = 0 at this instant, what is the position of each
mass at the time t = 5 sec? The coordinates .li, and x2 are mea-
sured from the static-equilibrium positions ofthe body.

Figure P.19.92.

I I
19.93. A body weighing 143 N is connected by a light rod to a Figure P.19.95.
spring of stiffness K equal to 2.6 Nlmm and to a dashpot having
a damping factor (1. Point B has a given motion x' of 30.5 sin t mm
with I in seconds. If the center of A is to have an amplitude of
steady-state motion of 20 mm, what muyt c be'!

-1 .4 m
4- *19.96. Let K z i n Fig. P.lY.95 be very small compared tn K ,
1 Assume one mass has been released 81 f = 0 from a position dis-
placed from equilibrium with zero velocity, while the other mass
is released lrom thc initial sfationary ]pusition at that instant with
I zero velocity. Show that one inass will have a maximum velocity

\I\/\/\
K .I while the other will have a minimum velocity and that there will
be a mntinwal transfer of kinetic energy from one mass to the
other at a frequency equal to the heat frequency of the natural fre-
quencics of the system.

Figure P.19.93. Hinr: Study the phasors A cos <+I


"K
and A cos

1021
1022 CHAPTFK l Y VIBRATIONS

19.10 Closure
This inlroduclory study ofvihralion hrings ((1 ii c l o x [lie prcscnt study d ' [ ~ a - -
t i c k and rigid-hody mcchaiiics. AI you progress to the study of def(irtn;ihle
inedia i n your courscs i n solid and fluid mechanics y o u w i l l find that particle
inechanics imd, to :i l e s w exLc111 rigid-hody mechanics. bill forin c(irncr-
\lories fiir t h e x disciplines. And iii your studies invdr,inf the design of
m:ichine\ and the pcriorm;incr oi vcliicle\ you w i l l firid rigid-hody rncchanics
indispensahlc.
I t should he rcdiLed. hii er. th;ii w e have by 110 incan\ said thc kist
word oii particle mil rigid-hody iiieclimics. MOIK advanced srudics ill
cmphasiie 1hc variiitioiiill approach introduced in statics. With the use i i i the
ciilculus oi variation .uch topics as Haniiltoii's principle, Lagrangc's equii-
tion," and Hamiltori~lac(ihitheory w i l l he prc\enird and y i i u w i l l then \ee a
ginxtcr unity hctwecii mdi;inics and other areas of physics such a s electro-
magnetic themy atid u'iivc mechanic\. A l w thc special thciiry of rclali\ il)
will niost surely hc considcrcd.
Finally. i n yuuI studies of niodcrn physics you w i l l coiiie t i l more full)
understand the liiiiitii~ioiis0 1 cliisiiciil mecliiinics when you iirc inlroduccd to
quantum niechiiiiics.
19.97. If K , = 2K2 = I .8K3, what should Ks be for a period of
free vibration uf .2 sec'? The mass M is 3 kg.

A B

K = 50 lbhn
Figure P.19.97.

19.98. In Prohlem 19.55, determine the natural frequency of


the system. If the mass is deflected 2 in. and then reledhcd,
determine the displacement from equilibrium after 3 sec. Finally,
determine the total distance traveled during this time.
Figure P.19.100.

19.101. What is the radius of gyration of the speedboat about a


vertical axis going through the center of gravity, if it is noted that
the boat will swing ahout this verticiil axis one time per second?
The mass of the boat is 500 kg.
Figure P.19.98.

19.99. Find the natural frequency of motion of body A for small


rotation of rod BD when we neglect the inertial effects of rod BD.
The spring constant K2 is .9 N/mm and the spring constant K , is
1.8 N/mm. The weight of block A is 178 N. Neglect friction
everywhere. Kod BD weighs 44 N.

Figure P.19.101.

19.102. A rod of length L and mas M is suspended from a fric-


tionless roller. If a small impulsive torque is applied to the rod
when it is in a state of rest, what is the natural frequency of oscil-
lation about this state of rest?

Figure P.19.99.

19.100. What is the equivalent spring constant for small oscilla-


tions about the shaft AB? Neglect all mass except the block at B,
which weighs 100 Ib. The shear modulus of elasticity G for the
shaft is 15 x IOh psi. What is the natural frequency of the system
for torsional oscillation of small amplitude'?
i
Figure P.IY.102.

102:
c \
.K ti.
.
\
.
\

I023
Integration Formulas

xvii
22. j sin 1'8 cos m0 d0 = - '
Im
~~ cos 2 m H

24. G sin 0 dH = sin 0 - H cos 0

25. j 0 c m H d O = c ( i s H + H s i n H
Computation of Principal
Moments of Inertia
We now turn to the problem of computing the principal moments of
inertia and the directions of the principal axes for the case where we do not
have planes of symmetry. It is unfortunate that a careful study of this impor-
tant calculation is beyond the level of this text. However, we shall present
enough material to permit the computation of the principal moments of iner-
tia and the directions of their respective axes.
The procedure that we shall outline is that of extremizing the mass
moment of inertia at a point where the inertia-tensor components are known
for a reference xvz. This will be done by varying the direction cosines I, m,
and n of an axis k so as to extremize Ikk as given by Eq. 9.13. We accordingly
set the differential of I,, equal to zero as follows:
dl,, = 211_ dl + 2m1, dm + 2nlu dn
-211, d m - 2 m l _ dl - 21lXz dn (11.1)
-2nlc dl - 2mI,, dn - 2nlyz dm = O

Collecting terms and canceling the factor 2, we get


(II_ - mI,yy- nlxz)dl+ ( - l I x ~+ m l _ - nIy,)dm
+ (-11, - mIvz + nl,,)dn = 0 (11.2)

If the differentials dl, dm, and dn were independent we could set their respec-
tive coefficients equal to zero to satisfy the equation. However, they are not
independent because the equation
/2 + m 2 + n2 = I (11.3)
must at all times be satisfied. Accordingly, the differentials of the direction
cosines must be related as follows':
Id1 + m d m + ndn = 0 (11.4)
'Weare t h w cxuemizing I,, in the presence of a constraining equation

xix
XX APPENDIX I1 COMPUTATION OF PRINW'AL MOMENTS OF INERIW,

We can o f course consider any two dillerentials a s independent. The third i s


then established i n accordance with the equation above.
We shall tiow introduce thc Lrigrrmgr ~ n u l ~ i p l Ai ~ to
~ r facilitate the
extremizing process. This constant i s an arbitrary constant at this stage of the
calculation Multiplying Eq. 11.4 by ;L and suhtracting Eil. 11.4 from Eq. 11.2
we get whcn collecting tertiih:

[ f i t-( A J I -
I
- it,,,,ii + [- i l >+i - i;)/17 -
1
i l p dni
+ [ - I ~ -, / / , : w r + i f . ~- ~ ) n ] < / n= ( I (11.51

Let us next consider that in and I I are independent uariablcs arid consider the
value of A s o chosen that the coefficient o f d l i s zero. l h a t is.

(Is, - A)/ - ItVm- f s , i r = 0 (11.6)

With the f i r s t tern1 Eq. 11.5 dispiihed of in ttiir way. we arc left with diffcren-
tiirls din nnd (hi, which :ire indrpendenl. Accordingly. we ciiii \et thcir respec-
Live coefficients equal to z e n i i n ordcr to satisfy the equation. Hence. we have
in addition to Ey. 11.6 the following equations:
-Itt/ + - A)lIl -~/,:I1 = 0
-1,:) - + ( 1 . ~- A I I I = o (11.7)

A necessary condition for the solution ill a set o i direction cosines I , m. ;uid 11.
Srom Eqs. 11.6 and 11.7. which does not violate Eq. 11.3' i s that the detcrmi-
nant of the coefficients of these variables he zero. Thus:

-.A!

-It:
-la,
-a)
-1,.
1::;
(/::-a)
1 = i) (11.81

This results i n a cubic equntion for which wc can show there are three real
roots for A. Substituting these roots into a n y two if Eqs. 11.6 and 11.7 plus Eq.
11.3. we can delerminc three direction cosines for e;ich root. Thcce are thc
direction cosines S i x the principal axes measured rclative to .q:.We could gel
the principal moments of inertia next hy substituting a set ill these direction
cosines into Eq. 9.13 and solving for lAA. However. that i s not necessary. siiicc
i t can be shown lliat the thrcc I.;ipranpe inultiplicrs (ii-c the principal nioinciith
o f inertia.
Additional Data
for the Ellipse
If we restrict our attention to the case of an ellipse, as shown in Fig. IV.l, we
can compute the length of the major diameter (usually called the major axis)
by solving for r from Eq. 12.34 with p set equal to zero, separately for 0 = 0
and for 0 = z, and then adding the results.
Y

Figure IV.1. Ellipse.

Thus,

Therefore,
rI + r2 = 2a = ~p ('I-+-)
+€
1
1- E

Solving for a, we get

a=-
EP (IV.2)
1- €

xxi
xxii APPENDIX 111 ADDITIONAL DATA FOR THE ELLIPSE

The term a is the semimajor diameter. Tu determine the semiminor diameter,


b, we consider point C on the trajectory in Fig. IV.1. Distance rc is indicated
a s f i n the diagram, and the distance from the focus.f, to the center at M is 3.
Using the basic definition of a conic, we can say:

Noting the shaded right triangle in the diagram. we can write

f = \' 3 2 + g' (1V.4)


By substituting Eq. IV.4 into equation IV3, squaring hotti sides, and rearrang-
ing, we get

h2 + 87 3)Z
= €?(/I + (1V.S)
Observing Fig. IV. I and noting Eq. IV. I , we can express the distance 8 as
follows:

Substituting Eq. IV.6 into Eq. IV.5. we get

From Eq. IV.2 we see (hat


CI
p = - (I- € ? )

I IV 8)
Substituting Eq. IV.8 into Eq. IV.7. we have

Canceling terms wherever possible, we get the desired result on noting Eq. 1V.X:

I~

-
~

b = all (1V.9)

Finally, we can show hy straightforward integration that the area of the


ellipse is given as

A = nab (IV.10)
Proof that Infinitesimal
Rotations Are Vectors
You will recall that finite rotations did not qualify as vectors, even though they
had magnitude and direction, because they did not combine according to the
parallelogram law. Specifically the fact that the combination of finite rotations
was not commutative disqualified them as vectors. We shall here show that, in
the limit, as rotations become vanishingly small they do combine in a commu-
tative manner and accordingly can then be considered as vectors.
Accordingly, consider Fig. V.1 showing a rigid body with point P at
position r measured from stationary reference XYZ. If the body undergoes a
small but finite rotation A@about axis A-A, point P goes to P’, as has been in
the diagram. We can express the magnitude of Ar between P and P’as follows:
IArI = lr/sin @A@ (v.1)
Z

Figure V.1. Rigid body undergoes rotation A@.

xxiii
xxiv APPENDIX I V PROOF THA T INFINITESIMAL ROTATIONS ARE VECTORS

If we assume, for the monient. that A+ i b a vector having a direction along the
axis of rotation consistent with the right-hand rule. we may express the equation:
Ar = A + X r (V 2)
In the limit as A+ --f 0 the relation above hecomes exact.
Now consider two arbitrary, small, but finite rotations represented by
proposed vectors A@,and A& For the first roldtion wc pct a displacement f i x
point P given as
A r , = Ad,l X r (V.3)
And for a second buccessive rotation we get for point P :
Ar, = Aq5, x ( r + Arl) iv 4)
= Aq5,X(r + A @ , X r )

The total displaccinent for point P is then


Ar, + Ar2 =A+, X r + A+q X ( r + A+l X r ) (V.5)
=A@,Xr+A+~xr+A+~XXA@,Xr)
As the rotations hcciiine vanishingly small, we can replace the npproximetc
equality sign by an exact equality sign and we can drop the litst exprebsion in
the equation ahovc 11s second order. Wc then havc on collecting terms:
drl + dr, = (dd,l + ~ 1 4X ~r ) (V6)
We see from the above equation that the total displacement of any point P for
successive infinitesimal rotations is inde/vndriit of the order OS these rota-
tions. Thus. superposition of vanishingly small rotations i s commutative and
we can now fully accept d d , as a vector.
Computer Projects:
Statics & Dynamics

Preface
In this appendix you will find 12 statics projects and 17 dynamics projects
specially designed for use on the computer. I have been careful to limit the
programming needs for the problems not to go beyond the usual freshman
course in Fortran programming. The programs conform completely to the
ANSI standard for Fortran 77 and will run on any machine having an ANSI
Standard compiler.
At SUNY Buffalo and at G.W. we assign one or two projects per
semester on ~ o ofp our regular program. No regular class time is used to teach
programming or to go over solutions. We give our students literature for log-
ging in, editing, filing, etc. peculiar to the machine we will work on, and the
students are supposed to learn to use the machine with the help of our Com-
puting Center “consultants.”
1 would like to thank my graduate students, Dr. Sun Lei Chang and Dr.
Anoop Dhingra, as well as Dr. John Hu; they did the original programming
under my direction. Ms. Chashia Tracy Chan also deserves thanks for her
help in rewriting the programs to make them totally standard conforming.
xxvi APPENDIX v COMPUTER PROJECTS: STATICS AND DYNAMICS

Contents
Problem File Name

Statics projects 1-12


I . Moment Prohlem MECHl.FOR
2. Torque Pmblem MECH2.FOR
3. Equivalent Problem MECH3.FOR
4. Friction Prohlem MECH4.FOR
5. Cenrroidal Coordinates of Block PROB5.FOR
6. Centroidal Coordinates of Plate CENTER.FOR
7. Beam an Nonlinear Springs BEAM.FOR
8. Principal Axis Problem PRINCIPL.FOR
9. Area Second Moments and Products of Area CEN.FOR
IO. Maximum Second Moment of Area P883.FOR
I I . Moments and Products of Inertia BLOCK.FOR
12. Area Moments and Products of Arcd for Complex Area TWOF.FOR
Dynamics projects 13-29
13. Projectile Problem With Friction MECHS.FOR
14. Spring Impact Problem CLOSE.FOR
15. Impdcl Problem (Stationary Panicles) MOM1.FOR
16. Impact Problem (Moving Particles) MOM.FOR
17. Torpedo Impact (Constant Speed) TORPEDO.FOR
18. Torpedo Impact (Accelerating Freighter) TORP.FOR
19. Conservation of Energy Problem HARM.FOR
20. Conveyor Problem EX144.FOR
21. Piston Device Problem (Constant Speed of Piston) PISTON.FOR
22. Piston Device Problem (Accelerating Piston) PISV.FOR
23. Light Repair Prnblem COPIT.FOR
*24. Four-Bar Linkage Problem
With Constant Disc Speed. Find ws(. FBARS.FOR
$25. Four-Bar Linkage Prohlem
With Constant Disc Speed. Find O,, FBAR.FOR
*26. Four-Bar Linkage Problem
With Accelerating Disc. Find wH(. FBARVS.FOR
*27. Four-Bar Linkage Prohlem
With Accelerating Disc. Find ‘uuc. FBARV.FOR
28. Astro-Centrifuge Problem CENT.FOR
*29. Constant g Astro-centrifuge Problem PLOT.FOR

‘Note lhat the Newlon Raphson method can he proiitahly employed in Projects 24. 25,
26, 21, and 29. In each of the programs of these pwjecls. will be round B suhroutine for this well-
known method. More detail is readily available in m m milthematics lexthook%.
For all possible following sets of values of A , B, and C:
A ( I . , 2.. 3.)
B(I.,2.,3.)
C (I., 2.5, 4.)
find M,, M,, and M, at D.

(There are 21 different settings for the direction of force F = 1,000 N.)

Print out results as shown.

* Project 1 *
Force = 1,000.0 N

A B C Mx MY Mz
I .o 1.o 1.O 0.2309E + 04 -0.6928E + 04 -0.4619E + 04
etc.

xxvii
i

ma,,

a = angle of vertical plane


{D = angle of cable from vertical axis
Find the moment tending to tip the boat about its I a i r from the cable
shown, for the following conditions:
P = 100 N, 200 N, 300 N, 400 N
for each a (O", IO", 20", 30". 40". 50")
and for each (O", IO", 20", 30". 40". 50".60", 70", SO", 90")
Print out data as shown.

Load = 100.0

10 20 30 40 so
0 1.150E+04 .150E+04 .1S0E+W .ISOE+04 .150E+04 .150E+04

etc

Kxviii
50 Ib

...Y

For setting of 8, going from zero to 330" in steps of 30", compute


mmponents of equivalent .force .system at "A" for the 50-lb force for two
distances of L being 0 in and 10 in.

Print out data as shown

Note: I + t , J + i , K + k

0 in 10 in

00 F= 0.001 + 0.00J + -50.00K F= 0.001 + 0.001 + -50.00K


C = -75.001 +-1OO.OOJ + O.OOK C = -1 16.671+-1oO.OOJ + O.OOK
30" F= F=
C= C=
60"

330" etc
-

xxix
I Dry Thrust Bearing

F = 100,200,300 N

Pressure= P = K [ I o g ( 2 + \ ' r ) ] ( c o s 2 r r r ) P u

(Kis a constant you must determine)

p varies with r

for r = 0.005 m p = 0.40


r=0.015 m p = 0.25
r = 0.025 m p=0.15
r = 0.035 in p=i) in
r = 0.045 m p = 0.07
r = 0.055 rn p = 0.05
r = 0.065 m p = 0.04
r = 0.075 m p = 0.03
r = 0.085 m p = 0.02
r = 0.095 m p = 0.0I

Find Resisting Torque due to Coulombfriction


5 in

5 in

Find Centroidal Coordinates. There are 25 equally spaced holes in the


block each with its own diameter and lengfh that will be asked for inter-
actively during the problem. Please echo the data you use.

D ( I , J) Diameter of each hole D ( I , J) + D ( I + 1, J) 2 $"


L(1, J) Length of each hole D( I , J) + D ( I , J + 1) 2 5"
Indicate cases where

D ( I , J ) + D ( I + I , J ) > ~ " ~ ~ D ( I , J ) + D ( I , J>+{ 'I ')

. . .
.I .2 .3 .2 . I -.I
.2 .3 .2 .I
.2 .I .3 .I .2 .2 .I .3 . I .2
D ( I , J ) = .3 .4 .5 .4 .3 in. L(1,J) = .3 .4 .S .4 .3 in.
.4 .5 .4 .s .4 .4 .s .4 .s .4
..5 .3 .I .3 .s . .s .3 .I .3 .5-

xxxi
Prink out data iis shown:

xxxii
PW

-x

PL

-
There are un to 100 circular holes randomlv distributed in a rectaneu-
lar plate, each with its own radius and x , y coordinates that will be asked for
interactively during the program. The program will check if uverlaps occur
between holes or hole and boundary. If overlaps occur then the program will
print a message indicating kind of overlap. Otherwise, calculate the centroidal
coordinares of the plate. The plate has length PL and width PW that will be
asked for interactively.

Procedure
a) Input data; Echo
h) Check overlap with boundary (Print out which holes have overlap with
boundaries.)
XU) + RU) > Xn,ax X(1) R(1) < 0
~

Y(I) + RU) > Y,rdx Y(1) - R(1) < 0


c) Check overluy between circles. (Print out which holes overlap with each
other.)
D(1,J) < K(I) + R(J)
d) Calculate area and first moments about X and Y axes.
e ) Calculate the centroidal coordinates.
f) Print out in the following format:

xxxiii
Length = Width =
Hole XCOOR YCOOR RADIUS

Area of plate i s
The centroidal coordin;ites arc
XCOOR =
YCOOR =

Use your program for the following cases:

Case 1
PL = 50.000
PW = 30.000

I.3.0lJ 2 I .Oil
45.llll 24.00
3x.00 25.00
S.OI1 23.00
25.00 2.IlO

Case 2
PL = 28.00
PW = 14.00

X(I1 Y(1) RII)


.- -
5.0 12.0 3.0
Ix.5 2.0 I .SI
25.0 13.0 0.5
I6.C IO.Il 2.0
22.0 12.0 3.0
18.0 3.0 2.0

xxxiv
A nonuniform force distribution acts on a rigid beam AB supported by
two different nonlinear springs. Compute the slope of beam AB for the fol-
lowing conditions.

Force: -[10sin(Zn~)+15Iog,,(:+I)]e-~ 2
N
Spring I : K, = 1~1”’ x 5 x 104

Spring 2 : K? = 1 ~ 1 x~ 10
’ ~4 N

The length of the beam L will be inputted interactively


Work out for L = 2.0 m and L = 2.5 m
In your output give:
Length of beam
Y, and Y , in mm
Slope of AB in radians and in degrees.

xxxv
I'M/

For an! set of \palues given inkr;ulivcly.


I.ength: PI.
Width: PW
Position: A(X.Y)
Angle: n
Find at A and lor llie lollowing data
&,x,, l,y.y.: Sccond inomelits ofarea (cross itched).
1;. 1; : Principal second moinenls of area.

Nute: Point A can hc insidr iiieii.

Work out for the /idlowiii,q d o f o


/'L = 18.00 111111
PLY= 12.00 riiin
a = 22.5,'
(X.Y),, = 15.00 mm. 4 . 0 0 inn)

xxxvi
i

YMAX

Hole I

Hole J
PW

x
PL
=MAX

There are up to 100 circular holes randomly distributed in a rectangular


plate. Each hose has its own radius and x, y coordinates that will be asked for
interactively during the program. The program will check if overlaps occur
between holes or hole and boundary. If overlaps occur then the program will
print a message. Otherwise, the program calculates &, Iw, lxyfor area of the
plate surface.

Procedure
a) Input. Specify PL, PW, XU), Y(I), R(I), and N (the number of holes)
b) Check overlap with boundary
For1 < I< N
X(1) + R(I) > PL
X(1) - R(1) < 0
Y(1) + R(1) > PW
Y(1) R(1) < 0
~

Then print out: “Circle I has overlap with boundary.”

xxxvii
S=(l

5 in

E
8 in \
.\

At what point S along CD do you get the niaxirnuni \econd rn(iment


~~

of area for area CEDF having 2 holes. What is its value'? (Even if you know
intuitively where this point i?,
show this via thc cornputcr.)

xxxviii
I Y

A
z /

User selects dimensions A , B, C for a block with a random system of


holes having

Check for overlap of holes with boundary. If so print out which holes
overlap with boundary. Check for overlap of holes with each other. If so print
out which holes overlap with each other. Compute lXx. I,. and Ly for unit
density of block. Run program for the following cases.

xxxix
I 12.00 18.00 2Y.00 5.50
2 27.00 32.00 3.00 5.10
3 35.00 41 .00 41.00 I .70
4 20.00 20.00 23.00 0.10

Case 2
A = 20 B = 30 c = 40
Hole XU) Y(I) L(I1 r(11

4.00 4.00 13.00 2.00


4.00 15.00 23.00 2.50
14.00 3.00 24.00 I .20
13.00 19.00 I.oo 1.10
19.00 25.00 28.00 3.00
19.00 26.00 I.00 0.10
1o.00 15.00 30.00 0.30
2.00 15.00 I .OO 0.10
c
X

I L

Write a program for computing the second moments and products of area
I,, lxvfor the cross-hatched area. User inputs L.
The functions describing the curves are:

F,(X) = X ( v ) ( s i n h $ ) e - x / L

F2 (X) = X ( 9) T ) cosh( L - x

Run problem for L = 1, L = 50.

xli
X

Projectile with Friction

Newton's L a w , for projectile motion (a spherical body) is given as:

where
C,,= drag coeffiecient for air
p = densily of air
D = diameter o f sphere
= coefficient of viscosity
Let

PI v,>11)
~~~~

= Re Reynolds number (Dimensionless)


Ir
The Scalar Equations are:

Problem:

GolfBall
Weight = 1.5 02.
D = 1.75 in
fi = 0.375 x 10-6 k 2
V, = I20 ft/sec ft2
p = 0.002378 slugslft'

a) Find trajectory at discreie points.


b) Find time ufflight.

Data for C,

CD I C, = 0.4

OS
0.4
0.3
JJ
0.2
0.I I J
3= O'l

9 x 104 Re
Algorithm- Method of Central Diffrrences:

C,, Ke u ( t ) + u(r - At)


.(I) = u ( t - At) - 24f-[- 2

,'(I) = \ ( I - A t ) - 24 7 A I - gAr

*(I) = i ( f - AI) + A/
l-[ i t ( ~ -AI) + /((I)\
r(f)= ' ( I -At) + -At2[ v ( t - At) + I,(f)]
use At = .04 s e ~ .

Program s h i ~ i l dend with J 5 0 (when hall hits ground)

Print out result:

I (set) x (It) ?' (ft)


0.04 4.149 2.17

and thereafter cvcry 0.2 seconds

Hints: ( I ) Solve for ~ ( 1 and


) v ( t ) from Eqs. Ibefore writing program
(2) 1x1 U , = (((1 - At) VI = v ( / - AI)
u,.= u(1) v, = v(t)
Starting with initial data for U , and V, solve for U, and V,. Thcn
inc.rc,mrvit by lctting V, = V2 and 0,= U?.This is done with a
DO loop nccded to determine C,, and to print out.
(3) Use the c(incIition
II((I/S)"S .Eq. I)
Print . . .

LO pi-int nut cvcl-y S t h terrii

xliv
Six Linear Springs

Develop a program to find how close bottom of W comes to the base (ground)
for the data:
W (weight) (N)
D (m)
d,. d,. d3 (m)
k , , k,, k , (N/m)
that the user will supply interactively. Print out data used and desired distance.
Run program for the following data:
W = IOOON
D = l.00m
d, = 0.20 m k , = 15,000N/m
d, = 0.25 m k, = 16,000N/m
d, = 0.30 m k, = 18,000 N/m

xlv
A Circular Plate of M and Radius H

A circular plate moving initially at spccd V,, to lelt liits a I-andom distribution
of palticles which ai-e initially \tationary and u hich haye the following dala:
M(II Illass
€(I) coefficient ol restitution
X(/). Y ( / ) , Z ( I ) position
Check that the Y ( / ) c(i(irdirrateh a~-ein asccndins crrder. To avoid thc
possibility 01particle collisions make sure that for thc particles, X ( I ) # X ( J )
and Z ( I ) # Z ( J ) for any I # J . Write a pi-opram lw Ihc s p e d of the disc
after it movcs a distmce 11. IIp l a k slops or revcrxs direction helore reach-
ing D. have statcineiit pi-inted that plate does not reach position Y = 11. User
supplics d l ahove data intcractively. Use SI units. Consider that the data is
such that the particles d o i ~ o ct d l i d e with cach other al'tcr inrpacting with
the plate.
Run program for following data (SI units). Echo this data i n your output.
The mass of the platc is 100.00 kg
Radius is 2.00 in
T h e initial spccd t i l the plate is 60.00 m i s
The distance D is 55 111

dvi
No. Mass Restitution X Coordinate Y Coordinate Z Coordinate
(kgj Coefficient (m) (m) (m)
I 2.500 0.230 1.2(x) 1.200 0.400
2 5.500 0.450 0.890 2.300 0.980
3 3.300 0.890 3.200 5.800 0.440
4 7.500 0.440 4.200 7.600 0.890
5 2.200 0.230 0.440 11.100 6.400
6 5.500 0.210 0.360 13.500 0.870
7 3.100 0.670 0.720 16.600 0.010
8 3.100 0.190 0.540 18.300 9.800
9 2.200 0.450 0.540 21.700 32.700
IO 1.700 0.100 0.210 28.600 7.600
II 0.760 0.880 0.760 31.900 0.890
12 0.650 0.560 0.230 36.380 0.650
I3 5.800 0.100 0.100 40.100 0.430
14 5.100 0.670 1.400 42.100 1.650
15 3.200 0.230 1.780 48.400 4.200
16 2.100 0.540 5.300 49. 100 2.700
17 0.200 0.220 2.300 51.500 1.400
18 0.560 0.550 3.200 54.600 1,000
19 0.320 0.230 1.100 56.400 0.430
20 1.650 0.230 1.430 61.800 3.200

xlvii
In project 16 each particle i s to have its own cnn~tiultvelocity component V,
before impact.
I . Assume particles are very small compared tn thc plate.
2. Insure that X(/)I X(J 1 and Z ( / 1 # Z(./) for I I .I.
User will specify the vclocity cnmponent M o r e impact keeping = V = 0.

Procedure: Choosc small distances o f plate innvcnient equal to 0.01 m. At


the beginning of the nrh interval you will have thc position of the entire systcin
and the vclocities of all the particles a s well as the plate velocity (V,,),,.
With
0.01
these velocities compute ncw pnsilions after the time intcrval Tb$,ln Now the
plate w i l l have moved frnm CY,,),,, to (Y,,),,,,,. a distance equ:d to 0.01 m.

If
a ) A particle i has 3 change of piisition u:hich causes i t to cross position
(Y,,),,,, during this tiinc interval.
b) Then let impact occur giving the plate a new velocity. As an approx-
iination consider this new velocity to occur at the beginning of the
( t i + 1 ) time step.

c) Ifthe velocity of the plate should hecome 7.eni or negative belore


reaching position D. print nul the fict that the plate does not rcach
position D.
The Y coordinates can he in any order of scqucnce
Run program fnr the siinil' following &ita
The mass of thc plate i s 100.00 kg.
Radius i s 2.00 in.
D = 55 111.
The initial s p e d of the plate i s 60.00 ( i d s )

rlviii
Determine if the torpedo hits the freighter and if so how far D from the how
of the freighter. The freighter is 20 meters long. Do this for all the following
sets of values of V,, V,, a:
a = (15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40.45)"
V, = (15, 20, 25, 30, 35.40) m/s
V, = (20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45) m/s
where
V, = velocity of the freighter
V, = velocity of the torpedo
a = degree as shown

3,000 rn

Hint: Use law of sines for triangle ABC

xlix
Do projecl 17 where the velocity of t h e light freighter at the configuration
shown is 10 kmihr and which we take at t h c lime f = 0 . 'Thc velocity viirics
in the following manner.

VI :- I O ~ b1.8\re-""kmihr

where I is in seconds

Procedure: Choiisc m i a l l Lime intervals of 0.01 ,econds. ('onipute velocil)


of the torpedo relative to the Sreigliler at each time iiilcrval. A I k I each timc
interval find how much the torpedo has moved along a line n,wniul Lo the
freighter atid along a direction p ~ ~ r u lto/ ~the
~ lli-eighler. Whcn the 110t-mi11dis-
tance equals or exceeds ,(3.ooo)' + ( 5 . I Y O ) ' Inahe your conclusion\. User
entcrs V , kmlhr and a" interactively.

Run program for:


V , = 45 kmlhr
V , = 35 kmihr
V i = 20 kmihr
CI = 30"
A mass Mcan slide in a frictionless manner along rod EF. At position shown,
spring K , is compressed D , inches and M is at distance D, feet from F. Spring
K, is elongated D, inches. The spring constants are K , lhlin and K2 Iblin. The
mass is M Ihm. Find the velocity of the mass as a function of the distance
it moves, and find the amplitude of the vibration. User specifies M lbm,
K , Ihlin, K, Ihlin, D , in, D, ft, D , in. Run the program for the following data:

M = 30lbm
K , = I.Olh/in
K, = 0.5 lblin
D ,= 6 in
D, = 4 fl
D, = 1 in

/
8 ft

Y-
5 ft F

li
Find ( T , ~ 7,) a s ii function of Lime as thc helt accelcralcs uniformly from
VI ftisec to V , ftisec in T sec. N(rj bodies at any lime 1. each d mass M Ihm.
hit the belt from the hoppers after filling a distance H. The weight of the helt
rebling on the bed is W Ib and the coeiricient of dynamic friction between belt
and hed of the conveyor is U . The number of impact5 pcr second, N(1). is
2 0 ~ 'I'' lsin rl. Also at r ( 0 ) there are 2 particles on the hell. Work the prohlcni
out in 100 time inlervals.
Kun problem for the i d l o w i n g dala:
W = 20 Ib
VI = 1.5 ft/sec
V2 = 7.5 It/sec
7 = 10 sec
M = 0.5 lhni
H = 2ft
I / = 0.23
Take time interwls of 0.001 sec and print out thc result at every tenth
d il second ;IS rwows:

~ h m e( 5 % ) Forcc (Ib)
0.00 5.71
0.10 5.36
I I

10.00 25.63
Do project 21 with the velocity of the piston varying with posi/inii s o a s 10
increase as the squiirr iifits vcrticiil distance p i n g froin I ftiscc to 3 W s e c as
a giieh from (x = 45" to n = 20'.

Procedure: Devclop equations as instructed in project 21. Wiite a subroutine


giving fix any value 1. which will he 8 dummy variable going from 45 t i i 20
iii steps i i S I, t i e Yiilues of a.@, and Y. Now get tlic velocily of the piston to
vary a s asked for above. Usc lhe subroutine to iacilitate this. Next a I giic,
Srom 45 tu 20. gel a, @, 6. 8. 9. and finally ? in ii DO loop calling i n thc suh-
routine lix each 1. Now get X,, and X,. Print o u t results.

iv
Find the magnitude of the velocity and the magnitude of the acceleration of
the man in the cockpit as arm DA rotates 90" in 20 equal increments. Get 20
readings during this part of the motion. Consider 20 successive stationary
axes XYZ at D with XY axes in the plane of DAB for each setting. Take angu-
lar accelerations as constant and the w's given as initial values,

Procedure: Compute V,, and ( I , , p and )unspecified. In a DO loop


with
for each rotation of 4.5" of DA starting from O", determine w2after each interval.
Find the time for that interval. Then get p, w l ,w2at the end of the interval.
Now get lVxyzl, laXYZlat the end of the interval and print out results for each
interval, O", 4.5". 9", etc.
Take a = 45" and constant DA = 13 ni

lv
. -c-.

Procedure:
ti) For each a. find /3 and y
, ~ \/,r Also gzt /3. Thcn sct
h) Consider rini A / ( . Gcl ( o ~ ,and h,,,..
c ) For each a. print 11111 ({I,,, and (;I,,,

L” d

Ivi
Compute the angular velocity and angular acceleration of the four bar linkage
in FBARS.FOR. Print the angular acceleration of BC and a in 20 steps.

lvii
Do project 24 for variable angular speed of disc given as:
= 2 +
qrlsc 1.1 kxlY2 radlsec
where a is in radians.

lviii
Compute the angular velocity and angular acceleration in FBAR.FOR. For
this case the angular speed of the disk is variable and is given as:

w = 2 + 1.32.1/2radlsec
Print the angular acceleration of BC and a in 20 steps.

lix
In Example 15. 14. M'C want to chart the pzrfixinancc characterislics of thc
cenliiiiigc l o r tlic cirnfigul-ation shown 10 givc thc number of , q ' s accelrralion
of thc astronauts hc:id for the following conditions:
(oI 2 20 rpni in 10 stcps
i
w, 2 i12 rpm iii 6 cteps
o , = 5 rpm. 10 rpni. and IS rpni
(GI = s rpm'. 8 rpm'. and 10 rpm'

w
~
Y

WI
\
Cockpit I
Given the rcsults in the following iornmat:

For 0,= 5 rpin. 6 ,= 5 rpm'

2
3
h

For ui = IO rpm. (3, = S rpm2 t t c

Ix
In the centrifuge of example 15.14, find the values of w, and w2 to maintain
the same magnitude of acceleration, assuming the other data is fixed. Get
results for accelerations of 0.5 g, 1.0 g and 1.5 g.
Use the Newton-Raphson method to determine the minimum value of
w, for any value of wz which ranges from 0 'pm to 20 'pm.
Print out wI in the following format:

a: 0.5 g I.0g 1.5g

0.00
0.50

An'

Ixi
2.2. F = 3X.5 N @> 66.h from r axis. 2.V6. 18.21n1 I/. 111. I l l = (.SI.li. .6X611, .5145l.
2.4. 1. = 2.75 km. 2.~8.
2.6. n = 17.32N I* = 60' 2.100
2.8. 5 = 100 N @ -120' with horimntal.
6, = 76.53 N @ -67.5~with horiruntal. 3.2. 4 - l 6 j - 3k It.
Fc = 76.53 N @ -22.5" with hol-imntal. 3.4. hi + 1.1hj t 7.59Rk m .
2.10. F = 846 N CC 17.6X' with horimntal. 3.6. -1Oh7.4 Pi-,,, l W l . 3 N-nl.
2.12. T,, = 767.2 N a = 36.8" 3.8. i? '. 2/.j + :k.
2.14. F = 1,206N. 3.10. --iR.OZh N-in -6.S24.8 N-in.
2.16. F = 137.5 N @ 43.34' from x direction. 3.12. 13.x 111
2.18. F = 242 Ih @ 3 . 0 7 ~from -i direction. 3.14. -251.5k Pi-ni.
2.22. t,,,,= 36.4 Ibl: = 81.5 Ihf. 3.16. X413 fl-lh 4412 ft-lh 11 ft-lh.
2.24. FBc = A30F II,,,, = .590F. 3. I 8. IXOi ~ 50k kN-m.
2.26. 2,690 Ih XO3.X Ib. 30; t 7Sj ~~ S(1k kN-in.
2.28. I* = 911~.
b;,c = 707 N - I . S S l . X i + 7 j + 3S4.4k kN-tn.
2.30. +
F = 215.9i 196Xj + 3151kN. 3.20. -84; + 9Jj - 46k N ~ m .
2.32. F = 07.4 Ih I = ,267 m = ,535 n = -.XO2
3.22. M, = q o k - &ojlh-lt.
2.34. 6+6 = YIX.hi - I5Xl.j - X35.8kN.
2.36. 7 = 400 N < = -1007 N.
M,, = 0 lh-It.
M, = - "joi + " ' o j Ih-St elc.
2.40. +
F = 25.71' 2 4 . 3 + 16k Ih. ,,
2.42. A = + 5 i 2 i T 5\.2k. 3.24. (7.277f;,,, + S . i l S F ; , , - 111.000)~+
2.44. f = ,463 + 3I4j + ,349k. (?.<)I I/;,,< S.l45fi;.,Jj +
+ +
F = 463; 81.4j 34.Yk N . (-2,41153,! + s . l 4 s ~ , , l kti-lb.
2.46. -164 -.4h5 -10.5. 3.26. I .32'1hF It-lh.
2.48. D = 10i - 769j -3.77k. 3.28. 22,245 N-m M,, = -3Oi + l(ll1j - 3hk N-m
2.52 .4 I 8 It. 3.30. llh.2 Ih 77.011 lh-Ut.
2.54. 17.05 N. 3.32. 5,764 Ih-ft.
2.56. A = 2.5 N a = 45.7- 3.34. - ~ 1135 hN-m - I 17.5 kN-"1.
2.58. -75 ft? 95.94~. 3.38. 71111 I b f t (100 Ih-It 1.200 Ih-li.
2.60. -28.R3 N. 3.40. 175 N.
2.62. 47.5 II.
3.42. -7,271lk Ih-St lll.405k Ih-fl.
2.64. (18; + 20j - 42k) 47. 3.44. MA = M,, = -261; - Z h I j N-m.
2.68. ,804; + ,465j + , 3 7 2 3.46. 4211 It-lh.
2.70. 640 m2. 3.48. C = 1 O l l i + S l j - 224k lh-ft.
2.74. -29.6. 3.50. -1.x57 N-In.
2.76. (a) -43; + 4Yj + 2k. 3.52 ,W,, = 4Xi - 3 h j - 225.6k N ~ m .
(b) -136. M, = 4 4 6 . 9 N - t n
( c ) -136. 3.54. M = 3,h35 Ih-in (a' hK.2- 10 h w i m n l a l .
2.78. L,,, = 373 miles I.,,. = 6x9 mile, 3.56. C = 35.35; + 22.3(7j + X0.07k N-in.
162 miles longer. 3.5x. 120 lh-ft 1611 lh-ft 60 Ih.
2.80. F; = 57.1 N FT. = 342.8 N = 971.4 N. 3.60. 1.750 N - m .
2.82. F = 231.3 N. 3.62. 408.4 N-in.
2.84. 32.4 ft-lh. 3.64. 1.174 f t - l h
2.86. I l2.C -190.72 Ih 3.66. -4S2k lh-ft -I.202k lh-ft.
2.88. 35.7kN. 3.68 IO,h00i + 4.SOOj - ?.000k m .
2.90. 19.87m. 1 2 . 5 4 111.
2.92. F = -80.1 x I O "k N. 3.70. -27.7 N - m .
2.94. 251 ft2. 3.72. 217.6 N-m.

lxii
4.2. F = 15 kN C = 30 kN-m C.C.W. 4.76. F = 1.697 x 10“’N 24.04 m from base along in-
4.4. F = 150N C = 187.5 N-m. clined surface.
4.6. MA = 8kkN-m FA = FH = -IOfkN. 4.78. F = 666 x 108N.
40
M, = 22.7% kN-m. @ i m from base.
4.8. Move 200 Ib force 5 ft to left. 4.80. ?, = 21.2 ft 7 = 4.67 ft.
4.10. FA = -2OOj - 150kN. 4.82. x? = ,07441 m.
C, = 34.0i + 26.Ok N-In. 4.84. F = 4 o O j kN MoulSidclanc= 9 o o k kN-m
4.12. F = 20i - 60j + 30k N. Mrnh,dc = -3OOk kN-m.
C, = 900; + 680j + 760k N-m. 4.86. 1,415 kN 1.915 mfromfrontofload.
4.14. 12.375 m froni origin. 4.88. FR = 4.6981’ - l0.09jkN.
4.16. F = -44.567i - 33.425j - 22.283k N. MR = -3i + 3.2316kkN-m.
C :: -31.007i - 160.465’ + 302.71k kN-m. 4.90. -~7 . 0 2 7 ~+ ,7026.
I’ = 1 7 . 5 7 ~

4.18. FR = -204i + 604j + 408k Ih. 4.92. I = 3.51 m.


C, = 8,lhOi + 2.032j + 3,264kft-lb. 4.94. F = 2,200 Ib X = 4.136 ft
C , = 2,032j - 816k ft-lb. 4.96. -217.2 N-m.
4.20. FR = 400i - 1,YOOj + 6OOk N. 4.98. FH = 5OOi - 1.220j N
c, = 24.2130i + 2,OIX)j - 3.30llk N-m. C , = 240i - 2,190k N-m.
4.22. F, = -50k kN C , = 7 . 3 + 5Oj kN-m. 4.100. FR = 58,900 Ib X = 3.919 from bottom left corner.
f
4.24. 6 = 2h.Y Ib 5 = 17.6 Ib 6 = 35.5 Ib. 4.102. x = 1.20ft 7 = 1.125ft i = Tft.
4.26. F = 2,100; - SoOj Ib X = -.OS ft. 4.104. 7 = 1.299 ft.
4.28. FR = 400i - 160Oj N 4.106. -1,550 Ib X = 20.04 ft.
C, = -1,800i - 2 , 4 0 j - 12,600k N-m. 4.108. j: = 10.94 ft 7 = 12.67 ft.
4.30. FR = 39.441 + 74.71”. 4.110. 485.397 kN @ 1.636 m below top of gate.
X = 6 6 9 m. 132.38 I kN @ 1 m below top of gate.
4.32. FH = -10llk N X = 2.5 m V = 2.2 m. 4.112. X = 4.98 m = 2.65 m.
Fx = 0 C , = 2XOi + 450jN-m.
4.34. FR = 0 C, = 860i + 900jN-cm.
4.36. FR = 353.3 - 653.53 N X = 9.2739 m. 5.18. Txc = 26.79 Ib TBA= 37.9 Ib.
4.38. FR = 43,000 Ib .7 = 23.209 ft. 5.20. = 111.81b T8” = 109.Ylb Tsc = 63.71b.
4.42. F = 3,164k Ib. 5.22. 27 Ih 36.35 Ih 4.653 in.
4.44. X = 10.37 in. = 7. = (I. 5.24. 671 N, 447N. 1,NON.
4.48. E = .289 u = .400. 5.26. 409.8 N-m.
4.50. 10.84 m. 5.28. Ax = 4,233N, AY = 3,140N. R, = 4.233N.
4.52. X = 1.292 ft 7 = 7.63 ft. Rv = -1,840 N.
4.54. X = ,210 ft = ,0756 ft. 5.30. A ~ r= 2,OM N, A y = 6,970 N, MA = 62,360 N-m
4.56. 7 = 3.808 m. B = 530.4N.
4.58. F 2 -37.5k k N X = ,844 m 7 = 1.067 m 5.32. A* = 8.00 kN A\, = -12.50 kN Rx = -8.00 kN
(origin at front left lower corner of the load). Ex, = 22.5 kN.
original weight 90 kN. 5.34. GD = 462 lh FBc = 215 Ib 4B 375 Ib.
lost weight = 52.5 kN. 5.36. T, = 125.0 N f’ = 125 N.
4.60. F, = -I 11,780k Ib X = -3.78 ft 5.38. T = 117.4N a = 7 9 . g
(in from oftrailer C.G.). 5.40. Ax = 433N. A s = 790N MA = 1,167N-m.
F, = -86,386k Ib X = -7.329 ft. 5.42. A r = 200N. A v = 3,464N MA = 1,192N-m.
4.62. W = .Sl273Yy x, = ,2042 m y‘ = .Im 5.44. A r = 9,736 N Av = -2,670 N B, = -9,736 N
L . = -.lY68m. B>, = 6,670N.
4.64. FK = 2.315x 10”lb X = 20ft 7 = 12.44ft. 5.46. a = 17.46‘.
4.66. FK = 262 N. 5.48.
4.68. 4,025 N-m 596.3 N-m.
4.70. :c 7.8644 x IO* Pa.
5.50.
4.72. F =: 61,740 Ih 10.386ft.
4.74. F =: 8761 Ih 2.615 ft.
ixiii
5.52. A r = 408 N A s = -2SXN G, = -749.5 N 5.l30 'I' = 2.121 Ih H = 3.000 Ih 1'' = 3.00l1 Ih
Gv = 583 N. ' I = 1.1181h H = 2.121 Ih 1,' = 5.121 Ih.
5.54. 7 = 20 N-m. 5.132. I;,,, = 353 Ih 'I:,, = 2x9 Ih 7,,, = 3Y4 Ih.
5.56. T,, = 40.5 kN q,,. = 39.3 kN. 5.131. lid = I . E X N I;, = 7WJ N 'Ti = 2.124 N
5.58. 72 Ih 447 Ih. 'I;, = I.I)IZN I = .llX?X t u = ,728 n = .6lX
5.60. 4 m. 5.1.36. I,,, = X.11011 111 I:, = 5.000 Ih &I, = 6.42X lh
5.62.
5.13x.
5.64. R5 = I1 = 58,900 Ih M,* = 142,500 f t ~ l h . 11, = 4.XOli N.
5.66. Rr = 0, R , = 4,953 Ib hl = bl.OX2.5 l i l h . 5.140, )lt = EN 1, = 150 N.
5.68. R, = 1,006 Ib M,. = I0.IOX ft-lh. 5.142. 63.75 kN-in.
R,, = 294 Ib Mi>= 2.770 it-lh. 5.144. & = 4 9 6 7 N.
5.70. 270 Ih 253 Ih. 5.146. , t , = 11, = IX.17ON ,4, = 63.hhON.
5.72. ym2,x = 2.5 ton U> = I 0 . X tun ,lt = 1.7 ton 5.148. ('n = hIi(1 Ih C'3 = I1 ( ' = -320 lh
c, = 1.7 ton y = 34 ft-tan /I, = I .7 t o n Pi, = 1.033 Ih I., = 312.5 Ih.
M,, = 85 it-ton. 5.150. p = 2118 p\i p a y .
5.74. 17.55 tun (2 supports) 24.Y tiin M = 7 0 ton-ft. 5.152. A = 43% - S33j - 19.liOk I h E = 240 Ih.
5.76. F, = 293 N F2 = 52.37 N F, = 254.3 N. / I = -413;+ 13?j - SZOk Ih K = 0.
5.78. A = -5Ollj + I .500k Ib 5.154. A x = -28.13 Ih tl, = -W lh H , = 7011,
MA = 26,260i - 9,100k h-lh B , = 11.
B = -5Olj Ih 5.156. ,I = 15.08 kN.
Mx = -9,100k ii-lh. 5.158. A = 0 A , = I.L138Ih ('$ = H 8 = 3.1162 Ih
5.80. F = 57.14 Ib A , = l60.1 Ih I ) , = 1.')38 Ih. Ram IOICC = '1.74X Ih.
B> = 93.0 Ih E. = 22.6 Ib A. = I8.W Ih. 5.l60. T,, = 1.174N.
5.82. At = 0 A , = SON A~ = lIl(1 N 5.lh2. A = l.39Y x 1Il4N A , = 5.54') x 1 0 ' N .
M t = -200 N-m. M , = 1.355 x IO' N-m H = 2.887 N.
M y = -220 N-m M. = I IO N-m.
5.84. 8%= 3.f100 Ih E . =' 26,500 Ih ( ' ~ = 17.11(10 Ih.
5.86. 3 ft A? = 50 N E . = SON.
5.88. P = 33.7 Ih A. = 25 Ih A , = -7.50 Ih. 6.2. E t = 2.01iO Ih 1' ,AI, = J.XlIX Ih T
5.92. 11,394 Ib. I K = 2.670 Ih. C' etc.
5.94. 65,100 Ih. 6.4. IM.' = I X.720 Ih C IIH = X.X25 T
5.96. F,;c = 4.36 kN A , = .XOO kN A , = 190.7 hN. HC; = 18.720 I[, 'r ctc.
5.98. B~ = 1 6 5 . 9 ~ B , = 2 1 1 6 . 3 ~ /;.,( = m s . n ~ . 6.6. A I 1 = / ) E = 26.8 kN C GC = CF = 3.39 kN C
5.100. Ca x 576 Ih C y = 1,326 Ih M< = XllliY.6 N-In. A(; = 11; = I'J hN 1 H ( ' = ( I ) = 20 k N C.
5.102. T , = 209 N 7. = 202 N F = 2X6 N. IK; = I)/,' = ~ 1 . 1 k1 N 'I' (;I.' = 2 I l h k N ('.
5.104. A = 10,640 Ih C = 6,520 Ih I ) = 6.52(1 Ih 6.8. ,AH = 7117 Ih C
G = H = 7,.5lK) Ih F = IO,640 Ih. A ( . = ('E = XI0 lh 'I
5.106. 1154N E/{ = I1
NO = 500 Ih C'
5.108.
5.110.
9.418 x 10'' Pn.
? = (6.833 - 6.50: -
.,
i x I l l ' Po. 111 = 707 Ih C:.
5.112. 7.. = 281.7 psi 6.10. A N = h.'JSIi Ih V
5.114. Gi. = 750 Ih C ! = 650 Ih. )A(' = 4.414 Ih 'I'
5.116. F, = Az = 806 Ih = A , = 500 Ih. I<(' = 3.207 Ih . I
5.118. R , = 41 k N R2 = 88 kN K , = 141 kN. (7) = 11.
5.120. e.,, = 1,694 Ib FFF = 4.<J3I Ih. 6.12. .A/? = 353.5 kN c'
5.122. A x = 13.15 Ib A, = 142.6 Ib. A/. = 250 hN T
5.124. 1, = 1,688 N 1;) = 2,XJ(1 N. /,A' = 250 kN '1
5.126. T = 30.67 Ih. LII = 100 hN 'I
5.128. Ct = -322.3 Ih C , = -161.3 Ih ( ' ~ = -5Xi.h Ih IK' = 31h.2 kN I'
Ur = -322.7 Ih D. = -3Y8.9 Ih. HK = 70,s kN 'I.

lxiv
6.14. JI = 25 kN T BH = 8 . 6 4 k N C 6.48. Section AB H = 0
AJ = 31.25 kN C BC = SO kN C y=o
IH = 56.25 kN T CD = SO kN C V = 11.36s - 262lb
BJ = 6.25 kN T HC = 0 etc. M, = 410 ft-lb M, = 0
6.16. C/) = 583 Ih C M , = - 5 . 6 8 ~+
~ 262s - 2,194ft-lh
AC = nc = A / ) = o Section BC V = 130.02 + 5.64s Ib
H I ) = 1,158 IbT H = 227.54 - 9.87s Ib
others are x r o . M; = (axial tvrque) = -70.47 ft-lb
6.18. AC = 1 4 . 1 4 k N T M; = (bending torque) = -123.33 ft-lb
CO = I4 k N T Section CD V = -262 + 11.36s Ib
DE = 2 k N C My (axial torque) = -.477 ft-lb
A / ) = 24.5 k N C Mr = -3,021 + 262s - 5 . 5 8 ft-lb.
~~
others are zero. 6.50. O<x<15
6.211. s,, = 24.246 Ih C, Fnc = 32,709.5 Ib T V = M = O
F,,, = 1,350 Ib C, F,,, = 22,709.5 Ih C. S<x<IO
6.22. DC = 1,202 Ib T DE = 0. V = 500 Ib
6.24. G F = 21.3 kNT. M = -5(K)(x - S ) ft-lh
6.26. HF = 0 A H = 258 kN T. I O < x < 25
6.28. HC = 115.5 kN T HK = 57.7 kN C M = -5OO(x - S ) - 3O(x -10)2/2.
DE = 77.0 kN T /I/ = 38.50 kN T 6.52. o < x < IO
EF = 38.50 k N T. V = -737.5 Ib
6.311. DG = YO k N C / I F = 56.6 kN C M = 7 3 7 . 5 ~ft-lh
AR = 127.3 k N 1’ AC = YO kN C I O < x < 25
CH = S O k N C Cf) = YO kN C. V = 262.5 Ib
6.32. FH=HE=4,72KT FI7=2,5KC F C = O K M = 7 3 7 . 5 ~- I,CQO(x - IO)
6.34. FI:=.SSXKC E F = . S K C D H = I.ll8KT. 2 5 < X < l O
6.36. bLc = 4 1 . 6 3 K C F,,. = l 6 2 . S K T V = 262.5 Ib
FHc = 83.3X K T <,(; = SO.03 K C. M = -262.5~ + 10,500 ft-lh.
6.38. M = -5001 + 2.500 ft-lb 6.54. o<.rss
M = -15.r’ - 2001 + 1,000 ft-lh. V = -1.333 N
6.411. V = -737.5 Ih M = 3,6W ft-lb M = 1.333xN-m
V = 262.5 Ih M = 6,850 ft-lb 5 < x < 15
V = 262.5 Ib M = 1.312.5 Ft-lh. V = -209 + 600x - 3,833 N
6.42. M = 1,333~- 2W(x -SI2 + q(x - 9)’ N-m
15sx<25
14.14 < 3 < 29.14 V = -52.5 Ih H = 0 V = 667N
M :: 52.5s - 217 ft-lb. M = 667x c 16,660 N-m.
etc. 6.56. -500 N-m.
6.44. O<.r<IO H=O v = O V,=-2Os 6.58. Mmdx= -5,334 N-m.
M,, = 0 M. = 0 M x = -IOs2 6.60. = -6,500 ft-lh.
M,,vdx
I O < ,s < 20’ H = 0
-~ y = 200N V = 0 6.62. O < n < 3
M , = 1.000N-m M: = 2OO(s - IO) M) = 0 V = -60 + 5x2 N
20 < s < 30 H = 200 N V = -1,000 N M = 60x - +x3N-m
V, = I ) Mb = 0 M! = - 1,000s + 21.000N-m 3 < x < 6
M. = 2,OI)O N-m. V = -60 + 5.x’ N
6.46. 0 ’< B <
-~ V = -70.7 sin B N M = ~ I I X- ?x3 - s , m n N - m
H = -70.7 cos 0 N 6 < x < II
M = 424 - 424 cos 0 N-m V = -1.000N
.c 0 < $ V = 29.3 ’iin ON M = 1,000~- 16,000 N-ni
H = 29.3 COS e~ Mmdx = 5,000 N-m.
M = 176 cos B N-m.

Ixv
6.64. 0 < x < 5 6.88.
V = ,596.~~” kN
M = -.238xi” kN-in 6.90.
5 < x < IO
V = 6.66 - 3(r - 5 ) + i,lr - 5)’kN
+
M = -6.66~ lY.99 + ?(x - 5)’ - j\,(.r - 5)‘
M,,,2sx = -22.6 kN-m
6.66. length = 230 fl 7;,,,,. = 565.8 Ih.
6.68. T,,ll,x= 17,OXX Ib L = XI.5 R.
6.70. 7;,,,, = 35,2llll N.
6.72. TmdX= 109 Ib h = I18.1 rl.
6.74. elevation (3 H = 17.84 in
61.68 m dragging.
6.76. A r = 675 N R r = 675 N A > = 650 N
B) = 5 0 0 N 7.4.
T,, = 937.1 N a = 43.92”. 7.6.
6.78. RC = 45.3 kN C 7.8.
DC = 3 2 k N C 7.10.
DE = 3 2 k N C 7.14.
HA = 45.1 kN T 7.16.
un = nE = A E = 11.
6.80. AE = 1,250lhT 7.18.
AI1 = 1,250 Ih 7 7.20.
ED = I,lMlIh C
C E = 1,060 Ib C 7.24.
CA = 1 ,O6OIb C 7.26. 7 = 1233 it-lh.
CD = 1,500 Ib T. 7.2~. 710 N Iclnckwisel
6.82. O < X < 3 SO N lui,untercl~,ckwi\e).
V = II1.x N 7.30. 1,. = 190.7 N.
M = 101’ N.m 7.34. 3 2 . M Ih < M; < 67.32 Ib.
2 U; = 5 0 Ih ( n r r friction)
3<.r<Y 7.36. ~ = m s .
P ,,,,,
V = Illx - lY.44 N 73. 01,,,,,, = XI)’.
M = -IO- I ?
2
+ 19.44(r - 3 ) N-m 7.40. d.76 fl.
7.40. l . f W m.
Y < . X < 12
7.44. 251.5 Ih.
V = 70.6 N
7.46. U’, = 7.241 N p ,,,,,, = 0.0270.
M = -YO(* - 4.5) + 1 ~ . 4 4 - ( . 3~) + sno ~ - m .
6.84. 0 <x < IO
V = M = O
7.4x.
I O < ,Y < 20
V = -650 Ib 7.50.
M = 65(1(.~- Ill)fl-lh
7.52. 7 = 320 N.
20 < x < 40
7.54. 7 = 18X.6 N-m.
V = 350 Ib
7.56. X32 N.
M = 650(.\ - IO) - l.llOll(.r - 20) ft-lh
7.58. 267 Ih.
40 < x < 65
7.60. I3h.U N .
V = O
7.62. p\ = O.?hO.
M = -500 ft-lh.
RI 7.64, p, = 0.OJX.
6.86. y = h(l - cos-). 7.6h. I’ T 202 N p3 = 0.556
/

lxvi
7.68. x = 277 mm. 8.56. rc = 3.39i + 3.44j - 3k in.
7.70. F, = 256N F;, = 150.4N.
8.58.
ab'rr
I= = -
7.72. F,,,, = 2,210 N p, = 0.4. 4 '
7.78. 133.6 in.-lh 155.6 in.-lb. 8.60. 1, = 1.113units4 IYy= .535units4.
7.80. W = 6,100 Ih. lxy= .750 units".
7.84. 0.2387~. 8.62. IYY= 15112 - 8 ft".

7.86. pT= .00308. 8.66. 1- = 666.7 W ly.v= 1,257 ft4.


7.88. F = 128.2N. iXy= 791.7 n4.
7.90. 0 = 30.9C T = 292lb. 8.68. 1- = 4,540 ft4 lyy= 11,250 ft?
7.92. 7.1 I N . 8.70. I, = 6.646 ft4 Iy, = 15.39 ft".
7.94. 3,333 N. 5, = 9.52 ft".
7.96. P = 13.22 1bC.W. P = 163.2lbC.C.W. 8.76. 1- = 1.512 ft" I=,= 559 W.
7.98. 40.7 N-m. 343
7.100. 94.7 mm. 8.78. 1- = 7 R 4 I?, = -,6fP(&)IZy = 0.
7.102. 35.5Y above horizontal. 8.80. = 8.463 x 107mm4
I=&
7.106. 0 = 41.Y. /,*"< = 1.8869 x 108 mm".
7.108. 256 N. 8.82. 5;;. = 140.6 ft4 IY.,.= 439 ft4 la,?,= 213 ft'.
7.110. 1.002 x IO4 N. 8.84. 1- = 91.92 ft" IYy= 1,455 ft4 5, = -96.52 ft4.
7.112. W, = 429.18 N. J, = 1,547 ft4.
7.114. Wc = 810N. 8.88. 109.2 mm4 2.367 mm".
7.116. T =: 877 N-m. 8.90. 1,299 mm4 79. I mm4.
8.94. I, = ,003781 m4 I2 = .0002557m4.
8.96. X = 3.16 mm y = 1.323 mm.
8.4. M, = I25 ft' M v = 200 ftJ. I, = 2.1 I x 10" mm' I2 = 8.0675 x IO3 mm".
8.8. X = 14.30 ft = 5.74 ft. 8.98. yc = 1.671 m.
8.12. xc = 0.1691 m y , = 0.363 m. 8.100. 1- = 3.29 x 107mm4 = 9.85 x 106mm"
8.14. xc = 2.02 mm y , = 83.6 mm. ly,v = 2.89 x lo6 mm' IycYc = 1.607 x IO6 mm"
8.16. xc = 0.1217 m y, = 0.4478 m. 5, = 6.90 x 106 mm" = 1.457~x IO6 mm".
8.18. xc = 7.23 in. y, = 2.55 in. M; = 226.1 in.)
8.102. x c = d 6h y = & o ,
8.20. xc = y, = 242.22 mm. E 21n 2, = 0.
8.22. X~ = 1.7172m y , = 0.1722m. 8.104. 6.75' 96.75".
8.24. x, = 2.889 m y , = 2.667 m. 8.106. A = 151.24m' V = 113.0mJ.
8.26. x. = 315.7 mm. 8.108. x, = 1.500 in. I,.. = 83.250 in4.
8.28. x, = 40.1 mm y< = 19.51 mm.
8.30. X = 12.92 ft. 8.110.
8.32. xc = Y2 yc = + b zc = 4 I c ' 8.112. M. = 10.616s inJ
8.34. -
z = xu. 3 M: = 185.7 - 0.4659
8.36. <. = 1.17Yi + .955j + ,284,4111. M, = (.1886)[316.8 + (4 + 311)-
8.38. .rc = 2.571 m.
8.40. X = 8.22m = T = 0.
8.42. X~ = yt, = 0 z, = 9.78 in. 9.2. 4,333 Ibm-ft2 15,333 Ibm-ft2
8.44. center of volume X = -9.75 mm
7 = 122.55mm i = 0 9.4. I "Y = + bz) 1- = &M(b2 + 12)
center of mass and gravity In = + P).
X = -32.76 mm y = 447 mm Z = 0.
8.46. X = 41.95 mm 7 = 493 mm t = 608 mm. 9.6. ;MI%
8.48. rc = ,7423 - .1720km. 9.8. 2.67 x 107grams-mm2
8.50. Y< = i
2
(4
6

9.10.
3.95 x 1O8grams-mm2.
1.723 x I06 grams-mm2.
8.52. A = 1,751 in? V = 5,242in?
8.54. A = ,8624 m2 V = ,35329 m'. 9.12. 3,959 kg-mm2.

lxvii
9.14. = 1 .llil4 x IIF mm'. 10.32. d = .? ft.
I , , = 1.875 mm' 10.34. 25.9".
I , , = 1.172 x 1114mmm' 10.36. 77.3~.
( / r z ) M = 205 kg-mm' I0.3X. I .Oh6 N.
(I,,,), = 3.X? k p - n i d 10.40. H = 1'1.?2^.
= 23.Y kg-mm'. 10.42. 33.5'.
10.44. 440 m .
9.16. 37.0 kp-mm' 166.8 kg-mm' 203.X kg-mm'.
I$\,, = 6.21 4ug-ft' I ..__ = I I . , . = 29.l~slug-ti'
10.46. a = ,358 111.
9.20. .
10.48. id = .I I26 m.
ir, = I 19.1 h g . i t 2 I,,, = 1x.63 S I U F - ~ I ~
10.52. Whcn d > 2, slable equilihrium.
I.. = IO6.6 slup-ft?.
When il < 2, unstahle equilihriuin.
9.22. I* a + I ,,' + 1~
.. = E(,,?6
t h'+ c.3
10.56. LY,,;,> = 250 Ih.
+ 2M(.xl + i.2 +3 10.60. I= I1n1.
9.24. 10.61. L,= 3)'.
I,..v..= 4,615 kp-m'. P = 7.540Ih.
10.62.
9.26. 1.258 x Ill kp-m' 1.239 x 1 1 1 ~ 2 k g - ~ n 2 10.63. 0 = 27.7~.
3.Yl x 10 I kg-m'.
9.2X. I.650 kg-In2 1.438 kg-m' .5 I3 kp-in'. 10.64.
9.30. 1. = 2.54 II I = 2X,400 Ihm-11'.
l L ~=r 8,(193 Ihm-in? l v , = l.601 Ihm-in? IO.66.
9.32.
I , %= 1.282 Ihn-in.'
9.34. I,< = 17.K kg-m'. 111.67. \y,,,,%= I .OOO N.
9.36. 3,026 Ihm-ft'. R > l h l l l for ctahlc euuilibriuni.
9.38. ,574 kg-m'.
9.40. -.nnwh k p - d
9.44. 362 kg-mm'.
9.46. ( I > , ) ,= 534 kg-mm'
(I,,,), = 16.59 x Iil'kg-mm'
(l.~)M = 21.9 x 1O'kg-mm'
= 5.68 x IO' kp-nim'
il,J*,= VJ, = 0.
9.48. .Sl4Y3 kg-m' .SI01 X7 k p - d .SI503!if-111'.
9.50. 1,075 k g - d 92.35 kg-m'.
9.52. I,,) = 7.58p,, k p m ' I\: = -I.7XOp,, kg-m'.

10.2. S = I.250 N 11.14.


S = 750N. 11.16.
10.4. e = 14.4X'. II.IX.
10.6. W = ,351 7 I I .20.
10.8. e = 8.53'. 11.22.
10.10. P = I W I 2 ) Cot H. 11.24.
10.12. 2,s I3 Ih. 1 1.26.
10.14. T.& = 7.42 kN
TX: = 28.8 k N . 11.2x.
10.16. tan = 5iIo - 3h)IOi + dl.
10.18. T' = 40 N-m.
10.20. P = ,0545 N .
10.22. W = 270 Ih. 11.30.
10.24. W = 2,770 N.
10.26. C' = IOX.6 N. 11.32.
10.28. d = 72.0 mm. 11.34.
lxviii
11.36. E,, = .995i - ,09953 R = 101.5m. 11.106. A = 635.8 m2.
11.38. lal = 10.616 ft/sec2. 11.108. ,00255 g's.
11.40. V = 891.4 kmhr. 11.110. v = + lor, + 2r,filsec
11.42. 7.68 fVsec2 49.4 fr/sec2. a = -205 + 4c0fr/sec2 a * E = -15.2 ft/sec2.
11.44. x = -8.94 ft y = -2.24 ft. 11.112. u = 7.21 ft/secz.
11.46. a = .O~E,+ . 0 1 5 0 4 ~&see2.
,~ 11.114. i = 17.49 m
11.48. a = SE, + 65, m/sec3. i' = 15.29 m
11.50. e = 1.063 i = I O d s e c j. = ,1623 d s e c .
0 = ,275 radlsec2. 11.116. d = 982.2 m S = ,463 m.
11.52. R = 53.3 radlsec h = 72 radIsec2. 11.118. a = 27.62'.
11.54. V = 2 1 . 5 5 + 3 5 8 ~ ~ m d s e c 11.120. F,,, = ,019621 - ,029433 + .304k N
a = - 5 1 7 ~+~ 127.4 ~~rnmmlsec~. 11.122. V = 149i + 200j + 60k d s e c .
11.56. V = - 3 ~ + 3~e g d s e c Tensile force on rod is 45 N.
a = -l6.60c, - 28.8r,m/sec2. 11.124. E" = ,29311 + .1466j + ,5863k.
11.58. V(2) = ,75246, + 1 . 1 3 9 ~+ ~2 4 4 d s e c
4 2 ) = -1.064~+ ~ 2.3646, + 12;- d s e c 2 .
11.60. r = 11.66g + (t' + 1 O ) ~ ~ f t 12.2. r = IOi + X j + 7km.
V = 1 1 . 6 6 ~+~3 9 5 fthec 12.4. 99.4 ft 2.485 see.
a = 6 r 5 ft/sec2. 12.6. 6.26 see.
11.62. V = l.061EF + , 0 4 2 4 2 ~+~1 . 0 6 1 ~ . d s e c 12.10. d = .01021 m.
a = -5.268~+ ~ .4329r, + 5 . 3 4 5 ~ ~ d s e c . 12.12. 162.8 m.
11.64. a = - 4 5 + 3e0 + .019896: fuseez. 12.14. 10.37 m.
11.66. V = 1 . 5 0 0 ~+~, 6 0 0 ~ + ~2 . 6 0 d~ s~e c 12.16. 62.90 d s e c .
a = -1.200~+ ~ 6e, - 9.81+dsec2. 12.18. V, = 14.12 kmhr % = 6.833 kmihr.
11.68. V = -.01062+ + 1 2 . 2 7 ~ ~ f t l s e c 12.20. 4 d s e c .
a = - 77.285 + 1.093~,ft/sec~. 12.22. 435 d s e c 16,490 m.
11.70. i = ,382 + 2.48 zz f t 12.24. 96.8 fVsec 64.1 ft.
2 = ,00694 fusee 12.26. 82.82 Ib 13.22 fVsec2.
$' = ,0239 ftlsec. 12.28. 17.22 ft distance = 17.22 ft.
11.72. Particle 1 2.3971' - ,397j d s e c 12.30. 77.53 d s e c 2 .
Particle 2 3971 + 2.603j d s e c , etc. 12.32. d = 13.86mm I = 20mm.
11.74. F := -10,680i + 7.36jN. 12.34. 2 2 . 4 d s e c d = 108.1 m.
11.76. 0 = 27.4 radlsec R = 553 radlsec. 12.36. A = 48.83 m2.
11.78. Vxvz= - l O j - 12k ftlsec 12.38. d = 2.4754 ft V = -2.72 fVsec.
arYi= Sj - 34.2k fusee2. 12.40. r = S22sec.
11.80. Hit at 3.946 m to right of center. 12.42. t = 8.58 hours.
11.82. Hit at 77 ft from bow. 12.44. V = 1.9365 ftlsec.
11.84. F = -.0652k N. 12.46. t = 2.10 sec h = 92.7 ft.
11.86. a = 18.55". 12.48. h = 77,280 ft.
11.88. 6.76 see p = 80.53". 12.50. F = 2411 Ib.
11.90. F = -5.731' + 4 6 . l j N . 12.54. d, = 31.29rpm.
11.92. Vxvz= 36.li + 19.44j - 99.2k d s e c 12.56. d = g/02.
a _ = -1094i + 4.441' - 8.85k m/sec.2 12.58. 350 N.
11.94. F := l63.li + 244.6j + 1.009 x 104kN. 12.60. w = 9.64 radfsrc.
11.96. V = 136i + 8Oj + 5kfVsec 12.62. E, = -.594i + .396j + ,701k.
r = 1.5231 + 1,004j + Io6kft. 12.66. %. = 35,921 kmhour $
! = 25,397 kmhour.
11.98. Hit at midpoint of freighter. 12.68. 0 = 1.131 radlsec2 T = ,1978N.
11.100. y = 34.19 km. 12.70. Ar = 2.07 hours.
11.102. V := 1.742i + .8360jdsec 12.74. V,,, = 15,094 kmihour T = 5.36 hours.
a = 6.33% + 10.322jm/sec. 12.76. V = 194,500 mph.
11.104. 128.5 fr/sec. 12.78. r = 548 hours.

lxix
'921"iI
'PZI'EI
'ZZI'El
'UZI'EI
'RII'EI
'9I I 'El
.PII'EI
.ZII'El
'01 1x1
'Y01'EI
'POI'EI
'ZUI'EI
'on I'E I
'Xh'EI
%.El
'P6EI

'O6EI
'RUE1
'VUE1
'PUEI
'ZX'EI
'UUEI
'RL'EI
'PL'EI
ZL'EI
'OL'EI

'VYEI
'PYEI
'ZYEI
'OYEI
'RS'EI
'9S'EI
WXI
'ZS'EI
W.EI
'RP'EI
'YP'EI
'ZP'EI
'OVEI
'XE'EI
'VCEI

'PC'EI
'ZE'EI
14.2. V = 333i + 4 O O j + 4,000k d s e c . 14.98. w = 593 cycleslsec = 3725 radsec.
14.4. V = 177.1 ft/sec to left. 14.100. 21.0 d s e c 2 .
14.6. f = 1.631 sec Ai = .7136 sec. 14.102. H = 34.4 x IO6 slug-ft'lsec.
14.8. FAY= 12.8i - 14.40j + 48.Ok N. 14.104. 0 = ,0375 radsec2 ec = .1749i + ,2623 d s e c ' .
14.10. I = -.964i - ,3881' + .97k Ib-sec. 14.106. 0 = 2.01 radsec,.
14.12. f = ,646sec. 14.108. V = 21.1 ftlsec.
14.14. f = 1.55 sec f = 13.21 sec F = 25,233 N. 14.110. (V,), = 12,975 mihour
14.16. 1.961 HP. (51, = 21,370mihour
14.18. T, = 21.70lb. AV = 31,190 - 17,260 = 13,930mihour.
14.20. = 76.7 Ib-sec. 14.112. x = 4.464 m.
14.22. AV = 10.00 kmlhour. 14.114. = 34.35 Wsec.
14.24. V = ,402 d s e c . 14.116. x = -20,566 m.
14.28. V, = 5.183 d s e c V, = 10.37 d s e c . 14.118. V = 2.778 ftlsec = 1.645 knots.
14.30. 4.905 d s e c . 14.120. S = 2.238 ft V, = ,1791 ftlsec.
14.32. F, = 965 Ib. 14.122. 6, = 5.47" 6, = 29.9".
1434. (V,), = 4 . 1 0 d s e c AKE = 18.15 N-m. 14.124. V, = 161i + 17O.Xj - 26.lk ft/sec.
14.36. (%), = -1.130mlsec. 14.126. (%), = 2 6 . 6 d s e c . [V,), = 31.1 mlsec.
14.38. S = 5.610 in. 14.128. Ho = 1.51 slug-ft'lsec Po = 0.
14.42. e= I1.8I". 14.130. H,,= 5480 slug-ft'laec.
14.44. 6 = ,750111. 14.132. h = 3000 km rmar= 9371 km.
14.46. 4.648 d s 6 = .36 m. 14.134. F = 2329 Ib.
14.48. 6 = ,7990 m. 14.136. V = 18 k d h o u r AKE = 3.24 joules.
14.50. 14.86 ft/sec. 14.138. E = 58.96Mev 1, = -325 mR = ,18746
14.52. (%), = -1.88i + 14.l4j nB = -.97417.
(V& = 8.Olj.
14.56. A = ,05142 m 6 = ,059 m.
15.4. -10.66i + 7.31j - 35.18k d s .
14.58. 50.5".
15.6. -521i + 108.7j + 65.2k m l s .
14.40. Drag = 3.53 mnV'.
15.8. p = IOi + Sjmmlsec
14.62. Drag = ,468 mnVz.
p = -1250k mm/sec2.
14.64. F = -- 4 zsR2 3.53N. 15.10. w = .94Oi + .342j + 1.8kradsec.
3 c I, = -.616i + 1.692jrad/sec2.
14.66. 37,306 kndhour.
15.12. w = -.4i + 170.8j - 170.8kradsec.
14.68. d = ,205 m.
I, = -.2i - 68.32j - 68.31-k radlsec2.
14.70. w, = 8.292 radsec.
15.14. I, = 3.14i + 1356j radsec2
14.72. o2 = 5.107 radsec.
ij = 407j + 14,200k radsec'.
14.74. 4071 mihour.
15.16. w = -121.hjradsec.
14.76. 6210 kwhour.
I, = 3823i rad/sec2.
14.78. h = I83 km.
15.18. I, = . I 2j rad/sec2
14.80. (AV), = I135 kmlhour
ij = -.024i radhec'.
(Av), = 1085 kmlhour.
15.20. V, = .Si + . 1 2 1 2 j d s
14.82. 6354 km 9373 km.
0 = .4788 radsec.
14.84.
14.86.
rmax = 32,534 miles.
rn. = 8900 miles AV = 7285 mDh.
15.22.
15.24.
e= .lXi - . l j + .2krad/sec2.
V = - 2 0 5 - 2.14j + 17.1Ok d s e c 2 .
14.88. Vo = 741 k d h o u r
15.26. V = -243i + 207j + 2Sk ndsec.
= 826 kndhour.
15.28. w = 56.7 radsec V, = 29j - 12.03k mlsec.
14.90. P = 2 . 0 2 - .0435j + ,5966 slug-ft/sec
Ifo = 1.9751 - 1.326j - 25.8k slug-ft2/sec
15.30. V, = -2 fdsec.
15.32. w = 4 radsec V, = -fii - 19j mlsec.
H, = -5.61i - 16.761' - 1.21% slug-ft2/sec. 15.34. wc = -10 radlsec.
14.92. I, = -20.0 rad/sec2.

14.94.
.
w =
T - 852Vmo
15.36. V, = -.548i - ,373jmlsec
a, = -43.41' - 63.7j mlsec'.
4m(s,2 + s22)
lxxi
15.38. w..
~ ,=, -9.33 radlsec y, = -12,381’ - 7.149k dsec. 15.118. ax,,/ = -15.SOi + ,405j - 7.XOk mlarc’
15.40. q,* = -54.7 radlsec y, = 79.8 ftJaec. (aA)xvL= -I.O5i + ,665j - 2.2k mlhec’,
15.44. = 14.66 m/SCC OJ = -5 I-adISCC. 15.122. F = 12.42; Ib.
15.46. v, = I I.95i - 4.949j mlscc 15.124. Axial forcr = 30.7 N compression
Bending rnornznt = 21 N-in.
a H = -57.771 57.77j mlscc’
-
15.126. Yx,>,,= 1.791 N.
9 = 2.625 radlscc. 15.128. -125.7i ftlsecl ,732 Ih in DIUS.# direction
15.48. (u,,,, = -.h09 radlscc iiA,, = 14.7 I radlsec’.
i, = -4i + 2 j + 30k radlsec’.
15.50. v9= 5.03i + 2 j - i k mlsec.
15.130.
q = 2.07radlwc cbc = -1.7YY radlsec’.
15.52. v, -.Si - 14.7j
= - 2.710k ftlsrc
15.132.
15.134. aXYL= -3OOi + I 5 j - 300k ftlsec’.
a,) = -1.2S.j + IOkftlsec’. 15.136. 162.2 ftlsec’.
15.54. wax = -0.0176k radlsec 15.138. ‘on = -.SI177 radlsec
i, = -4.34 x I W k radlcec?. hn = -I.lIl 15 radlsec’.
15.56. m, = 3.643 radlscc 15.140. V , , = 2Oi - 3 l j ftlscc
hA= -6.45 r u d l d a X m = 2Oi + S j - 5O(lk ftlscc’.
15.5X. w = 1.273 radlsec v. = 2. I63 mlsec.
15.142. V, = I .5oOJi - I.5OO.j mlscc.
15.60. v = 1.156 mlsec. 15.144. v, = IO mlsec W<.,> = 20 rad/\rc q,<.= I1
15.62. ( = 5.478 miscc ,z,( = -929.6 mlsec’. 15.146. V,, = 2 j mlsec
15.64. wH = 7.93 r a d k c h,, = 20.7 radlscc’.
axyz = -13.33k mlrrc’.
15.66. = 5.00 radlscc.
15.68. (UA,, = -5 radlscc e,, = -36O.8 I-ildl\ec?.
15.70. V,, = X.Xhi + S j mlscc. 16.2. 2.12 N - m
15.72. V’, = - 1 7 . 3 2 - l O j - 5Ok fllsec. 16.4. l6.70 m down.
15.74. V,, = 1.3Oi + I . X j + .130knilsec. 16.6. I- = A72 Ih.
15.76. (0, = 15.40 rndlscc o, = -31.37 radlqec. 16.8. I’ = 678 N .
15.78. w , = I . Y X 5 radlsec. 16.10. u,, = -3.27 inkc’.
15.80. V,, = -2.05i + 4 . 0 2 j - 2.66k inlsec. 16.12. r = ,285 scc.
15.82. , = -.9ORi - .5?53j - .6k mlscc. 16.14. ii, = - . ~ 6 5 7radisec’.
15.84. V,,, = 4.0Oi mlsec. 16.16. F4H = 163.4 N .
15.86. v,,, = 37.9 ftlsec rcl. to ground 16.18. 552 Rev.
vL\:= 9.813 ftlsec rel. to rod. 16.20. r,, = 71,833 p\i.
15.88. V5v: = 3.756 mliec V, = 7.165 mlsec. 16.22. < = 87.7 Ih fi; = 169.7 Ih.
15.90. w,> = Y.028 radlsec. 16.24. B y = C, = 2244 N 8. = C, = 5.27 N .
15.92. V,, = 5Oi - 5 j - 20kfdsec. 16.26. A , = fl, = 3200 Ih.
aXYZ= -1OOi - 3OOj - 35k ft/sec2. 16.28. O,, = -.9583 radlsec.
15.94. a X Y L= 2hOOi - l 7 3 . 2 j - 1712k fdscc’.
16.30.
15.96. axyL= - l h I . Y k mlsec’.
15.Y8. axiz = -5.OXi + 2.3 14j + 2.7llk mlsec’. 16.32. O = -49.97 radlscc’.
I5.lW. 0 ” - = 1.9COi - I8.69j - 1.207k mlsec’. 16.34. ai, = -12.13ftiaec’ 8 = -1.035 radlieo’.
1axy71 = 1.914 g’s. 16.36. -2.08 111.
15.102, a A,,.,,
I,.
= -25.6; - 57.6k rnlsec’ 16.38. e = -14.96 radlscc’.
15.106. a l E ,,,,, = -.403i - . 2 3 i j - l.647k. 16.40. 28.5 radlsec’.
15.108. Vxy7 = - 1 . I13i + . I 2 0 2 j mlsrc 16.42. I. U 2 mlsec’.
aXYz= .IJYhYi - .I859j mlsec’. 16.44. .ins6 ft.
15.110. axi7 = -1.204i - 2.570jftIsec’. 16.46. P = 1437 Ih.
Iaxy71= ,08814 g‘s. 16.48. 3.43 misec’.
15.112. axy7 = -73.22i - 112.63 + 67.3k mlsec’. 16.50. f = 283%’
15.114. ayyL = -.4j + I - l S j l + 2(5i + 2Ok) X ( . 2 j ) 16.52. f = 24.53 N N = 85.0 N .
+ (.02i -- I O j , X C-.Oljl + (.Si + 20k) 16.54. .4O5 m/sec2.
x [(.Si + 2Oj) x (-.olj)l miaec‘. 16.56. 7 = 68.53 Ih.
15.116. F = -.SI; + .I359j - ,07176k N. 16.58. a = 0.

lxxii
16.60. a = -2.512i + 6.26j mlsec2. 16.128. u, = 4.06i - 7.20j mJsec2.
16.64. 13.08 mlsec 0 = 10.90 radiaec. 16.130. NA = 17.13 Ib NB = 38.9 Ih
16.66. i = ,1361 Wsec' i: = 0 k; = ,6932radlsec' 4 = 3.43 Ib FR = 7.78 Ih.
16.68. V, = 7.732 m/cec. 16.132. k; = -18.34 radsec'.
16.70. P = 8.75 N. 16.134. AI = 0 A v = -21.83 Ih
16.72. BLI = 49.5 N AC = 37.0 N. Az = 100lb.
16.74. i = -3.343 m/$ec 16.136. e, = 226.2" rc = ,256 m
= -3.2Y4 misec. 0,, = 266.8" rD = ,416 m.
16.76. e = 19.32 radsec' i: = -16.100 m/sec*. 16.138. A,v = -192.7 N A , = 2500 N
16.78, i;, = -2.18 misec2 pc = 2.18 mlsec2. MA = 5647.5 N-m.
16.80, T, = 246 N T, = ,201 N.
16.82,
16.84.
e = 7.40 radsec2
OB,: = -6.43 rad/sec2
X =.;7.40 ft/sec2.
e,, = 4.29 radlsec'. 17.2. 4627 ft-lb.
16.86. gAn = 6.54 rad/sec*. 17.4. 24.5 N-m.
16.88. uA = I.1308i + .6529j &see*
17.6. 45.8N-m 4.954 N-m
h = ,17125 rad/sec2 17.8. KE = 18.95 ft-lb.
uH = ,52549 + ,047523 mlsec2.
16.90,
16.92.
,222 Rev.
A . = -32 N
A v = -212.4N
17.10.
17.12.
1 8@P8
= 3 w . 9 +Z@.ir-ui'
V, = 4 7 5 mlsec.
17.14. w = 2.79 radlsec.
= -176.6 N 17.18. V, = 5.40 d s e c .
B\, = -26.40 N. 17.20. w. = 20 radsec w. = 10.0 rad/sec
16.94. By = 0 A> = 0 17.22. V, = 11.93 fusee.
B t = -215 N A>, = -254 N 17.24. w, = 2.79 rad/sec.
A; = SON. 17.26. A = ,985 ft.
16.96. ri, = -6.26 rad/sec2 B, = 6.90 Ib Bv = 0 17.30. bH = 35.30 radsec.
Ax = 28.9 Ib A v = 0. 17.32. V = 2.354 m/s f = 79.4 N.
16.98. B, = 25N = 60.2 N 17.34. V = 4.60 misec f = 7480 N.
A> = 25 N A v = -60.2 N 17.36. 25.3 rad/sec.
16.100. B, = 200 N B! = -21.93 N 17.38. V, = 13.61 ft/sec.
2
A - = 2(H) N A t = -21.93 N. 17.40. (Ha)" = 12n slug-ft
(HJs = 0
16.102. M r = -9.171 N-m V, = -48.9N see
My = 20.9 N-m Vy = 8.66 N
slug-ft2
( H J Z = 74n ~.
see
M; = -3415 N-m.
17.42. (HJZ = 1.941 kg-m2/sec ( H J * = 3 kg-m2/sec
16.104. r3 = 1.260 ft 0, = 249.5"
r4 = 1.098 ft e, = 192.2". (HJz = 0.
17.44. h = 1.016m.
16.106. yo = -.667 in. 7, = 0
17.46. T , = I130 N P = 678. I N.
yc = 5.67 in. zc = 0. 17.48. L = 8.47 m.
16.108. e, = 270° LA = ,318 m. 17.50. w = 2.732RPM.
16.110. 6, = 223.1" rB = 1.727 m V, = -27.3 fusee.
17.52.
8, = 254.3" r4 = 2.21 m.
17.54. w = 9.09 radsec.
16.112. T = 169.6lb.
11.56. f = ,0467 sec.
16.114. f = 9.174 see.
y rndl = 1431 m II6.I".
17.58. ,

16.116. 16.90 mlsecZ.


17.62. mA = -108.7 radlsec.
16.118. -4 I radsec2.
17.64. o = 9.90 radlsec.
16.120. 60.4 Ih.
17.66. V, = -1 1.04 mlsec.
16.122. D v = 6.Y6 N D, = 31.23 N. 17.68. (q), = -165.2 radlsec (w,), = 24.22 radisec.
16.124. ii, = -3.26 radisec'. 17.70. w, = 7.64 radlsec.
16.126. k; = .0580rad/sec2 17.72. V, = 1.542i - I ,028j m/sec.
X:=5m Y=5m. 17.74. f = 15.05 per see.

lxxii
17.76. -15.24 ftisec o, = 60.9 radlscc 18.42. @ = -5.43 radsec:
17.7% = -12.39 misec.
[(!I,.),], 5.82 mdlsec.
= 12.85 mlsec. 18.44. 1.663 ft-lhlrad.
17.m. 15.52 ft-lh. 18.46. .SO4 N-m
17.82. d = .I246 m. from the posts in a direction normal
17.84. V = 7.29 ftlscc. to the plate.
Ihm-ft2 Ihm - ft2
17.86. (H(.)! = -14,550 ~~~~~
18.48. H = 32.4; + 93.2k ___
5CC see
18.50.

Ihm - Si wz = If? + $2 + 24ljrcoso


(H,) = -14,530
SCC
. I_
@=-
- 1;: .
iycoso
17.~8. 2.32 mlsec.
I:.
17.90. o = 4.1 I radlsec.
18.52. $/ = I .3 I4 radlsec
17.92. V,: = -.31 17i - .434j m k c
17.94. w = 14.78 rddlsec.
4 = 2 radlsec
I3 = 12.9".
1n.54. @ = 3.26 radlsec.
18.2. bx = 12.1') rad/sec2 in.56. e = 13.98"
b, = 7.31 r a d k c ' 4 = -.0442 radlsec.
& = .(I10radlscu'. @ = ,1264 radlsec.
18.4. -.X0Xj ft-lh. 18.58. o = 128.3"
18.6. 14Y.X; N-m. (8 = -1.194radlsec.
18.8. a = -122.6i - 5 j + 22.Yk mlsec'. 18.60. M = -29.5i + 318hj + ,409kN-m
18.10. Shear Corce = 12.2 Ih 18.61. K = -.1262i + .1433j + Y.17kN
Tensile fkrce = 25,0(10 Ih H = -.7OOi + ,14331'.
Moment = -2178 ft-lh. 18.62. 15.54 radsec.
18.14. M = X . 1 5 - SX6j + 3.5Yk N-m. 18.63. 23 I 0 radlsec or ,0654 radlsec.
18.16. M = -14X.Xi + 300j - IOX.6k N-in. 18.64. R = 62.7 m.
18.18. Moment ahout the center of mass of CD duc to motion 18.65. e= 47.30
d'CL?Mc,, = -3.lX x I O ~ " N - m (8 =-.12X3 radlsec
Moment ahout the center of mass EG due to motion !p = .525 radsec.
o f f i : i c : M , , = -1.147 x l0"N-In. 18.66. m\ = . 3 radsec
1n.20. M = -2462; - IlOhj - 2212kN-m. ot= .IX95 radlsec
18.22. M = 14741'. u. ,423 radlsec.
L

18.24. T , = 3.12 N-m 18.67. 6 = .2064 radsec


.I, = -.I10524 N-m Z in direction of z axis.
7- = -20.Y5 N-in. 18.68. 4 = I .YOS rad/sec
18.26. M = 1444i N-m. e = 7 1.87".
18.28. M = -2390 sin .419ti + 4.2Y x I O 4 cos ,419tj N-m.
1x.m M = X.35; - .S%j + 3.59k N - m
18.32. @ = 2 radlsec
%=o 19.4. K2 = 3.90 N-m.
(8 = -13.33 radlsec.
18.34. 1744 radlsec. 1Y.6. = 12B radlsec
\;L
in.36. T, = -24.9 SI-lh. 19.8. ,438 cyclesisec.
1x38. = .no283 radiiec 19.10. ,557 cyciesisec.
Result is an angular acceleration in the direction of the 19.12. 19.81 radlsec: X.34 Nlmm
torque equal to a4xx radlsec~. 19.14. 28.6 radsec.

lxxiv
19.64. 110.7m V = 51.Jkm/hr.
19.66. w = 15.95 radlsec.
w,, = VI K
M-w2 19.68. 17.89 N K = 553 x IO2 Nim
19.70. 9.805 N.
19.18. 16.05 r d s c c ; 87.9 radlsec. 19.72. 1.808 radlsec.
19.20. 1.420 sec. 19.74. -I 1.28".
19.22. Y + , 3 2 6 ~+ .01230x2 + .0001S50x' = 0 19.76. mi + 2ct + ( K , + K , ) x =0
o = ,0909 cycleslsec. , ~~ ~~~~~~

IW
19.24. ( K ) = 2.43 x IO5N-mlrad
I -4
c<, = iX(KI 6 ) +

w, = 3Wrad/sec 19.78. x(5) = - 2 1 I in. f z 6.92 rad/sec.


8 = -7.42". 19.82. f = ,321 sec.
19.26. w, = I cyclelsec. 19.84. w = ,0225 cyclelsec.
19.28. 7.88 cycleslsec
0 = -.342". 19.86.

1Y.34. 235 radlsec. +( -.05+ 0155


a
-)ea7] =0 (111)
19.36. 1.377'.
19.38. P = 1(2KL - WlZ)] 19.90. 8.73 Ibhn.
19.40. 2.32 rad/sec. 19.92. .000705m.
19.42. k = ,518 m. 19.94. 2 degrees of lreedum Y + 45 Ix - 7738 = 0
19.44. p = 0.809. 8 - 3861 + 81208 = 0.
19.97. K3 = 799Nlm.
19.98. 1.972 in.; 80.03 in.
19.99. 2.35 radlsec.
19.100. 48.2 radlsec.
19.101. k = ,748111.
_-
(68
19.102. wntT
19.103. w = 19.80 rad/sec.
19.104. W = 64.6 N.
19.50. 2.32 radlsec. 19.105. 8, = ,0608 rad.
/(3 + sinalg 19.106. .003014 rad.
19.52. w , ~= v - - r . 19.107. ,221 sec.
19.108. A = .M)1454m
19.54. w,, = B = 337 N.
~ i R - r l ) [ l + ( k z l / r , 2 ) '] 19.109. 21.6 rad/sec
19.56. x = ,004185ft. .O1115m
19.58. ,00992 m. c = 192.0 N-sec/m.

lxxv
Index

Acceleration: sign conventions, 249 Complementary solution. 542, 990


far different referenccs, 7 4 3 4 4 Binormill vector, 567 Composite areas. 334
from translating axes, 492-93 Body axis. 933 for second moments and products of
path variables, 4 6 5 4 9 Body forces, 117 area, 360-52
rectangular components, 455-64 Bound vccto~s,IX-19 Composite material, 848
Acceleration vector, 454 Bowden, F.P.. 281 Composite volumes. 127, 344
for cylindrical coordinates, 482-83 Broyt X-20 digger, 206 Cone clutch, 326
Accelerometer. 472 Bucyrus-Erie Dynahoe digger, 218 Conic pendulum. 544
Active forces, 414 Burnout velocity, 539 Conic section.. 543.. IY
Addition of vectors, 24-27 circle, 563
Adiabatic expansion. of a perfect gas. 524 directrix of. 543
Air gun, 524 cccentricity of, 543
Amplitude, 964 cllipie, 543
Angle of repose, 292 foocus "f, 543
Angle of wrap, 304 Catenary c k . 27 hyperhola, 543
Angular imp&, 882 parabola. 543
Angular momentum equations, with Euler Conservation of angular momentum
aneles.
angles. 93+36 for satellite, 679
Aneular momentum. 677 moment of momentum, 688 Conservation of lincar momentum, 647
f i r plane motion, 788-89 Newton's law, 564 Conservation of mass. 694.695
work energy equation, 869 Conservation of mechanical energy. 598
Central force motion, 538-39 Conservative force fields, 433, 597
gravitational, 5 3 9 4 7 Constrainine force. 414
Ahhdes,3 Center of pressure, 129-30 Cuntinuum,-l2
Areal velocity, 540 Center of volume, 342 Control volumc. 158
Assackatlive law, 24 Centroid Coriolis force, 113,116-778
Axial direction, 481 coordinates. 332 Coulomb friction:
Axial force. 237 for volumes. 3 4 2 4 3 definition of, 281
sign convention, 248,249 of planc area. 332 IilWS "f, 282-81
Anis of precession, 9.33 Chains, 266
Axis of rotation. instantaneous, 729 Chasles' theorem, 709-1 I
Chopper, 808
Balancing. 8 3 8 4 2 Circular motion. 474 Couples. 77-79
Ballislics, 458-62 addition of, 80M2
Beam: inoment ahout G line, 82
definition of. 247 moment of. 77-79
differential equations of equilibrium, Cramer's rule. 1015
259-60 Coefficient of restitution. 660,895 Critical damping, 1002
Sf Coefficient of rolling resistance, 320 Cross product. 4 7 4 9
Belt friction, ldblr of vducs, 320 Curl operator. 605
Centrifueal Coefficient of viscosity, 22, 1005 Curvilinear translation, 528
BendinL Commutative law, 16 Cycle, Y64
definition of, 247 for dot product, 42 Cyclone. 778
diagrams. 2 6 1 4 3 Compass settings, 28 Cylindrical coordinates, 480
lxxviii INDEX

Datum. change of, 594 general equations. 1 6 2 4 tiravitiliional law. 538


Deformable solids: method of total potential energy, 434-35 Gravity:
displacement field, 425 necessary and sufficient conditions, 162 law of ilttiilCtiOll, 21
virtual work, 425 neutral. 441 ti"lf stream. 778
Degrees of freedom, 418-19 stable, 441 Gusset plate. 221. 224
Derivative of vector. as seen from translating unstable, 441 Gyroscope:
axes. 493 Equivalent spring constant. 965 cardm supmaion. 940
Derivative: torsional, 914 aingle degree 0 1 freedom, 938-39
I W U ~ i c g ~dr s~ ~ ~ C C J O I 940111
TI.
for di tiyrohcopic cuuple. 922
Dielectr
applicaiion\ of,' 9 I 6 2 4 Hamiitun~Jacuhitheory, I022
com&ncniarv solution, 542 Extremum points, 435 Hamiiton's principle, 1022
Hydrometer. 9711
Farad. 567
Finite elements, 444 ldcaiirations of mechanic<. 12-13
Dit&sional hbmogeeneitv.' 8-9 Fink truss, 235 Impiict. 659
Dimensions: First law of thermodynamics, 694-95 direct ccntritl, 659
basic, 6 5 First moment of area. 33 1-32 eccenlric. 659
force,9 First moment of mars, 343 perfectiy elilitii.. hhl
law of dimensional homogeneity. 8-9 First moment of volume, 34243 prrtectly plastic. 662
length. 4 First moment: pinnc d, 659
primary. 4 for composite areas. 334 oblique central, 659
secondary, 4.7 with axis of symmetry. 334 with mnsiivr rigid hody. 665
time, 4-5 First-order tensors, 402 Impending s1ipp;tge. 2x2
Direct central impact. 659 Fission pracesa, 7u6 Impulsc. 637
Directed line segment, 14 Fletmer's ship, 929 angular, 882
Direction cosines, 32 Flyball governor. 208, 557. 888-89 from light. 674
Directrix, 543 Focus. 543 linear, 882
Displacement field, 425 Force: Impulse-momenturn equations:
Displacement vector, 15 central, 538 angular for rigid hodies. 882
Distributed force systems, 117-18 Coriolis. 77678 h e i r for rigid bodies, 882
Distributive law: dynamic. 838 Impulhivc force, 64849. 895
for CTOSS product. 4 7 4 x impulsive, 64849, 895 llllp"1Si"c lUrq"C, 895
for dot product. 42 ineniul. 773 Inertia ellipsoid, Ixix. 407-9
Dot product, 41-43 Force field, conservative, 594-97 lncnial forces, 172
Drop test, 608 Force polygon, 168 Inertial rcfcrcncr. 19, 504
Dym, C.L., 413, 1022 Forces: ln~liintilnruu~ axis of rotation. 729
Dynamic coefficient of friction. 282-83 active. 414 1ntegriltion fonnul;ls. X Y i i k X X i i
Dynamic forces, 838 body. I I7 Integration. by parts, 633
Dynamics, definition of, 451 conservative. 432-33 Intensir) ~floadiug,I I X
constraining, 414 Isothermal erpilnrion. of a perfect gab 524
Eccentric impact, 659 distributed, 117-18
of slablike bodies, 895 parallel, coplanar distribution, I33 Just-rigid t ~ u s s 224
.
Echo satellite. 674 parallel distribution. 129-30
Einstein, Albert, 3 surface, I17 Kepler, first law. 547
Ellipse, properties of, Iv-lvi translation of, 9 6 9 5 Kioematics. drlinitiim of. 451
Ellipsoid of inenia, 407-9 Frame. 155 Kinetic energy:
Energy methods, 413,426 Free-My diagram. 152-54 for il single pnniclr, 580
Energy methods: Free fall, 777 for rigid hudieh, 61445. 853-61
for a single panicle, 580 Free vector^. 18 relativistic, 633
for rigid bodies, 853-57 Free vibration, 96145 using mass center, 014-15
for vibrations. 984-85 Freauencv. 964
Energy. potential, 594 Friciion: Langrange multiplier, x x
Equality of vectors, 17, 18 Coulomb, 281 Langrilnge'a equations. 1i122
Equation of state. for P perfect gas, belt friction. 301-3 Law of cosines, 25
524 coefficients of friction, 282 Law of sines. 25
Equations of equilibrium: comder contact woblems. 299 Lilws of gravitational attrilction, 2W21
concurrent forces, 16546 impinding rlipp&, 282 Length, 4
coplanar forces. 170 laws of, 282-83 Line of ilctiun. 17
general case, 187 simple contact problems, 28685 Linear ",omentum, 637
parallel forces. 183 definition. 281 conservation ul. 647
summary of special cases. 183 viscous. 2x1 for a system of pimiclcr. 643
Equations of motion. using Euler angles Functional. 243 fur mars center. 645
934-36 Linear spring, 521
&uilibyi"m: Generalized coordinates, 418 Lines of nodes, 931
conditrans for, 930 Gradient operator, 483 LuKdrithmic decrement. 1018
for concurrent forces. 16546 Gradient operator, 595 Lubrication, 281
for conservative forces, 432-33 Gravitational attraction. 21
for coplanar forces. 170 Gravitational cenwal force motion, 539 MacLaurin scriea, 441
for parallel forces. I83 Gravitational constant, 2 I Magnification factor, i1)10
INDEX lxxix
Magnua effect. 929 Nonlinear differential equation, 536 Principal moments of inertia, for mass, xxxi,
~ a n o m e t e r 9x9
. Nonlinear spring, 521 389.407-9
Mars. 49 I Normal stress, 401 Principal normal vector, 466
Mass center: definilicln. 565 Nutation: Principle of virtual work (see Vinual work)
kinetic eoerm. 614 angle Of. 933 Product of area, 335
velocity. 933 composite areas. 3 6 M 2
computations of, 2 5 7 4 2
Oblique central impact, 659 rotation of ares, 36-67
. . Optimization theory, 444 Product of inertia. xxii
relation tu a r e a . xxviii. 3x7 Orhital time. 545 Properties of plane sear. principal axes,
Osculating plane, 465-66 370-72
Over-rigid truss, 224
Overdamped vibration, loo0 Radial direction, 481
involving plane of symmetry. Xxiv-xxv, Radiation pressure, 674
382-83 Pappus-Guldinus theorems, 347-50 Radius of curvature. 466
relation to ilrmb, xxix, 38C-87 Parallelogram law, 15, 21 formula for plane path, 467
rotation of axes, xixviii. 395-Y8 Parking orbit, 550 Radius of gyration, 355,618, xxiv
transfer theorem, xxxx, 393 Panicle, 13, 14 for mass, xxiv, 382
Mass, rest mass. 63 I Panicles, system of, 564 Random wnlk, 60
Mass, unita of. IO Particular solution. 542-990 Rate gyro. 939
Maxwell Eqs. 694 Pascal unit, 131 Rectangular cwrdinater, 455
Mcchanical energy. conserviitim of. 598 Path function, 580 Rectilinear translation:
Mechanics. laws of. 19-21 Path varhblea, 465, 4 6 7 4 9 definition of, 512
Newton's law, 561 force a function of position, 520
Pelton water wheel, 752 force a function of speed, 515-17
Perigee, 547,679 force a function of time, 512-13
Period, Y64 force is constant, 512-13
for mass center, 645 Period of deformation, 660-895 Reference:
Method of moment 01 momentum. 686-89 Period of restitution, 66W895 inertial. 19
for a particle. 675 Phase angle, 964 right-hand, 48
Method of momentuni, linear. 637 Phason. 962 Reg& precession, 453
Methud uf sections, 238-39 Piecrsidr continuity, 513 Relative motion, axes translating. 492-94
Method of total potential energy, 434-35 Pitch, 490 Relative motion. eeneral. 744-49. 7 5 5 4 8
Method of undetermined coefficients, I007 Plane areas, radii of gyration, 355
Method of work energy, for rigid bdiea. Plane motion:
8h&h3 definition of, 787
Mode of vibration. 1017 rolling slablike bodies, 810 .
Mohr's circle, 372 moment of momentum, 788-91 Resonance, 992
Moment of a force: ruvalim of arbiualy bodies. 834 Rest mass,633
aboul an axis. 69-73 rotation of body of revolution. 791-92 Resultant:
about a point. 62-64 rotation of slablike bodies, 800 definition of, l(12-3
Moment of area, 331--32 rotaion with two planes of symmetry. 797 general. 103
for mass (see Mass moment of inertia) slablike bodies, general plane simplest:
Moment of mommtum. 675 motion, 816 coplanar system. 106-7
for a hystem of particles. 686 Plane of conlact, 659 general case, I12
fur plane motion, 788-90 Plane strain. xliv, 401 parallel system, I10
of a rigid hody, 878-79 Plane stress. xliii. 401, 410 Retrograde precession, 953
Momcntum: Plane surfaces: Rigid bodies, plane motion of, 707
lincar. 637 centroid, 332 Rigid body. 13
mument of. 675 t i n t moment, 331-34 Rolling resistance. 319-20
Multidegree of lrecdom vibrations. 885-89 xcund moment, 355-56 Rotation, 708
Multiple integration, 120, 126 Planimeter, 638 axis of, 708
finite, 16
Natural frequency. 964
torsional. 975 Scalar components, 30-33
Neutral equilibrium, 441 Position vector, 61 orthogonal. 31-32
Newton's first law, 19-20 Potential energy. 388, 595
Newton's law, 9 function. 432
for a aystem of particles. 564 linear spring, 390
for center of mass. 565 svstem of narticles. 610
fur central forces, 539 Poind mass,.Sl I
for cylindrical coordinates. 536 Power, 585
for notiinertial references. 773 Rat1 truss, 235
for path vilriilbles. 561 Precession:
for reclilngulvr coordinatea, 512 angle of. 933
Newton's second law. 19-20
Newton's third law. 19. 868
Newton's viacvsity law. 22. Io05
Newton, Isaac. 3 Principal axes: kotatidn of ax&, 366-67
Newton-Raphsun. lviii for areas, 37&71 Second order tensor, xlii
Noninenial reference. 773 for mess, xxxi, 389, 407-9 Second-order tensor, xlii. 400-2

~~~~
__
IXXX INDEX

Separation of variahlcs. 5 111


Shamcs. I.H., xi,, I, Iii.210, 247, 372. 408.
410.413.4.14. 1022

She; strain. xliv

Space mechmics, 544


launching angle. 544
tcajeclorics, 5 4 6 4 7
vsnguiiril ~ d l i t e 548
.
Specific weight. 119. 141
Sneed. 14

lineis. 521
nunlinear. 52 I
Square scrcw rhreud. 3 17
Icsid, 317
pilch, 317
self-l<,cking. l l x
Stabilily, 4 4 1 4 3
Stahlc rquilihrium, 441
requirements lor, 4 4 1 4 2
Static coefficicnt of friction. 283
Slatic determinancy:
definition of, 204-5
external. 205
internal, 205
Static indeteminacy, definition of, 21W5
Statics. 211
Sleady pEcrsaim. 936-27
, I
Steady state ~ d u t i o n 99
Sicvinius, S.. 21
Stress, xllii, 401
Sublraclion of veclurs. 24. 27
Surface forcca, I17
Surtice traclions, I17

work-energy equilriun, 6OY

Tnhor. D., Z R I
Tensors. xlii. 40lM
symmetry of, 41H)
Theorems of Pappus-Guldinua, 3 4 7 1 8
Three-lurcc theorrm, 200
Toroue-frcc motimt. Y45-5 I
Torshgraph. YY?
Torsioiiill spring, 43X
Tvrsional vibration, 973
Turd potcniial energy. 243
Towing lank, 485, 891
lor mm mumcnt "1 inertia. i x x v
for mass product ufioenin. x x x v
Transfer theorems:
for tiiass muinem of inelria. 393
for mass product 01 inerlia, 3Y3
for products of ilveil. 357
fbr second momcnls o f mca. 156

You might also like